blob: 997b2a7b9da1b483549a60a3d0944180f4df665d [file] [log] [blame]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001 ----------------------
Willy Tarreau8317b282014-04-23 01:49:41 +02002 HAProxy
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02003 Configuration Manual
4 ----------------------
Willy Tarreau2e077f82019-11-25 20:36:16 +01005 version 2.2
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02006 willy tarreau
Willy Tarreaud0089302020-04-17 14:19:38 +02007 2020/04/17
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008
9
10This document covers the configuration language as implemented in the version
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011specified above. It does not provide any hints, examples, or advice. For such
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012documentation, please refer to the Reference Manual or the Architecture Manual.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013The summary below is meant to help you find sections by name and navigate
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014through the document.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016Note to documentation contributors :
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040017 This document is formatted with 80 columns per line, with even number of
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020018 spaces for indentation and without tabs. Please follow these rules strictly
19 so that it remains easily printable everywhere. If a line needs to be
20 printed verbatim and does not fit, please end each line with a backslash
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020021 ('\') and continue on next line, indented by two characters. It is also
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010022 sometimes useful to prefix all output lines (logs, console outputs) with 3
23 closing angle brackets ('>>>') in order to emphasize the difference between
24 inputs and outputs when they may be ambiguous. If you add sections,
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020025 please update the summary below for easier searching.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020026
27
28Summary
29-------
30
311. Quick reminder about HTTP
321.1. The HTTP transaction model
331.2. HTTP request
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100341.2.1. The request line
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200351.2.2. The request headers
361.3. HTTP response
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100371.3.1. The response line
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200381.3.2. The response headers
39
402. Configuring HAProxy
412.1. Configuration file format
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200422.2. Quoting and escaping
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +0200432.3. Environment variables
442.4. Time format
452.5. Examples
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020046
473. Global parameters
483.1. Process management and security
493.2. Performance tuning
503.3. Debugging
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +0100513.4. Userlists
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +0200523.5. Peers
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +0200533.6. Mailers
William Lallemandc9515522019-06-12 16:32:11 +0200543.7. Programs
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +0100553.8. HTTP-errors
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020056
574. Proxies
584.1. Proxy keywords matrix
594.2. Alphabetically sorted keywords reference
60
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100615. Bind and server options
Willy Tarreau086fbf52012-09-24 20:34:51 +0200625.1. Bind options
635.2. Server and default-server options
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +0200645.3. Server DNS resolution
655.3.1. Global overview
665.3.2. The resolvers section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020067
Julien Pivotto6ccee412019-11-27 15:49:54 +0100686. Cache
696.1. Limitation
706.2. Setup
716.2.1. Cache section
726.2.2. Proxy section
73
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200747. Using ACLs and fetching samples
757.1. ACL basics
767.1.1. Matching booleans
777.1.2. Matching integers
787.1.3. Matching strings
797.1.4. Matching regular expressions (regexes)
807.1.5. Matching arbitrary data blocks
817.1.6. Matching IPv4 and IPv6 addresses
827.2. Using ACLs to form conditions
837.3. Fetching samples
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200847.3.1. Converters
857.3.2. Fetching samples from internal states
867.3.3. Fetching samples at Layer 4
877.3.4. Fetching samples at Layer 5
887.3.5. Fetching samples from buffer contents (Layer 6)
897.3.6. Fetching HTTP samples (Layer 7)
Christopher Fauletba3c68f2020-04-01 16:27:05 +0200907.3.7. Fetching health-check samples
917.3.8. Fetching samples for developers
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200927.4. Pre-defined ACLs
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020093
948. Logging
958.1. Log levels
968.2. Log formats
978.2.1. Default log format
988.2.2. TCP log format
998.2.3. HTTP log format
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01001008.2.4. Custom log format
Willy Tarreau5f51e1a2012-12-03 18:40:10 +01001018.2.5. Error log format
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02001028.3. Advanced logging options
1038.3.1. Disabling logging of external tests
1048.3.2. Logging before waiting for the session to terminate
1058.3.3. Raising log level upon errors
1068.3.4. Disabling logging of successful connections
1078.4. Timing events
1088.5. Session state at disconnection
1098.6. Non-printable characters
1108.7. Capturing HTTP cookies
1118.8. Capturing HTTP headers
1128.9. Examples of logs
113
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02001149. Supported filters
1159.1. Trace
1169.2. HTTP compression
Christopher Fauletf7e4e7e2016-10-27 22:29:49 +02001179.3. Stream Processing Offload Engine (SPOE)
Christopher Faulet99a17a22018-12-11 09:18:27 +01001189.4. Cache
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +02001199.5. fcgi-app
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +0200120
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020012110. FastCGI applications
12210.1. Setup
12310.1.1. Fcgi-app section
12410.1.2. Proxy section
12510.1.3. Example
12610.2. Default parameters
12710.3. Limitations
128
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200129
1301. Quick reminder about HTTP
131----------------------------
132
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100133When HAProxy is running in HTTP mode, both the request and the response are
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200134fully analyzed and indexed, thus it becomes possible to build matching criteria
135on almost anything found in the contents.
136
137However, it is important to understand how HTTP requests and responses are
138formed, and how HAProxy decomposes them. It will then become easier to write
139correct rules and to debug existing configurations.
140
141
1421.1. The HTTP transaction model
143-------------------------------
144
145The HTTP protocol is transaction-driven. This means that each request will lead
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100146to one and only one response. Traditionally, a TCP connection is established
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100147from the client to the server, a request is sent by the client through the
148connection, the server responds, and the connection is closed. A new request
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200149will involve a new connection :
150
151 [CON1] [REQ1] ... [RESP1] [CLO1] [CON2] [REQ2] ... [RESP2] [CLO2] ...
152
153In this mode, called the "HTTP close" mode, there are as many connection
154establishments as there are HTTP transactions. Since the connection is closed
155by the server after the response, the client does not need to know the content
156length.
157
158Due to the transactional nature of the protocol, it was possible to improve it
159to avoid closing a connection between two subsequent transactions. In this mode
160however, it is mandatory that the server indicates the content length for each
161response so that the client does not wait indefinitely. For this, a special
162header is used: "Content-length". This mode is called the "keep-alive" mode :
163
164 [CON] [REQ1] ... [RESP1] [REQ2] ... [RESP2] [CLO] ...
165
166Its advantages are a reduced latency between transactions, and less processing
167power required on the server side. It is generally better than the close mode,
168but not always because the clients often limit their concurrent connections to
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +0200169a smaller value.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200170
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100171Another improvement in the communications is the pipelining mode. It still uses
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200172keep-alive, but the client does not wait for the first response to send the
173second request. This is useful for fetching large number of images composing a
174page :
175
176 [CON] [REQ1] [REQ2] ... [RESP1] [RESP2] [CLO] ...
177
178This can obviously have a tremendous benefit on performance because the network
179latency is eliminated between subsequent requests. Many HTTP agents do not
180correctly support pipelining since there is no way to associate a response with
181the corresponding request in HTTP. For this reason, it is mandatory for the
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +0100182server to reply in the exact same order as the requests were received.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200183
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100184The next improvement is the multiplexed mode, as implemented in HTTP/2. This
185time, each transaction is assigned a single stream identifier, and all streams
186are multiplexed over an existing connection. Many requests can be sent in
187parallel by the client, and responses can arrive in any order since they also
188carry the stream identifier.
189
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +0100190By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
191connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
192leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and the
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100193start of a new request. When it receives HTTP/2 connections from a client, it
194processes all the requests in parallel and leaves the connection idling,
195waiting for new requests, just as if it was a keep-alive HTTP connection.
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +0200196
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +0200197HAProxy supports 4 connection modes :
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +0100198 - keep alive : all requests and responses are processed (default)
199 - tunnel : only the first request and response are processed,
Christopher Faulet6c9bbb22019-03-26 21:37:23 +0100200 everything else is forwarded with no analysis (deprecated).
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +0100201 - server close : the server-facing connection is closed after the response.
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +0200202 - close : the connection is actively closed after end of response.
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +0100203
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100204For HTTP/2, the connection mode resembles more the "server close" mode : given
205the independence of all streams, there is currently no place to hook the idle
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100206server connection after a response, so it is closed after the response. HTTP/2
207is only supported for incoming connections, not on connections going to
208servers.
209
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200210
2111.2. HTTP request
212-----------------
213
214First, let's consider this HTTP request :
215
216 Line Contents
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100217 number
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200218 1 GET /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2 HTTP/1.1
219 2 Host: www.mydomain.com
220 3 User-agent: my small browser
221 4 Accept: image/jpeg, image/gif
222 5 Accept: image/png
223
224
2251.2.1. The Request line
226-----------------------
227
228Line 1 is the "request line". It is always composed of 3 fields :
229
230 - a METHOD : GET
231 - a URI : /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
232 - a version tag : HTTP/1.1
233
234All of them are delimited by what the standard calls LWS (linear white spaces),
235which are commonly spaces, but can also be tabs or line feeds/carriage returns
236followed by spaces/tabs. The method itself cannot contain any colon (':') and
237is limited to alphabetic letters. All those various combinations make it
238desirable that HAProxy performs the splitting itself rather than leaving it to
239the user to write a complex or inaccurate regular expression.
240
241The URI itself can have several forms :
242
243 - A "relative URI" :
244
245 /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
246
247 It is a complete URL without the host part. This is generally what is
248 received by servers, reverse proxies and transparent proxies.
249
250 - An "absolute URI", also called a "URL" :
251
252 http://192.168.0.12:8080/serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
253
254 It is composed of a "scheme" (the protocol name followed by '://'), a host
255 name or address, optionally a colon (':') followed by a port number, then
256 a relative URI beginning at the first slash ('/') after the address part.
257 This is generally what proxies receive, but a server supporting HTTP/1.1
258 must accept this form too.
259
260 - a star ('*') : this form is only accepted in association with the OPTIONS
261 method and is not relayable. It is used to inquiry a next hop's
262 capabilities.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100263
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200264 - an address:port combination : 192.168.0.12:80
265 This is used with the CONNECT method, which is used to establish TCP
266 tunnels through HTTP proxies, generally for HTTPS, but sometimes for
267 other protocols too.
268
269In a relative URI, two sub-parts are identified. The part before the question
270mark is called the "path". It is typically the relative path to static objects
271on the server. The part after the question mark is called the "query string".
272It is mostly used with GET requests sent to dynamic scripts and is very
273specific to the language, framework or application in use.
274
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100275HTTP/2 doesn't convey a version information with the request, so the version is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100276assumed to be the same as the one of the underlying protocol (i.e. "HTTP/2").
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100277However, haproxy natively processes HTTP/1.x requests and headers, so requests
278received over an HTTP/2 connection are transcoded to HTTP/1.1 before being
279processed. This explains why they still appear as "HTTP/1.1" in haproxy's logs
280as well as in server logs.
281
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200282
2831.2.2. The request headers
284--------------------------
285
286The headers start at the second line. They are composed of a name at the
287beginning of the line, immediately followed by a colon (':'). Traditionally,
288an LWS is added after the colon but that's not required. Then come the values.
289Multiple identical headers may be folded into one single line, delimiting the
290values with commas, provided that their order is respected. This is commonly
291encountered in the "Cookie:" field. A header may span over multiple lines if
292the subsequent lines begin with an LWS. In the example in 1.2, lines 4 and 5
293define a total of 3 values for the "Accept:" header.
294
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100295Contrary to a common misconception, header names are not case-sensitive, and
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200296their values are not either if they refer to other header names (such as the
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100297"Connection:" header). In HTTP/2, header names are always sent in lower case,
298as can be seen when running in debug mode.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200299
300The end of the headers is indicated by the first empty line. People often say
301that it's a double line feed, which is not exact, even if a double line feed
302is one valid form of empty line.
303
304Fortunately, HAProxy takes care of all these complex combinations when indexing
305headers, checking values and counting them, so there is no reason to worry
306about the way they could be written, but it is important not to accuse an
307application of being buggy if it does unusual, valid things.
308
309Important note:
Lukas Tribus23953682017-04-28 13:24:30 +0000310 As suggested by RFC7231, HAProxy normalizes headers by replacing line breaks
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200311 in the middle of headers by LWS in order to join multi-line headers. This
312 is necessary for proper analysis and helps less capable HTTP parsers to work
313 correctly and not to be fooled by such complex constructs.
314
315
3161.3. HTTP response
317------------------
318
319An HTTP response looks very much like an HTTP request. Both are called HTTP
320messages. Let's consider this HTTP response :
321
322 Line Contents
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100323 number
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200324 1 HTTP/1.1 200 OK
325 2 Content-length: 350
326 3 Content-Type: text/html
327
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +0200328As a special case, HTTP supports so called "Informational responses" as status
329codes 1xx. These messages are special in that they don't convey any part of the
330response, they're just used as sort of a signaling message to ask a client to
Willy Tarreau5843d1a2010-02-01 15:13:32 +0100331continue to post its request for instance. In the case of a status 100 response
332the requested information will be carried by the next non-100 response message
333following the informational one. This implies that multiple responses may be
334sent to a single request, and that this only works when keep-alive is enabled
335(1xx messages are HTTP/1.1 only). HAProxy handles these messages and is able to
336correctly forward and skip them, and only process the next non-100 response. As
337such, these messages are neither logged nor transformed, unless explicitly
338state otherwise. Status 101 messages indicate that the protocol is changing
339over the same connection and that haproxy must switch to tunnel mode, just as
340if a CONNECT had occurred. Then the Upgrade header would contain additional
341information about the type of protocol the connection is switching to.
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +0200342
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200343
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003441.3.1. The response line
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200345------------------------
346
347Line 1 is the "response line". It is always composed of 3 fields :
348
349 - a version tag : HTTP/1.1
350 - a status code : 200
351 - a reason : OK
352
353The status code is always 3-digit. The first digit indicates a general status :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100354 - 1xx = informational message to be skipped (e.g. 100, 101)
355 - 2xx = OK, content is following (e.g. 200, 206)
356 - 3xx = OK, no content following (e.g. 302, 304)
357 - 4xx = error caused by the client (e.g. 401, 403, 404)
358 - 5xx = error caused by the server (e.g. 500, 502, 503)
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200359
Lukas Tribus23953682017-04-28 13:24:30 +0000360Please refer to RFC7231 for the detailed meaning of all such codes. The
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100361"reason" field is just a hint, but is not parsed by clients. Anything can be
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200362found there, but it's a common practice to respect the well-established
363messages. It can be composed of one or multiple words, such as "OK", "Found",
364or "Authentication Required".
365
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100366HAProxy may emit the following status codes by itself :
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200367
368 Code When / reason
369 200 access to stats page, and when replying to monitoring requests
370 301 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
371 302 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
372 303 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
Willy Tarreaub67fdc42013-03-29 19:28:11 +0100373 307 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
374 308 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200375 400 for an invalid or too large request
376 401 when an authentication is required to perform the action (when
377 accessing the stats page)
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +0200378 403 when a request is forbidden by a "http-request deny" rule
Florian Tham9205fea2020-01-08 13:35:30 +0100379 404 when the requested resource could not be found
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200380 408 when the request timeout strikes before the request is complete
Florian Tham272e29b2020-01-08 10:19:05 +0100381 410 when the requested resource is no longer available and will not
382 be available again
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200383 500 when haproxy encounters an unrecoverable internal error, such as a
384 memory allocation failure, which should never happen
385 502 when the server returns an empty, invalid or incomplete response, or
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +0200386 when an "http-response deny" rule blocks the response.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200387 503 when no server was available to handle the request, or in response to
388 monitoring requests which match the "monitor fail" condition
389 504 when the response timeout strikes before the server responds
390
391The error 4xx and 5xx codes above may be customized (see "errorloc" in section
3924.2).
393
394
3951.3.2. The response headers
396---------------------------
397
398Response headers work exactly like request headers, and as such, HAProxy uses
399the same parsing function for both. Please refer to paragraph 1.2.2 for more
400details.
401
402
4032. Configuring HAProxy
404----------------------
405
4062.1. Configuration file format
407------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200408
409HAProxy's configuration process involves 3 major sources of parameters :
410
411 - the arguments from the command-line, which always take precedence
412 - the "global" section, which sets process-wide parameters
413 - the proxies sections which can take form of "defaults", "listen",
414 "frontend" and "backend".
415
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100416The configuration file syntax consists in lines beginning with a keyword
417referenced in this manual, optionally followed by one or several parameters
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200418delimited by spaces.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100419
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200420
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +02004212.2. Quoting and escaping
422-------------------------
423
424HAProxy's configuration introduces a quoting and escaping system similar to
425many programming languages. The configuration file supports 3 types: escaping
426with a backslash, weak quoting with double quotes, and strong quoting with
427single quotes.
428
429If spaces have to be entered in strings, then they must be escaped by preceding
430them by a backslash ('\') or by quoting them. Backslashes also have to be
431escaped by doubling or strong quoting them.
432
433Escaping is achieved by preceding a special character by a backslash ('\'):
434
435 \ to mark a space and differentiate it from a delimiter
436 \# to mark a hash and differentiate it from a comment
437 \\ to use a backslash
438 \' to use a single quote and differentiate it from strong quoting
439 \" to use a double quote and differentiate it from weak quoting
440
441Weak quoting is achieved by using double quotes (""). Weak quoting prevents
442the interpretation of:
443
444 space as a parameter separator
445 ' single quote as a strong quoting delimiter
446 # hash as a comment start
447
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +0200448Weak quoting permits the interpretation of variables, if you want to use a non
449-interpreted dollar within a double quoted string, you should escape it with a
450backslash ("\$"), it does not work outside weak quoting.
451
452Interpretation of escaping and special characters are not prevented by weak
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200453quoting.
454
455Strong quoting is achieved by using single quotes (''). Inside single quotes,
456nothing is interpreted, it's the efficient way to quote regexes.
457
458Quoted and escaped strings are replaced in memory by their interpreted
459equivalent, it allows you to perform concatenation.
460
461 Example:
462 # those are equivalents:
463 log-format %{+Q}o\ %t\ %s\ %{-Q}r
464 log-format "%{+Q}o %t %s %{-Q}r"
465 log-format '%{+Q}o %t %s %{-Q}r'
466 log-format "%{+Q}o %t"' %s %{-Q}r'
467 log-format "%{+Q}o %t"' %s'\ %{-Q}r
468
469 # those are equivalents:
470 reqrep "^([^\ :]*)\ /static/(.*)" \1\ /\2
471 reqrep "^([^ :]*)\ /static/(.*)" '\1 /\2'
472 reqrep "^([^ :]*)\ /static/(.*)" "\1 /\2"
473 reqrep "^([^ :]*)\ /static/(.*)" "\1\ /\2"
474
475
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02004762.3. Environment variables
477--------------------------
478
479HAProxy's configuration supports environment variables. Those variables are
480interpreted only within double quotes. Variables are expanded during the
481configuration parsing. Variable names must be preceded by a dollar ("$") and
482optionally enclosed with braces ("{}") similarly to what is done in Bourne
483shell. Variable names can contain alphanumerical characters or the character
484underscore ("_") but should not start with a digit.
485
486 Example:
487
488 bind "fd@${FD_APP1}"
489
490 log "${LOCAL_SYSLOG}:514" local0 notice # send to local server
491
492 user "$HAPROXY_USER"
493
William Lallemand4d03e432019-06-14 15:35:37 +0200494Some variables are defined by HAProxy, they can be used in the configuration
495file, or could be inherited by a program (See 3.7. Programs):
William Lallemanddaf4cd22018-04-17 16:46:13 +0200496
William Lallemand4d03e432019-06-14 15:35:37 +0200497* HAPROXY_LOCALPEER: defined at the startup of the process which contains the
498 name of the local peer. (See "-L" in the management guide.)
499
500* HAPROXY_CFGFILES: list of the configuration files loaded by HAProxy,
501 separated by semicolons. Can be useful in the case you specified a
502 directory.
503
504* HAPROXY_MWORKER: In master-worker mode, this variable is set to 1.
505
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -0500506* HAPROXY_CLI: configured listeners addresses of the stats socket for every
William Lallemand4d03e432019-06-14 15:35:37 +0200507 processes, separated by semicolons.
508
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -0500509* HAPROXY_MASTER_CLI: In master-worker mode, listeners addresses of the master
William Lallemand4d03e432019-06-14 15:35:37 +0200510 CLI, separated by semicolons.
511
512See also "external-check command" for other variables.
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +0200513
5142.4. Time format
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200515----------------
516
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100517Some parameters involve values representing time, such as timeouts. These
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100518values are generally expressed in milliseconds (unless explicitly stated
519otherwise) but may be expressed in any other unit by suffixing the unit to the
520numeric value. It is important to consider this because it will not be repeated
521for every keyword. Supported units are :
522
523 - us : microseconds. 1 microsecond = 1/1000000 second
524 - ms : milliseconds. 1 millisecond = 1/1000 second. This is the default.
525 - s : seconds. 1s = 1000ms
526 - m : minutes. 1m = 60s = 60000ms
527 - h : hours. 1h = 60m = 3600s = 3600000ms
528 - d : days. 1d = 24h = 1440m = 86400s = 86400000ms
529
530
Lukas Tribusaa83a312017-03-21 09:25:09 +00005312.5. Examples
Patrick Mezard35da19c2010-06-12 17:02:47 +0200532-------------
533
534 # Simple configuration for an HTTP proxy listening on port 80 on all
535 # interfaces and forwarding requests to a single backend "servers" with a
536 # single server "server1" listening on 127.0.0.1:8000
537 global
538 daemon
539 maxconn 256
540
541 defaults
542 mode http
543 timeout connect 5000ms
544 timeout client 50000ms
545 timeout server 50000ms
546
547 frontend http-in
548 bind *:80
549 default_backend servers
550
551 backend servers
552 server server1 127.0.0.1:8000 maxconn 32
553
554
555 # The same configuration defined with a single listen block. Shorter but
556 # less expressive, especially in HTTP mode.
557 global
558 daemon
559 maxconn 256
560
561 defaults
562 mode http
563 timeout connect 5000ms
564 timeout client 50000ms
565 timeout server 50000ms
566
567 listen http-in
568 bind *:80
569 server server1 127.0.0.1:8000 maxconn 32
570
571
572Assuming haproxy is in $PATH, test these configurations in a shell with:
573
Willy Tarreauccb289d2010-12-11 20:19:38 +0100574 $ sudo haproxy -f configuration.conf -c
Patrick Mezard35da19c2010-06-12 17:02:47 +0200575
576
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02005773. Global parameters
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200578--------------------
579
580Parameters in the "global" section are process-wide and often OS-specific. They
581are generally set once for all and do not need being changed once correct. Some
582of them have command-line equivalents.
583
584The following keywords are supported in the "global" section :
585
586 * Process management and security
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200587 - ca-base
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200588 - chroot
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200589 - crt-base
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200590 - cpu-map
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200591 - daemon
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200592 - description
593 - deviceatlas-json-file
594 - deviceatlas-log-level
595 - deviceatlas-separator
596 - deviceatlas-properties-cookie
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +0900597 - external-check
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200598 - gid
599 - group
Cyril Bonté203ec5a2017-03-23 22:44:13 +0100600 - hard-stop-after
Christopher Faulet98fbe952019-07-22 16:18:24 +0200601 - h1-case-adjust
602 - h1-case-adjust-file
Willy Tarreaud96f1122019-12-03 07:07:36 +0100603 - insecure-fork-wanted
Willy Tarreaua45a8b52019-12-06 16:31:45 +0100604 - insecure-setuid-wanted
Emmanuel Hocdet70df7bf2019-01-04 11:08:20 +0100605 - issuers-chain-path
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200606 - log
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200607 - log-tag
Joe Williamsdf5b38f2010-12-29 17:05:48 +0100608 - log-send-hostname
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200609 - lua-load
Tim Duesterhusdd74b5f2020-01-12 13:55:40 +0100610 - lua-prepend-path
William Lallemand27edc4b2019-05-07 17:49:33 +0200611 - mworker-max-reloads
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200612 - nbproc
Christopher Fauletbe0faa22017-08-29 15:37:10 +0200613 - nbthread
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200614 - node
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200615 - pidfile
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +0100616 - presetenv
617 - resetenv
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200618 - uid
619 - ulimit-n
620 - user
Willy Tarreau636848a2019-04-15 19:38:50 +0200621 - set-dumpable
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +0100622 - setenv
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +0200623 - stats
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200624 - ssl-default-bind-ciphers
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +0200625 - ssl-default-bind-ciphersuites
Jerome Magninb203ff62020-04-03 15:28:22 +0200626 - ssl-default-bind-curves
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200627 - ssl-default-bind-options
628 - ssl-default-server-ciphers
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +0200629 - ssl-default-server-ciphersuites
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200630 - ssl-default-server-options
631 - ssl-dh-param-file
Emeric Brun850efd52014-01-29 12:24:34 +0100632 - ssl-server-verify
Emmanuel Hocdetc3b7e742020-04-22 11:06:19 +0200633 - ssl-skip-self-issued-ca
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +0100634 - unix-bind
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +0100635 - unsetenv
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +0100636 - 51degrees-data-file
637 - 51degrees-property-name-list
Dragan Dosen93b38d92015-06-29 16:43:25 +0200638 - 51degrees-property-separator
Dragan Dosenae6d39a2015-06-29 16:43:27 +0200639 - 51degrees-cache-size
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +0200640 - wurfl-data-file
641 - wurfl-information-list
642 - wurfl-information-list-separator
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +0200643 - wurfl-cache-size
William Dauchy0fec3ab2019-10-27 20:08:11 +0100644 - strict-limits
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100645
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200646 * Performance tuning
William Dauchy0a8824f2019-10-27 20:08:09 +0100647 - busy-polling
Willy Tarreau1746eec2014-04-25 10:46:47 +0200648 - max-spread-checks
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200649 - maxconn
Willy Tarreau81c25d02011-09-07 15:17:21 +0200650 - maxconnrate
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +0100651 - maxcomprate
William Lallemand072a2bf2012-11-20 17:01:01 +0100652 - maxcompcpuusage
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +0100653 - maxpipes
Willy Tarreau93e7c002013-10-07 18:51:07 +0200654 - maxsessrate
Willy Tarreau403edff2012-09-06 11:58:37 +0200655 - maxsslconn
Willy Tarreaue43d5322013-10-07 20:01:52 +0200656 - maxsslrate
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200657 - maxzlibmem
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200658 - noepoll
659 - nokqueue
Emmanuel Hocdet0ba4f482019-04-08 16:53:32 +0000660 - noevports
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200661 - nopoll
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +0100662 - nosplice
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +0300663 - nogetaddrinfo
Lukas Tribusa0bcbdc2016-09-12 21:42:20 +0000664 - noreuseport
Willy Tarreau75c62c22018-11-22 11:02:09 +0100665 - profiling.tasks
Willy Tarreaufe255b72007-10-14 23:09:26 +0200666 - spread-checks
Baptiste Assmann5626f482015-08-23 10:00:10 +0200667 - server-state-base
Baptiste Assmannef1f0fc2015-08-23 10:06:39 +0200668 - server-state-file
Grant Zhang872f9c22017-01-21 01:10:18 +0000669 - ssl-engine
Grant Zhangfa6c7ee2017-01-14 01:42:15 +0000670 - ssl-mode-async
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200671 - tune.buffers.limit
672 - tune.buffers.reserve
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +0200673 - tune.bufsize
Willy Tarreau43961d52010-10-04 20:39:20 +0200674 - tune.chksize
William Lallemandf3747832012-11-09 12:33:10 +0100675 - tune.comp.maxlevel
Willy Tarreaufe20e5b2017-07-27 11:42:14 +0200676 - tune.h2.header-table-size
Willy Tarreaue6baec02017-07-27 11:45:11 +0200677 - tune.h2.initial-window-size
Willy Tarreau5242ef82017-07-27 11:47:28 +0200678 - tune.h2.max-concurrent-streams
Willy Tarreau193b8c62012-11-22 00:17:38 +0100679 - tune.http.cookielen
Stéphane Cottin23e9e932017-05-18 08:58:41 +0200680 - tune.http.logurilen
Willy Tarreauac1932d2011-10-24 19:14:41 +0200681 - tune.http.maxhdr
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +0100682 - tune.idletimer
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +0100683 - tune.lua.forced-yield
Willy Tarreau32f61e22015-03-18 17:54:59 +0100684 - tune.lua.maxmem
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +0100685 - tune.lua.session-timeout
686 - tune.lua.task-timeout
Thierry FOURNIER7dd784b2015-10-01 14:49:33 +0200687 - tune.lua.service-timeout
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +0100688 - tune.maxaccept
689 - tune.maxpollevents
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +0200690 - tune.maxrewrite
Willy Tarreauf3045d22015-04-29 16:24:50 +0200691 - tune.pattern.cache-size
Willy Tarreaubd9a0a72011-10-23 21:14:29 +0200692 - tune.pipesize
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +0100693 - tune.rcvbuf.client
694 - tune.rcvbuf.server
Willy Tarreaub22fc302015-12-14 12:04:35 +0100695 - tune.recv_enough
Olivier Houchard1599b802018-05-24 18:59:04 +0200696 - tune.runqueue-depth
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +0100697 - tune.sndbuf.client
698 - tune.sndbuf.server
Willy Tarreau6ec58db2012-11-16 16:32:15 +0100699 - tune.ssl.cachesize
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +0100700 - tune.ssl.lifetime
Emeric Brun8dc60392014-05-09 13:52:00 +0200701 - tune.ssl.force-private-cache
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +0100702 - tune.ssl.maxrecord
Remi Gacognef46cd6e2014-06-12 14:58:40 +0200703 - tune.ssl.default-dh-param
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +0200704 - tune.ssl.ssl-ctx-cache-size
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +0100705 - tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +0200706 - tune.vars.global-max-size
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +0100707 - tune.vars.proc-max-size
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +0200708 - tune.vars.reqres-max-size
709 - tune.vars.sess-max-size
710 - tune.vars.txn-max-size
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +0100711 - tune.zlib.memlevel
712 - tune.zlib.windowsize
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100713
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200714 * Debugging
715 - debug
716 - quiet
Willy Tarreau3eb10b82020-04-15 16:42:39 +0200717 - zero-warning
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200718
719
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007203.1. Process management and security
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200721------------------------------------
722
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200723ca-base <dir>
724 Assigns a default directory to fetch SSL CA certificates and CRLs from when a
Emmanuel Hocdet842e94e2019-12-16 16:39:17 +0100725 relative path is used with "ca-file", "ca-verify-file" or "crl-file"
726 directives. Absolute locations specified in "ca-file", "ca-verify-file" and
727 "crl-file" prevail and ignore "ca-base".
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200728
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200729chroot <jail dir>
730 Changes current directory to <jail dir> and performs a chroot() there before
731 dropping privileges. This increases the security level in case an unknown
732 vulnerability would be exploited, since it would make it very hard for the
733 attacker to exploit the system. This only works when the process is started
734 with superuser privileges. It is important to ensure that <jail_dir> is both
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100735 empty and non-writable to anyone.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100736
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100737cpu-map [auto:]<process-set>[/<thread-set>] <cpu-set>...
738 On Linux 2.6 and above, it is possible to bind a process or a thread to a
739 specific CPU set. This means that the process or the thread will never run on
740 other CPUs. The "cpu-map" directive specifies CPU sets for process or thread
741 sets. The first argument is a process set, eventually followed by a thread
742 set. These sets have the format
743
744 all | odd | even | number[-[number]]
745
746 <number>> must be a number between 1 and 32 or 64, depending on the machine's
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100747 word size. Any process IDs above nbproc and any thread IDs above nbthread are
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100748 ignored. It is possible to specify a range with two such number delimited by
749 a dash ('-'). It also is possible to specify all processes at once using
Christopher Faulet1dcb9cb2017-11-22 10:24:40 +0100750 "all", only odd numbers using "odd" or even numbers using "even", just like
751 with the "bind-process" directive. The second and forthcoming arguments are
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100752 CPU sets. Each CPU set is either a unique number between 0 and 31 or 63 or a
Christopher Faulet1dcb9cb2017-11-22 10:24:40 +0100753 range with two such numbers delimited by a dash ('-'). Multiple CPU numbers
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100754 or ranges may be specified, and the processes or threads will be allowed to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100755 bind to all of them. Obviously, multiple "cpu-map" directives may be
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100756 specified. Each "cpu-map" directive will replace the previous ones when they
757 overlap. A thread will be bound on the intersection of its mapping and the
758 one of the process on which it is attached. If the intersection is null, no
759 specific binding will be set for the thread.
Willy Tarreaufc6c0322012-11-16 16:12:27 +0100760
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +0100761 Ranges can be partially defined. The higher bound can be omitted. In such
762 case, it is replaced by the corresponding maximum value, 32 or 64 depending
763 on the machine's word size.
764
Christopher Faulet26028f62017-11-22 15:01:51 +0100765 The prefix "auto:" can be added before the process set to let HAProxy
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100766 automatically bind a process or a thread to a CPU by incrementing
767 process/thread and CPU sets. To be valid, both sets must have the same
768 size. No matter the declaration order of the CPU sets, it will be bound from
769 the lowest to the highest bound. Having a process and a thread range with the
770 "auto:" prefix is not supported. Only one range is supported, the other one
771 must be a fixed number.
Christopher Faulet26028f62017-11-22 15:01:51 +0100772
773 Examples:
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100774 cpu-map 1-4 0-3 # bind processes 1 to 4 on the first 4 CPUs
775
776 cpu-map 1/all 0-3 # bind all threads of the first process on the
777 # first 4 CPUs
778
779 cpu-map 1- 0- # will be replaced by "cpu-map 1-64 0-63"
780 # or "cpu-map 1-32 0-31" depending on the machine's
781 # word size.
782
Christopher Faulet26028f62017-11-22 15:01:51 +0100783 # all these lines bind the process 1 to the cpu 0, the process 2 to cpu 1
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100784 # and so on.
Christopher Faulet26028f62017-11-22 15:01:51 +0100785 cpu-map auto:1-4 0-3
786 cpu-map auto:1-4 0-1 2-3
787 cpu-map auto:1-4 3 2 1 0
788
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100789 # all these lines bind the thread 1 to the cpu 0, the thread 2 to cpu 1
790 # and so on.
791 cpu-map auto:1/1-4 0-3
792 cpu-map auto:1/1-4 0-1 2-3
793 cpu-map auto:1/1-4 3 2 1 0
794
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100795 # bind each process to exactly one CPU using all/odd/even keyword
Christopher Faulet26028f62017-11-22 15:01:51 +0100796 cpu-map auto:all 0-63
797 cpu-map auto:even 0-31
798 cpu-map auto:odd 32-63
799
800 # invalid cpu-map because process and CPU sets have different sizes.
801 cpu-map auto:1-4 0 # invalid
802 cpu-map auto:1 0-3 # invalid
803
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100804 # invalid cpu-map because automatic binding is used with a process range
805 # and a thread range.
806 cpu-map auto:all/all 0 # invalid
807 cpu-map auto:all/1-4 0 # invalid
808 cpu-map auto:1-4/all 0 # invalid
809
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200810crt-base <dir>
811 Assigns a default directory to fetch SSL certificates from when a relative
William Dauchy238ea3b2020-01-11 13:09:12 +0100812 path is used with "crtfile" or "crt" directives. Absolute locations specified
813 prevail and ignore "crt-base".
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200814
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200815daemon
816 Makes the process fork into background. This is the recommended mode of
817 operation. It is equivalent to the command line "-D" argument. It can be
Lukas Tribusf46bf952017-11-21 12:39:34 +0100818 disabled by the command line "-db" argument. This option is ignored in
819 systemd mode.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200820
David Carlier8167f302015-06-01 13:50:06 +0200821deviceatlas-json-file <path>
822 Sets the path of the DeviceAtlas JSON data file to be loaded by the API.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100823 The path must be a valid JSON data file and accessible by HAProxy process.
David Carlier8167f302015-06-01 13:50:06 +0200824
825deviceatlas-log-level <value>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100826 Sets the level of information returned by the API. This directive is
David Carlier8167f302015-06-01 13:50:06 +0200827 optional and set to 0 by default if not set.
828
829deviceatlas-separator <char>
830 Sets the character separator for the API properties results. This directive
831 is optional and set to | by default if not set.
832
Cyril Bonté0306c4a2015-10-26 22:37:38 +0100833deviceatlas-properties-cookie <name>
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +0200834 Sets the client cookie's name used for the detection if the DeviceAtlas
835 Client-side component was used during the request. This directive is optional
836 and set to DAPROPS by default if not set.
David Carlier29b3ca32015-09-25 14:09:21 +0100837
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +0900838external-check
Willy Tarreaud96f1122019-12-03 07:07:36 +0100839 Allows the use of an external agent to perform health checks. This is
840 disabled by default as a security precaution, and even when enabled, checks
Willy Tarreaua45a8b52019-12-06 16:31:45 +0100841 may still fail unless "insecure-fork-wanted" is enabled as well. If the
842 program launched makes use of a setuid executable (it should really not),
843 you may also need to set "insecure-setuid-wanted" in the global section.
844 See "option external-check", and "insecure-fork-wanted", and
845 "insecure-setuid-wanted".
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +0900846
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200847gid <number>
848 Changes the process' group ID to <number>. It is recommended that the group
849 ID is dedicated to HAProxy or to a small set of similar daemons. HAProxy must
850 be started with a user belonging to this group, or with superuser privileges.
Michael Schererab012dd2013-01-12 18:35:19 +0100851 Note that if haproxy is started from a user having supplementary groups, it
852 will only be able to drop these groups if started with superuser privileges.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200853 See also "group" and "uid".
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100854
Willy Tarreau11770ce2019-12-03 08:29:22 +0100855group <group name>
856 Similar to "gid" but uses the GID of group name <group name> from /etc/group.
857 See also "gid" and "user".
858
Cyril Bonté203ec5a2017-03-23 22:44:13 +0100859hard-stop-after <time>
860 Defines the maximum time allowed to perform a clean soft-stop.
861
862 Arguments :
863 <time> is the maximum time (by default in milliseconds) for which the
864 instance will remain alive when a soft-stop is received via the
865 SIGUSR1 signal.
866
867 This may be used to ensure that the instance will quit even if connections
868 remain opened during a soft-stop (for example with long timeouts for a proxy
869 in tcp mode). It applies both in TCP and HTTP mode.
870
871 Example:
872 global
873 hard-stop-after 30s
874
Christopher Faulet98fbe952019-07-22 16:18:24 +0200875h1-case-adjust <from> <to>
876 Defines the case adjustment to apply, when enabled, to the header name
877 <from>, to change it to <to> before sending it to HTTP/1 clients or
878 servers. <from> must be in lower case, and <from> and <to> must not differ
879 except for their case. It may be repeated if several header names need to be
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +0500880 adjusted. Duplicate entries are not allowed. If a lot of header names have to
Christopher Faulet98fbe952019-07-22 16:18:24 +0200881 be adjusted, it might be more convenient to use "h1-case-adjust-file".
882 Please note that no transformation will be applied unless "option
883 h1-case-adjust-bogus-client" or "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server" is
884 specified in a proxy.
885
886 There is no standard case for header names because, as stated in RFC7230,
887 they are case-insensitive. So applications must handle them in a case-
888 insensitive manner. But some bogus applications violate the standards and
889 erroneously rely on the cases most commonly used by browsers. This problem
890 becomes critical with HTTP/2 because all header names must be exchanged in
891 lower case, and HAProxy follows the same convention. All header names are
892 sent in lower case to clients and servers, regardless of the HTTP version.
893
894 Applications which fail to properly process requests or responses may require
895 to temporarily use such workarounds to adjust header names sent to them for
896 the time it takes the application to be fixed. Please note that an
897 application which requires such workarounds might be vulnerable to content
898 smuggling attacks and must absolutely be fixed.
899
900 Example:
901 global
902 h1-case-adjust content-length Content-Length
903
904 See "h1-case-adjust-file", "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client" and
905 "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server".
906
907h1-case-adjust-file <hdrs-file>
908 Defines a file containing a list of key/value pairs used to adjust the case
909 of some header names before sending them to HTTP/1 clients or servers. The
910 file <hdrs-file> must contain 2 header names per line. The first one must be
911 in lower case and both must not differ except for their case. Lines which
912 start with '#' are ignored, just like empty lines. Leading and trailing tabs
913 and spaces are stripped. Duplicate entries are not allowed. Please note that
914 no transformation will be applied unless "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client"
915 or "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server" is specified in a proxy.
916
917 If this directive is repeated, only the last one will be processed. It is an
918 alternative to the directive "h1-case-adjust" if a lot of header names need
919 to be adjusted. Please read the risks associated with using this.
920
921 See "h1-case-adjust", "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client" and
922 "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server".
923
Willy Tarreaud96f1122019-12-03 07:07:36 +0100924insecure-fork-wanted
925 By default haproxy tries hard to prevent any thread and process creation
926 after it starts. Doing so is particularly important when using Lua files of
927 uncertain origin, and when experimenting with development versions which may
928 still contain bugs whose exploitability is uncertain. And generally speaking
929 it's good hygiene to make sure that no unexpected background activity can be
930 triggered by traffic. But this prevents external checks from working, and may
931 break some very specific Lua scripts which actively rely on the ability to
932 fork. This option is there to disable this protection. Note that it is a bad
933 idea to disable it, as a vulnerability in a library or within haproxy itself
934 will be easier to exploit once disabled. In addition, forking from Lua or
935 anywhere else is not reliable as the forked process may randomly embed a lock
936 set by another thread and never manage to finish an operation. As such it is
937 highly recommended that this option is never used and that any workload
938 requiring such a fork be reconsidered and moved to a safer solution (such as
939 agents instead of external checks). This option supports the "no" prefix to
940 disable it.
941
Willy Tarreaua45a8b52019-12-06 16:31:45 +0100942insecure-setuid-wanted
943 HAProxy doesn't need to call executables at run time (except when using
944 external checks which are strongly recommended against), and is even expected
945 to isolate itself into an empty chroot. As such, there basically is no valid
946 reason to allow a setuid executable to be called without the user being fully
947 aware of the risks. In a situation where haproxy would need to call external
948 checks and/or disable chroot, exploiting a vulnerability in a library or in
949 haproxy itself could lead to the execution of an external program. On Linux
950 it is possible to lock the process so that any setuid bit present on such an
951 executable is ignored. This significantly reduces the risk of privilege
952 escalation in such a situation. This is what haproxy does by default. In case
953 this causes a problem to an external check (for example one which would need
954 the "ping" command), then it is possible to disable this protection by
955 explicitly adding this directive in the global section. If enabled, it is
956 possible to turn it back off by prefixing it with the "no" keyword.
957
Emmanuel Hocdet70df7bf2019-01-04 11:08:20 +0100958issuers-chain-path <dir>
959 Assigns a directory to load certificate chain for issuer completion. All
960 files must be in PEM format. For certificates loaded with "crt" or "crt-list",
961 if certificate chain is not included in PEM (also commonly known as
962 intermediate certificate), haproxy will complete chain if the issuer of the
963 certificate corresponds to the first certificate of the chain loaded with
964 "issuers-chain-path".
965 A "crt" file with PrivateKey+Certificate+IntermediateCA2+IntermediateCA1
966 could be replaced with PrivateKey+Certificate. HAProxy will complete the
967 chain if a file with IntermediateCA2+IntermediateCA1 is present in
968 "issuers-chain-path" directory. All other certificates with the same issuer
969 will share the chain in memory.
970
Frédéric Lécailled690dfa2019-04-25 10:52:17 +0200971log <address> [len <length>] [format <format>] [sample <ranges>:<smp_size>]
972 <facility> [max level [min level]]
Cyril Bonté3e954872018-03-20 23:30:27 +0100973 Adds a global syslog server. Several global servers can be defined. They
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100974 will receive logs for starts and exits, as well as all logs from proxies
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100975 configured with "log global".
976
977 <address> can be one of:
978
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +0100979 - An IPv4 address optionally followed by a colon and a UDP port. If
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100980 no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the standard syslog
981 port).
982
David du Colombier24bb5f52011-03-17 10:40:23 +0100983 - An IPv6 address followed by a colon and optionally a UDP port. If
984 no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the standard syslog
985 port).
986
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +0100987 - A filesystem path to a datagram UNIX domain socket, keeping in mind
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100988 considerations for chroot (be sure the path is accessible inside
989 the chroot) and uid/gid (be sure the path is appropriately
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100990 writable).
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100991
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +0100992 - A file descriptor number in the form "fd@<number>", which may point
993 to a pipe, terminal, or socket. In this case unbuffered logs are used
994 and one writev() call per log is performed. This is a bit expensive
995 but acceptable for most workloads. Messages sent this way will not be
996 truncated but may be dropped, in which case the DroppedLogs counter
997 will be incremented. The writev() call is atomic even on pipes for
998 messages up to PIPE_BUF size, which POSIX recommends to be at least
999 512 and which is 4096 bytes on most modern operating systems. Any
1000 larger message may be interleaved with messages from other processes.
1001 Exceptionally for debugging purposes the file descriptor may also be
1002 directed to a file, but doing so will significantly slow haproxy down
1003 as non-blocking calls will be ignored. Also there will be no way to
1004 purge nor rotate this file without restarting the process. Note that
1005 the configured syslog format is preserved, so the output is suitable
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01001006 for use with a TCP syslog server. See also the "short" and "raw"
1007 format below.
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +01001008
1009 - "stdout" / "stderr", which are respectively aliases for "fd@1" and
1010 "fd@2", see above.
1011
Willy Tarreauc046d162019-08-30 15:24:59 +02001012 - A ring buffer in the form "ring@<name>", which will correspond to an
1013 in-memory ring buffer accessible over the CLI using the "show events"
1014 command, which will also list existing rings and their sizes. Such
1015 buffers are lost on reload or restart but when used as a complement
1016 this can help troubleshooting by having the logs instantly available.
1017
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02001018 You may want to reference some environment variables in the address
1019 parameter, see section 2.3 about environment variables.
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01001020
Willy Tarreau18324f52014-06-27 18:10:07 +02001021 <length> is an optional maximum line length. Log lines larger than this value
1022 will be truncated before being sent. The reason is that syslog
1023 servers act differently on log line length. All servers support the
1024 default value of 1024, but some servers simply drop larger lines
1025 while others do log them. If a server supports long lines, it may
1026 make sense to set this value here in order to avoid truncating long
1027 lines. Similarly, if a server drops long lines, it is preferable to
1028 truncate them before sending them. Accepted values are 80 to 65535
1029 inclusive. The default value of 1024 is generally fine for all
1030 standard usages. Some specific cases of long captures or
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001031 JSON-formatted logs may require larger values. You may also need to
1032 increase "tune.http.logurilen" if your request URIs are truncated.
Willy Tarreau18324f52014-06-27 18:10:07 +02001033
Dragan Dosen7ad31542015-09-28 17:16:47 +02001034 <format> is the log format used when generating syslog messages. It may be
1035 one of the following :
1036
1037 rfc3164 The RFC3164 syslog message format. This is the default.
1038 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc3164)
1039
1040 rfc5424 The RFC5424 syslog message format.
1041 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc5424)
1042
Willy Tarreaue8746a02018-11-12 08:45:00 +01001043 short A message containing only a level between angle brackets such as
1044 '<3>', followed by the text. The PID, date, time, process name
1045 and system name are omitted. This is designed to be used with a
1046 local log server. This format is compatible with what the systemd
1047 logger consumes.
1048
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01001049 raw A message containing only the text. The level, PID, date, time,
1050 process name and system name are omitted. This is designed to be
1051 used in containers or during development, where the severity only
1052 depends on the file descriptor used (stdout/stderr).
1053
Frédéric Lécailled690dfa2019-04-25 10:52:17 +02001054 <ranges> A list of comma-separated ranges to identify the logs to sample.
1055 This is used to balance the load of the logs to send to the log
1056 server. The limits of the ranges cannot be null. They are numbered
1057 from 1. The size or period (in number of logs) of the sample must be
1058 set with <sample_size> parameter.
1059
1060 <sample_size>
1061 The size of the sample in number of logs to consider when balancing
1062 their logging loads. It is used to balance the load of the logs to
1063 send to the syslog server. This size must be greater or equal to the
1064 maximum of the high limits of the ranges.
1065 (see also <ranges> parameter).
1066
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +01001067 <facility> must be one of the 24 standard syslog facilities :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001068
Willy Tarreaue8746a02018-11-12 08:45:00 +01001069 kern user mail daemon auth syslog lpr news
1070 uucp cron auth2 ftp ntp audit alert cron2
1071 local0 local1 local2 local3 local4 local5 local6 local7
1072
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01001073 Note that the facility is ignored for the "short" and "raw"
1074 formats, but still required as a positional field. It is
1075 recommended to use "daemon" in this case to make it clear that
1076 it's only supposed to be used locally.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001077
1078 An optional level can be specified to filter outgoing messages. By default,
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +02001079 all messages are sent. If a maximum level is specified, only messages with a
1080 severity at least as important as this level will be sent. An optional minimum
1081 level can be specified. If it is set, logs emitted with a more severe level
1082 than this one will be capped to this level. This is used to avoid sending
1083 "emerg" messages on all terminals on some default syslog configurations.
1084 Eight levels are known :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001085
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02001086 emerg alert crit err warning notice info debug
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001087
Joe Williamsdf5b38f2010-12-29 17:05:48 +01001088log-send-hostname [<string>]
1089 Sets the hostname field in the syslog header. If optional "string" parameter
1090 is set the header is set to the string contents, otherwise uses the hostname
1091 of the system. Generally used if one is not relaying logs through an
1092 intermediate syslog server or for simply customizing the hostname printed in
1093 the logs.
1094
Kevinm48936af2010-12-22 16:08:21 +00001095log-tag <string>
1096 Sets the tag field in the syslog header to this string. It defaults to the
1097 program name as launched from the command line, which usually is "haproxy".
1098 Sometimes it can be useful to differentiate between multiple processes
Willy Tarreau094af4e2015-01-07 15:03:42 +01001099 running on the same host. See also the per-proxy "log-tag" directive.
Kevinm48936af2010-12-22 16:08:21 +00001100
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01001101lua-load <file>
1102 This global directive loads and executes a Lua file. This directive can be
1103 used multiple times.
1104
Tim Duesterhusdd74b5f2020-01-12 13:55:40 +01001105lua-prepend-path <string> [<type>]
1106 Prepends the given string followed by a semicolon to Lua's package.<type>
1107 variable.
1108 <type> must either be "path" or "cpath". If <type> is not given it defaults
1109 to "path".
1110
1111 Lua's paths are semicolon delimited lists of patterns that specify how the
1112 `require` function attempts to find the source file of a library. Question
1113 marks (?) within a pattern will be replaced by module name. The path is
1114 evaluated left to right. This implies that paths that are prepended later
1115 will be checked earlier.
1116
1117 As an example by specifying the following path:
1118
1119 lua-prepend-path /usr/share/haproxy-lua/?/init.lua
1120 lua-prepend-path /usr/share/haproxy-lua/?.lua
1121
1122 When `require "example"` is being called Lua will first attempt to load the
1123 /usr/share/haproxy-lua/example.lua script, if that does not exist the
1124 /usr/share/haproxy-lua/example/init.lua will be attempted and the default
1125 paths if that does not exist either.
1126
1127 See https://www.lua.org/pil/8.1.html for the details within the Lua
1128 documentation.
1129
William Lallemand4cfede82017-11-24 22:02:34 +01001130master-worker [no-exit-on-failure]
William Lallemande202b1e2017-06-01 17:38:56 +02001131 Master-worker mode. It is equivalent to the command line "-W" argument.
1132 This mode will launch a "master" which will monitor the "workers". Using
1133 this mode, you can reload HAProxy directly by sending a SIGUSR2 signal to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001134 the master. The master-worker mode is compatible either with the foreground
William Lallemande202b1e2017-06-01 17:38:56 +02001135 or daemon mode. It is recommended to use this mode with multiprocess and
1136 systemd.
William Lallemand4cfede82017-11-24 22:02:34 +01001137 By default, if a worker exits with a bad return code, in the case of a
1138 segfault for example, all workers will be killed, and the master will leave.
1139 It is convenient to combine this behavior with Restart=on-failure in a
1140 systemd unit file in order to relaunch the whole process. If you don't want
1141 this behavior, you must use the keyword "no-exit-on-failure".
William Lallemande202b1e2017-06-01 17:38:56 +02001142
William Lallemand4cfede82017-11-24 22:02:34 +01001143 See also "-W" in the management guide.
William Lallemande202b1e2017-06-01 17:38:56 +02001144
William Lallemand27edc4b2019-05-07 17:49:33 +02001145mworker-max-reloads <number>
1146 In master-worker mode, this option limits the number of time a worker can
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05001147 survive to a reload. If the worker did not leave after a reload, once its
William Lallemand27edc4b2019-05-07 17:49:33 +02001148 number of reloads is greater than this number, the worker will receive a
1149 SIGTERM. This option helps to keep under control the number of workers.
1150 See also "show proc" in the Management Guide.
1151
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001152nbproc <number>
1153 Creates <number> processes when going daemon. This requires the "daemon"
1154 mode. By default, only one process is created, which is the recommended mode
1155 of operation. For systems limited to small sets of file descriptors per
Willy Tarreau149ab772019-01-26 14:27:06 +01001156 process, it may be needed to fork multiple daemons. When set to a value
1157 larger than 1, threads are automatically disabled. USING MULTIPLE PROCESSES
Willy Tarreau1f672a82019-01-26 14:20:55 +01001158 IS HARDER TO DEBUG AND IS REALLY DISCOURAGED. See also "daemon" and
1159 "nbthread".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001160
Christopher Fauletbe0faa22017-08-29 15:37:10 +02001161nbthread <number>
1162 This setting is only available when support for threads was built in. It
Willy Tarreau26f6ae12019-02-02 12:56:15 +01001163 makes haproxy run on <number> threads. This is exclusive with "nbproc". While
1164 "nbproc" historically used to be the only way to use multiple processors, it
1165 also involved a number of shortcomings related to the lack of synchronization
1166 between processes (health-checks, peers, stick-tables, stats, ...) which do
1167 not affect threads. As such, any modern configuration is strongly encouraged
Willy Tarreau149ab772019-01-26 14:27:06 +01001168 to migrate away from "nbproc" to "nbthread". "nbthread" also works when
1169 HAProxy is started in foreground. On some platforms supporting CPU affinity,
1170 when nbproc is not used, the default "nbthread" value is automatically set to
1171 the number of CPUs the process is bound to upon startup. This means that the
1172 thread count can easily be adjusted from the calling process using commands
1173 like "taskset" or "cpuset". Otherwise, this value defaults to 1. The default
1174 value is reported in the output of "haproxy -vv". See also "nbproc".
Christopher Fauletbe0faa22017-08-29 15:37:10 +02001175
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001176pidfile <pidfile>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001177 Writes PIDs of all daemons into file <pidfile>. This option is equivalent to
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001178 the "-p" command line argument. The file must be accessible to the user
1179 starting the process. See also "daemon".
1180
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +01001181presetenv <name> <value>
1182 Sets environment variable <name> to value <value>. If the variable exists, it
1183 is NOT overwritten. The changes immediately take effect so that the next line
1184 in the configuration file sees the new value. See also "setenv", "resetenv",
1185 and "unsetenv".
1186
1187resetenv [<name> ...]
1188 Removes all environment variables except the ones specified in argument. It
1189 allows to use a clean controlled environment before setting new values with
1190 setenv or unsetenv. Please note that some internal functions may make use of
1191 some environment variables, such as time manipulation functions, but also
1192 OpenSSL or even external checks. This must be used with extreme care and only
1193 after complete validation. The changes immediately take effect so that the
1194 next line in the configuration file sees the new environment. See also
1195 "setenv", "presetenv", and "unsetenv".
1196
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +01001197stats bind-process [ all | odd | even | <process_num>[-[process_num>]] ] ...
Willy Tarreau35b7b162012-10-22 23:17:18 +02001198 Limits the stats socket to a certain set of processes numbers. By default the
1199 stats socket is bound to all processes, causing a warning to be emitted when
1200 nbproc is greater than 1 because there is no way to select the target process
1201 when connecting. However, by using this setting, it becomes possible to pin
1202 the stats socket to a specific set of processes, typically the first one. The
1203 warning will automatically be disabled when this setting is used, whatever
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01001204 the number of processes used. The maximum process ID depends on the machine's
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +01001205 word size (32 or 64). Ranges can be partially defined. The higher bound can
1206 be omitted. In such case, it is replaced by the corresponding maximum
1207 value. A better option consists in using the "process" setting of the "stats
1208 socket" line to force the process on each line.
Willy Tarreau35b7b162012-10-22 23:17:18 +02001209
Baptiste Assmann5626f482015-08-23 10:00:10 +02001210server-state-base <directory>
1211 Specifies the directory prefix to be prepended in front of all servers state
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02001212 file names which do not start with a '/'. See also "server-state-file",
1213 "load-server-state-from-file" and "server-state-file-name".
Baptiste Assmannef1f0fc2015-08-23 10:06:39 +02001214
1215server-state-file <file>
1216 Specifies the path to the file containing state of servers. If the path starts
1217 with a slash ('/'), it is considered absolute, otherwise it is considered
1218 relative to the directory specified using "server-state-base" (if set) or to
1219 the current directory. Before reloading HAProxy, it is possible to save the
1220 servers' current state using the stats command "show servers state". The
1221 output of this command must be written in the file pointed by <file>. When
1222 starting up, before handling traffic, HAProxy will read, load and apply state
1223 for each server found in the file and available in its current running
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02001224 configuration. See also "server-state-base" and "show servers state",
1225 "load-server-state-from-file" and "server-state-file-name"
Baptiste Assmann5626f482015-08-23 10:00:10 +02001226
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +01001227setenv <name> <value>
1228 Sets environment variable <name> to value <value>. If the variable exists, it
1229 is overwritten. The changes immediately take effect so that the next line in
1230 the configuration file sees the new value. See also "presetenv", "resetenv",
1231 and "unsetenv".
1232
Willy Tarreau636848a2019-04-15 19:38:50 +02001233set-dumpable
1234 This option is better left disabled by default and enabled only upon a
William Dauchyec730982019-10-27 20:08:10 +01001235 developer's request. If it has been enabled, it may still be forcibly
1236 disabled by prefixing it with the "no" keyword. It has no impact on
1237 performance nor stability but will try hard to re-enable core dumps that were
1238 possibly disabled by file size limitations (ulimit -f), core size limitations
1239 (ulimit -c), or "dumpability" of a process after changing its UID/GID (such
1240 as /proc/sys/fs/suid_dumpable on Linux). Core dumps might still be limited by
1241 the current directory's permissions (check what directory the file is started
1242 from), the chroot directory's permission (it may be needed to temporarily
1243 disable the chroot directive or to move it to a dedicated writable location),
1244 or any other system-specific constraint. For example, some Linux flavours are
1245 notorious for replacing the default core file with a path to an executable
1246 not even installed on the system (check /proc/sys/kernel/core_pattern). Often,
1247 simply writing "core", "core.%p" or "/var/log/core/core.%p" addresses the
1248 issue. When trying to enable this option waiting for a rare issue to
1249 re-appear, it's often a good idea to first try to obtain such a dump by
1250 issuing, for example, "kill -11" to the haproxy process and verify that it
1251 leaves a core where expected when dying.
Willy Tarreau636848a2019-04-15 19:38:50 +02001252
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +01001253ssl-default-bind-ciphers <ciphers>
1254 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
1255 the default string describing the list of cipher algorithms ("cipher suite")
Bertrand Jacquin8cf7c1e2019-02-03 18:35:25 +00001256 that are negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake up to TLSv1.2 for all
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +02001257 "bind" lines which do not explicitly define theirs. The format of the string
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +00001258 is defined in "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages. For background
1259 information and recommendations see e.g.
1260 (https://wiki.mozilla.org/Security/Server_Side_TLS) and
1261 (https://mozilla.github.io/server-side-tls/ssl-config-generator/). For TLSv1.3
1262 cipher configuration, please check the "ssl-default-bind-ciphersuites" keyword.
1263 Please check the "bind" keyword for more information.
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +02001264
1265ssl-default-bind-ciphersuites <ciphersuites>
1266 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in and
1267 OpenSSL 1.1.1 or later was used to build HAProxy. It sets the default string
1268 describing the list of cipher algorithms ("cipher suite") that are negotiated
1269 during the TLSv1.3 handshake for all "bind" lines which do not explicitly define
1270 theirs. The format of the string is defined in
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +00001271 "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages under the section "ciphersuites". For
1272 cipher configuration for TLSv1.2 and earlier, please check the
1273 "ssl-default-bind-ciphers" keyword. Please check the "bind" keyword for more
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +02001274 information.
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +01001275
Jerome Magninb203ff62020-04-03 15:28:22 +02001276ssl-default-bind-curves <curves>
1277 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
1278 the default string describing the list of elliptic curves algorithms ("curve
1279 suite") that are negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake with ECDHE. The format
1280 of the string is a colon-delimited list of curve name.
1281 Please check the "bind" keyword for more information.
1282
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01001283ssl-default-bind-options [<option>]...
1284 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
1285 default ssl-options to force on all "bind" lines. Please check the "bind"
1286 keyword to see available options.
1287
1288 Example:
1289 global
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +02001290 ssl-default-bind-options ssl-min-ver TLSv1.0 no-tls-tickets
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01001291
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +01001292ssl-default-server-ciphers <ciphers>
1293 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
1294 sets the default string describing the list of cipher algorithms that are
Bertrand Jacquin8cf7c1e2019-02-03 18:35:25 +00001295 negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake up to TLSv1.2 with the server,
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +02001296 for all "server" lines which do not explicitly define theirs. The format of
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +00001297 the string is defined in "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages. For background
1298 information and recommendations see e.g.
1299 (https://wiki.mozilla.org/Security/Server_Side_TLS) and
1300 (https://mozilla.github.io/server-side-tls/ssl-config-generator/).
1301 For TLSv1.3 cipher configuration, please check the
1302 "ssl-default-server-ciphersuites" keyword. Please check the "server" keyword
1303 for more information.
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +02001304
1305ssl-default-server-ciphersuites <ciphersuites>
1306 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in and
1307 OpenSSL 1.1.1 or later was used to build HAProxy. It sets the default
1308 string describing the list of cipher algorithms that are negotiated during
1309 the TLSv1.3 handshake with the server, for all "server" lines which do not
1310 explicitly define theirs. The format of the string is defined in
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +00001311 "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages under the section "ciphersuites". For
1312 cipher configuration for TLSv1.2 and earlier, please check the
1313 "ssl-default-server-ciphers" keyword. Please check the "server" keyword for
1314 more information.
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +01001315
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01001316ssl-default-server-options [<option>]...
1317 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
1318 default ssl-options to force on all "server" lines. Please check the "server"
1319 keyword to see available options.
1320
Remi Gacogne47783ef2015-05-29 15:53:22 +02001321ssl-dh-param-file <file>
1322 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
1323 the default DH parameters that are used during the SSL/TLS handshake when
1324 ephemeral Diffie-Hellman (DHE) key exchange is used, for all "bind" lines
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001325 which do not explicitly define theirs. It will be overridden by custom DH
Remi Gacogne47783ef2015-05-29 15:53:22 +02001326 parameters found in a bind certificate file if any. If custom DH parameters
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +02001327 are not specified either by using ssl-dh-param-file or by setting them
1328 directly in the certificate file, pre-generated DH parameters of the size
1329 specified by tune.ssl.default-dh-param will be used. Custom parameters are
1330 known to be more secure and therefore their use is recommended.
Remi Gacogne47783ef2015-05-29 15:53:22 +02001331 Custom DH parameters may be generated by using the OpenSSL command
1332 "openssl dhparam <size>", where size should be at least 2048, as 1024-bit DH
1333 parameters should not be considered secure anymore.
1334
William Lallemand4c5adbf2020-02-24 14:23:22 +01001335ssl-load-extra-files <none|all|bundle|sctl|ocsp|issuer|key>*
William Lallemand3af48e72020-02-03 17:15:52 +01001336 This setting alters the way HAProxy will look for unspecified files during
1337 the loading of the SSL certificates.
1338
1339 By default, HAProxy discovers automatically a lot of files not specified in
1340 the configuration, and you may want to disable this behavior if you want to
1341 optimize the startup time.
1342
1343 "none": Only load the files specified in the configuration. Don't try to load
1344 a certificate bundle if the file does not exist. In the case of a directory,
1345 it won't try to bundle the certificates if they have the same basename.
1346
1347 "all": This is the default behavior, it will try to load everything,
William Lallemand4c5adbf2020-02-24 14:23:22 +01001348 bundles, sctl, ocsp, issuer, key.
William Lallemand3af48e72020-02-03 17:15:52 +01001349
1350 "bundle": When a file specified in the configuration does not exist, HAProxy
1351 will try to load a certificate bundle. This is done by looking for
1352 <basename>.rsa, .ecdsa and .dsa. In the case of directories, HAProxy will
1353 try to gather the files with the same basename in a multi-certificate bundle.
1354 The bundles were introduced with OpenSSL 1.0.2 and were the only way back
1355 then to load an ECDSA certificate and a RSA one, with the same SNI. Since
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +05001356 OpenSSL 1.1.1 it is not recommended anymore, you can specify both the ECDSA
William Lallemand3af48e72020-02-03 17:15:52 +01001357 and the RSA file on the bind line.
1358
1359 "sctl": Try to load "<basename>.sctl" for each crt keyword.
1360
1361 "ocsp": Try to load "<basename>.ocsp" for each crt keyword.
1362
1363 "issuer": Try to load "<basename>.issuer" if the issuer of the OCSP file is
1364 not provided in the PEM file.
1365
William Lallemand4c5adbf2020-02-24 14:23:22 +01001366 "key": If the private key was not provided by the PEM file, try to load a
1367 file "<basename>.key" containing a private key.
1368
William Lallemand3af48e72020-02-03 17:15:52 +01001369 The default behavior is "all".
1370
1371 Example:
1372 ssl-load-extra-files bundle sctl
1373 ssl-load-extra-files sctl ocsp issuer
1374 ssl-load-extra-files none
1375
1376 See also: "crt", section 5.1 about bind options.
1377
Emeric Brun850efd52014-01-29 12:24:34 +01001378ssl-server-verify [none|required]
1379 The default behavior for SSL verify on servers side. If specified to 'none',
1380 servers certificates are not verified. The default is 'required' except if
1381 forced using cmdline option '-dV'.
1382
Emmanuel Hocdetc3b7e742020-04-22 11:06:19 +02001383ssl-skip-self-issued-ca
1384 Self issued CA, aka x509 root CA, is the enchor for chain validation: as a
1385 server is useless to send it, client must have it. Standard configuration
1386 need to not include such CA in PEM file. This option allows you to keep such
1387 CA in PEM file without sending it to the client. Use case is to provide
1388 issuer for ocsp without the need for '.issuer' file and be able to share it
1389 with 'issuers-chain-path'. This concerns all certificates without intermediate
1390 certificates. It's useless for BoringSSL, .issuer is ignored because ocsp
1391 bits does not need it.
1392
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +02001393stats socket [<address:port>|<path>] [param*]
1394 Binds a UNIX socket to <path> or a TCPv4/v6 address to <address:port>.
1395 Connections to this socket will return various statistics outputs and even
1396 allow some commands to be issued to change some runtime settings. Please
Willy Tarreau1af20c72017-06-23 16:01:14 +02001397 consult section 9.3 "Unix Socket commands" of Management Guide for more
Kevin Decherf949c7202015-10-13 23:26:44 +02001398 details.
Willy Tarreau6162db22009-10-10 17:13:00 +02001399
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +02001400 All parameters supported by "bind" lines are supported, for instance to
1401 restrict access to some users or their access rights. Please consult
1402 section 5.1 for more information.
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +02001403
1404stats timeout <timeout, in milliseconds>
1405 The default timeout on the stats socket is set to 10 seconds. It is possible
1406 to change this value with "stats timeout". The value must be passed in
Willy Tarreaubefdff12007-12-02 22:27:38 +01001407 milliseconds, or be suffixed by a time unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }.
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +02001408
1409stats maxconn <connections>
1410 By default, the stats socket is limited to 10 concurrent connections. It is
1411 possible to change this value with "stats maxconn".
1412
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001413uid <number>
1414 Changes the process' user ID to <number>. It is recommended that the user ID
1415 is dedicated to HAProxy or to a small set of similar daemons. HAProxy must
1416 be started with superuser privileges in order to be able to switch to another
1417 one. See also "gid" and "user".
1418
1419ulimit-n <number>
1420 Sets the maximum number of per-process file-descriptors to <number>. By
1421 default, it is automatically computed, so it is recommended not to use this
1422 option.
1423
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01001424unix-bind [ prefix <prefix> ] [ mode <mode> ] [ user <user> ] [ uid <uid> ]
1425 [ group <group> ] [ gid <gid> ]
1426
1427 Fixes common settings to UNIX listening sockets declared in "bind" statements.
1428 This is mainly used to simplify declaration of those UNIX sockets and reduce
1429 the risk of errors, since those settings are most commonly required but are
1430 also process-specific. The <prefix> setting can be used to force all socket
1431 path to be relative to that directory. This might be needed to access another
1432 component's chroot. Note that those paths are resolved before haproxy chroots
1433 itself, so they are absolute. The <mode>, <user>, <uid>, <group> and <gid>
1434 all have the same meaning as their homonyms used by the "bind" statement. If
1435 both are specified, the "bind" statement has priority, meaning that the
1436 "unix-bind" settings may be seen as process-wide default settings.
1437
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +01001438unsetenv [<name> ...]
1439 Removes environment variables specified in arguments. This can be useful to
1440 hide some sensitive information that are occasionally inherited from the
1441 user's environment during some operations. Variables which did not exist are
1442 silently ignored so that after the operation, it is certain that none of
1443 these variables remain. The changes immediately take effect so that the next
1444 line in the configuration file will not see these variables. See also
1445 "setenv", "presetenv", and "resetenv".
1446
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001447user <user name>
1448 Similar to "uid" but uses the UID of user name <user name> from /etc/passwd.
1449 See also "uid" and "group".
1450
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +02001451node <name>
1452 Only letters, digits, hyphen and underscore are allowed, like in DNS names.
1453
1454 This statement is useful in HA configurations where two or more processes or
1455 servers share the same IP address. By setting a different node-name on all
1456 nodes, it becomes easy to immediately spot what server is handling the
1457 traffic.
1458
1459description <text>
1460 Add a text that describes the instance.
1461
1462 Please note that it is required to escape certain characters (# for example)
1463 and this text is inserted into a html page so you should avoid using
1464 "<" and ">" characters.
1465
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +0100146651degrees-data-file <file path>
1467 The path of the 51Degrees data file to provide device detection services. The
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001468 file should be unzipped and accessible by HAProxy with relevant permissions.
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01001469
Dragan Dosenae6d39a2015-06-29 16:43:27 +02001470 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01001471 compiled with USE_51DEGREES.
1472
Ben Shillitof25e8e52016-12-02 14:25:37 +0000147351degrees-property-name-list [<string> ...]
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01001474 A list of 51Degrees property names to be load from the dataset. A full list
1475 of names is available on the 51Degrees website:
1476 https://51degrees.com/resources/property-dictionary
1477
Dragan Dosenae6d39a2015-06-29 16:43:27 +02001478 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01001479 compiled with USE_51DEGREES.
1480
Dragan Dosen93b38d92015-06-29 16:43:25 +0200148151degrees-property-separator <char>
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01001482 A char that will be appended to every property value in a response header
1483 containing 51Degrees results. If not set that will be set as ','.
1484
Dragan Dosenae6d39a2015-06-29 16:43:27 +02001485 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been
1486 compiled with USE_51DEGREES.
1487
148851degrees-cache-size <number>
1489 Sets the size of the 51Degrees converter cache to <number> entries. This
1490 is an LRU cache which reminds previous device detections and their results.
1491 By default, this cache is disabled.
1492
1493 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01001494 compiled with USE_51DEGREES.
1495
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02001496wurfl-data-file <file path>
1497 The path of the WURFL data file to provide device detection services. The
1498 file should be accessible by HAProxy with relevant permissions.
1499
1500 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been compiled
1501 with USE_WURFL=1.
1502
1503wurfl-information-list [<capability>]*
1504 A space-delimited list of WURFL capabilities, virtual capabilities, property
1505 names we plan to use in injected headers. A full list of capability and
1506 virtual capability names is available on the Scientiamobile website :
1507
1508 https://www.scientiamobile.com/wurflCapability
1509
1510 Valid WURFL properties are:
1511 - wurfl_id Contains the device ID of the matched device.
1512
1513 - wurfl_root_id Contains the device root ID of the matched
1514 device.
1515
1516 - wurfl_isdevroot Tells if the matched device is a root device.
1517 Possible values are "TRUE" or "FALSE".
1518
1519 - wurfl_useragent The original useragent coming with this
1520 particular web request.
1521
1522 - wurfl_api_version Contains a string representing the currently
1523 used Libwurfl API version.
1524
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02001525 - wurfl_info A string containing information on the parsed
1526 wurfl.xml and its full path.
1527
1528 - wurfl_last_load_time Contains the UNIX timestamp of the last time
1529 WURFL has been loaded successfully.
1530
1531 - wurfl_normalized_useragent The normalized useragent.
1532
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02001533 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been compiled
1534 with USE_WURFL=1.
1535
1536wurfl-information-list-separator <char>
1537 A char that will be used to separate values in a response header containing
1538 WURFL results. If not set that a comma (',') will be used by default.
1539
1540 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been compiled
1541 with USE_WURFL=1.
1542
1543wurfl-patch-file [<file path>]
1544 A list of WURFL patch file paths. Note that patches are loaded during startup
1545 thus before the chroot.
1546
1547 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been compiled
1548 with USE_WURFL=1.
1549
paulborilebad132c2019-04-18 11:57:04 +02001550wurfl-cache-size <size>
1551 Sets the WURFL Useragent cache size. For faster lookups, already processed user
1552 agents are kept in a LRU cache :
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02001553 - "0" : no cache is used.
paulborilebad132c2019-04-18 11:57:04 +02001554 - <size> : size of lru cache in elements.
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02001555
1556 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been compiled
1557 with USE_WURFL=1.
1558
William Dauchy0fec3ab2019-10-27 20:08:11 +01001559strict-limits
1560 Makes process fail at startup when a setrlimit fails. Haproxy is tries to set
1561 the best setrlimit according to what has been calculated. If it fails, it
1562 will emit a warning. Use this option if you want an explicit failure of
1563 haproxy when those limits fail. This option is disabled by default. If it has
1564 been enabled, it may still be forcibly disabled by prefixing it with the "no"
1565 keyword.
1566
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015673.2. Performance tuning
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001568-----------------------
1569
Willy Tarreaubeb859a2018-11-22 18:07:59 +01001570busy-polling
1571 In some situations, especially when dealing with low latency on processors
1572 supporting a variable frequency or when running inside virtual machines, each
1573 time the process waits for an I/O using the poller, the processor goes back
1574 to sleep or is offered to another VM for a long time, and it causes
1575 excessively high latencies. This option provides a solution preventing the
1576 processor from sleeping by always using a null timeout on the pollers. This
1577 results in a significant latency reduction (30 to 100 microseconds observed)
1578 at the expense of a risk to overheat the processor. It may even be used with
1579 threads, in which case improperly bound threads may heavily conflict,
1580 resulting in a worse performance and high values for the CPU stolen fields
1581 in "show info" output, indicating which threads are misconfigured. It is
1582 important not to let the process run on the same processor as the network
1583 interrupts when this option is used. It is also better to avoid using it on
1584 multiple CPU threads sharing the same core. This option is disabled by
1585 default. If it has been enabled, it may still be forcibly disabled by
1586 prefixing it with the "no" keyword. It is ignored by the "select" and
1587 "poll" pollers.
1588
William Dauchy3894d972019-12-28 15:36:02 +01001589 This option is automatically disabled on old processes in the context of
1590 seamless reload; it avoids too much cpu conflicts when multiple processes
1591 stay around for some time waiting for the end of their current connections.
1592
Willy Tarreau1746eec2014-04-25 10:46:47 +02001593max-spread-checks <delay in milliseconds>
1594 By default, haproxy tries to spread the start of health checks across the
1595 smallest health check interval of all the servers in a farm. The principle is
1596 to avoid hammering services running on the same server. But when using large
1597 check intervals (10 seconds or more), the last servers in the farm take some
1598 time before starting to be tested, which can be a problem. This parameter is
1599 used to enforce an upper bound on delay between the first and the last check,
1600 even if the servers' check intervals are larger. When servers run with
1601 shorter intervals, their intervals will be respected though.
1602
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001603maxconn <number>
1604 Sets the maximum per-process number of concurrent connections to <number>. It
1605 is equivalent to the command-line argument "-n". Proxies will stop accepting
1606 connections when this limit is reached. The "ulimit-n" parameter is
Willy Tarreau8274e102014-06-19 15:31:25 +02001607 automatically adjusted according to this value. See also "ulimit-n". Note:
1608 the "select" poller cannot reliably use more than 1024 file descriptors on
1609 some platforms. If your platform only supports select and reports "select
1610 FAILED" on startup, you need to reduce maxconn until it works (slightly
Willy Tarreaub28f3442019-03-04 08:13:43 +01001611 below 500 in general). If this value is not set, it will automatically be
1612 calculated based on the current file descriptors limit reported by the
1613 "ulimit -n" command, possibly reduced to a lower value if a memory limit
1614 is enforced, based on the buffer size, memory allocated to compression, SSL
1615 cache size, and use or not of SSL and the associated maxsslconn (which can
1616 also be automatic).
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001617
Willy Tarreau81c25d02011-09-07 15:17:21 +02001618maxconnrate <number>
1619 Sets the maximum per-process number of connections per second to <number>.
1620 Proxies will stop accepting connections when this limit is reached. It can be
1621 used to limit the global capacity regardless of each frontend capacity. It is
1622 important to note that this can only be used as a service protection measure,
1623 as there will not necessarily be a fair share between frontends when the
1624 limit is reached, so it's a good idea to also limit each frontend to some
1625 value close to its expected share. Also, lowering tune.maxaccept can improve
1626 fairness.
1627
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +01001628maxcomprate <number>
1629 Sets the maximum per-process input compression rate to <number> kilobytes
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001630 per second. For each session, if the maximum is reached, the compression
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +01001631 level will be decreased during the session. If the maximum is reached at the
1632 beginning of a session, the session will not compress at all. If the maximum
1633 is not reached, the compression level will be increased up to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001634 tune.comp.maxlevel. A value of zero means there is no limit, this is the
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +01001635 default value.
1636
William Lallemand072a2bf2012-11-20 17:01:01 +01001637maxcompcpuusage <number>
1638 Sets the maximum CPU usage HAProxy can reach before stopping the compression
1639 for new requests or decreasing the compression level of current requests.
1640 It works like 'maxcomprate' but measures CPU usage instead of incoming data
1641 bandwidth. The value is expressed in percent of the CPU used by haproxy. In
1642 case of multiple processes (nbproc > 1), each process manages its individual
1643 usage. A value of 100 disable the limit. The default value is 100. Setting
1644 a lower value will prevent the compression work from slowing the whole
1645 process down and from introducing high latencies.
1646
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01001647maxpipes <number>
1648 Sets the maximum per-process number of pipes to <number>. Currently, pipes
1649 are only used by kernel-based tcp splicing. Since a pipe contains two file
1650 descriptors, the "ulimit-n" value will be increased accordingly. The default
1651 value is maxconn/4, which seems to be more than enough for most heavy usages.
1652 The splice code dynamically allocates and releases pipes, and can fall back
1653 to standard copy, so setting this value too low may only impact performance.
1654
Willy Tarreau93e7c002013-10-07 18:51:07 +02001655maxsessrate <number>
1656 Sets the maximum per-process number of sessions per second to <number>.
1657 Proxies will stop accepting connections when this limit is reached. It can be
1658 used to limit the global capacity regardless of each frontend capacity. It is
1659 important to note that this can only be used as a service protection measure,
1660 as there will not necessarily be a fair share between frontends when the
1661 limit is reached, so it's a good idea to also limit each frontend to some
1662 value close to its expected share. Also, lowering tune.maxaccept can improve
1663 fairness.
1664
Willy Tarreau403edff2012-09-06 11:58:37 +02001665maxsslconn <number>
1666 Sets the maximum per-process number of concurrent SSL connections to
1667 <number>. By default there is no SSL-specific limit, which means that the
1668 global maxconn setting will apply to all connections. Setting this limit
1669 avoids having openssl use too much memory and crash when malloc returns NULL
1670 (since it unfortunately does not reliably check for such conditions). Note
1671 that the limit applies both to incoming and outgoing connections, so one
1672 connection which is deciphered then ciphered accounts for 2 SSL connections.
Willy Tarreaud0256482015-01-15 21:45:22 +01001673 If this value is not set, but a memory limit is enforced, this value will be
1674 automatically computed based on the memory limit, maxconn, the buffer size,
1675 memory allocated to compression, SSL cache size, and use of SSL in either
1676 frontends, backends or both. If neither maxconn nor maxsslconn are specified
1677 when there is a memory limit, haproxy will automatically adjust these values
1678 so that 100% of the connections can be made over SSL with no risk, and will
1679 consider the sides where it is enabled (frontend, backend, both).
Willy Tarreau403edff2012-09-06 11:58:37 +02001680
Willy Tarreaue43d5322013-10-07 20:01:52 +02001681maxsslrate <number>
1682 Sets the maximum per-process number of SSL sessions per second to <number>.
1683 SSL listeners will stop accepting connections when this limit is reached. It
1684 can be used to limit the global SSL CPU usage regardless of each frontend
1685 capacity. It is important to note that this can only be used as a service
1686 protection measure, as there will not necessarily be a fair share between
1687 frontends when the limit is reached, so it's a good idea to also limit each
1688 frontend to some value close to its expected share. It is also important to
1689 note that the sessions are accounted before they enter the SSL stack and not
1690 after, which also protects the stack against bad handshakes. Also, lowering
1691 tune.maxaccept can improve fairness.
1692
William Lallemand9d5f5482012-11-07 16:12:57 +01001693maxzlibmem <number>
1694 Sets the maximum amount of RAM in megabytes per process usable by the zlib.
1695 When the maximum amount is reached, future sessions will not compress as long
1696 as RAM is unavailable. When sets to 0, there is no limit.
William Lallemande3a7d992012-11-20 11:25:20 +01001697 The default value is 0. The value is available in bytes on the UNIX socket
1698 with "show info" on the line "MaxZlibMemUsage", the memory used by zlib is
1699 "ZlibMemUsage" in bytes.
1700
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001701noepoll
1702 Disables the use of the "epoll" event polling system on Linux. It is
1703 equivalent to the command-line argument "-de". The next polling system
Willy Tarreaue9f49e72012-11-11 17:42:00 +01001704 used will generally be "poll". See also "nopoll".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001705
1706nokqueue
1707 Disables the use of the "kqueue" event polling system on BSD. It is
1708 equivalent to the command-line argument "-dk". The next polling system
1709 used will generally be "poll". See also "nopoll".
1710
Emmanuel Hocdet0ba4f482019-04-08 16:53:32 +00001711noevports
1712 Disables the use of the event ports event polling system on SunOS systems
1713 derived from Solaris 10 and later. It is equivalent to the command-line
1714 argument "-dv". The next polling system used will generally be "poll". See
1715 also "nopoll".
1716
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001717nopoll
1718 Disables the use of the "poll" event polling system. It is equivalent to the
1719 command-line argument "-dp". The next polling system used will be "select".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001720 It should never be needed to disable "poll" since it's available on all
Emmanuel Hocdet0ba4f482019-04-08 16:53:32 +00001721 platforms supported by HAProxy. See also "nokqueue", "noepoll" and
1722 "noevports".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001723
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01001724nosplice
1725 Disables the use of kernel tcp splicing between sockets on Linux. It is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001726 equivalent to the command line argument "-dS". Data will then be copied
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01001727 using conventional and more portable recv/send calls. Kernel tcp splicing is
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001728 limited to some very recent instances of kernel 2.6. Most versions between
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01001729 2.6.25 and 2.6.28 are buggy and will forward corrupted data, so they must not
1730 be used. This option makes it easier to globally disable kernel splicing in
1731 case of doubt. See also "option splice-auto", "option splice-request" and
1732 "option splice-response".
1733
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03001734nogetaddrinfo
1735 Disables the use of getaddrinfo(3) for name resolving. It is equivalent to
1736 the command line argument "-dG". Deprecated gethostbyname(3) will be used.
1737
Lukas Tribusa0bcbdc2016-09-12 21:42:20 +00001738noreuseport
1739 Disables the use of SO_REUSEPORT - see socket(7). It is equivalent to the
1740 command line argument "-dR".
1741
Willy Tarreaud2d33482019-04-25 17:09:07 +02001742profiling.tasks { auto | on | off }
1743 Enables ('on') or disables ('off') per-task CPU profiling. When set to 'auto'
1744 the profiling automatically turns on a thread when it starts to suffer from
1745 an average latency of 1000 microseconds or higher as reported in the
1746 "avg_loop_us" activity field, and automatically turns off when the latency
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05001747 returns below 990 microseconds (this value is an average over the last 1024
Willy Tarreaud2d33482019-04-25 17:09:07 +02001748 loops so it does not vary quickly and tends to significantly smooth short
1749 spikes). It may also spontaneously trigger from time to time on overloaded
1750 systems, containers, or virtual machines, or when the system swaps (which
1751 must absolutely never happen on a load balancer).
1752
1753 CPU profiling per task can be very convenient to report where the time is
1754 spent and which requests have what effect on which other request. Enabling
1755 it will typically affect the overall's performance by less than 1%, thus it
1756 is recommended to leave it to the default 'auto' value so that it only
1757 operates when a problem is identified. This feature requires a system
Willy Tarreau75c62c22018-11-22 11:02:09 +01001758 supporting the clock_gettime(2) syscall with clock identifiers
1759 CLOCK_MONOTONIC and CLOCK_THREAD_CPUTIME_ID, otherwise the reported time will
1760 be zero. This option may be changed at run time using "set profiling" on the
1761 CLI.
1762
Willy Tarreaufe255b72007-10-14 23:09:26 +02001763spread-checks <0..50, in percent>
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +09001764 Sometimes it is desirable to avoid sending agent and health checks to
1765 servers at exact intervals, for instance when many logical servers are
1766 located on the same physical server. With the help of this parameter, it
1767 becomes possible to add some randomness in the check interval between 0
1768 and +/- 50%. A value between 2 and 5 seems to show good results. The
1769 default value remains at 0.
Willy Tarreaufe255b72007-10-14 23:09:26 +02001770
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001771ssl-engine <name> [algo <comma-separated list of algorithms>]
Grant Zhang872f9c22017-01-21 01:10:18 +00001772 Sets the OpenSSL engine to <name>. List of valid values for <name> may be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001773 obtained using the command "openssl engine". This statement may be used
Grant Zhang872f9c22017-01-21 01:10:18 +00001774 multiple times, it will simply enable multiple crypto engines. Referencing an
1775 unsupported engine will prevent haproxy from starting. Note that many engines
1776 will lead to lower HTTPS performance than pure software with recent
1777 processors. The optional command "algo" sets the default algorithms an ENGINE
1778 will supply using the OPENSSL function ENGINE_set_default_string(). A value
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001779 of "ALL" uses the engine for all cryptographic operations. If no list of
1780 algo is specified then the value of "ALL" is used. A comma-separated list
Grant Zhang872f9c22017-01-21 01:10:18 +00001781 of different algorithms may be specified, including: RSA, DSA, DH, EC, RAND,
1782 CIPHERS, DIGESTS, PKEY, PKEY_CRYPTO, PKEY_ASN1. This is the same format that
1783 openssl configuration file uses:
1784 https://www.openssl.org/docs/man1.0.2/apps/config.html
1785
Grant Zhangfa6c7ee2017-01-14 01:42:15 +00001786ssl-mode-async
1787 Adds SSL_MODE_ASYNC mode to the SSL context. This enables asynchronous TLS
Emeric Brun3854e012017-05-17 20:42:48 +02001788 I/O operations if asynchronous capable SSL engines are used. The current
Emeric Brunb5e42a82017-06-06 12:35:14 +00001789 implementation supports a maximum of 32 engines. The Openssl ASYNC API
1790 doesn't support moving read/write buffers and is not compliant with
1791 haproxy's buffer management. So the asynchronous mode is disabled on
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05001792 read/write operations (it is only enabled during initial and renegotiation
Emeric Brunb5e42a82017-06-06 12:35:14 +00001793 handshakes).
Grant Zhangfa6c7ee2017-01-14 01:42:15 +00001794
Willy Tarreau33cb0652014-12-23 22:52:37 +01001795tune.buffers.limit <number>
1796 Sets a hard limit on the number of buffers which may be allocated per process.
1797 The default value is zero which means unlimited. The minimum non-zero value
1798 will always be greater than "tune.buffers.reserve" and should ideally always
1799 be about twice as large. Forcing this value can be particularly useful to
1800 limit the amount of memory a process may take, while retaining a sane
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001801 behavior. When this limit is reached, sessions which need a buffer wait for
Willy Tarreau33cb0652014-12-23 22:52:37 +01001802 another one to be released by another session. Since buffers are dynamically
1803 allocated and released, the waiting time is very short and not perceptible
1804 provided that limits remain reasonable. In fact sometimes reducing the limit
1805 may even increase performance by increasing the CPU cache's efficiency. Tests
1806 have shown good results on average HTTP traffic with a limit to 1/10 of the
1807 expected global maxconn setting, which also significantly reduces memory
1808 usage. The memory savings come from the fact that a number of connections
1809 will not allocate 2*tune.bufsize. It is best not to touch this value unless
1810 advised to do so by an haproxy core developer.
1811
Willy Tarreau1058ae72014-12-23 22:40:40 +01001812tune.buffers.reserve <number>
1813 Sets the number of buffers which are pre-allocated and reserved for use only
1814 during memory shortage conditions resulting in failed memory allocations. The
1815 minimum value is 2 and is also the default. There is no reason a user would
1816 want to change this value, it's mostly aimed at haproxy core developers.
1817
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +02001818tune.bufsize <number>
1819 Sets the buffer size to this size (in bytes). Lower values allow more
1820 sessions to coexist in the same amount of RAM, and higher values allow some
1821 applications with very large cookies to work. The default value is 16384 and
1822 can be changed at build time. It is strongly recommended not to change this
1823 from the default value, as very low values will break some services such as
1824 statistics, and values larger than default size will increase memory usage,
1825 possibly causing the system to run out of memory. At least the global maxconn
Willy Tarreau45a66cc2017-11-24 11:28:00 +01001826 parameter should be decreased by the same factor as this one is increased. In
1827 addition, use of HTTP/2 mandates that this value must be 16384 or more. If an
1828 HTTP request is larger than (tune.bufsize - tune.maxrewrite), haproxy will
Dmitry Sivachenkof6f4f7b2012-10-21 18:10:25 +04001829 return HTTP 400 (Bad Request) error. Similarly if an HTTP response is larger
Willy Tarreauc77d3642018-12-12 06:19:42 +01001830 than this size, haproxy will return HTTP 502 (Bad Gateway). Note that the
1831 value set using this parameter will automatically be rounded up to the next
1832 multiple of 8 on 32-bit machines and 16 on 64-bit machines.
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +02001833
Willy Tarreau43961d52010-10-04 20:39:20 +02001834tune.chksize <number>
1835 Sets the check buffer size to this size (in bytes). Higher values may help
1836 find string or regex patterns in very large pages, though doing so may imply
1837 more memory and CPU usage. The default value is 16384 and can be changed at
1838 build time. It is not recommended to change this value, but to use better
1839 checks whenever possible.
1840
William Lallemandf3747832012-11-09 12:33:10 +01001841tune.comp.maxlevel <number>
1842 Sets the maximum compression level. The compression level affects CPU
1843 usage during compression. This value affects CPU usage during compression.
1844 Each session using compression initializes the compression algorithm with
1845 this value. The default value is 1.
1846
Willy Tarreauc299e1e2019-02-27 11:35:12 +01001847tune.fail-alloc
1848 If compiled with DEBUG_FAIL_ALLOC, gives the percentage of chances an
1849 allocation attempt fails. Must be between 0 (no failure) and 100 (no
1850 success). This is useful to debug and make sure memory failures are handled
1851 gracefully.
1852
Willy Tarreaufe20e5b2017-07-27 11:42:14 +02001853tune.h2.header-table-size <number>
1854 Sets the HTTP/2 dynamic header table size. It defaults to 4096 bytes and
1855 cannot be larger than 65536 bytes. A larger value may help certain clients
1856 send more compact requests, depending on their capabilities. This amount of
1857 memory is consumed for each HTTP/2 connection. It is recommended not to
1858 change it.
1859
Willy Tarreaue6baec02017-07-27 11:45:11 +02001860tune.h2.initial-window-size <number>
1861 Sets the HTTP/2 initial window size, which is the number of bytes the client
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001862 can upload before waiting for an acknowledgment from haproxy. This setting
1863 only affects payload contents (i.e. the body of POST requests), not headers.
Willy Tarreaue6baec02017-07-27 11:45:11 +02001864 The default value is 65535, which roughly allows up to 5 Mbps of upload
1865 bandwidth per client over a network showing a 100 ms ping time, or 500 Mbps
1866 over a 1-ms local network. It can make sense to increase this value to allow
1867 faster uploads, or to reduce it to increase fairness when dealing with many
1868 clients. It doesn't affect resource usage.
1869
Willy Tarreau5242ef82017-07-27 11:47:28 +02001870tune.h2.max-concurrent-streams <number>
1871 Sets the HTTP/2 maximum number of concurrent streams per connection (ie the
1872 number of outstanding requests on a single connection). The default value is
1873 100. A larger one may slightly improve page load time for complex sites when
1874 visited over high latency networks, but increases the amount of resources a
1875 single client may allocate. A value of zero disables the limit so a single
1876 client may create as many streams as allocatable by haproxy. It is highly
1877 recommended not to change this value.
1878
Willy Tarreaua24b35c2019-02-21 13:24:36 +01001879tune.h2.max-frame-size <number>
1880 Sets the HTTP/2 maximum frame size that haproxy announces it is willing to
1881 receive to its peers. The default value is the largest between 16384 and the
1882 buffer size (tune.bufsize). In any case, haproxy will not announce support
1883 for frame sizes larger than buffers. The main purpose of this setting is to
1884 allow to limit the maximum frame size setting when using large buffers. Too
1885 large frame sizes might have performance impact or cause some peers to
1886 misbehave. It is highly recommended not to change this value.
1887
Willy Tarreau193b8c62012-11-22 00:17:38 +01001888tune.http.cookielen <number>
1889 Sets the maximum length of captured cookies. This is the maximum value that
1890 the "capture cookie xxx len yyy" will be allowed to take, and any upper value
1891 will automatically be truncated to this one. It is important not to set too
1892 high a value because all cookie captures still allocate this size whatever
1893 their configured value (they share a same pool). This value is per request
1894 per response, so the memory allocated is twice this value per connection.
1895 When not specified, the limit is set to 63 characters. It is recommended not
1896 to change this value.
1897
Stéphane Cottin23e9e932017-05-18 08:58:41 +02001898tune.http.logurilen <number>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001899 Sets the maximum length of request URI in logs. This prevents truncating long
1900 request URIs with valuable query strings in log lines. This is not related
Stéphane Cottin23e9e932017-05-18 08:58:41 +02001901 to syslog limits. If you increase this limit, you may also increase the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001902 'log ... len yyy' parameter. Your syslog daemon may also need specific
Stéphane Cottin23e9e932017-05-18 08:58:41 +02001903 configuration directives too.
1904 The default value is 1024.
1905
Willy Tarreauac1932d2011-10-24 19:14:41 +02001906tune.http.maxhdr <number>
1907 Sets the maximum number of headers in a request. When a request comes with a
1908 number of headers greater than this value (including the first line), it is
1909 rejected with a "400 Bad Request" status code. Similarly, too large responses
1910 are blocked with "502 Bad Gateway". The default value is 101, which is enough
1911 for all usages, considering that the widely deployed Apache server uses the
1912 same limit. It can be useful to push this limit further to temporarily allow
Christopher Faulet50174f32017-06-21 16:31:35 +02001913 a buggy application to work by the time it gets fixed. The accepted range is
1914 1..32767. Keep in mind that each new header consumes 32bits of memory for
1915 each session, so don't push this limit too high.
Willy Tarreauac1932d2011-10-24 19:14:41 +02001916
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +01001917tune.idletimer <timeout>
1918 Sets the duration after which haproxy will consider that an empty buffer is
1919 probably associated with an idle stream. This is used to optimally adjust
1920 some packet sizes while forwarding large and small data alternatively. The
1921 decision to use splice() or to send large buffers in SSL is modulated by this
1922 parameter. The value is in milliseconds between 0 and 65535. A value of zero
1923 means that haproxy will not try to detect idle streams. The default is 1000,
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001924 which seems to correctly detect end user pauses (e.g. read a page before
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05001925 clicking). There should be no reason for changing this value. Please check
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +01001926 tune.ssl.maxrecord below.
1927
Willy Tarreau7ac908b2019-02-27 12:02:18 +01001928tune.listener.multi-queue { on | off }
1929 Enables ('on') or disables ('off') the listener's multi-queue accept which
1930 spreads the incoming traffic to all threads a "bind" line is allowed to run
1931 on instead of taking them for itself. This provides a smoother traffic
1932 distribution and scales much better, especially in environments where threads
1933 may be unevenly loaded due to external activity (network interrupts colliding
1934 with one thread for example). This option is enabled by default, but it may
1935 be forcefully disabled for troubleshooting or for situations where it is
1936 estimated that the operating system already provides a good enough
1937 distribution and connections are extremely short-lived.
1938
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01001939tune.lua.forced-yield <number>
1940 This directive forces the Lua engine to execute a yield each <number> of
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +01001941 instructions executed. This permits interrupting a long script and allows the
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01001942 HAProxy scheduler to process other tasks like accepting connections or
1943 forwarding traffic. The default value is 10000 instructions. If HAProxy often
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001944 executes some Lua code but more responsiveness is required, this value can be
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01001945 lowered. If the Lua code is quite long and its result is absolutely required
1946 to process the data, the <number> can be increased.
1947
Willy Tarreau32f61e22015-03-18 17:54:59 +01001948tune.lua.maxmem
1949 Sets the maximum amount of RAM in megabytes per process usable by Lua. By
1950 default it is zero which means unlimited. It is important to set a limit to
1951 ensure that a bug in a script will not result in the system running out of
1952 memory.
1953
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01001954tune.lua.session-timeout <timeout>
1955 This is the execution timeout for the Lua sessions. This is useful for
Thierry FOURNIER7dd784b2015-10-01 14:49:33 +02001956 preventing infinite loops or spending too much time in Lua. This timeout
1957 counts only the pure Lua runtime. If the Lua does a sleep, the sleep is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001958 not taken in account. The default timeout is 4s.
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01001959
1960tune.lua.task-timeout <timeout>
1961 Purpose is the same as "tune.lua.session-timeout", but this timeout is
1962 dedicated to the tasks. By default, this timeout isn't set because a task may
1963 remain alive during of the lifetime of HAProxy. For example, a task used to
1964 check servers.
1965
Thierry FOURNIER7dd784b2015-10-01 14:49:33 +02001966tune.lua.service-timeout <timeout>
1967 This is the execution timeout for the Lua services. This is useful for
1968 preventing infinite loops or spending too much time in Lua. This timeout
1969 counts only the pure Lua runtime. If the Lua does a sleep, the sleep is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001970 not taken in account. The default timeout is 4s.
Thierry FOURNIER7dd784b2015-10-01 14:49:33 +02001971
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +01001972tune.maxaccept <number>
Willy Tarreau16a21472012-11-19 12:39:59 +01001973 Sets the maximum number of consecutive connections a process may accept in a
1974 row before switching to other work. In single process mode, higher numbers
1975 give better performance at high connection rates. However in multi-process
1976 modes, keeping a bit of fairness between processes generally is better to
1977 increase performance. This value applies individually to each listener, so
1978 that the number of processes a listener is bound to is taken into account.
1979 This value defaults to 64. In multi-process mode, it is divided by twice
1980 the number of processes the listener is bound to. Setting this value to -1
1981 completely disables the limitation. It should normally not be needed to tweak
1982 this value.
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +01001983
1984tune.maxpollevents <number>
1985 Sets the maximum amount of events that can be processed at once in a call to
1986 the polling system. The default value is adapted to the operating system. It
1987 has been noticed that reducing it below 200 tends to slightly decrease
1988 latency at the expense of network bandwidth, and increasing it above 200
1989 tends to trade latency for slightly increased bandwidth.
1990
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +02001991tune.maxrewrite <number>
1992 Sets the reserved buffer space to this size in bytes. The reserved space is
1993 used for header rewriting or appending. The first reads on sockets will never
1994 fill more than bufsize-maxrewrite. Historically it has defaulted to half of
1995 bufsize, though that does not make much sense since there are rarely large
1996 numbers of headers to add. Setting it too high prevents processing of large
1997 requests or responses. Setting it too low prevents addition of new headers
1998 to already large requests or to POST requests. It is generally wise to set it
1999 to about 1024. It is automatically readjusted to half of bufsize if it is
2000 larger than that. This means you don't have to worry about it when changing
2001 bufsize.
2002
Willy Tarreauf3045d22015-04-29 16:24:50 +02002003tune.pattern.cache-size <number>
2004 Sets the size of the pattern lookup cache to <number> entries. This is an LRU
2005 cache which reminds previous lookups and their results. It is used by ACLs
2006 and maps on slow pattern lookups, namely the ones using the "sub", "reg",
2007 "dir", "dom", "end", "bin" match methods as well as the case-insensitive
2008 strings. It applies to pattern expressions which means that it will be able
2009 to memorize the result of a lookup among all the patterns specified on a
2010 configuration line (including all those loaded from files). It automatically
2011 invalidates entries which are updated using HTTP actions or on the CLI. The
2012 default cache size is set to 10000 entries, which limits its footprint to
Willy Tarreau403bfbb2019-10-23 06:59:31 +02002013 about 5 MB per process/thread on 32-bit systems and 8 MB per process/thread
2014 on 64-bit systems, as caches are thread/process local. There is a very low
Willy Tarreauf3045d22015-04-29 16:24:50 +02002015 risk of collision in this cache, which is in the order of the size of the
2016 cache divided by 2^64. Typically, at 10000 requests per second with the
2017 default cache size of 10000 entries, there's 1% chance that a brute force
2018 attack could cause a single collision after 60 years, or 0.1% after 6 years.
2019 This is considered much lower than the risk of a memory corruption caused by
2020 aging components. If this is not acceptable, the cache can be disabled by
2021 setting this parameter to 0.
2022
Willy Tarreaubd9a0a72011-10-23 21:14:29 +02002023tune.pipesize <number>
2024 Sets the kernel pipe buffer size to this size (in bytes). By default, pipes
2025 are the default size for the system. But sometimes when using TCP splicing,
2026 it can improve performance to increase pipe sizes, especially if it is
2027 suspected that pipes are not filled and that many calls to splice() are
2028 performed. This has an impact on the kernel's memory footprint, so this must
2029 not be changed if impacts are not understood.
2030
Olivier Houchard88698d92019-04-16 19:07:22 +02002031tune.pool-low-fd-ratio <number>
2032 This setting sets the max number of file descriptors (in percentage) used by
2033 haproxy globally against the maximum number of file descriptors haproxy can
2034 use before we stop putting connection into the idle pool for reuse. The
2035 default is 20.
2036
2037tune.pool-high-fd-ratio <number>
2038 This setting sets the max number of file descriptors (in percentage) used by
2039 haproxy globally against the maximum number of file descriptors haproxy can
2040 use before we start killing idle connections when we can't reuse a connection
2041 and we have to create a new one. The default is 25 (one quarter of the file
2042 descriptor will mean that roughly half of the maximum front connections can
2043 keep an idle connection behind, anything beyond this probably doesn't make
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05002044 much sense in the general case when targeting connection reuse).
Olivier Houchard88698d92019-04-16 19:07:22 +02002045
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01002046tune.rcvbuf.client <number>
2047tune.rcvbuf.server <number>
2048 Forces the kernel socket receive buffer size on the client or the server side
2049 to the specified value in bytes. This value applies to all TCP/HTTP frontends
2050 and backends. It should normally never be set, and the default size (0) lets
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05002051 the kernel auto-tune this value depending on the amount of available memory.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002052 However it can sometimes help to set it to very low values (e.g. 4096) in
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01002053 order to save kernel memory by preventing it from buffering too large amounts
2054 of received data. Lower values will significantly increase CPU usage though.
2055
Willy Tarreaub22fc302015-12-14 12:04:35 +01002056tune.recv_enough <number>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002057 HAProxy uses some hints to detect that a short read indicates the end of the
Willy Tarreaub22fc302015-12-14 12:04:35 +01002058 socket buffers. One of them is that a read returns more than <recv_enough>
2059 bytes, which defaults to 10136 (7 segments of 1448 each). This default value
2060 may be changed by this setting to better deal with workloads involving lots
2061 of short messages such as telnet or SSH sessions.
2062
Olivier Houchard1599b802018-05-24 18:59:04 +02002063tune.runqueue-depth <number>
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05002064 Sets the maximum amount of task that can be processed at once when running
Olivier Houchard1599b802018-05-24 18:59:04 +02002065 tasks. The default value is 200. Increasing it may incur latency when
2066 dealing with I/Os, making it too small can incur extra overhead.
2067
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01002068tune.sndbuf.client <number>
2069tune.sndbuf.server <number>
2070 Forces the kernel socket send buffer size on the client or the server side to
2071 the specified value in bytes. This value applies to all TCP/HTTP frontends
2072 and backends. It should normally never be set, and the default size (0) lets
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05002073 the kernel auto-tune this value depending on the amount of available memory.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002074 However it can sometimes help to set it to very low values (e.g. 4096) in
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01002075 order to save kernel memory by preventing it from buffering too large amounts
2076 of received data. Lower values will significantly increase CPU usage though.
2077 Another use case is to prevent write timeouts with extremely slow clients due
2078 to the kernel waiting for a large part of the buffer to be read before
2079 notifying haproxy again.
2080
Willy Tarreau6ec58db2012-11-16 16:32:15 +01002081tune.ssl.cachesize <number>
Emeric Brunaf9619d2012-11-28 18:47:52 +01002082 Sets the size of the global SSL session cache, in a number of blocks. A block
2083 is large enough to contain an encoded session without peer certificate.
2084 An encoded session with peer certificate is stored in multiple blocks
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03002085 depending on the size of the peer certificate. A block uses approximately
Emeric Brunaf9619d2012-11-28 18:47:52 +01002086 200 bytes of memory. The default value may be forced at build time, otherwise
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002087 defaults to 20000. When the cache is full, the most idle entries are purged
Emeric Brunaf9619d2012-11-28 18:47:52 +01002088 and reassigned. Higher values reduce the occurrence of such a purge, hence
2089 the number of CPU-intensive SSL handshakes by ensuring that all users keep
2090 their session as long as possible. All entries are pre-allocated upon startup
Emeric Brun22890a12012-12-28 14:41:32 +01002091 and are shared between all processes if "nbproc" is greater than 1. Setting
2092 this value to 0 disables the SSL session cache.
Willy Tarreau6ec58db2012-11-16 16:32:15 +01002093
Emeric Brun8dc60392014-05-09 13:52:00 +02002094tune.ssl.force-private-cache
Lukas Tribus27935782018-10-01 02:00:16 +02002095 This option disables SSL session cache sharing between all processes. It
Emeric Brun8dc60392014-05-09 13:52:00 +02002096 should normally not be used since it will force many renegotiations due to
2097 clients hitting a random process. But it may be required on some operating
2098 systems where none of the SSL cache synchronization method may be used. In
2099 this case, adding a first layer of hash-based load balancing before the SSL
2100 layer might limit the impact of the lack of session sharing.
2101
Emeric Brun4f65bff2012-11-16 15:11:00 +01002102tune.ssl.lifetime <timeout>
2103 Sets how long a cached SSL session may remain valid. This time is expressed
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03002104 in seconds and defaults to 300 (5 min). It is important to understand that it
Emeric Brun4f65bff2012-11-16 15:11:00 +01002105 does not guarantee that sessions will last that long, because if the cache is
2106 full, the longest idle sessions will be purged despite their configured
2107 lifetime. The real usefulness of this setting is to prevent sessions from
2108 being used for too long.
2109
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +01002110tune.ssl.maxrecord <number>
2111 Sets the maximum amount of bytes passed to SSL_write() at a time. Default
2112 value 0 means there is no limit. Over SSL/TLS, the client can decipher the
2113 data only once it has received a full record. With large records, it means
2114 that clients might have to download up to 16kB of data before starting to
2115 process them. Limiting the value can improve page load times on browsers
2116 located over high latency or low bandwidth networks. It is suggested to find
2117 optimal values which fit into 1 or 2 TCP segments (generally 1448 bytes over
2118 Ethernet with TCP timestamps enabled, or 1460 when timestamps are disabled),
2119 keeping in mind that SSL/TLS add some overhead. Typical values of 1419 and
2120 2859 gave good results during tests. Use "strace -e trace=write" to find the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002121 best value. HAProxy will automatically switch to this setting after an idle
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +01002122 stream has been detected (see tune.idletimer above).
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +01002123
Remi Gacognef46cd6e2014-06-12 14:58:40 +02002124tune.ssl.default-dh-param <number>
2125 Sets the maximum size of the Diffie-Hellman parameters used for generating
2126 the ephemeral/temporary Diffie-Hellman key in case of DHE key exchange. The
2127 final size will try to match the size of the server's RSA (or DSA) key (e.g,
2128 a 2048 bits temporary DH key for a 2048 bits RSA key), but will not exceed
2129 this maximum value. Default value if 1024. Only 1024 or higher values are
2130 allowed. Higher values will increase the CPU load, and values greater than
2131 1024 bits are not supported by Java 7 and earlier clients. This value is not
Remi Gacogne47783ef2015-05-29 15:53:22 +02002132 used if static Diffie-Hellman parameters are supplied either directly
2133 in the certificate file or by using the ssl-dh-param-file parameter.
Remi Gacognef46cd6e2014-06-12 14:58:40 +02002134
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +02002135tune.ssl.ssl-ctx-cache-size <number>
2136 Sets the size of the cache used to store generated certificates to <number>
2137 entries. This is a LRU cache. Because generating a SSL certificate
2138 dynamically is expensive, they are cached. The default cache size is set to
2139 1000 entries.
2140
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +01002141tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size <number>
2142 Sets the maximum size of the buffer used for capturing client-hello cipher
2143 list. If the value is 0 (default value) the capture is disabled, otherwise
2144 a buffer is allocated for each SSL/TLS connection.
2145
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02002146tune.vars.global-max-size <size>
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +01002147tune.vars.proc-max-size <size>
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02002148tune.vars.reqres-max-size <size>
2149tune.vars.sess-max-size <size>
2150tune.vars.txn-max-size <size>
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +01002151 These five tunes help to manage the maximum amount of memory used by the
2152 variables system. "global" limits the overall amount of memory available for
2153 all scopes. "proc" limits the memory for the process scope, "sess" limits the
2154 memory for the session scope, "txn" for the transaction scope, and "reqres"
2155 limits the memory for each request or response processing.
2156 Memory accounting is hierarchical, meaning more coarse grained limits include
2157 the finer grained ones: "proc" includes "sess", "sess" includes "txn", and
2158 "txn" includes "reqres".
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02002159
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01002160 For example, when "tune.vars.sess-max-size" is limited to 100,
2161 "tune.vars.txn-max-size" and "tune.vars.reqres-max-size" cannot exceed
2162 100 either. If we create a variable "txn.var" that contains 100 bytes,
2163 all available space is consumed.
2164 Notice that exceeding the limits at runtime will not result in an error
2165 message, but values might be cut off or corrupted. So make sure to accurately
2166 plan for the amount of space needed to store all your variables.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02002167
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +01002168tune.zlib.memlevel <number>
2169 Sets the memLevel parameter in zlib initialization for each session. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03002170 defines how much memory should be allocated for the internal compression
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +01002171 state. A value of 1 uses minimum memory but is slow and reduces compression
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002172 ratio, a value of 9 uses maximum memory for optimal speed. Can be a value
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +01002173 between 1 and 9. The default value is 8.
2174
2175tune.zlib.windowsize <number>
2176 Sets the window size (the size of the history buffer) as a parameter of the
2177 zlib initialization for each session. Larger values of this parameter result
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002178 in better compression at the expense of memory usage. Can be a value between
2179 8 and 15. The default value is 15.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002180
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020021813.3. Debugging
2182--------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002183
Willy Tarreau1b857852020-02-25 11:27:22 +01002184debug (deprecated)
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002185 Enables debug mode which dumps to stdout all exchanges, and disables forking
2186 into background. It is the equivalent of the command-line argument "-d". It
2187 should never be used in a production configuration since it may prevent full
2188 system startup.
2189
2190quiet
2191 Do not display any message during startup. It is equivalent to the command-
2192 line argument "-q".
2193
Willy Tarreau3eb10b82020-04-15 16:42:39 +02002194zero-warning
2195 When this option is set, haproxy will refuse to start if any warning was
2196 emitted while processing the configuration. It is highly recommended to set
2197 this option on configurations that are not changed often, as it helps detect
2198 subtle mistakes and keep the configuration clean and forward-compatible. Note
2199 that "haproxy -c" will also report errors in such a case. This option is
2200 equivalent to command line argument "-dW".
2201
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002202
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +010022033.4. Userlists
2204--------------
2205It is possible to control access to frontend/backend/listen sections or to
2206http stats by allowing only authenticated and authorized users. To do this,
2207it is required to create at least one userlist and to define users.
2208
2209userlist <listname>
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01002210 Creates new userlist with name <listname>. Many independent userlists can be
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002211 used to store authentication & authorization data for independent customers.
2212
2213group <groupname> [users <user>,<user>,(...)]
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01002214 Adds group <groupname> to the current userlist. It is also possible to
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002215 attach users to this group by using a comma separated list of names
2216 proceeded by "users" keyword.
2217
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002218user <username> [password|insecure-password <password>]
2219 [groups <group>,<group>,(...)]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002220 Adds user <username> to the current userlist. Both secure (encrypted) and
2221 insecure (unencrypted) passwords can be used. Encrypted passwords are
Daniel Schnellerd06f31c2017-11-06 16:51:04 +01002222 evaluated using the crypt(3) function, so depending on the system's
2223 capabilities, different algorithms are supported. For example, modern Glibc
2224 based Linux systems support MD5, SHA-256, SHA-512, and, of course, the
2225 classic DES-based method of encrypting passwords.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002226
Daniel Schnellerd06f31c2017-11-06 16:51:04 +01002227 Attention: Be aware that using encrypted passwords might cause significantly
2228 increased CPU usage, depending on the number of requests, and the algorithm
2229 used. For any of the hashed variants, the password for each request must
2230 be processed through the chosen algorithm, before it can be compared to the
2231 value specified in the config file. Most current algorithms are deliberately
2232 designed to be expensive to compute to achieve resistance against brute
2233 force attacks. They do not simply salt/hash the clear text password once,
2234 but thousands of times. This can quickly become a major factor in haproxy's
2235 overall CPU consumption!
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002236
2237 Example:
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002238 userlist L1
2239 group G1 users tiger,scott
2240 group G2 users xdb,scott
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002241
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002242 user tiger password $6$k6y3o.eP$JlKBx9za9667qe4(...)xHSwRv6J.C0/D7cV91
2243 user scott insecure-password elgato
2244 user xdb insecure-password hello
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002245
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002246 userlist L2
2247 group G1
2248 group G2
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002249
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002250 user tiger password $6$k6y3o.eP$JlKBx(...)xHSwRv6J.C0/D7cV91 groups G1
2251 user scott insecure-password elgato groups G1,G2
2252 user xdb insecure-password hello groups G2
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002253
2254 Please note that both lists are functionally identical.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002255
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002256
22573.5. Peers
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02002258----------
Emeric Brun94900952015-06-11 18:25:54 +02002259It is possible to propagate entries of any data-types in stick-tables between
2260several haproxy instances over TCP connections in a multi-master fashion. Each
2261instance pushes its local updates and insertions to remote peers. The pushed
2262values overwrite remote ones without aggregation. Interrupted exchanges are
2263automatically detected and recovered from the last known point.
2264In addition, during a soft restart, the old process connects to the new one
2265using such a TCP connection to push all its entries before the new process
2266tries to connect to other peers. That ensures very fast replication during a
2267reload, it typically takes a fraction of a second even for large tables.
2268Note that Server IDs are used to identify servers remotely, so it is important
2269that configurations look similar or at least that the same IDs are forced on
2270each server on all participants.
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002271
2272peers <peersect>
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04002273 Creates a new peer list with name <peersect>. It is an independent section,
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002274 which is referenced by one or more stick-tables.
2275
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01002276bind [<address>]:<port_range> [, ...] [param*]
2277 Defines the binding parameters of the local peer of this "peers" section.
2278 Such lines are not supported with "peer" line in the same "peers" section.
2279
Willy Tarreau77e4bd12015-05-01 20:02:17 +02002280disabled
2281 Disables a peers section. It disables both listening and any synchronization
2282 related to this section. This is provided to disable synchronization of stick
2283 tables without having to comment out all "peers" references.
2284
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01002285default-bind [param*]
2286 Defines the binding parameters for the local peer, excepted its address.
2287
2288default-server [param*]
2289 Change default options for a server in a "peers" section.
2290
2291 Arguments:
2292 <param*> is a list of parameters for this server. The "default-server"
2293 keyword accepts an important number of options and has a complete
2294 section dedicated to it. Please refer to section 5 for more
2295 details.
2296
2297
2298 See also: "server" and section 5 about server options
2299
Willy Tarreau77e4bd12015-05-01 20:02:17 +02002300enable
2301 This re-enables a disabled peers section which was previously disabled.
2302
Frédéric Lécailleb6f759b2019-11-05 09:57:45 +01002303log <address> [len <length>] [format <format>] [sample <ranges>:<smp_size>]
2304 <facility> [<level> [<minlevel>]]
2305 "peers" sections support the same "log" keyword as for the proxies to
2306 log information about the "peers" listener. See "log" option for proxies for
2307 more details.
2308
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01002309peer <peername> <ip>:<port> [param*]
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002310 Defines a peer inside a peers section.
2311 If <peername> is set to the local peer name (by default hostname, or forced
2312 using "-L" command line option), haproxy will listen for incoming remote peer
2313 connection on <ip>:<port>. Otherwise, <ip>:<port> defines where to connect to
2314 to join the remote peer, and <peername> is used at the protocol level to
2315 identify and validate the remote peer on the server side.
2316
2317 During a soft restart, local peer <ip>:<port> is used by the old instance to
2318 connect the new one and initiate a complete replication (teaching process).
2319
2320 It is strongly recommended to have the exact same peers declaration on all
2321 peers and to only rely on the "-L" command line argument to change the local
2322 peer name. This makes it easier to maintain coherent configuration files
2323 across all peers.
2324
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02002325 You may want to reference some environment variables in the address
2326 parameter, see section 2.3 about environment variables.
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01002327
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01002328 Note: "peer" keyword may transparently be replaced by "server" keyword (see
2329 "server" keyword explanation below).
2330
2331server <peername> [<ip>:<port>] [param*]
Michael Prokop4438c602019-05-24 10:25:45 +02002332 As previously mentioned, "peer" keyword may be replaced by "server" keyword
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01002333 with a support for all "server" parameters found in 5.2 paragraph.
2334 If the underlying peer is local, <ip>:<port> parameters must not be present.
2335 These parameters must be provided on a "bind" line (see "bind" keyword
2336 of this "peers" section).
2337 Some of these parameters are irrelevant for "peers" sections.
2338
2339
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02002340 Example:
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01002341 # The old way.
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002342 peers mypeers
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +01002343 peer haproxy1 192.168.0.1:1024
2344 peer haproxy2 192.168.0.2:1024
2345 peer haproxy3 10.2.0.1:1024
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002346
2347 backend mybackend
2348 mode tcp
2349 balance roundrobin
2350 stick-table type ip size 20k peers mypeers
2351 stick on src
2352
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +01002353 server srv1 192.168.0.30:80
2354 server srv2 192.168.0.31:80
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002355
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01002356 Example:
2357 peers mypeers
2358 bind 127.0.0.11:10001 ssl crt mycerts/pem
2359 default-server ssl verify none
2360 server hostA 127.0.0.10:10000
2361 server hostB #local peer
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002362
Frédéric Lécaille4f5b77c2019-03-18 14:05:58 +01002363
2364table <tablename> type {ip | integer | string [len <length>] | binary [len <length>]}
2365 size <size> [expire <expire>] [nopurge] [store <data_type>]*
2366
2367 Configure a stickiness table for the current section. This line is parsed
2368 exactly the same way as the "stick-table" keyword in others section, except
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05002369 for the "peers" argument which is not required here and with an additional
Frédéric Lécaille4f5b77c2019-03-18 14:05:58 +01002370 mandatory first parameter to designate the stick-table. Contrary to others
2371 sections, there may be several "table" lines in "peers" sections (see also
2372 "stick-table" keyword).
2373
2374 Also be aware of the fact that "peers" sections have their own stick-table
2375 namespaces to avoid collisions between stick-table names identical in
2376 different "peers" section. This is internally handled prepending the "peers"
2377 sections names to the name of the stick-tables followed by a '/' character.
2378 If somewhere else in the configuration file you have to refer to such
2379 stick-tables declared in "peers" sections you must use the prefixed version
2380 of the stick-table name as follows:
2381
2382 peers mypeers
2383 peer A ...
2384 peer B ...
2385 table t1 ...
2386
2387 frontend fe1
2388 tcp-request content track-sc0 src table mypeers/t1
2389
2390 This is also this prefixed version of the stick-table names which must be
2391 used to refer to stick-tables through the CLI.
2392
2393 About "peers" protocol, as only "peers" belonging to the same section may
2394 communicate with each others, there is no need to do such a distinction.
2395 Several "peers" sections may declare stick-tables with the same name.
2396 This is shorter version of the stick-table name which is sent over the network.
2397 There is only a '/' character as prefix to avoid stick-table name collisions between
2398 stick-tables declared as backends and stick-table declared in "peers" sections
2399 as follows in this weird but supported configuration:
2400
2401 peers mypeers
2402 peer A ...
2403 peer B ...
2404 table t1 type string size 10m store gpc0
2405
2406 backend t1
2407 stick-table type string size 10m store gpc0 peers mypeers
2408
2409 Here "t1" table declared in "mypeeers" section has "mypeers/t1" as global name.
2410 "t1" table declared as a backend as "t1" as global name. But at peer protocol
2411 level the former table is named "/t1", the latter is again named "t1".
2412
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +090024133.6. Mailers
2414------------
2415It is possible to send email alerts when the state of servers changes.
2416If configured email alerts are sent to each mailer that is configured
2417in a mailers section. Email is sent to mailers using SMTP.
2418
Pieter Baauw386a1272015-08-16 15:26:24 +02002419mailers <mailersect>
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09002420 Creates a new mailer list with the name <mailersect>. It is an
2421 independent section which is referenced by one or more proxies.
2422
2423mailer <mailername> <ip>:<port>
2424 Defines a mailer inside a mailers section.
2425
2426 Example:
2427 mailers mymailers
2428 mailer smtp1 192.168.0.1:587
2429 mailer smtp2 192.168.0.2:587
2430
2431 backend mybackend
2432 mode tcp
2433 balance roundrobin
2434
2435 email-alert mailers mymailers
2436 email-alert from test1@horms.org
2437 email-alert to test2@horms.org
2438
2439 server srv1 192.168.0.30:80
2440 server srv2 192.168.0.31:80
2441
Pieter Baauw235fcfc2016-02-13 15:33:40 +01002442timeout mail <time>
2443 Defines the time available for a mail/connection to be made and send to
2444 the mail-server. If not defined the default value is 10 seconds. To allow
2445 for at least two SYN-ACK packets to be send during initial TCP handshake it
2446 is advised to keep this value above 4 seconds.
2447
2448 Example:
2449 mailers mymailers
2450 timeout mail 20s
2451 mailer smtp1 192.168.0.1:587
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09002452
William Lallemandc9515522019-06-12 16:32:11 +020024533.7. Programs
2454-------------
2455In master-worker mode, it is possible to launch external binaries with the
2456master, these processes are called programs. These programs are launched and
2457managed the same way as the workers.
2458
2459During a reload of HAProxy, those processes are dealing with the same
2460sequence as a worker:
2461
2462 - the master is re-executed
2463 - the master sends a SIGUSR1 signal to the program
2464 - if "option start-on-reload" is not disabled, the master launches a new
2465 instance of the program
2466
2467During a stop, or restart, a SIGTERM is sent to the programs.
2468
2469program <name>
2470 This is a new program section, this section will create an instance <name>
2471 which is visible in "show proc" on the master CLI. (See "9.4. Master CLI" in
2472 the management guide).
2473
2474command <command> [arguments*]
2475 Define the command to start with optional arguments. The command is looked
2476 up in the current PATH if it does not include an absolute path. This is a
2477 mandatory option of the program section. Arguments containing spaces must
2478 be enclosed in quotes or double quotes or be prefixed by a backslash.
2479
Andrew Heberle97236962019-07-12 11:50:26 +08002480user <user name>
2481 Changes the executed command user ID to the <user name> from /etc/passwd.
2482 See also "group".
2483
2484group <group name>
2485 Changes the executed command group ID to the <group name> from /etc/group.
2486 See also "user".
2487
William Lallemandc9515522019-06-12 16:32:11 +02002488option start-on-reload
2489no option start-on-reload
2490 Start (or not) a new instance of the program upon a reload of the master.
2491 The default is to start a new instance. This option may only be used in a
2492 program section.
2493
2494
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +010024953.8. HTTP-errors
2496----------------
2497
2498It is possible to globally declare several groups of HTTP errors, to be
2499imported afterwards in any proxy section. Same group may be referenced at
2500several places and can be fully or partially imported.
2501
2502http-errors <name>
2503 Create a new http-errors group with the name <name>. It is an independent
2504 section that may be referenced by one or more proxies using its name.
2505
2506errorfile <code> <file>
2507 Associate a file contents to an HTTP error code
2508
2509 Arguments :
2510 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
2511 generating codes 200, 400, 403, 404, 405, 408, 410, 425, 429,
2512 500, 502, 503, and 504.
2513
2514 <file> designates a file containing the full HTTP response. It is
2515 recommended to follow the common practice of appending ".http" to
2516 the filename so that people do not confuse the response with HTML
2517 error pages, and to use absolute paths, since files are read
2518 before any chroot is performed.
2519
2520 Please referrers to "errorfile" keyword in section 4 for details.
2521
2522 Example:
2523 http-errors website-1
2524 errorfile 400 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/site1/400.http
2525 errorfile 404 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/site1/404.http
2526 errorfile 408 /dev/null # work around Chrome pre-connect bug
2527
2528 http-errors website-2
2529 errorfile 400 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/site2/400.http
2530 errorfile 404 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/site2/404.http
2531 errorfile 408 /dev/null # work around Chrome pre-connect bug
2532
2533
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020025344. Proxies
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002535----------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002536
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002537Proxy configuration can be located in a set of sections :
William Lallemand6e62fb62015-04-28 16:55:23 +02002538 - defaults [<name>]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002539 - frontend <name>
2540 - backend <name>
2541 - listen <name>
2542
2543A "defaults" section sets default parameters for all other sections following
2544its declaration. Those default parameters are reset by the next "defaults"
2545section. See below for the list of parameters which can be set in a "defaults"
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002546section. The name is optional but its use is encouraged for better readability.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002547
2548A "frontend" section describes a set of listening sockets accepting client
2549connections.
2550
2551A "backend" section describes a set of servers to which the proxy will connect
2552to forward incoming connections.
2553
2554A "listen" section defines a complete proxy with its frontend and backend
2555parts combined in one section. It is generally useful for TCP-only traffic.
2556
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002557All proxy names must be formed from upper and lower case letters, digits,
2558'-' (dash), '_' (underscore) , '.' (dot) and ':' (colon). ACL names are
2559case-sensitive, which means that "www" and "WWW" are two different proxies.
2560
2561Historically, all proxy names could overlap, it just caused troubles in the
2562logs. Since the introduction of content switching, it is mandatory that two
2563proxies with overlapping capabilities (frontend/backend) have different names.
2564However, it is still permitted that a frontend and a backend share the same
2565name, as this configuration seems to be commonly encountered.
2566
2567Right now, two major proxy modes are supported : "tcp", also known as layer 4,
2568and "http", also known as layer 7. In layer 4 mode, HAProxy simply forwards
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002569bidirectional traffic between two sides. In layer 7 mode, HAProxy analyzes the
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002570protocol, and can interact with it by allowing, blocking, switching, adding,
2571modifying, or removing arbitrary contents in requests or responses, based on
2572arbitrary criteria.
2573
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01002574In HTTP mode, the processing applied to requests and responses flowing over
2575a connection depends in the combination of the frontend's HTTP options and
Julien Pivotto21ad3152019-12-10 13:11:17 +01002576the backend's. HAProxy supports 3 connection modes :
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01002577
2578 - KAL : keep alive ("option http-keep-alive") which is the default mode : all
2579 requests and responses are processed, and connections remain open but idle
2580 between responses and new requests.
2581
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01002582 - SCL: server close ("option http-server-close") : the server-facing
2583 connection is closed after the end of the response is received, but the
2584 client-facing connection remains open.
2585
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02002586 - CLO: close ("option httpclose"): the connection is closed after the end of
2587 the response and "Connection: close" appended in both directions.
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01002588
2589The effective mode that will be applied to a connection passing through a
2590frontend and a backend can be determined by both proxy modes according to the
2591following matrix, but in short, the modes are symmetric, keep-alive is the
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02002592weakest option and close is the strongest.
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01002593
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02002594 Backend mode
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01002595
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02002596 | KAL | SCL | CLO
2597 ----+-----+-----+----
2598 KAL | KAL | SCL | CLO
2599 ----+-----+-----+----
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02002600 mode SCL | SCL | SCL | CLO
2601 ----+-----+-----+----
2602 CLO | CLO | CLO | CLO
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01002603
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002604
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01002605
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020026064.1. Proxy keywords matrix
2607--------------------------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002608
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02002609The following list of keywords is supported. Most of them may only be used in a
2610limited set of section types. Some of them are marked as "deprecated" because
2611they are inherited from an old syntax which may be confusing or functionally
2612limited, and there are new recommended keywords to replace them. Keywords
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002613marked with "(*)" can be optionally inverted using the "no" prefix, e.g. "no
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02002614option contstats". This makes sense when the option has been enabled by default
Willy Tarreau3842f002009-06-14 11:39:52 +02002615and must be disabled for a specific instance. Such options may also be prefixed
2616with "default" in order to restore default settings regardless of what has been
2617specified in a previous "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002618
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002619
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002620 keyword defaults frontend listen backend
2621------------------------------------+----------+----------+---------+---------
2622acl - X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002623backlog X X X -
2624balance X - X X
2625bind - X X -
2626bind-process X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002627capture cookie - X X -
2628capture request header - X X -
2629capture response header - X X -
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02002630compression X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002631cookie X - X X
Thierry FOURNIERa0a1b752015-05-26 17:44:32 +02002632declare capture - X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002633default-server X - X X
2634default_backend X X X -
2635description - X X X
2636disabled X X X X
2637dispatch - - X X
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09002638email-alert from X X X X
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09002639email-alert level X X X X
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09002640email-alert mailers X X X X
2641email-alert myhostname X X X X
2642email-alert to X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002643enabled X X X X
2644errorfile X X X X
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +01002645errorfiles X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002646errorloc X X X X
2647errorloc302 X X X X
2648-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
2649errorloc303 X X X X
Cyril Bonté4288c5a2018-03-12 22:02:59 +01002650force-persist - - X X
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02002651filter - X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002652fullconn X - X X
2653grace X X X X
2654hash-type X - X X
Christopher Faulet6d0c3df2020-01-22 09:26:35 +01002655http-after-response - X X X
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02002656http-check connect X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002657http-check disable-on-404 X - X X
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02002658http-check expect X - X X
Willy Tarreau7ab6aff2010-10-12 06:30:16 +02002659http-check send-state X - X X
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02002660http-check set-var X - X X
2661http-check unset-var X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002662http-request - X X X
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02002663http-response - X X X
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02002664http-reuse X - X X
Baptiste Assmann2c42ef52013-10-09 21:57:02 +02002665http-send-name-header - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002666id - X X X
Cyril Bonté4288c5a2018-03-12 22:02:59 +01002667ignore-persist - - X X
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02002668load-server-state-from-file X - X X
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02002669log (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreaufb4e7ea2015-01-07 14:55:17 +01002670log-format X X X -
Dragan Dosen7ad31542015-09-28 17:16:47 +02002671log-format-sd X X X -
Willy Tarreau094af4e2015-01-07 15:03:42 +01002672log-tag X X X X
Willy Tarreauc35362a2014-04-25 13:58:37 +02002673max-keep-alive-queue X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002674maxconn X X X -
2675mode X X X X
2676monitor fail - X X -
2677monitor-net X X X -
2678monitor-uri X X X -
2679option abortonclose (*) X - X X
2680option accept-invalid-http-request (*) X X X -
2681option accept-invalid-http-response (*) X - X X
2682option allbackups (*) X - X X
2683option checkcache (*) X - X X
2684option clitcpka (*) X X X -
2685option contstats (*) X X X -
2686option dontlog-normal (*) X X X -
2687option dontlognull (*) X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002688-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
2689option forwardfor X X X X
Christopher Faulet98fbe952019-07-22 16:18:24 +02002690option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client (*) X X X -
2691option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server (*) X - X X
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02002692option http-buffer-request (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau82649f92015-05-01 22:40:51 +02002693option http-ignore-probes (*) X X X -
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01002694option http-keep-alive (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau96e31212011-05-30 18:10:30 +02002695option http-no-delay (*) X X X X
Christopher Faulet98db9762018-09-21 10:25:19 +02002696option http-pretend-keepalive (*) X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002697option http-server-close (*) X X X X
2698option http-use-proxy-header (*) X X X -
2699option httpchk X - X X
2700option httpclose (*) X X X X
Freddy Spierenburge88b7732019-03-25 14:35:17 +01002701option httplog X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002702option http_proxy (*) X X X X
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04002703option independent-streams (*) X X X X
Gabor Lekenyb4c81e42010-09-29 18:17:05 +02002704option ldap-check X - X X
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09002705option external-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002706option log-health-checks (*) X - X X
2707option log-separate-errors (*) X X X -
2708option logasap (*) X X X -
2709option mysql-check X - X X
2710option nolinger (*) X X X X
2711option originalto X X X X
2712option persist (*) X - X X
Baptiste Assmann809e22a2015-10-12 20:22:55 +02002713option pgsql-check X - X X
2714option prefer-last-server (*) X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002715option redispatch (*) X - X X
Hervé COMMOWICKec032d62011-08-05 16:23:48 +02002716option redis-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002717option smtpchk X - X X
2718option socket-stats (*) X X X -
2719option splice-auto (*) X X X X
2720option splice-request (*) X X X X
2721option splice-response (*) X X X X
Christopher Fauletba7bc162016-11-07 21:07:38 +01002722option spop-check - - - X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002723option srvtcpka (*) X - X X
2724option ssl-hello-chk X - X X
2725-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01002726option tcp-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002727option tcp-smart-accept (*) X X X -
2728option tcp-smart-connect (*) X - X X
2729option tcpka X X X X
2730option tcplog X X X X
2731option transparent (*) X - X X
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09002732external-check command X - X X
2733external-check path X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002734persist rdp-cookie X - X X
2735rate-limit sessions X X X -
2736redirect - X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002737-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002738retries X - X X
Olivier Houcharda254a372019-04-05 15:30:12 +02002739retry-on X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002740server - - X X
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02002741server-state-file-name X - X X
Frédéric Lécaillecb4502e2017-04-20 13:36:25 +02002742server-template - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002743source X - X X
Baptiste Assmann5a549212015-10-12 20:30:24 +02002744stats admin - X X X
2745stats auth X X X X
2746stats enable X X X X
2747stats hide-version X X X X
2748stats http-request - X X X
2749stats realm X X X X
2750stats refresh X X X X
2751stats scope X X X X
2752stats show-desc X X X X
2753stats show-legends X X X X
2754stats show-node X X X X
2755stats uri X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002756-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
2757stick match - - X X
2758stick on - - X X
2759stick store-request - - X X
Willy Tarreaud8dc99f2011-07-01 11:33:25 +02002760stick store-response - - X X
Adam Spiers68af3c12017-04-06 16:31:39 +01002761stick-table - X X X
Christopher Faulet404f9192020-04-09 23:13:54 +02002762tcp-check connect X - X X
2763tcp-check expect X - X X
2764tcp-check send X - X X
2765tcp-check send-binary X - X X
2766tcp-check set-var X - X X
2767tcp-check unset-var X - X X
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02002768tcp-request connection - X X -
2769tcp-request content - X X X
Willy Tarreaua56235c2010-09-14 11:31:36 +02002770tcp-request inspect-delay - X X X
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +02002771tcp-request session - X X -
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02002772tcp-response content - - X X
2773tcp-response inspect-delay - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002774timeout check X - X X
2775timeout client X X X -
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02002776timeout client-fin X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002777timeout connect X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002778timeout http-keep-alive X X X X
2779timeout http-request X X X X
2780timeout queue X - X X
2781timeout server X - X X
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02002782timeout server-fin X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002783timeout tarpit X X X X
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02002784timeout tunnel X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002785transparent (deprecated) X - X X
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01002786unique-id-format X X X -
2787unique-id-header X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002788use_backend - X X -
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +02002789use-fcgi-app - - X X
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +02002790use-server - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002791------------------------------------+----------+----------+---------+---------
2792 keyword defaults frontend listen backend
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002793
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002794
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020027954.2. Alphabetically sorted keywords reference
2796---------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002797
2798This section provides a description of each keyword and its usage.
2799
2800
2801acl <aclname> <criterion> [flags] [operator] <value> ...
2802 Declare or complete an access list.
2803 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2804 no | yes | yes | yes
2805 Example:
2806 acl invalid_src src 0.0.0.0/7 224.0.0.0/3
2807 acl invalid_src src_port 0:1023
2808 acl local_dst hdr(host) -i localhost
2809
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02002810 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002811
2812
Willy Tarreauc73ce2b2008-01-06 10:55:10 +01002813backlog <conns>
2814 Give hints to the system about the approximate listen backlog desired size
2815 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2816 yes | yes | yes | no
2817 Arguments :
2818 <conns> is the number of pending connections. Depending on the operating
2819 system, it may represent the number of already acknowledged
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02002820 connections, of non-acknowledged ones, or both.
Willy Tarreauc73ce2b2008-01-06 10:55:10 +01002821
2822 In order to protect against SYN flood attacks, one solution is to increase
2823 the system's SYN backlog size. Depending on the system, sometimes it is just
2824 tunable via a system parameter, sometimes it is not adjustable at all, and
2825 sometimes the system relies on hints given by the application at the time of
2826 the listen() syscall. By default, HAProxy passes the frontend's maxconn value
2827 to the listen() syscall. On systems which can make use of this value, it can
2828 sometimes be useful to be able to specify a different value, hence this
2829 backlog parameter.
2830
2831 On Linux 2.4, the parameter is ignored by the system. On Linux 2.6, it is
2832 used as a hint and the system accepts up to the smallest greater power of
2833 two, and never more than some limits (usually 32768).
2834
2835 See also : "maxconn" and the target operating system's tuning guide.
2836
2837
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002838balance <algorithm> [ <arguments> ]
Willy Tarreau226071e2014-04-10 11:55:45 +02002839balance url_param <param> [check_post]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002840 Define the load balancing algorithm to be used in a backend.
2841 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2842 yes | no | yes | yes
2843 Arguments :
2844 <algorithm> is the algorithm used to select a server when doing load
2845 balancing. This only applies when no persistence information
2846 is available, or when a connection is redispatched to another
2847 server. <algorithm> may be one of the following :
2848
2849 roundrobin Each server is used in turns, according to their weights.
2850 This is the smoothest and fairest algorithm when the server's
2851 processing time remains equally distributed. This algorithm
2852 is dynamic, which means that server weights may be adjusted
Willy Tarreau9757a382009-10-03 12:56:50 +02002853 on the fly for slow starts for instance. It is limited by
Godbacha34bdc02013-07-22 07:44:53 +08002854 design to 4095 active servers per backend. Note that in some
Willy Tarreau9757a382009-10-03 12:56:50 +02002855 large farms, when a server becomes up after having been down
2856 for a very short time, it may sometimes take a few hundreds
2857 requests for it to be re-integrated into the farm and start
2858 receiving traffic. This is normal, though very rare. It is
2859 indicated here in case you would have the chance to observe
2860 it, so that you don't worry.
2861
2862 static-rr Each server is used in turns, according to their weights.
2863 This algorithm is as similar to roundrobin except that it is
2864 static, which means that changing a server's weight on the
2865 fly will have no effect. On the other hand, it has no design
2866 limitation on the number of servers, and when a server goes
2867 up, it is always immediately reintroduced into the farm, once
2868 the full map is recomputed. It also uses slightly less CPU to
2869 run (around -1%).
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002870
Willy Tarreau2d2a7f82008-03-17 12:07:56 +01002871 leastconn The server with the lowest number of connections receives the
2872 connection. Round-robin is performed within groups of servers
2873 of the same load to ensure that all servers will be used. Use
2874 of this algorithm is recommended where very long sessions are
2875 expected, such as LDAP, SQL, TSE, etc... but is not very well
2876 suited for protocols using short sessions such as HTTP. This
2877 algorithm is dynamic, which means that server weights may be
2878 adjusted on the fly for slow starts for instance.
2879
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01002880 first The first server with available connection slots receives the
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03002881 connection. The servers are chosen from the lowest numeric
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01002882 identifier to the highest (see server parameter "id"), which
2883 defaults to the server's position in the farm. Once a server
Willy Tarreau64559c52012-04-07 09:08:45 +02002884 reaches its maxconn value, the next server is used. It does
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01002885 not make sense to use this algorithm without setting maxconn.
2886 The purpose of this algorithm is to always use the smallest
2887 number of servers so that extra servers can be powered off
2888 during non-intensive hours. This algorithm ignores the server
2889 weight, and brings more benefit to long session such as RDP
Willy Tarreau64559c52012-04-07 09:08:45 +02002890 or IMAP than HTTP, though it can be useful there too. In
2891 order to use this algorithm efficiently, it is recommended
2892 that a cloud controller regularly checks server usage to turn
2893 them off when unused, and regularly checks backend queue to
2894 turn new servers on when the queue inflates. Alternatively,
2895 using "http-check send-state" may inform servers on the load.
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01002896
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002897 source The source IP address is hashed and divided by the total
2898 weight of the running servers to designate which server will
2899 receive the request. This ensures that the same client IP
2900 address will always reach the same server as long as no
2901 server goes down or up. If the hash result changes due to the
2902 number of running servers changing, many clients will be
2903 directed to a different server. This algorithm is generally
2904 used in TCP mode where no cookie may be inserted. It may also
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002905 be used on the Internet to provide a best-effort stickiness
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002906 to clients which refuse session cookies. This algorithm is
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02002907 static by default, which means that changing a server's
2908 weight on the fly will have no effect, but this can be
2909 changed using "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002910
Oskar Stolc8dc41842012-05-19 10:19:54 +01002911 uri This algorithm hashes either the left part of the URI (before
2912 the question mark) or the whole URI (if the "whole" parameter
2913 is present) and divides the hash value by the total weight of
2914 the running servers. The result designates which server will
2915 receive the request. This ensures that the same URI will
2916 always be directed to the same server as long as no server
2917 goes up or down. This is used with proxy caches and
2918 anti-virus proxies in order to maximize the cache hit rate.
2919 Note that this algorithm may only be used in an HTTP backend.
2920 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
2921 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
2922 but this can be changed using "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002923
Oskar Stolc8dc41842012-05-19 10:19:54 +01002924 This algorithm supports two optional parameters "len" and
Marek Majkowski9c30fc12008-04-27 23:25:55 +02002925 "depth", both followed by a positive integer number. These
2926 options may be helpful when it is needed to balance servers
2927 based on the beginning of the URI only. The "len" parameter
2928 indicates that the algorithm should only consider that many
2929 characters at the beginning of the URI to compute the hash.
2930 Note that having "len" set to 1 rarely makes sense since most
2931 URIs start with a leading "/".
2932
2933 The "depth" parameter indicates the maximum directory depth
2934 to be used to compute the hash. One level is counted for each
2935 slash in the request. If both parameters are specified, the
2936 evaluation stops when either is reached.
2937
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002938 url_param The URL parameter specified in argument will be looked up in
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02002939 the query string of each HTTP GET request.
2940
2941 If the modifier "check_post" is used, then an HTTP POST
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02002942 request entity will be searched for the parameter argument,
2943 when it is not found in a query string after a question mark
Willy Tarreau226071e2014-04-10 11:55:45 +02002944 ('?') in the URL. The message body will only start to be
2945 analyzed once either the advertised amount of data has been
2946 received or the request buffer is full. In the unlikely event
2947 that chunked encoding is used, only the first chunk is
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02002948 scanned. Parameter values separated by a chunk boundary, may
Willy Tarreau226071e2014-04-10 11:55:45 +02002949 be randomly balanced if at all. This keyword used to support
2950 an optional <max_wait> parameter which is now ignored.
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02002951
2952 If the parameter is found followed by an equal sign ('=') and
2953 a value, then the value is hashed and divided by the total
2954 weight of the running servers. The result designates which
2955 server will receive the request.
2956
2957 This is used to track user identifiers in requests and ensure
2958 that a same user ID will always be sent to the same server as
2959 long as no server goes up or down. If no value is found or if
2960 the parameter is not found, then a round robin algorithm is
2961 applied. Note that this algorithm may only be used in an HTTP
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02002962 backend. This algorithm is static by default, which means
2963 that changing a server's weight on the fly will have no
2964 effect, but this can be changed using "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002965
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02002966 hdr(<name>) The HTTP header <name> will be looked up in each HTTP
2967 request. Just as with the equivalent ACL 'hdr()' function,
2968 the header name in parenthesis is not case sensitive. If the
2969 header is absent or if it does not contain any value, the
2970 roundrobin algorithm is applied instead.
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01002971
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002972 An optional 'use_domain_only' parameter is available, for
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01002973 reducing the hash algorithm to the main domain part with some
2974 specific headers such as 'Host'. For instance, in the Host
2975 value "haproxy.1wt.eu", only "1wt" will be considered.
2976
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02002977 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
2978 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
2979 but this can be changed using "hash-type".
2980
Willy Tarreau21c741a2019-01-14 18:14:27 +01002981 random
2982 random(<draws>)
2983 A random number will be used as the key for the consistent
Willy Tarreau760e81d2018-05-03 07:20:40 +02002984 hashing function. This means that the servers' weights are
2985 respected, dynamic weight changes immediately take effect, as
2986 well as new server additions. Random load balancing can be
2987 useful with large farms or when servers are frequently added
Willy Tarreau21c741a2019-01-14 18:14:27 +01002988 or removed as it may avoid the hammering effect that could
2989 result from roundrobin or leastconn in this situation. The
2990 hash-balance-factor directive can be used to further improve
2991 fairness of the load balancing, especially in situations
2992 where servers show highly variable response times. When an
2993 argument <draws> is present, it must be an integer value one
2994 or greater, indicating the number of draws before selecting
2995 the least loaded of these servers. It was indeed demonstrated
2996 that picking the least loaded of two servers is enough to
2997 significantly improve the fairness of the algorithm, by
2998 always avoiding to pick the most loaded server within a farm
2999 and getting rid of any bias that could be induced by the
3000 unfair distribution of the consistent list. Higher values N
3001 will take away N-1 of the highest loaded servers at the
3002 expense of performance. With very high values, the algorithm
3003 will converge towards the leastconn's result but much slower.
3004 The default value is 2, which generally shows very good
3005 distribution and performance. This algorithm is also known as
3006 the Power of Two Random Choices and is described here :
3007 http://www.eecs.harvard.edu/~michaelm/postscripts/handbook2001.pdf
Willy Tarreau760e81d2018-05-03 07:20:40 +02003008
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02003009 rdp-cookie
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02003010 rdp-cookie(<name>)
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02003011 The RDP cookie <name> (or "mstshash" if omitted) will be
3012 looked up and hashed for each incoming TCP request. Just as
3013 with the equivalent ACL 'req_rdp_cookie()' function, the name
3014 is not case-sensitive. This mechanism is useful as a degraded
3015 persistence mode, as it makes it possible to always send the
3016 same user (or the same session ID) to the same server. If the
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003017 cookie is not found, the normal roundrobin algorithm is
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02003018 used instead.
3019
3020 Note that for this to work, the frontend must ensure that an
3021 RDP cookie is already present in the request buffer. For this
3022 you must use 'tcp-request content accept' rule combined with
3023 a 'req_rdp_cookie_cnt' ACL.
3024
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02003025 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
3026 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
3027 but this can be changed using "hash-type".
3028
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02003029 See also the rdp_cookie pattern fetch function.
Simon Hormanab814e02011-06-24 14:50:20 +09003030
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003031 <arguments> is an optional list of arguments which may be needed by some
Marek Majkowski9c30fc12008-04-27 23:25:55 +02003032 algorithms. Right now, only "url_param" and "uri" support an
3033 optional argument.
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02003034
Willy Tarreau3cd9af22009-03-15 14:06:41 +01003035 The load balancing algorithm of a backend is set to roundrobin when no other
3036 algorithm, mode nor option have been set. The algorithm may only be set once
3037 for each backend.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003038
Lukas Tribus80512b12018-10-27 20:07:40 +02003039 With authentication schemes that require the same connection like NTLM, URI
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05003040 based algorithms must not be used, as they would cause subsequent requests
Lukas Tribus80512b12018-10-27 20:07:40 +02003041 to be routed to different backend servers, breaking the invalid assumptions
3042 NTLM relies on.
3043
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003044 Examples :
3045 balance roundrobin
3046 balance url_param userid
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02003047 balance url_param session_id check_post 64
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01003048 balance hdr(User-Agent)
3049 balance hdr(host)
3050 balance hdr(Host) use_domain_only
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02003051
3052 Note: the following caveats and limitations on using the "check_post"
3053 extension with "url_param" must be considered :
3054
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003055 - all POST requests are eligible for consideration, because there is no way
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02003056 to determine if the parameters will be found in the body or entity which
3057 may contain binary data. Therefore another method may be required to
3058 restrict consideration of POST requests that have no URL parameters in
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +02003059 the body. (see acl http_end)
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02003060
3061 - using a <max_wait> value larger than the request buffer size does not
3062 make sense and is useless. The buffer size is set at build time, and
3063 defaults to 16 kB.
3064
3065 - Content-Encoding is not supported, the parameter search will probably
3066 fail; and load balancing will fall back to Round Robin.
3067
3068 - Expect: 100-continue is not supported, load balancing will fall back to
3069 Round Robin.
3070
Lukas Tribus23953682017-04-28 13:24:30 +00003071 - Transfer-Encoding (RFC7230 3.3.1) is only supported in the first chunk.
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02003072 If the entire parameter value is not present in the first chunk, the
3073 selection of server is undefined (actually, defined by how little
3074 actually appeared in the first chunk).
3075
3076 - This feature does not support generation of a 100, 411 or 501 response.
3077
3078 - In some cases, requesting "check_post" MAY attempt to scan the entire
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003079 contents of a message body. Scanning normally terminates when linear
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02003080 white space or control characters are found, indicating the end of what
3081 might be a URL parameter list. This is probably not a concern with SGML
3082 type message bodies.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003083
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +02003084 See also : "dispatch", "cookie", "transparent", "hash-type" and "http_proxy".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003085
3086
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02003087bind [<address>]:<port_range> [, ...] [param*]
3088bind /<path> [, ...] [param*]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003089 Define one or several listening addresses and/or ports in a frontend.
3090 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3091 no | yes | yes | no
3092 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaub1e52e82008-01-13 14:49:51 +01003093 <address> is optional and can be a host name, an IPv4 address, an IPv6
3094 address, or '*'. It designates the address the frontend will
3095 listen on. If unset, all IPv4 addresses of the system will be
3096 listened on. The same will apply for '*' or the system's
David du Colombier9c938da2011-03-17 10:40:27 +01003097 special address "0.0.0.0". The IPv6 equivalent is '::'.
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01003098 Optionally, an address family prefix may be used before the
3099 address to force the family regardless of the address format,
3100 which can be useful to specify a path to a unix socket with
3101 no slash ('/'). Currently supported prefixes are :
3102 - 'ipv4@' -> address is always IPv4
3103 - 'ipv6@' -> address is always IPv6
3104 - 'unix@' -> address is a path to a local unix socket
Willy Tarreau70f72e02014-07-08 00:37:50 +02003105 - 'abns@' -> address is in abstract namespace (Linux only).
3106 Note: since abstract sockets are not "rebindable", they
3107 do not cope well with multi-process mode during
3108 soft-restart, so it is better to avoid them if
3109 nbproc is greater than 1. The effect is that if the
3110 new process fails to start, only one of the old ones
3111 will be able to rebind to the socket.
Willy Tarreau40aa0702013-03-10 23:51:38 +01003112 - 'fd@<n>' -> use file descriptor <n> inherited from the
3113 parent. The fd must be bound and may or may not already
3114 be listening.
William Lallemand2fe7dd02018-09-11 16:51:29 +02003115 - 'sockpair@<n>'-> like fd@ but you must use the fd of a
3116 connected unix socket or of a socketpair. The bind waits
3117 to receive a FD over the unix socket and uses it as if it
3118 was the FD of an accept(). Should be used carefully.
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02003119 You may want to reference some environment variables in the
3120 address parameter, see section 2.3 about environment
3121 variables.
Willy Tarreaub1e52e82008-01-13 14:49:51 +01003122
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01003123 <port_range> is either a unique TCP port, or a port range for which the
3124 proxy will accept connections for the IP address specified
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01003125 above. The port is mandatory for TCP listeners. Note that in
3126 the case of an IPv6 address, the port is always the number
3127 after the last colon (':'). A range can either be :
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01003128 - a numerical port (ex: '80')
3129 - a dash-delimited ports range explicitly stating the lower
3130 and upper bounds (ex: '2000-2100') which are included in
3131 the range.
3132
3133 Particular care must be taken against port ranges, because
3134 every <address:port> couple consumes one socket (= a file
3135 descriptor), so it's easy to consume lots of descriptors
3136 with a simple range, and to run out of sockets. Also, each
3137 <address:port> couple must be used only once among all
3138 instances running on a same system. Please note that binding
3139 to ports lower than 1024 generally require particular
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04003140 privileges to start the program, which are independent of
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01003141 the 'uid' parameter.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003142
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01003143 <path> is a UNIX socket path beginning with a slash ('/'). This is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003144 alternative to the TCP listening port. HAProxy will then
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01003145 receive UNIX connections on the socket located at this place.
3146 The path must begin with a slash and by default is absolute.
3147 It can be relative to the prefix defined by "unix-bind" in
3148 the global section. Note that the total length of the prefix
3149 followed by the socket path cannot exceed some system limits
3150 for UNIX sockets, which commonly are set to 107 characters.
3151
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02003152 <param*> is a list of parameters common to all sockets declared on the
3153 same line. These numerous parameters depend on OS and build
3154 options and have a complete section dedicated to them. Please
3155 refer to section 5 to for more details.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02003156
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003157 It is possible to specify a list of address:port combinations delimited by
3158 commas. The frontend will then listen on all of these addresses. There is no
3159 fixed limit to the number of addresses and ports which can be listened on in
3160 a frontend, as well as there is no limit to the number of "bind" statements
3161 in a frontend.
3162
3163 Example :
3164 listen http_proxy
3165 bind :80,:443
3166 bind 10.0.0.1:10080,10.0.0.1:10443
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01003167 bind /var/run/ssl-frontend.sock user root mode 600 accept-proxy
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003168
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02003169 listen http_https_proxy
3170 bind :80
Cyril Bonté0d44fc62012-10-09 22:45:33 +02003171 bind :443 ssl crt /etc/haproxy/site.pem
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02003172
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01003173 listen http_https_proxy_explicit
3174 bind ipv6@:80
3175 bind ipv4@public_ssl:443 ssl crt /etc/haproxy/site.pem
3176 bind unix@ssl-frontend.sock user root mode 600 accept-proxy
3177
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01003178 listen external_bind_app1
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02003179 bind "fd@${FD_APP1}"
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01003180
Willy Tarreau55dcaf62015-09-27 15:03:15 +02003181 Note: regarding Linux's abstract namespace sockets, HAProxy uses the whole
3182 sun_path length is used for the address length. Some other programs
3183 such as socat use the string length only by default. Pass the option
3184 ",unix-tightsocklen=0" to any abstract socket definition in socat to
3185 make it compatible with HAProxy's.
3186
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01003187 See also : "source", "option forwardfor", "unix-bind" and the PROXY protocol
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02003188 documentation, and section 5 about bind options.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003189
3190
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +01003191bind-process [ all | odd | even | <process_num>[-[<process_num>]] ] ...
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01003192 Limit visibility of an instance to a certain set of processes numbers.
3193 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3194 yes | yes | yes | yes
3195 Arguments :
3196 all All process will see this instance. This is the default. It
3197 may be used to override a default value.
3198
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01003199 odd This instance will be enabled on processes 1,3,5,...63. This
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01003200 option may be combined with other numbers.
3201
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01003202 even This instance will be enabled on processes 2,4,6,...64. This
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01003203 option may be combined with other numbers. Do not use it
3204 with less than 2 processes otherwise some instances might be
3205 missing from all processes.
3206
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +01003207 process_num The instance will be enabled on this process number or range,
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01003208 whose values must all be between 1 and 32 or 64 depending on
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +01003209 the machine's word size. Ranges can be partially defined. The
3210 higher bound can be omitted. In such case, it is replaced by
3211 the corresponding maximum value. If a proxy is bound to
3212 process numbers greater than the configured global.nbproc, it
3213 will either be forced to process #1 if a single process was
Willy Tarreau102df612014-05-07 23:56:38 +02003214 specified, or to all processes otherwise.
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01003215
3216 This keyword limits binding of certain instances to certain processes. This
3217 is useful in order not to have too many processes listening to the same
3218 ports. For instance, on a dual-core machine, it might make sense to set
3219 'nbproc 2' in the global section, then distributes the listeners among 'odd'
3220 and 'even' instances.
3221
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01003222 At the moment, it is not possible to reference more than 32 or 64 processes
3223 using this keyword, but this should be more than enough for most setups.
3224 Please note that 'all' really means all processes regardless of the machine's
3225 word size, and is not limited to the first 32 or 64.
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01003226
Willy Tarreau6ae1ba62014-05-07 19:01:58 +02003227 Each "bind" line may further be limited to a subset of the proxy's processes,
3228 please consult the "process" bind keyword in section 5.1.
3229
Willy Tarreaub369a042014-09-16 13:21:03 +02003230 When a frontend has no explicit "bind-process" line, it tries to bind to all
3231 the processes referenced by its "bind" lines. That means that frontends can
3232 easily adapt to their listeners' processes.
3233
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01003234 If some backends are referenced by frontends bound to other processes, the
3235 backend automatically inherits the frontend's processes.
3236
3237 Example :
3238 listen app_ip1
3239 bind 10.0.0.1:80
Willy Tarreaubfcd3112010-10-23 11:22:08 +02003240 bind-process odd
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01003241
3242 listen app_ip2
3243 bind 10.0.0.2:80
Willy Tarreaubfcd3112010-10-23 11:22:08 +02003244 bind-process even
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01003245
3246 listen management
3247 bind 10.0.0.3:80
Willy Tarreaubfcd3112010-10-23 11:22:08 +02003248 bind-process 1 2 3 4
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01003249
Willy Tarreau110ecc12012-11-15 17:50:01 +01003250 listen management
3251 bind 10.0.0.4:80
3252 bind-process 1-4
3253
Willy Tarreau6ae1ba62014-05-07 19:01:58 +02003254 See also : "nbproc" in global section, and "process" in section 5.1.
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01003255
3256
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003257capture cookie <name> len <length>
3258 Capture and log a cookie in the request and in the response.
3259 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3260 no | yes | yes | no
3261 Arguments :
3262 <name> is the beginning of the name of the cookie to capture. In order
3263 to match the exact name, simply suffix the name with an equal
3264 sign ('='). The full name will appear in the logs, which is
3265 useful with application servers which adjust both the cookie name
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003266 and value (e.g. ASPSESSIONXXX).
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003267
3268 <length> is the maximum number of characters to report in the logs, which
3269 include the cookie name, the equal sign and the value, all in the
3270 standard "name=value" form. The string will be truncated on the
3271 right if it exceeds <length>.
3272
3273 Only the first cookie is captured. Both the "cookie" request headers and the
3274 "set-cookie" response headers are monitored. This is particularly useful to
3275 check for application bugs causing session crossing or stealing between
3276 users, because generally the user's cookies can only change on a login page.
3277
3278 When the cookie was not presented by the client, the associated log column
3279 will report "-". When a request does not cause a cookie to be assigned by the
3280 server, a "-" is reported in the response column.
3281
3282 The capture is performed in the frontend only because it is necessary that
3283 the log format does not change for a given frontend depending on the
3284 backends. This may change in the future. Note that there can be only one
Willy Tarreau193b8c62012-11-22 00:17:38 +01003285 "capture cookie" statement in a frontend. The maximum capture length is set
3286 by the global "tune.http.cookielen" setting and defaults to 63 characters. It
3287 is not possible to specify a capture in a "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003288
3289 Example:
3290 capture cookie ASPSESSION len 32
3291
3292 See also : "capture request header", "capture response header" as well as
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02003293 section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003294
3295
3296capture request header <name> len <length>
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01003297 Capture and log the last occurrence of the specified request header.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003298 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3299 no | yes | yes | no
3300 Arguments :
3301 <name> is the name of the header to capture. The header names are not
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01003302 case-sensitive, but it is a common practice to write them as they
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003303 appear in the requests, with the first letter of each word in
3304 upper case. The header name will not appear in the logs, only the
3305 value is reported, but the position in the logs is respected.
3306
3307 <length> is the maximum number of characters to extract from the value and
3308 report in the logs. The string will be truncated on the right if
3309 it exceeds <length>.
3310
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01003311 The complete value of the last occurrence of the header is captured. The
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003312 value will be added to the logs between braces ('{}'). If multiple headers
3313 are captured, they will be delimited by a vertical bar ('|') and will appear
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01003314 in the same order they were declared in the configuration. Non-existent
3315 headers will be logged just as an empty string. Common uses for request
3316 header captures include the "Host" field in virtual hosting environments, the
3317 "Content-length" when uploads are supported, "User-agent" to quickly
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003318 differentiate between real users and robots, and "X-Forwarded-For" in proxied
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01003319 environments to find where the request came from.
3320
3321 Note that when capturing headers such as "User-agent", some spaces may be
3322 logged, making the log analysis more difficult. Thus be careful about what
3323 you log if you know your log parser is not smart enough to rely on the
3324 braces.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003325
Willy Tarreau0900abb2012-11-22 00:21:46 +01003326 There is no limit to the number of captured request headers nor to their
3327 length, though it is wise to keep them low to limit memory usage per session.
3328 In order to keep log format consistent for a same frontend, header captures
3329 can only be declared in a frontend. It is not possible to specify a capture
3330 in a "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003331
3332 Example:
3333 capture request header Host len 15
3334 capture request header X-Forwarded-For len 15
Cyril Bontéd1b0f7c2015-10-26 22:37:39 +01003335 capture request header Referer len 15
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003336
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02003337 See also : "capture cookie", "capture response header" as well as section 8
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003338 about logging.
3339
3340
3341capture response header <name> len <length>
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01003342 Capture and log the last occurrence of the specified response header.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003343 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3344 no | yes | yes | no
3345 Arguments :
3346 <name> is the name of the header to capture. The header names are not
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01003347 case-sensitive, but it is a common practice to write them as they
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003348 appear in the response, with the first letter of each word in
3349 upper case. The header name will not appear in the logs, only the
3350 value is reported, but the position in the logs is respected.
3351
3352 <length> is the maximum number of characters to extract from the value and
3353 report in the logs. The string will be truncated on the right if
3354 it exceeds <length>.
3355
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01003356 The complete value of the last occurrence of the header is captured. The
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003357 result will be added to the logs between braces ('{}') after the captured
3358 request headers. If multiple headers are captured, they will be delimited by
3359 a vertical bar ('|') and will appear in the same order they were declared in
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01003360 the configuration. Non-existent headers will be logged just as an empty
3361 string. Common uses for response header captures include the "Content-length"
3362 header which indicates how many bytes are expected to be returned, the
3363 "Location" header to track redirections.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003364
Willy Tarreau0900abb2012-11-22 00:21:46 +01003365 There is no limit to the number of captured response headers nor to their
3366 length, though it is wise to keep them low to limit memory usage per session.
3367 In order to keep log format consistent for a same frontend, header captures
3368 can only be declared in a frontend. It is not possible to specify a capture
3369 in a "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003370
3371 Example:
3372 capture response header Content-length len 9
3373 capture response header Location len 15
3374
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02003375 See also : "capture cookie", "capture request header" as well as section 8
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003376 about logging.
3377
3378
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01003379compression algo <algorithm> ...
3380compression type <mime type> ...
Willy Tarreau70737d12012-10-27 00:34:28 +02003381compression offload
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02003382 Enable HTTP compression.
3383 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3384 yes | yes | yes | yes
3385 Arguments :
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01003386 algo is followed by the list of supported compression algorithms.
3387 type is followed by the list of MIME types that will be compressed.
3388 offload makes haproxy work as a compression offloader only (see notes).
3389
3390 The currently supported algorithms are :
Willy Tarreauc91840a2015-03-28 17:00:39 +01003391 identity this is mostly for debugging, and it was useful for developing
3392 the compression feature. Identity does not apply any change on
3393 data.
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01003394
Willy Tarreauc91840a2015-03-28 17:00:39 +01003395 gzip applies gzip compression. This setting is only available when
Baptiste Assmannf085d632015-12-21 17:57:32 +01003396 support for zlib or libslz was built in.
Willy Tarreauc91840a2015-03-28 17:00:39 +01003397
3398 deflate same as "gzip", but with deflate algorithm and zlib format.
3399 Note that this algorithm has ambiguous support on many
3400 browsers and no support at all from recent ones. It is
3401 strongly recommended not to use it for anything else than
3402 experimentation. This setting is only available when support
Baptiste Assmannf085d632015-12-21 17:57:32 +01003403 for zlib or libslz was built in.
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01003404
Willy Tarreauc91840a2015-03-28 17:00:39 +01003405 raw-deflate same as "deflate" without the zlib wrapper, and used as an
3406 alternative when the browser wants "deflate". All major
3407 browsers understand it and despite violating the standards,
3408 it is known to work better than "deflate", at least on MSIE
3409 and some versions of Safari. Do not use it in conjunction
3410 with "deflate", use either one or the other since both react
3411 to the same Accept-Encoding token. This setting is only
Baptiste Assmannf085d632015-12-21 17:57:32 +01003412 available when support for zlib or libslz was built in.
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01003413
Dmitry Sivachenko87c208b2012-11-22 20:03:26 +04003414 Compression will be activated depending on the Accept-Encoding request
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01003415 header. With identity, it does not take care of that header.
Dmitry Sivachenkoc9f3b452012-11-28 17:47:11 +04003416 If backend servers support HTTP compression, these directives
3417 will be no-op: haproxy will see the compressed response and will not
3418 compress again. If backend servers do not support HTTP compression and
3419 there is Accept-Encoding header in request, haproxy will compress the
3420 matching response.
Willy Tarreau70737d12012-10-27 00:34:28 +02003421
3422 The "offload" setting makes haproxy remove the Accept-Encoding header to
3423 prevent backend servers from compressing responses. It is strongly
3424 recommended not to do this because this means that all the compression work
3425 will be done on the single point where haproxy is located. However in some
3426 deployment scenarios, haproxy may be installed in front of a buggy gateway
Dmitry Sivachenkoc9f3b452012-11-28 17:47:11 +04003427 with broken HTTP compression implementation which can't be turned off.
3428 In that case haproxy can be used to prevent that gateway from emitting
3429 invalid payloads. In this case, simply removing the header in the
3430 configuration does not work because it applies before the header is parsed,
3431 so that prevents haproxy from compressing. The "offload" setting should
Willy Tarreauffea9fd2014-07-12 16:37:02 +02003432 then be used for such scenarios. Note: for now, the "offload" setting is
3433 ignored when set in a defaults section.
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02003434
William Lallemand05097442012-11-20 12:14:28 +01003435 Compression is disabled when:
Baptiste Assmann650d53d2013-01-05 15:44:44 +01003436 * the request does not advertise a supported compression algorithm in the
3437 "Accept-Encoding" header
3438 * the response message is not HTTP/1.1
Tim Duesterhusbb48c9a2019-01-30 23:46:04 +01003439 * HTTP status code is not one of 200, 201, 202, or 203
Baptiste Assmann650d53d2013-01-05 15:44:44 +01003440 * response contain neither a "Content-Length" header nor a
3441 "Transfer-Encoding" whose last value is "chunked"
3442 * response contains a "Content-Type" header whose first value starts with
3443 "multipart"
3444 * the response contains the "no-transform" value in the "Cache-control"
3445 header
3446 * User-Agent matches "Mozilla/4" unless it is MSIE 6 with XP SP2, or MSIE 7
3447 and later
3448 * The response contains a "Content-Encoding" header, indicating that the
3449 response is already compressed (see compression offload)
Tim Duesterhusbb48c9a2019-01-30 23:46:04 +01003450 * The response contains an invalid "ETag" header or multiple ETag headers
William Lallemand05097442012-11-20 12:14:28 +01003451
Tim Duesterhusb229f012019-01-29 16:38:56 +01003452 Note: The compression does not emit the Warning header.
William Lallemand05097442012-11-20 12:14:28 +01003453
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02003454 Examples :
3455 compression algo gzip
3456 compression type text/html text/plain
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003457
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02003458
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02003459cookie <name> [ rewrite | insert | prefix ] [ indirect ] [ nocache ]
Willy Tarreau4992dd22012-05-31 21:02:17 +02003460 [ postonly ] [ preserve ] [ httponly ] [ secure ]
3461 [ domain <domain> ]* [ maxidle <idle> ] [ maxlife <life> ]
Christopher Faulet2f533902020-01-21 11:06:48 +01003462 [ dynamic ] [ attr <value> ]*
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003463 Enable cookie-based persistence in a backend.
3464 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3465 yes | no | yes | yes
3466 Arguments :
3467 <name> is the name of the cookie which will be monitored, modified or
3468 inserted in order to bring persistence. This cookie is sent to
3469 the client via a "Set-Cookie" header in the response, and is
3470 brought back by the client in a "Cookie" header in all requests.
3471 Special care should be taken to choose a name which does not
3472 conflict with any likely application cookie. Also, if the same
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003473 backends are subject to be used by the same clients (e.g.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003474 HTTP/HTTPS), care should be taken to use different cookie names
3475 between all backends if persistence between them is not desired.
3476
3477 rewrite This keyword indicates that the cookie will be provided by the
3478 server and that haproxy will have to modify its value to set the
3479 server's identifier in it. This mode is handy when the management
3480 of complex combinations of "Set-cookie" and "Cache-control"
3481 headers is left to the application. The application can then
3482 decide whether or not it is appropriate to emit a persistence
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01003483 cookie. Since all responses should be monitored, this mode
3484 doesn't work in HTTP tunnel mode. Unless the application
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003485 behavior is very complex and/or broken, it is advised not to
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01003486 start with this mode for new deployments. This keyword is
3487 incompatible with "insert" and "prefix".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003488
3489 insert This keyword indicates that the persistence cookie will have to
Willy Tarreaua79094d2010-08-31 22:54:15 +02003490 be inserted by haproxy in server responses if the client did not
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02003491
Willy Tarreaua79094d2010-08-31 22:54:15 +02003492 already have a cookie that would have permitted it to access this
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02003493 server. When used without the "preserve" option, if the server
Michael Prokop4438c602019-05-24 10:25:45 +02003494 emits a cookie with the same name, it will be removed before
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003495 processing. For this reason, this mode can be used to upgrade
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02003496 existing configurations running in the "rewrite" mode. The cookie
3497 will only be a session cookie and will not be stored on the
3498 client's disk. By default, unless the "indirect" option is added,
3499 the server will see the cookies emitted by the client. Due to
3500 caching effects, it is generally wise to add the "nocache" or
3501 "postonly" keywords (see below). The "insert" keyword is not
3502 compatible with "rewrite" and "prefix".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003503
3504 prefix This keyword indicates that instead of relying on a dedicated
3505 cookie for the persistence, an existing one will be completed.
3506 This may be needed in some specific environments where the client
3507 does not support more than one single cookie and the application
3508 already needs it. In this case, whenever the server sets a cookie
3509 named <name>, it will be prefixed with the server's identifier
3510 and a delimiter. The prefix will be removed from all client
3511 requests so that the server still finds the cookie it emitted.
3512 Since all requests and responses are subject to being modified,
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01003513 this mode doesn't work with tunnel mode. The "prefix" keyword is
Willy Tarreau37229df2011-10-17 12:24:55 +02003514 not compatible with "rewrite" and "insert". Note: it is highly
3515 recommended not to use "indirect" with "prefix", otherwise server
3516 cookie updates would not be sent to clients.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003517
Willy Tarreaua79094d2010-08-31 22:54:15 +02003518 indirect When this option is specified, no cookie will be emitted to a
3519 client which already has a valid one for the server which has
3520 processed the request. If the server sets such a cookie itself,
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02003521 it will be removed, unless the "preserve" option is also set. In
3522 "insert" mode, this will additionally remove cookies from the
3523 requests transmitted to the server, making the persistence
3524 mechanism totally transparent from an application point of view.
Willy Tarreau37229df2011-10-17 12:24:55 +02003525 Note: it is highly recommended not to use "indirect" with
3526 "prefix", otherwise server cookie updates would not be sent to
3527 clients.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003528
3529 nocache This option is recommended in conjunction with the insert mode
3530 when there is a cache between the client and HAProxy, as it
3531 ensures that a cacheable response will be tagged non-cacheable if
3532 a cookie needs to be inserted. This is important because if all
3533 persistence cookies are added on a cacheable home page for
3534 instance, then all customers will then fetch the page from an
3535 outer cache and will all share the same persistence cookie,
3536 leading to one server receiving much more traffic than others.
3537 See also the "insert" and "postonly" options.
3538
3539 postonly This option ensures that cookie insertion will only be performed
3540 on responses to POST requests. It is an alternative to the
3541 "nocache" option, because POST responses are not cacheable, so
3542 this ensures that the persistence cookie will never get cached.
3543 Since most sites do not need any sort of persistence before the
3544 first POST which generally is a login request, this is a very
3545 efficient method to optimize caching without risking to find a
3546 persistence cookie in the cache.
3547 See also the "insert" and "nocache" options.
3548
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02003549 preserve This option may only be used with "insert" and/or "indirect". It
3550 allows the server to emit the persistence cookie itself. In this
3551 case, if a cookie is found in the response, haproxy will leave it
3552 untouched. This is useful in order to end persistence after a
3553 logout request for instance. For this, the server just has to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003554 emit a cookie with an invalid value (e.g. empty) or with a date in
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02003555 the past. By combining this mechanism with the "disable-on-404"
3556 check option, it is possible to perform a completely graceful
3557 shutdown because users will definitely leave the server after
3558 they logout.
3559
Willy Tarreau4992dd22012-05-31 21:02:17 +02003560 httponly This option tells haproxy to add an "HttpOnly" cookie attribute
3561 when a cookie is inserted. This attribute is used so that a
3562 user agent doesn't share the cookie with non-HTTP components.
3563 Please check RFC6265 for more information on this attribute.
3564
3565 secure This option tells haproxy to add a "Secure" cookie attribute when
3566 a cookie is inserted. This attribute is used so that a user agent
3567 never emits this cookie over non-secure channels, which means
3568 that a cookie learned with this flag will be presented only over
3569 SSL/TLS connections. Please check RFC6265 for more information on
3570 this attribute.
3571
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiefe3b6f2008-05-23 23:49:32 +02003572 domain This option allows to specify the domain at which a cookie is
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003573 inserted. It requires exactly one parameter: a valid domain
Willy Tarreau68a897b2009-12-03 23:28:34 +01003574 name. If the domain begins with a dot, the browser is allowed to
3575 use it for any host ending with that name. It is also possible to
3576 specify several domain names by invoking this option multiple
3577 times. Some browsers might have small limits on the number of
3578 domains, so be careful when doing that. For the record, sending
3579 10 domains to MSIE 6 or Firefox 2 works as expected.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiefe3b6f2008-05-23 23:49:32 +02003580
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02003581 maxidle This option allows inserted cookies to be ignored after some idle
3582 time. It only works with insert-mode cookies. When a cookie is
3583 sent to the client, the date this cookie was emitted is sent too.
3584 Upon further presentations of this cookie, if the date is older
3585 than the delay indicated by the parameter (in seconds), it will
3586 be ignored. Otherwise, it will be refreshed if needed when the
3587 response is sent to the client. This is particularly useful to
3588 prevent users who never close their browsers from remaining for
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003589 too long on the same server (e.g. after a farm size change). When
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02003590 this option is set and a cookie has no date, it is always
3591 accepted, but gets refreshed in the response. This maintains the
3592 ability for admins to access their sites. Cookies that have a
3593 date in the future further than 24 hours are ignored. Doing so
3594 lets admins fix timezone issues without risking kicking users off
3595 the site.
3596
3597 maxlife This option allows inserted cookies to be ignored after some life
3598 time, whether they're in use or not. It only works with insert
3599 mode cookies. When a cookie is first sent to the client, the date
3600 this cookie was emitted is sent too. Upon further presentations
3601 of this cookie, if the date is older than the delay indicated by
3602 the parameter (in seconds), it will be ignored. If the cookie in
3603 the request has no date, it is accepted and a date will be set.
3604 Cookies that have a date in the future further than 24 hours are
3605 ignored. Doing so lets admins fix timezone issues without risking
3606 kicking users off the site. Contrary to maxidle, this value is
3607 not refreshed, only the first visit date counts. Both maxidle and
3608 maxlife may be used at the time. This is particularly useful to
3609 prevent users who never close their browsers from remaining for
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003610 too long on the same server (e.g. after a farm size change). This
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02003611 is stronger than the maxidle method in that it forces a
3612 redispatch after some absolute delay.
3613
Olivier Houchard4e694042017-03-14 20:01:29 +01003614 dynamic Activate dynamic cookies. When used, a session cookie is
3615 dynamically created for each server, based on the IP and port
3616 of the server, and a secret key, specified in the
3617 "dynamic-cookie-key" backend directive.
3618 The cookie will be regenerated each time the IP address change,
3619 and is only generated for IPv4/IPv6.
3620
Christopher Faulet2f533902020-01-21 11:06:48 +01003621 attr This option tells haproxy to add an extra attribute when a
3622 cookie is inserted. The attribute value can contain any
3623 characters except control ones or ";". This option may be
3624 repeated.
3625
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003626 There can be only one persistence cookie per HTTP backend, and it can be
3627 declared in a defaults section. The value of the cookie will be the value
3628 indicated after the "cookie" keyword in a "server" statement. If no cookie
3629 is declared for a given server, the cookie is not set.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02003630
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003631 Examples :
3632 cookie JSESSIONID prefix
3633 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache
3634 cookie SRV insert postonly indirect
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02003635 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache maxidle 30m maxlife 8h
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003636
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +02003637 See also : "balance source", "capture cookie", "server" and "ignore-persist".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003638
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01003639
Thierry FOURNIERa0a1b752015-05-26 17:44:32 +02003640declare capture [ request | response ] len <length>
3641 Declares a capture slot.
3642 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3643 no | yes | yes | no
3644 Arguments:
3645 <length> is the length allowed for the capture.
3646
3647 This declaration is only available in the frontend or listen section, but the
3648 reserved slot can be used in the backends. The "request" keyword allocates a
3649 capture slot for use in the request, and "response" allocates a capture slot
3650 for use in the response.
3651
3652 See also: "capture-req", "capture-res" (sample converters),
Baptiste Assmann5ac425c2015-10-21 23:13:46 +02003653 "capture.req.hdr", "capture.res.hdr" (sample fetches),
Thierry FOURNIERa0a1b752015-05-26 17:44:32 +02003654 "http-request capture" and "http-response capture".
3655
3656
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01003657default-server [param*]
3658 Change default options for a server in a backend
3659 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3660 yes | no | yes | yes
3661 Arguments:
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01003662 <param*> is a list of parameters for this server. The "default-server"
3663 keyword accepts an important number of options and has a complete
3664 section dedicated to it. Please refer to section 5 for more
3665 details.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01003666
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01003667 Example :
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01003668 default-server inter 1000 weight 13
3669
3670 See also: "server" and section 5 about server options
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003671
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01003672
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003673default_backend <backend>
3674 Specify the backend to use when no "use_backend" rule has been matched.
3675 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3676 yes | yes | yes | no
3677 Arguments :
3678 <backend> is the name of the backend to use.
3679
3680 When doing content-switching between frontend and backends using the
3681 "use_backend" keyword, it is often useful to indicate which backend will be
3682 used when no rule has matched. It generally is the dynamic backend which
3683 will catch all undetermined requests.
3684
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003685 Example :
3686
3687 use_backend dynamic if url_dyn
3688 use_backend static if url_css url_img extension_img
3689 default_backend dynamic
3690
Willy Tarreau98d04852015-05-26 12:18:29 +02003691 See also : "use_backend"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003692
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003693
Baptiste Assmann27f51342013-10-09 06:51:49 +02003694description <string>
3695 Describe a listen, frontend or backend.
3696 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3697 no | yes | yes | yes
3698 Arguments : string
3699
3700 Allows to add a sentence to describe the related object in the HAProxy HTML
3701 stats page. The description will be printed on the right of the object name
3702 it describes.
3703 No need to backslash spaces in the <string> arguments.
3704
3705
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003706disabled
3707 Disable a proxy, frontend or backend.
3708 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3709 yes | yes | yes | yes
3710 Arguments : none
3711
3712 The "disabled" keyword is used to disable an instance, mainly in order to
3713 liberate a listening port or to temporarily disable a service. The instance
3714 will still be created and its configuration will be checked, but it will be
3715 created in the "stopped" state and will appear as such in the statistics. It
3716 will not receive any traffic nor will it send any health-checks or logs. It
3717 is possible to disable many instances at once by adding the "disabled"
3718 keyword in a "defaults" section.
3719
3720 See also : "enabled"
3721
3722
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02003723dispatch <address>:<port>
3724 Set a default server address
3725 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3726 no | no | yes | yes
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02003727 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02003728
3729 <address> is the IPv4 address of the default server. Alternatively, a
3730 resolvable hostname is supported, but this name will be resolved
3731 during start-up.
3732
3733 <ports> is a mandatory port specification. All connections will be sent
3734 to this port, and it is not permitted to use port offsets as is
3735 possible with normal servers.
3736
Willy Tarreau787aed52011-04-15 06:45:37 +02003737 The "dispatch" keyword designates a default server for use when no other
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02003738 server can take the connection. In the past it was used to forward non
3739 persistent connections to an auxiliary load balancer. Due to its simple
3740 syntax, it has also been used for simple TCP relays. It is recommended not to
3741 use it for more clarity, and to use the "server" directive instead.
3742
3743 See also : "server"
3744
Olivier Houchard4e694042017-03-14 20:01:29 +01003745
3746dynamic-cookie-key <string>
3747 Set the dynamic cookie secret key for a backend.
3748 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3749 yes | no | yes | yes
3750 Arguments : The secret key to be used.
3751
3752 When dynamic cookies are enabled (see the "dynamic" directive for cookie),
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003753 a dynamic cookie is created for each server (unless one is explicitly
Olivier Houchard4e694042017-03-14 20:01:29 +01003754 specified on the "server" line), using a hash of the IP address of the
3755 server, the TCP port, and the secret key.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003756 That way, we can ensure session persistence across multiple load-balancers,
Olivier Houchard4e694042017-03-14 20:01:29 +01003757 even if servers are dynamically added or removed.
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02003758
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003759enabled
3760 Enable a proxy, frontend or backend.
3761 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3762 yes | yes | yes | yes
3763 Arguments : none
3764
3765 The "enabled" keyword is used to explicitly enable an instance, when the
3766 defaults has been set to "disabled". This is very rarely used.
3767
3768 See also : "disabled"
3769
3770
3771errorfile <code> <file>
3772 Return a file contents instead of errors generated by HAProxy
3773 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3774 yes | yes | yes | yes
3775 Arguments :
3776 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
Florian Tham9205fea2020-01-08 13:35:30 +01003777 generating codes 200, 400, 403, 404, 405, 408, 410, 425, 429, 500,
3778 502, 503, and 504.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003779
3780 <file> designates a file containing the full HTTP response. It is
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01003781 recommended to follow the common practice of appending ".http" to
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003782 the filename so that people do not confuse the response with HTML
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01003783 error pages, and to use absolute paths, since files are read
3784 before any chroot is performed.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003785
3786 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
3787 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
3788 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
3789
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02003790 Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule.
3791
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003792 The files are returned verbatim on the TCP socket. This allows any trick such
3793 as redirections to another URL or site, as well as tricks to clean cookies,
3794 force enable or disable caching, etc... The package provides default error
3795 files returning the same contents as default errors.
3796
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01003797 The files should not exceed the configured buffer size (BUFSIZE), which
3798 generally is 8 or 16 kB, otherwise they will be truncated. It is also wise
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003799 not to put any reference to local contents (e.g. images) in order to avoid
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01003800 loops between the client and HAProxy when all servers are down, causing an
3801 error to be returned instead of an image. For better HTTP compliance, it is
3802 recommended that all header lines end with CR-LF and not LF alone.
3803
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003804 The files are read at the same time as the configuration and kept in memory.
3805 For this reason, the errors continue to be returned even when the process is
3806 chrooted, and no file change is considered while the process is running. A
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003807 simple method for developing those files consists in associating them to the
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003808 403 status code and interrogating a blocked URL.
3809
3810 See also : "errorloc", "errorloc302", "errorloc303"
3811
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01003812 Example :
3813 errorfile 400 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/400badreq.http
Willy Tarreau989222a2016-01-15 10:26:26 +01003814 errorfile 408 /dev/null # work around Chrome pre-connect bug
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01003815 errorfile 403 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/403forbid.http
3816 errorfile 503 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/503sorry.http
3817
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003818
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +01003819errorfiles <name> [<code> ...]
3820 Import, fully or partially, the error files defined in the <name> http-errors
3821 section.
3822 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3823 yes | yes | yes | yes
3824 Arguments :
3825 <name> is the name of an existing http-errors section.
3826
3827 <code> is a HTTP status code. Several status code may be listed.
3828 Currently, HAProxy is capable of generating codes 200, 400, 403,
3829 404, 405, 408, 410, 425, 429, 500, 502, 503, and 504.
3830
3831 Errors defined in the http-errors section with the name <name> are imported
3832 in the current proxy. If no status code is specified, all error files of the
3833 http-errors section are imported. Otherwise, only error files associated to
3834 the listed status code are imported. Those error files override the already
3835 defined custom errors for the proxy. And they may be overridden by following
3836 ones. Fonctionnly, it is exactly the same than declaring all error files by
3837 hand using "errorfile" directives.
3838
3839 See also : "errorfile", "errorloc", "errorloc302" , "errorloc303" and section
3840 3.8 about http-errors.
3841
3842 Example :
3843 errorfiles generic
3844 errorfiles site-1 403 404
3845
3846
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003847errorloc <code> <url>
3848errorloc302 <code> <url>
3849 Return an HTTP redirection to a URL instead of errors generated by HAProxy
3850 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3851 yes | yes | yes | yes
3852 Arguments :
3853 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
Florian Tham9205fea2020-01-08 13:35:30 +01003854 generating codes 200, 400, 403, 404, 405, 408, 410, 425, 429, 500,
3855 502, 503, and 504.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003856
3857 <url> it is the exact contents of the "Location" header. It may contain
3858 either a relative URI to an error page hosted on the same site,
3859 or an absolute URI designating an error page on another site.
3860 Special care should be given to relative URIs to avoid redirect
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003861 loops if the URI itself may generate the same error (e.g. 500).
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003862
3863 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
3864 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
3865 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
3866
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02003867 Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule.
3868
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003869 Note that both keyword return the HTTP 302 status code, which tells the
3870 client to fetch the designated URL using the same HTTP method. This can be
3871 quite problematic in case of non-GET methods such as POST, because the URL
3872 sent to the client might not be allowed for something other than GET. To
Willy Tarreau989222a2016-01-15 10:26:26 +01003873 work around this problem, please use "errorloc303" which send the HTTP 303
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003874 status code, indicating to the client that the URL must be fetched with a GET
3875 request.
3876
3877 See also : "errorfile", "errorloc303"
3878
3879
3880errorloc303 <code> <url>
3881 Return an HTTP redirection to a URL instead of errors generated by HAProxy
3882 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3883 yes | yes | yes | yes
3884 Arguments :
3885 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
Florian Tham9205fea2020-01-08 13:35:30 +01003886 generating codes 200, 400, 403, 404, 405, 408, 410, 425, 429, 500,
3887 502, 503, and 504.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003888
3889 <url> it is the exact contents of the "Location" header. It may contain
3890 either a relative URI to an error page hosted on the same site,
3891 or an absolute URI designating an error page on another site.
3892 Special care should be given to relative URIs to avoid redirect
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003893 loops if the URI itself may generate the same error (e.g. 500).
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003894
3895 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
3896 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
3897 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
3898
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02003899 Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule.
3900
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003901 Note that both keyword return the HTTP 303 status code, which tells the
3902 client to fetch the designated URL using the same HTTP GET method. This
3903 solves the usual problems associated with "errorloc" and the 302 code. It is
3904 possible that some very old browsers designed before HTTP/1.1 do not support
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01003905 it, but no such problem has been reported till now.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003906
3907 See also : "errorfile", "errorloc", "errorloc302"
3908
3909
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003910email-alert from <emailaddr>
3911 Declare the from email address to be used in both the envelope and header
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003912 of email alerts. This is the address that email alerts are sent from.
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003913 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3914 yes | yes | yes | yes
3915
3916 Arguments :
3917
3918 <emailaddr> is the from email address to use when sending email alerts
3919
3920 Also requires "email-alert mailers" and "email-alert to" to be set
3921 and if so sending email alerts is enabled for the proxy.
3922
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09003923 See also : "email-alert level", "email-alert mailers",
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +02003924 "email-alert myhostname", "email-alert to", section 3.6 about
3925 mailers.
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09003926
3927
3928email-alert level <level>
3929 Declare the maximum log level of messages for which email alerts will be
3930 sent. This acts as a filter on the sending of email alerts.
3931 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3932 yes | yes | yes | yes
3933
3934 Arguments :
3935
3936 <level> One of the 8 syslog levels:
3937 emerg alert crit err warning notice info debug
3938 The above syslog levels are ordered from lowest to highest.
3939
3940 By default level is alert
3941
3942 Also requires "email-alert from", "email-alert mailers" and
3943 "email-alert to" to be set and if so sending email alerts is enabled
3944 for the proxy.
3945
Simon Horman1421e212015-04-30 13:10:35 +09003946 Alerts are sent when :
3947
3948 * An un-paused server is marked as down and <level> is alert or lower
3949 * A paused server is marked as down and <level> is notice or lower
3950 * A server is marked as up or enters the drain state and <level>
3951 is notice or lower
3952 * "option log-health-checks" is enabled, <level> is info or lower,
3953 and a health check status update occurs
3954
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09003955 See also : "email-alert from", "email-alert mailers",
3956 "email-alert myhostname", "email-alert to",
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003957 section 3.6 about mailers.
3958
3959
3960email-alert mailers <mailersect>
3961 Declare the mailers to be used when sending email alerts
3962 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3963 yes | yes | yes | yes
3964
3965 Arguments :
3966
3967 <mailersect> is the name of the mailers section to send email alerts.
3968
3969 Also requires "email-alert from" and "email-alert to" to be set
3970 and if so sending email alerts is enabled for the proxy.
3971
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09003972 See also : "email-alert from", "email-alert level", "email-alert myhostname",
3973 "email-alert to", section 3.6 about mailers.
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003974
3975
3976email-alert myhostname <hostname>
3977 Declare the to hostname address to be used when communicating with
3978 mailers.
3979 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3980 yes | yes | yes | yes
3981
3982 Arguments :
3983
Baptiste Assmann738bad92015-12-21 15:27:53 +01003984 <hostname> is the hostname to use when communicating with mailers
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003985
3986 By default the systems hostname is used.
3987
3988 Also requires "email-alert from", "email-alert mailers" and
3989 "email-alert to" to be set and if so sending email alerts is enabled
3990 for the proxy.
3991
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09003992 See also : "email-alert from", "email-alert level", "email-alert mailers",
3993 "email-alert to", section 3.6 about mailers.
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003994
3995
3996email-alert to <emailaddr>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003997 Declare both the recipient address in the envelope and to address in the
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003998 header of email alerts. This is the address that email alerts are sent to.
3999 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4000 yes | yes | yes | yes
4001
4002 Arguments :
4003
4004 <emailaddr> is the to email address to use when sending email alerts
4005
4006 Also requires "email-alert mailers" and "email-alert to" to be set
4007 and if so sending email alerts is enabled for the proxy.
4008
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09004009 See also : "email-alert from", "email-alert level", "email-alert mailers",
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09004010 "email-alert myhostname", section 3.6 about mailers.
4011
4012
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01004013force-persist { if | unless } <condition>
4014 Declare a condition to force persistence on down servers
4015 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Cyril Bonté4288c5a2018-03-12 22:02:59 +01004016 no | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01004017
4018 By default, requests are not dispatched to down servers. It is possible to
4019 force this using "option persist", but it is unconditional and redispatches
4020 to a valid server if "option redispatch" is set. That leaves with very little
4021 possibilities to force some requests to reach a server which is artificially
4022 marked down for maintenance operations.
4023
4024 The "force-persist" statement allows one to declare various ACL-based
4025 conditions which, when met, will cause a request to ignore the down status of
4026 a server and still try to connect to it. That makes it possible to start a
4027 server, still replying an error to the health checks, and run a specially
4028 configured browser to test the service. Among the handy methods, one could
4029 use a specific source IP address, or a specific cookie. The cookie also has
4030 the advantage that it can easily be added/removed on the browser from a test
4031 page. Once the service is validated, it is then possible to open the service
4032 to the world by returning a valid response to health checks.
4033
4034 The forced persistence is enabled when an "if" condition is met, or unless an
4035 "unless" condition is met. The final redispatch is always disabled when this
4036 is used.
4037
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02004038 See also : "option redispatch", "ignore-persist", "persist",
Cyril Bontéa8e7bbc2010-04-25 22:29:29 +02004039 and section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01004040
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02004041
4042filter <name> [param*]
4043 Add the filter <name> in the filter list attached to the proxy.
4044 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4045 no | yes | yes | yes
4046 Arguments :
4047 <name> is the name of the filter. Officially supported filters are
4048 referenced in section 9.
4049
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +01004050 <param*> is a list of parameters accepted by the filter <name>. The
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02004051 parsing of these parameters are the responsibility of the
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +01004052 filter. Please refer to the documentation of the corresponding
4053 filter (section 9) for all details on the supported parameters.
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02004054
4055 Multiple occurrences of the filter line can be used for the same proxy. The
4056 same filter can be referenced many times if needed.
4057
4058 Example:
4059 listen
4060 bind *:80
4061
4062 filter trace name BEFORE-HTTP-COMP
4063 filter compression
4064 filter trace name AFTER-HTTP-COMP
4065
4066 compression algo gzip
4067 compression offload
4068
4069 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
4070
4071 See also : section 9.
4072
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01004073
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004074fullconn <conns>
4075 Specify at what backend load the servers will reach their maxconn
4076 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4077 yes | no | yes | yes
4078 Arguments :
4079 <conns> is the number of connections on the backend which will make the
4080 servers use the maximal number of connections.
4081
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01004082 When a server has a "maxconn" parameter specified, it means that its number
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004083 of concurrent connections will never go higher. Additionally, if it has a
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01004084 "minconn" parameter, it indicates a dynamic limit following the backend's
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004085 load. The server will then always accept at least <minconn> connections,
4086 never more than <maxconn>, and the limit will be on the ramp between both
4087 values when the backend has less than <conns> concurrent connections. This
4088 makes it possible to limit the load on the servers during normal loads, but
4089 push it further for important loads without overloading the servers during
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01004090 exceptional loads.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004091
Willy Tarreaufbb78422011-06-05 15:38:35 +02004092 Since it's hard to get this value right, haproxy automatically sets it to
4093 10% of the sum of the maxconns of all frontends that may branch to this
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +01004094 backend (based on "use_backend" and "default_backend" rules). That way it's
4095 safe to leave it unset. However, "use_backend" involving dynamic names are
4096 not counted since there is no way to know if they could match or not.
Willy Tarreaufbb78422011-06-05 15:38:35 +02004097
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004098 Example :
4099 # The servers will accept between 100 and 1000 concurrent connections each
4100 # and the maximum of 1000 will be reached when the backend reaches 10000
4101 # connections.
4102 backend dynamic
4103 fullconn 10000
4104 server srv1 dyn1:80 minconn 100 maxconn 1000
4105 server srv2 dyn2:80 minconn 100 maxconn 1000
4106
4107 See also : "maxconn", "server"
4108
4109
4110grace <time>
4111 Maintain a proxy operational for some time after a soft stop
4112 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Cyril Bonté99ed3272010-01-24 23:29:44 +01004113 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004114 Arguments :
4115 <time> is the time (by default in milliseconds) for which the instance
4116 will remain operational with the frontend sockets still listening
4117 when a soft-stop is received via the SIGUSR1 signal.
4118
4119 This may be used to ensure that the services disappear in a certain order.
4120 This was designed so that frontends which are dedicated to monitoring by an
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01004121 external equipment fail immediately while other ones remain up for the time
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004122 needed by the equipment to detect the failure.
4123
4124 Note that currently, there is very little benefit in using this parameter,
4125 and it may in fact complicate the soft-reconfiguration process more than
4126 simplify it.
4127
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004128
Andrew Rodland17be45e2016-10-25 17:04:12 -04004129hash-balance-factor <factor>
4130 Specify the balancing factor for bounded-load consistent hashing
4131 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4132 yes | no | no | yes
4133 Arguments :
4134 <factor> is the control for the maximum number of concurrent requests to
4135 send to a server, expressed as a percentage of the average number
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +01004136 of concurrent requests across all of the active servers.
Andrew Rodland17be45e2016-10-25 17:04:12 -04004137
4138 Specifying a "hash-balance-factor" for a server with "hash-type consistent"
4139 enables an algorithm that prevents any one server from getting too many
4140 requests at once, even if some hash buckets receive many more requests than
4141 others. Setting <factor> to 0 (the default) disables the feature. Otherwise,
4142 <factor> is a percentage greater than 100. For example, if <factor> is 150,
4143 then no server will be allowed to have a load more than 1.5 times the average.
4144 If server weights are used, they will be respected.
4145
4146 If the first-choice server is disqualified, the algorithm will choose another
4147 server based on the request hash, until a server with additional capacity is
4148 found. A higher <factor> allows more imbalance between the servers, while a
4149 lower <factor> means that more servers will be checked on average, affecting
4150 performance. Reasonable values are from 125 to 200.
4151
Willy Tarreau760e81d2018-05-03 07:20:40 +02004152 This setting is also used by "balance random" which internally relies on the
4153 consistent hashing mechanism.
4154
Andrew Rodland17be45e2016-10-25 17:04:12 -04004155 See also : "balance" and "hash-type".
4156
4157
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05004158hash-type <method> <function> <modifier>
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02004159 Specify a method to use for mapping hashes to servers
4160 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4161 yes | no | yes | yes
4162 Arguments :
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04004163 <method> is the method used to select a server from the hash computed by
4164 the <function> :
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02004165
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04004166 map-based the hash table is a static array containing all alive servers.
4167 The hashes will be very smooth, will consider weights, but
4168 will be static in that weight changes while a server is up
4169 will be ignored. This means that there will be no slow start.
4170 Also, since a server is selected by its position in the array,
4171 most mappings are changed when the server count changes. This
4172 means that when a server goes up or down, or when a server is
4173 added to a farm, most connections will be redistributed to
4174 different servers. This can be inconvenient with caches for
4175 instance.
Willy Tarreau798a39c2010-11-24 15:04:29 +01004176
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04004177 consistent the hash table is a tree filled with many occurrences of each
4178 server. The hash key is looked up in the tree and the closest
4179 server is chosen. This hash is dynamic, it supports changing
4180 weights while the servers are up, so it is compatible with the
4181 slow start feature. It has the advantage that when a server
4182 goes up or down, only its associations are moved. When a
4183 server is added to the farm, only a few part of the mappings
4184 are redistributed, making it an ideal method for caches.
4185 However, due to its principle, the distribution will never be
4186 very smooth and it may sometimes be necessary to adjust a
4187 server's weight or its ID to get a more balanced distribution.
4188 In order to get the same distribution on multiple load
4189 balancers, it is important that all servers have the exact
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05004190 same IDs. Note: consistent hash uses sdbm and avalanche if no
4191 hash function is specified.
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04004192
4193 <function> is the hash function to be used :
4194
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03004195 sdbm this function was created initially for sdbm (a public-domain
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04004196 reimplementation of ndbm) database library. It was found to do
4197 well in scrambling bits, causing better distribution of the keys
4198 and fewer splits. It also happens to be a good general hashing
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05004199 function with good distribution, unless the total server weight
4200 is a multiple of 64, in which case applying the avalanche
4201 modifier may help.
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04004202
4203 djb2 this function was first proposed by Dan Bernstein many years ago
4204 on comp.lang.c. Studies have shown that for certain workload this
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05004205 function provides a better distribution than sdbm. It generally
4206 works well with text-based inputs though it can perform extremely
4207 poorly with numeric-only input or when the total server weight is
4208 a multiple of 33, unless the avalanche modifier is also used.
4209
Willy Tarreaua0f42712013-11-14 14:30:35 +01004210 wt6 this function was designed for haproxy while testing other
4211 functions in the past. It is not as smooth as the other ones, but
4212 is much less sensible to the input data set or to the number of
4213 servers. It can make sense as an alternative to sdbm+avalanche or
4214 djb2+avalanche for consistent hashing or when hashing on numeric
4215 data such as a source IP address or a visitor identifier in a URL
4216 parameter.
4217
Willy Tarreau324f07f2015-01-20 19:44:50 +01004218 crc32 this is the most common CRC32 implementation as used in Ethernet,
4219 gzip, PNG, etc. It is slower than the other ones but may provide
4220 a better distribution or less predictable results especially when
4221 used on strings.
4222
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05004223 <modifier> indicates an optional method applied after hashing the key :
4224
4225 avalanche This directive indicates that the result from the hash
4226 function above should not be used in its raw form but that
4227 a 4-byte full avalanche hash must be applied first. The
4228 purpose of this step is to mix the resulting bits from the
4229 previous hash in order to avoid any undesired effect when
4230 the input contains some limited values or when the number of
4231 servers is a multiple of one of the hash's components (64
4232 for SDBM, 33 for DJB2). Enabling avalanche tends to make the
4233 result less predictable, but it's also not as smooth as when
4234 using the original function. Some testing might be needed
4235 with some workloads. This hash is one of the many proposed
4236 by Bob Jenkins.
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02004237
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04004238 The default hash type is "map-based" and is recommended for most usages. The
4239 default function is "sdbm", the selection of a function should be based on
4240 the range of the values being hashed.
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02004241
Andrew Rodland17be45e2016-10-25 17:04:12 -04004242 See also : "balance", "hash-balance-factor", "server"
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02004243
4244
Christopher Faulet6d0c3df2020-01-22 09:26:35 +01004245http-after-response <action> <options...> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4246 Access control for all Layer 7 responses (server, applet/service and internal
4247 ones).
4248
4249 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4250 no | yes | yes | yes
4251
4252 The http-after-response statement defines a set of rules which apply to layer
4253 7 processing. The rules are evaluated in their declaration order when they
4254 are met in a frontend, listen or backend section. Any rule may optionally be
4255 followed by an ACL-based condition, in which case it will only be evaluated
4256 if the condition is true. Since these rules apply on responses, the backend
4257 rules are applied first, followed by the frontend's rules.
4258
4259 Unlike http-response rules, these ones are applied on all responses, the
4260 server ones but also to all responses generated by HAProxy. These rules are
4261 evaluated at the end of the responses analysis, before the data forwarding.
4262
4263 The first keyword is the rule's action. The supported actions are described
4264 below.
4265
4266 There is no limit to the number of http-after-response statements per
4267 instance.
4268
4269 Example:
4270 http-after-response set-header Strict-Transport-Security "max-age=31536000"
4271 http-after-response set-header Cache-Control "no-store,no-cache,private"
4272 http-after-response set-header Pragma "no-cache"
4273
4274http-after-response add-header <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4275
4276 This appends an HTTP header field whose name is specified in <name> and whose
4277 value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format rules (see Custom Log
4278 Format in section 8.2.4). This may be used to send a cookie to a client for
4279 example, or to pass some internal information.
4280 This rule is not final, so it is possible to add other similar rules.
4281 Note that header addition is performed immediately, so one rule might reuse
4282 the resulting header from a previous rule.
4283
4284http-after-response allow [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4285
4286 This stops the evaluation of the rules and lets the response pass the check.
4287 No further "http-after-response" rules are evaluated.
4288
4289http-after-response del-header <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4290
4291 This removes all HTTP header fields whose name is specified in <name>.
4292
4293http-after-response replace-header <name> <regex-match> <replace-fmt>
4294 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4295
4296 This works like "http-response replace-header".
4297
4298 Example:
4299 http-after-response replace-header Set-Cookie (C=[^;]*);(.*) \1;ip=%bi;\2
4300
4301 # applied to:
4302 Set-Cookie: C=1; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT
4303
4304 # outputs:
4305 Set-Cookie: C=1;ip=192.168.1.20; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT
4306
4307 # assuming the backend IP is 192.168.1.20.
4308
4309http-after-response replace-value <name> <regex-match> <replace-fmt>
4310 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4311
4312 This works like "http-response replace-value".
4313
4314 Example:
4315 http-after-response replace-value Cache-control ^public$ private
4316
4317 # applied to:
4318 Cache-Control: max-age=3600, public
4319
4320 # outputs:
4321 Cache-Control: max-age=3600, private
4322
4323http-after-response set-header <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4324
4325 This does the same as "add-header" except that the header name is first
4326 removed if it existed. This is useful when passing security information to
4327 the server, where the header must not be manipulated by external users.
4328
4329http-after-response set-status <status> [reason <str>]
4330 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4331
4332 This replaces the response status code with <status> which must be an integer
4333 between 100 and 999. Optionally, a custom reason text can be provided defined
4334 by <str>, or the default reason for the specified code will be used as a
4335 fallback.
4336
4337 Example:
4338 # return "431 Request Header Fields Too Large"
4339 http-response set-status 431
4340 # return "503 Slow Down", custom reason
4341 http-response set-status 503 reason "Slow Down"
4342
4343http-after-response set-var(<var-name>) <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4344
4345 This is used to set the contents of a variable. The variable is declared
4346 inline.
4347
4348 Arguments:
4349 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
4350 scope. The scopes allowed are:
4351 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
4352 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
4353 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction
4354 (request and response)
4355 "req" : the variable is shared only during request
4356 processing
4357 "res" : the variable is shared only during response
4358 processing
4359 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
4360 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.'
4361 and '_'.
4362
4363 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
4364 followed by some converters.
4365
4366 Example:
4367 http-after-response set-var(sess.last_redir) res.hdr(location)
4368
4369http-after-response strict-mode { on | off }
4370
4371 This enables or disables the strict rewriting mode for following rules. It
4372 does not affect rules declared before it and it is only applicable on rules
4373 performing a rewrite on the responses. When the strict mode is enabled, any
4374 rewrite failure triggers an internal error. Otherwise, such errors are
4375 silently ignored. The purpose of the strict rewriting mode is to make some
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +05004376 rewrites optional while others must be performed to continue the response
Christopher Faulet6d0c3df2020-01-22 09:26:35 +01004377 processing.
4378
4379 By default, the strict rewriting mode is enabled. Its value is also reset
4380 when a ruleset evaluation ends. So, for instance, if you change the mode on
4381 the bacnkend, the default mode is restored when HAProxy starts the frontend
4382 rules evaluation.
4383
4384http-after-response unset-var(<var-name>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4385
4386 This is used to unset a variable. See "http-after-response set-var" for
4387 details about <var-name>.
4388
4389 Example:
4390 http-after-response unset-var(sess.last_redir)
4391
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02004392http-check connect [params*]
4393 Opens a new connection to perform an HTTP health check
4394 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4395 yes | no | yes | yes
4396
4397 Just like tcp-check health checks, it is possible to configure the connection
4398 to use to perform HTTP health check. This directive should also be used to
4399 describe a scenario involving several request/response exchanges, possibly on
4400 different ports or with different servers.
4401
4402 When there are no TCP port configured on the server line neither server port
4403 directive, then the first step of the http-check sequence must be to specify
4404 the port with a "http-check connect".
4405
4406 In an http-check ruleset a 'connect' is required, it is also mandatory to start
4407 the ruleset with a 'connect' rule. Purpose is to ensure admin know what they
4408 do.
4409
4410 When a connect must start the ruleset, if may still be preceded by set-var,
4411 unset-var or comment rules.
4412
4413 Parameters :
4414 They are optional and can be used to describe how HAProxy should open and
4415 use the HTTP connection.
4416
4417 default Use default options of the server line to do the health
4418 checks. The server options are used only if not redifined.
4419
4420 port <expr> if not set, check port or server port is used.
4421 It tells HAProxy where to open the connection to.
4422 <port> must be a valid TCP port source integer, from 1 to
4423 65535 or an sample-fetch expression.
4424
4425 addr <ip> defines the IP address to do the health check.
4426
4427 send-proxy send a PROXY protocol string
4428
4429 via-socks4 enables outgoing health checks using upstream socks4 proxy.
4430
4431 ssl opens a ciphered connection
4432
4433 sni <sni> specifies the SNI to use to do health checks over SSL.
4434
4435 alpn <alpn> defines which protocols to advertise with ALPN. The protocol
4436 list consists in a comma-delimited list of protocol names,
4437 for instance: "h2,http/1.1". If it is not set, the server ALPN
4438 is used.
4439
4440 linger cleanly close the connection instead of using a single RST.
4441
4442 Examples:
4443 # check HTTP and HTTPs services on a server.
4444 # first open port 80 thanks to server line port directive, then
4445 # tcp-check opens port 443, ciphered and run a request on it:
4446 option httpchk
4447
4448 http-check connect
4449 http-check send GET / HTTP/1.1 hdr host haproxy.1wt.eu
4450 http-check expect rstatus "^[23][0-9]{2}"
4451 http-check connect port 443 ssl sni haproxy.1wt.eu
4452 http-check send GET / HTTP/1.1 hdr host haproxy.1wt.eu
4453 http-check expect rstatus "^[23][0-9]{2}"
4454
4455 server www 10.0.0.1 check port 80
4456
4457 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check send", "http-check expect"
Christopher Faulet6d0c3df2020-01-22 09:26:35 +01004458
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004459http-check disable-on-404
4460 Enable a maintenance mode upon HTTP/404 response to health-checks
4461 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004462 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004463 Arguments : none
4464
4465 When this option is set, a server which returns an HTTP code 404 will be
4466 excluded from further load-balancing, but will still receive persistent
4467 connections. This provides a very convenient method for Web administrators
4468 to perform a graceful shutdown of their servers. It is also important to note
4469 that a server which is detected as failed while it was in this mode will not
4470 generate an alert, just a notice. If the server responds 2xx or 3xx again, it
4471 will immediately be reinserted into the farm. The status on the stats page
4472 reports "NOLB" for a server in this mode. It is important to note that this
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004473 option only works in conjunction with the "httpchk" option. If this option
4474 is used with "http-check expect", then it has precedence over it so that 404
4475 responses will still be considered as soft-stop.
4476
4477 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check expect"
4478
4479
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02004480http-check expect [min-recv <int>]
4481 [ok-status <st>] [error-status <st>] [tout-status <st>]
4482 [on-success <fmt>] [on-error <fmt>] [status-code <expr>]
4483 [!] <match> <pattern>
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04004484 Make HTTP health checks consider response contents or specific status codes
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004485 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau1ee51a62011-08-19 20:04:17 +02004486 yes | no | yes | yes
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02004487
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004488 Arguments :
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02004489 min-recv is optional and can define the minimum amount of data required to
4490 evaluate the current expect rule. If the number of received bytes
4491 is under this limit, the check will wait for more data. This
4492 option can be used to resolve some ambiguous matching rules or to
4493 avoid executing costly regex matches on content known to be still
4494 incomplete. If an exact string is used, the minimum between the
4495 string length and this parameter is used. This parameter is
4496 ignored if it is set to -1. If the expect rule does not match,
4497 the check will wait for more data. If set to 0, the evaluation
4498 result is always conclusive.
4499
4500 ok-status <st> is optional and can be used to set the check status if
4501 the expect rule is successfully evaluated and if it is
4502 the last rule in the tcp-check ruleset. "L7OK", "L7OKC",
4503 "L6OK" and "L4OK" are supported and may be used to set,
4504 respectively, HCHK_STATUS_L7OK, HCHK_STATUS_L7OKCD,
4505 HCHK_STATUS_L6OK or HCHK_STATUS_L4OK success status.
4506 By default "L7OK" is used.
4507
4508 error-status <st> is optional and can be used to set the check status if
4509 an error occurred during the expect rule evaluation.
4510 "L7RSP", "L7STS", "L6RSP" and "L4CON" are supported and
4511 may be used to set, respectively, HCHK_STATUS_L7RSP,
4512 HCHK_STATUS_L7STS, HCHK_STATUS_L6RSP or HCHK_STATUS_L4CON
4513 error status. By default "L7RSP" is used.
4514
4515 tout-status <st> is optional and can be used to set the check status if
4516 a timeout occurred during the expect rule evaluation.
4517 "L7TOUT", "L6TOUT", and "L4TOUT" are supported and may
4518 be used to set, respectively, HCHK_STATUS_L7TOUT,
4519 HCHK_STATUS_L6TOUT or HCHK_STATUS_L4TOUT timeout status.
4520 By default "L7TOUT" is used.
4521
4522 on-success <fmt> is optional and can be used to customize the
4523 informational message reported in logs if the expect
4524 rule is successfully evaluated and if it is the last rule
4525 in the tcp-check ruleset. <fmt> is a log-format string.
4526
4527 on-error <fmt> is optional and can be used to customize the
4528 informational message reported in logs if an error
4529 occurred during the expect rule evaluation. <fmt> is a
4530 log-format string.
4531
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004532 <match> is a keyword indicating how to look for a specific pattern in the
4533 response. The keyword may be one of "status", "rstatus",
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04004534 "string", or "rstring". The keyword may be preceded by an
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004535 exclamation mark ("!") to negate the match. Spaces are allowed
4536 between the exclamation mark and the keyword. See below for more
4537 details on the supported keywords.
4538
4539 <pattern> is the pattern to look for. It may be a string or a regular
4540 expression. If the pattern contains spaces, they must be escaped
4541 with the usual backslash ('\').
4542
4543 By default, "option httpchk" considers that response statuses 2xx and 3xx
4544 are valid, and that others are invalid. When "http-check expect" is used,
4545 it defines what is considered valid or invalid. Only one "http-check"
4546 statement is supported in a backend. If a server fails to respond or times
4547 out, the check obviously fails. The available matches are :
4548
4549 status <string> : test the exact string match for the HTTP status code.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04004550 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004551 response's status code is exactly this string. If the
4552 "status" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
4553 will be considered invalid if the status code matches.
4554
4555 rstatus <regex> : test a regular expression for the HTTP status code.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04004556 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004557 response's status code matches the expression. If the
4558 "rstatus" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
4559 will be considered invalid if the status code matches.
4560 This is mostly used to check for multiple codes.
4561
4562 string <string> : test the exact string match in the HTTP response body.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04004563 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004564 response's body contains this exact string. If the
4565 "string" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
4566 will be considered invalid if the body contains this
4567 string. This can be used to look for a mandatory word at
4568 the end of a dynamic page, or to detect a failure when a
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004569 specific error appears on the check page (e.g. a stack
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004570 trace).
4571
4572 rstring <regex> : test a regular expression on the HTTP response body.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04004573 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004574 response's body matches this expression. If the "rstring"
4575 keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response will be
4576 considered invalid if the body matches the expression.
4577 This can be used to look for a mandatory word at the end
4578 of a dynamic page, or to detect a failure when a specific
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004579 error appears on the check page (e.g. a stack trace).
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004580
4581 It is important to note that the responses will be limited to a certain size
4582 defined by the global "tune.chksize" option, which defaults to 16384 bytes.
4583 Thus, too large responses may not contain the mandatory pattern when using
4584 "string" or "rstring". If a large response is absolutely required, it is
4585 possible to change the default max size by setting the global variable.
4586 However, it is worth keeping in mind that parsing very large responses can
4587 waste some CPU cycles, especially when regular expressions are used, and that
4588 it is always better to focus the checks on smaller resources.
4589
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02004590 In an http-check ruleset, the last expect rule may be implicit. If no expect
4591 rule is specified after the last "http-check send", an implicit expect rule
4592 is defined to match on 2xx or 3xx status codes. It means this rule is also
4593 defined if there is no "http-check" rule at all, when only "option httpchk"
4594 is set.
Cyril Bonté32602d22015-01-30 00:07:07 +01004595
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004596 Last, if "http-check expect" is combined with "http-check disable-on-404",
4597 then this last one has precedence when the server responds with 404.
4598
4599 Examples :
4600 # only accept status 200 as valid
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01004601 http-check expect status 200
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004602
4603 # consider SQL errors as errors
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01004604 http-check expect ! string SQL\ Error
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004605
4606 # consider status 5xx only as errors
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01004607 http-check expect ! rstatus ^5
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004608
4609 # check that we have a correct hexadecimal tag before /html
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +03004610 http-check expect rstring <!--tag:[0-9a-f]*--></html>
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004611
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02004612 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check connect", "http-check disable-on-404"
4613 and "http-check send"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004614
4615
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02004616http-check send [meth <method>] [uri <uri>] [vsn <version>]
4617 [hdr <name> <fmt>]* [body <string>]
Christopher Faulet8acb1282020-04-09 08:44:06 +02004618 Add a possible list of headers and/or a body to the request sent during HTTP
4619 health checks.
4620 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4621 yes | no | yes | yes
4622 Arguments :
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02004623 meth <method> is the optional HTTP method used with the requests. When not
4624 set, the "OPTIONS" method is used, as it generally requires
4625 low server processing and is easy to filter out from the
4626 logs. Any method may be used, though it is not recommended
4627 to invent non-standard ones.
4628
4629 uri <uri> is optional and set the URI referenced in the HTTP requests.
4630 it defaults to " / " which is accessible by default on almost
4631 any server, but may be changed to any other URI. Query
4632 strings are permitted.
Christopher Faulet8acb1282020-04-09 08:44:06 +02004633
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02004634 vsn <version> is the optional HTTP version string. It defaults to
4635 "HTTP/1.0" but some servers might behave incorrectly in HTTP
4636 1.0, so turningit to HTTP/1.1 may sometimes help. Note that
4637 the Host field is mandatory in HTTP/1.1, use "hdr" argument
4638 to add it.
4639
4640 hdr <name> <fmt> adds the HTTP header field whose name is specified in
4641 <name> and whose value is defined by <fmt>, which follows
4642 to the log-format rules.
4643
4644 body <string> add the body defined by <string> to the request sent during
4645 HTTP health checks. If defined, the "Content-Length" header
4646 is thus automatically added to the request.
Christopher Faulet8acb1282020-04-09 08:44:06 +02004647
4648 In addition to the request line defined by the "option httpchk" directive,
4649 this one is the valid way to add some headers and optionally a body to the
4650 request sent during HTTP health checks. If a body is defined, the associate
4651 "Content-Length" header is automatically added. The old trick consisting to
4652 add headers after the version string on the "option httpchk" line is now
4653 deprecated. Note also the "Connection: close" header is still added if a
4654 "http-check expect" direcive is defined independently of this directive, just
4655 like the state header if the directive "http-check send-state" is defined.
4656
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02004657 Also "http-check send" doesn't support HTTP keep-alive. Keep in mind that it
4658 will automatically append a "Connection: close" header, meaning that this
4659 header should not be present in the request provided by "http-check send".
4660
Christopher Faulet8acb1282020-04-09 08:44:06 +02004661 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check send-state" and "http-check expect"
4662
4663
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01004664http-check send-state
4665 Enable emission of a state header with HTTP health checks
4666 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4667 yes | no | yes | yes
4668 Arguments : none
4669
4670 When this option is set, haproxy will systematically send a special header
4671 "X-Haproxy-Server-State" with a list of parameters indicating to each server
4672 how they are seen by haproxy. This can be used for instance when a server is
4673 manipulated without access to haproxy and the operator needs to know whether
4674 haproxy still sees it up or not, or if the server is the last one in a farm.
4675
4676 The header is composed of fields delimited by semi-colons, the first of which
4677 is a word ("UP", "DOWN", "NOLB"), possibly followed by a number of valid
4678 checks on the total number before transition, just as appears in the stats
4679 interface. Next headers are in the form "<variable>=<value>", indicating in
4680 no specific order some values available in the stats interface :
Joseph Lynch514061c2015-01-15 17:52:59 -08004681 - a variable "address", containing the address of the backend server.
4682 This corresponds to the <address> field in the server declaration. For
4683 unix domain sockets, it will read "unix".
4684
4685 - a variable "port", containing the port of the backend server. This
4686 corresponds to the <port> field in the server declaration. For unix
4687 domain sockets, it will read "unix".
4688
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01004689 - a variable "name", containing the name of the backend followed by a slash
4690 ("/") then the name of the server. This can be used when a server is
4691 checked in multiple backends.
4692
4693 - a variable "node" containing the name of the haproxy node, as set in the
4694 global "node" variable, otherwise the system's hostname if unspecified.
4695
4696 - a variable "weight" indicating the weight of the server, a slash ("/")
4697 and the total weight of the farm (just counting usable servers). This
4698 helps to know if other servers are available to handle the load when this
4699 one fails.
4700
4701 - a variable "scur" indicating the current number of concurrent connections
4702 on the server, followed by a slash ("/") then the total number of
4703 connections on all servers of the same backend.
4704
4705 - a variable "qcur" indicating the current number of requests in the
4706 server's queue.
4707
4708 Example of a header received by the application server :
4709 >>> X-Haproxy-Server-State: UP 2/3; name=bck/srv2; node=lb1; weight=1/2; \
4710 scur=13/22; qcur=0
4711
4712 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check disable-on-404"
4713
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02004714
4715http-check set-var(<var-name>) <expr>
4716
4717 This operation sets the content of a variable. The variable is declared inline.
4718
4719 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4720 yes | no | yes | yes
4721
4722 Arguments:
4723 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
4724 scope. The scopes allowed for http-check are:
4725 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process.
4726 "sess" : the variable is shared with the tcp-check session.
4727 "check": the variable is declared for the lifetime of the tcp-check.
4728 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
4729 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.',
4730 and '-'.
4731
4732 <expr> Is a sample-fetch expression potentially followed by converters.
4733
4734 Example:
4735 http-check set-var(check.port) int(1234)
4736
4737
4738http-check unset-var(<var-name>)
4739
4740 Free a reference to a variable within its scope.
4741
4742 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4743 yes | no | yes | yes
4744
4745 Arguments:
4746 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
4747 scope. The scopes allowed for http-check are:
4748 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process.
4749 "sess" : the variable is shared with the tcp-check session.
4750 "check": the variable is declared for the lifetime of the tcp-check.
4751 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
4752 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.',
4753 and '-'.
4754
4755 Example:
4756 http-check unset-var(check.port)
4757
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004758
4759http-request <action> [options...] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01004760 Access control for Layer 7 requests
4761
4762 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4763 no | yes | yes | yes
4764
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01004765 The http-request statement defines a set of rules which apply to layer 7
4766 processing. The rules are evaluated in their declaration order when they are
4767 met in a frontend, listen or backend section. Any rule may optionally be
4768 followed by an ACL-based condition, in which case it will only be evaluated
4769 if the condition is true.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01004770
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004771 The first keyword is the rule's action. The supported actions are described
4772 below.
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01004773
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004774 There is no limit to the number of http-request statements per instance.
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01004775
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004776 Example:
4777 acl nagios src 192.168.129.3
4778 acl local_net src 192.168.0.0/16
4779 acl auth_ok http_auth(L1)
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01004780
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004781 http-request allow if nagios
4782 http-request allow if local_net auth_ok
4783 http-request auth realm Gimme if local_net auth_ok
4784 http-request deny
Willy Tarreau81499eb2012-12-27 12:19:02 +01004785
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004786 Example:
4787 acl key req.hdr(X-Add-Acl-Key) -m found
4788 acl add path /addacl
4789 acl del path /delacl
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01004790
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004791 acl myhost hdr(Host) -f myhost.lst
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01004792
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004793 http-request add-acl(myhost.lst) %[req.hdr(X-Add-Acl-Key)] if key add
4794 http-request del-acl(myhost.lst) %[req.hdr(X-Add-Acl-Key)] if key del
Thierry FOURNIERdad3d1d2014-04-22 18:07:25 +02004795
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004796 Example:
4797 acl value req.hdr(X-Value) -m found
4798 acl setmap path /setmap
4799 acl delmap path /delmap
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004800
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004801 use_backend bk_appli if { hdr(Host),map_str(map.lst) -m found }
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004802
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004803 http-request set-map(map.lst) %[src] %[req.hdr(X-Value)] if setmap value
4804 http-request del-map(map.lst) %[src] if delmap
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004805
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004806 See also : "stats http-request", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7
4807 about ACL usage.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004808
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004809http-request add-acl(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004810
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004811 This is used to add a new entry into an ACL. The ACL must be loaded from a
4812 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be updated is
4813 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
4814 log-format rules, to collect content of the new entry. It performs a lookup
4815 in the ACL before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or more) values. This
4816 lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive with large lists!
4817 It is the equivalent of the "add acl" command from the stats socket, but can
4818 be triggered by an HTTP request.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004819
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004820http-request add-header <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004821
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004822 This appends an HTTP header field whose name is specified in <name> and
4823 whose value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format rules (see
4824 Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4). This is particularly useful to pass
4825 connection-specific information to the server (e.g. the client's SSL
4826 certificate), or to combine several headers into one. This rule is not
4827 final, so it is possible to add other similar rules. Note that header
4828 addition is performed immediately, so one rule might reuse the resulting
4829 header from a previous rule.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004830
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004831http-request allow [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004832
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004833 This stops the evaluation of the rules and lets the request pass the check.
4834 No further "http-request" rules are evaluated.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004835
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004836
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004837http-request auth [realm <realm>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004838
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004839 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately responds with an
4840 HTTP 401 or 407 error code to invite the user to present a valid user name
4841 and password. No further "http-request" rules are evaluated. An optional
4842 "realm" parameter is supported, it sets the authentication realm that is
4843 returned with the response (typically the application's name).
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004844
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004845 Example:
4846 acl auth_ok http_auth_group(L1) G1
4847 http-request auth unless auth_ok
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004848
Jarno Huuskonen251a6b72019-01-04 14:05:02 +02004849http-request cache-use <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004850
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +02004851 See section 6.2 about cache setup.
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01004852
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004853http-request capture <sample> [ len <length> | id <id> ]
4854 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01004855
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004856 This captures sample expression <sample> from the request buffer, and
4857 converts it to a string of at most <len> characters. The resulting string is
4858 stored into the next request "capture" slot, so it will possibly appear next
4859 to some captured HTTP headers. It will then automatically appear in the logs,
4860 and it will be possible to extract it using sample fetch rules to feed it
4861 into headers or anything. The length should be limited given that this size
4862 will be allocated for each capture during the whole session life.
4863 Please check section 7.3 (Fetching samples) and "capture request header" for
4864 more information.
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01004865
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004866 If the keyword "id" is used instead of "len", the action tries to store the
4867 captured string in a previously declared capture slot. This is useful to run
4868 captures in backends. The slot id can be declared by a previous directive
Baptiste Assmann19a69b32020-01-16 14:34:22 +01004869 "http-request capture" or with the "declare capture" keyword.
4870
4871 When using this action in a backend, double check that the relevant
4872 frontend(s) have the required capture slots otherwise, this rule will be
4873 ignored at run time. This can't be detected at configuration parsing time
4874 due to HAProxy's ability to dynamically resolve backend name at runtime.
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01004875
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004876http-request del-acl(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01004877
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004878 This is used to delete an entry from an ACL. The ACL must be loaded from a
4879 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be updated is
4880 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
4881 log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
4882 It is the equivalent of the "del acl" command from the stats socket, but can
4883 be triggered by an HTTP request.
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01004884
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004885http-request del-header <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreauf4c43c12013-06-11 17:01:13 +02004886
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004887 This removes all HTTP header fields whose name is specified in <name>.
Willy Tarreau9a355ec2013-06-11 17:45:46 +02004888
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004889http-request del-map(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau42cf39e2013-06-11 18:51:32 +02004890
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004891 This is used to delete an entry from a MAP. The MAP must be loaded from a
4892 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be updated is
4893 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
4894 log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
4895 It takes one argument: "file name" It is the equivalent of the "del map"
4896 command from the stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP request.
Willy Tarreau51347ed2013-06-11 19:34:13 +02004897
Christopher Faulet554c0eb2020-01-14 12:00:28 +01004898http-request deny [deny_status <status>] [ { errorfile | errorfiles } <err> ]
4899 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Patrick Hemmer268a7072018-05-11 12:52:31 -04004900
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004901 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately rejects the request
4902 and emits an HTTP 403 error, or optionally the status code specified as an
4903 argument to "deny_status". The list of permitted status codes is limited to
Christopher Faulet554c0eb2020-01-14 12:00:28 +01004904 those that can be overridden by the "errorfile" directive. A specific error
4905 message may be specified. It may be an error file, using the "errorfile"
4906 keyword followed by the file containing the full HTTP response. It may also
4907 be an error from an http-errors section, using the "errorfiles" keyword
4908 followed by the section name.
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004909 No further "http-request" rules are evaluated.
Patrick Hemmer268a7072018-05-11 12:52:31 -04004910
Olivier Houchard602bf7d2019-05-10 13:59:15 +02004911http-request disable-l7-retry [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4912 This disables any attempt to retry the request if it fails for any other
4913 reason than a connection failure. This can be useful for example to make
4914 sure POST requests aren't retried on failure.
4915
Baptiste Assmann333939c2019-01-21 08:34:50 +01004916http-request do-resolve(<var>,<resolvers>,[ipv4,ipv6]) <expr> :
4917
4918 This action performs a DNS resolution of the output of <expr> and stores
4919 the result in the variable <var>. It uses the DNS resolvers section
4920 pointed by <resolvers>.
4921 It is possible to choose a resolution preference using the optional
4922 arguments 'ipv4' or 'ipv6'.
4923 When performing the DNS resolution, the client side connection is on
4924 pause waiting till the end of the resolution.
4925 If an IP address can be found, it is stored into <var>. If any kind of
4926 error occurs, then <var> is not set.
4927 One can use this action to discover a server IP address at run time and
4928 based on information found in the request (IE a Host header).
4929 If this action is used to find the server's IP address (using the
4930 "set-dst" action), then the server IP address in the backend must be set
4931 to 0.0.0.0.
4932
4933 Example:
4934 resolvers mydns
4935 nameserver local 127.0.0.53:53
4936 nameserver google 8.8.8.8:53
4937 timeout retry 1s
4938 hold valid 10s
4939 hold nx 3s
4940 hold other 3s
4941 hold obsolete 0s
4942 accepted_payload_size 8192
4943
4944 frontend fe
4945 bind 10.42.0.1:80
4946 http-request do-resolve(txn.myip,mydns,ipv4) hdr(Host),lower
4947 http-request capture var(txn.myip) len 40
4948
4949 # return 503 when the variable is not set,
4950 # which mean DNS resolution error
4951 use_backend b_503 unless { var(txn.myip) -m found }
4952
4953 default_backend be
4954
4955 backend b_503
4956 # dummy backend used to return 503.
4957 # one can use the errorfile directive to send a nice
4958 # 503 error page to end users
4959
4960 backend be
4961 # rule to prevent HAProxy from reconnecting to services
4962 # on the local network (forged DNS name used to scan the network)
4963 http-request deny if { var(txn.myip) -m ip 127.0.0.0/8 10.0.0.0/8 }
4964 http-request set-dst var(txn.myip)
4965 server clear 0.0.0.0:0
4966
4967 NOTE: Don't forget to set the "protection" rules to ensure HAProxy won't
4968 be used to scan the network or worst won't loop over itself...
4969
Frédéric Lécaille06f5b642018-11-12 11:01:10 +01004970http-request early-hint <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4971
4972 This is used to build an HTTP 103 Early Hints response prior to any other one.
4973 This appends an HTTP header field to this response whose name is specified in
4974 <name> and whose value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format rules
4975 (see Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4). This is particularly useful to pass
Frédéric Lécaille3aac1062018-11-13 09:42:13 +01004976 to the client some Link headers to preload resources required to render the
4977 HTML documents.
Frédéric Lécaille06f5b642018-11-12 11:01:10 +01004978
4979 See RFC 8297 for more information.
4980
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004981http-request redirect <rule> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004982
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004983 This performs an HTTP redirection based on a redirect rule. This is exactly
4984 the same as the "redirect" statement except that it inserts a redirect rule
4985 which can be processed in the middle of other "http-request" rules and that
4986 these rules use the "log-format" strings. See the "redirect" keyword for the
4987 rule's syntax.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004988
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004989http-request reject [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004990
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004991 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately closes the connection
4992 without sending any response. It acts similarly to the
4993 "tcp-request content reject" rules. It can be useful to force an immediate
4994 connection closure on HTTP/2 connections.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004995
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004996http-request replace-header <name> <match-regex> <replace-fmt>
4997 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaua9083d02015-05-08 15:27:59 +02004998
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +05004999 This matches the value of all occurrences of header field <name> against
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01005000 <match-regex>. Matching is performed case-sensitively. Matching values are
5001 completely replaced by <replace-fmt>. Format characters are allowed in
5002 <replace-fmt> and work like <fmt> arguments in "http-request add-header".
5003 Standard back-references using the backslash ('\') followed by a number are
5004 supported.
Thierry FOURNIER82bf70d2015-05-26 17:58:29 +02005005
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01005006 This action acts on whole header lines, regardless of the number of values
5007 they may contain. Thus it is well-suited to process headers naturally
5008 containing commas in their value, such as If-Modified-Since. Headers that
5009 contain a comma-separated list of values, such as Accept, should be processed
5010 using "http-request replace-value".
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +01005011
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01005012 Example:
5013 http-request replace-header Cookie foo=([^;]*);(.*) foo=\1;ip=%bi;\2
5014
5015 # applied to:
5016 Cookie: foo=foobar; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT;
5017
5018 # outputs:
5019 Cookie: foo=foobar;ip=192.168.1.20; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT;
5020
5021 # assuming the backend IP is 192.168.1.20
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02005022
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01005023 http-request replace-header User-Agent curl foo
5024
5025 # applied to:
5026 User-Agent: curl/7.47.0
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02005027
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01005028 # outputs:
5029 User-Agent: foo
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02005030
Willy Tarreau262c3f12019-12-17 06:52:51 +01005031http-request replace-path <match-regex> <replace-fmt>
5032 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5033
5034 This works like "replace-header" except that it works on the request's path
5035 component instead of a header. The path component starts at the first '/'
5036 after an optional scheme+authority. It does contain the query string if any
5037 is present. The replacement does not modify the scheme nor authority.
5038
5039 It is worth noting that regular expressions may be more expensive to evaluate
5040 than certain ACLs, so rare replacements may benefit from a condition to avoid
5041 performing the evaluation at all if it does not match.
5042
5043 Example:
5044 # prefix /foo : turn /bar?q=1 into /foo/bar?q=1 :
5045 http-request replace-path (.*) /foo\1
5046
5047 # suffix /foo : turn /bar?q=1 into /bar/foo?q=1 :
5048 http-request replace-path ([^?]*)(\?(.*))? \1/foo\2
5049
5050 # strip /foo : turn /foo/bar?q=1 into /bar?q=1
5051 http-request replace-path /foo/(.*) /\1
5052 # or more efficient if only some requests match :
5053 http-request replace-path /foo/(.*) /\1 if { url_beg /foo/ }
5054
Willy Tarreau33810222019-06-12 17:44:02 +02005055http-request replace-uri <match-regex> <replace-fmt>
5056 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5057
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01005058 This works like "replace-header" except that it works on the request's URI part
5059 instead of a header. The URI part may contain an optional scheme, authority or
5060 query string. These are considered to be part of the value that is matched
5061 against.
5062
5063 It is worth noting that regular expressions may be more expensive to evaluate
5064 than certain ACLs, so rare replacements may benefit from a condition to avoid
5065 performing the evaluation at all if it does not match.
Willy Tarreau33810222019-06-12 17:44:02 +02005066
Willy Tarreau62b59132019-12-17 06:51:20 +01005067 IMPORTANT NOTE: historically in HTTP/1.x, the vast majority of requests sent
5068 by browsers use the "origin form", which differs from the "absolute form" in
5069 that they do not contain a scheme nor authority in the URI portion. Mostly
5070 only requests sent to proxies, those forged by hand and some emitted by
5071 certain applications use the absolute form. As such, "replace-uri" usually
5072 works fine most of the time in HTTP/1.x with rules starting with a "/". But
5073 with HTTP/2, clients are encouraged to send absolute URIs only, which look
5074 like the ones HTTP/1 clients use to talk to proxies. Such partial replace-uri
5075 rules may then fail in HTTP/2 when they work in HTTP/1. Either the rules need
Willy Tarreau262c3f12019-12-17 06:52:51 +01005076 to be adapted to optionally match a scheme and authority, or replace-path
5077 should be used.
Willy Tarreau33810222019-06-12 17:44:02 +02005078
Willy Tarreau62b59132019-12-17 06:51:20 +01005079 Example:
5080 # rewrite all "http" absolute requests to "https":
5081 http-request replace-uri ^http://(.*) https://\1
Willy Tarreau33810222019-06-12 17:44:02 +02005082
Willy Tarreau62b59132019-12-17 06:51:20 +01005083 # prefix /foo : turn /bar?q=1 into /foo/bar?q=1 :
5084 http-request replace-uri ([^/:]*://[^/]*)?(.*) \1/foo\2
Willy Tarreau33810222019-06-12 17:44:02 +02005085
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005086http-request replace-value <name> <match-regex> <replace-fmt>
5087 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02005088
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01005089 This works like "replace-header" except that it matches the regex against
5090 every comma-delimited value of the header field <name> instead of the
5091 entire header. This is suited for all headers which are allowed to carry
5092 more than one value. An example could be the Accept header.
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02005093
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01005094 Example:
5095 http-request replace-value X-Forwarded-For ^192\.168\.(.*)$ 172.16.\1
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +02005096
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01005097 # applied to:
5098 X-Forwarded-For: 192.168.10.1, 192.168.13.24, 10.0.0.37
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +02005099
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01005100 # outputs:
5101 X-Forwarded-For: 172.16.10.1, 172.16.13.24, 10.0.0.37
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +01005102
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01005103http-request return [status <code>] [content-type <type>]
5104 [ { default-errorfiles | errorfile <file> | errorfiles <name> |
5105 file <file> | lf-file <file> | string <str> | lf-string <fmt> } ]
Christopher Faulet4a2c1422020-01-31 17:36:01 +01005106 [ hdr <name> <fmt> ]*
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01005107 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5108
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +05005109 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately returns a response. The
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01005110 default status code used for the response is 200. It can be optionally
5111 specified as an arguments to "status". The response content-type may also be
5112 specified as an argument to "content-type". Finally the response itselft may
5113 be defined. If can be a full HTTP response specifying the errorfile to use,
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +05005114 or the response payload specifying the file or the string to use. These rules
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01005115 are followed to create the response :
5116
5117 * If neither the errorfile nor the payload to use is defined, a dummy
5118 response is returned. Only the "status" argument is considered. It can be
5119 any code in the range [200, 599]. The "content-type" argument, if any, is
5120 ignored.
5121
5122 * If "default-errorfiles" argument is set, the proxy's errorfiles are
5123 considered. If the "status" argument is defined, it must be one of the
5124 status code handled by hparoxy (200, 400, 403, 404, 405, 408, 410, 425,
5125 429, 500, 502, 503, and 504). The "content-type" argument, if any, is
5126 ignored.
5127
5128 * If a specific errorfile is defined, with an "errorfile" argument, the
5129 corresponding file, containing a full HTTP response, is returned. Only the
5130 "status" argument is considered. It must be one of the status code handled
5131 by hparoxy (200, 400, 403, 404, 405, 408, 410, 425, 429, 500, 502, 503, and
5132 504). The "content-type" argument, if any, is ignored.
5133
5134 * If an http-errors section is defined, with an "errorfiles" argument, the
5135 corresponding file in the specified http-errors section, containing a full
5136 HTTP response, is returned. Only the "status" argument is considered. It
5137 must be one of the status code handled by hparoxy (200, 400, 403, 404, 405,
5138 408, 410, 425, 429, 500, 502, 503, and 504). The "content-type" argument,
5139 if any, is ignored.
5140
5141 * If a "file" or a "lf-file" argument is specified, the file's content is
5142 used as the response payload. If the file is not empty, its content-type
5143 must be set as argument to "content-type". Otherwise, any "content-type"
5144 argument is ignored. With a "lf-file" argument, the file's content is
5145 evaluated as a log-format string. With a "file" argument, it is considered
5146 as a raw content.
5147
5148 * If a "string" or "lf-string" argument is specified, the defined string is
5149 used as the response payload. The content-type must always be set as
5150 argument to "content-type". With a "lf-string" argument, the string is
5151 evaluated as a log-format string. With a "string" argument, it is
5152 considered as a raw string.
5153
Christopher Faulet4a2c1422020-01-31 17:36:01 +01005154 When the response is not based an errorfile, it is possible to appends HTTP
5155 header fields to the response using "hdr" arguments. Otherwise, all "hdr"
5156 arguments are ignored. For each one, the header name is specified in <name>
5157 and its value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format rules.
5158
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01005159 Note that the generated response must be smaller than a buffer. And to avoid
5160 any warning, when an errorfile or a raw file is loaded, the buffer space
5161 reserved to the headers rewritting should also be free.
5162
5163 No further "http-request" rules are evaluated.
5164
5165 Example:
5166 http-request return errorfile /etc/haproy/errorfiles/200.http \
5167 if { path /ping }
5168
5169 http-request return content-type image/x-icon file /var/www/favicon.ico \
5170 if { path /favicon.ico }
5171
5172 http-request return status 403 content-type text/plain \
5173 lf-string "Access denied. IP %[src] is blacklisted." \
5174 if { src -f /etc/haproxy/blacklist.lst }
5175
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005176http-request sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5177http-request sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02005178
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005179 This actions increments the GPC0 or GPC1 counter according with the sticky
5180 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action silently fails
5181 and the actions evaluation continues.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02005182
Cédric Dufour0d7712d2019-11-06 18:38:53 +01005183http-request sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
5184 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02005185
Cédric Dufour0d7712d2019-11-06 18:38:53 +01005186 This action sets the 32-bit unsigned GPT0 tag according to the sticky counter
5187 designated by <sc-id> and the value of <int>/<expr>. The expected result is a
5188 boolean. If an error occurs, this action silently fails and the actions
5189 evaluation continues.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02005190
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005191http-request set-dst <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02005192
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005193 This is used to set the destination IP address to the value of specified
5194 expression. Useful when a proxy in front of HAProxy rewrites destination IP,
5195 but provides the correct IP in a HTTP header; or you want to mask the IP for
5196 privacy. If you want to connect to the new address/port, use '0.0.0.0:0' as a
5197 server address in the backend.
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01005198
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005199 Arguments:
5200 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch followed
5201 by some converters.
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01005202
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005203 Example:
5204 http-request set-dst hdr(x-dst)
5205 http-request set-dst dst,ipmask(24)
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01005206
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005207 When possible, set-dst preserves the original destination port as long as the
5208 address family allows it, otherwise the destination port is set to 0.
Adis Nezirovic2fbcafc2015-07-06 15:44:30 +02005209
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005210http-request set-dst-port <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Adis Nezirovic2fbcafc2015-07-06 15:44:30 +02005211
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005212 This is used to set the destination port address to the value of specified
5213 expression. If you want to connect to the new address/port, use '0.0.0.0:0'
5214 as a server address in the backend.
Adis Nezirovic2fbcafc2015-07-06 15:44:30 +02005215
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005216 Arguments:
5217 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
5218 followed by some converters.
Adis Nezirovic2fbcafc2015-07-06 15:44:30 +02005219
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005220 Example:
5221 http-request set-dst-port hdr(x-port)
5222 http-request set-dst-port int(4000)
Adis Nezirovic2fbcafc2015-07-06 15:44:30 +02005223
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005224 When possible, set-dst-port preserves the original destination address as
5225 long as the address family supports a port, otherwise it forces the
5226 destination address to IPv4 "0.0.0.0" before rewriting the port.
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02005227
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005228http-request set-header <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02005229
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005230 This does the same as "http-request add-header" except that the header name
5231 is first removed if it existed. This is useful when passing security
5232 information to the server, where the header must not be manipulated by
5233 external users. Note that the new value is computed before the removal so it
5234 is possible to concatenate a value to an existing header.
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02005235
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005236 Example:
5237 http-request set-header X-Haproxy-Current-Date %T
5238 http-request set-header X-SSL %[ssl_fc]
5239 http-request set-header X-SSL-Session_ID %[ssl_fc_session_id,hex]
5240 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-Verify %[ssl_c_verify]
5241 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-DN %{+Q}[ssl_c_s_dn]
5242 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-CN %{+Q}[ssl_c_s_dn(cn)]
5243 http-request set-header X-SSL-Issuer %{+Q}[ssl_c_i_dn]
5244 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-NotBefore %{+Q}[ssl_c_notbefore]
5245 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-NotAfter %{+Q}[ssl_c_notafter]
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02005246
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005247http-request set-log-level <level> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02005248
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005249 This is used to change the log level of the current request when a certain
5250 condition is met. Valid levels are the 8 syslog levels (see the "log"
5251 keyword) plus the special level "silent" which disables logging for this
5252 request. This rule is not final so the last matching rule wins. This rule
5253 can be useful to disable health checks coming from another equipment.
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02005254
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005255http-request set-map(<file-name>) <key fmt> <value fmt>
5256 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02005257
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005258 This is used to add a new entry into a MAP. The MAP must be loaded from a
5259 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be updated is
5260 passed between parentheses. It takes 2 arguments: <key fmt>, which follows
5261 log-format rules, used to collect MAP key, and <value fmt>, which follows
5262 log-format rules, used to collect content for the new entry.
5263 It performs a lookup in the MAP before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or
5264 more) values. This lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive
5265 with large lists! It is the equivalent of the "set map" command from the
5266 stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP request.
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02005267
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005268http-request set-mark <mark> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02005269
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005270 This is used to set the Netfilter MARK on all packets sent to the client to
5271 the value passed in <mark> on platforms which support it. This value is an
5272 unsigned 32 bit value which can be matched by netfilter and by the routing
5273 table. It can be expressed both in decimal or hexadecimal format (prefixed by
5274 "0x"). This can be useful to force certain packets to take a different route
5275 (for example a cheaper network path for bulk downloads). This works on Linux
5276 kernels 2.6.32 and above and requires admin privileges.
Willy Tarreau00005ce2016-10-21 15:07:45 +02005277
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005278http-request set-method <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02005279
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005280 This rewrites the request method with the result of the evaluation of format
5281 string <fmt>. There should be very few valid reasons for having to do so as
5282 this is more likely to break something than to fix it.
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02005283
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005284http-request set-nice <nice> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02005285
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005286 This sets the "nice" factor of the current request being processed. It only
5287 has effect against the other requests being processed at the same time.
5288 The default value is 0, unless altered by the "nice" setting on the "bind"
5289 line. The accepted range is -1024..1024. The higher the value, the nicest
5290 the request will be. Lower values will make the request more important than
5291 other ones. This can be useful to improve the speed of some requests, or
5292 lower the priority of non-important requests. Using this setting without
5293 prior experimentation can cause some major slowdown.
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02005294
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005295http-request set-path <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau00005ce2016-10-21 15:07:45 +02005296
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005297 This rewrites the request path with the result of the evaluation of format
5298 string <fmt>. The query string, if any, is left intact. If a scheme and
5299 authority is found before the path, they are left intact as well. If the
5300 request doesn't have a path ("*"), this one is replaced with the format.
5301 This can be used to prepend a directory component in front of a path for
5302 example. See also "http-request set-query" and "http-request set-uri".
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02005303
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005304 Example :
5305 # prepend the host name before the path
5306 http-request set-path /%[hdr(host)]%[path]
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02005307
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005308http-request set-priority-class <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Olivier Houchardccaa7de2017-10-02 11:51:03 +02005309
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005310 This is used to set the queue priority class of the current request.
5311 The value must be a sample expression which converts to an integer in the
5312 range -2047..2047. Results outside this range will be truncated.
5313 The priority class determines the order in which queued requests are
5314 processed. Lower values have higher priority.
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02005315
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005316http-request set-priority-offset <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02005317
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005318 This is used to set the queue priority timestamp offset of the current
5319 request. The value must be a sample expression which converts to an integer
5320 in the range -524287..524287. Results outside this range will be truncated.
5321 When a request is queued, it is ordered first by the priority class, then by
5322 the current timestamp adjusted by the given offset in milliseconds. Lower
5323 values have higher priority.
5324 Note that the resulting timestamp is is only tracked with enough precision
5325 for 524,287ms (8m44s287ms). If the request is queued long enough to where the
5326 adjusted timestamp exceeds this value, it will be misidentified as highest
5327 priority. Thus it is important to set "timeout queue" to a value, where when
5328 combined with the offset, does not exceed this limit.
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02005329
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005330http-request set-query <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01005331
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005332 This rewrites the request's query string which appears after the first
5333 question mark ("?") with the result of the evaluation of format string <fmt>.
5334 The part prior to the question mark is left intact. If the request doesn't
5335 contain a question mark and the new value is not empty, then one is added at
5336 the end of the URI, followed by the new value. If a question mark was
5337 present, it will never be removed even if the value is empty. This can be
5338 used to add or remove parameters from the query string.
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08005339
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005340 See also "http-request set-query" and "http-request set-uri".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01005341
5342 Example:
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005343 # replace "%3D" with "=" in the query string
5344 http-request set-query %[query,regsub(%3D,=,g)]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01005345
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005346http-request set-src <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5347 This is used to set the source IP address to the value of specified
5348 expression. Useful when a proxy in front of HAProxy rewrites source IP, but
5349 provides the correct IP in a HTTP header; or you want to mask source IP for
Olivier Doucet56e31202020-04-21 09:32:56 +02005350 privacy. All subsequent calls to "src" fetch will return this value
5351 (see example).
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005352
5353 Arguments :
5354 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch followed
5355 by some converters.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01005356
Olivier Doucet56e31202020-04-21 09:32:56 +02005357 See also "option forwardfor".
5358
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01005359 Example:
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005360 http-request set-src hdr(x-forwarded-for)
5361 http-request set-src src,ipmask(24)
5362
Olivier Doucet56e31202020-04-21 09:32:56 +02005363 # After the masking this will track connections
5364 # based on the IP address with the last byte zeroed out.
5365 http-request track-sc0 src
5366
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005367 When possible, set-src preserves the original source port as long as the
5368 address family allows it, otherwise the source port is set to 0.
5369
5370http-request set-src-port <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5371
5372 This is used to set the source port address to the value of specified
5373 expression.
5374
5375 Arguments:
5376 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch followed
5377 by some converters.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01005378
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01005379 Example:
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005380 http-request set-src-port hdr(x-port)
5381 http-request set-src-port int(4000)
5382
5383 When possible, set-src-port preserves the original source address as long as
5384 the address family supports a port, otherwise it forces the source address to
5385 IPv4 "0.0.0.0" before rewriting the port.
5386
5387http-request set-tos <tos> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5388
5389 This is used to set the TOS or DSCP field value of packets sent to the client
5390 to the value passed in <tos> on platforms which support this. This value
5391 represents the whole 8 bits of the IP TOS field, and can be expressed both in
5392 decimal or hexadecimal format (prefixed by "0x"). Note that only the 6 higher
5393 bits are used in DSCP or TOS, and the two lower bits are always 0. This can
5394 be used to adjust some routing behavior on border routers based on some
5395 information from the request.
5396
5397 See RFC 2474, 2597, 3260 and 4594 for more information.
5398
5399http-request set-uri <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5400
5401 This rewrites the request URI with the result of the evaluation of format
5402 string <fmt>. The scheme, authority, path and query string are all replaced
5403 at once. This can be used to rewrite hosts in front of proxies, or to
5404 perform complex modifications to the URI such as moving parts between the
5405 path and the query string.
5406 See also "http-request set-path" and "http-request set-query".
5407
5408http-request set-var(<var-name>) <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5409
5410 This is used to set the contents of a variable. The variable is declared
5411 inline.
5412
5413 Arguments:
5414 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
5415 scope. The scopes allowed are:
5416 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
5417 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
5418 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction
5419 (request and response)
5420 "req" : the variable is shared only during request
5421 processing
5422 "res" : the variable is shared only during response
5423 processing
5424 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
5425 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9'
5426 and '_'.
5427
5428 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
5429 followed by some converters.
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01005430
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02005431 Example:
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005432 http-request set-var(req.my_var) req.fhdr(user-agent),lower
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02005433
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005434http-request send-spoe-group <engine-name> <group-name>
5435 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02005436
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005437 This action is used to trigger sending of a group of SPOE messages. To do so,
5438 the SPOE engine used to send messages must be defined, as well as the SPOE
5439 group to send. Of course, the SPOE engine must refer to an existing SPOE
5440 filter. If not engine name is provided on the SPOE filter line, the SPOE
5441 agent name must be used.
5442
5443 Arguments:
5444 <engine-name> The SPOE engine name.
5445
5446 <group-name> The SPOE group name as specified in the engine
5447 configuration.
5448
5449http-request silent-drop [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5450
5451 This stops the evaluation of the rules and makes the client-facing connection
5452 suddenly disappear using a system-dependent way that tries to prevent the
5453 client from being notified. The effect it then that the client still sees an
5454 established connection while there's none on HAProxy. The purpose is to
5455 achieve a comparable effect to "tarpit" except that it doesn't use any local
5456 resource at all on the machine running HAProxy. It can resist much higher
5457 loads than "tarpit", and slow down stronger attackers. It is important to
5458 understand the impact of using this mechanism. All stateful equipment placed
5459 between the client and HAProxy (firewalls, proxies, load balancers) will also
5460 keep the established connection for a long time and may suffer from this
5461 action.
5462 On modern Linux systems running with enough privileges, the TCP_REPAIR socket
5463 option is used to block the emission of a TCP reset. On other systems, the
5464 socket's TTL is reduced to 1 so that the TCP reset doesn't pass the first
5465 router, though it's still delivered to local networks. Do not use it unless
5466 you fully understand how it works.
5467
Christopher Faulet46f95542019-12-20 10:07:22 +01005468http-request strict-mode { on | off }
5469
5470 This enables or disables the strict rewriting mode for following rules. It
5471 does not affect rules declared before it and it is only applicable on rules
5472 performing a rewrite on the requests. When the strict mode is enabled, any
5473 rewrite failure triggers an internal error. Otherwise, such errors are
5474 silently ignored. The purpose of the strict rewriting mode is to make some
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +05005475 rewrites optional while others must be performed to continue the request
Christopher Faulet46f95542019-12-20 10:07:22 +01005476 processing.
5477
Christopher Faulet1aea50e2020-01-17 16:03:53 +01005478 By default, the strict rewriting mode is enabled. Its value is also reset
Christopher Faulet46f95542019-12-20 10:07:22 +01005479 when a ruleset evaluation ends. So, for instance, if you change the mode on
5480 the frontend, the default mode is restored when HAProxy starts the backend
5481 rules evaluation.
5482
Christopher Faulet554c0eb2020-01-14 12:00:28 +01005483http-request tarpit [deny_status <status>] [ { errorfile | errorfiles } <err> ]
5484 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005485
5486 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately blocks the request
5487 without responding for a delay specified by "timeout tarpit" or
5488 "timeout connect" if the former is not set. After that delay, if the client
5489 is still connected, an HTTP error 500 (or optionally the status code
5490 specified as an argument to "deny_status") is returned so that the client
5491 does not suspect it has been tarpitted. Logs will report the flags "PT".
5492 The goal of the tarpit rule is to slow down robots during an attack when
5493 they're limited on the number of concurrent requests. It can be very
5494 efficient against very dumb robots, and will significantly reduce the load
5495 on firewalls compared to a "deny" rule. But when facing "correctly"
5496 developed robots, it can make things worse by forcing haproxy and the front
Christopher Faulet554c0eb2020-01-14 12:00:28 +01005497 firewall to support insane number of concurrent connections. A specific error
5498 message may be specified. It may be an error file, using the "errorfile"
5499 keyword followed by the file containing the full HTTP response. It may also
5500 be an error from an http-errors section, using the "errorfiles" keyword
5501 followed by the section name.
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005502 See also the "silent-drop" action.
5503
5504http-request track-sc0 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5505http-request track-sc1 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5506http-request track-sc2 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5507
5508 This enables tracking of sticky counters from current request. These rules do
5509 not stop evaluation and do not change default action. The number of counters
5510 that may be simultaneously tracked by the same connection is set in
5511 MAX_SESS_STKCTR at build time (reported in haproxy -vv) which defaults to 3,
5512 so the track-sc number is between 0 and (MAX_SESS_STCKTR-1). The first
5513 "track-sc0" rule executed enables tracking of the counters of the specified
5514 table as the first set. The first "track-sc1" rule executed enables tracking
5515 of the counters of the specified table as the second set. The first
5516 "track-sc2" rule executed enables tracking of the counters of the specified
5517 table as the third set. It is a recommended practice to use the first set of
5518 counters for the per-frontend counters and the second set for the per-backend
5519 ones. But this is just a guideline, all may be used everywhere.
5520
5521 Arguments :
5522 <key> is mandatory, and is a sample expression rule as described in
5523 section 7.3. It describes what elements of the incoming request or
5524 connection will be analyzed, extracted, combined, and used to
5525 select which table entry to update the counters.
5526
5527 <table> is an optional table to be used instead of the default one, which
5528 is the stick-table declared in the current proxy. All the counters
5529 for the matches and updates for the key will then be performed in
5530 that table until the session ends.
5531
5532 Once a "track-sc*" rule is executed, the key is looked up in the table and if
5533 it is not found, an entry is allocated for it. Then a pointer to that entry
5534 is kept during all the session's life, and this entry's counters are updated
5535 as often as possible, every time the session's counters are updated, and also
5536 systematically when the session ends. Counters are only updated for events
5537 that happen after the tracking has been started. As an exception, connection
5538 counters and request counters are systematically updated so that they reflect
5539 useful information.
5540
5541 If the entry tracks concurrent connection counters, one connection is counted
5542 for as long as the entry is tracked, and the entry will not expire during
5543 that time. Tracking counters also provides a performance advantage over just
5544 checking the keys, because only one table lookup is performed for all ACL
5545 checks that make use of it.
5546
5547http-request unset-var(<var-name>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5548
5549 This is used to unset a variable. See above for details about <var-name>.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02005550
5551 Example:
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005552 http-request unset-var(req.my_var)
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02005553
Christopher Faulet579d83b2019-11-22 15:34:17 +01005554http-request use-service <service-name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5555
5556 This directive executes the configured HTTP service to reply to the request
5557 and stops the evaluation of the rules. An HTTP service may choose to reply by
5558 sending any valid HTTP response or it may immediately close the connection
5559 without sending any response. Outside natives services, for instance the
5560 Prometheus exporter, it is possible to write your own services in Lua. No
5561 further "http-request" rules are evaluated.
5562
5563 Arguments :
5564 <service-name> is mandatory. It is the service to call
5565
5566 Example:
5567 http-request use-service prometheus-exporter if { path /metrics }
5568
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005569http-request wait-for-handshake [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02005570
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005571 This will delay the processing of the request until the SSL handshake
5572 happened. This is mostly useful to delay processing early data until we're
5573 sure they are valid.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02005574
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01005575
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005576http-response <action> <options...> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02005577 Access control for Layer 7 responses
5578
5579 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5580 no | yes | yes | yes
5581
5582 The http-response statement defines a set of rules which apply to layer 7
5583 processing. The rules are evaluated in their declaration order when they are
5584 met in a frontend, listen or backend section. Any rule may optionally be
5585 followed by an ACL-based condition, in which case it will only be evaluated
5586 if the condition is true. Since these rules apply on responses, the backend
5587 rules are applied first, followed by the frontend's rules.
5588
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005589 The first keyword is the rule's action. The supported actions are described
5590 below.
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02005591
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005592 There is no limit to the number of http-response statements per instance.
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02005593
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005594 Example:
5595 acl key_acl res.hdr(X-Acl-Key) -m found
Thierry FOURNIERdad3d1d2014-04-22 18:07:25 +02005596
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005597 acl myhost hdr(Host) -f myhost.lst
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005598
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005599 http-response add-acl(myhost.lst) %[res.hdr(X-Acl-Key)] if key_acl
5600 http-response del-acl(myhost.lst) %[res.hdr(X-Acl-Key)] if key_acl
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005601
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005602 Example:
5603 acl value res.hdr(X-Value) -m found
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005604
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005605 use_backend bk_appli if { hdr(Host),map_str(map.lst) -m found }
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005606
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005607 http-response set-map(map.lst) %[src] %[res.hdr(X-Value)] if value
5608 http-response del-map(map.lst) %[src] if ! value
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005609
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005610 See also : "http-request", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7 about
5611 ACL usage.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005612
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005613http-response add-acl(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005614
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005615 This is used to add a new entry into an ACL. The ACL must be loaded from a
5616 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be updated is
5617 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
5618 log-format rules, to collect content of the new entry. It performs a lookup
5619 in the ACL before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or more) values.
5620 This lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive with large lists!
5621 It is the equivalent of the "add acl" command from the stats socket, but can
5622 be triggered by an HTTP response.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005623
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005624http-response add-header <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005625
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005626 This appends an HTTP header field whose name is specified in <name> and whose
5627 value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format rules (see Custom Log
5628 Format in section 8.2.4). This may be used to send a cookie to a client for
5629 example, or to pass some internal information.
5630 This rule is not final, so it is possible to add other similar rules.
5631 Note that header addition is performed immediately, so one rule might reuse
5632 the resulting header from a previous rule.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005633
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005634http-response allow [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005635
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005636 This stops the evaluation of the rules and lets the response pass the check.
5637 No further "http-response" rules are evaluated for the current section.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005638
Jarno Huuskonen251a6b72019-01-04 14:05:02 +02005639http-response cache-store <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005640
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +02005641 See section 6.2 about cache setup.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005642
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005643http-response capture <sample> id <id> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005644
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005645 This captures sample expression <sample> from the response buffer, and
5646 converts it to a string. The resulting string is stored into the next request
5647 "capture" slot, so it will possibly appear next to some captured HTTP
5648 headers. It will then automatically appear in the logs, and it will be
5649 possible to extract it using sample fetch rules to feed it into headers or
5650 anything. Please check section 7.3 (Fetching samples) and
5651 "capture response header" for more information.
Thierry FOURNIER35d70ef2015-08-26 16:21:56 +02005652
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005653 The keyword "id" is the id of the capture slot which is used for storing the
5654 string. The capture slot must be defined in an associated frontend.
5655 This is useful to run captures in backends. The slot id can be declared by a
5656 previous directive "http-response capture" or with the "declare capture"
5657 keyword.
Baptiste Assmann19a69b32020-01-16 14:34:22 +01005658
5659 When using this action in a backend, double check that the relevant
5660 frontend(s) have the required capture slots otherwise, this rule will be
5661 ignored at run time. This can't be detected at configuration parsing time
5662 due to HAProxy's ability to dynamically resolve backend name at runtime.
Thierry FOURNIER35d70ef2015-08-26 16:21:56 +02005663
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005664http-response del-acl(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIER35d70ef2015-08-26 16:21:56 +02005665
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005666 This is used to delete an entry from an ACL. The ACL must be loaded from a
5667 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be updated is
5668 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
5669 log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
5670 It is the equivalent of the "del acl" command from the stats socket, but can
5671 be triggered by an HTTP response.
Willy Tarreauf4c43c12013-06-11 17:01:13 +02005672
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005673http-response del-header <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau9a355ec2013-06-11 17:45:46 +02005674
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005675 This removes all HTTP header fields whose name is specified in <name>.
Willy Tarreau42cf39e2013-06-11 18:51:32 +02005676
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005677http-response del-map(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau51347ed2013-06-11 19:34:13 +02005678
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005679 This is used to delete an entry from a MAP. The MAP must be loaded from a
5680 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be updated is
5681 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
5682 log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
5683 It takes one argument: "file name" It is the equivalent of the "del map"
5684 command from the stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP response.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02005685
Christopher Faulet554c0eb2020-01-14 12:00:28 +01005686http-response deny [deny_status <status>] [ { errorfile | errorfiles } <err> ]
5687 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02005688
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005689 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately rejects the response
Christopher Faulet040c8cd2020-01-13 16:43:45 +01005690 and emits an HTTP 502 error, or optionally the status code specified as an
5691 argument to "deny_status". The list of permitted status codes is limited to
Christopher Faulet554c0eb2020-01-14 12:00:28 +01005692 those that can be overridden by the "errorfile" directive. A specific error
5693 message may be specified. It may be an error file, using the "errorfile"
5694 keyword followed by the file containing the full HTTP response. It may also
5695 be an error from an http-errors section, using the "errorfiles" keyword
5696 followed by the section name.
Christopher Faulet040c8cd2020-01-13 16:43:45 +01005697 No further "http-response" rules are evaluated.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02005698
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005699http-response redirect <rule> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02005700
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005701 This performs an HTTP redirection based on a redirect rule.
5702 This supports a format string similarly to "http-request redirect" rules,
5703 with the exception that only the "location" type of redirect is possible on
5704 the response. See the "redirect" keyword for the rule's syntax. When a
5705 redirect rule is applied during a response, connections to the server are
5706 closed so that no data can be forwarded from the server to the client.
Thierry FOURNIERe80fada2015-05-26 18:06:31 +02005707
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005708http-response replace-header <name> <regex-match> <replace-fmt>
5709 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIERe80fada2015-05-26 18:06:31 +02005710
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01005711 This works like "http-request replace-header" except that it works on the
5712 server's response instead of the client's request.
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +01005713
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005714 Example:
5715 http-response replace-header Set-Cookie (C=[^;]*);(.*) \1;ip=%bi;\2
Willy Tarreau51d861a2015-05-22 17:30:48 +02005716
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005717 # applied to:
5718 Set-Cookie: C=1; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02005719
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005720 # outputs:
5721 Set-Cookie: C=1;ip=192.168.1.20; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02005722
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005723 # assuming the backend IP is 192.168.1.20.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02005724
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005725http-response replace-value <name> <regex-match> <replace-fmt>
5726 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02005727
Tim Duesterhus6bd909b2020-01-17 15:53:18 +01005728 This works like "http-request replace-value" except that it works on the
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01005729 server's response instead of the client's request.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02005730
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005731 Example:
5732 http-response replace-value Cache-control ^public$ private
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01005733
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005734 # applied to:
5735 Cache-Control: max-age=3600, public
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01005736
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005737 # outputs:
5738 Cache-Control: max-age=3600, private
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01005739
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01005740http-response return [status <code>] [content-type <type>]
5741 [ { default-errorfiles | errorfile <file> | errorfiles <name> |
5742 file <file> | lf-file <file> | string <str> | lf-string <fmt> } ]
Christopher Faulet4a2c1422020-01-31 17:36:01 +01005743 [ hdr <name> <value> ]*
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01005744 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5745
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +05005746 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately returns a response. The
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01005747 default status code used for the response is 200. It can be optionally
5748 specified as an arguments to "status". The response content-type may also be
5749 specified as an argument to "content-type". Finally the response itselft may
5750 be defined. If can be a full HTTP response specifying the errorfile to use,
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +05005751 or the response payload specifying the file or the string to use. These rules
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01005752 are followed to create the response :
5753
5754 * If neither the errorfile nor the payload to use is defined, a dummy
5755 response is returned. Only the "status" argument is considered. It can be
5756 any code in the range [200, 599]. The "content-type" argument, if any, is
5757 ignored.
5758
5759 * If "default-errorfiles" argument is set, the proxy's errorfiles are
5760 considered. If the "status" argument is defined, it must be one of the
5761 status code handled by hparoxy (200, 400, 403, 404, 405, 408, 410, 425,
5762 429, 500, 502, 503, and 504). The "content-type" argument, if any, is
5763 ignored.
5764
5765 * If a specific errorfile is defined, with an "errorfile" argument, the
5766 corresponding file, containing a full HTTP response, is returned. Only the
5767 "status" argument is considered. It must be one of the status code handled
5768 by hparoxy (200, 400, 403, 404, 405, 408, 410, 425, 429, 500, 502, 503, and
5769 504). The "content-type" argument, if any, is ignored.
5770
5771 * If an http-errors section is defined, with an "errorfiles" argument, the
5772 corresponding file in the specified http-errors section, containing a full
5773 HTTP response, is returned. Only the "status" argument is considered. It
5774 must be one of the status code handled by hparoxy (200, 400, 403, 404, 405,
5775 408, 410, 425, 429, 500, 502, 503, and 504). The "content-type" argument,
5776 if any, is ignored.
5777
5778 * If a "file" or a "lf-file" argument is specified, the file's content is
5779 used as the response payload. If the file is not empty, its content-type
5780 must be set as argument to "content-type". Otherwise, any "content-type"
5781 argument is ignored. With a "lf-file" argument, the file's content is
5782 evaluated as a log-format string. With a "file" argument, it is considered
5783 as a raw content.
5784
5785 * If a "string" or "lf-string" argument is specified, the defined string is
5786 used as the response payload. The content-type must always be set as
5787 argument to "content-type". With a "lf-string" argument, the string is
5788 evaluated as a log-format string. With a "string" argument, it is
5789 considered as a raw string.
5790
Christopher Faulet4a2c1422020-01-31 17:36:01 +01005791 When the response is not based an errorfile, it is possible to appends HTTP
5792 header fields to the response using "hdr" arguments. Otherwise, all "hdr"
5793 arguments are ignored. For each one, the header name is specified in <name>
5794 and its value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format rules.
5795
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01005796 Note that the generated response must be smaller than a buffer. And to avoid
5797 any warning, when an errorfile or a raw file is loaded, the buffer space
5798 reserved to the headers rewritting should also be free.
5799
5800 No further "http-response" rules are evaluated.
5801
5802 Example:
5803 http-response return errorfile /etc/haproy/errorfiles/200.http \
5804 if { status eq 404 }
5805
5806 http-response return content-type text/plain \
5807 string "This is the end !" \
5808 if { status eq 500 }
5809
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005810http-response sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5811http-response sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Ruoshan Huange4edc6b2016-07-14 15:07:45 +08005812
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005813 This action increments the GPC0 or GPC1 counter according with the sticky
5814 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action silently fails
5815 and the actions evaluation continues.
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +02005816
Cédric Dufour0d7712d2019-11-06 18:38:53 +01005817http-response sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
5818 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +02005819
Cédric Dufour0d7712d2019-11-06 18:38:53 +01005820 This action sets the 32-bit unsigned GPT0 tag according to the sticky counter
5821 designated by <sc-id> and the value of <int>/<expr>. The expected result is a
5822 boolean. If an error occurs, this action silently fails and the actions
5823 evaluation continues.
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +01005824
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005825http-response send-spoe-group [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02005826
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005827 This action is used to trigger sending of a group of SPOE messages. To do so,
5828 the SPOE engine used to send messages must be defined, as well as the SPOE
5829 group to send. Of course, the SPOE engine must refer to an existing SPOE
5830 filter. If not engine name is provided on the SPOE filter line, the SPOE
5831 agent name must be used.
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02005832
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005833 Arguments:
5834 <engine-name> The SPOE engine name.
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02005835
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005836 <group-name> The SPOE group name as specified in the engine
5837 configuration.
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02005838
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005839http-response set-header <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02005840
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005841 This does the same as "add-header" except that the header name is first
5842 removed if it existed. This is useful when passing security information to
5843 the server, where the header must not be manipulated by external users.
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02005844
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005845http-response set-log-level <level> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5846
5847 This is used to change the log level of the current request when a certain
5848 condition is met. Valid levels are the 8 syslog levels (see the "log"
5849 keyword) plus the special level "silent" which disables logging for this
5850 request. This rule is not final so the last matching rule wins. This rule can
5851 be useful to disable health checks coming from another equipment.
5852
5853http-response set-map(<file-name>) <key fmt> <value fmt>
5854
5855 This is used to add a new entry into a MAP. The MAP must be loaded from a
5856 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be updated is
5857 passed between parentheses. It takes 2 arguments: <key fmt>, which follows
5858 log-format rules, used to collect MAP key, and <value fmt>, which follows
5859 log-format rules, used to collect content for the new entry. It performs a
5860 lookup in the MAP before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or more) values.
5861 This lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive with large lists!
5862 It is the equivalent of the "set map" command from the stats socket, but can
5863 be triggered by an HTTP response.
5864
5865http-response set-mark <mark> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5866
5867 This is used to set the Netfilter MARK on all packets sent to the client to
5868 the value passed in <mark> on platforms which support it. This value is an
5869 unsigned 32 bit value which can be matched by netfilter and by the routing
5870 table. It can be expressed both in decimal or hexadecimal format (prefixed
5871 by "0x"). This can be useful to force certain packets to take a different
5872 route (for example a cheaper network path for bulk downloads). This works on
5873 Linux kernels 2.6.32 and above and requires admin privileges.
5874
5875http-response set-nice <nice> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5876
5877 This sets the "nice" factor of the current request being processed.
5878 It only has effect against the other requests being processed at the same
5879 time. The default value is 0, unless altered by the "nice" setting on the
5880 "bind" line. The accepted range is -1024..1024. The higher the value, the
5881 nicest the request will be. Lower values will make the request more important
5882 than other ones. This can be useful to improve the speed of some requests, or
5883 lower the priority of non-important requests. Using this setting without
5884 prior experimentation can cause some major slowdown.
5885
5886http-response set-status <status> [reason <str>]
5887 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5888
5889 This replaces the response status code with <status> which must be an integer
5890 between 100 and 999. Optionally, a custom reason text can be provided defined
5891 by <str>, or the default reason for the specified code will be used as a
5892 fallback.
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08005893
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02005894 Example:
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005895 # return "431 Request Header Fields Too Large"
5896 http-response set-status 431
5897 # return "503 Slow Down", custom reason
5898 http-response set-status 503 reason "Slow Down".
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02005899
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005900http-response set-tos <tos> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02005901
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005902 This is used to set the TOS or DSCP field value of packets sent to the client
5903 to the value passed in <tos> on platforms which support this.
5904 This value represents the whole 8 bits of the IP TOS field, and can be
5905 expressed both in decimal or hexadecimal format (prefixed by "0x"). Note that
5906 only the 6 higher bits are used in DSCP or TOS, and the two lower bits are
5907 always 0. This can be used to adjust some routing behavior on border routers
5908 based on some information from the request.
5909
5910 See RFC 2474, 2597, 3260 and 4594 for more information.
5911
5912http-response set-var(<var-name>) <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5913
5914 This is used to set the contents of a variable. The variable is declared
5915 inline.
5916
5917 Arguments:
5918 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
5919 scope. The scopes allowed are:
5920 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
5921 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
5922 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction
5923 (request and response)
5924 "req" : the variable is shared only during request
5925 processing
5926 "res" : the variable is shared only during response
5927 processing
5928 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
5929 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.'
5930 and '_'.
5931
5932 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
5933 followed by some converters.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02005934
5935 Example:
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005936 http-response set-var(sess.last_redir) res.hdr(location)
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02005937
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005938http-response silent-drop [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02005939
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005940 This stops the evaluation of the rules and makes the client-facing connection
5941 suddenly disappear using a system-dependent way that tries to prevent the
5942 client from being notified. The effect it then that the client still sees an
5943 established connection while there's none on HAProxy. The purpose is to
5944 achieve a comparable effect to "tarpit" except that it doesn't use any local
5945 resource at all on the machine running HAProxy. It can resist much higher
5946 loads than "tarpit", and slow down stronger attackers. It is important to
5947 understand the impact of using this mechanism. All stateful equipment placed
5948 between the client and HAProxy (firewalls, proxies, load balancers) will also
5949 keep the established connection for a long time and may suffer from this
5950 action.
5951 On modern Linux systems running with enough privileges, the TCP_REPAIR socket
5952 option is used to block the emission of a TCP reset. On other systems, the
5953 socket's TTL is reduced to 1 so that the TCP reset doesn't pass the first
5954 router, though it's still delivered to local networks. Do not use it unless
5955 you fully understand how it works.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02005956
Christopher Faulet46f95542019-12-20 10:07:22 +01005957http-response strict-mode { on | off }
5958
5959 This enables or disables the strict rewriting mode for following rules. It
5960 does not affect rules declared before it and it is only applicable on rules
5961 performing a rewrite on the responses. When the strict mode is enabled, any
5962 rewrite failure triggers an internal error. Otherwise, such errors are
5963 silently ignored. The purpose of the strict rewriting mode is to make some
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +05005964 rewrites optional while others must be performed to continue the response
Christopher Faulet46f95542019-12-20 10:07:22 +01005965 processing.
5966
Christopher Faulet1aea50e2020-01-17 16:03:53 +01005967 By default, the strict rewriting mode is enabled. Its value is also reset
Christopher Faulet46f95542019-12-20 10:07:22 +01005968 when a ruleset evaluation ends. So, for instance, if you change the mode on
5969 the bacnkend, the default mode is restored when HAProxy starts the frontend
5970 rules evaluation.
5971
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005972http-response track-sc0 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5973http-response track-sc1 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5974http-response track-sc2 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02005975
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005976 This enables tracking of sticky counters from current response. Please refer
5977 to "http-request track-sc" for a complete description. The only difference
5978 from "http-request track-sc" is the <key> sample expression can only make use
5979 of samples in response (e.g. res.*, status etc.) and samples below Layer 6
5980 (e.g. SSL-related samples, see section 7.3.4). If the sample is not
5981 supported, haproxy will fail and warn while parsing the config.
5982
5983http-response unset-var(<var-name>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5984
5985 This is used to unset a variable. See "http-response set-var" for details
5986 about <var-name>.
5987
5988 Example:
5989 http-response unset-var(sess.last_redir)
5990
Baptiste Assmann5ecb77f2013-10-06 23:24:13 +02005991
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02005992http-reuse { never | safe | aggressive | always }
5993 Declare how idle HTTP connections may be shared between requests
5994
5995 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5996 yes | no | yes | yes
5997
5998 By default, a connection established between haproxy and the backend server
Olivier Houchard86006a52018-12-14 19:37:49 +01005999 which is considered safe for reuse is moved back to the server's idle
6000 connections pool so that any other request can make use of it. This is the
6001 "safe" strategy below.
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02006002
6003 The argument indicates the desired connection reuse strategy :
6004
Olivier Houchard86006a52018-12-14 19:37:49 +01006005 - "never" : idle connections are never shared between sessions. This mode
6006 may be enforced to cancel a different strategy inherited from
6007 a defaults section or for troubleshooting. For example, if an
6008 old bogus application considers that multiple requests over
6009 the same connection come from the same client and it is not
6010 possible to fix the application, it may be desirable to
6011 disable connection sharing in a single backend. An example of
6012 such an application could be an old haproxy using cookie
6013 insertion in tunnel mode and not checking any request past the
6014 first one.
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02006015
Olivier Houchard86006a52018-12-14 19:37:49 +01006016 - "safe" : this is the default and the recommended strategy. The first
6017 request of a session is always sent over its own connection,
6018 and only subsequent requests may be dispatched over other
6019 existing connections. This ensures that in case the server
6020 closes the connection when the request is being sent, the
6021 browser can decide to silently retry it. Since it is exactly
6022 equivalent to regular keep-alive, there should be no side
6023 effects.
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02006024
6025 - "aggressive" : this mode may be useful in webservices environments where
6026 all servers are not necessarily known and where it would be
6027 appreciable to deliver most first requests over existing
6028 connections. In this case, first requests are only delivered
6029 over existing connections that have been reused at least once,
6030 proving that the server correctly supports connection reuse.
6031 It should only be used when it's sure that the client can
6032 retry a failed request once in a while and where the benefit
Michael Prokop4438c602019-05-24 10:25:45 +02006033 of aggressive connection reuse significantly outweighs the
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02006034 downsides of rare connection failures.
6035
6036 - "always" : this mode is only recommended when the path to the server is
6037 known for never breaking existing connections quickly after
6038 releasing them. It allows the first request of a session to be
6039 sent to an existing connection. This can provide a significant
6040 performance increase over the "safe" strategy when the backend
6041 is a cache farm, since such components tend to show a
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006042 consistent behavior and will benefit from the connection
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02006043 sharing. It is recommended that the "http-keep-alive" timeout
6044 remains low in this mode so that no dead connections remain
6045 usable. In most cases, this will lead to the same performance
6046 gains as "aggressive" but with more risks. It should only be
6047 used when it improves the situation over "aggressive".
6048
6049 When http connection sharing is enabled, a great care is taken to respect the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006050 connection properties and compatibility. Specifically :
6051 - connections made with "usesrc" followed by a client-dependent value
6052 ("client", "clientip", "hdr_ip") are marked private and never shared;
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02006053
6054 - connections sent to a server with a TLS SNI extension are marked private
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006055 and are never shared;
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02006056
Lukas Tribusfd9b68c2018-10-27 20:06:59 +02006057 - connections with certain bogus authentication schemes (relying on the
6058 connection) like NTLM are detected, marked private and are never shared;
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02006059
Lukas Tribuse8adfeb2019-11-06 11:50:25 +01006060 A connection pool is involved and configurable with "pool-max-conn".
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02006061
6062 Note: connection reuse improves the accuracy of the "server maxconn" setting,
6063 because almost no new connection will be established while idle connections
6064 remain available. This is particularly true with the "always" strategy.
6065
6066 See also : "option http-keep-alive", "server maxconn"
6067
6068
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05006069http-send-name-header [<header>]
6070 Add the server name to a request. Use the header string given by <header>
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05006071 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6072 yes | no | yes | yes
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05006073 Arguments :
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05006074 <header> The header string to use to send the server name
6075
Willy Tarreau81bef7e2019-10-07 14:58:02 +02006076 The "http-send-name-header" statement causes the header field named <header>
6077 to be set to the name of the target server at the moment the request is about
6078 to be sent on the wire. Any existing occurrences of this header are removed.
6079 Upon retries and redispatches, the header field is updated to always reflect
6080 the server being attempted to connect to. Given that this header is modified
6081 very late in the connection setup, it may have unexpected effects on already
6082 modified headers. For example using it with transport-level header such as
6083 connection, content-length, transfer-encoding and so on will likely result in
6084 invalid requests being sent to the server. Additionally it has been reported
6085 that this directive is currently being used as a way to overwrite the Host
6086 header field in outgoing requests; while this trick has been known to work
6087 as a side effect of the feature for some time, it is not officially supported
6088 and might possibly not work anymore in a future version depending on the
6089 technical difficulties this feature induces. A long-term solution instead
6090 consists in fixing the application which required this trick so that it binds
6091 to the correct host name.
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05006092
6093 See also : "server"
6094
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +01006095id <value>
Willy Tarreau53fb4ae2009-10-04 23:04:08 +02006096 Set a persistent ID to a proxy.
6097 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6098 no | yes | yes | yes
6099 Arguments : none
6100
6101 Set a persistent ID for the proxy. This ID must be unique and positive.
6102 An unused ID will automatically be assigned if unset. The first assigned
6103 value will be 1. This ID is currently only returned in statistics.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +01006104
6105
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02006106ignore-persist { if | unless } <condition>
6107 Declare a condition to ignore persistence
6108 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Cyril Bonté4288c5a2018-03-12 22:02:59 +01006109 no | no | yes | yes
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02006110
6111 By default, when cookie persistence is enabled, every requests containing
6112 the cookie are unconditionally persistent (assuming the target server is up
6113 and running).
6114
6115 The "ignore-persist" statement allows one to declare various ACL-based
6116 conditions which, when met, will cause a request to ignore persistence.
6117 This is sometimes useful to load balance requests for static files, which
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03006118 often don't require persistence. This can also be used to fully disable
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02006119 persistence for a specific User-Agent (for example, some web crawler bots).
6120
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02006121 The persistence is ignored when an "if" condition is met, or unless an
6122 "unless" condition is met.
6123
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +03006124 Example:
6125 acl url_static path_beg /static /images /img /css
6126 acl url_static path_end .gif .png .jpg .css .js
6127 ignore-persist if url_static
6128
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02006129 See also : "force-persist", "cookie", and section 7 about ACL usage.
6130
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02006131load-server-state-from-file { global | local | none }
6132 Allow seamless reload of HAProxy
6133 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6134 yes | no | yes | yes
6135
6136 This directive points HAProxy to a file where server state from previous
6137 running process has been saved. That way, when starting up, before handling
6138 traffic, the new process can apply old states to servers exactly has if no
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006139 reload occurred. The purpose of the "load-server-state-from-file" directive is
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02006140 to tell haproxy which file to use. For now, only 2 arguments to either prevent
6141 loading state or load states from a file containing all backends and servers.
6142 The state file can be generated by running the command "show servers state"
6143 over the stats socket and redirect output.
6144
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006145 The format of the file is versioned and is very specific. To understand it,
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02006146 please read the documentation of the "show servers state" command (chapter
Willy Tarreau1af20c72017-06-23 16:01:14 +02006147 9.3 of Management Guide).
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02006148
6149 Arguments:
6150 global load the content of the file pointed by the global directive
6151 named "server-state-file".
6152
6153 local load the content of the file pointed by the directive
6154 "server-state-file-name" if set. If not set, then the backend
6155 name is used as a file name.
6156
6157 none don't load any stat for this backend
6158
6159 Notes:
Willy Tarreaue5a60682016-11-09 14:54:53 +01006160 - server's IP address is preserved across reloads by default, but the
6161 order can be changed thanks to the server's "init-addr" setting. This
6162 means that an IP address change performed on the CLI at run time will
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006163 be preserved, and that any change to the local resolver (e.g. /etc/hosts)
Willy Tarreaue5a60682016-11-09 14:54:53 +01006164 will possibly not have any effect if the state file is in use.
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02006165
6166 - server's weight is applied from previous running process unless it has
6167 has changed between previous and new configuration files.
6168
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02006169 Example: Minimal configuration
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02006170
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02006171 global
6172 stats socket /tmp/socket
6173 server-state-file /tmp/server_state
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02006174
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02006175 defaults
6176 load-server-state-from-file global
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02006177
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02006178 backend bk
6179 server s1 127.0.0.1:22 check weight 11
6180 server s2 127.0.0.1:22 check weight 12
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02006181
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02006182
6183 Then one can run :
6184
6185 socat /tmp/socket - <<< "show servers state" > /tmp/server_state
6186
6187 Content of the file /tmp/server_state would be like this:
6188
6189 1
6190 # <field names skipped for the doc example>
6191 1 bk 1 s1 127.0.0.1 2 0 11 11 4 6 3 4 6 0 0
6192 1 bk 2 s2 127.0.0.1 2 0 12 12 4 6 3 4 6 0 0
6193
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02006194 Example: Minimal configuration
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02006195
6196 global
6197 stats socket /tmp/socket
6198 server-state-base /etc/haproxy/states
6199
6200 defaults
6201 load-server-state-from-file local
6202
6203 backend bk
6204 server s1 127.0.0.1:22 check weight 11
6205 server s2 127.0.0.1:22 check weight 12
6206
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02006207
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02006208 Then one can run :
6209
6210 socat /tmp/socket - <<< "show servers state bk" > /etc/haproxy/states/bk
6211
6212 Content of the file /etc/haproxy/states/bk would be like this:
6213
6214 1
6215 # <field names skipped for the doc example>
6216 1 bk 1 s1 127.0.0.1 2 0 11 11 4 6 3 4 6 0 0
6217 1 bk 2 s2 127.0.0.1 2 0 12 12 4 6 3 4 6 0 0
6218
6219 See also: "server-state-file", "server-state-file-name", and
6220 "show servers state"
6221
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02006222
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01006223log global
Frédéric Lécailled690dfa2019-04-25 10:52:17 +02006224log <address> [len <length>] [format <format>] [sample <ranges>:<smp_size>]
6225 <facility> [<level> [<minlevel>]]
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02006226no log
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01006227 Enable per-instance logging of events and traffic.
6228 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6229 yes | yes | yes | yes
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02006230
6231 Prefix :
6232 no should be used when the logger list must be flushed. For example,
6233 if you don't want to inherit from the default logger list. This
6234 prefix does not allow arguments.
6235
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01006236 Arguments :
6237 global should be used when the instance's logging parameters are the
6238 same as the global ones. This is the most common usage. "global"
6239 replaces <address>, <facility> and <level> with those of the log
6240 entries found in the "global" section. Only one "log global"
6241 statement may be used per instance, and this form takes no other
6242 parameter.
6243
6244 <address> indicates where to send the logs. It takes the same format as
6245 for the "global" section's logs, and can be one of :
6246
6247 - An IPv4 address optionally followed by a colon (':') and a UDP
6248 port. If no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the
6249 standard syslog port).
6250
David du Colombier24bb5f52011-03-17 10:40:23 +01006251 - An IPv6 address followed by a colon (':') and optionally a UDP
6252 port. If no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the
6253 standard syslog port).
6254
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01006255 - A filesystem path to a UNIX domain socket, keeping in mind
6256 considerations for chroot (be sure the path is accessible
6257 inside the chroot) and uid/gid (be sure the path is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006258 appropriately writable).
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01006259
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +01006260 - A file descriptor number in the form "fd@<number>", which may
6261 point to a pipe, terminal, or socket. In this case unbuffered
6262 logs are used and one writev() call per log is performed. This
6263 is a bit expensive but acceptable for most workloads. Messages
6264 sent this way will not be truncated but may be dropped, in
6265 which case the DroppedLogs counter will be incremented. The
6266 writev() call is atomic even on pipes for messages up to
6267 PIPE_BUF size, which POSIX recommends to be at least 512 and
6268 which is 4096 bytes on most modern operating systems. Any
6269 larger message may be interleaved with messages from other
6270 processes. Exceptionally for debugging purposes the file
6271 descriptor may also be directed to a file, but doing so will
6272 significantly slow haproxy down as non-blocking calls will be
6273 ignored. Also there will be no way to purge nor rotate this
6274 file without restarting the process. Note that the configured
6275 syslog format is preserved, so the output is suitable for use
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01006276 with a TCP syslog server. See also the "short" and "raw"
6277 formats below.
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +01006278
6279 - "stdout" / "stderr", which are respectively aliases for "fd@1"
6280 and "fd@2", see above.
6281
Willy Tarreauc046d162019-08-30 15:24:59 +02006282 - A ring buffer in the form "ring@<name>", which will correspond
6283 to an in-memory ring buffer accessible over the CLI using the
6284 "show events" command, which will also list existing rings and
6285 their sizes. Such buffers are lost on reload or restart but
6286 when used as a complement this can help troubleshooting by
6287 having the logs instantly available.
6288
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +01006289 You may want to reference some environment variables in the
6290 address parameter, see section 2.3 about environment variables.
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01006291
Willy Tarreau18324f52014-06-27 18:10:07 +02006292 <length> is an optional maximum line length. Log lines larger than this
6293 value will be truncated before being sent. The reason is that
6294 syslog servers act differently on log line length. All servers
6295 support the default value of 1024, but some servers simply drop
6296 larger lines while others do log them. If a server supports long
6297 lines, it may make sense to set this value here in order to avoid
6298 truncating long lines. Similarly, if a server drops long lines,
6299 it is preferable to truncate them before sending them. Accepted
6300 values are 80 to 65535 inclusive. The default value of 1024 is
6301 generally fine for all standard usages. Some specific cases of
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006302 long captures or JSON-formatted logs may require larger values.
Willy Tarreau18324f52014-06-27 18:10:07 +02006303
Frédéric Lécailled690dfa2019-04-25 10:52:17 +02006304 <ranges> A list of comma-separated ranges to identify the logs to sample.
6305 This is used to balance the load of the logs to send to the log
6306 server. The limits of the ranges cannot be null. They are numbered
6307 from 1. The size or period (in number of logs) of the sample must
6308 be set with <sample_size> parameter.
6309
6310 <sample_size>
6311 The size of the sample in number of logs to consider when balancing
6312 their logging loads. It is used to balance the load of the logs to
6313 send to the syslog server. This size must be greater or equal to the
6314 maximum of the high limits of the ranges.
6315 (see also <ranges> parameter).
6316
Willy Tarreauadb345d2018-11-12 07:56:13 +01006317 <format> is the log format used when generating syslog messages. It may be
6318 one of the following :
6319
6320 rfc3164 The RFC3164 syslog message format. This is the default.
6321 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc3164)
6322
6323 rfc5424 The RFC5424 syslog message format.
6324 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc5424)
6325
Willy Tarreaue8746a02018-11-12 08:45:00 +01006326 short A message containing only a level between angle brackets such as
6327 '<3>', followed by the text. The PID, date, time, process name
6328 and system name are omitted. This is designed to be used with a
6329 local log server. This format is compatible with what the
6330 systemd logger consumes.
6331
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01006332 raw A message containing only the text. The level, PID, date, time,
6333 process name and system name are omitted. This is designed to
6334 be used in containers or during development, where the severity
6335 only depends on the file descriptor used (stdout/stderr).
6336
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01006337 <facility> must be one of the 24 standard syslog facilities :
6338
Willy Tarreaue8746a02018-11-12 08:45:00 +01006339 kern user mail daemon auth syslog lpr news
6340 uucp cron auth2 ftp ntp audit alert cron2
6341 local0 local1 local2 local3 local4 local5 local6 local7
6342
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01006343 Note that the facility is ignored for the "short" and "raw"
6344 formats, but still required as a positional field. It is
6345 recommended to use "daemon" in this case to make it clear that
6346 it's only supposed to be used locally.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01006347
6348 <level> is optional and can be specified to filter outgoing messages. By
6349 default, all messages are sent. If a level is specified, only
6350 messages with a severity at least as important as this level
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +02006351 will be sent. An optional minimum level can be specified. If it
6352 is set, logs emitted with a more severe level than this one will
6353 be capped to this level. This is used to avoid sending "emerg"
6354 messages on all terminals on some default syslog configurations.
6355 Eight levels are known :
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01006356
6357 emerg alert crit err warning notice info debug
6358
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02006359 It is important to keep in mind that it is the frontend which decides what to
6360 log from a connection, and that in case of content switching, the log entries
6361 from the backend will be ignored. Connections are logged at level "info".
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01006362
6363 However, backend log declaration define how and where servers status changes
6364 will be logged. Level "notice" will be used to indicate a server going up,
6365 "warning" will be used for termination signals and definitive service
6366 termination, and "alert" will be used for when a server goes down.
6367
6368 Note : According to RFC3164, messages are truncated to 1024 bytes before
6369 being emitted.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01006370
6371 Example :
6372 log global
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01006373 log stdout format short daemon # send log to systemd
6374 log stdout format raw daemon # send everything to stdout
6375 log stderr format raw daemon notice # send important events to stderr
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +02006376 log 127.0.0.1:514 local0 notice # only send important events
6377 log 127.0.0.1:514 local0 notice notice # same but limit output level
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02006378 log "${LOCAL_SYSLOG}:514" local0 notice # send to local server
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01006379
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01006380
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01006381log-format <string>
Willy Tarreaufb4e7ea2015-01-07 14:55:17 +01006382 Specifies the log format string to use for traffic logs
6383 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6384 yes | yes | yes | no
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01006385
Willy Tarreaufb4e7ea2015-01-07 14:55:17 +01006386 This directive specifies the log format string that will be used for all logs
6387 resulting from traffic passing through the frontend using this line. If the
6388 directive is used in a defaults section, all subsequent frontends will use
6389 the same log format. Please see section 8.2.4 which covers the log format
6390 string in depth.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01006391
Guillaume de Lafond29f45602017-03-31 19:52:15 +02006392 "log-format" directive overrides previous "option tcplog", "log-format" and
6393 "option httplog" directives.
6394
Dragan Dosen7ad31542015-09-28 17:16:47 +02006395log-format-sd <string>
6396 Specifies the RFC5424 structured-data log format string
6397 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6398 yes | yes | yes | no
6399
6400 This directive specifies the RFC5424 structured-data log format string that
6401 will be used for all logs resulting from traffic passing through the frontend
6402 using this line. If the directive is used in a defaults section, all
6403 subsequent frontends will use the same log format. Please see section 8.2.4
6404 which covers the log format string in depth.
6405
6406 See https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc5424#section-6.3 for more information
6407 about the RFC5424 structured-data part.
6408
6409 Note : This log format string will be used only for loggers that have set
6410 log format to "rfc5424".
6411
6412 Example :
6413 log-format-sd [exampleSDID@1234\ bytes=\"%B\"\ status=\"%ST\"]
6414
6415
Willy Tarreau094af4e2015-01-07 15:03:42 +01006416log-tag <string>
6417 Specifies the log tag to use for all outgoing logs
6418 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6419 yes | yes | yes | yes
6420
6421 Sets the tag field in the syslog header to this string. It defaults to the
6422 log-tag set in the global section, otherwise the program name as launched
6423 from the command line, which usually is "haproxy". Sometimes it can be useful
6424 to differentiate between multiple processes running on the same host, or to
6425 differentiate customer instances running in the same process. In the backend,
6426 logs about servers up/down will use this tag. As a hint, it can be convenient
6427 to set a log-tag related to a hosted customer in a defaults section then put
6428 all the frontends and backends for that customer, then start another customer
6429 in a new defaults section. See also the global "log-tag" directive.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01006430
Willy Tarreauc35362a2014-04-25 13:58:37 +02006431max-keep-alive-queue <value>
6432 Set the maximum server queue size for maintaining keep-alive connections
6433 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6434 yes | no | yes | yes
6435
6436 HTTP keep-alive tries to reuse the same server connection whenever possible,
6437 but sometimes it can be counter-productive, for example if a server has a lot
6438 of connections while other ones are idle. This is especially true for static
6439 servers.
6440
6441 The purpose of this setting is to set a threshold on the number of queued
6442 connections at which haproxy stops trying to reuse the same server and prefers
6443 to find another one. The default value, -1, means there is no limit. A value
6444 of zero means that keep-alive requests will never be queued. For very close
6445 servers which can be reached with a low latency and which are not sensible to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006446 breaking keep-alive, a low value is recommended (e.g. local static server can
Willy Tarreauc35362a2014-04-25 13:58:37 +02006447 use a value of 10 or less). For remote servers suffering from a high latency,
6448 higher values might be needed to cover for the latency and/or the cost of
6449 picking a different server.
6450
6451 Note that this has no impact on responses which are maintained to the same
6452 server consecutively to a 401 response. They will still go to the same server
6453 even if they have to be queued.
6454
6455 See also : "option http-server-close", "option prefer-last-server", server
6456 "maxconn" and cookie persistence.
6457
Olivier Houcharda4d4fdf2018-12-14 19:27:06 +01006458max-session-srv-conns <nb>
6459 Set the maximum number of outgoing connections we can keep idling for a given
6460 client session. The default is 5 (it precisely equals MAX_SRV_LIST which is
6461 defined at build time).
Willy Tarreauc35362a2014-04-25 13:58:37 +02006462
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01006463maxconn <conns>
6464 Fix the maximum number of concurrent connections on a frontend
6465 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6466 yes | yes | yes | no
6467 Arguments :
6468 <conns> is the maximum number of concurrent connections the frontend will
6469 accept to serve. Excess connections will be queued by the system
6470 in the socket's listen queue and will be served once a connection
6471 closes.
6472
6473 If the system supports it, it can be useful on big sites to raise this limit
6474 very high so that haproxy manages connection queues, instead of leaving the
6475 clients with unanswered connection attempts. This value should not exceed the
6476 global maxconn. Also, keep in mind that a connection contains two buffers
Baptiste Assmann79fb45d2016-03-06 23:34:31 +01006477 of tune.bufsize (16kB by default) each, as well as some other data resulting
6478 in about 33 kB of RAM being consumed per established connection. That means
6479 that a medium system equipped with 1GB of RAM can withstand around
6480 20000-25000 concurrent connections if properly tuned.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01006481
6482 Also, when <conns> is set to large values, it is possible that the servers
6483 are not sized to accept such loads, and for this reason it is generally wise
6484 to assign them some reasonable connection limits.
6485
Willy Tarreauc8d5b952019-02-27 17:25:52 +01006486 When this value is set to zero, which is the default, the global "maxconn"
6487 value is used.
Vincent Bernat6341be52012-06-27 17:18:30 +02006488
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01006489 See also : "server", global section's "maxconn", "fullconn"
6490
6491
6492mode { tcp|http|health }
6493 Set the running mode or protocol of the instance
6494 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6495 yes | yes | yes | yes
6496 Arguments :
6497 tcp The instance will work in pure TCP mode. A full-duplex connection
6498 will be established between clients and servers, and no layer 7
6499 examination will be performed. This is the default mode. It
6500 should be used for SSL, SSH, SMTP, ...
6501
6502 http The instance will work in HTTP mode. The client request will be
6503 analyzed in depth before connecting to any server. Any request
6504 which is not RFC-compliant will be rejected. Layer 7 filtering,
6505 processing and switching will be possible. This is the mode which
6506 brings HAProxy most of its value.
6507
6508 health The instance will work in "health" mode. It will just reply "OK"
Willy Tarreau82569f92012-09-27 23:48:56 +02006509 to incoming connections and close the connection. Alternatively,
6510 If the "httpchk" option is set, "HTTP/1.0 200 OK" will be sent
6511 instead. Nothing will be logged in either case. This mode is used
6512 to reply to external components health checks. This mode is
6513 deprecated and should not be used anymore as it is possible to do
6514 the same and even better by combining TCP or HTTP modes with the
6515 "monitor" keyword.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01006516
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02006517 When doing content switching, it is mandatory that the frontend and the
6518 backend are in the same mode (generally HTTP), otherwise the configuration
6519 will be refused.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01006520
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02006521 Example :
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01006522 defaults http_instances
6523 mode http
6524
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02006525 See also : "monitor", "monitor-net"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01006526
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01006527
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01006528monitor fail { if | unless } <condition>
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01006529 Add a condition to report a failure to a monitor HTTP request.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01006530 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6531 no | yes | yes | no
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01006532 Arguments :
6533 if <cond> the monitor request will fail if the condition is satisfied,
6534 and will succeed otherwise. The condition should describe a
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01006535 combined test which must induce a failure if all conditions
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01006536 are met, for instance a low number of servers both in a
6537 backend and its backup.
6538
6539 unless <cond> the monitor request will succeed only if the condition is
6540 satisfied, and will fail otherwise. Such a condition may be
6541 based on a test on the presence of a minimum number of active
6542 servers in a list of backends.
6543
6544 This statement adds a condition which can force the response to a monitor
6545 request to report a failure. By default, when an external component queries
6546 the URI dedicated to monitoring, a 200 response is returned. When one of the
6547 conditions above is met, haproxy will return 503 instead of 200. This is
6548 very useful to report a site failure to an external component which may base
6549 routing advertisements between multiple sites on the availability reported by
6550 haproxy. In this case, one would rely on an ACL involving the "nbsrv"
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02006551 criterion. Note that "monitor fail" only works in HTTP mode. Both status
6552 messages may be tweaked using "errorfile" or "errorloc" if needed.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01006553
6554 Example:
6555 frontend www
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01006556 mode http
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01006557 acl site_dead nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2
6558 acl site_dead nbsrv(static) lt 2
6559 monitor-uri /site_alive
6560 monitor fail if site_dead
6561
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02006562 See also : "monitor-net", "monitor-uri", "errorfile", "errorloc"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01006563
6564
6565monitor-net <source>
6566 Declare a source network which is limited to monitor requests
6567 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6568 yes | yes | yes | no
6569 Arguments :
6570 <source> is the source IPv4 address or network which will only be able to
6571 get monitor responses to any request. It can be either an IPv4
6572 address, a host name, or an address followed by a slash ('/')
6573 followed by a mask.
6574
6575 In TCP mode, any connection coming from a source matching <source> will cause
6576 the connection to be immediately closed without any log. This allows another
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01006577 equipment to probe the port and verify that it is still listening, without
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01006578 forwarding the connection to a remote server.
6579
6580 In HTTP mode, a connection coming from a source matching <source> will be
6581 accepted, the following response will be sent without waiting for a request,
6582 then the connection will be closed : "HTTP/1.0 200 OK". This is normally
6583 enough for any front-end HTTP probe to detect that the service is UP and
Willy Tarreau82569f92012-09-27 23:48:56 +02006584 running without forwarding the request to a backend server. Note that this
6585 response is sent in raw format, without any transformation. This is important
6586 as it means that it will not be SSL-encrypted on SSL listeners.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01006587
Willy Tarreau82569f92012-09-27 23:48:56 +02006588 Monitor requests are processed very early, just after tcp-request connection
6589 ACLs which are the only ones able to block them. These connections are short
6590 lived and never wait for any data from the client. They cannot be logged, and
6591 it is the intended purpose. They are only used to report HAProxy's health to
6592 an upper component, nothing more. Please note that "monitor fail" rules do
6593 not apply to connections intercepted by "monitor-net".
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01006594
Willy Tarreau95cd2832010-03-04 23:36:33 +01006595 Last, please note that only one "monitor-net" statement can be specified in
6596 a frontend. If more than one is found, only the last one will be considered.
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02006597
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01006598 Example :
6599 # addresses .252 and .253 are just probing us.
6600 frontend www
6601 monitor-net 192.168.0.252/31
6602
6603 See also : "monitor fail", "monitor-uri"
6604
6605
6606monitor-uri <uri>
6607 Intercept a URI used by external components' monitor requests
6608 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6609 yes | yes | yes | no
6610 Arguments :
6611 <uri> is the exact URI which we want to intercept to return HAProxy's
6612 health status instead of forwarding the request.
6613
6614 When an HTTP request referencing <uri> will be received on a frontend,
6615 HAProxy will not forward it nor log it, but instead will return either
6616 "HTTP/1.0 200 OK" or "HTTP/1.0 503 Service unavailable", depending on failure
6617 conditions defined with "monitor fail". This is normally enough for any
6618 front-end HTTP probe to detect that the service is UP and running without
6619 forwarding the request to a backend server. Note that the HTTP method, the
6620 version and all headers are ignored, but the request must at least be valid
6621 at the HTTP level. This keyword may only be used with an HTTP-mode frontend.
6622
Willy Tarreau721d8e02017-12-01 18:25:08 +01006623 Monitor requests are processed very early, just after the request is parsed
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +02006624 and even before any "http-request". The only rulesets applied before are the
6625 tcp-request ones. They cannot be logged either, and it is the intended
6626 purpose. They are only used to report HAProxy's health to an upper component,
6627 nothing more. However, it is possible to add any number of conditions using
6628 "monitor fail" and ACLs so that the result can be adjusted to whatever check
6629 can be imagined (most often the number of available servers in a backend).
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01006630
Christopher Faulet6072beb2020-02-18 15:34:58 +01006631 Note: if <uri> starts by a slash ('/'), the matching is performed against the
6632 request's path instead of the request's uri. It is a workaround to let
6633 the HTTP/2 requests match the monitor-uri. Indeed, in HTTP/2, clients
6634 are encouraged to send absolute URIs only.
6635
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01006636 Example :
6637 # Use /haproxy_test to report haproxy's status
6638 frontend www
6639 mode http
6640 monitor-uri /haproxy_test
6641
6642 See also : "monitor fail", "monitor-net"
6643
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01006644
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006645option abortonclose
6646no option abortonclose
6647 Enable or disable early dropping of aborted requests pending in queues.
6648 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6649 yes | no | yes | yes
6650 Arguments : none
6651
6652 In presence of very high loads, the servers will take some time to respond.
6653 The per-instance connection queue will inflate, and the response time will
6654 increase respective to the size of the queue times the average per-session
6655 response time. When clients will wait for more than a few seconds, they will
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01006656 often hit the "STOP" button on their browser, leaving a useless request in
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006657 the queue, and slowing down other users, and the servers as well, because the
6658 request will eventually be served, then aborted at the first error
6659 encountered while delivering the response.
6660
6661 As there is no way to distinguish between a full STOP and a simple output
6662 close on the client side, HTTP agents should be conservative and consider
6663 that the client might only have closed its output channel while waiting for
6664 the response. However, this introduces risks of congestion when lots of users
6665 do the same, and is completely useless nowadays because probably no client at
6666 all will close the session while waiting for the response. Some HTTP agents
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006667 support this behavior (Squid, Apache, HAProxy), and others do not (TUX, most
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006668 hardware-based load balancers). So the probability for a closed input channel
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01006669 to represent a user hitting the "STOP" button is close to 100%, and the risk
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006670 of being the single component to break rare but valid traffic is extremely
6671 low, which adds to the temptation to be able to abort a session early while
6672 still not served and not pollute the servers.
6673
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006674 In HAProxy, the user can choose the desired behavior using the option
6675 "abortonclose". By default (without the option) the behavior is HTTP
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006676 compliant and aborted requests will be served. But when the option is
6677 specified, a session with an incoming channel closed will be aborted while
6678 it is still possible, either pending in the queue for a connection slot, or
6679 during the connection establishment if the server has not yet acknowledged
6680 the connection request. This considerably reduces the queue size and the load
6681 on saturated servers when users are tempted to click on STOP, which in turn
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01006682 reduces the response time for other users.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006683
6684 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6685 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6686
6687 See also : "timeout queue" and server's "maxconn" and "maxqueue" parameters
6688
6689
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02006690option accept-invalid-http-request
6691no option accept-invalid-http-request
6692 Enable or disable relaxing of HTTP request parsing
6693 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6694 yes | yes | yes | no
6695 Arguments : none
6696
Willy Tarreau91852eb2015-05-01 13:26:00 +02006697 By default, HAProxy complies with RFC7230 in terms of message parsing. This
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02006698 means that invalid characters in header names are not permitted and cause an
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006699 error to be returned to the client. This is the desired behavior as such
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02006700 forbidden characters are essentially used to build attacks exploiting server
6701 weaknesses, and bypass security filtering. Sometimes, a buggy browser or
6702 server will emit invalid header names for whatever reason (configuration,
6703 implementation) and the issue will not be immediately fixed. In such a case,
6704 it is possible to relax HAProxy's header name parser to accept any character
Willy Tarreau422246e2012-01-07 23:54:13 +01006705 even if that does not make sense, by specifying this option. Similarly, the
6706 list of characters allowed to appear in a URI is well defined by RFC3986, and
6707 chars 0-31, 32 (space), 34 ('"'), 60 ('<'), 62 ('>'), 92 ('\'), 94 ('^'), 96
6708 ('`'), 123 ('{'), 124 ('|'), 125 ('}'), 127 (delete) and anything above are
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006709 not allowed at all. HAProxy always blocks a number of them (0..32, 127). The
Willy Tarreau91852eb2015-05-01 13:26:00 +02006710 remaining ones are blocked by default unless this option is enabled. This
Willy Tarreau13317662015-05-01 13:47:08 +02006711 option also relaxes the test on the HTTP version, it allows HTTP/0.9 requests
6712 to pass through (no version specified) and multiple digits for both the major
6713 and the minor version.
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02006714
6715 This option should never be enabled by default as it hides application bugs
6716 and open security breaches. It should only be deployed after a problem has
6717 been confirmed.
6718
6719 When this option is enabled, erroneous header names will still be accepted in
6720 requests, but the complete request will be captured in order to permit later
Willy Tarreau422246e2012-01-07 23:54:13 +01006721 analysis using the "show errors" request on the UNIX stats socket. Similarly,
6722 requests containing invalid chars in the URI part will be logged. Doing this
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02006723 also helps confirming that the issue has been solved.
6724
6725 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6726 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6727
6728 See also : "option accept-invalid-http-response" and "show errors" on the
6729 stats socket.
6730
6731
6732option accept-invalid-http-response
6733no option accept-invalid-http-response
6734 Enable or disable relaxing of HTTP response parsing
6735 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6736 yes | no | yes | yes
6737 Arguments : none
6738
Willy Tarreau91852eb2015-05-01 13:26:00 +02006739 By default, HAProxy complies with RFC7230 in terms of message parsing. This
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02006740 means that invalid characters in header names are not permitted and cause an
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006741 error to be returned to the client. This is the desired behavior as such
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02006742 forbidden characters are essentially used to build attacks exploiting server
6743 weaknesses, and bypass security filtering. Sometimes, a buggy browser or
6744 server will emit invalid header names for whatever reason (configuration,
6745 implementation) and the issue will not be immediately fixed. In such a case,
6746 it is possible to relax HAProxy's header name parser to accept any character
Willy Tarreau91852eb2015-05-01 13:26:00 +02006747 even if that does not make sense, by specifying this option. This option also
6748 relaxes the test on the HTTP version format, it allows multiple digits for
6749 both the major and the minor version.
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02006750
6751 This option should never be enabled by default as it hides application bugs
6752 and open security breaches. It should only be deployed after a problem has
6753 been confirmed.
6754
6755 When this option is enabled, erroneous header names will still be accepted in
6756 responses, but the complete response will be captured in order to permit
6757 later analysis using the "show errors" request on the UNIX stats socket.
6758 Doing this also helps confirming that the issue has been solved.
6759
6760 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6761 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6762
6763 See also : "option accept-invalid-http-request" and "show errors" on the
6764 stats socket.
6765
6766
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006767option allbackups
6768no option allbackups
6769 Use either all backup servers at a time or only the first one
6770 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6771 yes | no | yes | yes
6772 Arguments : none
6773
6774 By default, the first operational backup server gets all traffic when normal
6775 servers are all down. Sometimes, it may be preferred to use multiple backups
6776 at once, because one will not be enough. When "option allbackups" is enabled,
6777 the load balancing will be performed among all backup servers when all normal
6778 ones are unavailable. The same load balancing algorithm will be used and the
6779 servers' weights will be respected. Thus, there will not be any priority
6780 order between the backup servers anymore.
6781
6782 This option is mostly used with static server farms dedicated to return a
6783 "sorry" page when an application is completely offline.
6784
6785 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6786 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6787
6788
6789option checkcache
6790no option checkcache
Godbach7056a352013-12-11 20:01:07 +08006791 Analyze all server responses and block responses with cacheable cookies
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006792 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6793 yes | no | yes | yes
6794 Arguments : none
6795
6796 Some high-level frameworks set application cookies everywhere and do not
6797 always let enough control to the developer to manage how the responses should
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01006798 be cached. When a session cookie is returned on a cacheable object, there is a
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006799 high risk of session crossing or stealing between users traversing the same
6800 caches. In some situations, it is better to block the response than to let
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +02006801 some sensitive session information go in the wild.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006802
6803 The option "checkcache" enables deep inspection of all server responses for
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01006804 strict compliance with HTTP specification in terms of cacheability. It
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01006805 carefully checks "Cache-control", "Pragma" and "Set-cookie" headers in server
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006806 response to check if there's a risk of caching a cookie on a client-side
6807 proxy. When this option is enabled, the only responses which can be delivered
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01006808 to the client are :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006809 - all those without "Set-Cookie" header;
Willy Tarreauc55ddce2017-12-21 11:41:38 +01006810 - all those with a return code other than 200, 203, 204, 206, 300, 301,
6811 404, 405, 410, 414, 501, provided that the server has not set a
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006812 "Cache-control: public" header field;
Willy Tarreau24ea0bc2017-12-21 11:32:55 +01006813 - all those that result from a request using a method other than GET, HEAD,
6814 OPTIONS, TRACE, provided that the server has not set a 'Cache-Control:
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006815 public' header field;
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006816 - those with a 'Pragma: no-cache' header
6817 - those with a 'Cache-control: private' header
6818 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-store' header
6819 - those with a 'Cache-control: max-age=0' header
6820 - those with a 'Cache-control: s-maxage=0' header
6821 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache' header
6822 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache="set-cookie"' header
6823 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache="set-cookie,' header
6824 (allowing other fields after set-cookie)
6825
6826 If a response doesn't respect these requirements, then it will be blocked
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +02006827 just as if it was from an "http-response deny" rule, with an "HTTP 502 bad
6828 gateway". The session state shows "PH--" meaning that the proxy blocked the
6829 response during headers processing. Additionally, an alert will be sent in
6830 the logs so that admins are informed that there's something to be fixed.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006831
6832 Due to the high impact on the application, the application should be tested
6833 in depth with the option enabled before going to production. It is also a
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01006834 good practice to always activate it during tests, even if it is not used in
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006835 production, as it will report potentially dangerous application behaviors.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006836
6837 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6838 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6839
6840
6841option clitcpka
6842no option clitcpka
6843 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on the client side
6844 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6845 yes | yes | yes | no
6846 Arguments : none
6847
6848 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
6849 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006850 periods (e.g. remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006851 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
6852
6853 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
6854 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
6855 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
6856 operating system and its tuning parameters.
6857
6858 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
6859 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
6860 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
6861 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
6862 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
6863
6864 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
6865
6866 Using option "clitcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on the
6867 client side of a connection, which should help when session expirations are
6868 noticed between HAProxy and a client.
6869
6870 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6871 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6872
6873 See also : "option srvtcpka", "option tcpka"
6874
6875
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01006876option contstats
6877 Enable continuous traffic statistics updates
6878 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6879 yes | yes | yes | no
6880 Arguments : none
6881
6882 By default, counters used for statistics calculation are incremented
6883 only when a session finishes. It works quite well when serving small
6884 objects, but with big ones (for example large images or archives) or
6885 with A/V streaming, a graph generated from haproxy counters looks like
Willy Tarreaudef0d222016-11-08 22:03:00 +01006886 a hedgehog. With this option enabled counters get incremented frequently
6887 along the session, typically every 5 seconds, which is often enough to
6888 produce clean graphs. Recounting touches a hotpath directly so it is not
6889 not enabled by default, as it can cause a lot of wakeups for very large
6890 session counts and cause a small performance drop.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01006891
6892
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02006893option dontlog-normal
6894no option dontlog-normal
6895 Enable or disable logging of normal, successful connections
6896 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6897 yes | yes | yes | no
6898 Arguments : none
6899
6900 There are large sites dealing with several thousand connections per second
6901 and for which logging is a major pain. Some of them are even forced to turn
6902 logs off and cannot debug production issues. Setting this option ensures that
6903 normal connections, those which experience no error, no timeout, no retry nor
6904 redispatch, will not be logged. This leaves disk space for anomalies. In HTTP
6905 mode, the response status code is checked and return codes 5xx will still be
6906 logged.
6907
6908 It is strongly discouraged to use this option as most of the time, the key to
6909 complex issues is in the normal logs which will not be logged here. If you
6910 need to separate logs, see the "log-separate-errors" option instead.
6911
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006912 See also : "log", "dontlognull", "log-separate-errors" and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02006913 logging.
6914
6915
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006916option dontlognull
6917no option dontlognull
6918 Enable or disable logging of null connections
6919 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6920 yes | yes | yes | no
6921 Arguments : none
6922
6923 In certain environments, there are components which will regularly connect to
6924 various systems to ensure that they are still alive. It can be the case from
6925 another load balancer as well as from monitoring systems. By default, even a
6926 simple port probe or scan will produce a log. If those connections pollute
6927 the logs too much, it is possible to enable option "dontlognull" to indicate
6928 that a connection on which no data has been transferred will not be logged,
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02006929 which typically corresponds to those probes. Note that errors will still be
6930 returned to the client and accounted for in the stats. If this is not what is
6931 desired, option http-ignore-probes can be used instead.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006932
6933 It is generally recommended not to use this option in uncontrolled
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006934 environments (e.g. internet), otherwise scans and other malicious activities
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006935 would not be logged.
6936
6937 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6938 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6939
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02006940 See also : "log", "http-ignore-probes", "monitor-net", "monitor-uri", and
6941 section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006942
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006943
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02006944option forwardfor [ except <network> ] [ header <name> ] [ if-none ]
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006945 Enable insertion of the X-Forwarded-For header to requests sent to servers
6946 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6947 yes | yes | yes | yes
6948 Arguments :
6949 <network> is an optional argument used to disable this option for sources
6950 matching <network>
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02006951 <name> an optional argument to specify a different "X-Forwarded-For"
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01006952 header name.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006953
6954 Since HAProxy works in reverse-proxy mode, the servers see its IP address as
6955 their client address. This is sometimes annoying when the client's IP address
6956 is expected in server logs. To solve this problem, the well-known HTTP header
6957 "X-Forwarded-For" may be added by HAProxy to all requests sent to the server.
6958 This header contains a value representing the client's IP address. Since this
6959 header is always appended at the end of the existing header list, the server
6960 must be configured to always use the last occurrence of this header only. See
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02006961 the server's manual to find how to enable use of this standard header. Note
6962 that only the last occurrence of the header must be used, since it is really
6963 possible that the client has already brought one.
6964
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01006965 The keyword "header" may be used to supply a different header name to replace
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02006966 the default "X-Forwarded-For". This can be useful where you might already
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006967 have a "X-Forwarded-For" header from a different application (e.g. stunnel),
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01006968 and you need preserve it. Also if your backend server doesn't use the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006969 "X-Forwarded-For" header and requires different one (e.g. Zeus Web Servers
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02006970 require "X-Cluster-Client-IP").
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006971
6972 Sometimes, a same HAProxy instance may be shared between a direct client
6973 access and a reverse-proxy access (for instance when an SSL reverse-proxy is
6974 used to decrypt HTTPS traffic). It is possible to disable the addition of the
6975 header for a known source address or network by adding the "except" keyword
6976 followed by the network address. In this case, any source IP matching the
6977 network will not cause an addition of this header. Most common uses are with
6978 private networks or 127.0.0.1.
6979
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02006980 Alternatively, the keyword "if-none" states that the header will only be
6981 added if it is not present. This should only be used in perfectly trusted
6982 environment, as this might cause a security issue if headers reaching haproxy
6983 are under the control of the end-user.
6984
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006985 This option may be specified either in the frontend or in the backend. If at
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02006986 least one of them uses it, the header will be added. Note that the backend's
6987 setting of the header subargument takes precedence over the frontend's if
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02006988 both are defined. In the case of the "if-none" argument, if at least one of
6989 the frontend or the backend does not specify it, it wants the addition to be
6990 mandatory, so it wins.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006991
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02006992 Example :
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006993 # Public HTTP address also used by stunnel on the same machine
6994 frontend www
6995 mode http
6996 option forwardfor except 127.0.0.1 # stunnel already adds the header
6997
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02006998 # Those servers want the IP Address in X-Client
6999 backend www
7000 mode http
7001 option forwardfor header X-Client
7002
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02007003 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-server-close",
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02007004 "option http-keep-alive"
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01007005
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02007006
Christopher Faulet98fbe952019-07-22 16:18:24 +02007007option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client
7008no option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client
7009 Enable or disable the case adjustment of HTTP/1 headers sent to bogus clients
7010 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7011 yes | yes | yes | no
7012 Arguments : none
7013
7014 There is no standard case for header names because, as stated in RFC7230,
7015 they are case-insensitive. So applications must handle them in a case-
7016 insensitive manner. But some bogus applications violate the standards and
7017 erroneously rely on the cases most commonly used by browsers. This problem
7018 becomes critical with HTTP/2 because all header names must be exchanged in
7019 lower case, and HAProxy follows the same convention. All header names are
7020 sent in lower case to clients and servers, regardless of the HTTP version.
7021
7022 When HAProxy receives an HTTP/1 response, its header names are converted to
7023 lower case and manipulated and sent this way to the clients. If a client is
7024 known to violate the HTTP standards and to fail to process a response coming
7025 from HAProxy, it is possible to transform the lower case header names to a
7026 different format when the response is formatted and sent to the client, by
7027 enabling this option and specifying the list of headers to be reformatted
7028 using the global directives "h1-case-adjust" or "h1-case-adjust-file". This
7029 must only be a temporary workaround for the time it takes the client to be
7030 fixed, because clients which require such workarounds might be vulnerable to
7031 content smuggling attacks and must absolutely be fixed.
7032
7033 Please note that this option will not affect standards-compliant clients.
7034
7035 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7036 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7037
7038 See also: "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server", "h1-case-adjust",
7039 "h1-case-adjust-file".
7040
7041
7042option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server
7043no option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server
7044 Enable or disable the case adjustment of HTTP/1 headers sent to bogus servers
7045 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7046 yes | no | yes | yes
7047 Arguments : none
7048
7049 There is no standard case for header names because, as stated in RFC7230,
7050 they are case-insensitive. So applications must handle them in a case-
7051 insensitive manner. But some bogus applications violate the standards and
7052 erroneously rely on the cases most commonly used by browsers. This problem
7053 becomes critical with HTTP/2 because all header names must be exchanged in
7054 lower case, and HAProxy follows the same convention. All header names are
7055 sent in lower case to clients and servers, regardless of the HTTP version.
7056
7057 When HAProxy receives an HTTP/1 request, its header names are converted to
7058 lower case and manipulated and sent this way to the servers. If a server is
7059 known to violate the HTTP standards and to fail to process a request coming
7060 from HAProxy, it is possible to transform the lower case header names to a
7061 different format when the request is formatted and sent to the server, by
7062 enabling this option and specifying the list of headers to be reformatted
7063 using the global directives "h1-case-adjust" or "h1-case-adjust-file". This
7064 must only be a temporary workaround for the time it takes the server to be
7065 fixed, because servers which require such workarounds might be vulnerable to
7066 content smuggling attacks and must absolutely be fixed.
7067
7068 Please note that this option will not affect standards-compliant servers.
7069
7070 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7071 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7072
7073 See also: "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client", "h1-case-adjust",
7074 "h1-case-adjust-file".
7075
7076
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02007077option http-buffer-request
7078no option http-buffer-request
7079 Enable or disable waiting for whole HTTP request body before proceeding
7080 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7081 yes | yes | yes | yes
7082 Arguments : none
7083
7084 It is sometimes desirable to wait for the body of an HTTP request before
7085 taking a decision. This is what is being done by "balance url_param" for
7086 example. The first use case is to buffer requests from slow clients before
7087 connecting to the server. Another use case consists in taking the routing
7088 decision based on the request body's contents. This option placed in a
7089 frontend or backend forces the HTTP processing to wait until either the whole
Christopher Faulet6db8a2e2019-11-19 16:27:25 +01007090 body is received or the request buffer is full. It can have undesired side
7091 effects with some applications abusing HTTP by expecting unbuffered
7092 transmissions between the frontend and the backend, so this should definitely
7093 not be used by default.
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02007094
Baptiste Assmanneccdf432015-10-28 13:49:01 +01007095 See also : "option http-no-delay", "timeout http-request"
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02007096
7097
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02007098option http-ignore-probes
7099no option http-ignore-probes
7100 Enable or disable logging of null connections and request timeouts
7101 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7102 yes | yes | yes | no
7103 Arguments : none
7104
7105 Recently some browsers started to implement a "pre-connect" feature
7106 consisting in speculatively connecting to some recently visited web sites
7107 just in case the user would like to visit them. This results in many
7108 connections being established to web sites, which end up in 408 Request
7109 Timeout if the timeout strikes first, or 400 Bad Request when the browser
7110 decides to close them first. These ones pollute the log and feed the error
7111 counters. There was already "option dontlognull" but it's insufficient in
7112 this case. Instead, this option does the following things :
7113 - prevent any 400/408 message from being sent to the client if nothing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007114 was received over a connection before it was closed;
7115 - prevent any log from being emitted in this situation;
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02007116 - prevent any error counter from being incremented
7117
7118 That way the empty connection is silently ignored. Note that it is better
7119 not to use this unless it is clear that it is needed, because it will hide
7120 real problems. The most common reason for not receiving a request and seeing
7121 a 408 is due to an MTU inconsistency between the client and an intermediary
7122 element such as a VPN, which blocks too large packets. These issues are
7123 generally seen with POST requests as well as GET with large cookies. The logs
7124 are often the only way to detect them.
7125
7126 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7127 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7128
7129 See also : "log", "dontlognull", "errorfile", and section 8 about logging.
7130
7131
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01007132option http-keep-alive
7133no option http-keep-alive
7134 Enable or disable HTTP keep-alive from client to server
7135 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7136 yes | yes | yes | yes
7137 Arguments : none
7138
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01007139 By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
7140 connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02007141 leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and
7142 the start of a new request. This mode may be changed by several options such
Christopher Faulet159e6672019-07-16 15:09:52 +02007143 as "option http-server-close" or "option httpclose". This option allows to
7144 set back the keep-alive mode, which can be useful when another mode was used
7145 in a defaults section.
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01007146
7147 Setting "option http-keep-alive" enables HTTP keep-alive mode on the client-
7148 and server- sides. This provides the lowest latency on the client side (slow
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01007149 network) and the fastest session reuse on the server side at the expense
7150 of maintaining idle connections to the servers. In general, it is possible
7151 with this option to achieve approximately twice the request rate that the
7152 "http-server-close" option achieves on small objects. There are mainly two
7153 situations where this option may be useful :
7154
7155 - when the server is non-HTTP compliant and authenticates the connection
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007156 instead of requests (e.g. NTLM authentication)
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01007157
7158 - when the cost of establishing the connection to the server is significant
7159 compared to the cost of retrieving the associated object from the server.
7160
7161 This last case can happen when the server is a fast static server of cache.
7162 In this case, the server will need to be properly tuned to support high enough
7163 connection counts because connections will last until the client sends another
7164 request.
7165
7166 If the client request has to go to another backend or another server due to
7167 content switching or the load balancing algorithm, the idle connection will
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01007168 immediately be closed and a new one re-opened. Option "prefer-last-server" is
7169 available to try optimize server selection so that if the server currently
7170 attached to an idle connection is usable, it will be used.
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01007171
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01007172 At the moment, logs will not indicate whether requests came from the same
7173 session or not. The accept date reported in the logs corresponds to the end
7174 of the previous request, and the request time corresponds to the time spent
7175 waiting for a new request. The keep-alive request time is still bound to the
7176 timeout defined by "timeout http-keep-alive" or "timeout http-request" if
7177 not set.
7178
Christopher Faulet159e6672019-07-16 15:09:52 +02007179 This option disables and replaces any previous "option httpclose" or "option
7180 http-server-close". When backend and frontend options differ, all of these 4
7181 options have precedence over "option http-keep-alive".
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01007182
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02007183 See also : "option httpclose",, "option http-server-close",
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01007184 "option prefer-last-server", "option http-pretend-keepalive",
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +01007185 and "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01007186
7187
Willy Tarreau96e31212011-05-30 18:10:30 +02007188option http-no-delay
7189no option http-no-delay
7190 Instruct the system to favor low interactive delays over performance in HTTP
7191 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7192 yes | yes | yes | yes
7193 Arguments : none
7194
7195 In HTTP, each payload is unidirectional and has no notion of interactivity.
7196 Any agent is expected to queue data somewhat for a reasonably low delay.
7197 There are some very rare server-to-server applications that abuse the HTTP
7198 protocol and expect the payload phase to be highly interactive, with many
7199 interleaved data chunks in both directions within a single request. This is
7200 absolutely not supported by the HTTP specification and will not work across
7201 most proxies or servers. When such applications attempt to do this through
7202 haproxy, it works but they will experience high delays due to the network
7203 optimizations which favor performance by instructing the system to wait for
7204 enough data to be available in order to only send full packets. Typical
7205 delays are around 200 ms per round trip. Note that this only happens with
7206 abnormal uses. Normal uses such as CONNECT requests nor WebSockets are not
7207 affected.
7208
7209 When "option http-no-delay" is present in either the frontend or the backend
7210 used by a connection, all such optimizations will be disabled in order to
7211 make the exchanges as fast as possible. Of course this offers no guarantee on
7212 the functionality, as it may break at any other place. But if it works via
7213 HAProxy, it will work as fast as possible. This option should never be used
7214 by default, and should never be used at all unless such a buggy application
7215 is discovered. The impact of using this option is an increase of bandwidth
7216 usage and CPU usage, which may significantly lower performance in high
7217 latency environments.
7218
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02007219 See also : "option http-buffer-request"
7220
Willy Tarreau96e31212011-05-30 18:10:30 +02007221
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02007222option http-pretend-keepalive
7223no option http-pretend-keepalive
7224 Define whether haproxy will announce keepalive to the server or not
7225 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet98db9762018-09-21 10:25:19 +02007226 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02007227 Arguments : none
7228
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02007229 When running with "option http-server-close" or "option httpclose", haproxy
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02007230 adds a "Connection: close" header to the request forwarded to the server.
7231 Unfortunately, when some servers see this header, they automatically refrain
7232 from using the chunked encoding for responses of unknown length, while this
7233 is totally unrelated. The immediate effect is that this prevents haproxy from
7234 maintaining the client connection alive. A second effect is that a client or
7235 a cache could receive an incomplete response without being aware of it, and
7236 consider the response complete.
7237
7238 By setting "option http-pretend-keepalive", haproxy will make the server
7239 believe it will keep the connection alive. The server will then not fall back
7240 to the abnormal undesired above. When haproxy gets the whole response, it
7241 will close the connection with the server just as it would do with the
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02007242 "option httpclose". That way the client gets a normal response and the
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02007243 connection is correctly closed on the server side.
7244
7245 It is recommended not to enable this option by default, because most servers
7246 will more efficiently close the connection themselves after the last packet,
7247 and release its buffers slightly earlier. Also, the added packet on the
7248 network could slightly reduce the overall peak performance. However it is
7249 worth noting that when this option is enabled, haproxy will have slightly
7250 less work to do. So if haproxy is the bottleneck on the whole architecture,
7251 enabling this option might save a few CPU cycles.
7252
Christopher Faulet98db9762018-09-21 10:25:19 +02007253 This option may be set in backend and listen sections. Using it in a frontend
7254 section will be ignored and a warning will be reported during startup. It is
7255 a backend related option, so there is no real reason to set it on a
7256 frontend. This option may be combined with "option httpclose", which will
7257 cause keepalive to be announced to the server and close to be announced to
7258 the client. This practice is discouraged though.
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02007259
7260 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7261 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7262
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02007263 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-server-close", and
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01007264 "option http-keep-alive"
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02007265
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01007266
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01007267option http-server-close
7268no option http-server-close
7269 Enable or disable HTTP connection closing on the server side
7270 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7271 yes | yes | yes | yes
7272 Arguments : none
7273
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01007274 By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
7275 connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
7276 leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and
7277 the start of a new request. This mode may be changed by several options such
Christopher Faulet159e6672019-07-16 15:09:52 +02007278 as "option http-server-close" or "option httpclose". Setting "option
7279 http-server-close" enables HTTP connection-close mode on the server side
7280 while keeping the ability to support HTTP keep-alive and pipelining on the
7281 client side. This provides the lowest latency on the client side (slow
7282 network) and the fastest session reuse on the server side to save server
7283 resources, similarly to "option httpclose". It also permits non-keepalive
7284 capable servers to be served in keep-alive mode to the clients if they
7285 conform to the requirements of RFC7230. Please note that some servers do not
7286 always conform to those requirements when they see "Connection: close" in the
7287 request. The effect will be that keep-alive will never be used. A workaround
7288 consists in enabling "option http-pretend-keepalive".
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01007289
7290 At the moment, logs will not indicate whether requests came from the same
7291 session or not. The accept date reported in the logs corresponds to the end
7292 of the previous request, and the request time corresponds to the time spent
7293 waiting for a new request. The keep-alive request time is still bound to the
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +01007294 timeout defined by "timeout http-keep-alive" or "timeout http-request" if
7295 not set.
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01007296
7297 This option may be set both in a frontend and in a backend. It is enabled if
7298 at least one of the frontend or backend holding a connection has it enabled.
Christopher Faulet159e6672019-07-16 15:09:52 +02007299 It disables and replaces any previous "option httpclose" or "option
7300 http-keep-alive". Please check section 4 ("Proxies") to see how this option
7301 combines with others when frontend and backend options differ.
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01007302
7303 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7304 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7305
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02007306 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-pretend-keepalive",
7307 "option http-keep-alive", and "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01007308
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01007309option http-use-proxy-header
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01007310no option http-use-proxy-header
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01007311 Make use of non-standard Proxy-Connection header instead of Connection
7312 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7313 yes | yes | yes | no
7314 Arguments : none
7315
Lukas Tribus23953682017-04-28 13:24:30 +00007316 While RFC7230 explicitly states that HTTP/1.1 agents must use the
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01007317 Connection header to indicate their wish of persistent or non-persistent
7318 connections, both browsers and proxies ignore this header for proxied
7319 connections and make use of the undocumented, non-standard Proxy-Connection
7320 header instead. The issue begins when trying to put a load balancer between
7321 browsers and such proxies, because there will be a difference between what
7322 haproxy understands and what the client and the proxy agree on.
7323
7324 By setting this option in a frontend, haproxy can automatically switch to use
7325 that non-standard header if it sees proxied requests. A proxied request is
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01007326 defined here as one where the URI begins with neither a '/' nor a '*'. This
7327 is incompatible with the HTTP tunnel mode. Note that this option can only be
7328 specified in a frontend and will affect the request along its whole life.
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01007329
Willy Tarreau844a7e72010-01-31 21:46:18 +01007330 Also, when this option is set, a request which requires authentication will
7331 automatically switch to use proxy authentication headers if it is itself a
7332 proxied request. That makes it possible to check or enforce authentication in
7333 front of an existing proxy.
7334
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01007335 This option should normally never be used, except in front of a proxy.
7336
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02007337 See also : "option httpclose", and "option http-server-close".
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01007338
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007339option httpchk
7340option httpchk <uri>
7341option httpchk <method> <uri>
7342option httpchk <method> <uri> <version>
7343 Enable HTTP protocol to check on the servers health
7344 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7345 yes | no | yes | yes
7346 Arguments :
7347 <method> is the optional HTTP method used with the requests. When not set,
7348 the "OPTIONS" method is used, as it generally requires low server
7349 processing and is easy to filter out from the logs. Any method
7350 may be used, though it is not recommended to invent non-standard
7351 ones.
7352
7353 <uri> is the URI referenced in the HTTP requests. It defaults to " / "
7354 which is accessible by default on almost any server, but may be
7355 changed to any other URI. Query strings are permitted.
7356
7357 <version> is the optional HTTP version string. It defaults to "HTTP/1.0"
7358 but some servers might behave incorrectly in HTTP 1.0, so turning
7359 it to HTTP/1.1 may sometimes help. Note that the Host field is
Christopher Faulet8acb1282020-04-09 08:44:06 +02007360 mandatory in HTTP/1.1, use "http-check send" directive to add it.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007361
7362 By default, server health checks only consist in trying to establish a TCP
7363 connection. When "option httpchk" is specified, a complete HTTP request is
7364 sent once the TCP connection is established, and responses 2xx and 3xx are
7365 considered valid, while all other ones indicate a server failure, including
7366 the lack of any response.
7367
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02007368 Combined with "http-check" directives, it is possible to customize the
7369 request sent during the HTTP health checks or the matching rules on the
7370 response. It is also possible to configure a send/expect sequence, just like
7371 with the directive "tcp-check" for TCP health checks.
7372
7373 The server configuration is used by default to open connections to perform
7374 HTTP health checks. By it is also possible to overwrite server parameters
7375 using "http-check connect" rules.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007376
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02007377 "httpchk" option does not necessarily require an HTTP backend, it also works
7378 with plain TCP backends. This is particularly useful to check simple scripts
7379 bound to some dedicated ports using the inetd daemon.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007380
Christopher Faulet8acb1282020-04-09 08:44:06 +02007381 Note : For a while, there was no way to add headers or body in the request
7382 used for HTTP health checks. So a workaround was to hide it at the end
7383 of the version string with a "\r\n" after the version. It is now
7384 deprecated. The directive "http-check send" must be used instead.
7385
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007386 Examples :
7387 # Relay HTTPS traffic to Apache instance and check service availability
7388 # using HTTP request "OPTIONS * HTTP/1.1" on port 80.
7389 backend https_relay
7390 mode tcp
Christopher Faulet8acb1282020-04-09 08:44:06 +02007391 option httpchk OPTIONS * HTTP/1.1
7392 http-check send hdr Host www
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007393 server apache1 192.168.1.1:443 check port 80
7394
Simon Hormanafc47ee2013-11-25 10:46:35 +09007395 See also : "option ssl-hello-chk", "option smtpchk", "option mysql-check",
7396 "option pgsql-check", "http-check" and the "check", "port" and
7397 "inter" server options.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007398
7399
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01007400option httpclose
7401no option httpclose
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02007402 Enable or disable HTTP connection closing
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01007403 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7404 yes | yes | yes | yes
7405 Arguments : none
7406
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01007407 By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
7408 connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
7409 leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and
7410 the start of a new request. This mode may be changed by several options such
Christopher Faulet159e6672019-07-16 15:09:52 +02007411 as "option http-server-close" or "option httpclose".
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01007412
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02007413 If "option httpclose" is set, HAProxy will close connections with the server
7414 and the client as soon as the request and the response are received. It will
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05007415 also check if a "Connection: close" header is already set in each direction,
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02007416 and will add one if missing. Any "Connection" header different from "close"
7417 will also be removed.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01007418
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02007419 This option may also be combined with "option http-pretend-keepalive", which
7420 will disable sending of the "Connection: close" header, but will still cause
7421 the connection to be closed once the whole response is received.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01007422
7423 This option may be set both in a frontend and in a backend. It is enabled if
7424 at least one of the frontend or backend holding a connection has it enabled.
Christopher Faulet159e6672019-07-16 15:09:52 +02007425 It disables and replaces any previous "option http-server-close" or "option
7426 http-keep-alive". Please check section 4 ("Proxies") to see how this option
7427 combines with others when frontend and backend options differ.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01007428
7429 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7430 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7431
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02007432 See also : "option http-server-close" and "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01007433
7434
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02007435option httplog [ clf ]
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01007436 Enable logging of HTTP request, session state and timers
7437 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Tim Duesterhus9ad9f352018-02-05 20:52:27 +01007438 yes | yes | yes | no
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02007439 Arguments :
7440 clf if the "clf" argument is added, then the output format will be
7441 the CLF format instead of HAProxy's default HTTP format. You can
7442 use this when you need to feed HAProxy's logs through a specific
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007443 log analyzer which only support the CLF format and which is not
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02007444 extensible.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01007445
7446 By default, the log output format is very poor, as it only contains the
7447 source and destination addresses, and the instance name. By specifying
7448 "option httplog", each log line turns into a much richer format including,
7449 but not limited to, the HTTP request, the connection timers, the session
7450 status, the connections numbers, the captured headers and cookies, the
7451 frontend, backend and server name, and of course the source address and
7452 ports.
7453
PiBa-NLbd556bf2014-12-11 21:31:54 +01007454 Specifying only "option httplog" will automatically clear the 'clf' mode
7455 if it was set by default.
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02007456
Guillaume de Lafond29f45602017-03-31 19:52:15 +02007457 "option httplog" overrides any previous "log-format" directive.
7458
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007459 See also : section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01007460
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02007461
7462option http_proxy
7463no option http_proxy
7464 Enable or disable plain HTTP proxy mode
7465 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7466 yes | yes | yes | yes
7467 Arguments : none
7468
7469 It sometimes happens that people need a pure HTTP proxy which understands
7470 basic proxy requests without caching nor any fancy feature. In this case,
7471 it may be worth setting up an HAProxy instance with the "option http_proxy"
7472 set. In this mode, no server is declared, and the connection is forwarded to
7473 the IP address and port found in the URL after the "http://" scheme.
7474
7475 No host address resolution is performed, so this only works when pure IP
7476 addresses are passed. Since this option's usage perimeter is rather limited,
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01007477 it will probably be used only by experts who know they need exactly it. This
7478 is incompatible with the HTTP tunnel mode.
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02007479
7480 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7481 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7482
7483 Example :
7484 # this backend understands HTTP proxy requests and forwards them directly.
7485 backend direct_forward
7486 option httpclose
7487 option http_proxy
7488
7489 See also : "option httpclose"
7490
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02007491
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04007492option independent-streams
7493no option independent-streams
7494 Enable or disable independent timeout processing for both directions
Willy Tarreauf27b5ea2009-10-03 22:01:18 +02007495 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7496 yes | yes | yes | yes
7497 Arguments : none
7498
7499 By default, when data is sent over a socket, both the write timeout and the
7500 read timeout for that socket are refreshed, because we consider that there is
7501 activity on that socket, and we have no other means of guessing if we should
7502 receive data or not.
7503
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007504 While this default behavior is desirable for almost all applications, there
Willy Tarreauf27b5ea2009-10-03 22:01:18 +02007505 exists a situation where it is desirable to disable it, and only refresh the
7506 read timeout if there are incoming data. This happens on sessions with large
7507 timeouts and low amounts of exchanged data such as telnet session. If the
7508 server suddenly disappears, the output data accumulates in the system's
7509 socket buffers, both timeouts are correctly refreshed, and there is no way
7510 to know the server does not receive them, so we don't timeout. However, when
7511 the underlying protocol always echoes sent data, it would be enough by itself
7512 to detect the issue using the read timeout. Note that this problem does not
7513 happen with more verbose protocols because data won't accumulate long in the
7514 socket buffers.
7515
7516 When this option is set on the frontend, it will disable read timeout updates
7517 on data sent to the client. There probably is little use of this case. When
7518 the option is set on the backend, it will disable read timeout updates on
7519 data sent to the server. Doing so will typically break large HTTP posts from
7520 slow lines, so use it with caution.
7521
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02007522 See also : "timeout client", "timeout server" and "timeout tunnel"
Willy Tarreauf27b5ea2009-10-03 22:01:18 +02007523
7524
Gabor Lekenyb4c81e42010-09-29 18:17:05 +02007525option ldap-check
7526 Use LDAPv3 health checks for server testing
7527 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7528 yes | no | yes | yes
7529 Arguments : none
7530
7531 It is possible to test that the server correctly talks LDAPv3 instead of just
7532 testing that it accepts the TCP connection. When this option is set, an
7533 LDAPv3 anonymous simple bind message is sent to the server, and the response
7534 is analyzed to find an LDAPv3 bind response message.
7535
7536 The server is considered valid only when the LDAP response contains success
7537 resultCode (http://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc4511#section-4.1.9).
7538
7539 Logging of bind requests is server dependent see your documentation how to
7540 configure it.
7541
7542 Example :
7543 option ldap-check
7544
7545 See also : "option httpchk"
7546
7547
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09007548option external-check
7549 Use external processes for server health checks
7550 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7551 yes | no | yes | yes
7552
7553 It is possible to test the health of a server using an external command.
7554 This is achieved by running the executable set using "external-check
7555 command".
7556
7557 Requires the "external-check" global to be set.
7558
7559 See also : "external-check", "external-check command", "external-check path"
7560
7561
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02007562option log-health-checks
7563no option log-health-checks
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02007564 Enable or disable logging of health checks status updates
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02007565 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7566 yes | no | yes | yes
7567 Arguments : none
7568
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02007569 By default, failed health check are logged if server is UP and successful
7570 health checks are logged if server is DOWN, so the amount of additional
7571 information is limited.
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02007572
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02007573 When this option is enabled, any change of the health check status or to
7574 the server's health will be logged, so that it becomes possible to know
7575 that a server was failing occasional checks before crashing, or exactly when
7576 it failed to respond a valid HTTP status, then when the port started to
7577 reject connections, then when the server stopped responding at all.
7578
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007579 Note that status changes not caused by health checks (e.g. enable/disable on
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02007580 the CLI) are intentionally not logged by this option.
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02007581
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02007582 See also: "option httpchk", "option ldap-check", "option mysql-check",
7583 "option pgsql-check", "option redis-check", "option smtpchk",
7584 "option tcp-check", "log" and section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02007585
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02007586
7587option log-separate-errors
7588no option log-separate-errors
7589 Change log level for non-completely successful connections
7590 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7591 yes | yes | yes | no
7592 Arguments : none
7593
7594 Sometimes looking for errors in logs is not easy. This option makes haproxy
7595 raise the level of logs containing potentially interesting information such
7596 as errors, timeouts, retries, redispatches, or HTTP status codes 5xx. The
7597 level changes from "info" to "err". This makes it possible to log them
7598 separately to a different file with most syslog daemons. Be careful not to
7599 remove them from the original file, otherwise you would lose ordering which
7600 provides very important information.
7601
7602 Using this option, large sites dealing with several thousand connections per
7603 second may log normal traffic to a rotating buffer and only archive smaller
7604 error logs.
7605
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007606 See also : "log", "dontlognull", "dontlog-normal" and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02007607 logging.
7608
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01007609
7610option logasap
7611no option logasap
Jerome Magnin95fb57b2020-04-23 19:01:17 +02007612 Enable or disable early logging.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01007613 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7614 yes | yes | yes | no
7615 Arguments : none
7616
Jerome Magnin95fb57b2020-04-23 19:01:17 +02007617 By default, logs are emitted when all the log format variables and sample
7618 fetches used in the definition of the log-format string return a value, or
7619 when the session is terminated. This allows the built in log-format strings
7620 to account for the transfer time, or the number of bytes in log messages.
7621
7622 When handling long lived connections such as large file transfers or RDP,
7623 it may take a while for the request or connection to appear in the logs.
7624 Using "option logasap", the log message is created as soon as the server
7625 connection is established in mode tcp, or as soon as the server sends the
7626 complete headers in mode http. Missing information in the logs will be the
7627 total number of bytes which will only indicate the amount of data transfered
7628 before the message was created and the total time which will not take the
7629 remainder of the connection life or transfer time into account. For the case
7630 of HTTP, it is good practice to capture the Content-Length response header
7631 so that the logs at least indicate how many bytes are expected to be
7632 transfered.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01007633
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01007634 Examples :
7635 listen http_proxy 0.0.0.0:80
7636 mode http
7637 option httplog
7638 option logasap
7639 log 192.168.2.200 local3
7640
7641 >>> Feb 6 12:14:14 localhost \
7642 haproxy[14389]: 10.0.1.2:33317 [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655] http-in \
7643 static/srv1 9/10/7/14/+30 200 +243 - - ---- 3/1/1/1/0 1/0 \
7644 "GET /image.iso HTTP/1.0"
7645
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007646 See also : "option httplog", "capture response header", and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01007647 logging.
7648
7649
Nenad Merdanovic6639a7c2014-05-30 14:26:32 +02007650option mysql-check [ user <username> [ post-41 ] ]
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02007651 Use MySQL health checks for server testing
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01007652 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7653 yes | no | yes | yes
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02007654 Arguments :
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02007655 <username> This is the username which will be used when connecting to MySQL
7656 server.
Nenad Merdanovic6639a7c2014-05-30 14:26:32 +02007657 post-41 Send post v4.1 client compatible checks
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02007658
7659 If you specify a username, the check consists of sending two MySQL packet,
7660 one Client Authentication packet, and one QUIT packet, to correctly close
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007661 MySQL session. We then parse the MySQL Handshake Initialization packet and/or
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02007662 Error packet. It is a basic but useful test which does not produce error nor
7663 aborted connect on the server. However, it requires adding an authorization
7664 in the MySQL table, like this :
7665
7666 USE mysql;
7667 INSERT INTO user (Host,User) values ('<ip_of_haproxy>','<username>');
7668 FLUSH PRIVILEGES;
7669
7670 If you don't specify a username (it is deprecated and not recommended), the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007671 check only consists in parsing the Mysql Handshake Initialization packet or
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02007672 Error packet, we don't send anything in this mode. It was reported that it
7673 can generate lockout if check is too frequent and/or if there is not enough
7674 traffic. In fact, you need in this case to check MySQL "max_connect_errors"
7675 value as if a connection is established successfully within fewer than MySQL
7676 "max_connect_errors" attempts after a previous connection was interrupted,
7677 the error count for the host is cleared to zero. If HAProxy's server get
7678 blocked, the "FLUSH HOSTS" statement is the only way to unblock it.
7679
7680 Remember that this does not check database presence nor database consistency.
7681 To do this, you can use an external check with xinetd for example.
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01007682
Hervé COMMOWICK212f7782011-06-10 14:05:59 +02007683 The check requires MySQL >=3.22, for older version, please use TCP check.
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01007684
7685 Most often, an incoming MySQL server needs to see the client's IP address for
7686 various purposes, including IP privilege matching and connection logging.
7687 When possible, it is often wise to masquerade the client's IP address when
7688 connecting to the server using the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword,
Willy Tarreau29fbe512015-08-20 19:35:14 +02007689 which requires the transparent proxy feature to be compiled in, and the MySQL
7690 server to route the client via the machine hosting haproxy.
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01007691
7692 See also: "option httpchk"
7693
7694
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01007695option nolinger
7696no option nolinger
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01007697 Enable or disable immediate session resource cleaning after close
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01007698 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7699 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007700 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01007701
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007702 When clients or servers abort connections in a dirty way (e.g. they are
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01007703 physically disconnected), the session timeouts triggers and the session is
7704 closed. But it will remain in FIN_WAIT1 state for some time in the system,
7705 using some resources and possibly limiting the ability to establish newer
7706 connections.
7707
7708 When this happens, it is possible to activate "option nolinger" which forces
7709 the system to immediately remove any socket's pending data on close. Thus,
7710 the session is instantly purged from the system's tables. This usually has
7711 side effects such as increased number of TCP resets due to old retransmits
7712 getting immediately rejected. Some firewalls may sometimes complain about
7713 this too.
7714
7715 For this reason, it is not recommended to use this option when not absolutely
7716 needed. You know that you need it when you have thousands of FIN_WAIT1
7717 sessions on your system (TIME_WAIT ones do not count).
7718
7719 This option may be used both on frontends and backends, depending on the side
7720 where it is required. Use it on the frontend for clients, and on the backend
7721 for servers.
7722
7723 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7724 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7725
7726
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02007727option originalto [ except <network> ] [ header <name> ]
7728 Enable insertion of the X-Original-To header to requests sent to servers
7729 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7730 yes | yes | yes | yes
7731 Arguments :
7732 <network> is an optional argument used to disable this option for sources
7733 matching <network>
7734 <name> an optional argument to specify a different "X-Original-To"
7735 header name.
7736
7737 Since HAProxy can work in transparent mode, every request from a client can
7738 be redirected to the proxy and HAProxy itself can proxy every request to a
7739 complex SQUID environment and the destination host from SO_ORIGINAL_DST will
7740 be lost. This is annoying when you want access rules based on destination ip
7741 addresses. To solve this problem, a new HTTP header "X-Original-To" may be
7742 added by HAProxy to all requests sent to the server. This header contains a
7743 value representing the original destination IP address. Since this must be
7744 configured to always use the last occurrence of this header only. Note that
7745 only the last occurrence of the header must be used, since it is really
7746 possible that the client has already brought one.
7747
7748 The keyword "header" may be used to supply a different header name to replace
7749 the default "X-Original-To". This can be useful where you might already
7750 have a "X-Original-To" header from a different application, and you need
7751 preserve it. Also if your backend server doesn't use the "X-Original-To"
7752 header and requires different one.
7753
7754 Sometimes, a same HAProxy instance may be shared between a direct client
7755 access and a reverse-proxy access (for instance when an SSL reverse-proxy is
7756 used to decrypt HTTPS traffic). It is possible to disable the addition of the
7757 header for a known source address or network by adding the "except" keyword
7758 followed by the network address. In this case, any source IP matching the
7759 network will not cause an addition of this header. Most common uses are with
7760 private networks or 127.0.0.1.
7761
7762 This option may be specified either in the frontend or in the backend. If at
7763 least one of them uses it, the header will be added. Note that the backend's
7764 setting of the header subargument takes precedence over the frontend's if
7765 both are defined.
7766
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02007767 Examples :
7768 # Original Destination address
7769 frontend www
7770 mode http
7771 option originalto except 127.0.0.1
7772
7773 # Those servers want the IP Address in X-Client-Dst
7774 backend www
7775 mode http
7776 option originalto header X-Client-Dst
7777
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02007778 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-server-close".
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02007779
7780
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01007781option persist
7782no option persist
7783 Enable or disable forced persistence on down servers
7784 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7785 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007786 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01007787
7788 When an HTTP request reaches a backend with a cookie which references a dead
7789 server, by default it is redispatched to another server. It is possible to
7790 force the request to be sent to the dead server first using "option persist"
7791 if absolutely needed. A common use case is when servers are under extreme
7792 load and spend their time flapping. In this case, the users would still be
7793 directed to the server they opened the session on, in the hope they would be
7794 correctly served. It is recommended to use "option redispatch" in conjunction
7795 with this option so that in the event it would not be possible to connect to
7796 the server at all (server definitely dead), the client would finally be
7797 redirected to another valid server.
7798
7799 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7800 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7801
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01007802 See also : "option redispatch", "retries", "force-persist"
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01007803
7804
Willy Tarreau0c122822013-12-15 18:49:01 +01007805option pgsql-check [ user <username> ]
7806 Use PostgreSQL health checks for server testing
7807 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7808 yes | no | yes | yes
7809 Arguments :
7810 <username> This is the username which will be used when connecting to
7811 PostgreSQL server.
7812
7813 The check sends a PostgreSQL StartupMessage and waits for either
7814 Authentication request or ErrorResponse message. It is a basic but useful
7815 test which does not produce error nor aborted connect on the server.
7816 This check is identical with the "mysql-check".
7817
7818 See also: "option httpchk"
7819
7820
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01007821option prefer-last-server
7822no option prefer-last-server
7823 Allow multiple load balanced requests to remain on the same server
7824 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7825 yes | no | yes | yes
7826 Arguments : none
7827
7828 When the load balancing algorithm in use is not deterministic, and a previous
7829 request was sent to a server to which haproxy still holds a connection, it is
7830 sometimes desirable that subsequent requests on a same session go to the same
7831 server as much as possible. Note that this is different from persistence, as
7832 we only indicate a preference which haproxy tries to apply without any form
7833 of warranty. The real use is for keep-alive connections sent to servers. When
7834 this option is used, haproxy will try to reuse the same connection that is
7835 attached to the server instead of rebalancing to another server, causing a
7836 close of the connection. This can make sense for static file servers. It does
Willy Tarreau068621e2013-12-23 15:11:25 +01007837 not make much sense to use this in combination with hashing algorithms. Note,
7838 haproxy already automatically tries to stick to a server which sends a 401 or
Lukas Tribus80512b12018-10-27 20:07:40 +02007839 to a proxy which sends a 407 (authentication required), when the load
7840 balancing algorithm is not deterministic. This is mandatory for use with the
7841 broken NTLM authentication challenge, and significantly helps in
Willy Tarreau068621e2013-12-23 15:11:25 +01007842 troubleshooting some faulty applications. Option prefer-last-server might be
7843 desirable in these environments as well, to avoid redistributing the traffic
7844 after every other response.
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01007845
7846 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7847 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7848
7849 See also: "option http-keep-alive"
7850
7851
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01007852option redispatch
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07007853option redispatch <interval>
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01007854no option redispatch
7855 Enable or disable session redistribution in case of connection failure
7856 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7857 yes | no | yes | yes
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07007858 Arguments :
7859 <interval> The optional integer value that controls how often redispatches
7860 occur when retrying connections. Positive value P indicates a
7861 redispatch is desired on every Pth retry, and negative value
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007862 N indicate a redispatch is desired on the Nth retry prior to the
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07007863 last retry. For example, the default of -1 preserves the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007864 historical behavior of redispatching on the last retry, a
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07007865 positive value of 1 would indicate a redispatch on every retry,
7866 and a positive value of 3 would indicate a redispatch on every
7867 third retry. You can disable redispatches with a value of 0.
7868
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01007869
7870 In HTTP mode, if a server designated by a cookie is down, clients may
7871 definitely stick to it because they cannot flush the cookie, so they will not
7872 be able to access the service anymore.
7873
Willy Tarreau59884a62019-01-02 14:48:31 +01007874 Specifying "option redispatch" will allow the proxy to break cookie or
7875 consistent hash based persistence and redistribute them to a working server.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01007876
Olivier Carrère6e6f59b2020-04-15 11:30:18 +02007877 Active servers are selected from a subset of the list of available
7878 servers. Active servers that are not down or in maintenance (i.e., whose
7879 health is not checked or that have been checked as "up"), are selected in the
7880 following order:
7881
7882 1. Any active, non-backup server, if any, or,
7883
7884 2. If the "allbackups" option is not set, the first backup server in the
7885 list, or
7886
7887 3. If the "allbackups" option is set, any backup server.
7888
7889 When a retry occurs, HAProxy tries to select another server than the last
7890 one. The new server is selected from the current list of servers.
7891
7892 Sometimes, if the list is updated between retries (e.g., if numerous retries
7893 occur and last longer than the time needed to check that a server is down,
7894 remove it from the list and fall back on the list of backup servers),
7895 connections may be redirected to a backup server, though.
7896
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07007897 It also allows to retry connections to another server in case of multiple
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01007898 connection failures. Of course, it requires having "retries" set to a nonzero
7899 value.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01007900
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01007901 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7902 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7903
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +02007904 See also : "retries", "force-persist"
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01007905
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01007906
Hervé COMMOWICKec032d62011-08-05 16:23:48 +02007907option redis-check
7908 Use redis health checks for server testing
7909 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7910 yes | no | yes | yes
7911 Arguments : none
7912
7913 It is possible to test that the server correctly talks REDIS protocol instead
7914 of just testing that it accepts the TCP connection. When this option is set,
7915 a PING redis command is sent to the server, and the response is analyzed to
7916 find the "+PONG" response message.
7917
7918 Example :
7919 option redis-check
7920
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +03007921 See also : "option httpchk", "option tcp-check", "tcp-check expect"
Hervé COMMOWICKec032d62011-08-05 16:23:48 +02007922
7923
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01007924option smtpchk
7925option smtpchk <hello> <domain>
7926 Use SMTP health checks for server testing
7927 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7928 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01007929 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01007930 <hello> is an optional argument. It is the "hello" command to use. It can
Lukas Tribus27935782018-10-01 02:00:16 +02007931 be either "HELO" (for SMTP) or "EHLO" (for ESMTP). All other
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01007932 values will be turned into the default command ("HELO").
7933
7934 <domain> is the domain name to present to the server. It may only be
7935 specified (and is mandatory) if the hello command has been
7936 specified. By default, "localhost" is used.
7937
7938 When "option smtpchk" is set, the health checks will consist in TCP
7939 connections followed by an SMTP command. By default, this command is
7940 "HELO localhost". The server's return code is analyzed and only return codes
7941 starting with a "2" will be considered as valid. All other responses,
7942 including a lack of response will constitute an error and will indicate a
7943 dead server.
7944
7945 This test is meant to be used with SMTP servers or relays. Depending on the
7946 request, it is possible that some servers do not log each connection attempt,
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007947 so you may want to experiment to improve the behavior. Using telnet on port
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01007948 25 is often easier than adjusting the configuration.
7949
7950 Most often, an incoming SMTP server needs to see the client's IP address for
7951 various purposes, including spam filtering, anti-spoofing and logging. When
7952 possible, it is often wise to masquerade the client's IP address when
7953 connecting to the server using the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword,
Willy Tarreau29fbe512015-08-20 19:35:14 +02007954 which requires the transparent proxy feature to be compiled in.
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01007955
7956 Example :
7957 option smtpchk HELO mydomain.org
7958
7959 See also : "option httpchk", "source"
7960
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01007961
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiaeebf9b2009-10-04 15:43:17 +02007962option socket-stats
7963no option socket-stats
7964
7965 Enable or disable collecting & providing separate statistics for each socket.
7966 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7967 yes | yes | yes | no
7968
7969 Arguments : none
7970
7971
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01007972option splice-auto
7973no option splice-auto
7974 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets in both directions
7975 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7976 yes | yes | yes | yes
7977 Arguments : none
7978
7979 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, haproxy
7980 will automatically evaluate the opportunity to use kernel tcp splicing to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007981 forward data between the client and the server, in either direction. HAProxy
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01007982 uses heuristics to estimate if kernel splicing might improve performance or
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01007983 not. Both directions are handled independently. Note that the heuristics used
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01007984 are not much aggressive in order to limit excessive use of splicing. This
7985 option requires splicing to be enabled at compile time, and may be globally
7986 disabled with the global option "nosplice". Since splice uses pipes, using it
7987 requires that there are enough spare pipes.
7988
7989 Important note: kernel-based TCP splicing is a Linux-specific feature which
7990 first appeared in kernel 2.6.25. It offers kernel-based acceleration to
7991 transfer data between sockets without copying these data to user-space, thus
7992 providing noticeable performance gains and CPU cycles savings. Since many
7993 early implementations are buggy, corrupt data and/or are inefficient, this
7994 feature is not enabled by default, and it should be used with extreme care.
7995 While it is not possible to detect the correctness of an implementation,
7996 2.6.29 is the first version offering a properly working implementation. In
7997 case of doubt, splicing may be globally disabled using the global "nosplice"
7998 keyword.
7999
8000 Example :
8001 option splice-auto
8002
8003 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8004 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8005
8006 See also : "option splice-request", "option splice-response", and global
8007 options "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
8008
8009
8010option splice-request
8011no option splice-request
8012 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets for requests
8013 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8014 yes | yes | yes | yes
8015 Arguments : none
8016
8017 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, haproxy
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04008018 will use kernel tcp splicing whenever possible to forward data going from
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01008019 the client to the server. It might still use the recv/send scheme if there
8020 are no spare pipes left. This option requires splicing to be enabled at
8021 compile time, and may be globally disabled with the global option "nosplice".
8022 Since splice uses pipes, using it requires that there are enough spare pipes.
8023
8024 Important note: see "option splice-auto" for usage limitations.
8025
8026 Example :
8027 option splice-request
8028
8029 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8030 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8031
8032 See also : "option splice-auto", "option splice-response", and global options
8033 "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
8034
8035
8036option splice-response
8037no option splice-response
8038 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets for responses
8039 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8040 yes | yes | yes | yes
8041 Arguments : none
8042
8043 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, haproxy
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04008044 will use kernel tcp splicing whenever possible to forward data going from
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01008045 the server to the client. It might still use the recv/send scheme if there
8046 are no spare pipes left. This option requires splicing to be enabled at
8047 compile time, and may be globally disabled with the global option "nosplice".
8048 Since splice uses pipes, using it requires that there are enough spare pipes.
8049
8050 Important note: see "option splice-auto" for usage limitations.
8051
8052 Example :
8053 option splice-response
8054
8055 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8056 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8057
8058 See also : "option splice-auto", "option splice-request", and global options
8059 "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
8060
8061
Christopher Fauletba7bc162016-11-07 21:07:38 +01008062option spop-check
8063 Use SPOP health checks for server testing
8064 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8065 no | no | no | yes
8066 Arguments : none
8067
8068 It is possible to test that the server correctly talks SPOP protocol instead
8069 of just testing that it accepts the TCP connection. When this option is set,
8070 a HELLO handshake is performed between HAProxy and the server, and the
8071 response is analyzed to check no error is reported.
8072
8073 Example :
8074 option spop-check
8075
8076 See also : "option httpchk"
8077
8078
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008079option srvtcpka
8080no option srvtcpka
8081 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on the server side
8082 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8083 yes | no | yes | yes
8084 Arguments : none
8085
8086 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
8087 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008088 periods (e.g. remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008089 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
8090
8091 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
8092 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
8093 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
8094 operating system and its tuning parameters.
8095
8096 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
8097 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
8098 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
8099 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
8100 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
8101
8102 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
8103
8104 Using option "srvtcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on the
8105 server side of a connection, which should help when session expirations are
8106 noticed between HAProxy and a server.
8107
8108 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8109 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8110
8111 See also : "option clitcpka", "option tcpka"
8112
8113
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01008114option ssl-hello-chk
8115 Use SSLv3 client hello health checks for server testing
8116 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8117 yes | no | yes | yes
8118 Arguments : none
8119
8120 When some SSL-based protocols are relayed in TCP mode through HAProxy, it is
8121 possible to test that the server correctly talks SSL instead of just testing
8122 that it accepts the TCP connection. When "option ssl-hello-chk" is set, pure
8123 SSLv3 client hello messages are sent once the connection is established to
8124 the server, and the response is analyzed to find an SSL server hello message.
8125 The server is considered valid only when the response contains this server
8126 hello message.
8127
8128 All servers tested till there correctly reply to SSLv3 client hello messages,
8129 and most servers tested do not even log the requests containing only hello
8130 messages, which is appreciable.
8131
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02008132 Note that this check works even when SSL support was not built into haproxy
8133 because it forges the SSL message. When SSL support is available, it is best
8134 to use native SSL health checks instead of this one.
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01008135
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02008136 See also: "option httpchk", "check-ssl"
8137
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01008138
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01008139option tcp-check
8140 Perform health checks using tcp-check send/expect sequences
8141 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8142 yes | no | yes | yes
8143
8144 This health check method is intended to be combined with "tcp-check" command
8145 lists in order to support send/expect types of health check sequences.
8146
8147 TCP checks currently support 4 modes of operations :
8148 - no "tcp-check" directive : the health check only consists in a connection
8149 attempt, which remains the default mode.
8150
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03008151 - "tcp-check send" or "tcp-check send-binary" only is mentioned : this is
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01008152 used to send a string along with a connection opening. With some
8153 protocols, it helps sending a "QUIT" message for example that prevents
8154 the server from logging a connection error for each health check. The
8155 check result will still be based on the ability to open the connection
8156 only.
8157
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03008158 - "tcp-check expect" only is mentioned : this is used to test a banner.
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01008159 The connection is opened and haproxy waits for the server to present some
8160 contents which must validate some rules. The check result will be based
8161 on the matching between the contents and the rules. This is suited for
8162 POP, IMAP, SMTP, FTP, SSH, TELNET.
8163
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03008164 - both "tcp-check send" and "tcp-check expect" are mentioned : this is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008165 used to test a hello-type protocol. HAProxy sends a message, the server
8166 responds and its response is analyzed. the check result will be based on
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03008167 the matching between the response contents and the rules. This is often
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01008168 suited for protocols which require a binding or a request/response model.
8169 LDAP, MySQL, Redis and SSL are example of such protocols, though they
8170 already all have their dedicated checks with a deeper understanding of
8171 the respective protocols.
8172 In this mode, many questions may be sent and many answers may be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008173 analyzed.
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01008174
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02008175 A fifth mode can be used to insert comments in different steps of the
8176 script.
8177
8178 For each tcp-check rule you create, you can add a "comment" directive,
8179 followed by a string. This string will be reported in the log and stderr
8180 in debug mode. It is useful to make user-friendly error reporting.
8181 The "comment" is of course optional.
8182
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +01008183 During the execution of a health check, a variable scope is made available
8184 to store data samples, using the "tcp-check set-var" operation. Freeing
8185 those variable is possible using "tcp-check unset-var".
8186
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02008187
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01008188 Examples :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008189 # perform a POP check (analyze only server's banner)
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01008190 option tcp-check
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02008191 tcp-check expect string +OK\ POP3\ ready comment POP\ protocol
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01008192
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008193 # perform an IMAP check (analyze only server's banner)
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01008194 option tcp-check
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02008195 tcp-check expect string *\ OK\ IMAP4\ ready comment IMAP\ protocol
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01008196
8197 # look for the redis master server after ensuring it speaks well
8198 # redis protocol, then it exits properly.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008199 # (send a command then analyze the response 3 times)
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01008200 option tcp-check
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02008201 tcp-check comment PING\ phase
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01008202 tcp-check send PING\r\n
Baptiste Assmanna3322992015-08-04 10:12:18 +02008203 tcp-check expect string +PONG
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02008204 tcp-check comment role\ check
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01008205 tcp-check send info\ replication\r\n
8206 tcp-check expect string role:master
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02008207 tcp-check comment QUIT\ phase
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01008208 tcp-check send QUIT\r\n
8209 tcp-check expect string +OK
8210
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008211 forge a HTTP request, then analyze the response
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01008212 (send many headers before analyzing)
8213 option tcp-check
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02008214 tcp-check comment forge\ and\ send\ HTTP\ request
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01008215 tcp-check send HEAD\ /\ HTTP/1.1\r\n
8216 tcp-check send Host:\ www.mydomain.com\r\n
8217 tcp-check send User-Agent:\ HAProxy\ tcpcheck\r\n
8218 tcp-check send \r\n
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02008219 tcp-check expect rstring HTTP/1\..\ (2..|3..) comment check\ HTTP\ response
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01008220
8221
8222 See also : "tcp-check expect", "tcp-check send"
8223
8224
Willy Tarreau9ea05a72009-06-14 12:07:01 +02008225option tcp-smart-accept
8226no option tcp-smart-accept
8227 Enable or disable the saving of one ACK packet during the accept sequence
8228 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8229 yes | yes | yes | no
8230 Arguments : none
8231
8232 When an HTTP connection request comes in, the system acknowledges it on
8233 behalf of HAProxy, then the client immediately sends its request, and the
8234 system acknowledges it too while it is notifying HAProxy about the new
8235 connection. HAProxy then reads the request and responds. This means that we
8236 have one TCP ACK sent by the system for nothing, because the request could
8237 very well be acknowledged by HAProxy when it sends its response.
8238
8239 For this reason, in HTTP mode, HAProxy automatically asks the system to avoid
8240 sending this useless ACK on platforms which support it (currently at least
8241 Linux). It must not cause any problem, because the system will send it anyway
8242 after 40 ms if the response takes more time than expected to come.
8243
8244 During complex network debugging sessions, it may be desirable to disable
8245 this optimization because delayed ACKs can make troubleshooting more complex
8246 when trying to identify where packets are delayed. It is then possible to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008247 fall back to normal behavior by specifying "no option tcp-smart-accept".
Willy Tarreau9ea05a72009-06-14 12:07:01 +02008248
8249 It is also possible to force it for non-HTTP proxies by simply specifying
8250 "option tcp-smart-accept". For instance, it can make sense with some services
8251 such as SMTP where the server speaks first.
8252
8253 It is recommended to avoid forcing this option in a defaults section. In case
8254 of doubt, consider setting it back to automatic values by prepending the
8255 "default" keyword before it, or disabling it using the "no" keyword.
8256
Willy Tarreaud88edf22009-06-14 15:48:17 +02008257 See also : "option tcp-smart-connect"
8258
8259
8260option tcp-smart-connect
8261no option tcp-smart-connect
8262 Enable or disable the saving of one ACK packet during the connect sequence
8263 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8264 yes | no | yes | yes
8265 Arguments : none
8266
8267 On certain systems (at least Linux), HAProxy can ask the kernel not to
8268 immediately send an empty ACK upon a connection request, but to directly
8269 send the buffer request instead. This saves one packet on the network and
8270 thus boosts performance. It can also be useful for some servers, because they
8271 immediately get the request along with the incoming connection.
8272
8273 This feature is enabled when "option tcp-smart-connect" is set in a backend.
8274 It is not enabled by default because it makes network troubleshooting more
8275 complex.
8276
8277 It only makes sense to enable it with protocols where the client speaks first
8278 such as HTTP. In other situations, if there is no data to send in place of
8279 the ACK, a normal ACK is sent.
8280
8281 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8282 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8283
8284 See also : "option tcp-smart-accept"
8285
Willy Tarreau9ea05a72009-06-14 12:07:01 +02008286
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008287option tcpka
8288 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on both sides
8289 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8290 yes | yes | yes | yes
8291 Arguments : none
8292
8293 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
8294 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008295 periods (e.g. remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008296 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
8297
8298 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
8299 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
8300 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
8301 operating system and its tuning parameters.
8302
8303 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
8304 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
8305 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
8306 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
8307 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
8308
8309 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
8310
8311 Using option "tcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on both
8312 the client and server sides of a connection. Note that this is meaningful
8313 only in "defaults" or "listen" sections. If this option is used in a
8314 frontend, only the client side will get keep-alives, and if this option is
8315 used in a backend, only the server side will get keep-alives. For this
8316 reason, it is strongly recommended to explicitly use "option clitcpka" and
8317 "option srvtcpka" when the configuration is split between frontends and
8318 backends.
8319
8320 See also : "option clitcpka", "option srvtcpka"
8321
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008322
8323option tcplog
8324 Enable advanced logging of TCP connections with session state and timers
8325 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Tim Duesterhus9ad9f352018-02-05 20:52:27 +01008326 yes | yes | yes | no
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008327 Arguments : none
8328
8329 By default, the log output format is very poor, as it only contains the
8330 source and destination addresses, and the instance name. By specifying
8331 "option tcplog", each log line turns into a much richer format including, but
8332 not limited to, the connection timers, the session status, the connections
8333 numbers, the frontend, backend and server name, and of course the source
8334 address and ports. This option is useful for pure TCP proxies in order to
8335 find which of the client or server disconnects or times out. For normal HTTP
8336 proxies, it's better to use "option httplog" which is even more complete.
8337
Guillaume de Lafond29f45602017-03-31 19:52:15 +02008338 "option tcplog" overrides any previous "log-format" directive.
8339
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008340 See also : "option httplog", and section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008341
8342
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008343option transparent
8344no option transparent
8345 Enable client-side transparent proxying
8346 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau4b1f8592008-12-23 23:13:55 +01008347 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008348 Arguments : none
8349
8350 This option was introduced in order to provide layer 7 persistence to layer 3
8351 load balancers. The idea is to use the OS's ability to redirect an incoming
8352 connection for a remote address to a local process (here HAProxy), and let
8353 this process know what address was initially requested. When this option is
8354 used, sessions without cookies will be forwarded to the original destination
8355 IP address of the incoming request (which should match that of another
8356 equipment), while requests with cookies will still be forwarded to the
8357 appropriate server.
8358
8359 Note that contrary to a common belief, this option does NOT make HAProxy
8360 present the client's IP to the server when establishing the connection.
8361
Willy Tarreaua1146052011-03-01 09:51:54 +01008362 See also: the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword, and the
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008363 "transparent" option of the "bind" keyword.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008364
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008365
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09008366external-check command <command>
8367 Executable to run when performing an external-check
8368 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8369 yes | no | yes | yes
8370
8371 Arguments :
8372 <command> is the external command to run
8373
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09008374 The arguments passed to the to the command are:
8375
Cyril Bonté777be862014-12-02 21:21:35 +01008376 <proxy_address> <proxy_port> <server_address> <server_port>
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09008377
Cyril Bonté777be862014-12-02 21:21:35 +01008378 The <proxy_address> and <proxy_port> are derived from the first listener
8379 that is either IPv4, IPv6 or a UNIX socket. In the case of a UNIX socket
8380 listener the proxy_address will be the path of the socket and the
8381 <proxy_port> will be the string "NOT_USED". In a backend section, it's not
8382 possible to determine a listener, and both <proxy_address> and <proxy_port>
8383 will have the string value "NOT_USED".
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09008384
Cyril Bonté72cda2a2014-12-27 22:28:39 +01008385 Some values are also provided through environment variables.
8386
8387 Environment variables :
8388 HAPROXY_PROXY_ADDR The first bind address if available (or empty if not
8389 applicable, for example in a "backend" section).
8390
8391 HAPROXY_PROXY_ID The backend id.
8392
8393 HAPROXY_PROXY_NAME The backend name.
8394
8395 HAPROXY_PROXY_PORT The first bind port if available (or empty if not
8396 applicable, for example in a "backend" section or
8397 for a UNIX socket).
8398
8399 HAPROXY_SERVER_ADDR The server address.
8400
8401 HAPROXY_SERVER_CURCONN The current number of connections on the server.
8402
8403 HAPROXY_SERVER_ID The server id.
8404
8405 HAPROXY_SERVER_MAXCONN The server max connections.
8406
8407 HAPROXY_SERVER_NAME The server name.
8408
8409 HAPROXY_SERVER_PORT The server port if available (or empty for a UNIX
8410 socket).
8411
8412 PATH The PATH environment variable used when executing
8413 the command may be set using "external-check path".
8414
William Lallemand4d03e432019-06-14 15:35:37 +02008415 See also "2.3. Environment variables" for other variables.
8416
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09008417 If the command executed and exits with a zero status then the check is
8418 considered to have passed, otherwise the check is considered to have
8419 failed.
8420
8421 Example :
8422 external-check command /bin/true
8423
8424 See also : "external-check", "option external-check", "external-check path"
8425
8426
8427external-check path <path>
8428 The value of the PATH environment variable used when running an external-check
8429 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8430 yes | no | yes | yes
8431
8432 Arguments :
8433 <path> is the path used when executing external command to run
8434
8435 The default path is "".
8436
8437 Example :
8438 external-check path "/usr/bin:/bin"
8439
8440 See also : "external-check", "option external-check",
8441 "external-check command"
8442
8443
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02008444persist rdp-cookie
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02008445persist rdp-cookie(<name>)
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02008446 Enable RDP cookie-based persistence
8447 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8448 yes | no | yes | yes
8449 Arguments :
8450 <name> is the optional name of the RDP cookie to check. If omitted, the
Willy Tarreau61e28f22010-05-16 22:31:05 +02008451 default cookie name "msts" will be used. There currently is no
8452 valid reason to change this name.
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02008453
8454 This statement enables persistence based on an RDP cookie. The RDP cookie
8455 contains all information required to find the server in the list of known
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008456 servers. So when this option is set in the backend, the request is analyzed
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02008457 and if an RDP cookie is found, it is decoded. If it matches a known server
8458 which is still UP (or if "option persist" is set), then the connection is
8459 forwarded to this server.
8460
8461 Note that this only makes sense in a TCP backend, but for this to work, the
8462 frontend must have waited long enough to ensure that an RDP cookie is present
8463 in the request buffer. This is the same requirement as with the "rdp-cookie"
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01008464 load-balancing method. Thus it is highly recommended to put all statements in
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02008465 a single "listen" section.
8466
Willy Tarreau61e28f22010-05-16 22:31:05 +02008467 Also, it is important to understand that the terminal server will emit this
8468 RDP cookie only if it is configured for "token redirection mode", which means
8469 that the "IP address redirection" option is disabled.
8470
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02008471 Example :
8472 listen tse-farm
8473 bind :3389
8474 # wait up to 5s for an RDP cookie in the request
8475 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
8476 tcp-request content accept if RDP_COOKIE
8477 # apply RDP cookie persistence
8478 persist rdp-cookie
8479 # if server is unknown, let's balance on the same cookie.
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02008480 # alternatively, "balance leastconn" may be useful too.
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02008481 balance rdp-cookie
8482 server srv1 1.1.1.1:3389
8483 server srv2 1.1.1.2:3389
8484
Simon Hormanab814e02011-06-24 14:50:20 +09008485 See also : "balance rdp-cookie", "tcp-request", the "req_rdp_cookie" ACL and
8486 the rdp_cookie pattern fetch function.
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02008487
8488
Willy Tarreau3a7d2072009-03-05 23:48:25 +01008489rate-limit sessions <rate>
8490 Set a limit on the number of new sessions accepted per second on a frontend
8491 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8492 yes | yes | yes | no
8493 Arguments :
8494 <rate> The <rate> parameter is an integer designating the maximum number
8495 of new sessions per second to accept on the frontend.
8496
8497 When the frontend reaches the specified number of new sessions per second, it
8498 stops accepting new connections until the rate drops below the limit again.
8499 During this time, the pending sessions will be kept in the socket's backlog
8500 (in system buffers) and haproxy will not even be aware that sessions are
8501 pending. When applying very low limit on a highly loaded service, it may make
8502 sense to increase the socket's backlog using the "backlog" keyword.
8503
8504 This feature is particularly efficient at blocking connection-based attacks
8505 or service abuse on fragile servers. Since the session rate is measured every
8506 millisecond, it is extremely accurate. Also, the limit applies immediately,
8507 no delay is needed at all to detect the threshold.
8508
8509 Example : limit the connection rate on SMTP to 10 per second max
8510 listen smtp
8511 mode tcp
8512 bind :25
8513 rate-limit sessions 10
Panagiotis Panagiotopoulos7282d8e2016-02-11 16:37:15 +02008514 server smtp1 127.0.0.1:1025
Willy Tarreau3a7d2072009-03-05 23:48:25 +01008515
Willy Tarreaua17c2d92011-07-25 08:16:20 +02008516 Note : when the maximum rate is reached, the frontend's status is not changed
8517 but its sockets appear as "WAITING" in the statistics if the
8518 "socket-stats" option is enabled.
Willy Tarreau3a7d2072009-03-05 23:48:25 +01008519
8520 See also : the "backlog" keyword and the "fe_sess_rate" ACL criterion.
8521
8522
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02008523redirect location <loc> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
8524redirect prefix <pfx> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
8525redirect scheme <sch> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02008526 Return an HTTP redirection if/unless a condition is matched
8527 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8528 no | yes | yes | yes
8529
8530 If/unless the condition is matched, the HTTP request will lead to a redirect
Willy Tarreauf285f542010-01-03 20:03:03 +01008531 response. If no condition is specified, the redirect applies unconditionally.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02008532
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01008533 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02008534 <loc> With "redirect location", the exact value in <loc> is placed into
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01008535 the HTTP "Location" header. When used in an "http-request" rule,
8536 <loc> value follows the log-format rules and can include some
8537 dynamic values (see Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4).
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02008538
8539 <pfx> With "redirect prefix", the "Location" header is built from the
8540 concatenation of <pfx> and the complete URI path, including the
8541 query string, unless the "drop-query" option is specified (see
8542 below). As a special case, if <pfx> equals exactly "/", then
8543 nothing is inserted before the original URI. It allows one to
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01008544 redirect to the same URL (for instance, to insert a cookie). When
8545 used in an "http-request" rule, <pfx> value follows the log-format
8546 rules and can include some dynamic values (see Custom Log Format
8547 in section 8.2.4).
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02008548
8549 <sch> With "redirect scheme", then the "Location" header is built by
8550 concatenating <sch> with "://" then the first occurrence of the
8551 "Host" header, and then the URI path, including the query string
8552 unless the "drop-query" option is specified (see below). If no
8553 path is found or if the path is "*", then "/" is used instead. If
8554 no "Host" header is found, then an empty host component will be
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03008555 returned, which most recent browsers interpret as redirecting to
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02008556 the same host. This directive is mostly used to redirect HTTP to
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01008557 HTTPS. When used in an "http-request" rule, <sch> value follows
8558 the log-format rules and can include some dynamic values (see
8559 Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4).
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01008560
8561 <code> The code is optional. It indicates which type of HTTP redirection
Willy Tarreaub67fdc42013-03-29 19:28:11 +01008562 is desired. Only codes 301, 302, 303, 307 and 308 are supported,
8563 with 302 used by default if no code is specified. 301 means
8564 "Moved permanently", and a browser may cache the Location. 302
Baptiste Assmannea849c02015-08-03 11:42:50 +02008565 means "Moved temporarily" and means that the browser should not
Willy Tarreaub67fdc42013-03-29 19:28:11 +01008566 cache the redirection. 303 is equivalent to 302 except that the
8567 browser will fetch the location with a GET method. 307 is just
8568 like 302 but makes it clear that the same method must be reused.
8569 Likewise, 308 replaces 301 if the same method must be used.
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01008570
8571 <option> There are several options which can be specified to adjust the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008572 expected behavior of a redirection :
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01008573
8574 - "drop-query"
8575 When this keyword is used in a prefix-based redirection, then the
8576 location will be set without any possible query-string, which is useful
8577 for directing users to a non-secure page for instance. It has no effect
8578 with a location-type redirect.
8579
Willy Tarreau81e3b4f2010-01-10 00:42:19 +01008580 - "append-slash"
8581 This keyword may be used in conjunction with "drop-query" to redirect
8582 users who use a URL not ending with a '/' to the same one with the '/'.
8583 It can be useful to ensure that search engines will only see one URL.
8584 For this, a return code 301 is preferred.
8585
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01008586 - "set-cookie NAME[=value]"
8587 A "Set-Cookie" header will be added with NAME (and optionally "=value")
8588 to the response. This is sometimes used to indicate that a user has
8589 been seen, for instance to protect against some types of DoS. No other
8590 cookie option is added, so the cookie will be a session cookie. Note
8591 that for a browser, a sole cookie name without an equal sign is
8592 different from a cookie with an equal sign.
8593
8594 - "clear-cookie NAME[=]"
8595 A "Set-Cookie" header will be added with NAME (and optionally "="), but
8596 with the "Max-Age" attribute set to zero. This will tell the browser to
8597 delete this cookie. It is useful for instance on logout pages. It is
8598 important to note that clearing the cookie "NAME" will not remove a
8599 cookie set with "NAME=value". You have to clear the cookie "NAME=" for
8600 that, because the browser makes the difference.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02008601
8602 Example: move the login URL only to HTTPS.
8603 acl clear dst_port 80
8604 acl secure dst_port 8080
8605 acl login_page url_beg /login
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01008606 acl logout url_beg /logout
Willy Tarreau79da4692008-11-19 20:03:04 +01008607 acl uid_given url_reg /login?userid=[^&]+
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01008608 acl cookie_set hdr_sub(cookie) SEEN=1
8609
8610 redirect prefix https://mysite.com set-cookie SEEN=1 if !cookie_set
Willy Tarreau79da4692008-11-19 20:03:04 +01008611 redirect prefix https://mysite.com if login_page !secure
8612 redirect prefix http://mysite.com drop-query if login_page !uid_given
8613 redirect location http://mysite.com/ if !login_page secure
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01008614 redirect location / clear-cookie USERID= if logout
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02008615
Willy Tarreau81e3b4f2010-01-10 00:42:19 +01008616 Example: send redirects for request for articles without a '/'.
8617 acl missing_slash path_reg ^/article/[^/]*$
8618 redirect code 301 prefix / drop-query append-slash if missing_slash
8619
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02008620 Example: redirect all HTTP traffic to HTTPS when SSL is handled by haproxy.
David BERARDe7153042012-11-03 00:11:31 +01008621 redirect scheme https if !{ ssl_fc }
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02008622
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01008623 Example: append 'www.' prefix in front of all hosts not having it
Coen Rosdorff596659b2016-04-11 11:33:49 +02008624 http-request redirect code 301 location \
8625 http://www.%[hdr(host)]%[capture.req.uri] \
8626 unless { hdr_beg(host) -i www }
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01008627
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008628 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02008629
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01008630
Willy Tarreaue5c5ce92008-06-20 17:27:19 +02008631retries <value>
8632 Set the number of retries to perform on a server after a connection failure
8633 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8634 yes | no | yes | yes
8635 Arguments :
8636 <value> is the number of times a connection attempt should be retried on
8637 a server when a connection either is refused or times out. The
8638 default value is 3.
8639
8640 It is important to understand that this value applies to the number of
8641 connection attempts, not full requests. When a connection has effectively
8642 been established to a server, there will be no more retry.
8643
8644 In order to avoid immediate reconnections to a server which is restarting,
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07008645 a turn-around timer of min("timeout connect", one second) is applied before
8646 a retry occurs.
Willy Tarreaue5c5ce92008-06-20 17:27:19 +02008647
8648 When "option redispatch" is set, the last retry may be performed on another
8649 server even if a cookie references a different server.
8650
8651 See also : "option redispatch"
8652
8653
Olivier Houcharda254a372019-04-05 15:30:12 +02008654retry-on [list of keywords]
8655 Specify when to attempt to automatically retry a failed request
8656 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8657 yes | no | yes | yes
8658 Arguments :
8659 <keywords> is a list of keywords or HTTP status codes, each representing a
8660 type of failure event on which an attempt to retry the request
8661 is desired. Please read the notes at the bottom before changing
8662 this setting. The following keywords are supported :
8663
8664 none never retry
8665
8666 conn-failure retry when the connection or the SSL handshake failed
8667 and the request could not be sent. This is the default.
8668
8669 empty-response retry when the server connection was closed after part
8670 of the request was sent, and nothing was received from
8671 the server. This type of failure may be caused by the
8672 request timeout on the server side, poor network
8673 condition, or a server crash or restart while
8674 processing the request.
8675
Olivier Houcharde3249a92019-05-03 23:01:47 +02008676 junk-response retry when the server returned something not looking
8677 like a complete HTTP response. This includes partial
8678 responses headers as well as non-HTTP contents. It
8679 usually is a bad idea to retry on such events, which
8680 may be caused a configuration issue (wrong server port)
8681 or by the request being harmful to the server (buffer
8682 overflow attack for example).
8683
Olivier Houcharda254a372019-04-05 15:30:12 +02008684 response-timeout the server timeout stroke while waiting for the server
8685 to respond to the request. This may be caused by poor
8686 network condition, the reuse of an idle connection
8687 which has expired on the path, or by the request being
8688 extremely expensive to process. It generally is a bad
8689 idea to retry on such events on servers dealing with
8690 heavy database processing (full scans, etc) as it may
8691 amplify denial of service attacks.
8692
Olivier Houchard865d8392019-05-03 22:46:27 +02008693 0rtt-rejected retry requests which were sent over early data and were
8694 rejected by the server. These requests are generally
8695 considered to be safe to retry.
8696
Olivier Houcharda254a372019-04-05 15:30:12 +02008697 <status> any HTTP status code among "404" (Not Found), "408"
8698 (Request Timeout), "425" (Too Early), "500" (Server
8699 Error), "501" (Not Implemented), "502" (Bad Gateway),
8700 "503" (Service Unavailable), "504" (Gateway Timeout).
8701
Olivier Houchardddf0e032019-05-10 18:05:40 +02008702 all-retryable-errors
8703 retry request for any error that are considered
8704 retryable. This currently activates "conn-failure",
8705 "empty-response", "junk-response", "response-timeout",
8706 "0rtt-rejected", "500", "502", "503", and "504".
8707
Olivier Houcharda254a372019-04-05 15:30:12 +02008708 Using this directive replaces any previous settings with the new ones; it is
8709 not cumulative.
8710
8711 Please note that using anything other than "none" and "conn-failure" requires
8712 to allocate a buffer and copy the whole request into it, so it has memory and
8713 performance impacts. Requests not fitting in a single buffer will never be
8714 retried (see the global tune.bufsize setting).
8715
8716 You have to make sure the application has a replay protection mechanism built
8717 in such as a unique transaction IDs passed in requests, or that replaying the
8718 same request has no consequence, or it is very dangerous to use any retry-on
8719 value beside "conn-failure" and "none". Static file servers and caches are
8720 generally considered safe against any type of retry. Using a status code can
8721 be useful to quickly leave a server showing an abnormal behavior (out of
8722 memory, file system issues, etc), but in this case it may be a good idea to
8723 immediately redispatch the connection to another server (please see "option
8724 redispatch" for this). Last, it is important to understand that most causes
8725 of failures are the requests themselves and that retrying a request causing a
8726 server to misbehave will often make the situation even worse for this server,
8727 or for the whole service in case of redispatch.
8728
8729 Unless you know exactly how the application deals with replayed requests, you
8730 should not use this directive.
8731
8732 The default is "conn-failure".
8733
8734 See also: "retries", "option redispatch", "tune.bufsize"
8735
David du Colombier486df472011-03-17 10:40:26 +01008736server <name> <address>[:[port]] [param*]
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008737 Declare a server in a backend
8738 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8739 no | no | yes | yes
8740 Arguments :
8741 <name> is the internal name assigned to this server. This name will
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008742 appear in logs and alerts. If "http-send-name-header" is
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05008743 set, it will be added to the request header sent to the server.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008744
David du Colombier486df472011-03-17 10:40:26 +01008745 <address> is the IPv4 or IPv6 address of the server. Alternatively, a
8746 resolvable hostname is supported, but this name will be resolved
8747 during start-up. Address "0.0.0.0" or "*" has a special meaning.
8748 It indicates that the connection will be forwarded to the same IP
Willy Tarreaud669a4f2010-07-13 14:49:50 +02008749 address as the one from the client connection. This is useful in
8750 transparent proxy architectures where the client's connection is
8751 intercepted and haproxy must forward to the original destination
8752 address. This is more or less what the "transparent" keyword does
8753 except that with a server it's possible to limit concurrency and
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01008754 to report statistics. Optionally, an address family prefix may be
8755 used before the address to force the family regardless of the
8756 address format, which can be useful to specify a path to a unix
8757 socket with no slash ('/'). Currently supported prefixes are :
8758 - 'ipv4@' -> address is always IPv4
8759 - 'ipv6@' -> address is always IPv6
8760 - 'unix@' -> address is a path to a local unix socket
Willy Tarreauccfccef2014-05-10 01:49:15 +02008761 - 'abns@' -> address is in abstract namespace (Linux only)
William Lallemand2fe7dd02018-09-11 16:51:29 +02008762 - 'sockpair@' -> address is the FD of a connected unix
8763 socket or of a socketpair. During a connection, the
8764 backend creates a pair of connected sockets, and passes
8765 one of them over the FD. The bind part will use the
8766 received socket as the client FD. Should be used
8767 carefully.
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02008768 You may want to reference some environment variables in the
8769 address parameter, see section 2.3 about environment
Willy Tarreau6a031d12016-11-07 19:42:35 +01008770 variables. The "init-addr" setting can be used to modify the way
8771 IP addresses should be resolved upon startup.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008772
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02008773 <port> is an optional port specification. If set, all connections will
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008774 be sent to this port. If unset, the same port the client
8775 connected to will be used. The port may also be prefixed by a "+"
8776 or a "-". In this case, the server's port will be determined by
8777 adding this value to the client's port.
8778
8779 <param*> is a list of parameters for this server. The "server" keywords
8780 accepts an important number of options and has a complete section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008781 dedicated to it. Please refer to section 5 for more details.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008782
8783 Examples :
8784 server first 10.1.1.1:1080 cookie first check inter 1000
8785 server second 10.1.1.2:1080 cookie second check inter 1000
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01008786 server transp ipv4@
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02008787 server backup "${SRV_BACKUP}:1080" backup
8788 server www1_dc1 "${LAN_DC1}.101:80"
8789 server www1_dc2 "${LAN_DC2}.101:80"
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008790
Willy Tarreau55dcaf62015-09-27 15:03:15 +02008791 Note: regarding Linux's abstract namespace sockets, HAProxy uses the whole
8792 sun_path length is used for the address length. Some other programs
8793 such as socat use the string length only by default. Pass the option
8794 ",unix-tightsocklen=0" to any abstract socket definition in socat to
8795 make it compatible with HAProxy's.
8796
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05008797 See also: "default-server", "http-send-name-header" and section 5 about
8798 server options
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008799
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02008800server-state-file-name [<file>]
8801 Set the server state file to read, load and apply to servers available in
8802 this backend. It only applies when the directive "load-server-state-from-file"
8803 is set to "local". When <file> is not provided or if this directive is not
8804 set, then backend name is used. If <file> starts with a slash '/', then it is
8805 considered as an absolute path. Otherwise, <file> is concatenated to the
8806 global directive "server-state-file-base".
8807
8808 Example: the minimal configuration below would make HAProxy look for the
8809 state server file '/etc/haproxy/states/bk':
8810
8811 global
8812 server-state-file-base /etc/haproxy/states
8813
Willy Tarreauc9c6cdb2020-03-05 16:03:58 +01008814 backend bk
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02008815 load-server-state-from-file
8816
8817 See also: "server-state-file-base", "load-server-state-from-file", and
8818 "show servers state"
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008819
Frédéric Lécaillecb4502e2017-04-20 13:36:25 +02008820server-template <prefix> <num | range> <fqdn>[:<port>] [params*]
8821 Set a template to initialize servers with shared parameters.
8822 The names of these servers are built from <prefix> and <num | range> parameters.
8823 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8824 no | no | yes | yes
8825
8826 Arguments:
8827 <prefix> A prefix for the server names to be built.
8828
8829 <num | range>
8830 If <num> is provided, this template initializes <num> servers
8831 with 1 up to <num> as server name suffixes. A range of numbers
8832 <num_low>-<num_high> may also be used to use <num_low> up to
8833 <num_high> as server name suffixes.
8834
8835 <fqdn> A FQDN for all the servers this template initializes.
8836
8837 <port> Same meaning as "server" <port> argument (see "server" keyword).
8838
8839 <params*>
8840 Remaining server parameters among all those supported by "server"
8841 keyword.
8842
8843 Examples:
8844 # Initializes 3 servers with srv1, srv2 and srv3 as names,
8845 # google.com as FQDN, and health-check enabled.
8846 server-template srv 1-3 google.com:80 check
8847
8848 # or
8849 server-template srv 3 google.com:80 check
8850
8851 # would be equivalent to:
8852 server srv1 google.com:80 check
8853 server srv2 google.com:80 check
8854 server srv3 google.com:80 check
8855
8856
8857
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008858source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | client | clientip } ]
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02008859source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | hdr_ip(<hdr>[,<occ>]) } ]
Willy Tarreaud53f96b2009-02-04 18:46:54 +01008860source <addr>[:<port>] [interface <name>]
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008861 Set the source address for outgoing connections
8862 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8863 yes | no | yes | yes
8864 Arguments :
8865 <addr> is the IPv4 address HAProxy will bind to before connecting to a
8866 server. This address is also used as a source for health checks.
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01008867
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008868 The default value of 0.0.0.0 means that the system will select
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01008869 the most appropriate address to reach its destination. Optionally
8870 an address family prefix may be used before the address to force
8871 the family regardless of the address format, which can be useful
8872 to specify a path to a unix socket with no slash ('/'). Currently
8873 supported prefixes are :
8874 - 'ipv4@' -> address is always IPv4
8875 - 'ipv6@' -> address is always IPv6
8876 - 'unix@' -> address is a path to a local unix socket
Willy Tarreauccfccef2014-05-10 01:49:15 +02008877 - 'abns@' -> address is in abstract namespace (Linux only)
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +02008878 You may want to reference some environment variables in the
8879 address parameter, see section 2.3 about environment variables.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008880
8881 <port> is an optional port. It is normally not needed but may be useful
8882 in some very specific contexts. The default value of zero means
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +02008883 the system will select a free port. Note that port ranges are not
8884 supported in the backend. If you want to force port ranges, you
8885 have to specify them on each "server" line.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008886
8887 <addr2> is the IP address to present to the server when connections are
8888 forwarded in full transparent proxy mode. This is currently only
8889 supported on some patched Linux kernels. When this address is
8890 specified, clients connecting to the server will be presented
8891 with this address, while health checks will still use the address
8892 <addr>.
8893
8894 <port2> is the optional port to present to the server when connections
8895 are forwarded in full transparent proxy mode (see <addr2> above).
8896 The default value of zero means the system will select a free
8897 port.
8898
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02008899 <hdr> is the name of a HTTP header in which to fetch the IP to bind to.
8900 This is the name of a comma-separated header list which can
8901 contain multiple IP addresses. By default, the last occurrence is
8902 used. This is designed to work with the X-Forwarded-For header
Baptiste Assmannea3e73b2013-02-02 23:47:49 +01008903 and to automatically bind to the client's IP address as seen
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02008904 by previous proxy, typically Stunnel. In order to use another
8905 occurrence from the last one, please see the <occ> parameter
8906 below. When the header (or occurrence) is not found, no binding
8907 is performed so that the proxy's default IP address is used. Also
8908 keep in mind that the header name is case insensitive, as for any
8909 HTTP header.
8910
8911 <occ> is the occurrence number of a value to be used in a multi-value
8912 header. This is to be used in conjunction with "hdr_ip(<hdr>)",
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04008913 in order to specify which occurrence to use for the source IP
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02008914 address. Positive values indicate a position from the first
8915 occurrence, 1 being the first one. Negative values indicate
8916 positions relative to the last one, -1 being the last one. This
8917 is helpful for situations where an X-Forwarded-For header is set
8918 at the entry point of an infrastructure and must be used several
8919 proxy layers away. When this value is not specified, -1 is
8920 assumed. Passing a zero here disables the feature.
8921
Willy Tarreaud53f96b2009-02-04 18:46:54 +01008922 <name> is an optional interface name to which to bind to for outgoing
8923 traffic. On systems supporting this features (currently, only
8924 Linux), this allows one to bind all traffic to the server to
8925 this interface even if it is not the one the system would select
8926 based on routing tables. This should be used with extreme care.
8927 Note that using this option requires root privileges.
8928
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008929 The "source" keyword is useful in complex environments where a specific
8930 address only is allowed to connect to the servers. It may be needed when a
8931 private address must be used through a public gateway for instance, and it is
8932 known that the system cannot determine the adequate source address by itself.
8933
8934 An extension which is available on certain patched Linux kernels may be used
8935 through the "usesrc" optional keyword. It makes it possible to connect to the
8936 servers with an IP address which does not belong to the system itself. This
8937 is called "full transparent proxy mode". For this to work, the destination
8938 servers have to route their traffic back to this address through the machine
8939 running HAProxy, and IP forwarding must generally be enabled on this machine.
8940
8941 In this "full transparent proxy" mode, it is possible to force a specific IP
8942 address to be presented to the servers. This is not much used in fact. A more
8943 common use is to tell HAProxy to present the client's IP address. For this,
8944 there are two methods :
8945
8946 - present the client's IP and port addresses. This is the most transparent
8947 mode, but it can cause problems when IP connection tracking is enabled on
8948 the machine, because a same connection may be seen twice with different
8949 states. However, this solution presents the huge advantage of not
8950 limiting the system to the 64k outgoing address+port couples, because all
8951 of the client ranges may be used.
8952
8953 - present only the client's IP address and select a spare port. This
8954 solution is still quite elegant but slightly less transparent (downstream
8955 firewalls logs will not match upstream's). It also presents the downside
8956 of limiting the number of concurrent connections to the usual 64k ports.
8957 However, since the upstream and downstream ports are different, local IP
8958 connection tracking on the machine will not be upset by the reuse of the
8959 same session.
8960
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008961 This option sets the default source for all servers in the backend. It may
8962 also be specified in a "defaults" section. Finer source address specification
8963 is possible at the server level using the "source" server option. Refer to
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008964 section 5 for more information.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008965
Baptiste Assmann91bd3372015-07-17 21:59:42 +02008966 In order to work, "usesrc" requires root privileges.
8967
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008968 Examples :
8969 backend private
8970 # Connect to the servers using our 192.168.1.200 source address
8971 source 192.168.1.200
8972
8973 backend transparent_ssl1
8974 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address
8975 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc clientip
8976
8977 backend transparent_ssl2
8978 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address and port
8979 # not recommended if IP conntrack is present on the local machine.
8980 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc client
8981
8982 backend transparent_ssl3
8983 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address. It
8984 # is more conntrack-friendly.
8985 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc clientip
8986
8987 backend transparent_smtp
8988 # Connect to the SMTP farm from the client's source address/port
8989 # with Tproxy version 4.
8990 source 0.0.0.0 usesrc clientip
8991
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02008992 backend transparent_http
8993 # Connect to the servers using the client's IP as seen by previous
8994 # proxy.
8995 source 0.0.0.0 usesrc hdr_ip(x-forwarded-for,-1)
8996
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008997 See also : the "source" server option in section 5, the Tproxy patches for
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008998 the Linux kernel on www.balabit.com, the "bind" keyword.
8999
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009000
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02009001stats admin { if | unless } <cond>
9002 Enable statistics admin level if/unless a condition is matched
9003 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02009004 no | yes | yes | yes
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02009005
9006 This statement enables the statistics admin level if/unless a condition is
9007 matched.
9008
9009 The admin level allows to enable/disable servers from the web interface. By
9010 default, statistics page is read-only for security reasons.
9011
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01009012 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
9013 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009014 processes, which can result in random behaviors.
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01009015
Cyril Bonté23b39d92011-02-10 22:54:44 +01009016 Currently, the POST request is limited to the buffer size minus the reserved
9017 buffer space, which means that if the list of servers is too long, the
9018 request won't be processed. It is recommended to alter few servers at a
9019 time.
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02009020
9021 Example :
9022 # statistics admin level only for localhost
9023 backend stats_localhost
9024 stats enable
9025 stats admin if LOCALHOST
9026
9027 Example :
9028 # statistics admin level always enabled because of the authentication
9029 backend stats_auth
9030 stats enable
9031 stats auth admin:AdMiN123
9032 stats admin if TRUE
9033
9034 Example :
9035 # statistics admin level depends on the authenticated user
9036 userlist stats-auth
9037 group admin users admin
9038 user admin insecure-password AdMiN123
9039 group readonly users haproxy
9040 user haproxy insecure-password haproxy
9041
9042 backend stats_auth
9043 stats enable
9044 acl AUTH http_auth(stats-auth)
9045 acl AUTH_ADMIN http_auth_group(stats-auth) admin
9046 stats http-request auth unless AUTH
9047 stats admin if AUTH_ADMIN
9048
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01009049 See also : "stats enable", "stats auth", "stats http-request", "nbproc",
9050 "bind-process", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7 about
9051 ACL usage.
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02009052
9053
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009054stats auth <user>:<passwd>
9055 Enable statistics with authentication and grant access to an account
9056 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02009057 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009058 Arguments :
9059 <user> is a user name to grant access to
9060
9061 <passwd> is the cleartext password associated to this user
9062
9063 This statement enables statistics with default settings, and restricts access
9064 to declared users only. It may be repeated as many times as necessary to
9065 allow as many users as desired. When a user tries to access the statistics
9066 without a valid account, a "401 Forbidden" response will be returned so that
9067 the browser asks the user to provide a valid user and password. The real
9068 which will be returned to the browser is configurable using "stats realm".
9069
9070 Since the authentication method is HTTP Basic Authentication, the passwords
9071 circulate in cleartext on the network. Thus, it was decided that the
9072 configuration file would also use cleartext passwords to remind the users
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +02009073 that those ones should not be sensitive and not shared with any other account.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009074
9075 It is also possible to reduce the scope of the proxies which appear in the
9076 report using "stats scope".
9077
9078 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
9079 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
9080 unobvious parameters.
9081
9082 Example :
9083 # public access (limited to this backend only)
9084 backend public_www
9085 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
9086 stats enable
9087 stats hide-version
9088 stats scope .
9089 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009090 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009091 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
9092 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
9093
9094 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
9095 backend private_monitoring
9096 stats enable
9097 stats uri /admin?stats
9098 stats refresh 5s
9099
9100 See also : "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats scope", "stats uri"
9101
9102
9103stats enable
9104 Enable statistics reporting with default settings
9105 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02009106 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009107 Arguments : none
9108
9109 This statement enables statistics reporting with default settings defined
9110 at build time. Unless stated otherwise, these settings are used :
9111 - stats uri : /haproxy?stats
9112 - stats realm : "HAProxy Statistics"
9113 - stats auth : no authentication
9114 - stats scope : no restriction
9115
9116 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
9117 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
9118 unobvious parameters.
9119
9120 Example :
9121 # public access (limited to this backend only)
9122 backend public_www
9123 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
9124 stats enable
9125 stats hide-version
9126 stats scope .
9127 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009128 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009129 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
9130 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
9131
9132 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
9133 backend private_monitoring
9134 stats enable
9135 stats uri /admin?stats
9136 stats refresh 5s
9137
9138 See also : "stats auth", "stats realm", "stats uri"
9139
9140
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009141stats hide-version
9142 Enable statistics and hide HAProxy version reporting
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02009143 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02009144 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009145 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02009146
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009147 By default, the stats page reports some useful status information along with
9148 the statistics. Among them is HAProxy's version. However, it is generally
9149 considered dangerous to report precise version to anyone, as it can help them
9150 target known weaknesses with specific attacks. The "stats hide-version"
9151 statement removes the version from the statistics report. This is recommended
9152 for public sites or any site with a weak login/password.
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02009153
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +02009154 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
9155 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
9156 unobvious parameters.
9157
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009158 Example :
9159 # public access (limited to this backend only)
9160 backend public_www
9161 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +02009162 stats enable
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009163 stats hide-version
9164 stats scope .
9165 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009166 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009167 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
9168 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02009169
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02009170 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
9171 backend private_monitoring
9172 stats enable
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009173 stats uri /admin?stats
9174 stats refresh 5s
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki15514c22010-01-04 16:03:09 +01009175
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009176 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02009177
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01009178
Cyril Bonté2be1b3f2010-09-30 23:46:30 +02009179stats http-request { allow | deny | auth [realm <realm>] }
9180 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
9181 Access control for statistics
9182
9183 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9184 no | no | yes | yes
9185
9186 As "http-request", these set of options allow to fine control access to
9187 statistics. Each option may be followed by if/unless and acl.
9188 First option with matched condition (or option without condition) is final.
9189 For "deny" a 403 error will be returned, for "allow" normal processing is
9190 performed, for "auth" a 401/407 error code is returned so the client
9191 should be asked to enter a username and password.
9192
9193 There is no fixed limit to the number of http-request statements per
9194 instance.
9195
9196 See also : "http-request", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7
9197 about ACL usage.
9198
9199
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009200stats realm <realm>
9201 Enable statistics and set authentication realm
9202 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02009203 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009204 Arguments :
9205 <realm> is the name of the HTTP Basic Authentication realm reported to
9206 the browser. The browser uses it to display it in the pop-up
9207 inviting the user to enter a valid username and password.
9208
9209 The realm is read as a single word, so any spaces in it should be escaped
9210 using a backslash ('\').
9211
9212 This statement is useful only in conjunction with "stats auth" since it is
9213 only related to authentication.
9214
9215 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
9216 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
9217 unobvious parameters.
9218
9219 Example :
9220 # public access (limited to this backend only)
9221 backend public_www
9222 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
9223 stats enable
9224 stats hide-version
9225 stats scope .
9226 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009227 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009228 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
9229 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
9230
9231 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
9232 backend private_monitoring
9233 stats enable
9234 stats uri /admin?stats
9235 stats refresh 5s
9236
9237 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats uri"
9238
9239
9240stats refresh <delay>
9241 Enable statistics with automatic refresh
9242 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02009243 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009244 Arguments :
9245 <delay> is the suggested refresh delay, specified in seconds, which will
9246 be returned to the browser consulting the report page. While the
9247 browser is free to apply any delay, it will generally respect it
9248 and refresh the page this every seconds. The refresh interval may
9249 be specified in any other non-default time unit, by suffixing the
9250 unit after the value, as explained at the top of this document.
9251
9252 This statement is useful on monitoring displays with a permanent page
9253 reporting the load balancer's activity. When set, the HTML report page will
9254 include a link "refresh"/"stop refresh" so that the user can select whether
9255 he wants automatic refresh of the page or not.
9256
9257 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
9258 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
9259 unobvious parameters.
9260
9261 Example :
9262 # public access (limited to this backend only)
9263 backend public_www
9264 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
9265 stats enable
9266 stats hide-version
9267 stats scope .
9268 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009269 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009270 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
9271 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
9272
9273 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
9274 backend private_monitoring
9275 stats enable
9276 stats uri /admin?stats
9277 stats refresh 5s
9278
9279 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
9280
9281
9282stats scope { <name> | "." }
9283 Enable statistics and limit access scope
9284 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02009285 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009286 Arguments :
9287 <name> is the name of a listen, frontend or backend section to be
9288 reported. The special name "." (a single dot) designates the
9289 section in which the statement appears.
9290
9291 When this statement is specified, only the sections enumerated with this
9292 statement will appear in the report. All other ones will be hidden. This
9293 statement may appear as many times as needed if multiple sections need to be
9294 reported. Please note that the name checking is performed as simple string
9295 comparisons, and that it is never checked that a give section name really
9296 exists.
9297
9298 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
9299 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
9300 unobvious parameters.
9301
9302 Example :
9303 # public access (limited to this backend only)
9304 backend public_www
9305 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
9306 stats enable
9307 stats hide-version
9308 stats scope .
9309 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009310 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009311 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
9312 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
9313
9314 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
9315 backend private_monitoring
9316 stats enable
9317 stats uri /admin?stats
9318 stats refresh 5s
9319
9320 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
9321
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009322
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02009323stats show-desc [ <desc> ]
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009324 Enable reporting of a description on the statistics page.
9325 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02009326 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009327
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02009328 <desc> is an optional description to be reported. If unspecified, the
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009329 description from global section is automatically used instead.
9330
9331 This statement is useful for users that offer shared services to their
9332 customers, where node or description should be different for each customer.
9333
9334 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
9335 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009336 unobvious parameters. By default description is not shown.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009337
9338 Example :
9339 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
9340 backend private_monitoring
9341 stats enable
9342 stats show-desc Master node for Europe, Asia, Africa
9343 stats uri /admin?stats
9344 stats refresh 5s
9345
9346 See also: "show-node", "stats enable", "stats uri" and "description" in
9347 global section.
9348
9349
9350stats show-legends
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02009351 Enable reporting additional information on the statistics page
9352 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9353 yes | yes | yes | yes
9354 Arguments : none
9355
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03009356 Enable reporting additional information on the statistics page :
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009357 - cap: capabilities (proxy)
9358 - mode: one of tcp, http or health (proxy)
9359 - id: SNMP ID (proxy, socket, server)
9360 - IP (socket, server)
9361 - cookie (backend, server)
9362
9363 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
9364 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009365 unobvious parameters. Default behavior is not to show this information.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009366
9367 See also: "stats enable", "stats uri".
9368
9369
9370stats show-node [ <name> ]
9371 Enable reporting of a host name on the statistics page.
9372 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02009373 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009374 Arguments:
9375 <name> is an optional name to be reported. If unspecified, the
9376 node name from global section is automatically used instead.
9377
9378 This statement is useful for users that offer shared services to their
9379 customers, where node or description might be different on a stats page
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009380 provided for each customer. Default behavior is not to show host name.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009381
9382 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
9383 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
9384 unobvious parameters.
9385
9386 Example:
9387 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
9388 backend private_monitoring
9389 stats enable
9390 stats show-node Europe-1
9391 stats uri /admin?stats
9392 stats refresh 5s
9393
9394 See also: "show-desc", "stats enable", "stats uri", and "node" in global
9395 section.
9396
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009397
9398stats uri <prefix>
9399 Enable statistics and define the URI prefix to access them
9400 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02009401 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009402 Arguments :
9403 <prefix> is the prefix of any URI which will be redirected to stats. This
9404 prefix may contain a question mark ('?') to indicate part of a
9405 query string.
9406
9407 The statistics URI is intercepted on the relayed traffic, so it appears as a
9408 page within the normal application. It is strongly advised to ensure that the
9409 selected URI will never appear in the application, otherwise it will never be
9410 possible to reach it in the application.
9411
9412 The default URI compiled in haproxy is "/haproxy?stats", but this may be
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01009413 changed at build time, so it's better to always explicitly specify it here.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009414 It is generally a good idea to include a question mark in the URI so that
9415 intermediate proxies refrain from caching the results. Also, since any string
9416 beginning with the prefix will be accepted as a stats request, the question
9417 mark helps ensuring that no valid URI will begin with the same words.
9418
9419 It is sometimes very convenient to use "/" as the URI prefix, and put that
9420 statement in a "listen" instance of its own. That makes it easy to dedicate
9421 an address or a port to statistics only.
9422
9423 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
9424 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
9425 unobvious parameters.
9426
9427 Example :
9428 # public access (limited to this backend only)
9429 backend public_www
9430 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
9431 stats enable
9432 stats hide-version
9433 stats scope .
9434 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009435 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009436 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
9437 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
9438
9439 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
9440 backend private_monitoring
9441 stats enable
9442 stats uri /admin?stats
9443 stats refresh 5s
9444
9445 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm"
9446
9447
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009448stick match <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <cond>]
9449 Define a request pattern matching condition to stick a user to a server
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009450 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009451 no | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009452
9453 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02009454 <pattern> is a sample expression rule as described in section 7.3. It
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009455 describes what elements of the incoming request or connection
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009456 will be analyzed in the hope to find a matching entry in a
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009457 stickiness table. This rule is mandatory.
9458
9459 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
9460 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
9461 the "stick-table" statement.
9462
9463 <cond> is an optional matching condition. It makes it possible to match
9464 on a certain criterion only when other conditions are met (or
9465 not met). For instance, it could be used to match on a source IP
9466 address except when a request passes through a known proxy, in
9467 which case we'd match on a header containing that IP address.
9468
9469 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
9470 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick match" statement
9471 describes a rule to extract the stickiness criterion from an incoming request
9472 or connection. See section 7 for a complete list of possible patterns and
9473 transformation rules.
9474
9475 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
9476 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
9477 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
9478 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
9479 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
9480 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
9481 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
9482
9483 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick match" statement
9484 will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. See section 7 for
9485 ACL based conditions.
9486
9487 There is no limit on the number of "stick match" statements. The first that
9488 applies and matches will cause the request to be directed to the same server
9489 as was used for the request which created the entry. That way, multiple
9490 matches can be used as fallbacks.
9491
9492 The stick rules are checked after the persistence cookies, so they will not
9493 affect stickiness if a cookie has already been used to select a server. That
9494 way, it becomes very easy to insert cookies and match on IP addresses in
9495 order to maintain stickiness between HTTP and HTTPS.
9496
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01009497 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
9498 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009499 processes, which can result in random behaviors.
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01009500
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009501 Example :
9502 # forward SMTP users to the same server they just used for POP in the
9503 # last 30 minutes
9504 backend pop
9505 mode tcp
9506 balance roundrobin
9507 stick store-request src
9508 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
9509 server s1 192.168.1.1:110
9510 server s2 192.168.1.1:110
9511
9512 backend smtp
9513 mode tcp
9514 balance roundrobin
9515 stick match src table pop
9516 server s1 192.168.1.1:25
9517 server s2 192.168.1.1:25
9518
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01009519 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", "nbproc", "bind-process" and section 7
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02009520 about ACLs and samples fetching.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009521
9522
9523stick on <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
9524 Define a request pattern to associate a user to a server
9525 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9526 no | no | yes | yes
9527
9528 Note : This form is exactly equivalent to "stick match" followed by
9529 "stick store-request", all with the same arguments. Please refer
9530 to both keywords for details. It is only provided as a convenience
9531 for writing more maintainable configurations.
9532
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01009533 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
9534 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009535 processes, which can result in random behaviors.
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01009536
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009537 Examples :
9538 # The following form ...
Willy Tarreauec579d82010-02-26 19:15:04 +01009539 stick on src table pop if !localhost
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009540
9541 # ...is strictly equivalent to this one :
9542 stick match src table pop if !localhost
9543 stick store-request src table pop if !localhost
9544
9545
9546 # Use cookie persistence for HTTP, and stick on source address for HTTPS as
9547 # well as HTTP without cookie. Share the same table between both accesses.
9548 backend http
9549 mode http
9550 balance roundrobin
9551 stick on src table https
9552 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache
9553 server s1 192.168.1.1:80 cookie s1
9554 server s2 192.168.1.1:80 cookie s2
9555
9556 backend https
9557 mode tcp
9558 balance roundrobin
9559 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
9560 stick on src
9561 server s1 192.168.1.1:443
9562 server s2 192.168.1.1:443
9563
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01009564 See also : "stick match", "stick store-request", "nbproc" and "bind-process".
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009565
9566
9567stick store-request <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
9568 Define a request pattern used to create an entry in a stickiness table
9569 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9570 no | no | yes | yes
9571
9572 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02009573 <pattern> is a sample expression rule as described in section 7.3. It
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009574 describes what elements of the incoming request or connection
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009575 will be analyzed, extracted and stored in the table once a
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009576 server is selected.
9577
9578 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
9579 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
9580 the "stick-table" statement.
9581
9582 <cond> is an optional storage condition. It makes it possible to store
9583 certain criteria only when some conditions are met (or not met).
9584 For instance, it could be used to store the source IP address
9585 except when the request passes through a known proxy, in which
9586 case we'd store a converted form of a header containing that IP
9587 address.
9588
9589 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
9590 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick store-request" statement
9591 describes a rule to decide what to extract from the request and when to do
9592 it, in order to store it into a stickiness table for further requests to
9593 match it using the "stick match" statement. Obviously the extracted part must
9594 make sense and have a chance to be matched in a further request. Storing a
9595 client's IP address for instance often makes sense. Storing an ID found in a
9596 URL parameter also makes sense. Storing a source port will almost never make
9597 any sense because it will be randomly matched. See section 7 for a complete
9598 list of possible patterns and transformation rules.
9599
9600 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
9601 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
9602 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
9603 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
9604 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
9605 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
9606 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
9607
9608 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick store-request"
9609 statement will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. This
9610 condition will be evaluated while parsing the request, so any criteria can be
9611 used. See section 7 for ACL based conditions.
9612
9613 There is no limit on the number of "stick store-request" statements, but
9614 there is a limit of 8 simultaneous stores per request or response. This
9615 makes it possible to store up to 8 criteria, all extracted from either the
9616 request or the response, regardless of the number of rules. Only the 8 first
9617 ones which match will be kept. Using this, it is possible to feed multiple
9618 tables at once in the hope to increase the chance to recognize a user on
Willy Tarreau9667a802013-12-09 12:52:13 +01009619 another protocol or access method. Using multiple store-request rules with
9620 the same table is possible and may be used to find the best criterion to rely
9621 on, by arranging the rules by decreasing preference order. Only the first
9622 extracted criterion for a given table will be stored. All subsequent store-
9623 request rules referencing the same table will be skipped and their ACLs will
9624 not be evaluated.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009625
9626 The "store-request" rules are evaluated once the server connection has been
9627 established, so that the table will contain the real server that processed
9628 the request.
9629
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01009630 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
9631 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009632 processes, which can result in random behaviors.
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01009633
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009634 Example :
9635 # forward SMTP users to the same server they just used for POP in the
9636 # last 30 minutes
9637 backend pop
9638 mode tcp
9639 balance roundrobin
9640 stick store-request src
9641 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
9642 server s1 192.168.1.1:110
9643 server s2 192.168.1.1:110
9644
9645 backend smtp
9646 mode tcp
9647 balance roundrobin
9648 stick match src table pop
9649 server s1 192.168.1.1:25
9650 server s2 192.168.1.1:25
9651
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01009652 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", "nbproc", "bind-process" and section 7
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02009653 about ACLs and sample fetching.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009654
9655
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +02009656stick-table type {ip | integer | string [len <length>] | binary [len <length>]}
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02009657 size <size> [expire <expire>] [nopurge] [peers <peersect>]
9658 [store <data_type>]*
Godbach64cef792013-12-04 16:08:22 +08009659 Configure the stickiness table for the current section
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009660 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreauc00cdc22010-06-06 16:48:26 +02009661 no | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009662
9663 Arguments :
9664 ip a table declared with "type ip" will only store IPv4 addresses.
9665 This form is very compact (about 50 bytes per entry) and allows
9666 very fast entry lookup and stores with almost no overhead. This
9667 is mainly used to store client source IP addresses.
9668
David du Colombier9a6d3c92011-03-17 10:40:24 +01009669 ipv6 a table declared with "type ipv6" will only store IPv6 addresses.
9670 This form is very compact (about 60 bytes per entry) and allows
9671 very fast entry lookup and stores with almost no overhead. This
9672 is mainly used to store client source IP addresses.
9673
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009674 integer a table declared with "type integer" will store 32bit integers
9675 which can represent a client identifier found in a request for
9676 instance.
9677
9678 string a table declared with "type string" will store substrings of up
9679 to <len> characters. If the string provided by the pattern
9680 extractor is larger than <len>, it will be truncated before
9681 being stored. During matching, at most <len> characters will be
9682 compared between the string in the table and the extracted
9683 pattern. When not specified, the string is automatically limited
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +02009684 to 32 characters.
9685
9686 binary a table declared with "type binary" will store binary blocks
9687 of <len> bytes. If the block provided by the pattern
9688 extractor is larger than <len>, it will be truncated before
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02009689 being stored. If the block provided by the sample expression
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +02009690 is shorter than <len>, it will be padded by 0. When not
9691 specified, the block is automatically limited to 32 bytes.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009692
9693 <length> is the maximum number of characters that will be stored in a
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +02009694 "string" type table (See type "string" above). Or the number
9695 of bytes of the block in "binary" type table. Be careful when
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009696 changing this parameter as memory usage will proportionally
9697 increase.
9698
9699 <size> is the maximum number of entries that can fit in the table. This
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01009700 value directly impacts memory usage. Count approximately
9701 50 bytes per entry, plus the size of a string if any. The size
9702 supports suffixes "k", "m", "g" for 2^10, 2^20 and 2^30 factors.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009703
9704 [nopurge] indicates that we refuse to purge older entries when the table
9705 is full. When not specified and the table is full when haproxy
9706 wants to store an entry in it, it will flush a few of the oldest
9707 entries in order to release some space for the new ones. This is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009708 most often the desired behavior. In some specific cases, it
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009709 be desirable to refuse new entries instead of purging the older
9710 ones. That may be the case when the amount of data to store is
9711 far above the hardware limits and we prefer not to offer access
9712 to new clients than to reject the ones already connected. When
9713 using this parameter, be sure to properly set the "expire"
9714 parameter (see below).
9715
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02009716 <peersect> is the name of the peers section to use for replication. Entries
9717 which associate keys to server IDs are kept synchronized with
9718 the remote peers declared in this section. All entries are also
9719 automatically learned from the local peer (old process) during a
9720 soft restart.
9721
Willy Tarreau1abc6732015-05-01 19:21:02 +02009722 NOTE : each peers section may be referenced only by tables
9723 belonging to the same unique process.
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01009724
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009725 <expire> defines the maximum duration of an entry in the table since it
9726 was last created, refreshed or matched. The expiration delay is
9727 defined using the standard time format, similarly as the various
9728 timeouts. The maximum duration is slightly above 24 days. See
Jarno Huuskonene0ee0be2017-07-04 10:35:12 +03009729 section 2.4 for more information. If this delay is not specified,
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02009730 the session won't automatically expire, but older entries will
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009731 be removed once full. Be sure not to use the "nopurge" parameter
9732 if not expiration delay is specified.
9733
Willy Tarreau08d5f982010-06-06 13:34:54 +02009734 <data_type> is used to store additional information in the stick-table. This
9735 may be used by ACLs in order to control various criteria related
9736 to the activity of the client matching the stick-table. For each
9737 item specified here, the size of each entry will be inflated so
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02009738 that the additional data can fit. Several data types may be
9739 stored with an entry. Multiple data types may be specified after
9740 the "store" keyword, as a comma-separated list. Alternatively,
9741 it is possible to repeat the "store" keyword followed by one or
9742 several data types. Except for the "server_id" type which is
9743 automatically detected and enabled, all data types must be
9744 explicitly declared to be stored. If an ACL references a data
9745 type which is not stored, the ACL will simply not match. Some
9746 data types require an argument which must be passed just after
9747 the type between parenthesis. See below for the supported data
9748 types and their arguments.
9749
9750 The data types that can be stored with an entry are the following :
9751 - server_id : this is an integer which holds the numeric ID of the server a
9752 request was assigned to. It is used by the "stick match", "stick store",
9753 and "stick on" rules. It is automatically enabled when referenced.
9754
9755 - gpc0 : first General Purpose Counter. It is a positive 32-bit integer
9756 integer which may be used for anything. Most of the time it will be used
9757 to put a special tag on some entries, for instance to note that a
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009758 specific behavior was detected and must be known for future matches.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02009759
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +02009760 - gpc0_rate(<period>) : increment rate of the first General Purpose Counter
9761 over a period. It is a positive 32-bit integer integer which may be used
9762 for anything. Just like <gpc0>, it counts events, but instead of keeping
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009763 a cumulative number, it maintains the rate at which the counter is
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +02009764 incremented. Most of the time it will be used to measure the frequency of
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009765 occurrence of certain events (e.g. requests to a specific URL).
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +02009766
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +01009767 - gpc1 : second General Purpose Counter. It is a positive 32-bit integer
9768 integer which may be used for anything. Most of the time it will be used
9769 to put a special tag on some entries, for instance to note that a
9770 specific behavior was detected and must be known for future matches.
9771
9772 - gpc1_rate(<period>) : increment rate of the second General Purpose Counter
9773 over a period. It is a positive 32-bit integer integer which may be used
9774 for anything. Just like <gpc1>, it counts events, but instead of keeping
9775 a cumulative number, it maintains the rate at which the counter is
9776 incremented. Most of the time it will be used to measure the frequency of
9777 occurrence of certain events (e.g. requests to a specific URL).
9778
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02009779 - conn_cnt : Connection Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which counts
9780 the absolute number of connections received from clients which matched
9781 this entry. It does not mean the connections were accepted, just that
9782 they were received.
9783
9784 - conn_cur : Current Connections. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
9785 stores the concurrent connection counts for the entry. It is incremented
9786 once an incoming connection matches the entry, and decremented once the
9787 connection leaves. That way it is possible to know at any time the exact
9788 number of concurrent connections for an entry.
9789
9790 - conn_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
9791 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
9792 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
9793 incoming connection rate over that period, in connections per period. The
9794 result is an integer which can be matched using ACLs.
9795
9796 - sess_cnt : Session Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which counts
9797 the absolute number of sessions received from clients which matched this
9798 entry. A session is a connection that was accepted by the layer 4 rules.
9799
9800 - sess_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
9801 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
9802 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
9803 incoming session rate over that period, in sessions per period. The
9804 result is an integer which can be matched using ACLs.
9805
9806 - http_req_cnt : HTTP request Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
9807 counts the absolute number of HTTP requests received from clients which
9808 matched this entry. It does not matter whether they are valid requests or
9809 not. Note that this is different from sessions when keep-alive is used on
9810 the client side.
9811
9812 - http_req_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
9813 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
9814 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
9815 HTTP request rate over that period, in requests per period. The result is
9816 an integer which can be matched using ACLs. It does not matter whether
9817 they are valid requests or not. Note that this is different from sessions
9818 when keep-alive is used on the client side.
9819
9820 - http_err_cnt : HTTP Error Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
9821 counts the absolute number of HTTP requests errors induced by clients
9822 which matched this entry. Errors are counted on invalid and truncated
9823 requests, as well as on denied or tarpitted requests, and on failed
9824 authentications. If the server responds with 4xx, then the request is
9825 also counted as an error since it's an error triggered by the client
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009826 (e.g. vulnerability scan).
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02009827
9828 - http_err_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
9829 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
9830 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
9831 HTTP request error rate over that period, in requests per period (see
9832 http_err_cnt above for what is accounted as an error). The result is an
9833 integer which can be matched using ACLs.
9834
9835 - bytes_in_cnt : client to server byte count. It is a positive 64-bit
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009836 integer which counts the cumulative number of bytes received from clients
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02009837 which matched this entry. Headers are included in the count. This may be
9838 used to limit abuse of upload features on photo or video servers.
9839
9840 - bytes_in_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
9841 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
9842 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
9843 incoming bytes rate over that period, in bytes per period. It may be used
9844 to detect users which upload too much and too fast. Warning: with large
9845 uploads, it is possible that the amount of uploaded data will be counted
9846 once upon termination, thus causing spikes in the average transfer speed
9847 instead of having a smooth one. This may partially be smoothed with
9848 "option contstats" though this is not perfect yet. Use of byte_in_cnt is
9849 recommended for better fairness.
9850
9851 - bytes_out_cnt : server to client byte count. It is a positive 64-bit
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009852 integer which counts the cumulative number of bytes sent to clients which
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02009853 matched this entry. Headers are included in the count. This may be used
9854 to limit abuse of bots sucking the whole site.
9855
9856 - bytes_out_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes
9857 an integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
9858 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
9859 outgoing bytes rate over that period, in bytes per period. It may be used
9860 to detect users which download too much and too fast. Warning: with large
9861 transfers, it is possible that the amount of transferred data will be
9862 counted once upon termination, thus causing spikes in the average
9863 transfer speed instead of having a smooth one. This may partially be
9864 smoothed with "option contstats" though this is not perfect yet. Use of
9865 byte_out_cnt is recommended for better fairness.
Willy Tarreau08d5f982010-06-06 13:34:54 +02009866
Willy Tarreauc00cdc22010-06-06 16:48:26 +02009867 There is only one stick-table per proxy. At the moment of writing this doc,
9868 it does not seem useful to have multiple tables per proxy. If this happens
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009869 to be required, simply create a dummy backend with a stick-table in it and
9870 reference it.
9871
9872 It is important to understand that stickiness based on learning information
9873 has some limitations, including the fact that all learned associations are
Baptiste Assmann123ff042016-03-06 23:29:28 +01009874 lost upon restart unless peers are properly configured to transfer such
9875 information upon restart (recommended). In general it can be good as a
9876 complement but not always as an exclusive stickiness.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009877
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02009878 Last, memory requirements may be important when storing many data types.
9879 Indeed, storing all indicators above at once in each entry requires 116 bytes
9880 per entry, or 116 MB for a 1-million entries table. This is definitely not
9881 something that can be ignored.
9882
9883 Example:
9884 # Keep track of counters of up to 1 million IP addresses over 5 minutes
9885 # and store a general purpose counter and the average connection rate
9886 # computed over a sliding window of 30 seconds.
9887 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store gpc0,conn_rate(30s)
9888
Jarno Huuskonene0ee0be2017-07-04 10:35:12 +03009889 See also : "stick match", "stick on", "stick store-request", section 2.4
David du Colombiera13d1b92011-03-17 10:40:22 +01009890 about time format and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009891
9892
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02009893stick store-response <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
Baptiste Assmann2f2d2ec2016-03-06 23:27:24 +01009894 Define a response pattern used to create an entry in a stickiness table
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02009895 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9896 no | no | yes | yes
9897
9898 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02009899 <pattern> is a sample expression rule as described in section 7.3. It
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02009900 describes what elements of the response or connection will
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009901 be analyzed, extracted and stored in the table once a
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02009902 server is selected.
9903
9904 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
9905 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
9906 the "stick-table" statement.
9907
9908 <cond> is an optional storage condition. It makes it possible to store
9909 certain criteria only when some conditions are met (or not met).
9910 For instance, it could be used to store the SSL session ID only
9911 when the response is a SSL server hello.
9912
9913 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
9914 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick store-response"
9915 statement describes a rule to decide what to extract from the response and
9916 when to do it, in order to store it into a stickiness table for further
9917 requests to match it using the "stick match" statement. Obviously the
9918 extracted part must make sense and have a chance to be matched in a further
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02009919 request. Storing an ID found in a header of a response makes sense.
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02009920 See section 7 for a complete list of possible patterns and transformation
9921 rules.
9922
9923 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
9924 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
9925 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
9926 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
9927 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
9928 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
9929 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
9930
9931 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick store-response"
9932 statement will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. This
9933 condition will be evaluated while parsing the response, so any criteria can
9934 be used. See section 7 for ACL based conditions.
9935
9936 There is no limit on the number of "stick store-response" statements, but
9937 there is a limit of 8 simultaneous stores per request or response. This
9938 makes it possible to store up to 8 criteria, all extracted from either the
9939 request or the response, regardless of the number of rules. Only the 8 first
9940 ones which match will be kept. Using this, it is possible to feed multiple
9941 tables at once in the hope to increase the chance to recognize a user on
Willy Tarreau9667a802013-12-09 12:52:13 +01009942 another protocol or access method. Using multiple store-response rules with
9943 the same table is possible and may be used to find the best criterion to rely
9944 on, by arranging the rules by decreasing preference order. Only the first
9945 extracted criterion for a given table will be stored. All subsequent store-
9946 response rules referencing the same table will be skipped and their ACLs will
9947 not be evaluated. However, even if a store-request rule references a table, a
9948 store-response rule may also use the same table. This means that each table
9949 may learn exactly one element from the request and one element from the
9950 response at once.
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02009951
9952 The table will contain the real server that processed the request.
9953
9954 Example :
9955 # Learn SSL session ID from both request and response and create affinity.
9956 backend https
9957 mode tcp
9958 balance roundrobin
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02009959 # maximum SSL session ID length is 32 bytes.
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02009960 stick-table type binary len 32 size 30k expire 30m
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02009961
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02009962 acl clienthello req_ssl_hello_type 1
9963 acl serverhello rep_ssl_hello_type 2
9964
9965 # use tcp content accepts to detects ssl client and server hello.
9966 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
9967 tcp-request content accept if clienthello
9968
9969 # no timeout on response inspect delay by default.
9970 tcp-response content accept if serverhello
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02009971
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02009972 # SSL session ID (SSLID) may be present on a client or server hello.
9973 # Its length is coded on 1 byte at offset 43 and its value starts
9974 # at offset 44.
9975
9976 # Match and learn on request if client hello.
9977 stick on payload_lv(43,1) if clienthello
9978
9979 # Learn on response if server hello.
9980 stick store-response payload_lv(43,1) if serverhello
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02009981
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02009982 server s1 192.168.1.1:443
9983 server s2 192.168.1.1:443
9984
9985 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", and section 7 about ACLs and pattern
9986 extraction.
9987
9988
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +02009989tcp-check connect [params*]
9990 Opens a new connection
9991 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet404f9192020-04-09 23:13:54 +02009992 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +02009993
9994 When an application lies on more than a single TCP port or when HAProxy
9995 load-balance many services in a single backend, it makes sense to probe all
9996 the services individually before considering a server as operational.
9997
9998 When there are no TCP port configured on the server line neither server port
9999 directive, then the 'tcp-check connect port <port>' must be the first step
10000 of the sequence.
10001
10002 In a tcp-check ruleset a 'connect' is required, it is also mandatory to start
10003 the ruleset with a 'connect' rule. Purpose is to ensure admin know what they
10004 do.
10005
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010010006 When a connect must start the ruleset, if may still be preceded by set-var,
10007 unset-var or comment rules.
10008
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020010009 Parameters :
10010 They are optional and can be used to describe how HAProxy should open and
10011 use the TCP connection.
10012
Christopher Faulet4dce5922020-03-30 13:54:42 +020010013 default Use default options of the server line to do the health
Christopher Fauletbb591a12020-04-01 16:52:17 +020010014 checks. The server options are used only if not redifined.
Christopher Faulet4dce5922020-03-30 13:54:42 +020010015
Christopher Fauletb7d30092020-03-30 15:19:03 +020010016 port <expr> if not set, check port or server port is used.
Christopher Faulet5c288742020-03-31 08:15:58 +020010017 It tells HAProxy where to open the connection to.
10018 <port> must be a valid TCP port source integer, from 1 to
Christopher Fauletb7d30092020-03-30 15:19:03 +020010019 65535 or an sample-fetch expression.
Christopher Faulet5c288742020-03-31 08:15:58 +020010020
10021 addr <ip> defines the IP address to do the health check.
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020010022
10023 send-proxy send a PROXY protocol string
10024
Christopher Faulet085426a2020-03-30 13:07:02 +020010025 via-socks4 enables outgoing health checks using upstream socks4 proxy.
10026
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020010027 ssl opens a ciphered connection
10028
Christopher Faulet79b31d42020-03-30 13:00:05 +020010029 sni <sni> specifies the SNI to use to do health checks over SSL.
10030
Christopher Faulet98572322020-03-30 13:16:44 +020010031 alpn <alpn> defines which protocols to advertise with ALPN. The protocol
10032 list consists in a comma-delimited list of protocol names,
10033 for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without quotes).
10034 If it is not set, the server ALPN is used.
10035
Christopher Faulet5c288742020-03-31 08:15:58 +020010036 linger cleanly close the connection instead of using a single RST.
Gaetan Rivetf8ba6772020-02-07 15:37:17 +010010037
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020010038 Examples:
10039 # check HTTP and HTTPs services on a server.
10040 # first open port 80 thanks to server line port directive, then
10041 # tcp-check opens port 443, ciphered and run a request on it:
10042 option tcp-check
10043 tcp-check connect
10044 tcp-check send GET\ /\ HTTP/1.0\r\n
10045 tcp-check send Host:\ haproxy.1wt.eu\r\n
10046 tcp-check send \r\n
10047 tcp-check expect rstring (2..|3..)
10048 tcp-check connect port 443 ssl
10049 tcp-check send GET\ /\ HTTP/1.0\r\n
10050 tcp-check send Host:\ haproxy.1wt.eu\r\n
10051 tcp-check send \r\n
10052 tcp-check expect rstring (2..|3..)
10053 server www 10.0.0.1 check port 80
10054
10055 # check both POP and IMAP from a single server:
10056 option tcp-check
Gaetan Rivetf8ba6772020-02-07 15:37:17 +010010057 tcp-check connect port 110 linger
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020010058 tcp-check expect string +OK\ POP3\ ready
10059 tcp-check connect port 143
10060 tcp-check expect string *\ OK\ IMAP4\ ready
10061 server mail 10.0.0.1 check
10062
10063 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check send", "tcp-check expect"
10064
10065
Christopher Fauletec07e382020-04-07 14:56:26 +020010066tcp-check expect [min-recv <int>]
10067 [ok-status <st>] [error-status <st>] [tout-status <st>]
Christopher Faulet98cc57c2020-04-01 20:52:31 +020010068 [on-success <fmt>] [on-error <fmt>] [status-code <expr>]
Christopher Fauletcf80f2f2020-04-01 11:04:52 +020010069 [!] <match> <pattern>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010070 Specify data to be collected and analyzed during a generic health check
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020010071 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet404f9192020-04-09 23:13:54 +020010072 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020010073
10074 Arguments :
Gaetan Rivet1afd8262020-02-07 15:37:17 +010010075 min-recv is optional and can define the minimum amount of data required to
10076 evaluate the current expect rule. If the number of received bytes
10077 is under this limit, the check will wait for more data. This
10078 option can be used to resolve some ambiguous matching rules or to
10079 avoid executing costly regex matches on content known to be still
10080 incomplete. If an exact string (string or binary) is used, the
10081 minimum between the string length and this parameter is used.
10082 This parameter is ignored if it is set to -1. If the expect rule
10083 does not match, the check will wait for more data. If set to 0,
10084 the evaluation result is always conclusive.
10085
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020010086 <match> is a keyword indicating how to look for a specific pattern in the
Gaetan Rivetefab6c62020-02-07 15:37:17 +010010087 response. The keyword may be one of "string", "rstring", "binary" or
10088 "rbinary".
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020010089 The keyword may be preceded by an exclamation mark ("!") to negate
10090 the match. Spaces are allowed between the exclamation mark and the
10091 keyword. See below for more details on the supported keywords.
10092
Christopher Fauletec07e382020-04-07 14:56:26 +020010093 ok-status <st> is optional and can be used to set the check status if
10094 the expect rule is successfully evaluated and if it is
10095 the last rule in the tcp-check ruleset. "L7OK", "L7OKC",
10096 "L6OK" and "L4OK" are supported and may be used to set,
10097 respectively, HCHK_STATUS_L7OK, HCHK_STATUS_L7OKCD,
10098 HCHK_STATUS_L6OK or HCHK_STATUS_L4OK success status.
10099 By default "L7OK" is used.
10100
Christopher Fauletcf80f2f2020-04-01 11:04:52 +020010101 error-status <st> is optional and can be used to set the check status if
10102 an error occurred during the expect rule evaluation.
10103 "L7RSP", "L7STS", "L6RSP" and "L4CON" are supported and
10104 may be used to set, respectively, HCHK_STATUS_L7RSP,
10105 HCHK_STATUS_L7STS, HCHK_STATUS_L6RSP or HCHK_STATUS_L4CON
10106 error status. By default "L7RSP" is used.
10107
Christopher Fauletec07e382020-04-07 14:56:26 +020010108 tout-status <st> is optional and can be used to set the check status if
Christopher Fauletcf80f2f2020-04-01 11:04:52 +020010109 a timeout occurred during the expect rule evaluation.
10110 "L7TOUT", "L6TOUT", and "L4TOUT" are supported and may
10111 be used to set, respectively, HCHK_STATUS_L7TOUT,
10112 HCHK_STATUS_L6TOUT or HCHK_STATUS_L4TOUT timeout status.
10113 By default "L7TOUT" is used.
10114
Christopher Fauletbe52b4d2020-04-01 16:30:22 +020010115 on-success <fmt> is optional and can be used to customize the
10116 informational message reported in logs if the expect
10117 rule is successfully evaluated and if it is the last rule
10118 in the tcp-check ruleset. <fmt> is a log-format string.
10119
10120 on-error <fmt> is optional and can be used to customize the
10121 informational message reported in logs if an error
10122 occurred during the expect rule evaluation. <fmt> is a
10123 log-format string.
10124
Christopher Faulet98cc57c2020-04-01 20:52:31 +020010125 status-code <expr> is optional and can be used to set the check status code
10126 reported in logs, on success or on error. <expr> is a
10127 standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
10128 followed by some converters.
10129
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020010130 <pattern> is the pattern to look for. It may be a string or a regular
10131 expression. If the pattern contains spaces, they must be escaped
10132 with the usual backslash ('\').
10133 If the match is set to binary, then the pattern must be passed as
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010134 a series of hexadecimal digits in an even number. Each sequence of
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020010135 two digits will represent a byte. The hexadecimal digits may be
10136 used upper or lower case.
10137
10138
10139 The available matches are intentionally similar to their http-check cousins :
10140
10141 string <string> : test the exact string matches in the response buffer.
10142 A health check response will be considered valid if the
10143 response's buffer contains this exact string. If the
10144 "string" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
10145 will be considered invalid if the body contains this
10146 string. This can be used to look for a mandatory pattern
10147 in a protocol response, or to detect a failure when a
10148 specific error appears in a protocol banner.
10149
10150 rstring <regex> : test a regular expression on the response buffer.
10151 A health check response will be considered valid if the
10152 response's buffer matches this expression. If the
10153 "rstring" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
10154 will be considered invalid if the body matches the
10155 expression.
10156
10157 binary <hexstring> : test the exact string in its hexadecimal form matches
10158 in the response buffer. A health check response will
10159 be considered valid if the response's buffer contains
10160 this exact hexadecimal string.
10161 Purpose is to match data on binary protocols.
10162
Gaetan Rivetefab6c62020-02-07 15:37:17 +010010163 rbinary <regex> : test a regular expression on the response buffer, like
10164 "rstring". However, the response buffer is transformed
10165 into its hexadecimal form, including NUL-bytes. This
10166 allows using all regex engines to match any binary
10167 content. The hexadecimal transformation takes twice the
10168 size of the original response. As such, the expected
10169 pattern should work on at-most half the response buffer
10170 size.
10171
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020010172 It is important to note that the responses will be limited to a certain size
10173 defined by the global "tune.chksize" option, which defaults to 16384 bytes.
10174 Thus, too large responses may not contain the mandatory pattern when using
10175 "string", "rstring" or binary. If a large response is absolutely required, it
10176 is possible to change the default max size by setting the global variable.
10177 However, it is worth keeping in mind that parsing very large responses can
10178 waste some CPU cycles, especially when regular expressions are used, and that
10179 it is always better to focus the checks on smaller resources. Also, in its
10180 current state, the check will not find any string nor regex past a null
10181 character in the response. Similarly it is not possible to request matching
10182 the null character.
10183
10184 Examples :
10185 # perform a POP check
10186 option tcp-check
10187 tcp-check expect string +OK\ POP3\ ready
10188
10189 # perform an IMAP check
10190 option tcp-check
10191 tcp-check expect string *\ OK\ IMAP4\ ready
10192
10193 # look for the redis master server
10194 option tcp-check
10195 tcp-check send PING\r\n
Baptiste Assmanna3322992015-08-04 10:12:18 +020010196 tcp-check expect string +PONG
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020010197 tcp-check send info\ replication\r\n
10198 tcp-check expect string role:master
10199 tcp-check send QUIT\r\n
10200 tcp-check expect string +OK
10201
10202
10203 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check send",
10204 "tcp-check send-binary", "http-check expect", tune.chksize
10205
10206
10207tcp-check send <data>
10208 Specify a string to be sent as a question during a generic health check
10209 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet404f9192020-04-09 23:13:54 +020010210 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020010211
10212 <data> : the data to be sent as a question during a generic health check
10213 session. For now, <data> must be a string.
10214
10215 Examples :
10216 # look for the redis master server
10217 option tcp-check
10218 tcp-check send info\ replication\r\n
10219 tcp-check expect string role:master
10220
10221 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check expect",
10222 "tcp-check send-binary", tune.chksize
10223
10224
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010225tcp-check send-binary <hexstring>
10226 Specify a hex digits string to be sent as a binary question during a raw
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020010227 tcp health check
10228 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet404f9192020-04-09 23:13:54 +020010229 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020010230
10231 <data> : the data to be sent as a question during a generic health check
10232 session. For now, <data> must be a string.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010233 <hexstring> : test the exact string in its hexadecimal form matches in the
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020010234 response buffer. A health check response will be considered
10235 valid if the response's buffer contains this exact
10236 hexadecimal string.
10237 Purpose is to send binary data to ask on binary protocols.
10238
10239 Examples :
10240 # redis check in binary
10241 option tcp-check
10242 tcp-check send-binary 50494e470d0a # PING\r\n
10243 tcp-check expect binary 2b504F4e47 # +PONG
10244
10245
10246 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check expect",
10247 "tcp-check send", tune.chksize
10248
10249
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010010250tcp-check set-var(<var-name>) <expr>
10251
10252 This operation sets the content of a variable. The variable is declared inline.
10253
10254 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet404f9192020-04-09 23:13:54 +020010255 yes | no | yes | yes
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010010256
10257 Arguments:
10258 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
10259 scope. The scopes allowed for tcp-check are:
10260 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process.
10261 "sess" : the variable is shared with the tcp-check session.
10262 "check": the variable is declared for the lifetime of the tcp-check.
10263 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
10264 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.',
10265 and '-'.
10266
10267 <expr> Is a sample-fetch expression potentially followed by converters.
10268
10269 Example:
10270 tcp-check set-var(check.port) int(1234)
10271
10272
10273tcp-check unset-var(<var-name>)
10274
10275 Free a reference to a variable within its scope.
10276
10277 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet404f9192020-04-09 23:13:54 +020010278 yes | no | yes | yes
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010010279
10280 Arguments:
10281 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
10282 scope. The scopes allowed for tcp-check are:
10283 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process.
10284 "sess" : the variable is shared with the tcp-check session.
10285 "check": the variable is declared for the lifetime of the tcp-check.
10286 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
10287 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.',
10288 and '-'.
10289
10290 Example:
10291 tcp-check unset-var(check.port)
10292
10293
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010294tcp-request connection <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
10295 Perform an action on an incoming connection depending on a layer 4 condition
Willy Tarreau1a687942010-05-23 22:40:30 +020010296 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10297 no | yes | yes | no
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010298 Arguments :
Willy Tarreauc870bfd2015-09-28 18:47:38 +020010299 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. See
10300 below.
Willy Tarreau1a687942010-05-23 22:40:30 +020010301
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010302 <condition> is a standard layer4-only ACL-based condition (see section 7).
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020010303
10304 Immediately after acceptance of a new incoming connection, it is possible to
10305 evaluate some conditions to decide whether this connection must be accepted
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010306 or dropped or have its counters tracked. Those conditions cannot make use of
10307 any data contents because the connection has not been read from yet, and the
10308 buffers are not yet allocated. This is used to selectively and very quickly
10309 accept or drop connections from various sources with a very low overhead. If
10310 some contents need to be inspected in order to take the decision, the
10311 "tcp-request content" statements must be used instead.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020010312
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010313 The "tcp-request connection" rules are evaluated in their exact declaration
10314 order. If no rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to
10315 accept the incoming connection. There is no specific limit to the number of
10316 rules which may be inserted.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020010317
Willy Tarreaua9083d02015-05-08 15:27:59 +020010318 Four types of actions are supported :
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010319 - accept :
10320 accepts the connection if the condition is true (when used with "if")
10321 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
10322 the rules evaluation.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020010323
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010324 - reject :
10325 rejects the connection if the condition is true (when used with "if")
10326 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
10327 the rules evaluation. Rejected connections do not even become a
10328 session, which is why they are accounted separately for in the stats,
10329 as "denied connections". They are not considered for the session
10330 rate-limit and are not logged either. The reason is that these rules
10331 should only be used to filter extremely high connection rates such as
10332 the ones encountered during a massive DDoS attack. Under these extreme
10333 conditions, the simple action of logging each event would make the
10334 system collapse and would considerably lower the filtering capacity. If
10335 logging is absolutely desired, then "tcp-request content" rules should
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020010336 be used instead, as "tcp-request session" rules will not log either.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020010337
Willy Tarreau4f0d9192013-06-11 20:40:55 +020010338 - expect-proxy layer4 :
10339 configures the client-facing connection to receive a PROXY protocol
10340 header before any byte is read from the socket. This is equivalent to
10341 having the "accept-proxy" keyword on the "bind" line, except that using
10342 the TCP rule allows the PROXY protocol to be accepted only for certain
10343 IP address ranges using an ACL. This is convenient when multiple layers
10344 of load balancers are passed through by traffic coming from public
10345 hosts.
10346
Bertrand Jacquin90759682016-06-06 15:35:39 +010010347 - expect-netscaler-cip layer4 :
10348 configures the client-facing connection to receive a NetScaler Client
10349 IP insertion protocol header before any byte is read from the socket.
10350 This is equivalent to having the "accept-netscaler-cip" keyword on the
10351 "bind" line, except that using the TCP rule allows the PROXY protocol
10352 to be accepted only for certain IP address ranges using an ACL. This
10353 is convenient when multiple layers of load balancers are passed
10354 through by traffic coming from public hosts.
10355
Willy Tarreau18bf01e2014-06-13 16:18:52 +020010356 - capture <sample> len <length> :
10357 This only applies to "tcp-request content" rules. It captures sample
10358 expression <sample> from the request buffer, and converts it to a
10359 string of at most <len> characters. The resulting string is stored into
10360 the next request "capture" slot, so it will possibly appear next to
10361 some captured HTTP headers. It will then automatically appear in the
10362 logs, and it will be possible to extract it using sample fetch rules to
10363 feed it into headers or anything. The length should be limited given
10364 that this size will be allocated for each capture during the whole
Willy Tarreaua9083d02015-05-08 15:27:59 +020010365 session life. Please check section 7.3 (Fetching samples) and "capture
10366 request header" for more information.
Willy Tarreau18bf01e2014-06-13 16:18:52 +020010367
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020010368 - { track-sc0 | track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>] :
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010369 enables tracking of sticky counters from current connection. These
Moemen MHEDHBI9cf46342018-09-25 17:50:53 +020010370 rules do not stop evaluation and do not change default action. The
10371 number of counters that may be simultaneously tracked by the same
10372 connection is set in MAX_SESS_STKCTR at build time (reported in
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050010373 haproxy -vv) which defaults to 3, so the track-sc number is between 0
Moemen MHEDHBI9cf46342018-09-25 17:50:53 +020010374 and (MAX_SESS_STCKTR-1). The first "track-sc0" rule executed enables
10375 tracking of the counters of the specified table as the first set. The
10376 first "track-sc1" rule executed enables tracking of the counters of the
10377 specified table as the second set. The first "track-sc2" rule executed
10378 enables tracking of the counters of the specified table as the third
10379 set. It is a recommended practice to use the first set of counters for
10380 the per-frontend counters and the second set for the per-backend ones.
10381 But this is just a guideline, all may be used everywhere.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020010382
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010383 These actions take one or two arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +020010384 <key> is mandatory, and is a sample expression rule as described
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010385 in section 7.3. It describes what elements of the incoming
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010386 request or connection will be analyzed, extracted, combined,
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010010387 and used to select which table entry to update the counters.
10388 Note that "tcp-request connection" cannot use content-based
10389 fetches.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020010390
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010391 <table> is an optional table to be used instead of the default one,
10392 which is the stick-table declared in the current proxy. All
10393 the counters for the matches and updates for the key will
10394 then be performed in that table until the session ends.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020010395
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010396 Once a "track-sc*" rule is executed, the key is looked up in the table
10397 and if it is not found, an entry is allocated for it. Then a pointer to
10398 that entry is kept during all the session's life, and this entry's
10399 counters are updated as often as possible, every time the session's
10400 counters are updated, and also systematically when the session ends.
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010010401 Counters are only updated for events that happen after the tracking has
10402 been started. For example, connection counters will not be updated when
10403 tracking layer 7 information, since the connection event happens before
10404 layer7 information is extracted.
10405
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010406 If the entry tracks concurrent connection counters, one connection is
10407 counted for as long as the entry is tracked, and the entry will not
10408 expire during that time. Tracking counters also provides a performance
10409 advantage over just checking the keys, because only one table lookup is
10410 performed for all ACL checks that make use of it.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020010411
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +020010412 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>):
10413 The "sc-inc-gpc0" increments the GPC0 counter according to the sticky
10414 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action silently
10415 fails and the actions evaluation continues.
10416
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010010417 - sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>):
10418 The "sc-inc-gpc1" increments the GPC1 counter according to the sticky
10419 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action silently
10420 fails and the actions evaluation continues.
10421
Cédric Dufour0d7712d2019-11-06 18:38:53 +010010422 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }:
10423 This action sets the 32-bit unsigned GPT0 tag according to the sticky
10424 counter designated by <sc-id> and the value of <int>/<expr>. The
10425 expected result is a boolean. If an error occurs, this action silently
10426 fails and the actions evaluation continues.
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020010427
William Lallemand2e785f22016-05-25 01:48:42 +020010428 - set-src <expr> :
10429 Is used to set the source IP address to the value of specified
10430 expression. Useful if you want to mask source IP for privacy.
10431 If you want to provide an IP from a HTTP header use "http-request
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +020010432 set-src".
William Lallemand2e785f22016-05-25 01:48:42 +020010433
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +020010434 Arguments:
10435 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
10436 followed by some converters.
William Lallemand2e785f22016-05-25 01:48:42 +020010437
10438 Example:
William Lallemand2e785f22016-05-25 01:48:42 +020010439 tcp-request connection set-src src,ipmask(24)
10440
Willy Tarreau0c630532016-10-21 17:52:58 +020010441 When possible, set-src preserves the original source port as long as the
10442 address family allows it, otherwise the source port is set to 0.
William Lallemand2e785f22016-05-25 01:48:42 +020010443
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +020010444 - set-src-port <expr> :
10445 Is used to set the source port address to the value of specified
10446 expression.
10447
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +020010448 Arguments:
10449 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
10450 followed by some converters.
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +020010451
10452 Example:
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +020010453 tcp-request connection set-src-port int(4000)
10454
Willy Tarreau0c630532016-10-21 17:52:58 +020010455 When possible, set-src-port preserves the original source address as long
10456 as the address family supports a port, otherwise it forces the source
10457 address to IPv4 "0.0.0.0" before rewriting the port.
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +020010458
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +020010459 - set-dst <expr> :
10460 Is used to set the destination IP address to the value of specified
10461 expression. Useful if you want to mask IP for privacy in log.
10462 If you want to provide an IP from a HTTP header use "http-request
10463 set-dst". If you want to connect to the new address/port, use
10464 '0.0.0.0:0' as a server address in the backend.
10465
10466 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
10467 followed by some converters.
10468
10469 Example:
10470
10471 tcp-request connection set-dst dst,ipmask(24)
10472 tcp-request connection set-dst ipv4(10.0.0.1)
10473
Willy Tarreau0c630532016-10-21 17:52:58 +020010474 When possible, set-dst preserves the original destination port as long as
10475 the address family allows it, otherwise the destination port is set to 0.
10476
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +020010477 - set-dst-port <expr> :
10478 Is used to set the destination port address to the value of specified
10479 expression. If you want to connect to the new address/port, use
10480 '0.0.0.0:0' as a server address in the backend.
10481
10482
10483 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
10484 followed by some converters.
10485
10486 Example:
10487
10488 tcp-request connection set-dst-port int(4000)
10489
Willy Tarreau0c630532016-10-21 17:52:58 +020010490 When possible, set-dst-port preserves the original destination address as
10491 long as the address family supports a port, otherwise it forces the
10492 destination address to IPv4 "0.0.0.0" before rewriting the port.
10493
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020010494 - "silent-drop" :
10495 This stops the evaluation of the rules and makes the client-facing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010496 connection suddenly disappear using a system-dependent way that tries
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020010497 to prevent the client from being notified. The effect it then that the
10498 client still sees an established connection while there's none on
10499 HAProxy. The purpose is to achieve a comparable effect to "tarpit"
10500 except that it doesn't use any local resource at all on the machine
10501 running HAProxy. It can resist much higher loads than "tarpit", and
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010502 slow down stronger attackers. It is important to understand the impact
10503 of using this mechanism. All stateful equipment placed between the
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020010504 client and HAProxy (firewalls, proxies, load balancers) will also keep
10505 the established connection for a long time and may suffer from this
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010506 action. On modern Linux systems running with enough privileges, the
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020010507 TCP_REPAIR socket option is used to block the emission of a TCP
10508 reset. On other systems, the socket's TTL is reduced to 1 so that the
10509 TCP reset doesn't pass the first router, though it's still delivered to
10510 local networks. Do not use it unless you fully understand how it works.
10511
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010512 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
10513 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
10514 "track-sc*" actions as well as for changing the default action to a reject.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020010515
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010516 Example: accept all connections from white-listed hosts, reject too fast
10517 connection without counting them, and track accepted connections.
10518 This results in connection rate being capped from abusive sources.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020010519
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010520 tcp-request connection accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020010521 tcp-request connection reject if { src_conn_rate gt 10 }
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020010522 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020010523
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010524 Example: accept all connections from white-listed hosts, count all other
10525 connections and reject too fast ones. This results in abusive ones
10526 being blocked as long as they don't slow down.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020010527
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010528 tcp-request connection accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020010529 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src
10530 tcp-request connection reject if { sc0_conn_rate gt 10 }
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020010531
Willy Tarreau4f0d9192013-06-11 20:40:55 +020010532 Example: enable the PROXY protocol for traffic coming from all known proxies.
10533
10534 tcp-request connection expect-proxy layer4 if { src -f proxies.lst }
10535
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020010536 See section 7 about ACL usage.
10537
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020010538 See also : "tcp-request session", "tcp-request content", "stick-table"
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020010539
10540
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010541tcp-request content <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
10542 Perform an action on a new session depending on a layer 4-7 condition
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010543 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaufb356202010-08-03 14:02:05 +020010544 no | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010545 Arguments :
Willy Tarreauc870bfd2015-09-28 18:47:38 +020010546 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. See
10547 below.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010548
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010549 <condition> is a standard layer 4-7 ACL-based condition (see section 7).
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010550
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010551 A request's contents can be analyzed at an early stage of request processing
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010552 called "TCP content inspection". During this stage, ACL-based rules are
10553 evaluated every time the request contents are updated, until either an
10554 "accept" or a "reject" rule matches, or the TCP request inspection delay
10555 expires with no matching rule.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010556
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010557 The first difference between these rules and "tcp-request connection" rules
10558 is that "tcp-request content" rules can make use of contents to take a
10559 decision. Most often, these decisions will consider a protocol recognition or
10560 validity. The second difference is that content-based rules can be used in
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +010010561 both frontends and backends. In case of HTTP keep-alive with the client, all
10562 tcp-request content rules are evaluated again, so haproxy keeps a record of
10563 what sticky counters were assigned by a "tcp-request connection" versus a
10564 "tcp-request content" rule, and flushes all the content-related ones after
10565 processing an HTTP request, so that they may be evaluated again by the rules
10566 being evaluated again for the next request. This is of particular importance
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010567 when the rule tracks some L7 information or when it is conditioned by an
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +010010568 L7-based ACL, since tracking may change between requests.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010569
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010570 Content-based rules are evaluated in their exact declaration order. If no
10571 rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to accept the
10572 contents. There is no specific limit to the number of rules which may be
10573 inserted.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010574
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020010575 Several types of actions are supported :
Willy Tarreau18bf01e2014-06-13 16:18:52 +020010576 - accept : the request is accepted
Baptiste Assmann333939c2019-01-21 08:34:50 +010010577 - do-resolve: perform a DNS resolution
Willy Tarreau18bf01e2014-06-13 16:18:52 +020010578 - reject : the request is rejected and the connection is closed
10579 - capture : the specified sample expression is captured
Patrick Hemmer268a7072018-05-11 12:52:31 -040010580 - set-priority-class <expr> | set-priority-offset <expr>
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020010581 - { track-sc0 | track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>]
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +020010582 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>)
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010010583 - sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>)
Cédric Dufour0d7712d2019-11-06 18:38:53 +010010584 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
Baptiste Assmanne1afd4f2019-04-18 16:21:13 +020010585 - set-dst <expr>
10586 - set-dst-port <expr>
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020010587 - set-var(<var-name>) <expr>
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010010588 - unset-var(<var-name>)
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020010589 - silent-drop
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010590 - send-spoe-group <engine-name> <group-name>
Christopher Faulet579d83b2019-11-22 15:34:17 +010010591 - use-service <service-name>
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010592
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010593 They have the same meaning as their counter-parts in "tcp-request connection"
10594 so please refer to that section for a complete description.
Baptiste Assmann333939c2019-01-21 08:34:50 +010010595 For "do-resolve" action, please check the "http-request do-resolve"
10596 configuration section.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010597
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +010010598 While there is nothing mandatory about it, it is recommended to use the
10599 track-sc0 in "tcp-request connection" rules, track-sc1 for "tcp-request
10600 content" rules in the frontend, and track-sc2 for "tcp-request content"
10601 rules in the backend, because that makes the configuration more readable
10602 and easier to troubleshoot, but this is just a guideline and all counters
10603 may be used everywhere.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010604
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010010605 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010606 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
10607 "track-sc*" actions as well as for changing the default action to a reject.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010608
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010609 It is perfectly possible to match layer 7 contents with "tcp-request content"
Willy Tarreauc0239e02012-04-16 14:42:55 +020010610 rules, since HTTP-specific ACL matches are able to preliminarily parse the
10611 contents of a buffer before extracting the required data. If the buffered
10612 contents do not parse as a valid HTTP message, then the ACL does not match.
10613 The parser which is involved there is exactly the same as for all other HTTP
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +010010614 processing, so there is no risk of parsing something differently. In an HTTP
10615 backend connected to from an HTTP frontend, it is guaranteed that HTTP
10616 contents will always be immediately present when the rule is evaluated first.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010617
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010010618 Tracking layer7 information is also possible provided that the information
Willy Tarreau4d54c7c2014-09-16 15:48:15 +020010619 are present when the rule is processed. The rule processing engine is able to
10620 wait until the inspect delay expires when the data to be tracked is not yet
10621 available.
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010010622
Baptiste Assmanne1afd4f2019-04-18 16:21:13 +020010623 The "set-dst" and "set-dst-port" are used to set respectively the destination
10624 IP and port. More information on how to use it at "http-request set-dst".
10625
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020010626 The "set-var" is used to set the content of a variable. The variable is
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020010627 declared inline. For "tcp-request session" rules, only session-level
10628 variables can be used, without any layer7 contents.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020010629
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010010630 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about
10631 its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010010632 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010010633 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
10634 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020010635 (request and response)
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010010636 "req" : the variable is shared only during request
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020010637 processing
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010010638 "res" : the variable is shared only during response
10639 processing
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020010640 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010010641 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9',
10642 '.' and '_'.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020010643
10644 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
10645 followed by some converters.
10646
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010010647 The "unset-var" is used to unset a variable. See above for details about
10648 <var-name>.
10649
Patrick Hemmer268a7072018-05-11 12:52:31 -040010650 The "set-priority-class" is used to set the queue priority class of the
10651 current request. The value must be a sample expression which converts to an
10652 integer in the range -2047..2047. Results outside this range will be
10653 truncated. The priority class determines the order in which queued requests
10654 are processed. Lower values have higher priority.
10655
10656 The "set-priority-offset" is used to set the queue priority timestamp offset
10657 of the current request. The value must be a sample expression which converts
10658 to an integer in the range -524287..524287. Results outside this range will be
10659 truncated. When a request is queued, it is ordered first by the priority
10660 class, then by the current timestamp adjusted by the given offset in
10661 milliseconds. Lower values have higher priority.
10662 Note that the resulting timestamp is is only tracked with enough precision for
10663 524,287ms (8m44s287ms). If the request is queued long enough to where the
10664 adjusted timestamp exceeds this value, it will be misidentified as highest
10665 priority. Thus it is important to set "timeout queue" to a value, where when
10666 combined with the offset, does not exceed this limit.
10667
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +020010668 The "send-spoe-group" is used to trigger sending of a group of SPOE
10669 messages. To do so, the SPOE engine used to send messages must be defined, as
10670 well as the SPOE group to send. Of course, the SPOE engine must refer to an
10671 existing SPOE filter. If not engine name is provided on the SPOE filter line,
10672 the SPOE agent name must be used.
10673
10674 <engine-name> The SPOE engine name.
10675
10676 <group-name> The SPOE group name as specified in the engine configuration.
10677
Christopher Faulet579d83b2019-11-22 15:34:17 +010010678 The "use-service" is used to executes a TCP service which will reply to the
10679 request and stop the evaluation of the rules. This service may choose to
10680 reply by sending any valid response or it may immediately close the
10681 connection without sending anything. Outside natives services, it is possible
10682 to write your own services in Lua. No further "tcp-request" rules are
10683 evaluated.
10684
10685 Example:
10686 tcp-request content use-service lua.deny { src -f /etc/haproxy/blacklist.lst }
10687
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020010688 Example:
10689
10690 tcp-request content set-var(sess.my_var) src
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010010691 tcp-request content unset-var(sess.my_var2)
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020010692
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010693 Example:
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010694 # Accept HTTP requests containing a Host header saying "example.com"
10695 # and reject everything else.
10696 acl is_host_com hdr(Host) -i example.com
10697 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
Willy Tarreauc0239e02012-04-16 14:42:55 +020010698 tcp-request content accept if is_host_com
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010699 tcp-request content reject
10700
10701 Example:
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010702 # reject SMTP connection if client speaks first
10703 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
10704 acl content_present req_len gt 0
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020010705 tcp-request content reject if content_present
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010706
10707 # Forward HTTPS connection only if client speaks
10708 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
10709 acl content_present req_len gt 0
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020010710 tcp-request content accept if content_present
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010711 tcp-request content reject
10712
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010010713 Example:
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +030010714 # Track the last IP(stick-table type string) from X-Forwarded-For
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010010715 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
Willy Tarreau4d54c7c2014-09-16 15:48:15 +020010716 tcp-request content track-sc0 hdr(x-forwarded-for,-1)
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +030010717 # Or track the last IP(stick-table type ip|ipv6) from X-Forwarded-For
10718 tcp-request content track-sc0 req.hdr_ip(x-forwarded-for,-1)
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010010719
10720 Example:
10721 # track request counts per "base" (concatenation of Host+URL)
10722 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
Willy Tarreau4d54c7c2014-09-16 15:48:15 +020010723 tcp-request content track-sc0 base table req-rate
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010010724
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010725 Example: track per-frontend and per-backend counters, block abusers at the
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +030010726 frontend when the backend detects abuse(and marks gpc0).
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010727
10728 frontend http
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010729 # Use General Purpose Counter 0 in SC0 as a global abuse counter
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010730 # protecting all our sites
10731 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store gpc0
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020010732 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src
10733 tcp-request connection reject if { sc0_get_gpc0 gt 0 }
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010734 ...
10735 use_backend http_dynamic if { path_end .php }
10736
10737 backend http_dynamic
10738 # if a source makes too fast requests to this dynamic site (tracked
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020010739 # by SC1), block it globally in the frontend.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010740 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store http_req_rate(10s)
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020010741 acl click_too_fast sc1_http_req_rate gt 10
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +030010742 acl mark_as_abuser sc0_inc_gpc0(http) gt 0
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020010743 tcp-request content track-sc1 src
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010744 tcp-request content reject if click_too_fast mark_as_abuser
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010745
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010746 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010747
Jarno Huuskonen95b012b2017-04-06 13:59:14 +030010748 See also : "tcp-request connection", "tcp-request session",
10749 "tcp-request inspect-delay", and "http-request".
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010750
10751
10752tcp-request inspect-delay <timeout>
10753 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for data during content inspection
10754 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaufb356202010-08-03 14:02:05 +020010755 no | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010756 Arguments :
10757 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
10758 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
10759 as explained at the top of this document.
10760
10761 People using haproxy primarily as a TCP relay are often worried about the
10762 risk of passing any type of protocol to a server without any analysis. In
10763 order to be able to analyze the request contents, we must first withhold
10764 the data then analyze them. This statement simply enables withholding of
10765 data for at most the specified amount of time.
10766
Willy Tarreaufb356202010-08-03 14:02:05 +020010767 TCP content inspection applies very early when a connection reaches a
10768 frontend, then very early when the connection is forwarded to a backend. This
10769 means that a connection may experience a first delay in the frontend and a
10770 second delay in the backend if both have tcp-request rules.
10771
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010772 Note that when performing content inspection, haproxy will evaluate the whole
10773 rules for every new chunk which gets in, taking into account the fact that
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010010774 those data are partial. If no rule matches before the aforementioned delay,
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010775 a last check is performed upon expiration, this time considering that the
Willy Tarreaud869b242009-03-15 14:43:58 +010010776 contents are definitive. If no delay is set, haproxy will not wait at all
10777 and will immediately apply a verdict based on the available information.
10778 Obviously this is unlikely to be very useful and might even be racy, so such
10779 setups are not recommended.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010780
10781 As soon as a rule matches, the request is released and continues as usual. If
10782 the timeout is reached and no rule matches, the default policy will be to let
10783 it pass through unaffected.
10784
10785 For most protocols, it is enough to set it to a few seconds, as most clients
10786 send the full request immediately upon connection. Add 3 or more seconds to
10787 cover TCP retransmits but that's all. For some protocols, it may make sense
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010010788 to use large values, for instance to ensure that the client never talks
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010789 before the server (e.g. SMTP), or to wait for a client to talk before passing
10790 data to the server (e.g. SSL). Note that the client timeout must cover at
Willy Tarreaub824b002010-09-29 16:36:16 +020010791 least the inspection delay, otherwise it will expire first. If the client
10792 closes the connection or if the buffer is full, the delay immediately expires
10793 since the contents will not be able to change anymore.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010794
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020010795 See also : "tcp-request content accept", "tcp-request content reject",
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010796 "timeout client".
10797
10798
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020010799tcp-response content <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
10800 Perform an action on a session response depending on a layer 4-7 condition
10801 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10802 no | no | yes | yes
10803 Arguments :
Willy Tarreauc870bfd2015-09-28 18:47:38 +020010804 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. See
10805 below.
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020010806
10807 <condition> is a standard layer 4-7 ACL-based condition (see section 7).
10808
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010809 Response contents can be analyzed at an early stage of response processing
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020010810 called "TCP content inspection". During this stage, ACL-based rules are
10811 evaluated every time the response contents are updated, until either an
Willy Tarreaucc1e04b2013-09-11 23:20:29 +020010812 "accept", "close" or a "reject" rule matches, or a TCP response inspection
10813 delay is set and expires with no matching rule.
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020010814
10815 Most often, these decisions will consider a protocol recognition or validity.
10816
10817 Content-based rules are evaluated in their exact declaration order. If no
10818 rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to accept the
10819 contents. There is no specific limit to the number of rules which may be
10820 inserted.
10821
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020010822 Several types of actions are supported :
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020010823 - accept :
10824 accepts the response if the condition is true (when used with "if")
10825 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
10826 the rules evaluation.
10827
Willy Tarreaucc1e04b2013-09-11 23:20:29 +020010828 - close :
10829 immediately closes the connection with the server if the condition is
10830 true (when used with "if"), or false (when used with "unless"). The
10831 first such rule executed ends the rules evaluation. The main purpose of
10832 this action is to force a connection to be finished between a client
10833 and a server after an exchange when the application protocol expects
10834 some long time outs to elapse first. The goal is to eliminate idle
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010835 connections which take significant resources on servers with certain
Willy Tarreaucc1e04b2013-09-11 23:20:29 +020010836 protocols.
10837
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020010838 - reject :
10839 rejects the response if the condition is true (when used with "if")
10840 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040010841 the rules evaluation. Rejected session are immediately closed.
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020010842
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020010843 - set-var(<var-name>) <expr>
10844 Sets a variable.
10845
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010010846 - unset-var(<var-name>)
10847 Unsets a variable.
10848
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +020010849 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>):
10850 This action increments the GPC0 counter according to the sticky
10851 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action fails
10852 silently and the actions evaluation continues.
10853
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010010854 - sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>):
10855 This action increments the GPC1 counter according to the sticky
10856 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action fails
10857 silently and the actions evaluation continues.
10858
Cédric Dufour0d7712d2019-11-06 18:38:53 +010010859 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
10860 This action sets the 32-bit unsigned GPT0 tag according to the sticky
10861 counter designated by <sc-id> and the value of <int>/<expr>. The
10862 expected result is a boolean. If an error occurs, this action silently
10863 fails and the actions evaluation continues.
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020010864
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020010865 - "silent-drop" :
10866 This stops the evaluation of the rules and makes the client-facing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010867 connection suddenly disappear using a system-dependent way that tries
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020010868 to prevent the client from being notified. The effect it then that the
10869 client still sees an established connection while there's none on
10870 HAProxy. The purpose is to achieve a comparable effect to "tarpit"
10871 except that it doesn't use any local resource at all on the machine
10872 running HAProxy. It can resist much higher loads than "tarpit", and
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010873 slow down stronger attackers. It is important to understand the impact
10874 of using this mechanism. All stateful equipment placed between the
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020010875 client and HAProxy (firewalls, proxies, load balancers) will also keep
10876 the established connection for a long time and may suffer from this
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010877 action. On modern Linux systems running with enough privileges, the
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020010878 TCP_REPAIR socket option is used to block the emission of a TCP
10879 reset. On other systems, the socket's TTL is reduced to 1 so that the
10880 TCP reset doesn't pass the first router, though it's still delivered to
10881 local networks. Do not use it unless you fully understand how it works.
10882
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +020010883 - send-spoe-group <engine-name> <group-name>
10884 Send a group of SPOE messages.
10885
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020010886 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
10887 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
10888 for changing the default action to a reject.
10889
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040010890 It is perfectly possible to match layer 7 contents with "tcp-response
10891 content" rules, but then it is important to ensure that a full response has
10892 been buffered, otherwise no contents will match. In order to achieve this,
10893 the best solution involves detecting the HTTP protocol during the inspection
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020010894 period.
10895
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020010896 The "set-var" is used to set the content of a variable. The variable is
10897 declared inline.
10898
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010010899 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about
10900 its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010010901 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010010902 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
10903 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020010904 (request and response)
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010010905 "req" : the variable is shared only during request
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020010906 processing
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010010907 "res" : the variable is shared only during response
10908 processing
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020010909 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010010910 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9',
10911 '.' and '_'.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020010912
10913 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
10914 followed by some converters.
10915
10916 Example:
10917
10918 tcp-request content set-var(sess.my_var) src
10919
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010010920 The "unset-var" is used to unset a variable. See above for details about
10921 <var-name>.
10922
10923 Example:
10924
10925 tcp-request content unset-var(sess.my_var)
10926
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +020010927 The "send-spoe-group" is used to trigger sending of a group of SPOE
10928 messages. To do so, the SPOE engine used to send messages must be defined, as
10929 well as the SPOE group to send. Of course, the SPOE engine must refer to an
10930 existing SPOE filter. If not engine name is provided on the SPOE filter line,
10931 the SPOE agent name must be used.
10932
10933 <engine-name> The SPOE engine name.
10934
10935 <group-name> The SPOE group name as specified in the engine configuration.
10936
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020010937 See section 7 about ACL usage.
10938
10939 See also : "tcp-request content", "tcp-response inspect-delay"
10940
10941
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020010942tcp-request session <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
10943 Perform an action on a validated session depending on a layer 5 condition
10944 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10945 no | yes | yes | no
10946 Arguments :
10947 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. See
10948 below.
10949
10950 <condition> is a standard layer5-only ACL-based condition (see section 7).
10951
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010952 Once a session is validated, (i.e. after all handshakes have been completed),
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020010953 it is possible to evaluate some conditions to decide whether this session
10954 must be accepted or dropped or have its counters tracked. Those conditions
10955 cannot make use of any data contents because no buffers are allocated yet and
10956 the processing cannot wait at this stage. The main use case it to copy some
10957 early information into variables (since variables are accessible in the
10958 session), or to keep track of some information collected after the handshake,
10959 such as SSL-level elements (SNI, ciphers, client cert's CN) or information
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010960 from the PROXY protocol header (e.g. track a source forwarded this way). The
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020010961 extracted information can thus be copied to a variable or tracked using
10962 "track-sc" rules. Of course it is also possible to decide to accept/reject as
10963 with other rulesets. Most operations performed here could also be performed
10964 in "tcp-request content" rules, except that in HTTP these rules are evaluated
10965 for each new request, and that might not always be acceptable. For example a
10966 rule might increment a counter on each evaluation. It would also be possible
10967 that a country is resolved by geolocation from the source IP address,
10968 assigned to a session-wide variable, then the source address rewritten from
10969 an HTTP header for all requests. If some contents need to be inspected in
10970 order to take the decision, the "tcp-request content" statements must be used
10971 instead.
10972
10973 The "tcp-request session" rules are evaluated in their exact declaration
10974 order. If no rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to
10975 accept the incoming session. There is no specific limit to the number of
10976 rules which may be inserted.
10977
10978 Several types of actions are supported :
10979 - accept : the request is accepted
10980 - reject : the request is rejected and the connection is closed
10981 - { track-sc0 | track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>]
10982 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>)
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010010983 - sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>)
Cédric Dufour0d7712d2019-11-06 18:38:53 +010010984 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020010985 - set-var(<var-name>) <expr>
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010010986 - unset-var(<var-name>)
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020010987 - silent-drop
10988
10989 These actions have the same meaning as their respective counter-parts in
10990 "tcp-request connection" and "tcp-request content", so please refer to these
10991 sections for a complete description.
10992
10993 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
10994 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
10995 "track-sc*" actions as well as for changing the default action to a reject.
10996
10997 Example: track the original source address by default, or the one advertised
10998 in the PROXY protocol header for connection coming from the local
10999 proxies. The first connection-level rule enables receipt of the
11000 PROXY protocol for these ones, the second rule tracks whatever
11001 address we decide to keep after optional decoding.
11002
11003 tcp-request connection expect-proxy layer4 if { src -f proxies.lst }
11004 tcp-request session track-sc0 src
11005
11006 Example: accept all sessions from white-listed hosts, reject too fast
11007 sessions without counting them, and track accepted sessions.
11008 This results in session rate being capped from abusive sources.
11009
11010 tcp-request session accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
11011 tcp-request session reject if { src_sess_rate gt 10 }
11012 tcp-request session track-sc0 src
11013
11014 Example: accept all sessions from white-listed hosts, count all other
11015 sessions and reject too fast ones. This results in abusive ones
11016 being blocked as long as they don't slow down.
11017
11018 tcp-request session accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
11019 tcp-request session track-sc0 src
11020 tcp-request session reject if { sc0_sess_rate gt 10 }
11021
11022 See section 7 about ACL usage.
11023
11024 See also : "tcp-request connection", "tcp-request content", "stick-table"
11025
11026
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020011027tcp-response inspect-delay <timeout>
11028 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a response during content inspection
11029 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11030 no | no | yes | yes
11031 Arguments :
11032 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
11033 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
11034 as explained at the top of this document.
11035
11036 See also : "tcp-response content", "tcp-request inspect-delay".
11037
11038
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010011039timeout check <timeout>
11040 Set additional check timeout, but only after a connection has been already
11041 established.
11042
11043 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11044 yes | no | yes | yes
11045 Arguments:
11046 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
11047 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
11048 as explained at the top of this document.
11049
11050 If set, haproxy uses min("timeout connect", "inter") as a connect timeout
11051 for check and "timeout check" as an additional read timeout. The "min" is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011052 used so that people running with *very* long "timeout connect" (e.g. those
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010011053 who needed this due to the queue or tarpit) do not slow down their checks.
Willy Tarreaud7550a22010-02-10 05:10:19 +010011054 (Please also note that there is no valid reason to have such long connect
11055 timeouts, because "timeout queue" and "timeout tarpit" can always be used to
11056 avoid that).
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010011057
11058 If "timeout check" is not set haproxy uses "inter" for complete check
11059 timeout (connect + read) exactly like all <1.3.15 version.
11060
11061 In most cases check request is much simpler and faster to handle than normal
11062 requests and people may want to kick out laggy servers so this timeout should
Willy Tarreau41a340d2008-01-22 12:25:31 +010011063 be smaller than "timeout server".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010011064
11065 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
11066 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
11067 forget about it.
11068
Willy Tarreau41a340d2008-01-22 12:25:31 +010011069 See also: "timeout connect", "timeout queue", "timeout server",
11070 "timeout tarpit".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010011071
11072
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010011073timeout client <timeout>
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010011074 Set the maximum inactivity time on the client side.
11075 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11076 yes | yes | yes | no
11077 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010011078 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010011079 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
11080 as explained at the top of this document.
11081
11082 The inactivity timeout applies when the client is expected to acknowledge or
11083 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
11084 during the first phase, when the client sends the request, and during the
Baptiste Assmann2e1941e2016-03-06 23:24:12 +010011085 response while it is reading data sent by the server. That said, for the
11086 first phase, it is preferable to set the "timeout http-request" to better
11087 protect HAProxy from Slowloris like attacks. The value is specified in
11088 milliseconds by default, but can be in any other unit if the number is
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010011089 suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this document. In TCP mode
11090 (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly recommended that the
11091 client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in order to avoid complex
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +010011092 situations to debug. It is a good practice to cover one or several TCP packet
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010011093 losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3 seconds
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011094 (e.g. 4 or 5 seconds). If some long-lived sessions are mixed with short-lived
11095 sessions (e.g. WebSocket and HTTP), it's worth considering "timeout tunnel",
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020011096 which overrides "timeout client" and "timeout server" for tunnels, as well as
11097 "timeout client-fin" for half-closed connections.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010011098
11099 This parameter is specific to frontends, but can be specified once for all in
11100 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
11101 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
11102 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050011103 during startup because it may result in accumulation of expired sessions in
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010011104 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
11105
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +010011106 This also applies to HTTP/2 connections, which will be closed with GOAWAY.
Lukas Tribus75df9d72017-11-24 19:05:12 +010011107
Tim Duesterhus86e6b6e2019-05-14 20:57:59 +020011108 See also : "timeout server", "timeout tunnel", "timeout http-request".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010011109
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010011110
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020011111timeout client-fin <timeout>
11112 Set the inactivity timeout on the client side for half-closed connections.
11113 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11114 yes | yes | yes | no
11115 Arguments :
11116 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
11117 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
11118 as explained at the top of this document.
11119
11120 The inactivity timeout applies when the client is expected to acknowledge or
11121 send data while one direction is already shut down. This timeout is different
11122 from "timeout client" in that it only applies to connections which are closed
11123 in one direction. This is particularly useful to avoid keeping connections in
11124 FIN_WAIT state for too long when clients do not disconnect cleanly. This
11125 problem is particularly common long connections such as RDP or WebSocket.
11126 Note that this timeout can override "timeout tunnel" when a connection shuts
Willy Tarreau599391a2017-11-24 10:16:00 +010011127 down in one direction. It is applied to idle HTTP/2 connections once a GOAWAY
11128 frame was sent, often indicating an expectation that the connection quickly
11129 ends.
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020011130
11131 This parameter is specific to frontends, but can be specified once for all in
11132 "defaults" sections. By default it is not set, so half-closed connections
11133 will use the other timeouts (timeout.client or timeout.tunnel).
11134
11135 See also : "timeout client", "timeout server-fin", and "timeout tunnel".
11136
11137
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010011138timeout connect <timeout>
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010011139 Set the maximum time to wait for a connection attempt to a server to succeed.
11140 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11141 yes | no | yes | yes
11142 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010011143 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010011144 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
11145 as explained at the top of this document.
11146
11147 If the server is located on the same LAN as haproxy, the connection should be
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +010011148 immediate (less than a few milliseconds). Anyway, it is a good practice to
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010011149 cover one or several TCP packet losses by specifying timeouts that are
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011150 slightly above multiples of 3 seconds (e.g. 4 or 5 seconds). By default, the
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010011151 connect timeout also presets both queue and tarpit timeouts to the same value
11152 if these have not been specified.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010011153
11154 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
11155 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
11156 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
11157 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050011158 during startup because it may result in accumulation of failed sessions in
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010011159 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
11160
Tim Duesterhus86e6b6e2019-05-14 20:57:59 +020011161 See also: "timeout check", "timeout queue", "timeout server", "timeout tarpit".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010011162
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010011163
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +010011164timeout http-keep-alive <timeout>
11165 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a new HTTP request to appear
11166 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11167 yes | yes | yes | yes
11168 Arguments :
11169 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
11170 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
11171 as explained at the top of this document.
11172
11173 By default, the time to wait for a new request in case of keep-alive is set
11174 by "timeout http-request". However this is not always convenient because some
11175 people want very short keep-alive timeouts in order to release connections
11176 faster, and others prefer to have larger ones but still have short timeouts
11177 once the request has started to present itself.
11178
11179 The "http-keep-alive" timeout covers these needs. It will define how long to
11180 wait for a new HTTP request to start coming after a response was sent. Once
11181 the first byte of request has been seen, the "http-request" timeout is used
11182 to wait for the complete request to come. Note that empty lines prior to a
11183 new request do not refresh the timeout and are not counted as a new request.
11184
11185 There is also another difference between the two timeouts : when a connection
11186 expires during timeout http-keep-alive, no error is returned, the connection
11187 just closes. If the connection expires in "http-request" while waiting for a
11188 connection to complete, a HTTP 408 error is returned.
11189
11190 In general it is optimal to set this value to a few tens to hundreds of
11191 milliseconds, to allow users to fetch all objects of a page at once but
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011192 without waiting for further clicks. Also, if set to a very small value (e.g.
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +010011193 1 millisecond) it will probably only accept pipelined requests but not the
11194 non-pipelined ones. It may be a nice trade-off for very large sites running
Patrick Mézard2382ad62010-05-09 10:43:32 +020011195 with tens to hundreds of thousands of clients.
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +010011196
11197 If this parameter is not set, the "http-request" timeout applies, and if both
11198 are not set, "timeout client" still applies at the lower level. It should be
11199 set in the frontend to take effect, unless the frontend is in TCP mode, in
11200 which case the HTTP backend's timeout will be used.
11201
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +010011202 When using HTTP/2 "timeout client" is applied instead. This is so we can keep
11203 using short keep-alive timeouts in HTTP/1.1 while using longer ones in HTTP/2
Lukas Tribus75df9d72017-11-24 19:05:12 +010011204 (where we only have one connection per client and a connection setup).
11205
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +010011206 See also : "timeout http-request", "timeout client".
11207
11208
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010011209timeout http-request <timeout>
11210 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a complete HTTP request
11211 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaucd7afc02009-07-12 10:03:17 +020011212 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010011213 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010011214 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010011215 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
11216 as explained at the top of this document.
11217
11218 In order to offer DoS protection, it may be required to lower the maximum
11219 accepted time to receive a complete HTTP request without affecting the client
11220 timeout. This helps protecting against established connections on which
11221 nothing is sent. The client timeout cannot offer a good protection against
11222 this abuse because it is an inactivity timeout, which means that if the
11223 attacker sends one character every now and then, the timeout will not
11224 trigger. With the HTTP request timeout, no matter what speed the client
Willy Tarreau2705a612014-05-23 17:38:34 +020011225 types, the request will be aborted if it does not complete in time. When the
11226 timeout expires, an HTTP 408 response is sent to the client to inform it
11227 about the problem, and the connection is closed. The logs will report
11228 termination codes "cR". Some recent browsers are having problems with this
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011229 standard, well-documented behavior, so it might be needed to hide the 408
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020011230 code using "option http-ignore-probes" or "errorfile 408 /dev/null". See
11231 more details in the explanations of the "cR" termination code in section 8.5.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010011232
Baptiste Assmanneccdf432015-10-28 13:49:01 +010011233 By default, this timeout only applies to the header part of the request,
11234 and not to any data. As soon as the empty line is received, this timeout is
11235 not used anymore. When combined with "option http-buffer-request", this
11236 timeout also applies to the body of the request..
11237 It is used again on keep-alive connections to wait for a second
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +010011238 request if "timeout http-keep-alive" is not set.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010011239
11240 Generally it is enough to set it to a few seconds, as most clients send the
11241 full request immediately upon connection. Add 3 or more seconds to cover TCP
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011242 retransmits but that's all. Setting it to very low values (e.g. 50 ms) will
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010011243 generally work on local networks as long as there are no packet losses. This
11244 will prevent people from sending bare HTTP requests using telnet.
11245
11246 If this parameter is not set, the client timeout still applies between each
Willy Tarreaucd7afc02009-07-12 10:03:17 +020011247 chunk of the incoming request. It should be set in the frontend to take
11248 effect, unless the frontend is in TCP mode, in which case the HTTP backend's
11249 timeout will be used.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010011250
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020011251 See also : "errorfile", "http-ignore-probes", "timeout http-keep-alive", and
Baptiste Assmanneccdf432015-10-28 13:49:01 +010011252 "timeout client", "option http-buffer-request".
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010011253
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010011254
11255timeout queue <timeout>
11256 Set the maximum time to wait in the queue for a connection slot to be free
11257 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11258 yes | no | yes | yes
11259 Arguments :
11260 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
11261 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
11262 as explained at the top of this document.
11263
11264 When a server's maxconn is reached, connections are left pending in a queue
11265 which may be server-specific or global to the backend. In order not to wait
11266 indefinitely, a timeout is applied to requests pending in the queue. If the
11267 timeout is reached, it is considered that the request will almost never be
11268 served, so it is dropped and a 503 error is returned to the client.
11269
11270 The "timeout queue" statement allows to fix the maximum time for a request to
11271 be left pending in a queue. If unspecified, the same value as the backend's
11272 connection timeout ("timeout connect") is used, for backwards compatibility
11273 with older versions with no "timeout queue" parameter.
11274
Tim Duesterhus86e6b6e2019-05-14 20:57:59 +020011275 See also : "timeout connect".
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010011276
11277
11278timeout server <timeout>
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010011279 Set the maximum inactivity time on the server side.
11280 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11281 yes | no | yes | yes
11282 Arguments :
11283 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
11284 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
11285 as explained at the top of this document.
11286
11287 The inactivity timeout applies when the server is expected to acknowledge or
11288 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
11289 during the first phase of the server's response, when it has to send the
11290 headers, as it directly represents the server's processing time for the
11291 request. To find out what value to put there, it's often good to start with
11292 what would be considered as unacceptable response times, then check the logs
11293 to observe the response time distribution, and adjust the value accordingly.
11294
11295 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
11296 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
11297 document. In TCP mode (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly
11298 recommended that the client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in
11299 order to avoid complex situations to debug. Whatever the expected server
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +010011300 response times, it is a good practice to cover at least one or several TCP
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010011301 packet losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011302 seconds (e.g. 4 or 5 seconds minimum). If some long-lived sessions are mixed
11303 with short-lived sessions (e.g. WebSocket and HTTP), it's worth considering
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020011304 "timeout tunnel", which overrides "timeout client" and "timeout server" for
11305 tunnels.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010011306
11307 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
11308 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
11309 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
11310 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050011311 during startup because it may result in accumulation of expired sessions in
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010011312 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
11313
Tim Duesterhus86e6b6e2019-05-14 20:57:59 +020011314 See also : "timeout client" and "timeout tunnel".
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010011315
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020011316
11317timeout server-fin <timeout>
11318 Set the inactivity timeout on the server side for half-closed connections.
11319 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11320 yes | no | yes | yes
11321 Arguments :
11322 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
11323 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
11324 as explained at the top of this document.
11325
11326 The inactivity timeout applies when the server is expected to acknowledge or
11327 send data while one direction is already shut down. This timeout is different
11328 from "timeout server" in that it only applies to connections which are closed
11329 in one direction. This is particularly useful to avoid keeping connections in
11330 FIN_WAIT state for too long when a remote server does not disconnect cleanly.
11331 This problem is particularly common long connections such as RDP or WebSocket.
11332 Note that this timeout can override "timeout tunnel" when a connection shuts
11333 down in one direction. This setting was provided for completeness, but in most
11334 situations, it should not be needed.
11335
11336 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
11337 "defaults" sections. By default it is not set, so half-closed connections
11338 will use the other timeouts (timeout.server or timeout.tunnel).
11339
11340 See also : "timeout client-fin", "timeout server", and "timeout tunnel".
11341
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010011342
11343timeout tarpit <timeout>
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +010011344 Set the duration for which tarpitted connections will be maintained
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010011345 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11346 yes | yes | yes | yes
11347 Arguments :
11348 <timeout> is the tarpit duration specified in milliseconds by default, but
11349 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
11350 as explained at the top of this document.
11351
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +020011352 When a connection is tarpitted using "http-request tarpit", it is maintained
11353 open with no activity for a certain amount of time, then closed. "timeout
11354 tarpit" defines how long it will be maintained open.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010011355
11356 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
11357 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
11358 document. If unspecified, the same value as the backend's connection timeout
11359 ("timeout connect") is used, for backwards compatibility with older versions
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +010011360 with no "timeout tarpit" parameter.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010011361
Tim Duesterhus86e6b6e2019-05-14 20:57:59 +020011362 See also : "timeout connect".
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010011363
11364
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020011365timeout tunnel <timeout>
11366 Set the maximum inactivity time on the client and server side for tunnels.
11367 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11368 yes | no | yes | yes
11369 Arguments :
11370 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
11371 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
11372 as explained at the top of this document.
11373
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040011374 The tunnel timeout applies when a bidirectional connection is established
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020011375 between a client and a server, and the connection remains inactive in both
11376 directions. This timeout supersedes both the client and server timeouts once
11377 the connection becomes a tunnel. In TCP, this timeout is used as soon as no
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011378 analyzer remains attached to either connection (e.g. tcp content rules are
11379 accepted). In HTTP, this timeout is used when a connection is upgraded (e.g.
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020011380 when switching to the WebSocket protocol, or forwarding a CONNECT request
11381 to a proxy), or after the first response when no keepalive/close option is
11382 specified.
11383
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020011384 Since this timeout is usually used in conjunction with long-lived connections,
11385 it usually is a good idea to also set "timeout client-fin" to handle the
11386 situation where a client suddenly disappears from the net and does not
11387 acknowledge a close, or sends a shutdown and does not acknowledge pending
11388 data anymore. This can happen in lossy networks where firewalls are present,
11389 and is detected by the presence of large amounts of sessions in a FIN_WAIT
11390 state.
11391
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020011392 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
11393 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
11394 document. Whatever the expected normal idle time, it is a good practice to
11395 cover at least one or several TCP packet losses by specifying timeouts that
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011396 are slightly above multiples of 3 seconds (e.g. 4 or 5 seconds minimum).
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020011397
11398 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
11399 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
11400 forget about it.
11401
11402 Example :
11403 defaults http
11404 option http-server-close
11405 timeout connect 5s
11406 timeout client 30s
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020011407 timeout client-fin 30s
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020011408 timeout server 30s
11409 timeout tunnel 1h # timeout to use with WebSocket and CONNECT
11410
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020011411 See also : "timeout client", "timeout client-fin", "timeout server".
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020011412
11413
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010011414transparent (deprecated)
11415 Enable client-side transparent proxying
11416 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau4b1f8592008-12-23 23:13:55 +010011417 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010011418 Arguments : none
11419
11420 This keyword was introduced in order to provide layer 7 persistence to layer
11421 3 load balancers. The idea is to use the OS's ability to redirect an incoming
11422 connection for a remote address to a local process (here HAProxy), and let
11423 this process know what address was initially requested. When this option is
11424 used, sessions without cookies will be forwarded to the original destination
11425 IP address of the incoming request (which should match that of another
11426 equipment), while requests with cookies will still be forwarded to the
11427 appropriate server.
11428
11429 The "transparent" keyword is deprecated, use "option transparent" instead.
11430
11431 Note that contrary to a common belief, this option does NOT make HAProxy
11432 present the client's IP to the server when establishing the connection.
11433
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010011434 See also: "option transparent"
11435
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010011436unique-id-format <string>
11437 Generate a unique ID for each request.
11438 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11439 yes | yes | yes | no
11440 Arguments :
11441 <string> is a log-format string.
11442
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020011443 This keyword creates a ID for each request using the custom log format. A
11444 unique ID is useful to trace a request passing through many components of
11445 a complex infrastructure. The newly created ID may also be logged using the
11446 %ID tag the log-format string.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010011447
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020011448 The format should be composed from elements that are guaranteed to be
11449 unique when combined together. For instance, if multiple haproxy instances
11450 are involved, it might be important to include the node name. It is often
11451 needed to log the incoming connection's source and destination addresses
11452 and ports. Note that since multiple requests may be performed over the same
11453 connection, including a request counter may help differentiate them.
11454 Similarly, a timestamp may protect against a rollover of the counter.
11455 Logging the process ID will avoid collisions after a service restart.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010011456
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020011457 It is recommended to use hexadecimal notation for many fields since it
11458 makes them more compact and saves space in logs.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010011459
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020011460 Example:
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010011461
Julien Vehentf21be322014-03-07 08:27:34 -050011462 unique-id-format %{+X}o\ %ci:%cp_%fi:%fp_%Ts_%rt:%pid
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010011463
11464 will generate:
11465
11466 7F000001:8296_7F00001E:1F90_4F7B0A69_0003:790A
11467
11468 See also: "unique-id-header"
11469
11470unique-id-header <name>
11471 Add a unique ID header in the HTTP request.
11472 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11473 yes | yes | yes | no
11474 Arguments :
11475 <name> is the name of the header.
11476
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020011477 Add a unique-id header in the HTTP request sent to the server, using the
11478 unique-id-format. It can't work if the unique-id-format doesn't exist.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010011479
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020011480 Example:
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010011481
Julien Vehentf21be322014-03-07 08:27:34 -050011482 unique-id-format %{+X}o\ %ci:%cp_%fi:%fp_%Ts_%rt:%pid
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010011483 unique-id-header X-Unique-ID
11484
11485 will generate:
11486
11487 X-Unique-ID: 7F000001:8296_7F00001E:1F90_4F7B0A69_0003:790A
11488
11489 See also: "unique-id-format"
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010011490
Willy Tarreauf51658d2014-04-23 01:21:56 +020011491use_backend <backend> [{if | unless} <condition>]
Willy Tarreau1d0dfb12009-07-07 15:10:31 +020011492 Switch to a specific backend if/unless an ACL-based condition is matched.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010011493 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11494 no | yes | yes | no
11495 Arguments :
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +010011496 <backend> is the name of a valid backend or "listen" section, or a
11497 "log-format" string resolving to a backend name.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010011498
Willy Tarreauf51658d2014-04-23 01:21:56 +020011499 <condition> is a condition composed of ACLs, as described in section 7. If
11500 it is omitted, the rule is unconditionally applied.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010011501
11502 When doing content-switching, connections arrive on a frontend and are then
11503 dispatched to various backends depending on a number of conditions. The
11504 relation between the conditions and the backends is described with the
Willy Tarreau1d0dfb12009-07-07 15:10:31 +020011505 "use_backend" keyword. While it is normally used with HTTP processing, it can
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011506 also be used in pure TCP, either without content using stateless ACLs (e.g.
Willy Tarreau1d0dfb12009-07-07 15:10:31 +020011507 source address validation) or combined with a "tcp-request" rule to wait for
11508 some payload.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010011509
11510 There may be as many "use_backend" rules as desired. All of these rules are
11511 evaluated in their declaration order, and the first one which matches will
11512 assign the backend.
11513
11514 In the first form, the backend will be used if the condition is met. In the
11515 second form, the backend will be used if the condition is not met. If no
11516 condition is valid, the backend defined with "default_backend" will be used.
11517 If no default backend is defined, either the servers in the same section are
11518 used (in case of a "listen" section) or, in case of a frontend, no server is
11519 used and a 503 service unavailable response is returned.
11520
Willy Tarreau51aecc72009-07-12 09:47:04 +020011521 Note that it is possible to switch from a TCP frontend to an HTTP backend. In
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010011522 this case, either the frontend has already checked that the protocol is HTTP,
Willy Tarreau51aecc72009-07-12 09:47:04 +020011523 and backend processing will immediately follow, or the backend will wait for
11524 a complete HTTP request to get in. This feature is useful when a frontend
11525 must decode several protocols on a unique port, one of them being HTTP.
11526
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +010011527 When <backend> is a simple name, it is resolved at configuration time, and an
11528 error is reported if the specified backend does not exist. If <backend> is
11529 a log-format string instead, no check may be done at configuration time, so
11530 the backend name is resolved dynamically at run time. If the resulting
11531 backend name does not correspond to any valid backend, no other rule is
11532 evaluated, and the default_backend directive is applied instead. Note that
11533 when using dynamic backend names, it is highly recommended to use a prefix
11534 that no other backend uses in order to ensure that an unauthorized backend
11535 cannot be forced from the request.
11536
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011537 It is worth mentioning that "use_backend" rules with an explicit name are
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +010011538 used to detect the association between frontends and backends to compute the
11539 backend's "fullconn" setting. This cannot be done for dynamic names.
11540
11541 See also: "default_backend", "tcp-request", "fullconn", "log-format", and
11542 section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010011543
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020011544use-fcgi-app <name>
11545 Defines the FastCGI application to use for the backend.
11546 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11547 no | no | yes | yes
11548 Arguments :
11549 <name> is the name of the FastCGI application to use.
11550
11551 See section 10.1 about FastCGI application setup for details.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010011552
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020011553use-server <server> if <condition>
11554use-server <server> unless <condition>
11555 Only use a specific server if/unless an ACL-based condition is matched.
11556 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11557 no | no | yes | yes
11558 Arguments :
Jerome Magnin824186b2020-03-29 09:37:12 +020011559 <server> is the name of a valid server in the same backend section
11560 or a "log-format" string resolving to a server name.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020011561
11562 <condition> is a condition composed of ACLs, as described in section 7.
11563
11564 By default, connections which arrive to a backend are load-balanced across
11565 the available servers according to the configured algorithm, unless a
11566 persistence mechanism such as a cookie is used and found in the request.
11567
11568 Sometimes it is desirable to forward a particular request to a specific
11569 server without having to declare a dedicated backend for this server. This
11570 can be achieved using the "use-server" rules. These rules are evaluated after
11571 the "redirect" rules and before evaluating cookies, and they have precedence
11572 on them. There may be as many "use-server" rules as desired. All of these
11573 rules are evaluated in their declaration order, and the first one which
11574 matches will assign the server.
11575
11576 If a rule designates a server which is down, and "option persist" is not used
11577 and no force-persist rule was validated, it is ignored and evaluation goes on
11578 with the next rules until one matches.
11579
11580 In the first form, the server will be used if the condition is met. In the
11581 second form, the server will be used if the condition is not met. If no
11582 condition is valid, the processing continues and the server will be assigned
11583 according to other persistence mechanisms.
11584
11585 Note that even if a rule is matched, cookie processing is still performed but
11586 does not assign the server. This allows prefixed cookies to have their prefix
11587 stripped.
11588
11589 The "use-server" statement works both in HTTP and TCP mode. This makes it
11590 suitable for use with content-based inspection. For instance, a server could
11591 be selected in a farm according to the TLS SNI field. And if these servers
11592 have their weight set to zero, they will not be used for other traffic.
11593
11594 Example :
11595 # intercept incoming TLS requests based on the SNI field
11596 use-server www if { req_ssl_sni -i www.example.com }
11597 server www 192.168.0.1:443 weight 0
11598 use-server mail if { req_ssl_sni -i mail.example.com }
11599 server mail 192.168.0.1:587 weight 0
11600 use-server imap if { req_ssl_sni -i imap.example.com }
Lukas Tribus98a3e3f2017-03-26 12:55:35 +000011601 server imap 192.168.0.1:993 weight 0
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020011602 # all the rest is forwarded to this server
11603 server default 192.168.0.2:443 check
11604
Jerome Magnin824186b2020-03-29 09:37:12 +020011605 When <server> is a simple name, it is checked against existing servers in the
11606 configuration and an error is reported if the specified server does not exist.
11607 If it is a log-format, no check is performed when parsing the configuration,
11608 and if we can't resolve a valid server name at runtime but the use-server rule
11609 was conditionned by an ACL returning true, no other use-server rule is applied
11610 and we fall back to load balancing.
11611
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011612 See also: "use_backend", section 5 about server and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020011613
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011614
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100116155. Bind and server options
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011616--------------------------
11617
11618The "bind", "server" and "default-server" keywords support a number of settings
11619depending on some build options and on the system HAProxy was built on. These
11620settings generally each consist in one word sometimes followed by a value,
11621written on the same line as the "bind" or "server" line. All these options are
11622described in this section.
11623
11624
116255.1. Bind options
11626-----------------
11627
11628The "bind" keyword supports a certain number of settings which are all passed
11629as arguments on the same line. The order in which those arguments appear makes
11630no importance, provided that they appear after the bind address. All of these
11631parameters are optional. Some of them consist in a single words (booleans),
11632while other ones expect a value after them. In this case, the value must be
11633provided immediately after the setting name.
11634
11635The currently supported settings are the following ones.
11636
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010011637accept-netscaler-cip <magic number>
11638 Enforces the use of the NetScaler Client IP insertion protocol over any
11639 connection accepted by any of the TCP sockets declared on the same line. The
11640 NetScaler Client IP insertion protocol dictates the layer 3/4 addresses of
11641 the incoming connection to be used everywhere an address is used, with the
11642 only exception of "tcp-request connection" rules which will only see the
11643 real connection address. Logs will reflect the addresses indicated in the
11644 protocol, unless it is violated, in which case the real address will still
11645 be used. This keyword combined with support from external components can be
11646 used as an efficient and reliable alternative to the X-Forwarded-For
Bertrand Jacquin90759682016-06-06 15:35:39 +010011647 mechanism which is not always reliable and not even always usable. See also
11648 "tcp-request connection expect-netscaler-cip" for a finer-grained setting of
11649 which client is allowed to use the protocol.
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010011650
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011651accept-proxy
11652 Enforces the use of the PROXY protocol over any connection accepted by any of
Willy Tarreau77992672014-06-14 11:06:17 +020011653 the sockets declared on the same line. Versions 1 and 2 of the PROXY protocol
11654 are supported and correctly detected. The PROXY protocol dictates the layer
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011655 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection to be used everywhere an address is
11656 used, with the only exception of "tcp-request connection" rules which will
11657 only see the real connection address. Logs will reflect the addresses
11658 indicated in the protocol, unless it is violated, in which case the real
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011659 address will still be used. This keyword combined with support from external
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011660 components can be used as an efficient and reliable alternative to the
11661 X-Forwarded-For mechanism which is not always reliable and not even always
Willy Tarreau4f0d9192013-06-11 20:40:55 +020011662 usable. See also "tcp-request connection expect-proxy" for a finer-grained
11663 setting of which client is allowed to use the protocol.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011664
Olivier Houchardc2aae742017-09-22 18:26:28 +020011665allow-0rtt
Bertrand Jacquina25282b2018-08-14 00:56:13 +010011666 Allow receiving early data when using TLSv1.3. This is disabled by default,
Olivier Houchard69752962019-01-08 15:35:32 +010011667 due to security considerations. Because it is vulnerable to replay attacks,
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050011668 you should only allow if for requests that are safe to replay, i.e. requests
Olivier Houchard69752962019-01-08 15:35:32 +010011669 that are idempotent. You can use the "wait-for-handshake" action for any
11670 request that wouldn't be safe with early data.
Olivier Houchardc2aae742017-09-22 18:26:28 +020011671
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020011672alpn <protocols>
11673 This enables the TLS ALPN extension and advertises the specified protocol
11674 list as supported on top of ALPN. The protocol list consists in a comma-
11675 delimited list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050011676 quotes). This requires that the SSL library is built with support for TLS
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020011677 extensions enabled (check with haproxy -vv). The ALPN extension replaces the
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +010011678 initial NPN extension. ALPN is required to enable HTTP/2 on an HTTP frontend.
11679 Versions of OpenSSL prior to 1.0.2 didn't support ALPN and only supposed the
11680 now obsolete NPN extension. At the time of writing this, most browsers still
11681 support both ALPN and NPN for HTTP/2 so a fallback to NPN may still work for
11682 a while. But ALPN must be used whenever possible. If both HTTP/2 and HTTP/1.1
11683 are expected to be supported, both versions can be advertised, in order of
11684 preference, like below :
11685
11686 bind :443 ssl crt pub.pem alpn h2,http/1.1
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020011687
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011688backlog <backlog>
Willy Tarreaue2711c72019-02-27 15:39:41 +010011689 Sets the socket's backlog to this value. If unspecified or 0, the frontend's
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011690 backlog is used instead, which generally defaults to the maxconn value.
11691
Emmanuel Hocdete7f2b732017-01-09 16:15:54 +010011692curves <curves>
11693 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
11694 the string describing the list of elliptic curves algorithms ("curve suite")
11695 that are negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake with ECDHE. The format of the
11696 string is a colon-delimited list of curve name.
11697 Example: "X25519:P-256" (without quote)
11698 When "curves" is set, "ecdhe" parameter is ignored.
11699
Emeric Brun7fb34422012-09-28 15:26:15 +020011700ecdhe <named curve>
11701 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
Emeric Brun6924ef82013-03-06 14:08:53 +010011702 the named curve (RFC 4492) used to generate ECDH ephemeral keys. By default,
11703 used named curve is prime256v1.
Emeric Brun7fb34422012-09-28 15:26:15 +020011704
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +020011705ca-file <cafile>
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +020011706 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
11707 designates a PEM file from which to load CA certificates used to verify
11708 client's certificate.
11709
Emeric Brunb6dc9342012-09-28 17:55:37 +020011710ca-ignore-err [all|<errorID>,...]
11711 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in.
11712 Sets a comma separated list of errorIDs to ignore during verify at depth > 0.
11713 If set to 'all', all errors are ignored. SSL handshake is not aborted if an
11714 error is ignored.
11715
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +020011716ca-sign-file <cafile>
11717 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
11718 designates a PEM file containing both the CA certificate and the CA private
11719 key used to create and sign server's certificates. This is a mandatory
11720 setting when the dynamic generation of certificates is enabled. See
11721 'generate-certificates' for details.
11722
Bertrand Jacquind4d0a232016-11-13 16:37:12 +000011723ca-sign-pass <passphrase>
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +020011724 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It is
11725 the CA private key passphrase. This setting is optional and used only when
11726 the dynamic generation of certificates is enabled. See
11727 'generate-certificates' for details.
11728
Emmanuel Hocdet842e94e2019-12-16 16:39:17 +010011729ca-verify-file <cafile>
11730 This setting designates a PEM file from which to load CA certificates used to
11731 verify client's certificate. It designates CA certificates which must not be
11732 included in CA names sent in server hello message. Typically, "ca-file" must
11733 be defined with intermediate certificates, and "ca-verify-file" with
11734 certificates to ending the chain, like root CA.
11735
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011736ciphers <ciphers>
11737 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
11738 the string describing the list of cipher algorithms ("cipher suite") that are
Bertrand Jacquin8cf7c1e2019-02-03 18:35:25 +000011739 negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake up to TLSv1.2. The format of the
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +000011740 string is defined in "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages. For background
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +020011741 information and recommendations see e.g.
11742 (https://wiki.mozilla.org/Security/Server_Side_TLS) and
11743 (https://mozilla.github.io/server-side-tls/ssl-config-generator/). For TLSv1.3
11744 cipher configuration, please check the "ciphersuites" keyword.
11745
11746ciphersuites <ciphersuites>
11747 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in and
11748 OpenSSL 1.1.1 or later was used to build HAProxy. It sets the string describing
11749 the list of cipher algorithms ("cipher suite") that are negotiated during the
11750 TLSv1.3 handshake. The format of the string is defined in "man 1 ciphers" from
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +000011751 OpenSSL man pages under the "ciphersuites" section. For cipher configuration
11752 for TLSv1.2 and earlier, please check the "ciphers" keyword.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011753
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +020011754crl-file <crlfile>
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +020011755 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
11756 designates a PEM file from which to load certificate revocation list used
11757 to verify client's certificate.
11758
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011759crt <cert>
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000011760 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
11761 designates a PEM file containing both the required certificates and any
11762 associated private keys. This file can be built by concatenating multiple
11763 PEM files into one (e.g. cat cert.pem key.pem > combined.pem). If your CA
11764 requires an intermediate certificate, this can also be concatenated into this
Emmanuel Hocdet70df7bf2019-01-04 11:08:20 +010011765 file. Intermediate certificate can also be shared in a directory via
11766 "issuers-chain-path" directive.
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000011767
William Lallemand4c5adbf2020-02-24 14:23:22 +010011768 If the file does not contain a private key, HAProxy will try to load
11769 the key at the same path suffixed by a ".key".
11770
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000011771 If the OpenSSL used supports Diffie-Hellman, parameters present in this file
11772 are loaded.
11773
11774 If a directory name is used instead of a PEM file, then all files found in
William Lallemand3f25ae32020-02-24 16:30:12 +010011775 that directory will be loaded in alphabetic order unless their name ends
11776 with '.key', '.issuer', '.ocsp' or '.sctl' (reserved extensions). This
11777 directive may be specified multiple times in order to load certificates from
11778 multiple files or directories. The certificates will be presented to clients
11779 who provide a valid TLS Server Name Indication field matching one of their
11780 CN or alt subjects. Wildcards are supported, where a wildcard character '*'
11781 is used instead of the first hostname component (e.g. *.example.org matches
Janusz Dziemidowicz2c701b52015-03-07 23:03:59 +010011782 www.example.org but not www.sub.example.org).
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000011783
11784 If no SNI is provided by the client or if the SSL library does not support
11785 TLS extensions, or if the client provides an SNI hostname which does not
11786 match any certificate, then the first loaded certificate will be presented.
11787 This means that when loading certificates from a directory, it is highly
Cyril Bonté3180f7b2015-01-25 00:16:08 +010011788 recommended to load the default one first as a file or to ensure that it will
11789 always be the first one in the directory.
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000011790
Emeric Brune032bfa2012-09-28 13:01:45 +020011791 Note that the same cert may be loaded multiple times without side effects.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011792
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011793 Some CAs (such as GoDaddy) offer a drop down list of server types that do not
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000011794 include HAProxy when obtaining a certificate. If this happens be sure to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011795 choose a web server that the CA believes requires an intermediate CA (for
11796 GoDaddy, selection Apache Tomcat will get the correct bundle, but many
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000011797 others, e.g. nginx, result in a wrong bundle that will not work for some
11798 clients).
11799
Emeric Brun4147b2e2014-06-16 18:36:30 +020011800 For each PEM file, haproxy checks for the presence of file at the same path
11801 suffixed by ".ocsp". If such file is found, support for the TLS Certificate
11802 Status Request extension (also known as "OCSP stapling") is automatically
11803 enabled. The content of this file is optional. If not empty, it must contain
11804 a valid OCSP Response in DER format. In order to be valid an OCSP Response
11805 must comply with the following rules: it has to indicate a good status,
11806 it has to be a single response for the certificate of the PEM file, and it
11807 has to be valid at the moment of addition. If these rules are not respected
11808 the OCSP Response is ignored and a warning is emitted. In order to identify
11809 which certificate an OCSP Response applies to, the issuer's certificate is
11810 necessary. If the issuer's certificate is not found in the PEM file, it will
11811 be loaded from a file at the same path as the PEM file suffixed by ".issuer"
11812 if it exists otherwise it will fail with an error.
11813
Janusz Dziemidowicz2c701b52015-03-07 23:03:59 +010011814 For each PEM file, haproxy also checks for the presence of file at the same
11815 path suffixed by ".sctl". If such file is found, support for Certificate
11816 Transparency (RFC6962) TLS extension is enabled. The file must contain a
11817 valid Signed Certificate Timestamp List, as described in RFC. File is parsed
11818 to check basic syntax, but no signatures are verified.
11819
yanbzhu6c25e9e2016-01-05 12:52:02 -050011820 There are cases where it is desirable to support multiple key types, e.g. RSA
11821 and ECDSA in the cipher suites offered to the clients. This allows clients
11822 that support EC certificates to be able to use EC ciphers, while
11823 simultaneously supporting older, RSA only clients.
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -050011824
11825 In order to provide this functionality, multiple PEM files, each with a
11826 different key type, are required. To associate these PEM files into a
11827 "cert bundle" that is recognized by haproxy, they must be named in the
11828 following way: All PEM files that are to be bundled must have the same base
11829 name, with a suffix indicating the key type. Currently, three suffixes are
11830 supported: rsa, dsa and ecdsa. For example, if www.example.com has two PEM
11831 files, an RSA file and an ECDSA file, they must be named: "example.pem.rsa"
11832 and "example.pem.ecdsa". The first part of the filename is arbitrary; only the
11833 suffix matters. To load this bundle into haproxy, specify the base name only:
11834
11835 Example : bind :8443 ssl crt example.pem
11836
yanbzhu6c25e9e2016-01-05 12:52:02 -050011837 Note that the suffix is not given to haproxy; this tells haproxy to look for
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -050011838 a cert bundle.
11839
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011840 HAProxy will load all PEM files in the bundle at the same time to try to
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -050011841 support multiple key types. PEM files are combined based on Common Name
11842 (CN) and Subject Alternative Name (SAN) to support SNI lookups. This means
11843 that even if you give haproxy a cert bundle, if there are no shared CN/SAN
11844 entries in the certificates in that bundle, haproxy will not be able to
11845 provide multi-cert support.
11846
11847 Assuming bundle in the example above contained the following:
11848
11849 Filename | CN | SAN
11850 -------------------+-----------------+-------------------
11851 example.pem.rsa | www.example.com | rsa.example.com
yanbzhu6c25e9e2016-01-05 12:52:02 -050011852 -------------------+-----------------+-------------------
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -050011853 example.pem.ecdsa | www.example.com | ecdsa.example.com
11854 -------------------+-----------------+-------------------
11855
11856 Users connecting with an SNI of "www.example.com" will be able
11857 to use both RSA and ECDSA cipher suites. Users connecting with an SNI of
11858 "rsa.example.com" will only be able to use RSA cipher suites, and users
11859 connecting with "ecdsa.example.com" will only be able to use ECDSA cipher
Emmanuel Hocdet84e417d2017-08-16 11:33:17 +020011860 suites. With BoringSSL and Openssl >= 1.1.1 multi-cert is natively supported,
11861 no need to bundle certificates. ECDSA certificate will be preferred if client
11862 support it.
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -050011863
11864 If a directory name is given as the <cert> argument, haproxy will
11865 automatically search and load bundled files in that directory.
11866
11867 OSCP files (.ocsp) and issuer files (.issuer) are supported with multi-cert
11868 bundling. Each certificate can have its own .ocsp and .issuer file. At this
11869 time, sctl is not supported in multi-certificate bundling.
11870
Emeric Brunb6dc9342012-09-28 17:55:37 +020011871crt-ignore-err <errors>
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000011872 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. Sets a
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011873 comma separated list of errorIDs to ignore during verify at depth == 0. If
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011874 set to 'all', all errors are ignored. SSL handshake is not aborted if an error
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000011875 is ignored.
Emeric Brunb6dc9342012-09-28 17:55:37 +020011876
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +010011877crt-list <file>
11878 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010011879 designates a list of PEM file with an optional ssl configuration and a SNI
11880 filter per certificate, with the following format for each line :
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +010011881
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010011882 <crtfile> [\[<sslbindconf> ...\]] [[!]<snifilter> ...]
11883
Emmanuel Hocdet842e94e2019-12-16 16:39:17 +010011884 sslbindconf support "npn", "alpn", "verify", "ca-file", "ca-verify-file",
11885 "no-ca-names", "crl-file", "ecdhe", "curves", "ciphers" configuration. With
11886 BoringSSL and Openssl >= 1.1.1 "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" are also
11887 supported. It override the configuration set in bind line for the certificate.
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +010011888
Emmanuel Hocdet7c41a1b2013-05-07 20:20:06 +020011889 Wildcards are supported in the SNI filter. Negative filter are also supported,
11890 only useful in combination with a wildcard filter to exclude a particular SNI.
11891 The certificates will be presented to clients who provide a valid TLS Server
11892 Name Indication field matching one of the SNI filters. If no SNI filter is
11893 specified, the CN and alt subjects are used. This directive may be specified
11894 multiple times. See the "crt" option for more information. The default
11895 certificate is still needed to meet OpenSSL expectations. If it is not used,
11896 the 'strict-sni' option may be used.
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +010011897
yanbzhu6c25e9e2016-01-05 12:52:02 -050011898 Multi-cert bundling (see "crt") is supported with crt-list, as long as only
Emmanuel Hocdetd294aea2016-05-13 11:14:06 +020011899 the base name is given in the crt-list. SNI filter will do the same work on
Emmanuel Hocdet84e417d2017-08-16 11:33:17 +020011900 all bundled certificates. With BoringSSL and Openssl >= 1.1.1 multi-cert is
11901 natively supported, avoid multi-cert bundling. RSA and ECDSA certificates can
11902 be declared in a row, and set different ssl and filter parameter.
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -050011903
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010011904 crt-list file example:
11905 cert1.pem
Emmanuel Hocdet05942112017-02-20 16:11:50 +010011906 cert2.pem [alpn h2,http/1.1]
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010011907 certW.pem *.domain.tld !secure.domain.tld
Emmanuel Hocdet05942112017-02-20 16:11:50 +010011908 certS.pem [curves X25519:P-256 ciphers ECDHE-ECDSA-AES256-GCM-SHA384] secure.domain.tld
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010011909
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011910defer-accept
11911 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on certain Linux kernels. It
11912 states that a connection will only be accepted once some data arrive on it,
11913 or at worst after the first retransmit. This should be used only on protocols
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011914 for which the client talks first (e.g. HTTP). It can slightly improve
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011915 performance by ensuring that most of the request is already available when
11916 the connection is accepted. On the other hand, it will not be able to detect
11917 connections which don't talk. It is important to note that this option is
11918 broken in all kernels up to 2.6.31, as the connection is never accepted until
11919 the client talks. This can cause issues with front firewalls which would see
11920 an established connection while the proxy will only see it in SYN_RECV. This
11921 option is only supported on TCPv4/TCPv6 sockets and ignored by other ones.
11922
William Lallemandf6975e92017-05-26 17:42:10 +020011923expose-fd listeners
11924 This option is only usable with the stats socket. It gives your stats socket
11925 the capability to pass listeners FD to another HAProxy process.
William Lallemande202b1e2017-06-01 17:38:56 +020011926 During a reload with the master-worker mode, the process is automatically
11927 reexecuted adding -x and one of the stats socket with this option.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011928 See also "-x" in the management guide.
William Lallemandf6975e92017-05-26 17:42:10 +020011929
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020011930force-sslv3
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011931 This option enforces use of SSLv3 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020011932 this listener. SSLv3 is generally less expensive than the TLS counterparts
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011933 for high connection rates. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011934 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020011935
11936force-tlsv10
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011937 This option enforces use of TLSv1.0 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011938 this listener. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011939 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020011940
11941force-tlsv11
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011942 This option enforces use of TLSv1.1 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011943 this listener. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011944 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020011945
11946force-tlsv12
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011947 This option enforces use of TLSv1.2 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011948 this listener. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011949 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020011950
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020011951force-tlsv13
11952 This option enforces use of TLSv1.3 only on SSL connections instantiated from
11953 this listener. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011954 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver".
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020011955
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +020011956generate-certificates
11957 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
11958 enables the dynamic SSL certificates generation. A CA certificate and its
11959 private key are necessary (see 'ca-sign-file'). When HAProxy is configured as
11960 a transparent forward proxy, SSL requests generate errors because of a common
11961 name mismatch on the certificate presented to the client. With this option
11962 enabled, HAProxy will try to forge a certificate using the SNI hostname
11963 indicated by the client. This is done only if no certificate matches the SNI
11964 hostname (see 'crt-list'). If an error occurs, the default certificate is
11965 used, else the 'strict-sni' option is set.
11966 It can also be used when HAProxy is configured as a reverse proxy to ease the
11967 deployment of an architecture with many backends.
11968
11969 Creating a SSL certificate is an expensive operation, so a LRU cache is used
11970 to store forged certificates (see 'tune.ssl.ssl-ctx-cache-size'). It
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011971 increases the HAProxy's memory footprint to reduce latency when the same
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +020011972 certificate is used many times.
11973
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011974gid <gid>
11975 Sets the group of the UNIX sockets to the designated system gid. It can also
11976 be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note that
11977 some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the "group"
11978 setting except that the group ID is used instead of its name. This setting is
11979 ignored by non UNIX sockets.
11980
11981group <group>
11982 Sets the group of the UNIX sockets to the designated system group. It can
11983 also be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note
11984 that some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the
11985 "gid" setting except that the group name is used instead of its gid. This
11986 setting is ignored by non UNIX sockets.
11987
11988id <id>
11989 Fixes the socket ID. By default, socket IDs are automatically assigned, but
11990 sometimes it is more convenient to fix them to ease monitoring. This value
11991 must be strictly positive and unique within the listener/frontend. This
11992 option can only be used when defining only a single socket.
11993
11994interface <interface>
Lukas Tribusfce2e962013-02-12 22:13:19 +010011995 Restricts the socket to a specific interface. When specified, only packets
11996 received from that particular interface are processed by the socket. This is
11997 currently only supported on Linux. The interface must be a primary system
11998 interface, not an aliased interface. It is also possible to bind multiple
11999 frontends to the same address if they are bound to different interfaces. Note
12000 that binding to a network interface requires root privileges. This parameter
Jérôme Magnin61275192018-02-07 11:39:58 +010012001 is only compatible with TCPv4/TCPv6 sockets. When specified, return traffic
12002 uses the same interface as inbound traffic, and its associated routing table,
12003 even if there are explicit routes through different interfaces configured.
12004 This can prove useful to address asymmetric routing issues when the same
12005 client IP addresses need to be able to reach frontends hosted on different
12006 interfaces.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020012007
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +020012008level <level>
12009 This setting is used with the stats sockets only to restrict the nature of
12010 the commands that can be issued on the socket. It is ignored by other
12011 sockets. <level> can be one of :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012012 - "user" is the least privileged level; only non-sensitive stats can be
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +020012013 read, and no change is allowed. It would make sense on systems where it
12014 is not easy to restrict access to the socket.
12015 - "operator" is the default level and fits most common uses. All data can
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012016 be read, and only non-sensitive changes are permitted (e.g. clear max
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +020012017 counters).
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012018 - "admin" should be used with care, as everything is permitted (e.g. clear
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +020012019 all counters).
12020
Andjelko Iharosc4df59e2017-07-20 11:59:48 +020012021severity-output <format>
12022 This setting is used with the stats sockets only to configure severity
12023 level output prepended to informational feedback messages. Severity
12024 level of messages can range between 0 and 7, conforming to syslog
12025 rfc5424. Valid and successful socket commands requesting data
12026 (i.e. "show map", "get acl foo" etc.) will never have a severity level
12027 prepended. It is ignored by other sockets. <format> can be one of :
12028 - "none" (default) no severity level is prepended to feedback messages.
12029 - "number" severity level is prepended as a number.
12030 - "string" severity level is prepended as a string following the
12031 rfc5424 convention.
12032
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020012033maxconn <maxconn>
12034 Limits the sockets to this number of concurrent connections. Extraneous
12035 connections will remain in the system's backlog until a connection is
12036 released. If unspecified, the limit will be the same as the frontend's
12037 maxconn. Note that in case of port ranges or multiple addresses, the same
12038 value will be applied to each socket. This setting enables different
12039 limitations on expensive sockets, for instance SSL entries which may easily
12040 eat all memory.
12041
12042mode <mode>
12043 Sets the octal mode used to define access permissions on the UNIX socket. It
12044 can also be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement.
12045 Note that some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is ignored by non
12046 UNIX sockets.
12047
12048mss <maxseg>
12049 Sets the TCP Maximum Segment Size (MSS) value to be advertised on incoming
12050 connections. This can be used to force a lower MSS for certain specific
12051 ports, for instance for connections passing through a VPN. Note that this
12052 relies on a kernel feature which is theoretically supported under Linux but
12053 was buggy in all versions prior to 2.6.28. It may or may not work on other
12054 operating systems. It may also not change the advertised value but change the
12055 effective size of outgoing segments. The commonly advertised value for TCPv4
12056 over Ethernet networks is 1460 = 1500(MTU) - 40(IP+TCP). If this value is
12057 positive, it will be used as the advertised MSS. If it is negative, it will
12058 indicate by how much to reduce the incoming connection's advertised MSS for
12059 outgoing segments. This parameter is only compatible with TCP v4/v6 sockets.
12060
12061name <name>
12062 Sets an optional name for these sockets, which will be reported on the stats
12063 page.
12064
Willy Tarreaud72f0f32015-10-13 14:50:22 +020012065namespace <name>
12066 On Linux, it is possible to specify which network namespace a socket will
12067 belong to. This directive makes it possible to explicitly bind a listener to
12068 a namespace different from the default one. Please refer to your operating
12069 system's documentation to find more details about network namespaces.
12070
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020012071nice <nice>
12072 Sets the 'niceness' of connections initiated from the socket. Value must be
12073 in the range -1024..1024 inclusive, and defaults to zero. Positive values
12074 means that such connections are more friendly to others and easily offer
12075 their place in the scheduler. On the opposite, negative values mean that
12076 connections want to run with a higher priority than others. The difference
12077 only happens under high loads when the system is close to saturation.
12078 Negative values are appropriate for low-latency or administration services,
12079 and high values are generally recommended for CPU intensive tasks such as SSL
12080 processing or bulk transfers which are less sensible to latency. For example,
12081 it may make sense to use a positive value for an SMTP socket and a negative
12082 one for an RDP socket.
12083
Emmanuel Hocdet174dfe52017-07-28 15:01:05 +020012084no-ca-names
12085 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
12086 prevents from send CA names in server hello message when ca-file is used.
Emmanuel Hocdet842e94e2019-12-16 16:39:17 +010012087 Use "ca-verify-file" instead of "ca-file" with "no-ca-names".
Emmanuel Hocdet174dfe52017-07-28 15:01:05 +020012088
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020012089no-sslv3
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020012090 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030012091 disables support for SSLv3 on any sockets instantiated from the listener when
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020012092 SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and cannot
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010012093 be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also available on
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020012094 global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". Use "ssl-min-ver" and
12095 "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020012096
Emeric Brun90ad8722012-10-02 14:00:59 +020012097no-tls-tickets
12098 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
12099 disables the stateless session resumption (RFC 5077 TLS Ticket
12100 extension) and force to use stateful session resumption. Stateless
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010012101 session resumption is more expensive in CPU usage. This option is also
12102 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options".
Lukas Tribusbdb386d2020-03-10 00:56:09 +010012103 The TLS ticket mechanism is only used up to TLS 1.2.
12104 Forward Secrecy is compromised with TLS tickets, unless ticket keys
12105 are periodically rotated (via reload or by using "tls-ticket-keys").
Emeric Brun90ad8722012-10-02 14:00:59 +020012106
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020012107no-tlsv10
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020012108 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030012109 disables support for TLSv1.0 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020012110 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010012111 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020012112 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". Use "ssl-min-ver"
12113 and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020012114
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020012115no-tlsv11
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020012116 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030012117 disables support for TLSv1.1 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020012118 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010012119 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020012120 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". Use "ssl-min-ver"
12121 and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020012122
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020012123no-tlsv12
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020012124 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030012125 disables support for TLSv1.2 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020012126 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010012127 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020012128 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". Use "ssl-min-ver"
12129 and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020012130
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020012131no-tlsv13
12132 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
12133 disables support for TLSv1.3 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
12134 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
12135 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020012136 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". Use "ssl-min-ver"
12137 and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020012138
Willy Tarreau6c9a3d52012-10-18 18:57:14 +020012139npn <protocols>
12140 This enables the NPN TLS extension and advertises the specified protocol list
12141 as supported on top of NPN. The protocol list consists in a comma-delimited
12142 list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without quotes).
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050012143 This requires that the SSL library is built with support for TLS extensions
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020012144 enabled (check with haproxy -vv). Note that the NPN extension has been
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +010012145 replaced with the ALPN extension (see the "alpn" keyword), though this one is
12146 only available starting with OpenSSL 1.0.2. If HTTP/2 is desired on an older
12147 version of OpenSSL, NPN might still be used as most clients still support it
12148 at the time of writing this. It is possible to enable both NPN and ALPN
12149 though it probably doesn't make any sense out of testing.
Willy Tarreau6c9a3d52012-10-18 18:57:14 +020012150
Lukas Tribus53ae85c2017-05-04 15:45:40 +000012151prefer-client-ciphers
12152 Use the client's preference when selecting the cipher suite, by default
12153 the server's preference is enforced. This option is also available on
12154 global statement "ssl-default-bind-options".
Lukas Tribus926594f2018-05-18 17:55:57 +020012155 Note that with OpenSSL >= 1.1.1 ChaCha20-Poly1305 is reprioritized anyway
12156 (without setting this option), if a ChaCha20-Poly1305 cipher is at the top of
12157 the client cipher list.
Lukas Tribus53ae85c2017-05-04 15:45:40 +000012158
Christopher Fauletc644fa92017-11-23 22:44:11 +010012159process <process-set>[/<thread-set>]
Willy Tarreaua36b3242019-02-02 13:14:34 +010012160 This restricts the list of processes or threads on which this listener is
Christopher Fauletc644fa92017-11-23 22:44:11 +010012161 allowed to run. It does not enforce any process but eliminates those which do
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012162 not match. If the frontend uses a "bind-process" setting, the intersection
Christopher Fauletc644fa92017-11-23 22:44:11 +010012163 between the two is applied. If in the end the listener is not allowed to run
12164 on any remaining process, a warning is emitted, and the listener will either
12165 run on the first process of the listener if a single process was specified,
12166 or on all of its processes if multiple processes were specified. If a thread
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012167 set is specified, it limits the threads allowed to process incoming
Willy Tarreaua36b3242019-02-02 13:14:34 +010012168 connections for this listener, for the the process set. If multiple processes
12169 and threads are configured, a warning is emitted, as it either results from a
12170 configuration error or a misunderstanding of these models. For the unlikely
12171 case where several ranges are needed, this directive may be repeated.
12172 <process-set> and <thread-set> must use the format
Christopher Fauletc644fa92017-11-23 22:44:11 +010012173
12174 all | odd | even | number[-[number]]
12175
12176 Ranges can be partially defined. The higher bound can be omitted. In such
12177 case, it is replaced by the corresponding maximum value. The main purpose of
12178 this directive is to be used with the stats sockets and have one different
12179 socket per process. The second purpose is to have multiple bind lines sharing
12180 the same IP:port but not the same process in a listener, so that the system
12181 can distribute the incoming connections into multiple queues and allow a
12182 smoother inter-process load balancing. Currently Linux 3.9 and above is known
12183 for supporting this. See also "bind-process" and "nbproc".
Willy Tarreau6ae1ba62014-05-07 19:01:58 +020012184
Christopher Fauleta717b992018-04-10 14:43:00 +020012185proto <name>
12186 Forces the multiplexer's protocol to use for the incoming connections. It
12187 must be compatible with the mode of the frontend (TCP or HTTP). It must also
12188 be usable on the frontend side. The list of available protocols is reported
12189 in haproxy -vv.
12190 Idea behind this optipon is to bypass the selection of the best multiplexer's
12191 protocol for all connections instantiated from this listening socket. For
Joseph Herlant71b4b152018-11-13 16:55:16 -080012192 instance, it is possible to force the http/2 on clear TCP by specifying "proto
Christopher Fauleta717b992018-04-10 14:43:00 +020012193 h2" on the bind line.
12194
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020012195ssl
12196 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030012197 enables SSL deciphering on connections instantiated from this listener. A
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020012198 certificate is necessary (see "crt" above). All contents in the buffers will
12199 appear in clear text, so that ACLs and HTTP processing will only have access
Emmanuel Hocdetbd695fe2017-05-15 15:53:41 +020012200 to deciphered contents. SSLv3 is disabled per default, use "ssl-min-ver SSLv3"
12201 to enable it.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020012202
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020012203ssl-max-ver [ SSLv3 | TLSv1.0 | TLSv1.1 | TLSv1.2 | TLSv1.3 ]
12204 This option enforces use of <version> or lower on SSL connections instantiated
12205 from this listener. This option is also available on global statement
12206 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver".
12207
12208ssl-min-ver [ SSLv3 | TLSv1.0 | TLSv1.1 | TLSv1.2 | TLSv1.3 ]
12209 This option enforces use of <version> or upper on SSL connections instantiated
12210 from this listener. This option is also available on global statement
12211 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-max-ver".
12212
Emmanuel Hocdet65623372013-01-24 17:17:15 +010012213strict-sni
12214 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. The
12215 SSL/TLS negotiation is allow only if the client provided an SNI which match
12216 a certificate. The default certificate is not used.
12217 See the "crt" option for more information.
12218
Willy Tarreau2af207a2015-02-04 00:45:58 +010012219tcp-ut <delay>
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010012220 Sets the TCP User Timeout for all incoming connections instantiated from this
Willy Tarreau2af207a2015-02-04 00:45:58 +010012221 listening socket. This option is available on Linux since version 2.6.37. It
12222 allows haproxy to configure a timeout for sockets which contain data not
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012223 receiving an acknowledgment for the configured delay. This is especially
Willy Tarreau2af207a2015-02-04 00:45:58 +010012224 useful on long-lived connections experiencing long idle periods such as
12225 remote terminals or database connection pools, where the client and server
12226 timeouts must remain high to allow a long period of idle, but where it is
12227 important to detect that the client has disappeared in order to release all
12228 resources associated with its connection (and the server's session). The
12229 argument is a delay expressed in milliseconds by default. This only works
12230 for regular TCP connections, and is ignored for other protocols.
12231
Willy Tarreau1c862c52012-10-05 16:21:00 +020012232tfo
Lukas Tribus0defb902013-02-13 23:35:39 +010012233 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on Linux kernels >= 3.7. It
Willy Tarreau1c862c52012-10-05 16:21:00 +020012234 enables TCP Fast Open on the listening socket, which means that clients which
12235 support this feature will be able to send a request and receive a response
12236 during the 3-way handshake starting from second connection, thus saving one
12237 round-trip after the first connection. This only makes sense with protocols
12238 that use high connection rates and where each round trip matters. This can
12239 possibly cause issues with many firewalls which do not accept data on SYN
12240 packets, so this option should only be enabled once well tested. This option
Lukas Tribus0999f762013-04-02 16:43:24 +020012241 is only supported on TCPv4/TCPv6 sockets and ignored by other ones. You may
12242 need to build HAProxy with USE_TFO=1 if your libc doesn't define
12243 TCP_FASTOPEN.
Willy Tarreau1c862c52012-10-05 16:21:00 +020012244
Nenad Merdanovic188ad3e2015-02-27 19:56:50 +010012245tls-ticket-keys <keyfile>
12246 Sets the TLS ticket keys file to load the keys from. The keys need to be 48
Emeric Brun9e754772019-01-10 17:51:55 +010012247 or 80 bytes long, depending if aes128 or aes256 is used, encoded with base64
12248 with one line per key (ex. openssl rand 80 | openssl base64 -A | xargs echo).
12249 The first key determines the key length used for next keys: you can't mix
12250 aes128 and aes256 keys. Number of keys is specified by the TLS_TICKETS_NO
12251 build option (default 3) and at least as many keys need to be present in
12252 the file. Last TLS_TICKETS_NO keys will be used for decryption and the
12253 penultimate one for encryption. This enables easy key rotation by just
12254 appending new key to the file and reloading the process. Keys must be
12255 periodically rotated (ex. every 12h) or Perfect Forward Secrecy is
12256 compromised. It is also a good idea to keep the keys off any permanent
Nenad Merdanovic188ad3e2015-02-27 19:56:50 +010012257 storage such as hard drives (hint: use tmpfs and don't swap those files).
12258 Lifetime hint can be changed using tune.ssl.timeout.
12259
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020012260transparent
12261 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on certain Linux kernels. It
12262 indicates that the addresses will be bound even if they do not belong to the
12263 local machine, and that packets targeting any of these addresses will be
12264 intercepted just as if the addresses were locally configured. This normally
12265 requires that IP forwarding is enabled. Caution! do not use this with the
12266 default address '*', as it would redirect any traffic for the specified port.
12267 This keyword is available only when HAProxy is built with USE_LINUX_TPROXY=1.
12268 This parameter is only compatible with TCPv4 and TCPv6 sockets, depending on
12269 kernel version. Some distribution kernels include backports of the feature,
12270 so check for support with your vendor.
12271
Willy Tarreau77e3af92012-11-24 15:07:23 +010012272v4v6
12273 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on most recent systems
12274 including Linux kernels >= 2.4.21. It is used to bind a socket to both IPv4
12275 and IPv6 when it uses the default address. Doing so is sometimes necessary
12276 on systems which bind to IPv6 only by default. It has no effect on non-IPv6
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030012277 sockets, and is overridden by the "v6only" option.
Willy Tarreau77e3af92012-11-24 15:07:23 +010012278
Willy Tarreau9b6700f2012-11-24 11:55:28 +010012279v6only
12280 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on most recent systems
12281 including Linux kernels >= 2.4.21. It is used to bind a socket to IPv6 only
12282 when it uses the default address. Doing so is sometimes preferred to doing it
Willy Tarreau77e3af92012-11-24 15:07:23 +010012283 system-wide as it is per-listener. It has no effect on non-IPv6 sockets and
12284 has precedence over the "v4v6" option.
Willy Tarreau9b6700f2012-11-24 11:55:28 +010012285
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020012286uid <uid>
12287 Sets the owner of the UNIX sockets to the designated system uid. It can also
12288 be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note that
12289 some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the "user"
12290 setting except that the user numeric ID is used instead of its name. This
12291 setting is ignored by non UNIX sockets.
12292
12293user <user>
12294 Sets the owner of the UNIX sockets to the designated system user. It can also
12295 be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note that
12296 some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the "uid"
12297 setting except that the user name is used instead of its uid. This setting is
12298 ignored by non UNIX sockets.
12299
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +020012300verify [none|optional|required]
12301 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. If set
12302 to 'none', client certificate is not requested. This is the default. In other
12303 cases, a client certificate is requested. If the client does not provide a
12304 certificate after the request and if 'verify' is set to 'required', then the
12305 handshake is aborted, while it would have succeeded if set to 'optional'. The
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +020012306 certificate provided by the client is always verified using CAs from
12307 'ca-file' and optional CRLs from 'crl-file'. On verify failure the handshake
12308 is aborted, regardless of the 'verify' option, unless the error code exactly
12309 matches one of those listed with 'ca-ignore-err' or 'crt-ignore-err'.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020012310
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +0200123115.2. Server and default-server options
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +010012312------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012313
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +010012314The "server" and "default-server" keywords support a certain number of settings
12315which are all passed as arguments on the server line. The order in which those
12316arguments appear does not count, and they are all optional. Some of those
12317settings are single words (booleans) while others expect one or several values
12318after them. In this case, the values must immediately follow the setting name.
12319Except default-server, all those settings must be specified after the server's
12320address if they are used:
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012321
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012322 server <name> <address>[:port] [settings ...]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +010012323 default-server [settings ...]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012324
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010012325Note that all these settings are supported both by "server" and "default-server"
12326keywords, except "id" which is only supported by "server".
12327
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010012328The currently supported settings are the following ones.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012329
Willy Tarreauceb4ac92012-04-28 00:41:46 +020012330addr <ipv4|ipv6>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012331 Using the "addr" parameter, it becomes possible to use a different IP address
Baptiste Assmann13f83532016-03-06 23:14:36 +010012332 to send health-checks or to probe the agent-check. On some servers, it may be
12333 desirable to dedicate an IP address to specific component able to perform
12334 complex tests which are more suitable to health-checks than the application.
12335 This parameter is ignored if the "check" parameter is not set. See also the
12336 "port" parameter.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012337
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090012338agent-check
12339 Enable an auxiliary agent check which is run independently of a regular
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010012340 health check. An agent health check is performed by making a TCP connection
Willy Tarreau7a0139e2018-12-16 08:42:56 +010012341 to the port set by the "agent-port" parameter and reading an ASCII string
12342 terminated by the first '\r' or '\n' met. The string is made of a series of
12343 words delimited by spaces, tabs or commas in any order, each consisting of :
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090012344
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010012345 - An ASCII representation of a positive integer percentage, e.g. "75%".
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090012346 Values in this format will set the weight proportional to the initial
Willy Tarreauc5af3a62014-10-07 15:27:33 +020012347 weight of a server as configured when haproxy starts. Note that a zero
12348 weight is reported on the stats page as "DRAIN" since it has the same
12349 effect on the server (it's removed from the LB farm).
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090012350
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012351 - The string "maxconn:" followed by an integer (no space between). Values
12352 in this format will set the maxconn of a server. The maximum number of
12353 connections advertised needs to be multiplied by the number of load
12354 balancers and different backends that use this health check to get the
12355 total number of connections the server might receive. Example: maxconn:30
Nenad Merdanovic174dd372016-04-24 23:10:06 +020012356
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010012357 - The word "ready". This will turn the server's administrative state to the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012358 READY mode, thus canceling any DRAIN or MAINT state
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090012359
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010012360 - The word "drain". This will turn the server's administrative state to the
12361 DRAIN mode, thus it will not accept any new connections other than those
12362 that are accepted via persistence.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090012363
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010012364 - The word "maint". This will turn the server's administrative state to the
12365 MAINT mode, thus it will not accept any new connections at all, and health
12366 checks will be stopped.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090012367
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010012368 - The words "down", "failed", or "stopped", optionally followed by a
12369 description string after a sharp ('#'). All of these mark the server's
12370 operating state as DOWN, but since the word itself is reported on the stats
12371 page, the difference allows an administrator to know if the situation was
12372 expected or not : the service may intentionally be stopped, may appear up
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012373 but fail some validity tests, or may be seen as down (e.g. missing process,
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010012374 or port not responding).
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090012375
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010012376 - The word "up" sets back the server's operating state as UP if health checks
12377 also report that the service is accessible.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090012378
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010012379 Parameters which are not advertised by the agent are not changed. For
12380 example, an agent might be designed to monitor CPU usage and only report a
12381 relative weight and never interact with the operating status. Similarly, an
12382 agent could be designed as an end-user interface with 3 radio buttons
12383 allowing an administrator to change only the administrative state. However,
12384 it is important to consider that only the agent may revert its own actions,
12385 so if a server is set to DRAIN mode or to DOWN state using the agent, the
12386 agent must implement the other equivalent actions to bring the service into
12387 operations again.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090012388
Simon Horman2f1f9552013-11-25 10:46:37 +090012389 Failure to connect to the agent is not considered an error as connectivity
12390 is tested by the regular health check which is enabled by the "check"
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010012391 parameter. Warning though, it is not a good idea to stop an agent after it
12392 reports "down", since only an agent reporting "up" will be able to turn the
12393 server up again. Note that the CLI on the Unix stats socket is also able to
Willy Tarreau989222a2016-01-15 10:26:26 +010012394 force an agent's result in order to work around a bogus agent if needed.
Simon Horman2f1f9552013-11-25 10:46:37 +090012395
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010012396 Requires the "agent-port" parameter to be set. See also the "agent-inter"
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010012397 and "no-agent-check" parameters.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090012398
James Brown55f9ff12015-10-21 18:19:05 -070012399agent-send <string>
12400 If this option is specified, haproxy will send the given string (verbatim)
12401 to the agent server upon connection. You could, for example, encode
12402 the backend name into this string, which would enable your agent to send
12403 different responses based on the backend. Make sure to include a '\n' if
12404 you want to terminate your request with a newline.
12405
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090012406agent-inter <delay>
12407 The "agent-inter" parameter sets the interval between two agent checks
12408 to <delay> milliseconds. If left unspecified, the delay defaults to 2000 ms.
12409
12410 Just as with every other time-based parameter, it may be entered in any
12411 other explicit unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }. The "agent-inter"
12412 parameter also serves as a timeout for agent checks "timeout check" is
12413 not set. In order to reduce "resonance" effects when multiple servers are
12414 hosted on the same hardware, the agent and health checks of all servers
12415 are started with a small time offset between them. It is also possible to
12416 add some random noise in the agent and health checks interval using the
12417 global "spread-checks" keyword. This makes sense for instance when a lot
12418 of backends use the same servers.
12419
12420 See also the "agent-check" and "agent-port" parameters.
12421
Misiek768d8602017-01-09 09:52:43 +010012422agent-addr <addr>
12423 The "agent-addr" parameter sets address for agent check.
12424
12425 You can offload agent-check to another target, so you can make single place
12426 managing status and weights of servers defined in haproxy in case you can't
12427 make self-aware and self-managing services. You can specify both IP or
12428 hostname, it will be resolved.
12429
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090012430agent-port <port>
12431 The "agent-port" parameter sets the TCP port used for agent checks.
12432
12433 See also the "agent-check" and "agent-inter" parameters.
12434
Olivier Houchard8cb2d2e2019-05-06 18:58:48 +020012435allow-0rtt
12436 Allow sending early data to the server when using TLS 1.3.
Olivier Houchard22c9b442019-05-06 19:01:04 +020012437 Note that early data will be sent only if the client used early data, or
12438 if the backend uses "retry-on" with the "0rtt-rejected" keyword.
Olivier Houchard8cb2d2e2019-05-06 18:58:48 +020012439
Olivier Houchardc7566002018-11-20 23:33:50 +010012440alpn <protocols>
12441 This enables the TLS ALPN extension and advertises the specified protocol
12442 list as supported on top of ALPN. The protocol list consists in a comma-
12443 delimited list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050012444 quotes). This requires that the SSL library is built with support for TLS
Olivier Houchardc7566002018-11-20 23:33:50 +010012445 extensions enabled (check with haproxy -vv). The ALPN extension replaces the
12446 initial NPN extension. ALPN is required to connect to HTTP/2 servers.
12447 Versions of OpenSSL prior to 1.0.2 didn't support ALPN and only supposed the
12448 now obsolete NPN extension.
12449 If both HTTP/2 and HTTP/1.1 are expected to be supported, both versions can
12450 be advertised, in order of preference, like below :
12451
12452 server 127.0.0.1:443 ssl crt pub.pem alpn h2,http/1.1
12453
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012454backup
12455 When "backup" is present on a server line, the server is only used in load
12456 balancing when all other non-backup servers are unavailable. Requests coming
12457 with a persistence cookie referencing the server will always be served
12458 though. By default, only the first operational backup server is used, unless
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010012459 the "allbackups" option is set in the backend. See also the "no-backup" and
12460 "allbackups" options.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010012461
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +020012462ca-file <cafile>
12463 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
12464 designates a PEM file from which to load CA certificates used to verify
12465 server's certificate.
12466
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012467check
12468 This option enables health checks on the server. By default, a server is
Patrick Mézardb7aeec62012-01-22 16:01:22 +010012469 always considered available. If "check" is set, the server is available when
12470 accepting periodic TCP connections, to ensure that it is really able to serve
12471 requests. The default address and port to send the tests to are those of the
12472 server, and the default source is the same as the one defined in the
12473 backend. It is possible to change the address using the "addr" parameter, the
12474 port using the "port" parameter, the source address using the "source"
12475 address, and the interval and timers using the "inter", "rise" and "fall"
Simon Hormanafc47ee2013-11-25 10:46:35 +090012476 parameters. The request method is define in the backend using the "httpchk",
12477 "smtpchk", "mysql-check", "pgsql-check" and "ssl-hello-chk" options. Please
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010012478 refer to those options and parameters for more information. See also
12479 "no-check" option.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010012480
Willy Tarreau6c16adc2012-10-05 00:04:16 +020012481check-send-proxy
12482 This option forces emission of a PROXY protocol line with outgoing health
12483 checks, regardless of whether the server uses send-proxy or not for the
12484 normal traffic. By default, the PROXY protocol is enabled for health checks
12485 if it is already enabled for normal traffic and if no "port" nor "addr"
12486 directive is present. However, if such a directive is present, the
12487 "check-send-proxy" option needs to be used to force the use of the
12488 protocol. See also the "send-proxy" option for more information.
12489
Olivier Houchard92150142018-12-21 19:47:01 +010012490check-alpn <protocols>
12491 Defines which protocols to advertise with ALPN. The protocol list consists in
12492 a comma-delimited list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0"
12493 (without quotes). If it is not set, the server ALPN is used.
12494
Jérôme Magninae9bb762018-12-09 16:08:26 +010012495check-sni <sni>
Olivier Houchard9130a962017-10-17 17:33:43 +020012496 This option allows you to specify the SNI to be used when doing health checks
Jérôme Magninae9bb762018-12-09 16:08:26 +010012497 over SSL. It is only possible to use a string to set <sni>. If you want to
12498 set a SNI for proxied traffic, see "sni".
Olivier Houchard9130a962017-10-17 17:33:43 +020012499
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020012500check-ssl
12501 This option forces encryption of all health checks over SSL, regardless of
12502 whether the server uses SSL or not for the normal traffic. This is generally
12503 used when an explicit "port" or "addr" directive is specified and SSL health
12504 checks are not inherited. It is important to understand that this option
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030012505 inserts an SSL transport layer below the checks, so that a simple TCP connect
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020012506 check becomes an SSL connect, which replaces the old ssl-hello-chk. The most
12507 common use is to send HTTPS checks by combining "httpchk" with SSL checks.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012508 All SSL settings are common to health checks and traffic (e.g. ciphers).
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010012509 See the "ssl" option for more information and "no-check-ssl" to disable
12510 this option.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020012511
Alexander Liu2a54bb72019-05-22 19:44:48 +080012512check-via-socks4
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050012513 This option enables outgoing health checks using upstream socks4 proxy. By
Alexander Liu2a54bb72019-05-22 19:44:48 +080012514 default, the health checks won't go through socks tunnel even it was enabled
12515 for normal traffic.
12516
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020012517ciphers <ciphers>
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +020012518 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. This
12519 option sets the string describing the list of cipher algorithms that is
12520 negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake with the server. The format of the
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +000012521 string is defined in "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages. For background
12522 information and recommendations see e.g.
12523 (https://wiki.mozilla.org/Security/Server_Side_TLS) and
12524 (https://mozilla.github.io/server-side-tls/ssl-config-generator/). For TLSv1.3
12525 cipher configuration, please check the "ciphersuites" keyword.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020012526
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +020012527ciphersuites <ciphersuites>
12528 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in and
12529 OpenSSL 1.1.1 or later was used to build HAProxy. This option sets the string
12530 describing the list of cipher algorithms that is negotiated during the TLS
12531 1.3 handshake with the server. The format of the string is defined in
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +000012532 "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages under the "ciphersuites" section.
12533 For cipher configuration for TLSv1.2 and earlier, please check the "ciphers"
12534 keyword.
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +020012535
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012536cookie <value>
12537 The "cookie" parameter sets the cookie value assigned to the server to
12538 <value>. This value will be checked in incoming requests, and the first
12539 operational server possessing the same value will be selected. In return, in
12540 cookie insertion or rewrite modes, this value will be assigned to the cookie
12541 sent to the client. There is nothing wrong in having several servers sharing
12542 the same cookie value, and it is in fact somewhat common between normal and
12543 backup servers. See also the "cookie" keyword in backend section.
12544
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +020012545crl-file <crlfile>
12546 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
12547 designates a PEM file from which to load certificate revocation list used
12548 to verify server's certificate.
12549
Emeric Bruna7aa3092012-10-26 12:58:00 +020012550crt <cert>
12551 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in.
12552 It designates a PEM file from which to load both a certificate and the
12553 associated private key. This file can be built by concatenating both PEM
12554 files into one. This certificate will be sent if the server send a client
12555 certificate request.
12556
Willy Tarreau96839092010-03-29 10:02:24 +020012557disabled
12558 The "disabled" keyword starts the server in the "disabled" state. That means
12559 that it is marked down in maintenance mode, and no connection other than the
12560 ones allowed by persist mode will reach it. It is very well suited to setup
12561 new servers, because normal traffic will never reach them, while it is still
12562 possible to test the service by making use of the force-persist mechanism.
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010012563 See also "enabled" setting.
Willy Tarreau96839092010-03-29 10:02:24 +020012564
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010012565enabled
12566 This option may be used as 'server' setting to reset any 'disabled'
12567 setting which would have been inherited from 'default-server' directive as
12568 default value.
12569 It may also be used as 'default-server' setting to reset any previous
12570 'default-server' 'disabled' setting.
Willy Tarreau96839092010-03-29 10:02:24 +020012571
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010012572error-limit <count>
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +010012573 If health observing is enabled, the "error-limit" parameter specifies the
12574 number of consecutive errors that triggers event selected by the "on-error"
12575 option. By default it is set to 10 consecutive errors.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010012576
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010012577 See also the "check", "error-limit" and "on-error".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010012578
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010012579fall <count>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012580 The "fall" parameter states that a server will be considered as dead after
12581 <count> consecutive unsuccessful health checks. This value defaults to 3 if
12582 unspecified. See also the "check", "inter" and "rise" parameters.
12583
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020012584force-sslv3
12585 This option enforces use of SSLv3 only when SSL is used to communicate with
12586 the server. SSLv3 is generally less expensive than the TLS counterparts for
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010012587 high connection rates. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020012588 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020012589
12590force-tlsv10
12591 This option enforces use of TLSv1.0 only when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010012592 the server. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020012593 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020012594
12595force-tlsv11
12596 This option enforces use of TLSv1.1 only when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010012597 the server. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020012598 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020012599
12600force-tlsv12
12601 This option enforces use of TLSv1.2 only when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010012602 the server. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020012603 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020012604
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020012605force-tlsv13
12606 This option enforces use of TLSv1.3 only when SSL is used to communicate with
12607 the server. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020012608 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and ssl-max-ver".
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020012609
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012610id <value>
Willy Tarreau53fb4ae2009-10-04 23:04:08 +020012611 Set a persistent ID for the server. This ID must be positive and unique for
12612 the proxy. An unused ID will automatically be assigned if unset. The first
12613 assigned value will be 1. This ID is currently only returned in statistics.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012614
Willy Tarreau6a031d12016-11-07 19:42:35 +010012615init-addr {last | libc | none | <ip>},[...]*
12616 Indicate in what order the server's address should be resolved upon startup
12617 if it uses an FQDN. Attempts are made to resolve the address by applying in
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012618 turn each of the methods mentioned in the comma-delimited list. The first
Willy Tarreau6a031d12016-11-07 19:42:35 +010012619 method which succeeds is used. If the end of the list is reached without
12620 finding a working method, an error is thrown. Method "last" suggests to pick
12621 the address which appears in the state file (see "server-state-file"). Method
12622 "libc" uses the libc's internal resolver (gethostbyname() or getaddrinfo()
12623 depending on the operating system and build options). Method "none"
12624 specifically indicates that the server should start without any valid IP
12625 address in a down state. It can be useful to ignore some DNS issues upon
12626 startup, waiting for the situation to get fixed later. Finally, an IP address
12627 (IPv4 or IPv6) may be provided. It can be the currently known address of the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012628 server (e.g. filled by a configuration generator), or the address of a dummy
Willy Tarreau6a031d12016-11-07 19:42:35 +010012629 server used to catch old sessions and present them with a decent error
12630 message for example. When the "first" load balancing algorithm is used, this
12631 IP address could point to a fake server used to trigger the creation of new
12632 instances on the fly. This option defaults to "last,libc" indicating that the
12633 previous address found in the state file (if any) is used first, otherwise
12634 the libc's resolver is used. This ensures continued compatibility with the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012635 historic behavior.
Willy Tarreau6a031d12016-11-07 19:42:35 +010012636
12637 Example:
12638 defaults
12639 # never fail on address resolution
12640 default-server init-addr last,libc,none
12641
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010012642inter <delay>
12643fastinter <delay>
12644downinter <delay>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012645 The "inter" parameter sets the interval between two consecutive health checks
12646 to <delay> milliseconds. If left unspecified, the delay defaults to 2000 ms.
12647 It is also possible to use "fastinter" and "downinter" to optimize delays
12648 between checks depending on the server state :
12649
Pieter Baauw44fc9df2015-09-17 21:30:46 +020012650 Server state | Interval used
12651 ----------------------------------------+----------------------------------
12652 UP 100% (non-transitional) | "inter"
12653 ----------------------------------------+----------------------------------
12654 Transitionally UP (going down "fall"), | "fastinter" if set,
12655 Transitionally DOWN (going up "rise"), | "inter" otherwise.
12656 or yet unchecked. |
12657 ----------------------------------------+----------------------------------
12658 DOWN 100% (non-transitional) | "downinter" if set,
12659 | "inter" otherwise.
12660 ----------------------------------------+----------------------------------
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010012661
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012662 Just as with every other time-based parameter, they can be entered in any
12663 other explicit unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }. The "inter" parameter also
12664 serves as a timeout for health checks sent to servers if "timeout check" is
12665 not set. In order to reduce "resonance" effects when multiple servers are
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090012666 hosted on the same hardware, the agent and health checks of all servers
12667 are started with a small time offset between them. It is also possible to
12668 add some random noise in the agent and health checks interval using the
12669 global "spread-checks" keyword. This makes sense for instance when a lot
12670 of backends use the same servers.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012671
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010012672maxconn <maxconn>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012673 The "maxconn" parameter specifies the maximal number of concurrent
12674 connections that will be sent to this server. If the number of incoming
Tim Duesterhuscefbbd92019-11-27 22:35:27 +010012675 concurrent connections goes higher than this value, they will be queued,
12676 waiting for a slot to be released. This parameter is very important as it can
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012677 save fragile servers from going down under extreme loads. If a "minconn"
12678 parameter is specified, the limit becomes dynamic. The default value is "0"
12679 which means unlimited. See also the "minconn" and "maxqueue" parameters, and
12680 the backend's "fullconn" keyword.
12681
Tim Duesterhuscefbbd92019-11-27 22:35:27 +010012682 In HTTP mode this parameter limits the number of concurrent requests instead
12683 of the number of connections. Multiple requests might be multiplexed over a
12684 single TCP connection to the server. As an example if you specify a maxconn
12685 of 50 you might see between 1 and 50 actual server connections, but no more
12686 than 50 concurrent requests.
12687
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010012688maxqueue <maxqueue>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012689 The "maxqueue" parameter specifies the maximal number of connections which
12690 will wait in the queue for this server. If this limit is reached, next
12691 requests will be redispatched to other servers instead of indefinitely
12692 waiting to be served. This will break persistence but may allow people to
12693 quickly re-log in when the server they try to connect to is dying. The
12694 default value is "0" which means the queue is unlimited. See also the
12695 "maxconn" and "minconn" parameters.
12696
Willy Tarreau9c538e02019-01-23 10:21:49 +010012697max-reuse <count>
12698 The "max-reuse" argument indicates the HTTP connection processors that they
12699 should not reuse a server connection more than this number of times to send
12700 new requests. Permitted values are -1 (the default), which disables this
12701 limit, or any positive value. Value zero will effectively disable keep-alive.
12702 This is only used to work around certain server bugs which cause them to leak
12703 resources over time. The argument is not necessarily respected by the lower
12704 layers as there might be technical limitations making it impossible to
12705 enforce. At least HTTP/2 connections to servers will respect it.
12706
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010012707minconn <minconn>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012708 When the "minconn" parameter is set, the maxconn limit becomes a dynamic
12709 limit following the backend's load. The server will always accept at least
12710 <minconn> connections, never more than <maxconn>, and the limit will be on
12711 the ramp between both values when the backend has less than <fullconn>
12712 concurrent connections. This makes it possible to limit the load on the
12713 server during normal loads, but push it further for important loads without
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010012714 overloading the server during exceptional loads. See also the "maxconn"
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012715 and "maxqueue" parameters, as well as the "fullconn" backend keyword.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010012716
Willy Tarreaud72f0f32015-10-13 14:50:22 +020012717namespace <name>
12718 On Linux, it is possible to specify which network namespace a socket will
12719 belong to. This directive makes it possible to explicitly bind a server to
12720 a namespace different from the default one. Please refer to your operating
12721 system's documentation to find more details about network namespaces.
12722
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010012723no-agent-check
12724 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "agent-check"
12725 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
12726 default value.
12727 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
12728 "default-server" "agent-check" setting.
12729
12730no-backup
12731 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "backup"
12732 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
12733 default value.
12734 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
12735 "default-server" "backup" setting.
12736
12737no-check
12738 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "check"
12739 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
12740 default value.
12741 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
12742 "default-server" "check" setting.
12743
12744no-check-ssl
12745 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "check-ssl"
12746 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
12747 default value.
12748 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
12749 "default-server" "check-ssl" setting.
12750
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010012751no-send-proxy
12752 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "send-proxy"
12753 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
12754 default value.
12755 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
12756 "default-server" "send-proxy" setting.
12757
12758no-send-proxy-v2
12759 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "send-proxy-v2"
12760 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
12761 default value.
12762 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
12763 "default-server" "send-proxy-v2" setting.
12764
12765no-send-proxy-v2-ssl
12766 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "send-proxy-v2-ssl"
12767 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
12768 default value.
12769 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
12770 "default-server" "send-proxy-v2-ssl" setting.
12771
12772no-send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn
12773 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn"
12774 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
12775 default value.
12776 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
12777 "default-server" "send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn" setting.
12778
12779no-ssl
12780 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "ssl"
12781 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
12782 default value.
12783 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
12784 "default-server" "ssl" setting.
12785
Willy Tarreau2a3fb1c2015-02-05 16:47:07 +010012786no-ssl-reuse
12787 This option disables SSL session reuse when SSL is used to communicate with
12788 the server. It will force the server to perform a full handshake for every
12789 new connection. It's probably only useful for benchmarking, troubleshooting,
12790 and for paranoid users.
12791
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020012792no-sslv3
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020012793 This option disables support for SSLv3 when SSL is used to communicate with
12794 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020012795 using any configuration option. Use "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020012796
Emmanuel Hocdet6cb2d1e2017-03-30 14:43:31 +020012797 Supported in default-server: No
12798
Emeric Brunf9c5c472012-10-11 15:28:34 +020012799no-tls-tickets
12800 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
12801 disables the stateless session resumption (RFC 5077 TLS Ticket
12802 extension) and force to use stateful session resumption. Stateless
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010012803 session resumption is more expensive in CPU usage for servers. This option
12804 is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Lukas Tribusbdb386d2020-03-10 00:56:09 +010012805 The TLS ticket mechanism is only used up to TLS 1.2.
12806 Forward Secrecy is compromised with TLS tickets, unless ticket keys
12807 are periodically rotated (via reload or by using "tls-ticket-keys").
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010012808 See also "tls-tickets".
Emeric Brunf9c5c472012-10-11 15:28:34 +020012809
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020012810no-tlsv10
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020012811 This option disables support for TLSv1.0 when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020012812 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
12813 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010012814 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. This
12815 option is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020012816 Use "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020012817
Emmanuel Hocdet6cb2d1e2017-03-30 14:43:31 +020012818 Supported in default-server: No
12819
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020012820no-tlsv11
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020012821 This option disables support for TLSv1.1 when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020012822 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
12823 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010012824 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. This
12825 option is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020012826 Use "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020012827
Emmanuel Hocdet6cb2d1e2017-03-30 14:43:31 +020012828 Supported in default-server: No
12829
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020012830no-tlsv12
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020012831 This option disables support for TLSv1.2 when SSL is used to communicate with
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020012832 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
12833 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010012834 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. This
12835 option is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020012836 Use "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020012837
12838 Supported in default-server: No
12839
12840no-tlsv13
12841 This option disables support for TLSv1.3 when SSL is used to communicate with
12842 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
12843 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
12844 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. This
12845 option is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020012846 Use "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020012847
Emmanuel Hocdet6cb2d1e2017-03-30 14:43:31 +020012848 Supported in default-server: No
12849
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010012850no-verifyhost
12851 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "verifyhost"
12852 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
12853 default value.
12854 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
12855 "default-server" "verifyhost" setting.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020012856
Frédéric Lécaille1b9423d2019-07-04 14:19:06 +020012857no-tfo
12858 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "tfo"
12859 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
12860 default value.
12861 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
12862 "default-server" "tfo" setting.
12863
Simon Hormanfa461682011-06-25 09:39:49 +090012864non-stick
12865 Never add connections allocated to this sever to a stick-table.
12866 This may be used in conjunction with backup to ensure that
12867 stick-table persistence is disabled for backup servers.
12868
Olivier Houchardc7566002018-11-20 23:33:50 +010012869npn <protocols>
12870 This enables the NPN TLS extension and advertises the specified protocol list
12871 as supported on top of NPN. The protocol list consists in a comma-delimited
12872 list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without quotes).
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050012873 This requires that the SSL library is built with support for TLS extensions
Olivier Houchardc7566002018-11-20 23:33:50 +010012874 enabled (check with haproxy -vv). Note that the NPN extension has been
12875 replaced with the ALPN extension (see the "alpn" keyword), though this one is
12876 only available starting with OpenSSL 1.0.2.
12877
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010012878observe <mode>
12879 This option enables health adjusting based on observing communication with
12880 the server. By default this functionality is disabled and enabling it also
12881 requires to enable health checks. There are two supported modes: "layer4" and
12882 "layer7". In layer4 mode, only successful/unsuccessful tcp connections are
12883 significant. In layer7, which is only allowed for http proxies, responses
12884 received from server are verified, like valid/wrong http code, unparsable
Willy Tarreau150d1462012-03-10 08:19:02 +010012885 headers, a timeout, etc. Valid status codes include 100 to 499, 501 and 505.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010012886
12887 See also the "check", "on-error" and "error-limit".
12888
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010012889on-error <mode>
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010012890 Select what should happen when enough consecutive errors are detected.
12891 Currently, four modes are available:
12892 - fastinter: force fastinter
12893 - fail-check: simulate a failed check, also forces fastinter (default)
12894 - sudden-death: simulate a pre-fatal failed health check, one more failed
12895 check will mark a server down, forces fastinter
12896 - mark-down: mark the server immediately down and force fastinter
12897
12898 See also the "check", "observe" and "error-limit".
12899
Simon Hormane0d1bfb2011-06-21 14:34:58 +090012900on-marked-down <action>
12901 Modify what occurs when a server is marked down.
12902 Currently one action is available:
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -070012903 - shutdown-sessions: Shutdown peer sessions. When this setting is enabled,
12904 all connections to the server are immediately terminated when the server
12905 goes down. It might be used if the health check detects more complex cases
12906 than a simple connection status, and long timeouts would cause the service
12907 to remain unresponsive for too long a time. For instance, a health check
12908 might detect that a database is stuck and that there's no chance to reuse
12909 existing connections anymore. Connections killed this way are logged with
12910 a 'D' termination code (for "Down").
Simon Hormane0d1bfb2011-06-21 14:34:58 +090012911
12912 Actions are disabled by default
12913
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -070012914on-marked-up <action>
12915 Modify what occurs when a server is marked up.
12916 Currently one action is available:
12917 - shutdown-backup-sessions: Shutdown sessions on all backup servers. This is
12918 done only if the server is not in backup state and if it is not disabled
12919 (it must have an effective weight > 0). This can be used sometimes to force
12920 an active server to take all the traffic back after recovery when dealing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012921 with long sessions (e.g. LDAP, SQL, ...). Doing this can cause more trouble
12922 than it tries to solve (e.g. incomplete transactions), so use this feature
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -070012923 with extreme care. Sessions killed because a server comes up are logged
12924 with an 'U' termination code (for "Up").
12925
12926 Actions are disabled by default
12927
Olivier Houchard006e3102018-12-10 18:30:32 +010012928pool-max-conn <max>
12929 Set the maximum number of idling connections for a server. -1 means unlimited
12930 connections, 0 means no idle connections. The default is -1. When idle
12931 connections are enabled, orphaned idle connections which do not belong to any
12932 client session anymore are moved to a dedicated pool so that they remain
12933 usable by future clients. This only applies to connections that can be shared
12934 according to the same principles as those applying to "http-reuse".
12935
Olivier Houchardb7b3faa2018-12-14 18:15:36 +010012936pool-purge-delay <delay>
12937 Sets the delay to start purging idle connections. Each <delay> interval, half
Olivier Houcharda56eebf2019-03-19 16:44:02 +010012938 of the idle connections are closed. 0 means we don't keep any idle connection.
Willy Tarreaufb553652019-06-04 14:06:31 +020012939 The default is 5s.
Olivier Houchardb7b3faa2018-12-14 18:15:36 +010012940
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010012941port <port>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012942 Using the "port" parameter, it becomes possible to use a different port to
12943 send health-checks. On some servers, it may be desirable to dedicate a port
12944 to a specific component able to perform complex tests which are more suitable
12945 to health-checks than the application. It is common to run a simple script in
12946 inetd for instance. This parameter is ignored if the "check" parameter is not
12947 set. See also the "addr" parameter.
12948
Christopher Faulet8ed0a3e2018-04-10 14:45:45 +020012949proto <name>
12950
12951 Forces the multiplexer's protocol to use for the outgoing connections to this
12952 server. It must be compatible with the mode of the backend (TCP or HTTP). It
12953 must also be usable on the backend side. The list of available protocols is
12954 reported in haproxy -vv.
12955 Idea behind this optipon is to bypass the selection of the best multiplexer's
12956 protocol for all connections established to this server.
12957
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012958redir <prefix>
12959 The "redir" parameter enables the redirection mode for all GET and HEAD
12960 requests addressing this server. This means that instead of having HAProxy
12961 forward the request to the server, it will send an "HTTP 302" response with
12962 the "Location" header composed of this prefix immediately followed by the
12963 requested URI beginning at the leading '/' of the path component. That means
12964 that no trailing slash should be used after <prefix>. All invalid requests
12965 will be rejected, and all non-GET or HEAD requests will be normally served by
12966 the server. Note that since the response is completely forged, no header
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010012967 mangling nor cookie insertion is possible in the response. However, cookies in
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012968 requests are still analyzed, making this solution completely usable to direct
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012969 users to a remote location in case of local disaster. Main use consists in
12970 increasing bandwidth for static servers by having the clients directly
12971 connect to them. Note: never use a relative location here, it would cause a
12972 loop between the client and HAProxy!
12973
12974 Example : server srv1 192.168.1.1:80 redir http://image1.mydomain.com check
12975
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010012976rise <count>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012977 The "rise" parameter states that a server will be considered as operational
12978 after <count> consecutive successful health checks. This value defaults to 2
12979 if unspecified. See also the "check", "inter" and "fall" parameters.
12980
Baptiste Assmann8e2d9432018-06-22 15:04:43 +020012981resolve-opts <option>,<option>,...
12982 Comma separated list of options to apply to DNS resolution linked to this
12983 server.
12984
12985 Available options:
12986
12987 * allow-dup-ip
12988 By default, HAProxy prevents IP address duplication in a backend when DNS
12989 resolution at runtime is in operation.
12990 That said, for some cases, it makes sense that two servers (in the same
12991 backend, being resolved by the same FQDN) have the same IP address.
12992 For such case, simply enable this option.
12993 This is the opposite of prevent-dup-ip.
12994
Daniel Corbettf8716912019-11-17 09:48:56 -050012995 * ignore-weight
12996 Ignore any weight that is set within an SRV record. This is useful when
12997 you would like to control the weights using an alternate method, such as
12998 using an "agent-check" or through the runtime api.
12999
Baptiste Assmann8e2d9432018-06-22 15:04:43 +020013000 * prevent-dup-ip
13001 Ensure HAProxy's default behavior is enforced on a server: prevent re-using
13002 an IP address already set to a server in the same backend and sharing the
13003 same fqdn.
13004 This is the opposite of allow-dup-ip.
13005
13006 Example:
13007 backend b_myapp
13008 default-server init-addr none resolvers dns
13009 server s1 myapp.example.com:80 check resolve-opts allow-dup-ip
13010 server s2 myapp.example.com:81 check resolve-opts allow-dup-ip
13011
13012 With the option allow-dup-ip set:
13013 * if the nameserver returns a single IP address, then both servers will use
13014 it
13015 * If the nameserver returns 2 IP addresses, then each server will pick up a
13016 different address
13017
13018 Default value: not set
13019
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020013020resolve-prefer <family>
13021 When DNS resolution is enabled for a server and multiple IP addresses from
13022 different families are returned, HAProxy will prefer using an IP address
13023 from the family mentioned in the "resolve-prefer" parameter.
13024 Available families: "ipv4" and "ipv6"
13025
Baptiste Assmannc4aabae2015-08-04 22:43:06 +020013026 Default value: ipv6
13027
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020013028 Example:
13029
13030 server s1 app1.domain.com:80 resolvers mydns resolve-prefer ipv6
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020013031
Thierry Fournierac88cfe2016-02-17 22:05:30 +010013032resolve-net <network>[,<network[,...]]
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050013033 This option prioritizes the choice of an ip address matching a network. This is
Thierry Fournierac88cfe2016-02-17 22:05:30 +010013034 useful with clouds to prefer a local ip. In some cases, a cloud high
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010013035 availability service can be announced with many ip addresses on many
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013036 different datacenters. The latency between datacenter is not negligible, so
13037 this patch permits to prefer a local datacenter. If no address matches the
Thierry Fournierac88cfe2016-02-17 22:05:30 +010013038 configured network, another address is selected.
13039
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020013040 Example:
13041
13042 server s1 app1.domain.com:80 resolvers mydns resolve-net 10.0.0.0/8
Thierry Fournierac88cfe2016-02-17 22:05:30 +010013043
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020013044resolvers <id>
13045 Points to an existing "resolvers" section to resolve current server's
13046 hostname.
13047
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020013048 Example:
13049
13050 server s1 app1.domain.com:80 check resolvers mydns
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020013051
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020013052 See also section 5.3
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020013053
Willy Tarreau5ab04ec2011-03-20 10:32:26 +010013054send-proxy
13055 The "send-proxy" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol over any
13056 connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs the other
13057 end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so that it can
13058 know the client's address or the public address it accessed to, whatever the
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010013059 upper layer protocol. For connections accepted by an "accept-proxy" or
13060 "accept-netscaler-cip" listener, the advertised address will be used. Only
13061 TCPv4 and TCPv6 address families are supported. Other families such as
13062 Unix sockets, will report an UNKNOWN family. Servers using this option can
13063 fully be chained to another instance of haproxy listening with an
13064 "accept-proxy" setting. This setting must not be used if the server isn't
13065 aware of the protocol. When health checks are sent to the server, the PROXY
13066 protocol is automatically used when this option is set, unless there is an
13067 explicit "port" or "addr" directive, in which case an explicit
13068 "check-send-proxy" directive would also be needed to use the PROXY protocol.
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010013069 See also the "no-send-proxy" option of this section and "accept-proxy" and
13070 "accept-netscaler-cip" option of the "bind" keyword.
Willy Tarreau5ab04ec2011-03-20 10:32:26 +010013071
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040013072send-proxy-v2
13073 The "send-proxy-v2" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol version 2
13074 over any connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs
13075 the other end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so
13076 that it can know the client's address or the public address it accessed to,
Emmanuel Hocdet404d9782017-10-24 10:55:14 +020013077 whatever the upper layer protocol. It also send ALPN information if an alpn
13078 have been negotiated. This setting must not be used if the server isn't aware
13079 of this version of the protocol. See also the "no-send-proxy-v2" option of
13080 this section and send-proxy" option of the "bind" keyword.
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040013081
Emmanuel Hocdetf643b802018-02-01 15:20:32 +010013082proxy-v2-options <option>[,<option>]*
Tim Duesterhuscf6e0c82020-03-13 12:34:24 +010013083 The "proxy-v2-options" parameter add options to send in PROXY protocol
13084 version 2 when "send-proxy-v2" is used. Options available are:
13085
13086 - ssl : See also "send-proxy-v2-ssl".
13087 - cert-cn : See also "send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn".
13088 - ssl-cipher: Name of the used cipher.
13089 - cert-sig : Signature algorithm of the used certificate.
13090 - cert-key : Key algorithm of the used certificate
13091 - authority : Host name value passed by the client (only SNI from a TLS
13092 connection is supported).
13093 - crc32c : Checksum of the PROXYv2 header.
13094 - unique-id : Send a unique ID generated using the frontend's
13095 "unique-id-format" within the PROXYv2 header.
13096 This unique-id is primarily meant for "mode tcp". It can
13097 lead to unexpected results in "mode http", because the
13098 generated unique ID is also used for the first HTTP request
13099 within a Keep-Alive connection.
Emmanuel Hocdetf643b802018-02-01 15:20:32 +010013100
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040013101send-proxy-v2-ssl
13102 The "send-proxy-v2-ssl" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol version
13103 2 over any connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs
13104 the other end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so
13105 that it can know the client's address or the public address it accessed to,
13106 whatever the upper layer protocol. In addition, the SSL information extension
13107 of the PROXY protocol is added to the PROXY protocol header. This setting
13108 must not be used if the server isn't aware of this version of the protocol.
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010013109 See also the "no-send-proxy-v2-ssl" option of this section and the
13110 "send-proxy-v2" option of the "bind" keyword.
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040013111
13112send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn
13113 The "send-proxy-v2-ssl" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol version
13114 2 over any connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs
13115 the other end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so
13116 that it can know the client's address or the public address it accessed to,
13117 whatever the upper layer protocol. In addition, the SSL information extension
13118 of the PROXY protocol, along along with the Common Name from the subject of
13119 the client certificate (if any), is added to the PROXY protocol header. This
13120 setting must not be used if the server isn't aware of this version of the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013121 protocol. See also the "no-send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn" option of this section and
13122 the "send-proxy-v2" option of the "bind" keyword.
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040013123
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010013124slowstart <start_time_in_ms>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013125 The "slowstart" parameter for a server accepts a value in milliseconds which
13126 indicates after how long a server which has just come back up will run at
13127 full speed. Just as with every other time-based parameter, it can be entered
13128 in any other explicit unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }. The speed grows
13129 linearly from 0 to 100% during this time. The limitation applies to two
13130 parameters :
13131
13132 - maxconn: the number of connections accepted by the server will grow from 1
13133 to 100% of the usual dynamic limit defined by (minconn,maxconn,fullconn).
13134
13135 - weight: when the backend uses a dynamic weighted algorithm, the weight
13136 grows linearly from 1 to 100%. In this case, the weight is updated at every
13137 health-check. For this reason, it is important that the "inter" parameter
13138 is smaller than the "slowstart", in order to maximize the number of steps.
13139
13140 The slowstart never applies when haproxy starts, otherwise it would cause
13141 trouble to running servers. It only applies when a server has been previously
13142 seen as failed.
13143
Willy Tarreau732eac42015-07-09 11:40:25 +020013144sni <expression>
13145 The "sni" parameter evaluates the sample fetch expression, converts it to a
13146 string and uses the result as the host name sent in the SNI TLS extension to
13147 the server. A typical use case is to send the SNI received from the client in
13148 a bridged HTTPS scenario, using the "ssl_fc_sni" sample fetch for the
Willy Tarreau2ab88672017-07-05 18:23:03 +020013149 expression, though alternatives such as req.hdr(host) can also make sense. If
13150 "verify required" is set (which is the recommended setting), the resulting
Willy Tarreauad92a9a2017-07-28 11:38:41 +020013151 name will also be matched against the server certificate's names. See the
Jérôme Magninb36a6d22018-12-09 16:03:40 +010013152 "verify" directive for more details. If you want to set a SNI for health
13153 checks, see the "check-sni" directive for more details.
Willy Tarreau732eac42015-07-09 11:40:25 +020013154
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +020013155source <addr>[:<pl>[-<ph>]] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | client | clientip } ]
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +020013156source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | hdr_ip(<hdr>[,<occ>]) } ]
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +020013157source <addr>[:<pl>[-<ph>]] [interface <name>] ...
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013158 The "source" parameter sets the source address which will be used when
13159 connecting to the server. It follows the exact same parameters and principle
13160 as the backend "source" keyword, except that it only applies to the server
13161 referencing it. Please consult the "source" keyword for details.
13162
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +020013163 Additionally, the "source" statement on a server line allows one to specify a
13164 source port range by indicating the lower and higher bounds delimited by a
13165 dash ('-'). Some operating systems might require a valid IP address when a
13166 source port range is specified. It is permitted to have the same IP/range for
13167 several servers. Doing so makes it possible to bypass the maximum of 64k
13168 total concurrent connections. The limit will then reach 64k connections per
13169 server.
13170
Lukas Tribus7d56c6d2016-09-13 09:51:15 +000013171 Since Linux 4.2/libc 2.23 IP_BIND_ADDRESS_NO_PORT is set for connections
13172 specifying the source address without port(s).
13173
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020013174ssl
Willy Tarreau44f65392013-06-25 07:56:20 +020013175 This option enables SSL ciphering on outgoing connections to the server. It
13176 is critical to verify server certificates using "verify" when using SSL to
13177 connect to servers, otherwise the communication is prone to trivial man in
13178 the-middle attacks rendering SSL useless. When this option is used, health
13179 checks are automatically sent in SSL too unless there is a "port" or an
13180 "addr" directive indicating the check should be sent to a different location.
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010013181 See the "no-ssl" to disable "ssl" option and "check-ssl" option to force
13182 SSL health checks.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020013183
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013184ssl-max-ver [ SSLv3 | TLSv1.0 | TLSv1.1 | TLSv1.2 | TLSv1.3 ]
13185 This option enforces use of <version> or lower when SSL is used to communicate
13186 with the server. This option is also available on global statement
13187 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver".
13188
13189ssl-min-ver [ SSLv3 | TLSv1.0 | TLSv1.1 | TLSv1.2 | TLSv1.3 ]
13190 This option enforces use of <version> or upper when SSL is used to communicate
13191 with the server. This option is also available on global statement
13192 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-max-ver".
13193
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010013194ssl-reuse
13195 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "no-ssl-reuse"
13196 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
13197 default value.
13198 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
13199 "default-server" "no-ssl-reuse" setting.
13200
13201stick
13202 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "non-stick"
13203 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
13204 default value.
13205 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
13206 "default-server" "non-stick" setting.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020013207
Alexander Liu2a54bb72019-05-22 19:44:48 +080013208socks4 <addr>:<port>
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050013209 This option enables upstream socks4 tunnel for outgoing connections to the
Alexander Liu2a54bb72019-05-22 19:44:48 +080013210 server. Using this option won't force the health check to go via socks4 by
13211 default. You will have to use the keyword "check-via-socks4" to enable it.
13212
Willy Tarreau163d4622015-10-13 16:16:41 +020013213tcp-ut <delay>
13214 Sets the TCP User Timeout for all outgoing connections to this server. This
13215 option is available on Linux since version 2.6.37. It allows haproxy to
13216 configure a timeout for sockets which contain data not receiving an
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013217 acknowledgment for the configured delay. This is especially useful on
Willy Tarreau163d4622015-10-13 16:16:41 +020013218 long-lived connections experiencing long idle periods such as remote
13219 terminals or database connection pools, where the client and server timeouts
13220 must remain high to allow a long period of idle, but where it is important to
13221 detect that the server has disappeared in order to release all resources
13222 associated with its connection (and the client's session). One typical use
13223 case is also to force dead server connections to die when health checks are
13224 too slow or during a soft reload since health checks are then disabled. The
13225 argument is a delay expressed in milliseconds by default. This only works for
13226 regular TCP connections, and is ignored for other protocols.
13227
Willy Tarreau034c88c2017-01-23 23:36:45 +010013228tfo
13229 This option enables using TCP fast open when connecting to servers, on
13230 systems that support it (currently only the Linux kernel >= 4.11).
13231 See the "tfo" bind option for more information about TCP fast open.
13232 Please note that when using tfo, you should also use the "conn-failure",
13233 "empty-response" and "response-timeout" keywords for "retry-on", or haproxy
Frédéric Lécaille1b9423d2019-07-04 14:19:06 +020013234 won't be able to retry the connection on failure. See also "no-tfo".
Willy Tarreau034c88c2017-01-23 23:36:45 +010013235
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013236track [<proxy>/]<server>
Willy Tarreau32091232014-05-16 13:52:00 +020013237 This option enables ability to set the current state of the server by tracking
13238 another one. It is possible to track a server which itself tracks another
13239 server, provided that at the end of the chain, a server has health checks
13240 enabled. If <proxy> is omitted the current one is used. If disable-on-404 is
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013241 used, it has to be enabled on both proxies.
13242
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010013243tls-tickets
13244 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "no-tls-tickets"
13245 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
13246 default value.
Lukas Tribusbdb386d2020-03-10 00:56:09 +010013247 The TLS ticket mechanism is only used up to TLS 1.2.
13248 Forward Secrecy is compromised with TLS tickets, unless ticket keys
13249 are periodically rotated (via reload or by using "tls-ticket-keys").
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010013250 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
Bjoern Jacke5ab7eb62020-02-13 14:16:16 +010013251 "default-server" "no-tls-tickets" setting.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010013252
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +020013253verify [none|required]
13254 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. If set
Emeric Brun850efd52014-01-29 12:24:34 +010013255 to 'none', server certificate is not verified. In the other case, The
Willy Tarreauad92a9a2017-07-28 11:38:41 +020013256 certificate provided by the server is verified using CAs from 'ca-file' and
13257 optional CRLs from 'crl-file' after having checked that the names provided in
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013258 the certificate's subject and subjectAlternateNames attributes match either
Willy Tarreauad92a9a2017-07-28 11:38:41 +020013259 the name passed using the "sni" directive, or if not provided, the static
13260 host name passed using the "verifyhost" directive. When no name is found, the
13261 certificate's names are ignored. For this reason, without SNI it's important
13262 to use "verifyhost". On verification failure the handshake is aborted. It is
13263 critically important to verify server certificates when using SSL to connect
13264 to servers, otherwise the communication is prone to trivial man-in-the-middle
13265 attacks rendering SSL totally useless. Unless "ssl_server_verify" appears in
13266 the global section, "verify" is set to "required" by default.
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +020013267
Evan Broderbe554312013-06-27 00:05:25 -070013268verifyhost <hostname>
13269 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in, and
Willy Tarreauad92a9a2017-07-28 11:38:41 +020013270 only takes effect if 'verify required' is also specified. This directive sets
13271 a default static hostname to check the server's certificate against when no
13272 SNI was used to connect to the server. If SNI is not used, this is the only
13273 way to enable hostname verification. This static hostname, when set, will
13274 also be used for health checks (which cannot provide an SNI value). If none
13275 of the hostnames in the certificate match the specified hostname, the
13276 handshake is aborted. The hostnames in the server-provided certificate may
13277 include wildcards. See also "verify", "sni" and "no-verifyhost" options.
Evan Broderbe554312013-06-27 00:05:25 -070013278
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010013279weight <weight>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013280 The "weight" parameter is used to adjust the server's weight relative to
13281 other servers. All servers will receive a load proportional to their weight
13282 relative to the sum of all weights, so the higher the weight, the higher the
Willy Tarreau6704d672009-06-15 10:56:05 +020013283 load. The default weight is 1, and the maximal value is 256. A value of 0
13284 means the server will not participate in load-balancing but will still accept
13285 persistent connections. If this parameter is used to distribute the load
13286 according to server's capacity, it is recommended to start with values which
13287 can both grow and shrink, for instance between 10 and 100 to leave enough
13288 room above and below for later adjustments.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013289
13290
Cyril Bonté46175dd2015-07-02 22:45:32 +0200132915.3. Server IP address resolution using DNS
13292-------------------------------------------
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020013293
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020013294HAProxy allows using a host name on the server line to retrieve its IP address
13295using name servers. By default, HAProxy resolves the name when parsing the
13296configuration file, at startup and cache the result for the process' life.
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020013297This is not sufficient in some cases, such as in Amazon where a server's IP
13298can change after a reboot or an ELB Virtual IP can change based on current
13299workload.
13300This chapter describes how HAProxy can be configured to process server's name
13301resolution at run time.
13302Whether run time server name resolution has been enable or not, HAProxy will
13303carry on doing the first resolution when parsing the configuration.
13304
13305
Cyril Bonté46175dd2015-07-02 22:45:32 +0200133065.3.1. Global overview
13307----------------------
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020013308
13309As we've seen in introduction, name resolution in HAProxy occurs at two
13310different steps of the process life:
13311
13312 1. when starting up, HAProxy parses the server line definition and matches a
13313 host name. It uses libc functions to get the host name resolved. This
13314 resolution relies on /etc/resolv.conf file.
13315
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020013316 2. at run time, HAProxy performs periodically name resolutions for servers
13317 requiring DNS resolutions.
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020013318
13319A few other events can trigger a name resolution at run time:
13320 - when a server's health check ends up in a connection timeout: this may be
13321 because the server has a new IP address. So we need to trigger a name
13322 resolution to know this new IP.
13323
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020013324When using resolvers, the server name can either be a hostname, or a SRV label.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013325HAProxy considers anything that starts with an underscore as a SRV label. If a
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020013326SRV label is specified, then the corresponding SRV records will be retrieved
13327from the DNS server, and the provided hostnames will be used. The SRV label
13328will be checked periodically, and if any server are added or removed, haproxy
13329will automatically do the same.
Olivier Houchardecfa18d2017-08-07 17:30:03 +020013330
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020013331A few things important to notice:
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050013332 - all the name servers are queried in the meantime. HAProxy will process the
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020013333 first valid response.
13334
13335 - a resolution is considered as invalid (NX, timeout, refused), when all the
13336 servers return an error.
13337
13338
Cyril Bonté46175dd2015-07-02 22:45:32 +0200133395.3.2. The resolvers section
13340----------------------------
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020013341
13342This section is dedicated to host information related to name resolution in
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020013343HAProxy. There can be as many as resolvers section as needed. Each section can
13344contain many name servers.
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020013345
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020013346When multiple name servers are configured in a resolvers section, then HAProxy
13347uses the first valid response. In case of invalid responses, only the last one
13348is treated. Purpose is to give the chance to a slow server to deliver a valid
13349answer after a fast faulty or outdated server.
13350
13351When each server returns a different error type, then only the last error is
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020013352used by HAProxy. The following processing is applied on this error:
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020013353
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020013354 1. HAProxy retries the same DNS query with a new query type. The A queries are
13355 switch to AAAA or the opposite. SRV queries are not concerned here. Timeout
13356 errors are also excluded.
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020013357
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020013358 2. When the fallback on the query type was done (or not applicable), HAProxy
13359 retries the original DNS query, with the preferred query type.
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020013360
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020013361 3. HAProxy retries previous steps <resolve_retires> times. If no valid
13362 response is received after that, it stops the DNS resolution and reports
13363 the error.
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020013364
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020013365For example, with 2 name servers configured in a resolvers section, the
13366following scenarios are possible:
13367
13368 - First response is valid and is applied directly, second response is
13369 ignored
13370
13371 - First response is invalid and second one is valid, then second response is
13372 applied
13373
13374 - First response is a NX domain and second one a truncated response, then
13375 HAProxy retries the query with a new type
13376
13377 - First response is a NX domain and second one is a timeout, then HAProxy
13378 retries the query with a new type
13379
13380 - Query timed out for both name servers, then HAProxy retries it with the
13381 same query type
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020013382
Olivier Houcharda8c6db82017-07-06 18:46:47 +020013383As a DNS server may not answer all the IPs in one DNS request, haproxy keeps
13384a cache of previous answers, an answer will be considered obsolete after
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020013385<hold obsolete> seconds without the IP returned.
Olivier Houcharda8c6db82017-07-06 18:46:47 +020013386
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020013387
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020013388resolvers <resolvers id>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013389 Creates a new name server list labeled <resolvers id>
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020013390
13391A resolvers section accept the following parameters:
13392
Baptiste Assmann2af08fe2017-08-14 00:13:01 +020013393accepted_payload_size <nb>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013394 Defines the maximum payload size accepted by HAProxy and announced to all the
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020013395 name servers configured in this resolvers section.
Baptiste Assmann2af08fe2017-08-14 00:13:01 +020013396 <nb> is in bytes. If not set, HAProxy announces 512. (minimal value defined
13397 by RFC 6891)
13398
Baptiste Assmann9d8dbbc2017-08-18 23:35:08 +020013399 Note: the maximum allowed value is 8192.
13400
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020013401nameserver <id> <ip>:<port>
13402 DNS server description:
13403 <id> : label of the server, should be unique
13404 <ip> : IP address of the server
13405 <port> : port where the DNS service actually runs
13406
Ben Draut44e609b2018-05-29 15:40:08 -060013407parse-resolv-conf
13408 Adds all nameservers found in /etc/resolv.conf to this resolvers nameservers
13409 list. Ordered as if each nameserver in /etc/resolv.conf was individually
13410 placed in the resolvers section in place of this directive.
13411
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020013412hold <status> <period>
13413 Defines <period> during which the last name resolution should be kept based
13414 on last resolution <status>
Baptiste Assmann987e16d2016-11-02 22:23:31 +010013415 <status> : last name resolution status. Acceptable values are "nx",
Olivier Houcharda8c6db82017-07-06 18:46:47 +020013416 "other", "refused", "timeout", "valid", "obsolete".
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020013417 <period> : interval between two successive name resolution when the last
13418 answer was in <status>. It follows the HAProxy time format.
13419 <period> is in milliseconds by default.
13420
Baptiste Assmann686408b2017-08-18 10:15:42 +020013421 Default value is 10s for "valid", 0s for "obsolete" and 30s for others.
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020013422
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020013423resolve_retries <nb>
13424 Defines the number <nb> of queries to send to resolve a server name before
13425 giving up.
13426 Default value: 3
13427
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020013428 A retry occurs on name server timeout or when the full sequence of DNS query
13429 type failover is over and we need to start up from the default ANY query
13430 type.
13431
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020013432timeout <event> <time>
13433 Defines timeouts related to name resolution
13434 <event> : the event on which the <time> timeout period applies to.
13435 events available are:
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +010013436 - resolve : default time to trigger name resolutions when no
13437 other time applied.
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020013438 Default value: 1s
13439 - retry : time between two DNS queries, when no valid response
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +010013440 have been received.
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020013441 Default value: 1s
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020013442 <time> : time related to the event. It follows the HAProxy time format.
13443 <time> is expressed in milliseconds.
13444
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020013445 Example:
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020013446
13447 resolvers mydns
13448 nameserver dns1 10.0.0.1:53
13449 nameserver dns2 10.0.0.2:53
Ben Draut44e609b2018-05-29 15:40:08 -060013450 parse-resolv-conf
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020013451 resolve_retries 3
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020013452 timeout resolve 1s
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020013453 timeout retry 1s
Baptiste Assmann987e16d2016-11-02 22:23:31 +010013454 hold other 30s
13455 hold refused 30s
13456 hold nx 30s
13457 hold timeout 30s
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020013458 hold valid 10s
Olivier Houcharda8c6db82017-07-06 18:46:47 +020013459 hold obsolete 30s
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020013460
13461
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +0200134626. Cache
13463---------
13464
13465HAProxy provides a cache, which was designed to perform cache on small objects
13466(favicon, css...). This is a minimalist low-maintenance cache which runs in
13467RAM.
13468
13469The cache is based on a memory which is shared between processes and threads,
13470this memory is split in blocks of 1k.
13471
13472If an object is not used anymore, it can be deleted to store a new object
13473independently of its expiration date. The oldest objects are deleted first
13474when we try to allocate a new one.
13475
13476The cache uses a hash of the host header and the URI as the key.
13477
13478It's possible to view the status of a cache using the Unix socket command
13479"show cache" consult section 9.3 "Unix Socket commands" of Management Guide
13480for more details.
13481
13482When an object is delivered from the cache, the server name in the log is
13483replaced by "<CACHE>".
13484
13485
134866.1. Limitation
13487----------------
13488
13489The cache won't store and won't deliver objects in these cases:
13490
13491- If the response is not a 200
13492- If the response contains a Vary header
13493- If the Content-Length + the headers size is greater than "max-object-size"
13494- If the response is not cacheable
13495
13496- If the request is not a GET
13497- If the HTTP version of the request is smaller than 1.1
13498- If the request contains an Authorization header
13499
13500
135016.2. Setup
13502-----------
13503
13504To setup a cache, you must define a cache section and use it in a proxy with
13505the corresponding http-request and response actions.
13506
13507
135086.2.1. Cache section
13509---------------------
13510
13511cache <name>
13512 Declare a cache section, allocate a shared cache memory named <name>, the
13513 size of cache is mandatory.
13514
13515total-max-size <megabytes>
13516 Define the size in RAM of the cache in megabytes. This size is split in
13517 blocks of 1kB which are used by the cache entries. Its maximum value is 4095.
13518
13519max-object-size <bytes>
13520 Define the maximum size of the objects to be cached. Must not be greater than
13521 an half of "total-max-size". If not set, it equals to a 256th of the cache size.
13522 All objects with sizes larger than "max-object-size" will not be cached.
13523
13524max-age <seconds>
13525 Define the maximum expiration duration. The expiration is set has the lowest
13526 value between the s-maxage or max-age (in this order) directive in the
13527 Cache-Control response header and this value. The default value is 60
13528 seconds, which means that you can't cache an object more than 60 seconds by
13529 default.
13530
13531
135326.2.2. Proxy section
13533---------------------
13534
13535http-request cache-use <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
13536 Try to deliver a cached object from the cache <name>. This directive is also
13537 mandatory to store the cache as it calculates the cache hash. If you want to
13538 use a condition for both storage and delivering that's a good idea to put it
13539 after this one.
13540
13541http-response cache-store <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
13542 Store an http-response within the cache. The storage of the response headers
13543 is done at this step, which means you can use others http-response actions
13544 to modify headers before or after the storage of the response. This action
13545 is responsible for the setup of the cache storage filter.
13546
13547
13548Example:
13549
13550 backend bck1
13551 mode http
13552
13553 http-request cache-use foobar
13554 http-response cache-store foobar
13555 server srv1 127.0.0.1:80
13556
13557 cache foobar
13558 total-max-size 4
13559 max-age 240
13560
13561
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200135627. Using ACLs and fetching samples
13563----------------------------------
13564
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013565HAProxy is capable of extracting data from request or response streams, from
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013566client or server information, from tables, environmental information etc...
13567The action of extracting such data is called fetching a sample. Once retrieved,
13568these samples may be used for various purposes such as a key to a stick-table,
13569but most common usages consist in matching them against predefined constant
13570data called patterns.
13571
13572
135737.1. ACL basics
13574---------------
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013575
13576The use of Access Control Lists (ACL) provides a flexible solution to perform
13577content switching and generally to take decisions based on content extracted
13578from the request, the response or any environmental status. The principle is
13579simple :
13580
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013581 - extract a data sample from a stream, table or the environment
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010013582 - optionally apply some format conversion to the extracted sample
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013583 - apply one or multiple pattern matching methods on this sample
13584 - perform actions only when a pattern matches the sample
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013585
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013586The actions generally consist in blocking a request, selecting a backend, or
13587adding a header.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013588
13589In order to define a test, the "acl" keyword is used. The syntax is :
13590
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013591 acl <aclname> <criterion> [flags] [operator] [<value>] ...
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013592
13593This creates a new ACL <aclname> or completes an existing one with new tests.
13594Those tests apply to the portion of request/response specified in <criterion>
13595and may be adjusted with optional flags [flags]. Some criteria also support
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010013596an operator which may be specified before the set of values. Optionally some
13597conversion operators may be applied to the sample, and they will be specified
13598as a comma-delimited list of keywords just after the first keyword. The values
13599are of the type supported by the criterion, and are separated by spaces.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013600
13601ACL names must be formed from upper and lower case letters, digits, '-' (dash),
13602'_' (underscore) , '.' (dot) and ':' (colon). ACL names are case-sensitive,
13603which means that "my_acl" and "My_Acl" are two different ACLs.
13604
13605There is no enforced limit to the number of ACLs. The unused ones do not affect
13606performance, they just consume a small amount of memory.
13607
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013608The criterion generally is the name of a sample fetch method, or one of its ACL
13609specific declinations. The default test method is implied by the output type of
13610this sample fetch method. The ACL declinations can describe alternate matching
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010013611methods of a same sample fetch method. The sample fetch methods are the only
13612ones supporting a conversion.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013613
13614Sample fetch methods return data which can be of the following types :
13615 - boolean
13616 - integer (signed or unsigned)
13617 - IPv4 or IPv6 address
13618 - string
13619 - data block
13620
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010013621Converters transform any of these data into any of these. For example, some
13622converters might convert a string to a lower-case string while other ones
13623would turn a string to an IPv4 address, or apply a netmask to an IP address.
13624The resulting sample is of the type of the last converter applied to the list,
13625which defaults to the type of the sample fetch method.
13626
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020013627Each sample or converter returns data of a specific type, specified with its
13628keyword in this documentation. When an ACL is declared using a standard sample
13629fetch method, certain types automatically involved a default matching method
13630which are summarized in the table below :
13631
13632 +---------------------+-----------------+
13633 | Sample or converter | Default |
13634 | output type | matching method |
13635 +---------------------+-----------------+
13636 | boolean | bool |
13637 +---------------------+-----------------+
13638 | integer | int |
13639 +---------------------+-----------------+
13640 | ip | ip |
13641 +---------------------+-----------------+
13642 | string | str |
13643 +---------------------+-----------------+
13644 | binary | none, use "-m" |
13645 +---------------------+-----------------+
13646
13647Note that in order to match a binary samples, it is mandatory to specify a
13648matching method, see below.
13649
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013650The ACL engine can match these types against patterns of the following types :
13651 - boolean
13652 - integer or integer range
13653 - IP address / network
13654 - string (exact, substring, suffix, prefix, subdir, domain)
13655 - regular expression
13656 - hex block
13657
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013658The following ACL flags are currently supported :
13659
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020013660 -i : ignore case during matching of all subsequent patterns.
13661 -f : load patterns from a file.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013662 -m : use a specific pattern matching method
Thierry FOURNIERb7729c92014-02-11 16:24:41 +010013663 -n : forbid the DNS resolutions
Thierry FOURNIER9860c412014-01-29 14:23:29 +010013664 -M : load the file pointed by -f like a map file.
Thierry FOURNIER3534d882014-01-20 17:01:44 +010013665 -u : force the unique id of the ACL
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013666 -- : force end of flags. Useful when a string looks like one of the flags.
13667
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013668The "-f" flag is followed by the name of a file from which all lines will be
13669read as individual values. It is even possible to pass multiple "-f" arguments
13670if the patterns are to be loaded from multiple files. Empty lines as well as
13671lines beginning with a sharp ('#') will be ignored. All leading spaces and tabs
13672will be stripped. If it is absolutely necessary to insert a valid pattern
13673beginning with a sharp, just prefix it with a space so that it is not taken for
13674a comment. Depending on the data type and match method, haproxy may load the
13675lines into a binary tree, allowing very fast lookups. This is true for IPv4 and
13676exact string matching. In this case, duplicates will automatically be removed.
13677
Thierry FOURNIER9860c412014-01-29 14:23:29 +010013678The "-M" flag allows an ACL to use a map file. If this flag is set, the file is
13679parsed as two column file. The first column contains the patterns used by the
13680ACL, and the second column contain the samples. The sample can be used later by
13681a map. This can be useful in some rare cases where an ACL would just be used to
13682check for the existence of a pattern in a map before a mapping is applied.
13683
Thierry FOURNIER3534d882014-01-20 17:01:44 +010013684The "-u" flag forces the unique id of the ACL. This unique id is used with the
13685socket interface to identify ACL and dynamically change its values. Note that a
13686file is always identified by its name even if an id is set.
13687
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013688Also, note that the "-i" flag applies to subsequent entries and not to entries
13689loaded from files preceding it. For instance :
13690
13691 acl valid-ua hdr(user-agent) -f exact-ua.lst -i -f generic-ua.lst test
13692
13693In this example, each line of "exact-ua.lst" will be exactly matched against
13694the "user-agent" header of the request. Then each line of "generic-ua" will be
13695case-insensitively matched. Then the word "test" will be insensitively matched
13696as well.
13697
13698The "-m" flag is used to select a specific pattern matching method on the input
13699sample. All ACL-specific criteria imply a pattern matching method and generally
13700do not need this flag. However, this flag is useful with generic sample fetch
13701methods to describe how they're going to be matched against the patterns. This
13702is required for sample fetches which return data type for which there is no
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013703obvious matching method (e.g. string or binary). When "-m" is specified and
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013704followed by a pattern matching method name, this method is used instead of the
13705default one for the criterion. This makes it possible to match contents in ways
13706that were not initially planned, or with sample fetch methods which return a
13707string. The matching method also affects the way the patterns are parsed.
13708
Thierry FOURNIERb7729c92014-02-11 16:24:41 +010013709The "-n" flag forbids the dns resolutions. It is used with the load of ip files.
13710By default, if the parser cannot parse ip address it considers that the parsed
13711string is maybe a domain name and try dns resolution. The flag "-n" disable this
13712resolution. It is useful for detecting malformed ip lists. Note that if the DNS
13713server is not reachable, the haproxy configuration parsing may last many minutes
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050013714waiting for the timeout. During this time no error messages are displayed. The
Thierry FOURNIERb7729c92014-02-11 16:24:41 +010013715flag "-n" disable this behavior. Note also that during the runtime, this
13716function is disabled for the dynamic acl modifications.
13717
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013718There are some restrictions however. Not all methods can be used with all
13719sample fetch methods. Also, if "-m" is used in conjunction with "-f", it must
13720be placed first. The pattern matching method must be one of the following :
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020013721
13722 - "found" : only check if the requested sample could be found in the stream,
13723 but do not compare it against any pattern. It is recommended not
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013724 to pass any pattern to avoid confusion. This matching method is
13725 particularly useful to detect presence of certain contents such
13726 as headers, cookies, etc... even if they are empty and without
13727 comparing them to anything nor counting them.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020013728
13729 - "bool" : check the value as a boolean. It can only be applied to fetches
13730 which return a boolean or integer value, and takes no pattern.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013731 Value zero or false does not match, all other values do match.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020013732
13733 - "int" : match the value as an integer. It can be used with integer and
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013734 boolean samples. Boolean false is integer 0, true is integer 1.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020013735
13736 - "ip" : match the value as an IPv4 or IPv6 address. It is compatible
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013737 with IP address samples only, so it is implied and never needed.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020013738
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013739 - "bin" : match the contents against a hexadecimal string representing a
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020013740 binary sequence. This may be used with binary or string samples.
13741
13742 - "len" : match the sample's length as an integer. This may be used with
13743 binary or string samples.
13744
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013745 - "str" : exact match : match the contents against a string. This may be
13746 used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020013747
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013748 - "sub" : substring match : check that the contents contain at least one of
13749 the provided string patterns. This may be used with binary or
13750 string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020013751
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013752 - "reg" : regex match : match the contents against a list of regular
13753 expressions. This may be used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020013754
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013755 - "beg" : prefix match : check that the contents begin like the provided
13756 string patterns. This may be used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020013757
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013758 - "end" : suffix match : check that the contents end like the provided
13759 string patterns. This may be used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020013760
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013761 - "dir" : subdir match : check that a slash-delimited portion of the
13762 contents exactly matches one of the provided string patterns.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020013763 This may be used with binary or string samples.
13764
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013765 - "dom" : domain match : check that a dot-delimited portion of the contents
13766 exactly match one of the provided string patterns. This may be
13767 used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020013768
13769For example, to quickly detect the presence of cookie "JSESSIONID" in an HTTP
13770request, it is possible to do :
13771
13772 acl jsess_present cook(JSESSIONID) -m found
13773
13774In order to apply a regular expression on the 500 first bytes of data in the
13775buffer, one would use the following acl :
13776
13777 acl script_tag payload(0,500) -m reg -i <script>
13778
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010013779On systems where the regex library is much slower when using "-i", it is
13780possible to convert the sample to lowercase before matching, like this :
13781
13782 acl script_tag payload(0,500),lower -m reg <script>
13783
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013784All ACL-specific criteria imply a default matching method. Most often, these
13785criteria are composed by concatenating the name of the original sample fetch
13786method and the matching method. For example, "hdr_beg" applies the "beg" match
13787to samples retrieved using the "hdr" fetch method. Since all ACL-specific
13788criteria rely on a sample fetch method, it is always possible instead to use
13789the original sample fetch method and the explicit matching method using "-m".
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020013790
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013791If an alternate match is specified using "-m" on an ACL-specific criterion,
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013792the matching method is simply applied to the underlying sample fetch method.
13793For example, all ACLs below are exact equivalent :
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020013794
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013795 acl short_form hdr_beg(host) www.
13796 acl alternate1 hdr_beg(host) -m beg www.
13797 acl alternate2 hdr_dom(host) -m beg www.
13798 acl alternate3 hdr(host) -m beg www.
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020013799
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020013800
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020013801The table below summarizes the compatibility matrix between sample or converter
13802types and the pattern types to fetch against. It indicates for each compatible
13803combination the name of the matching method to be used, surrounded with angle
13804brackets ">" and "<" when the method is the default one and will work by
13805default without "-m".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010013806
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013807 +-------------------------------------------------+
13808 | Input sample type |
13809 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020013810 | pattern type | boolean | integer | ip | string | binary |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013811 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
13812 | none (presence only) | found | found | found | found | found |
13813 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020013814 | none (boolean value) |> bool <| bool | | bool | |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013815 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020013816 | integer (value) | int |> int <| int | int | |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013817 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010013818 | integer (length) | len | len | len | len | len |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013819 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020013820 | IP address | | |> ip <| ip | ip |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013821 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020013822 | exact string | str | str | str |> str <| str |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013823 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010013824 | prefix | beg | beg | beg | beg | beg |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013825 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010013826 | suffix | end | end | end | end | end |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013827 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010013828 | substring | sub | sub | sub | sub | sub |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013829 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010013830 | subdir | dir | dir | dir | dir | dir |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013831 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010013832 | domain | dom | dom | dom | dom | dom |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013833 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010013834 | regex | reg | reg | reg | reg | reg |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013835 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
13836 | hex block | | | | bin | bin |
13837 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013838
13839
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200138407.1.1. Matching booleans
13841------------------------
13842
13843In order to match a boolean, no value is needed and all values are ignored.
13844Boolean matching is used by default for all fetch methods of type "boolean".
13845When boolean matching is used, the fetched value is returned as-is, which means
13846that a boolean "true" will always match and a boolean "false" will never match.
13847
13848Boolean matching may also be enforced using "-m bool" on fetch methods which
13849return an integer value. Then, integer value 0 is converted to the boolean
13850"false" and all other values are converted to "true".
13851
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013852
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200138537.1.2. Matching integers
13854------------------------
13855
13856Integer matching applies by default to integer fetch methods. It can also be
13857enforced on boolean fetches using "-m int". In this case, "false" is converted
13858to the integer 0, and "true" is converted to the integer 1.
13859
13860Integer matching also supports integer ranges and operators. Note that integer
13861matching only applies to positive values. A range is a value expressed with a
13862lower and an upper bound separated with a colon, both of which may be omitted.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013863
13864For instance, "1024:65535" is a valid range to represent a range of
13865unprivileged ports, and "1024:" would also work. "0:1023" is a valid
13866representation of privileged ports, and ":1023" would also work.
13867
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020013868As a special case, some ACL functions support decimal numbers which are in fact
13869two integers separated by a dot. This is used with some version checks for
13870instance. All integer properties apply to those decimal numbers, including
13871ranges and operators.
13872
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013873For an easier usage, comparison operators are also supported. Note that using
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010013874operators with ranges does not make much sense and is strongly discouraged.
13875Similarly, it does not make much sense to perform order comparisons with a set
13876of values.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013877
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010013878Available operators for integer matching are :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013879
13880 eq : true if the tested value equals at least one value
13881 ge : true if the tested value is greater than or equal to at least one value
13882 gt : true if the tested value is greater than at least one value
13883 le : true if the tested value is less than or equal to at least one value
13884 lt : true if the tested value is less than at least one value
13885
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010013886For instance, the following ACL matches any negative Content-Length header :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013887
13888 acl negative-length hdr_val(content-length) lt 0
13889
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020013890This one matches SSL versions between 3.0 and 3.1 (inclusive) :
13891
13892 acl sslv3 req_ssl_ver 3:3.1
13893
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013894
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200138957.1.3. Matching strings
13896-----------------------
13897
13898String matching applies to string or binary fetch methods, and exists in 6
13899different forms :
13900
13901 - exact match (-m str) : the extracted string must exactly match the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013902 patterns;
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013903
13904 - substring match (-m sub) : the patterns are looked up inside the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013905 extracted string, and the ACL matches if any of them is found inside;
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013906
13907 - prefix match (-m beg) : the patterns are compared with the beginning of
13908 the extracted string, and the ACL matches if any of them matches.
13909
13910 - suffix match (-m end) : the patterns are compared with the end of the
13911 extracted string, and the ACL matches if any of them matches.
13912
Baptiste Assmann33db6002016-03-06 23:32:10 +010013913 - subdir match (-m dir) : the patterns are looked up inside the extracted
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013914 string, delimited with slashes ("/"), and the ACL matches if any of them
13915 matches.
13916
13917 - domain match (-m dom) : the patterns are looked up inside the extracted
13918 string, delimited with dots ("."), and the ACL matches if any of them
13919 matches.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013920
13921String matching applies to verbatim strings as they are passed, with the
13922exception of the backslash ("\") which makes it possible to escape some
13923characters such as the space. If the "-i" flag is passed before the first
13924string, then the matching will be performed ignoring the case. In order
13925to match the string "-i", either set it second, or pass the "--" flag
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010013926before the first string. Same applies of course to match the string "--".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013927
Mathias Weiersmuellercb250fc2019-12-02 09:43:40 +010013928Do not use string matches for binary fetches which might contain null bytes
13929(0x00), as the comparison stops at the occurrence of the first null byte.
13930Instead, convert the binary fetch to a hex string with the hex converter first.
13931
13932Example:
13933 # matches if the string <tag> is present in the binary sample
13934 acl tag_found req.payload(0,0),hex -m sub 3C7461673E
13935
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013936
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200139377.1.4. Matching regular expressions (regexes)
13938---------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013939
13940Just like with string matching, regex matching applies to verbatim strings as
13941they are passed, with the exception of the backslash ("\") which makes it
13942possible to escape some characters such as the space. If the "-i" flag is
13943passed before the first regex, then the matching will be performed ignoring
13944the case. In order to match the string "-i", either set it second, or pass
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010013945the "--" flag before the first string. Same principle applies of course to
13946match the string "--".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013947
13948
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200139497.1.5. Matching arbitrary data blocks
13950-------------------------------------
13951
13952It is possible to match some extracted samples against a binary block which may
13953not safely be represented as a string. For this, the patterns must be passed as
13954a series of hexadecimal digits in an even number, when the match method is set
13955to binary. Each sequence of two digits will represent a byte. The hexadecimal
13956digits may be used upper or lower case.
13957
13958Example :
13959 # match "Hello\n" in the input stream (\x48 \x65 \x6c \x6c \x6f \x0a)
13960 acl hello payload(0,6) -m bin 48656c6c6f0a
13961
13962
139637.1.6. Matching IPv4 and IPv6 addresses
13964---------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013965
13966IPv4 addresses values can be specified either as plain addresses or with a
13967netmask appended, in which case the IPv4 address matches whenever it is
13968within the network. Plain addresses may also be replaced with a resolvable
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +010013969host name, but this practice is generally discouraged as it makes it more
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010013970difficult to read and debug configurations. If hostnames are used, you should
13971at least ensure that they are present in /etc/hosts so that the configuration
13972does not depend on any random DNS match at the moment the configuration is
13973parsed.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013974
Daniel Schnellereba56342016-04-13 00:26:52 +020013975The dotted IPv4 address notation is supported in both regular as well as the
13976abbreviated form with all-0-octets omitted:
13977
13978 +------------------+------------------+------------------+
13979 | Example 1 | Example 2 | Example 3 |
13980 +------------------+------------------+------------------+
13981 | 192.168.0.1 | 10.0.0.12 | 127.0.0.1 |
13982 | 192.168.1 | 10.12 | 127.1 |
13983 | 192.168.0.1/22 | 10.0.0.12/8 | 127.0.0.1/8 |
13984 | 192.168.1/22 | 10.12/8 | 127.1/8 |
13985 +------------------+------------------+------------------+
13986
13987Notice that this is different from RFC 4632 CIDR address notation in which
13988192.168.42/24 would be equivalent to 192.168.42.0/24.
13989
Willy Tarreauceb4ac92012-04-28 00:41:46 +020013990IPv6 may be entered in their usual form, with or without a netmask appended.
13991Only bit counts are accepted for IPv6 netmasks. In order to avoid any risk of
13992trouble with randomly resolved IP addresses, host names are never allowed in
13993IPv6 patterns.
13994
13995HAProxy is also able to match IPv4 addresses with IPv6 addresses in the
13996following situations :
13997 - tested address is IPv4, pattern address is IPv4, the match applies
13998 in IPv4 using the supplied mask if any.
13999 - tested address is IPv6, pattern address is IPv6, the match applies
14000 in IPv6 using the supplied mask if any.
14001 - tested address is IPv6, pattern address is IPv4, the match applies in IPv4
14002 using the pattern's mask if the IPv6 address matches with 2002:IPV4::,
14003 ::IPV4 or ::ffff:IPV4, otherwise it fails.
14004 - tested address is IPv4, pattern address is IPv6, the IPv4 address is first
14005 converted to IPv6 by prefixing ::ffff: in front of it, then the match is
14006 applied in IPv6 using the supplied IPv6 mask.
14007
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014008
140097.2. Using ACLs to form conditions
14010----------------------------------
14011
14012Some actions are only performed upon a valid condition. A condition is a
14013combination of ACLs with operators. 3 operators are supported :
14014
14015 - AND (implicit)
14016 - OR (explicit with the "or" keyword or the "||" operator)
14017 - Negation with the exclamation mark ("!")
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014018
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014019A condition is formed as a disjunctive form:
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014020
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014021 [!]acl1 [!]acl2 ... [!]acln { or [!]acl1 [!]acl2 ... [!]acln } ...
Willy Tarreaubef91e72013-03-31 23:14:46 +020014022
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014023Such conditions are generally used after an "if" or "unless" statement,
14024indicating when the condition will trigger the action.
Willy Tarreaubef91e72013-03-31 23:14:46 +020014025
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014026For instance, to block HTTP requests to the "*" URL with methods other than
14027"OPTIONS", as well as POST requests without content-length, and GET or HEAD
14028requests with a content-length greater than 0, and finally every request which
14029is not either GET/HEAD/POST/OPTIONS !
14030
14031 acl missing_cl hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0
Jarno Huuskonen84c51ec2017-04-03 14:20:34 +030014032 http-request deny if HTTP_URL_STAR !METH_OPTIONS || METH_POST missing_cl
14033 http-request deny if METH_GET HTTP_CONTENT
14034 http-request deny unless METH_GET or METH_POST or METH_OPTIONS
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014035
14036To select a different backend for requests to static contents on the "www" site
14037and to every request on the "img", "video", "download" and "ftp" hosts :
14038
14039 acl url_static path_beg /static /images /img /css
14040 acl url_static path_end .gif .png .jpg .css .js
14041 acl host_www hdr_beg(host) -i www
14042 acl host_static hdr_beg(host) -i img. video. download. ftp.
14043
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014044 # now use backend "static" for all static-only hosts, and for static URLs
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014045 # of host "www". Use backend "www" for the rest.
14046 use_backend static if host_static or host_www url_static
14047 use_backend www if host_www
14048
14049It is also possible to form rules using "anonymous ACLs". Those are unnamed ACL
14050expressions that are built on the fly without needing to be declared. They must
14051be enclosed between braces, with a space before and after each brace (because
14052the braces must be seen as independent words). Example :
14053
14054 The following rule :
14055
14056 acl missing_cl hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0
Jarno Huuskonen84c51ec2017-04-03 14:20:34 +030014057 http-request deny if METH_POST missing_cl
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014058
14059 Can also be written that way :
14060
Jarno Huuskonen84c51ec2017-04-03 14:20:34 +030014061 http-request deny if METH_POST { hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0 }
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014062
14063It is generally not recommended to use this construct because it's a lot easier
14064to leave errors in the configuration when written that way. However, for very
14065simple rules matching only one source IP address for instance, it can make more
14066sense to use them than to declare ACLs with random names. Another example of
14067good use is the following :
14068
14069 With named ACLs :
14070
14071 acl site_dead nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2
14072 acl site_dead nbsrv(static) lt 2
14073 monitor fail if site_dead
14074
14075 With anonymous ACLs :
14076
14077 monitor fail if { nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2 } || { nbsrv(static) lt 2 }
14078
Jarno Huuskonen84c51ec2017-04-03 14:20:34 +030014079See section 4.2 for detailed help on the "http-request deny" and "use_backend"
14080keywords.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014081
14082
140837.3. Fetching samples
14084---------------------
14085
14086Historically, sample fetch methods were only used to retrieve data to match
14087against patterns using ACLs. With the arrival of stick-tables, a new class of
14088sample fetch methods was created, most often sharing the same syntax as their
14089ACL counterpart. These sample fetch methods are also known as "fetches". As
14090of now, ACLs and fetches have converged. All ACL fetch methods have been made
14091available as fetch methods, and ACLs may use any sample fetch method as well.
14092
14093This section details all available sample fetch methods and their output type.
14094Some sample fetch methods have deprecated aliases that are used to maintain
14095compatibility with existing configurations. They are then explicitly marked as
14096deprecated and should not be used in new setups.
14097
14098The ACL derivatives are also indicated when available, with their respective
14099matching methods. These ones all have a well defined default pattern matching
14100method, so it is never necessary (though allowed) to pass the "-m" option to
14101indicate how the sample will be matched using ACLs.
14102
14103As indicated in the sample type versus matching compatibility matrix above,
14104when using a generic sample fetch method in an ACL, the "-m" option is
14105mandatory unless the sample type is one of boolean, integer, IPv4 or IPv6. When
14106the same keyword exists as an ACL keyword and as a standard fetch method, the
14107ACL engine will automatically pick the ACL-only one by default.
14108
14109Some of these keywords support one or multiple mandatory arguments, and one or
14110multiple optional arguments. These arguments are strongly typed and are checked
14111when the configuration is parsed so that there is no risk of running with an
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014112incorrect argument (e.g. an unresolved backend name). Fetch function arguments
14113are passed between parenthesis and are delimited by commas. When an argument
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014114is optional, it will be indicated below between square brackets ('[ ]'). When
14115all arguments are optional, the parenthesis may be omitted.
14116
14117Thus, the syntax of a standard sample fetch method is one of the following :
14118 - name
14119 - name(arg1)
14120 - name(arg1,arg2)
14121
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020014122
141237.3.1. Converters
14124-----------------
14125
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010014126Sample fetch methods may be combined with transformations to be applied on top
14127of the fetched sample (also called "converters"). These combinations form what
14128is called "sample expressions" and the result is a "sample". Initially this
14129was only supported by "stick on" and "stick store-request" directives but this
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014130has now be extended to all places where samples may be used (ACLs, log-format,
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010014131unique-id-format, add-header, ...).
14132
14133These transformations are enumerated as a series of specific keywords after the
14134sample fetch method. These keywords may equally be appended immediately after
14135the fetch keyword's argument, delimited by a comma. These keywords can also
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014136support some arguments (e.g. a netmask) which must be passed in parenthesis.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010014137
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010014138A certain category of converters are bitwise and arithmetic operators which
14139support performing basic operations on integers. Some bitwise operations are
14140supported (and, or, xor, cpl) and some arithmetic operations are supported
14141(add, sub, mul, div, mod, neg). Some comparators are provided (odd, even, not,
14142bool) which make it possible to report a match without having to write an ACL.
14143
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014144The currently available list of transformation keywords include :
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010014145
Ben Shillitof25e8e52016-12-02 14:25:37 +00001414651d.single(<prop>[,<prop>*])
14147 Returns values for the properties requested as a string, where values are
14148 separated by the delimiter specified with "51degrees-property-separator".
14149 The device is identified using the User-Agent header passed to the
14150 converter. The function can be passed up to five property names, and if a
14151 property name can't be found, the value "NoData" is returned.
14152
14153 Example :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014154 # Here the header "X-51D-DeviceTypeMobileTablet" is added to the request,
14155 # containing values for the three properties requested by using the
Ben Shillitof25e8e52016-12-02 14:25:37 +000014156 # User-Agent passed to the converter.
14157 frontend http-in
14158 bind *:8081
14159 default_backend servers
14160 http-request set-header X-51D-DeviceTypeMobileTablet \
14161 %[req.fhdr(User-Agent),51d.single(DeviceType,IsMobile,IsTablet)]
14162
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010014163add(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020014164 Adds <value> to the input value of type signed integer, and returns the
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020014165 result as a signed integer. <value> can be a numeric value or a variable
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010014166 name. The name of the variable starts with an indication about its scope. The
14167 scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010014168 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010014169 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
14170 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
14171 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
14172 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014173 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010014174 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010014175
Nenad Merdanovicc31499d2019-03-23 11:00:32 +010014176aes_gcm_dec(<bits>,<nonce>,<key>,<aead_tag>)
14177 Decrypts the raw byte input using the AES128-GCM, AES192-GCM or
14178 AES256-GCM algorithm, depending on the <bits> parameter. All other parameters
14179 need to be base64 encoded and the returned result is in raw byte format.
14180 If the <aead_tag> validation fails, the converter doesn't return any data.
14181 The <nonce>, <key> and <aead_tag> can either be strings or variables. This
14182 converter requires at least OpenSSL 1.0.1.
14183
14184 Example:
14185 http-response set-header X-Decrypted-Text %[var(txn.enc),\
14186 aes_gcm_dec(128,txn.nonce,Zm9vb2Zvb29mb29wZm9vbw==,txn.aead_tag)]
14187
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010014188and(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020014189 Performs a bitwise "AND" between <value> and the input value of type signed
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020014190 integer, and returns the result as an signed integer. <value> can be a
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010014191 numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable starts with an
14192 indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010014193 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010014194 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
14195 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
14196 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
14197 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014198 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010014199 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010014200
Holger Just1bfc24b2017-05-06 00:56:53 +020014201b64dec
14202 Converts (decodes) a base64 encoded input string to its binary
14203 representation. It performs the inverse operation of base64().
14204
Emeric Brun53d1a982014-04-30 18:21:37 +020014205base64
14206 Converts a binary input sample to a base64 string. It is used to log or
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014207 transfer binary content in a way that can be reliably transferred (e.g.
Emeric Brun53d1a982014-04-30 18:21:37 +020014208 an SSL ID can be copied in a header).
14209
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010014210bool
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020014211 Returns a boolean TRUE if the input value of type signed integer is
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010014212 non-null, otherwise returns FALSE. Used in conjunction with and(), it can be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014213 used to report true/false for bit testing on input values (e.g. verify the
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010014214 presence of a flag).
14215
Emeric Brun54c4ac82014-11-03 15:32:43 +010014216bytes(<offset>[,<length>])
14217 Extracts some bytes from an input binary sample. The result is a binary
14218 sample starting at an offset (in bytes) of the original sample and
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010014219 optionally truncated at the given length.
Emeric Brun54c4ac82014-11-03 15:32:43 +010014220
Willy Tarreau280f42b2018-02-19 15:34:12 +010014221concat([<start>],[<var>],[<end>])
14222 Concatenates up to 3 fields after the current sample which is then turned to
14223 a string. The first one, <start>, is a constant string, that will be appended
14224 immediately after the existing sample. It may be omitted if not used. The
14225 second one, <var>, is a variable name. The variable will be looked up, its
14226 contents converted to a string, and it will be appended immediately after the
14227 <first> part. If the variable is not found, nothing is appended. It may be
14228 omitted as well. The third field, <end> is a constant string that will be
14229 appended after the variable. It may also be omitted. Together, these elements
14230 allow to concatenate variables with delimiters to an existing set of
14231 variables. This can be used to build new variables made of a succession of
Willy Tarreauef21fac2020-02-14 13:37:20 +010014232 other variables, such as colon-delimited values. If commas or closing
14233 parethesis are needed as delimiters, they must be protected by quotes or
14234 backslashes, themselves protected so that they are not stripped by the first
14235 level parser. See examples below.
Willy Tarreau280f42b2018-02-19 15:34:12 +010014236
14237 Example:
14238 tcp-request session set-var(sess.src) src
14239 tcp-request session set-var(sess.dn) ssl_c_s_dn
14240 tcp-request session set-var(txn.sig) str(),concat(<ip=,sess.ip,>),concat(<dn=,sess.dn,>)
Willy Tarreauef21fac2020-02-14 13:37:20 +010014241 tcp-request session set-var(txn.ipport) "str(),concat('addr=(',sess.ip),concat(',',sess.port,')')"
Willy Tarreau280f42b2018-02-19 15:34:12 +010014242 http-request set-header x-hap-sig %[var(txn.sig)]
14243
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010014244cpl
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020014245 Takes the input value of type signed integer, applies a ones-complement
14246 (flips all bits) and returns the result as an signed integer.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010014247
Willy Tarreau80599772015-01-20 19:35:24 +010014248crc32([<avalanche>])
14249 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the CRC32
14250 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
14251 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
14252 converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
14253 balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
14254 provided for compatibility with other software which want a CRC32 to be
14255 computed on some input keys, so it follows the most common implementation as
14256 found in Ethernet, Gzip, PNG, etc... It is slower than the other algorithms
14257 but may provide a better or at least less predictable distribution. It must
14258 not be used for security purposes as a 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See
Emmanuel Hocdet50791a72018-03-21 11:19:01 +010014259 also "djb2", "sdbm", "wt6", "crc32c" and the "hash-type" directive.
14260
14261crc32c([<avalanche>])
14262 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the CRC32C
14263 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
14264 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
14265 converter uses the same functions as described in RFC4960, Appendix B [8].
14266 It is provided for compatibility with other software which want a CRC32C to be
14267 computed on some input keys. It is slower than the other algorithms and it must
14268 not be used for security purposes as a 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See
14269 also "djb2", "sdbm", "wt6", "crc32" and the "hash-type" directive.
Willy Tarreau80599772015-01-20 19:35:24 +010014270
Christopher Fauletea159d62020-04-01 16:21:44 +020014271cut_crlf
14272 Cuts the string representation of the input sample on the first carriage
14273 return ('\r') or newline ('\n') character found. Only the string length is
14274 updated.
14275
David Carlier29b3ca32015-09-25 14:09:21 +010014276da-csv-conv(<prop>[,<prop>*])
David Carlier4542b102015-06-01 13:54:29 +020014277 Asks the DeviceAtlas converter to identify the User Agent string passed on
14278 input, and to emit a string made of the concatenation of the properties
14279 enumerated in argument, delimited by the separator defined by the global
14280 keyword "deviceatlas-property-separator", or by default the pipe character
David Carlier840b0242016-03-16 10:09:55 +000014281 ('|'). There's a limit of 12 different properties imposed by the haproxy
David Carlier4542b102015-06-01 13:54:29 +020014282 configuration language.
14283
14284 Example:
14285 frontend www
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +020014286 bind *:8881
14287 default_backend servers
David Carlier840b0242016-03-16 10:09:55 +000014288 http-request set-header X-DeviceAtlas-Data %[req.fhdr(User-Agent),da-csv(primaryHardwareType,osName,osVersion,browserName,browserVersion,browserRenderingEngine)]
David Carlier4542b102015-06-01 13:54:29 +020014289
Willy Tarreau0851fd52019-12-17 10:07:25 +010014290debug([<prefix][,<destination>])
14291 This converter is used as debug tool. It takes a capture of the input sample
14292 and sends it to event sink <destination>, which may designate a ring buffer
14293 such as "buf0", as well as "stdout", or "stderr". Available sinks may be
14294 checked at run time by issuing "show events" on the CLI. When not specified,
14295 the output will be "buf0", which may be consulted via the CLI's "show events"
14296 command. An optional prefix <prefix> may be passed to help distinguish
14297 outputs from multiple expressions. It will then appear before the colon in
14298 the output message. The input sample is passed as-is on the output, so that
14299 it is safe to insert the debug converter anywhere in a chain, even with non-
14300 printable sample types.
14301
14302 Example:
14303 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src,debug(track-sc)
Thierry FOURNIER9687c772015-05-07 15:46:29 +020014304
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010014305div(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020014306 Divides the input value of type signed integer by <value>, and returns the
14307 result as an signed integer. If <value> is null, the largest unsigned
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020014308 integer is returned (typically 2^63-1). <value> can be a numeric value or a
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010014309 variable name. The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
14310 scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010014311 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010014312 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
14313 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
14314 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
14315 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014316 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010014317 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010014318
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020014319djb2([<avalanche>])
14320 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the DJB2
14321 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
14322 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
14323 converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
14324 balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
14325 mostly intended for debugging, but can be used as a stick-table entry to
14326 collect rough statistics. It must not be used for security purposes as a
Emmanuel Hocdet50791a72018-03-21 11:19:01 +010014327 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See also "crc32", "sdbm", "wt6", "crc32c",
14328 and the "hash-type" directive.
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020014329
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010014330even
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020014331 Returns a boolean TRUE if the input value of type signed integer is even
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010014332 otherwise returns FALSE. It is functionally equivalent to "not,and(1),bool".
14333
Marcin Deranek9631a282018-04-16 14:30:46 +020014334field(<index>,<delimiters>[,<count>])
14335 Extracts the substring at the given index counting from the beginning
14336 (positive index) or from the end (negative index) considering given delimiters
14337 from an input string. Indexes start at 1 or -1 and delimiters are a string
14338 formatted list of chars. Optionally you can specify <count> of fields to
14339 extract (default: 1). Value of 0 indicates extraction of all remaining
14340 fields.
14341
14342 Example :
14343 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),field(5,_) # f5
14344 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),field(2,_,0) # f2_f3__f5
14345 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),field(2,_,2) # f2_f3
14346 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),field(-2,_,3) # f2_f3_
14347 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),field(-3,_,0) # f1_f2_f3
Emeric Brunf399b0d2014-11-03 17:07:03 +010014348
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020014349hex
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014350 Converts a binary input sample to a hex string containing two hex digits per
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020014351 input byte. It is used to log or transfer hex dumps of some binary input data
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014352 in a way that can be reliably transferred (e.g. an SSL ID can be copied in a
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020014353 header).
Thierry FOURNIER2f49d6d2014-03-12 15:01:52 +010014354
Dragan Dosen3f957b22017-10-24 09:27:34 +020014355hex2i
14356 Converts a hex string containing two hex digits per input byte to an
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050014357 integer. If the input value cannot be converted, then zero is returned.
Dragan Dosen3f957b22017-10-24 09:27:34 +020014358
Christopher Faulet4ccc12f2020-04-01 09:08:32 +020014359htonl
14360 Converts the input integer value to its 32-bit binary representation in the
14361 network byte order. Because sample fetches own signed 64-bit integer, when
14362 this converter is used, the input integer value is first casted to an
14363 unsigned 32-bit integer.
14364
Cyril Bonté6bcd1822019-11-05 23:13:59 +010014365http_date([<offset],[<unit>])
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020014366 Converts an integer supposed to contain a date since epoch to a string
14367 representing this date in a format suitable for use in HTTP header fields. If
Damien Claisseae6f1252019-10-30 15:57:28 +000014368 an offset value is specified, then it is added to the date before the
14369 conversion is operated. This is particularly useful to emit Date header fields,
14370 Expires values in responses when combined with a positive offset, or
14371 Last-Modified values when the offset is negative.
14372 If a unit value is specified, then consider the timestamp as either
14373 "s" for seconds (default behavior), "ms" for milliseconds, or "us" for
14374 microseconds since epoch. Offset is assumed to have the same unit as
14375 input timestamp.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014376
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020014377in_table(<table>)
14378 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
14379 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, a boolean false
14380 is returned. Otherwise a boolean true is returned. This can be used to verify
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014381 the presence of a certain key in a table tracking some elements (e.g. whether
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020014382 or not a source IP address or an Authorization header was already seen).
14383
Tim Duesterhus1478aa72018-01-25 16:24:51 +010014384ipmask(<mask4>, [<mask6>])
14385 Apply a mask to an IP address, and use the result for lookups and storage.
Willy Tarreauffcb2e42014-07-10 16:29:08 +020014386 This can be used to make all hosts within a certain mask to share the same
Tim Duesterhus1478aa72018-01-25 16:24:51 +010014387 table entries and as such use the same server. The mask4 can be passed in
14388 dotted form (e.g. 255.255.255.0) or in CIDR form (e.g. 24). The mask6 can
14389 be passed in quadruplet form (e.g. ffff:ffff::) or in CIDR form (e.g. 64).
14390 If no mask6 is given IPv6 addresses will fail to convert for backwards
14391 compatibility reasons.
Willy Tarreauffcb2e42014-07-10 16:29:08 +020014392
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020014393json([<input-code>])
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014394 Escapes the input string and produces an ASCII output string ready to use as a
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020014395 JSON string. The converter tries to decode the input string according to the
Herve COMMOWICK8dfe8632016-08-05 12:01:20 +020014396 <input-code> parameter. It can be "ascii", "utf8", "utf8s", "utf8p" or
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020014397 "utf8ps". The "ascii" decoder never fails. The "utf8" decoder detects 3 types
14398 of errors:
14399 - bad UTF-8 sequence (lone continuation byte, bad number of continuation
14400 bytes, ...)
14401 - invalid range (the decoded value is within a UTF-8 prohibited range),
14402 - code overlong (the value is encoded with more bytes than necessary).
14403
14404 The UTF-8 JSON encoding can produce a "too long value" error when the UTF-8
14405 character is greater than 0xffff because the JSON string escape specification
14406 only authorizes 4 hex digits for the value encoding. The UTF-8 decoder exists
14407 in 4 variants designated by a combination of two suffix letters : "p" for
14408 "permissive" and "s" for "silently ignore". The behaviors of the decoders
14409 are :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014410 - "ascii" : never fails;
14411 - "utf8" : fails on any detected errors;
14412 - "utf8s" : never fails, but removes characters corresponding to errors;
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020014413 - "utf8p" : accepts and fixes the overlong errors, but fails on any other
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014414 error;
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020014415 - "utf8ps" : never fails, accepts and fixes the overlong errors, but removes
14416 characters corresponding to the other errors.
14417
14418 This converter is particularly useful for building properly escaped JSON for
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014419 logging to servers which consume JSON-formatted traffic logs.
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020014420
14421 Example:
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020014422 capture request header Host len 15
Herve COMMOWICK8dfe8632016-08-05 12:01:20 +020014423 capture request header user-agent len 150
14424 log-format '{"ip":"%[src]","user-agent":"%[capture.req.hdr(1),json(utf8s)]"}'
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020014425
14426 Input request from client 127.0.0.1:
14427 GET / HTTP/1.0
14428 User-Agent: Very "Ugly" UA 1/2
14429
14430 Output log:
14431 {"ip":"127.0.0.1","user-agent":"Very \"Ugly\" UA 1\/2"}
14432
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020014433language(<value>[,<default>])
14434 Returns the value with the highest q-factor from a list as extracted from the
14435 "accept-language" header using "req.fhdr". Values with no q-factor have a
14436 q-factor of 1. Values with a q-factor of 0 are dropped. Only values which
14437 belong to the list of semi-colon delimited <values> will be considered. The
14438 argument <value> syntax is "lang[;lang[;lang[;...]]]". If no value matches the
14439 given list and a default value is provided, it is returned. Note that language
14440 names may have a variant after a dash ('-'). If this variant is present in the
14441 list, it will be matched, but if it is not, only the base language is checked.
14442 The match is case-sensitive, and the output string is always one of those
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014443 provided in arguments. The ordering of arguments is meaningless, only the
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020014444 ordering of the values in the request counts, as the first value among
14445 multiple sharing the same q-factor is used.
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020014446
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020014447 Example :
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020014448
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020014449 # this configuration switches to the backend matching a
14450 # given language based on the request :
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020014451
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020014452 acl es req.fhdr(accept-language),language(es;fr;en) -m str es
14453 acl fr req.fhdr(accept-language),language(es;fr;en) -m str fr
14454 acl en req.fhdr(accept-language),language(es;fr;en) -m str en
14455 use_backend spanish if es
14456 use_backend french if fr
14457 use_backend english if en
14458 default_backend choose_your_language
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020014459
Willy Tarreau60a2ee72017-12-15 07:13:48 +010014460length
Etienne Carriereed0d24e2017-12-13 13:41:34 +010014461 Get the length of the string. This can only be placed after a string
14462 sample fetch function or after a transformation keyword returning a string
14463 type. The result is of type integer.
14464
Willy Tarreauffcb2e42014-07-10 16:29:08 +020014465lower
14466 Convert a string sample to lower case. This can only be placed after a string
14467 sample fetch function or after a transformation keyword returning a string
14468 type. The result is of type string.
14469
Willy Tarreau0dbfdba2014-07-10 16:37:47 +020014470ltime(<format>[,<offset>])
14471 Converts an integer supposed to contain a date since epoch to a string
14472 representing this date in local time using a format defined by the <format>
14473 string using strftime(3). The purpose is to allow any date format to be used
14474 in logs. An optional <offset> in seconds may be applied to the input date
14475 (positive or negative). See the strftime() man page for the format supported
14476 by your operating system. See also the utime converter.
14477
14478 Example :
14479
14480 # Emit two colons, one with the local time and another with ip:port
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014481 # e.g. 20140710162350 127.0.0.1:57325
Willy Tarreau0dbfdba2014-07-10 16:37:47 +020014482 log-format %[date,ltime(%Y%m%d%H%M%S)]\ %ci:%cp
14483
Christopher Faulet51fc9d12020-04-01 17:24:41 +020014484ltrim(<chars>)
14485 Skips any characters from <chars> from the beginning of the string
14486 representation of the input sample.
14487
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020014488map(<map_file>[,<default_value>])
14489map_<match_type>(<map_file>[,<default_value>])
14490map_<match_type>_<output_type>(<map_file>[,<default_value>])
14491 Search the input value from <map_file> using the <match_type> matching method,
14492 and return the associated value converted to the type <output_type>. If the
14493 input value cannot be found in the <map_file>, the converter returns the
14494 <default_value>. If the <default_value> is not set, the converter fails and
14495 acts as if no input value could be fetched. If the <match_type> is not set, it
14496 defaults to "str". Likewise, if the <output_type> is not set, it defaults to
14497 "str". For convenience, the "map" keyword is an alias for "map_str" and maps a
14498 string to another string.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010014499
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020014500 It is important to avoid overlapping between the keys : IP addresses and
14501 strings are stored in trees, so the first of the finest match will be used.
14502 Other keys are stored in lists, so the first matching occurrence will be used.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010014503
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010014504 The following array contains the list of all map functions available sorted by
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020014505 input type, match type and output type.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010014506
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020014507 input type | match method | output type str | output type int | output type ip
14508 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
14509 str | str | map_str | map_str_int | map_str_ip
14510 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Willy Tarreau787a4c02014-05-10 07:55:30 +020014511 str | beg | map_beg | map_beg_int | map_end_ip
14512 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020014513 str | sub | map_sub | map_sub_int | map_sub_ip
14514 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
14515 str | dir | map_dir | map_dir_int | map_dir_ip
14516 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
14517 str | dom | map_dom | map_dom_int | map_dom_ip
14518 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
14519 str | end | map_end | map_end_int | map_end_ip
14520 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Ruoshan Huang3c5e3742016-12-02 16:25:31 +080014521 str | reg | map_reg | map_reg_int | map_reg_ip
14522 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
14523 str | reg | map_regm | map_reg_int | map_reg_ip
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020014524 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
14525 int | int | map_int | map_int_int | map_int_ip
14526 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
14527 ip | ip | map_ip | map_ip_int | map_ip_ip
14528 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010014529
Thierry Fournier8feaa662016-02-10 22:55:20 +010014530 The special map called "map_regm" expect matching zone in the regular
14531 expression and modify the output replacing back reference (like "\1") by
14532 the corresponding match text.
14533
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020014534 The file contains one key + value per line. Lines which start with '#' are
14535 ignored, just like empty lines. Leading tabs and spaces are stripped. The key
14536 is then the first "word" (series of non-space/tabs characters), and the value
14537 is what follows this series of space/tab till the end of the line excluding
14538 trailing spaces/tabs.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010014539
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020014540 Example :
14541
14542 # this is a comment and is ignored
14543 2.22.246.0/23 United Kingdom \n
14544 <-><-----------><--><------------><---->
14545 | | | | `- trailing spaces ignored
14546 | | | `---------- value
14547 | | `-------------------- middle spaces ignored
14548 | `---------------------------- key
14549 `------------------------------------ leading spaces ignored
14550
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010014551mod(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020014552 Divides the input value of type signed integer by <value>, and returns the
14553 remainder as an signed integer. If <value> is null, then zero is returned.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020014554 <value> can be a numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010014555 starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010014556 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010014557 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
14558 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
14559 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
14560 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014561 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010014562 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010014563
14564mul(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020014565 Multiplies the input value of type signed integer by <value>, and returns
Thierry FOURNIER00c005c2015-07-08 01:10:21 +020014566 the product as an signed integer. In case of overflow, the largest possible
14567 value for the sign is returned so that the operation doesn't wrap around.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020014568 <value> can be a numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010014569 starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010014570 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010014571 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
14572 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
14573 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
14574 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014575 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010014576 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010014577
Nenad Merdanovicb7e7c472017-03-12 21:56:55 +010014578nbsrv
14579 Takes an input value of type string, interprets it as a backend name and
14580 returns the number of usable servers in that backend. Can be used in places
14581 where we want to look up a backend from a dynamic name, like a result of a
14582 map lookup.
14583
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010014584neg
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020014585 Takes the input value of type signed integer, computes the opposite value,
14586 and returns the remainder as an signed integer. 0 is identity. This operator
14587 is provided for reversed subtracts : in order to subtract the input from a
14588 constant, simply perform a "neg,add(value)".
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010014589
14590not
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020014591 Returns a boolean FALSE if the input value of type signed integer is
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010014592 non-null, otherwise returns TRUE. Used in conjunction with and(), it can be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014593 used to report true/false for bit testing on input values (e.g. verify the
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010014594 absence of a flag).
14595
14596odd
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020014597 Returns a boolean TRUE if the input value of type signed integer is odd
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010014598 otherwise returns FALSE. It is functionally equivalent to "and(1),bool".
14599
14600or(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020014601 Performs a bitwise "OR" between <value> and the input value of type signed
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020014602 integer, and returns the result as an signed integer. <value> can be a
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010014603 numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable starts with an
14604 indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010014605 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010014606 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
14607 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
14608 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
14609 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014610 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010014611 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010014612
Frédéric Lécaillebfe61382019-03-06 14:34:36 +010014613protobuf(<field_number>,[<field_type>])
14614 This extracts the protocol buffers message field in raw mode of an input binary
14615 sample representation of a protocol buffer message with <field_number> as field
14616 number (dotted notation) if <field_type> is not present, or as an integer sample
14617 if this field is present (see also "ungrpc" below).
14618 The list of the authorized types is the following one: "int32", "int64", "uint32",
14619 "uint64", "sint32", "sint64", "bool", "enum" for the "varint" wire type 0
14620 "fixed64", "sfixed64", "double" for the 64bit wire type 1, "fixed32", "sfixed32",
14621 "float" for the wire type 5. Note that "string" is considered as a length-delimited
14622 type, so it does not require any <field_type> argument to be extracted.
14623 More information may be found here about the protocol buffers message field types:
14624 https://developers.google.com/protocol-buffers/docs/encoding
14625
Willy Tarreauc4dc3502015-01-23 20:39:28 +010014626regsub(<regex>,<subst>[,<flags>])
Willy Tarreau7eda8492015-01-20 19:47:06 +010014627 Applies a regex-based substitution to the input string. It does the same
14628 operation as the well-known "sed" utility with "s/<regex>/<subst>/". By
14629 default it will replace in the input string the first occurrence of the
14630 largest part matching the regular expression <regex> with the substitution
14631 string <subst>. It is possible to replace all occurrences instead by adding
14632 the flag "g" in the third argument <flags>. It is also possible to make the
14633 regex case insensitive by adding the flag "i" in <flags>. Since <flags> is a
14634 string, it is made up from the concatenation of all desired flags. Thus if
14635 both "i" and "g" are desired, using "gi" or "ig" will have the same effect.
Willy Tarreauef21fac2020-02-14 13:37:20 +010014636 The first use of this converter is to replace certain characters or sequence
14637 of characters with other ones.
14638
14639 It is highly recommended to enclose the regex part using protected quotes to
14640 improve clarity and never have a closing parenthesis from the regex mixed up
14641 with the parenthesis from the function. Just like in Bourne shell, the first
14642 level of quotes is processed when delimiting word groups on the line, a
14643 second level is usable for argument. It is recommended to use single quotes
14644 outside since these ones do not try to resolve backslashes nor dollar signs.
Willy Tarreau7eda8492015-01-20 19:47:06 +010014645
Willy Tarreaucd0d2ed2020-02-14 17:33:06 +010014646 Examples:
Willy Tarreau7eda8492015-01-20 19:47:06 +010014647
14648 # de-duplicate "/" in header "x-path".
14649 # input: x-path: /////a///b/c/xzxyz/
14650 # output: x-path: /a/b/c/xzxyz/
Willy Tarreauef21fac2020-02-14 13:37:20 +010014651 http-request set-header x-path "%[hdr(x-path),regsub('/+','/','g')]"
Willy Tarreau7eda8492015-01-20 19:47:06 +010014652
Willy Tarreaucd0d2ed2020-02-14 17:33:06 +010014653 # copy query string to x-query and drop all leading '?', ';' and '&'
14654 http-request set-header x-query "%[query,regsub([?;&]*,'')]"
14655
Jerome Magnin07e1e3c2020-02-16 19:20:19 +010014656 # capture groups and backreferences
14657 # both lines do the same.
14658 http-request redirect location %[url,'regsub("(foo|bar)([0-9]+)?","\2\1",i)]'
14659 http-request redirect location %[url,regsub(\"(foo|bar)([0-9]+)?\",\"\2\1\",i)]
14660
Thierry FOURNIER35ab2752015-05-28 13:22:03 +020014661capture-req(<id>)
14662 Capture the string entry in the request slot <id> and returns the entry as
14663 is. If the slot doesn't exist, the capture fails silently.
14664
14665 See also: "declare capture", "http-request capture",
Baptiste Assmann5ac425c2015-10-21 23:13:46 +020014666 "http-response capture", "capture.req.hdr" and
14667 "capture.res.hdr" (sample fetches).
Thierry FOURNIER35ab2752015-05-28 13:22:03 +020014668
14669capture-res(<id>)
14670 Capture the string entry in the response slot <id> and returns the entry as
14671 is. If the slot doesn't exist, the capture fails silently.
14672
14673 See also: "declare capture", "http-request capture",
Baptiste Assmann5ac425c2015-10-21 23:13:46 +020014674 "http-response capture", "capture.req.hdr" and
14675 "capture.res.hdr" (sample fetches).
Thierry FOURNIER35ab2752015-05-28 13:22:03 +020014676
Christopher Faulet568415a2020-04-01 17:24:47 +020014677rtrim(<chars>)
14678 Skips any characters from <chars> from the end of the string representation
14679 of the input sample.
14680
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020014681sdbm([<avalanche>])
14682 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the SDBM
14683 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
14684 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
14685 converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
14686 balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
14687 mostly intended for debugging, but can be used as a stick-table entry to
14688 collect rough statistics. It must not be used for security purposes as a
Emmanuel Hocdet50791a72018-03-21 11:19:01 +010014689 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See also "crc32", "djb2", "wt6", "crc32c",
14690 and the "hash-type" directive.
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020014691
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020014692set-var(<var name>)
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014693 Sets a variable with the input content and returns the content on the output
14694 as-is. The variable keeps the value and the associated input type. The name of
14695 the variable starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010014696 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010014697 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
14698 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020014699 response),
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010014700 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
14701 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020014702 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010014703 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020014704
Dragan Dosen6e5a9ca2017-10-24 09:18:23 +020014705sha1
Tim Duesterhusd4376302019-06-17 12:41:44 +020014706 Converts a binary input sample to a SHA-1 digest. The result is a binary
Dragan Dosen6e5a9ca2017-10-24 09:18:23 +020014707 sample with length of 20 bytes.
14708
Tim Duesterhusd4376302019-06-17 12:41:44 +020014709sha2([<bits>])
14710 Converts a binary input sample to a digest in the SHA-2 family. The result
14711 is a binary sample with length of <bits>/8 bytes.
14712
14713 Valid values for <bits> are 224, 256, 384, 512, each corresponding to
14714 SHA-<bits>. The default value is 256.
14715
14716 Please note that this converter is only available when haproxy has been
14717 compiled with USE_OPENSSL.
14718
Nenad Merdanovic177adc92019-08-27 01:58:13 +020014719srv_queue
14720 Takes an input value of type string, either a server name or <backend>/<server>
14721 format and returns the number of queued sessions on that server. Can be used
14722 in places where we want to look up queued sessions from a dynamic name, like a
14723 cookie value (e.g. req.cook(SRVID),srv_queue) and then make a decision to break
14724 persistence or direct a request elsewhere.
14725
Tim Duesterhusca097c12018-04-27 21:18:45 +020014726strcmp(<var>)
14727 Compares the contents of <var> with the input value of type string. Returns
14728 the result as a signed integer compatible with strcmp(3): 0 if both strings
14729 are identical. A value less than 0 if the left string is lexicographically
14730 smaller than the right string or if the left string is shorter. A value greater
14731 than 0 otherwise (right string greater than left string or the right string is
14732 shorter).
14733
14734 Example :
14735
14736 http-request set-var(txn.host) hdr(host)
14737 # Check whether the client is attempting domain fronting.
14738 acl ssl_sni_http_host_match ssl_fc_sni,strcmp(txn.host) eq 0
14739
14740
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010014741sub(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020014742 Subtracts <value> from the input value of type signed integer, and returns
14743 the result as an signed integer. Note: in order to subtract the input from
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020014744 a constant, simply perform a "neg,add(value)". <value> can be a numeric value
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010014745 or a variable name. The name of the variable starts with an indication about
14746 its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010014747 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010014748 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
14749 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020014750 response),
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010014751 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
14752 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020014753 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010014754 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010014755
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020014756table_bytes_in_rate(<table>)
14757 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
14758 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
14759 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average client-to-server
14760 bytes rate associated with the input sample in the designated table, measured
14761 in amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. See also the
14762 sc_bytes_in_rate sample fetch keyword.
14763
14764
14765table_bytes_out_rate(<table>)
14766 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
14767 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
14768 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average server-to-client
14769 bytes rate associated with the input sample in the designated table, measured
14770 in amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. See also the
14771 sc_bytes_out_rate sample fetch keyword.
14772
14773table_conn_cnt(<table>)
14774 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
14775 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014776 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of incoming
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020014777 connections associated with the input sample in the designated table. See
14778 also the sc_conn_cnt sample fetch keyword.
14779
14780table_conn_cur(<table>)
14781 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
14782 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
14783 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current amount of concurrent
14784 tracked connections associated with the input sample in the designated table.
14785 See also the sc_conn_cur sample fetch keyword.
14786
14787table_conn_rate(<table>)
14788 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
14789 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
14790 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average incoming connection
14791 rate associated with the input sample in the designated table. See also the
14792 sc_conn_rate sample fetch keyword.
14793
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020014794table_gpt0(<table>)
14795 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
14796 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, boolean value zero
14797 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current value of the first
14798 general purpose tag associated with the input sample in the designated table.
14799 See also the sc_get_gpt0 sample fetch keyword.
14800
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020014801table_gpc0(<table>)
14802 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
14803 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
14804 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current value of the first
14805 general purpose counter associated with the input sample in the designated
14806 table. See also the sc_get_gpc0 sample fetch keyword.
14807
14808table_gpc0_rate(<table>)
14809 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
14810 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
14811 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the frequency which the gpc0
14812 counter was incremented over the configured period in the table, associated
14813 with the input sample in the designated table. See also the sc_get_gpc0_rate
14814 sample fetch keyword.
14815
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010014816table_gpc1(<table>)
14817 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
14818 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
14819 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current value of the second
14820 general purpose counter associated with the input sample in the designated
14821 table. See also the sc_get_gpc1 sample fetch keyword.
14822
14823table_gpc1_rate(<table>)
14824 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
14825 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
14826 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the frequency which the gpc1
14827 counter was incremented over the configured period in the table, associated
14828 with the input sample in the designated table. See also the sc_get_gpc1_rate
14829 sample fetch keyword.
14830
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020014831table_http_err_cnt(<table>)
14832 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
14833 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014834 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of HTTP
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020014835 errors associated with the input sample in the designated table. See also the
14836 sc_http_err_cnt sample fetch keyword.
14837
14838table_http_err_rate(<table>)
14839 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
14840 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
14841 is returned. Otherwise the average rate of HTTP errors associated with the
14842 input sample in the designated table, measured in amount of errors over the
14843 period configured in the table. See also the sc_http_err_rate sample fetch
14844 keyword.
14845
14846table_http_req_cnt(<table>)
14847 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
14848 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014849 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of HTTP
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020014850 requests associated with the input sample in the designated table. See also
14851 the sc_http_req_cnt sample fetch keyword.
14852
14853table_http_req_rate(<table>)
14854 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
14855 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
14856 is returned. Otherwise the average rate of HTTP requests associated with the
14857 input sample in the designated table, measured in amount of requests over the
14858 period configured in the table. See also the sc_http_req_rate sample fetch
14859 keyword.
14860
14861table_kbytes_in(<table>)
14862 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
14863 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014864 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of client-
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020014865 to-server data associated with the input sample in the designated table,
14866 measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit integers,
14867 which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also the sc_kbytes_in sample fetch
14868 keyword.
14869
14870table_kbytes_out(<table>)
14871 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
14872 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014873 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of server-
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020014874 to-client data associated with the input sample in the designated table,
14875 measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit integers,
14876 which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also the sc_kbytes_out sample fetch
14877 keyword.
14878
14879table_server_id(<table>)
14880 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
14881 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
14882 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the server ID associated with
14883 the input sample in the designated table. A server ID is associated to a
14884 sample by a "stick" rule when a connection to a server succeeds. A server ID
14885 zero means that no server is associated with this key.
14886
14887table_sess_cnt(<table>)
14888 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
14889 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014890 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of incoming
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020014891 sessions associated with the input sample in the designated table. Note that
14892 a session here refers to an incoming connection being accepted by the
14893 "tcp-request connection" rulesets. See also the sc_sess_cnt sample fetch
14894 keyword.
14895
14896table_sess_rate(<table>)
14897 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
14898 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
14899 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average incoming session
14900 rate associated with the input sample in the designated table. Note that a
14901 session here refers to an incoming connection being accepted by the
14902 "tcp-request connection" rulesets. See also the sc_sess_rate sample fetch
14903 keyword.
14904
14905table_trackers(<table>)
14906 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
14907 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
14908 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current amount of concurrent
14909 connections tracking the same key as the input sample in the designated
14910 table. It differs from table_conn_cur in that it does not rely on any stored
14911 information but on the table's reference count (the "use" value which is
14912 returned by "show table" on the CLI). This may sometimes be more suited for
14913 layer7 tracking. It can be used to tell a server how many concurrent
14914 connections there are from a given address for example. See also the
14915 sc_trackers sample fetch keyword.
14916
Willy Tarreauffcb2e42014-07-10 16:29:08 +020014917upper
14918 Convert a string sample to upper case. This can only be placed after a string
14919 sample fetch function or after a transformation keyword returning a string
14920 type. The result is of type string.
14921
Willy Tarreau62ba9ba2020-04-23 17:54:47 +020014922url_dec([<in_form>])
14923 Takes an url-encoded string provided as input and returns the decoded version
14924 as output. The input and the output are of type string. If the <in_form>
14925 argument is set to a non-zero integer value, the input string is assumed to
14926 be part of a form or query string and the '+' character will be turned into a
14927 space (' '). Otherwise this will only happen after a question mark indicating
14928 a query string ('?').
Thierry FOURNIER82ff3c92015-05-07 15:46:20 +020014929
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010014930ungrpc(<field_number>,[<field_type>])
Frédéric Lécaille50290fb2019-02-27 14:34:51 +010014931 This extracts the protocol buffers message field in raw mode of an input binary
Frédéric Lécaillebfe61382019-03-06 14:34:36 +010014932 sample representation of a gRPC message with <field_number> as field number
14933 (dotted notation) if <field_type> is not present, or as an integer sample if this
14934 field is present.
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010014935 The list of the authorized types is the following one: "int32", "int64", "uint32",
14936 "uint64", "sint32", "sint64", "bool", "enum" for the "varint" wire type 0
14937 "fixed64", "sfixed64", "double" for the 64bit wire type 1, "fixed32", "sfixed32",
14938 "float" for the wire type 5. Note that "string" is considered as a length-delimited
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +010014939 type, so it does not require any <field_type> argument to be extracted.
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010014940 More information may be found here about the protocol buffers message field types:
14941 https://developers.google.com/protocol-buffers/docs/encoding
Frédéric Lécaille50290fb2019-02-27 14:34:51 +010014942
14943 Example:
14944 // with such a protocol buffer .proto file content adapted from
14945 // https://github.com/grpc/grpc/blob/master/examples/protos/route_guide.proto
14946
14947 message Point {
14948 int32 latitude = 1;
14949 int32 longitude = 2;
14950 }
14951
14952 message PPoint {
14953 Point point = 59;
14954 }
14955
14956 message Rectangle {
14957 // One corner of the rectangle.
14958 PPoint lo = 48;
14959 // The other corner of the rectangle.
14960 PPoint hi = 49;
14961 }
14962
14963 let's say a body request is made of a "Rectangle" object value (two PPoint
14964 protocol buffers messages), the four protocol buffers fields could be
14965 extracted with these "ungrpc" directives:
14966
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010014967 req.body,ungrpc(48.59.1,int32) # "latitude" of "lo" first PPoint
14968 req.body,ungrpc(48.59.2,int32) # "longitude" of "lo" first PPoint
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050014969 req.body,ungrpc(49.59.1,int32) # "latitude" of "hi" second PPoint
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010014970 req.body,ungrpc(49.59.2,int32) # "longitude" of "hi" second PPoint
14971
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +010014972 We could also extract the intermediary 48.59 field as a binary sample as follows:
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010014973
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +010014974 req.body,ungrpc(48.59)
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010014975
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050014976 As a gRPC message is always made of a gRPC header followed by protocol buffers
Frédéric Lécaillebfe61382019-03-06 14:34:36 +010014977 messages, in the previous example the "latitude" of "lo" first PPoint
14978 could be extracted with these equivalent directives:
14979
14980 req.body,ungrpc(48.59),protobuf(1,int32)
14981 req.body,ungrpc(48),protobuf(59.1,int32)
14982 req.body,ungrpc(48),protobuf(59),protobuf(1,int32)
14983
14984 Note that the first convert must be "ungrpc", the remaining ones must be
14985 "protobuf" and only the last one may have or not a second argument to
14986 interpret the previous binary sample.
14987
Frédéric Lécaille50290fb2019-02-27 14:34:51 +010014988
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010014989unset-var(<var name>)
14990 Unsets a variable if the input content is defined. The name of the variable
14991 starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
14992 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
14993 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
14994 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
14995 response),
14996 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
14997 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
14998 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
14999 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
15000
Willy Tarreau0dbfdba2014-07-10 16:37:47 +020015001utime(<format>[,<offset>])
15002 Converts an integer supposed to contain a date since epoch to a string
15003 representing this date in UTC time using a format defined by the <format>
15004 string using strftime(3). The purpose is to allow any date format to be used
15005 in logs. An optional <offset> in seconds may be applied to the input date
15006 (positive or negative). See the strftime() man page for the format supported
15007 by your operating system. See also the ltime converter.
15008
15009 Example :
15010
15011 # Emit two colons, one with the UTC time and another with ip:port
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015012 # e.g. 20140710162350 127.0.0.1:57325
Willy Tarreau0dbfdba2014-07-10 16:37:47 +020015013 log-format %[date,utime(%Y%m%d%H%M%S)]\ %ci:%cp
15014
Marcin Deranek9631a282018-04-16 14:30:46 +020015015word(<index>,<delimiters>[,<count>])
15016 Extracts the nth word counting from the beginning (positive index) or from
15017 the end (negative index) considering given delimiters from an input string.
15018 Indexes start at 1 or -1 and delimiters are a string formatted list of chars.
Jerome Magnin88209322020-01-28 13:33:44 +010015019 Delimiters at the beginning or end of the input string are ignored.
Marcin Deranek9631a282018-04-16 14:30:46 +020015020 Optionally you can specify <count> of words to extract (default: 1).
15021 Value of 0 indicates extraction of all remaining words.
15022
15023 Example :
15024 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),word(4,_) # f5
15025 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),word(2,_,0) # f2_f3__f5
15026 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),word(3,_,2) # f3__f5
15027 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),word(-2,_,3) # f1_f2_f3
15028 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),word(-3,_,0) # f1_f2
Jerome Magnin88209322020-01-28 13:33:44 +010015029 str(/f1/f2/f3/f4),word(1,/) # f1
Emeric Brunc9a0f6d2014-11-25 14:09:01 +010015030
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020015031wt6([<avalanche>])
15032 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the WT6
15033 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
15034 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
15035 converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
15036 balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
15037 mostly intended for debugging, but can be used as a stick-table entry to
15038 collect rough statistics. It must not be used for security purposes as a
Emmanuel Hocdet50791a72018-03-21 11:19:01 +010015039 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See also "crc32", "djb2", "sdbm", "crc32c",
15040 and the "hash-type" directive.
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020015041
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010015042xor(<value>)
15043 Performs a bitwise "XOR" (exclusive OR) between <value> and the input value
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020015044 of type signed integer, and returns the result as an signed integer.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020015045 <value> can be a numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010015046 starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010015047 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010015048 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
15049 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020015050 response),
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010015051 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
15052 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020015053 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010015054 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010015055
Thierry FOURNIER01e09742016-12-26 11:46:11 +010015056xxh32([<seed>])
15057 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the 32-bit
15058 variant of the XXHash hash function. This hash supports a seed which defaults
15059 to zero but a different value maybe passed as the <seed> argument. This hash
15060 is known to be very good and very fast so it can be used to hash URLs and/or
15061 URL parameters for use as stick-table keys to collect statistics with a low
15062 collision rate, though care must be taken as the algorithm is not considered
15063 as cryptographically secure.
15064
15065xxh64([<seed>])
15066 Hashes a binary input sample into a signed 64-bit quantity using the 64-bit
15067 variant of the XXHash hash function. This hash supports a seed which defaults
15068 to zero but a different value maybe passed as the <seed> argument. This hash
15069 is known to be very good and very fast so it can be used to hash URLs and/or
15070 URL parameters for use as stick-table keys to collect statistics with a low
15071 collision rate, though care must be taken as the algorithm is not considered
15072 as cryptographically secure.
15073
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010015074
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200150757.3.2. Fetching samples from internal states
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015076--------------------------------------------
15077
15078A first set of sample fetch methods applies to internal information which does
15079not even relate to any client information. These ones are sometimes used with
15080"monitor-fail" directives to report an internal status to external watchers.
15081The sample fetch methods described in this section are usable anywhere.
15082
15083always_false : boolean
15084 Always returns the boolean "false" value. It may be used with ACLs as a
15085 temporary replacement for another one when adjusting configurations.
15086
15087always_true : boolean
15088 Always returns the boolean "true" value. It may be used with ACLs as a
15089 temporary replacement for another one when adjusting configurations.
15090
15091avg_queue([<backend>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010015092 Returns the total number of queued connections of the designated backend
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015093 divided by the number of active servers. The current backend is used if no
15094 backend is specified. This is very similar to "queue" except that the size of
15095 the farm is considered, in order to give a more accurate measurement of the
15096 time it may take for a new connection to be processed. The main usage is with
15097 ACL to return a sorry page to new users when it becomes certain they will get
15098 a degraded service, or to pass to the backend servers in a header so that
15099 they decide to work in degraded mode or to disable some functions to speed up
15100 the processing a bit. Note that in the event there would not be any active
15101 server anymore, twice the number of queued connections would be considered as
15102 the measured value. This is a fair estimate, as we expect one server to get
15103 back soon anyway, but we still prefer to send new traffic to another backend
15104 if in better shape. See also the "queue", "be_conn", and "be_sess_rate"
15105 sample fetches.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki346f76d2010-01-12 21:59:30 +010015106
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015107be_conn([<backend>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020015108 Applies to the number of currently established connections on the backend,
15109 possibly including the connection being evaluated. If no backend name is
15110 specified, the current one is used. But it is also possible to check another
15111 backend. It can be used to use a specific farm when the nominal one is full.
Patrick Hemmer4cdf3ab2018-06-14 17:10:27 -040015112 See also the "fe_conn", "queue", "be_conn_free", and "be_sess_rate" criteria.
15113
15114be_conn_free([<backend>]) : integer
15115 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of available connections
15116 across available servers in the backend. Queue slots are not included. Backup
15117 servers are also not included, unless all other servers are down. If no
15118 backend name is specified, the current one is used. But it is also possible
15119 to check another backend. It can be used to use a specific farm when the
Patrick Hemmer155e93e2018-06-14 18:01:35 -040015120 nominal one is full. See also the "be_conn", "connslots", and "srv_conn_free"
15121 criteria.
Patrick Hemmer4cdf3ab2018-06-14 17:10:27 -040015122
15123 OTHER CAVEATS AND NOTES: if any of the server maxconn, or maxqueue is 0
15124 (meaning unlimited), then this fetch clearly does not make sense, in which
15125 case the value returned will be -1.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015126
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015127be_sess_rate([<backend>]) : integer
15128 Returns an integer value corresponding to the sessions creation rate on the
15129 backend, in number of new sessions per second. This is used with ACLs to
15130 switch to an alternate backend when an expensive or fragile one reaches too
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015131 high a session rate, or to limit abuse of service (e.g. prevent sucking of an
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015132 online dictionary). It can also be useful to add this element to logs using a
15133 log-format directive.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010015134
15135 Example :
15136 # Redirect to an error page if the dictionary is requested too often
15137 backend dynamic
15138 mode http
15139 acl being_scanned be_sess_rate gt 100
15140 redirect location /denied.html if being_scanned
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010015141
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015142bin(<hex>) : bin
Thierry FOURNIERcc103292015-06-06 19:30:17 +020015143 Returns a binary chain. The input is the hexadecimal representation
15144 of the string.
15145
15146bool(<bool>) : bool
15147 Returns a boolean value. <bool> can be 'true', 'false', '1' or '0'.
15148 'false' and '0' are the same. 'true' and '1' are the same.
15149
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015150connslots([<backend>]) : integer
15151 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of connection slots
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030015152 still available in the backend, by totaling the maximum amount of
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015153 connections on all servers and the maximum queue size. This is probably only
15154 used with ACLs.
Tait Clarridge7896d522012-12-05 21:39:31 -050015155
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080015156 The basic idea here is to be able to measure the number of connection "slots"
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020015157 still available (connection + queue), so that anything beyond that (intended
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080015158 usage; see "use_backend" keyword) can be redirected to a different backend.
15159
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020015160 'connslots' = number of available server connection slots, + number of
15161 available server queue slots.
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080015162
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020015163 Note that while "fe_conn" may be used, "connslots" comes in especially
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020015164 useful when you have a case of traffic going to one single ip, splitting into
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015165 multiple backends (perhaps using ACLs to do name-based load balancing) and
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020015166 you want to be able to differentiate between different backends, and their
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015167 available "connslots". Also, whereas "nbsrv" only measures servers that are
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015168 actually *down*, this fetch is more fine-grained and looks into the number of
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020015169 available connection slots as well. See also "queue" and "avg_queue".
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080015170
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020015171 OTHER CAVEATS AND NOTES: at this point in time, the code does not take care
15172 of dynamic connections. Also, if any of the server maxconn, or maxqueue is 0,
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015173 then this fetch clearly does not make sense, in which case the value returned
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020015174 will be -1.
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080015175
Willy Tarreau70fe9442018-11-22 16:07:39 +010015176cpu_calls : integer
15177 Returns the number of calls to the task processing the stream or current
15178 request since it was allocated. This number is reset for each new request on
15179 the same connections in case of HTTP keep-alive. This value should usually be
15180 low and stable (around 2 calls for a typically simple request) but may become
15181 high if some processing (compression, caching or analysis) is performed. This
15182 is purely for performance monitoring purposes.
15183
15184cpu_ns_avg : integer
15185 Returns the average number of nanoseconds spent in each call to the task
15186 processing the stream or current request. This number is reset for each new
15187 request on the same connections in case of HTTP keep-alive. This value
15188 indicates the overall cost of processing the request or the connection for
15189 each call. There is no good nor bad value but the time spent in a call
15190 automatically causes latency for other processing (see lat_ns_avg below),
15191 and may affect other connection's apparent response time. Certain operations
15192 like compression, complex regex matching or heavy Lua operations may directly
15193 affect this value, and having it in the logs will make it easier to spot the
15194 faulty processing that needs to be fixed to recover decent performance.
15195 Note: this value is exactly cpu_ns_tot divided by cpu_calls.
15196
15197cpu_ns_tot : integer
15198 Returns the total number of nanoseconds spent in each call to the task
15199 processing the stream or current request. This number is reset for each new
15200 request on the same connections in case of HTTP keep-alive. This value
15201 indicates the overall cost of processing the request or the connection for
15202 each call. There is no good nor bad value but the time spent in a call
15203 automatically causes latency for other processing (see lat_ns_avg below),
15204 induces CPU costs on the machine, and may affect other connection's apparent
15205 response time. Certain operations like compression, complex regex matching or
15206 heavy Lua operations may directly affect this value, and having it in the
15207 logs will make it easier to spot the faulty processing that needs to be fixed
15208 to recover decent performance. The value may be artificially high due to a
15209 high cpu_calls count, for example when processing many HTTP chunks, and for
15210 this reason it is often preferred to log cpu_ns_avg instead.
15211
Cyril Bonté6bcd1822019-11-05 23:13:59 +010015212date([<offset>],[<unit>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau6236d3a2013-07-25 14:28:25 +020015213 Returns the current date as the epoch (number of seconds since 01/01/1970).
Damien Claisseae6f1252019-10-30 15:57:28 +000015214
15215 If an offset value is specified, then it is added to the current date before
15216 returning the value. This is particularly useful to compute relative dates,
15217 as both positive and negative offsets are allowed.
Willy Tarreau276fae92013-07-25 14:36:01 +020015218 It is useful combined with the http_date converter.
15219
Damien Claisseae6f1252019-10-30 15:57:28 +000015220 <unit> is facultative, and can be set to "s" for seconds (default behavior),
15221 "ms" for milliseconds or "us" for microseconds.
15222 If unit is set, return value is an integer reflecting either seconds,
15223 milliseconds or microseconds since epoch, plus offset.
15224 It is useful when a time resolution of less than a second is needed.
15225
Willy Tarreau276fae92013-07-25 14:36:01 +020015226 Example :
15227
15228 # set an expires header to now+1 hour in every response
15229 http-response set-header Expires %[date(3600),http_date]
Willy Tarreau6236d3a2013-07-25 14:28:25 +020015230
Damien Claisseae6f1252019-10-30 15:57:28 +000015231 # set an expires header to now+1 hour in every response, with
15232 # millisecond granularity
15233 http-response set-header Expires %[date(3600000,ms),http_date(0,ms)]
15234
Etienne Carrierea792a0a2018-01-17 13:43:24 +010015235date_us : integer
15236 Return the microseconds part of the date (the "second" part is returned by
15237 date sample). This sample is coherent with the date sample as it is comes
15238 from the same timeval structure.
15239
Willy Tarreaud716f9b2017-10-13 11:03:15 +020015240distcc_body(<token>[,<occ>]) : binary
15241 Parses a distcc message and returns the body associated to occurrence #<occ>
15242 of the token <token>. Occurrences start at 1, and when unspecified, any may
15243 match though in practice only the first one is checked for now. This can be
15244 used to extract file names or arguments in files built using distcc through
15245 haproxy. Please refer to distcc's protocol documentation for the complete
15246 list of supported tokens.
15247
15248distcc_param(<token>[,<occ>]) : integer
15249 Parses a distcc message and returns the parameter associated to occurrence
15250 #<occ> of the token <token>. Occurrences start at 1, and when unspecified,
15251 any may match though in practice only the first one is checked for now. This
15252 can be used to extract certain information such as the protocol version, the
15253 file size or the argument in files built using distcc through haproxy.
15254 Another use case consists in waiting for the start of the preprocessed file
15255 contents before connecting to the server to avoid keeping idle connections.
15256 Please refer to distcc's protocol documentation for the complete list of
15257 supported tokens.
15258
15259 Example :
15260 # wait up to 20s for the pre-processed file to be uploaded
15261 tcp-request inspect-delay 20s
15262 tcp-request content accept if { distcc_param(DOTI) -m found }
15263 # send large files to the big farm
15264 use_backend big_farm if { distcc_param(DOTI) gt 1000000 }
15265
Willy Tarreau595ec542013-06-12 21:34:28 +020015266env(<name>) : string
15267 Returns a string containing the value of environment variable <name>. As a
15268 reminder, environment variables are per-process and are sampled when the
15269 process starts. This can be useful to pass some information to a next hop
15270 server, or with ACLs to take specific action when the process is started a
15271 certain way.
15272
15273 Examples :
15274 # Pass the Via header to next hop with the local hostname in it
15275 http-request add-header Via 1.1\ %[env(HOSTNAME)]
15276
15277 # reject cookie-less requests when the STOP environment variable is set
15278 http-request deny if !{ cook(SESSIONID) -m found } { env(STOP) -m found }
15279
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015280fe_conn([<frontend>]) : integer
15281 Returns the number of currently established connections on the frontend,
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010015282 possibly including the connection being evaluated. If no frontend name is
15283 specified, the current one is used. But it is also possible to check another
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015284 frontend. It can be used to return a sorry page before hard-blocking, or to
15285 use a specific backend to drain new requests when the farm is considered
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015286 full. This is mostly used with ACLs but can also be used to pass some
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015287 statistics to servers in HTTP headers. See also the "dst_conn", "be_conn",
15288 "fe_sess_rate" fetches.
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020015289
Nenad Merdanovicad9a7e92016-10-03 04:57:37 +020015290fe_req_rate([<frontend>]) : integer
15291 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of HTTP requests per
15292 second sent to a frontend. This number can differ from "fe_sess_rate" in
15293 situations where client-side keep-alive is enabled.
15294
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015295fe_sess_rate([<frontend>]) : integer
15296 Returns an integer value corresponding to the sessions creation rate on the
15297 frontend, in number of new sessions per second. This is used with ACLs to
15298 limit the incoming session rate to an acceptable range in order to prevent
15299 abuse of service at the earliest moment, for example when combined with other
15300 layer 4 ACLs in order to force the clients to wait a bit for the rate to go
15301 down below the limit. It can also be useful to add this element to logs using
15302 a log-format directive. See also the "rate-limit sessions" directive for use
15303 in frontends.
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +010015304
15305 Example :
15306 # This frontend limits incoming mails to 10/s with a max of 100
15307 # concurrent connections. We accept any connection below 10/s, and
15308 # force excess clients to wait for 100 ms. Since clients are limited to
15309 # 100 max, there cannot be more than 10 incoming mails per second.
15310 frontend mail
15311 bind :25
15312 mode tcp
15313 maxconn 100
15314 acl too_fast fe_sess_rate ge 10
15315 tcp-request inspect-delay 100ms
15316 tcp-request content accept if ! too_fast
15317 tcp-request content accept if WAIT_END
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010015318
Nenad Merdanovic807a6e72017-03-12 22:00:00 +010015319hostname : string
15320 Returns the system hostname.
15321
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020015322int(<integer>) : signed integer
15323 Returns a signed integer.
15324
Thierry FOURNIERcc103292015-06-06 19:30:17 +020015325ipv4(<ipv4>) : ipv4
15326 Returns an ipv4.
15327
15328ipv6(<ipv6>) : ipv6
15329 Returns an ipv6.
15330
Willy Tarreau70fe9442018-11-22 16:07:39 +010015331lat_ns_avg : integer
15332 Returns the average number of nanoseconds spent between the moment the task
15333 handling the stream is woken up and the moment it is effectively called. This
15334 number is reset for each new request on the same connections in case of HTTP
15335 keep-alive. This value indicates the overall latency inflicted to the current
15336 request by all other requests being processed in parallel, and is a direct
15337 indicator of perceived performance due to noisy neighbours. In order to keep
15338 the value low, it is possible to reduce the scheduler's run queue depth using
15339 "tune.runqueue-depth", to reduce the number of concurrent events processed at
15340 once using "tune.maxpollevents", to decrease the stream's nice value using
15341 the "nice" option on the "bind" lines or in the frontend, or to look for
15342 other heavy requests in logs (those exhibiting large values of "cpu_ns_avg"),
15343 whose processing needs to be adjusted or fixed. Compression of large buffers
15344 could be a culprit, like heavy regex or long lists of regex.
15345 Note: this value is exactly lat_ns_tot divided by cpu_calls.
15346
15347lat_ns_tot : integer
15348 Returns the total number of nanoseconds spent between the moment the task
15349 handling the stream is woken up and the moment it is effectively called. This
15350 number is reset for each new request on the same connections in case of HTTP
15351 keep-alive. This value indicates the overall latency inflicted to the current
15352 request by all other requests being processed in parallel, and is a direct
15353 indicator of perceived performance due to noisy neighbours. In order to keep
15354 the value low, it is possible to reduce the scheduler's run queue depth using
15355 "tune.runqueue-depth", to reduce the number of concurrent events processed at
15356 once using "tune.maxpollevents", to decrease the stream's nice value using
15357 the "nice" option on the "bind" lines or in the frontend, or to look for
15358 other heavy requests in logs (those exhibiting large values of "cpu_ns_avg"),
15359 whose processing needs to be adjusted or fixed. Compression of large buffers
15360 could be a culprit, like heavy regex or long lists of regex. Note: while it
15361 may intuitively seem that the total latency adds to a transfer time, it is
15362 almost never true because while a task waits for the CPU, network buffers
15363 continue to fill up and the next call will process more at once. The value
15364 may be artificially high due to a high cpu_calls count, for example when
15365 processing many HTTP chunks, and for this reason it is often preferred to log
15366 lat_ns_avg instead, which is a more relevant performance indicator.
15367
Thierry FOURNIERcc103292015-06-06 19:30:17 +020015368meth(<method>) : method
15369 Returns a method.
15370
Willy Tarreau0f30d262014-11-24 16:02:05 +010015371nbproc : integer
15372 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of processes that were
15373 started (it equals the global "nbproc" setting). This is useful for logging
15374 and debugging purposes.
15375
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015376nbsrv([<backend>]) : integer
15377 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of usable servers of
15378 either the current backend or the named backend. This is mostly used with
15379 ACLs but can also be useful when added to logs. This is normally used to
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010015380 switch to an alternate backend when the number of servers is too low to
15381 to handle some load. It is useful to report a failure when combined with
15382 "monitor fail".
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +010015383
Patrick Hemmerfabb24f2018-08-13 14:07:57 -040015384prio_class : integer
15385 Returns the priority class of the current session for http mode or connection
15386 for tcp mode. The value will be that set by the last call to "http-request
15387 set-priority-class" or "tcp-request content set-priority-class".
15388
15389prio_offset : integer
15390 Returns the priority offset of the current session for http mode or
15391 connection for tcp mode. The value will be that set by the last call to
15392 "http-request set-priority-offset" or "tcp-request content
15393 set-priority-offset".
15394
Willy Tarreau0f30d262014-11-24 16:02:05 +010015395proc : integer
15396 Returns an integer value corresponding to the position of the process calling
15397 the function, between 1 and global.nbproc. This is useful for logging and
15398 debugging purposes.
15399
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015400queue([<backend>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010015401 Returns the total number of queued connections of the designated backend,
15402 including all the connections in server queues. If no backend name is
15403 specified, the current one is used, but it is also possible to check another
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015404 one. This is useful with ACLs or to pass statistics to backend servers. This
15405 can be used to take actions when queuing goes above a known level, generally
15406 indicating a surge of traffic or a massive slowdown on the servers. One
15407 possible action could be to reject new users but still accept old ones. See
15408 also the "avg_queue", "be_conn", and "be_sess_rate" fetches.
15409
Willy Tarreau84310e22014-02-14 11:59:04 +010015410rand([<range>]) : integer
15411 Returns a random integer value within a range of <range> possible values,
15412 starting at zero. If the range is not specified, it defaults to 2^32, which
15413 gives numbers between 0 and 4294967295. It can be useful to pass some values
15414 needed to take some routing decisions for example, or just for debugging
15415 purposes. This random must not be used for security purposes.
15416
Luca Schimweg8a694b82019-09-10 15:42:52 +020015417uuid([<version>]) : string
15418 Returns a UUID following the RFC4122 standard. If the version is not
15419 specified, a UUID version 4 (fully random) is returned.
15420 Currently, only version 4 is supported.
15421
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015422srv_conn([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
15423 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of currently established
15424 connections on the designated server, possibly including the connection being
15425 evaluated. If <backend> is omitted, then the server is looked up in the
15426 current backend. It can be used to use a specific farm when one server is
15427 full, or to inform the server about our view of the number of active
Patrick Hemmer155e93e2018-06-14 18:01:35 -040015428 connections with it. See also the "fe_conn", "be_conn", "queue", and
15429 "srv_conn_free" fetch methods.
15430
15431srv_conn_free([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
15432 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of available connections
15433 on the designated server, possibly including the connection being evaluated.
15434 The value does not include queue slots. If <backend> is omitted, then the
15435 server is looked up in the current backend. It can be used to use a specific
15436 farm when one server is full, or to inform the server about our view of the
15437 number of active connections with it. See also the "be_conn_free" and
15438 "srv_conn" fetch methods.
15439
15440 OTHER CAVEATS AND NOTES: If the server maxconn is 0, then this fetch clearly
15441 does not make sense, in which case the value returned will be -1.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015442
15443srv_is_up([<backend>/]<server>) : boolean
15444 Returns true when the designated server is UP, and false when it is either
15445 DOWN or in maintenance mode. If <backend> is omitted, then the server is
15446 looked up in the current backend. It is mainly used to take action based on
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015447 an external status reported via a health check (e.g. a geographical site's
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015448 availability). Another possible use which is more of a hack consists in
15449 using dummy servers as boolean variables that can be enabled or disabled from
15450 the CLI, so that rules depending on those ACLs can be tweaked in realtime.
15451
Willy Tarreauff2b7af2017-10-13 11:46:26 +020015452srv_queue([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
15453 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of connections currently
15454 pending in the designated server's queue. If <backend> is omitted, then the
15455 server is looked up in the current backend. It can sometimes be used together
15456 with the "use-server" directive to force to use a known faster server when it
15457 is not much loaded. See also the "srv_conn", "avg_queue" and "queue" sample
15458 fetch methods.
15459
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015460srv_sess_rate([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
15461 Returns an integer corresponding to the sessions creation rate on the
15462 designated server, in number of new sessions per second. If <backend> is
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030015463 omitted, then the server is looked up in the current backend. This is mostly
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015464 used with ACLs but can make sense with logs too. This is used to switch to an
15465 alternate backend when an expensive or fragile one reaches too high a session
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015466 rate, or to limit abuse of service (e.g. prevent latent requests from
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015467 overloading servers).
15468
15469 Example :
15470 # Redirect to a separate back
15471 acl srv1_full srv_sess_rate(be1/srv1) gt 50
15472 acl srv2_full srv_sess_rate(be1/srv2) gt 50
15473 use_backend be2 if srv1_full or srv2_full
15474
Willy Tarreau0f30d262014-11-24 16:02:05 +010015475stopping : boolean
15476 Returns TRUE if the process calling the function is currently stopping. This
15477 can be useful for logging, or for relaxing certain checks or helping close
15478 certain connections upon graceful shutdown.
15479
Thierry FOURNIERcc103292015-06-06 19:30:17 +020015480str(<string>) : string
15481 Returns a string.
15482
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015483table_avl([<table>]) : integer
15484 Returns the total number of available entries in the current proxy's
15485 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. See also table_cnt.
15486
15487table_cnt([<table>]) : integer
15488 Returns the total number of entries currently in use in the current proxy's
15489 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. See also src_conn_cnt and
15490 table_avl for other entry counting methods.
15491
Christopher Faulet34adb2a2017-11-21 21:45:38 +010015492thread : integer
15493 Returns an integer value corresponding to the position of the thread calling
15494 the function, between 0 and (global.nbthread-1). This is useful for logging
15495 and debugging purposes.
15496
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020015497var(<var-name>) : undefined
15498 Returns a variable with the stored type. If the variable is not set, the
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010015499 sample fetch fails. The name of the variable starts with an indication
15500 about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010015501 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010015502 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
15503 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020015504 response),
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010015505 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
15506 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020015507 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010015508 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020015509
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200155107.3.3. Fetching samples at Layer 4
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015511----------------------------------
15512
15513The layer 4 usually describes just the transport layer which in haproxy is
15514closest to the connection, where no content is yet made available. The fetch
15515methods described here are usable as low as the "tcp-request connection" rule
15516sets unless they require some future information. Those generally include
15517TCP/IP addresses and ports, as well as elements from stick-tables related to
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020015518the incoming connection. For retrieving a value from a sticky counters, the
15519counter number can be explicitly set as 0, 1, or 2 using the pre-defined
Moemen MHEDHBI9cf46342018-09-25 17:50:53 +020015520"sc0_", "sc1_", or "sc2_" prefix. These three pre-defined prefixes can only be
15521used if MAX_SESS_STKCTR value does not exceed 3, otherwise the counter number
15522can be specified as the first integer argument when using the "sc_" prefix.
15523Starting from "sc_0" to "sc_N" where N is (MAX_SESS_STKCTR-1). An optional
15524table may be specified with the "sc*" form, in which case the currently
15525tracked key will be looked up into this alternate table instead of the table
15526currently being tracked.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015527
Jérôme Magnin35e53a62019-01-16 14:38:37 +010015528bc_http_major : integer
Jérôme Magnin86577422018-12-07 09:03:11 +010015529 Returns the backend connection's HTTP major version encoding, which may be 1
15530 for HTTP/0.9 to HTTP/1.1 or 2 for HTTP/2. Note, this is based on the on-wire
15531 encoding and not the version present in the request header.
15532
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015533be_id : integer
15534 Returns an integer containing the current backend's id. It can be used in
15535 frontends with responses to check which backend processed the request.
15536
Marcin Deranekd2471c22016-12-12 14:08:05 +010015537be_name : string
15538 Returns a string containing the current backend's name. It can be used in
15539 frontends with responses to check which backend processed the request.
15540
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015541dst : ip
15542 This is the destination IPv4 address of the connection on the client side,
15543 which is the address the client connected to. It can be useful when running
15544 in transparent mode. It is of type IP and works on both IPv4 and IPv6 tables.
15545 On IPv6 tables, IPv4 address is mapped to its IPv6 equivalent, according to
Willy Tarreau64ded3d2019-01-23 10:02:15 +010015546 RFC 4291. When the incoming connection passed through address translation or
15547 redirection involving connection tracking, the original destination address
15548 before the redirection will be reported. On Linux systems, the source and
15549 destination may seldom appear reversed if the nf_conntrack_tcp_loose sysctl
15550 is set, because a late response may reopen a timed out connection and switch
15551 what is believed to be the source and the destination.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015552
15553dst_conn : integer
15554 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of currently established
15555 connections on the same socket including the one being evaluated. It is
15556 normally used with ACLs but can as well be used to pass the information to
15557 servers in an HTTP header or in logs. It can be used to either return a sorry
15558 page before hard-blocking, or to use a specific backend to drain new requests
15559 when the socket is considered saturated. This offers the ability to assign
15560 different limits to different listening ports or addresses. See also the
15561 "fe_conn" and "be_conn" fetches.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010015562
Willy Tarreau16e01562016-08-09 16:46:18 +020015563dst_is_local : boolean
15564 Returns true if the destination address of the incoming connection is local
15565 to the system, or false if the address doesn't exist on the system, meaning
15566 that it was intercepted in transparent mode. It can be useful to apply
15567 certain rules by default to forwarded traffic and other rules to the traffic
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015568 targeting the real address of the machine. For example the stats page could
Willy Tarreau16e01562016-08-09 16:46:18 +020015569 be delivered only on this address, or SSH access could be locally redirected.
15570 Please note that the check involves a few system calls, so it's better to do
15571 it only once per connection.
15572
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015573dst_port : integer
15574 Returns an integer value corresponding to the destination TCP port of the
15575 connection on the client side, which is the port the client connected to.
15576 This might be used when running in transparent mode, when assigning dynamic
15577 ports to some clients for a whole application session, to stick all users to
15578 a same server, or to pass the destination port information to a server using
15579 an HTTP header.
15580
Willy Tarreau60ca10a2017-08-18 15:26:54 +020015581fc_http_major : integer
15582 Reports the front connection's HTTP major version encoding, which may be 1
15583 for HTTP/0.9 to HTTP/1.1 or 2 for HTTP/2. Note, this is based on the on-wire
15584 encoding and not on the version present in the request header.
15585
Geoff Simmons7185b782019-08-27 18:31:16 +020015586fc_pp_authority : string
15587 Returns the authority TLV sent by the client in the PROXY protocol header,
15588 if any.
15589
Tim Duesterhusd1b15b62020-03-13 12:34:23 +010015590fc_pp_unique_id : string
15591 Returns the unique ID TLV sent by the client in the PROXY protocol header,
15592 if any.
15593
Emeric Brun4f603012017-01-05 15:11:44 +010015594fc_rcvd_proxy : boolean
15595 Returns true if the client initiated the connection with a PROXY protocol
15596 header.
15597
Thierry Fournier / OZON.IO6310bef2016-07-24 20:16:50 +020015598fc_rtt(<unit>) : integer
15599 Returns the Round Trip Time (RTT) measured by the kernel for the client
15600 connection. <unit> is facultative, by default the unit is milliseconds. <unit>
15601 can be set to "ms" for milliseconds or "us" for microseconds. If the server
15602 connection is not established, if the connection is not TCP or if the
15603 operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example Linux kernels before
15604 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
15605
15606fc_rttvar(<unit>) : integer
15607 Returns the Round Trip Time (RTT) variance measured by the kernel for the
15608 client connection. <unit> is facultative, by default the unit is milliseconds.
15609 <unit> can be set to "ms" for milliseconds or "us" for microseconds. If the
15610 server connection is not established, if the connection is not TCP or if the
15611 operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example Linux kernels before
15612 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
15613
Christopher Fauletba0c53e2019-10-17 14:40:48 +020015614fc_unacked : integer
Joe Williams30fcd392016-08-10 07:06:44 -070015615 Returns the unacked counter measured by the kernel for the client connection.
15616 If the server connection is not established, if the connection is not TCP or
15617 if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example Linux kernels
15618 before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
15619
Christopher Fauletba0c53e2019-10-17 14:40:48 +020015620fc_sacked : integer
Joe Williams30fcd392016-08-10 07:06:44 -070015621 Returns the sacked counter measured by the kernel for the client connection.
15622 If the server connection is not established, if the connection is not TCP or
15623 if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example Linux kernels
15624 before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
15625
Christopher Fauletba0c53e2019-10-17 14:40:48 +020015626fc_retrans : integer
Joe Williams30fcd392016-08-10 07:06:44 -070015627 Returns the retransmits counter measured by the kernel for the client
15628 connection. If the server connection is not established, if the connection is
15629 not TCP or if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example
15630 Linux kernels before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
15631
Christopher Fauletba0c53e2019-10-17 14:40:48 +020015632fc_fackets : integer
Joe Williams30fcd392016-08-10 07:06:44 -070015633 Returns the fack counter measured by the kernel for the client
15634 connection. If the server connection is not established, if the connection is
15635 not TCP or if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example
15636 Linux kernels before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
15637
Christopher Fauletba0c53e2019-10-17 14:40:48 +020015638fc_lost : integer
Joe Williams30fcd392016-08-10 07:06:44 -070015639 Returns the lost counter measured by the kernel for the client
15640 connection. If the server connection is not established, if the connection is
15641 not TCP or if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example
15642 Linux kernels before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
15643
Christopher Fauletba0c53e2019-10-17 14:40:48 +020015644fc_reordering : integer
Joe Williams30fcd392016-08-10 07:06:44 -070015645 Returns the reordering counter measured by the kernel for the client
15646 connection. If the server connection is not established, if the connection is
15647 not TCP or if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example
15648 Linux kernels before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
15649
Marcin Deranek9a66dfb2018-04-13 14:37:50 +020015650fe_defbe : string
15651 Returns a string containing the frontend's default backend name. It can be
15652 used in frontends to check which backend will handle requests by default.
15653
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015654fe_id : integer
15655 Returns an integer containing the current frontend's id. It can be used in
Marcin Deranek6e413ed2016-12-13 12:40:01 +010015656 backends to check from which frontend it was called, or to stick all users
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015657 coming via a same frontend to the same server.
15658
Marcin Deranekd2471c22016-12-12 14:08:05 +010015659fe_name : string
15660 Returns a string containing the current frontend's name. It can be used in
15661 backends to check from which frontend it was called, or to stick all users
15662 coming via a same frontend to the same server.
15663
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020015664sc_bytes_in_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020015665sc0_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
15666sc1_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
15667sc2_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020015668 Returns the average client-to-server bytes rate from the currently tracked
15669 counters, measured in amount of bytes over the period configured in the
15670 table. See also src_bytes_in_rate.
15671
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020015672sc_bytes_out_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020015673sc0_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
15674sc1_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
15675sc2_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020015676 Returns the average server-to-client bytes rate from the currently tracked
15677 counters, measured in amount of bytes over the period configured in the
15678 table. See also src_bytes_out_rate.
15679
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020015680sc_clr_gpc0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020015681sc0_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
15682sc1_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
15683sc2_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020015684 Clears the first General Purpose Counter associated to the currently tracked
15685 counters, and returns its previous value. Before the first invocation, the
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010015686 stored value is zero, so first invocation will always return zero. This is
15687 typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection
15688 when a first ACL was verified :
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020015689
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030015690 Example:
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020015691 # block if 5 consecutive requests continue to come faster than 10 sess
15692 # per second, and reset the counter as soon as the traffic slows down.
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020015693 acl abuse sc0_http_req_rate gt 10
15694 acl kill sc0_inc_gpc0 gt 5
15695 acl save sc0_clr_gpc0 ge 0
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020015696 tcp-request connection accept if !abuse save
15697 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
15698
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010015699sc_clr_gpc1(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
15700sc0_clr_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
15701sc1_clr_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
15702sc2_clr_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
15703 Clears the second General Purpose Counter associated to the currently tracked
15704 counters, and returns its previous value. Before the first invocation, the
15705 stored value is zero, so first invocation will always return zero. This is
15706 typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection
15707 when a first ACL was verified.
15708
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020015709sc_conn_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020015710sc0_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
15711sc1_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
15712sc2_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015713 Returns the cumulative number of incoming connections from currently tracked
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020015714 counters. See also src_conn_cnt.
15715
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020015716sc_conn_cur(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020015717sc0_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
15718sc1_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
15719sc2_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020015720 Returns the current amount of concurrent connections tracking the same
15721 tracked counters. This number is automatically incremented when tracking
15722 begins and decremented when tracking stops. See also src_conn_cur.
15723
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020015724sc_conn_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020015725sc0_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
15726sc1_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
15727sc2_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020015728 Returns the average connection rate from the currently tracked counters,
15729 measured in amount of connections over the period configured in the table.
15730 See also src_conn_rate.
15731
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020015732sc_get_gpc0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020015733sc0_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
15734sc1_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
15735sc2_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020015736 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Counter associated to the
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020015737 currently tracked counters. See also src_get_gpc0 and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc0.
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020015738
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010015739sc_get_gpc1(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
15740sc0_get_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
15741sc1_get_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
15742sc2_get_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
15743 Returns the value of the second General Purpose Counter associated to the
15744 currently tracked counters. See also src_get_gpc1 and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc1.
15745
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020015746sc_get_gpt0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
15747sc0_get_gpt0([<table>]) : integer
15748sc1_get_gpt0([<table>]) : integer
15749sc2_get_gpt0([<table>]) : integer
15750 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Tag associated to the
15751 currently tracked counters. See also src_get_gpt0.
15752
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020015753sc_gpc0_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020015754sc0_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
15755sc1_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
15756sc2_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020015757 Returns the average increment rate of the first General Purpose Counter
15758 associated to the currently tracked counters. It reports the frequency
15759 which the gpc0 counter was incremented over the configured period. See also
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020015760 src_gpc0_rate, sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpc0, and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc0. Note
15761 that the "gpc0_rate" counter must be stored in the stick-table for a value to
15762 be returned, as "gpc0" only holds the event count.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020015763
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010015764sc_gpc1_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
15765sc0_gpc1_rate([<table>]) : integer
15766sc1_gpc1_rate([<table>]) : integer
15767sc2_gpc1_rate([<table>]) : integer
15768 Returns the average increment rate of the second General Purpose Counter
15769 associated to the currently tracked counters. It reports the frequency
15770 which the gpc1 counter was incremented over the configured period. See also
15771 src_gpcA_rate, sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpc1, and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc1. Note
15772 that the "gpc1_rate" counter must be stored in the stick-table for a value to
15773 be returned, as "gpc1" only holds the event count.
15774
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020015775sc_http_err_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020015776sc0_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
15777sc1_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
15778sc2_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015779 Returns the cumulative number of HTTP errors from the currently tracked
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020015780 counters. This includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses.
15781 See also src_http_err_cnt.
15782
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020015783sc_http_err_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020015784sc0_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
15785sc1_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
15786sc2_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020015787 Returns the average rate of HTTP errors from the currently tracked counters,
15788 measured in amount of errors over the period configured in the table. This
15789 includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses. See also
15790 src_http_err_rate.
15791
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020015792sc_http_req_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020015793sc0_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
15794sc1_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
15795sc2_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015796 Returns the cumulative number of HTTP requests from the currently tracked
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020015797 counters. This includes every started request, valid or not. See also
15798 src_http_req_cnt.
15799
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020015800sc_http_req_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020015801sc0_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
15802sc1_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
15803sc2_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020015804 Returns the average rate of HTTP requests from the currently tracked
15805 counters, measured in amount of requests over the period configured in
15806 the table. This includes every started request, valid or not. See also
15807 src_http_req_rate.
15808
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020015809sc_inc_gpc0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020015810sc0_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
15811sc1_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
15812sc2_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020015813 Increments the first General Purpose Counter associated to the currently
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010015814 tracked counters, and returns its new value. Before the first invocation,
15815 the stored value is zero, so first invocation will increase it to 1 and will
15816 return 1. This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order
15817 to mark a connection when a first ACL was verified :
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020015818
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030015819 Example:
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020015820 acl abuse sc0_http_req_rate gt 10
15821 acl kill sc0_inc_gpc0 gt 0
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020015822 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
15823
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010015824sc_inc_gpc1(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
15825sc0_inc_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
15826sc1_inc_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
15827sc2_inc_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
15828 Increments the second General Purpose Counter associated to the currently
15829 tracked counters, and returns its new value. Before the first invocation,
15830 the stored value is zero, so first invocation will increase it to 1 and will
15831 return 1. This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order
15832 to mark a connection when a first ACL was verified.
15833
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020015834sc_kbytes_in(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020015835sc0_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
15836sc1_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
15837sc2_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020015838 Returns the total amount of client-to-server data from the currently tracked
15839 counters, measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit
15840 integers, which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also src_kbytes_in.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020015841
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020015842sc_kbytes_out(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020015843sc0_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
15844sc1_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
15845sc2_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020015846 Returns the total amount of server-to-client data from the currently tracked
15847 counters, measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit
15848 integers, which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also src_kbytes_out.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020015849
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020015850sc_sess_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020015851sc0_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
15852sc1_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
15853sc2_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015854 Returns the cumulative number of incoming connections that were transformed
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020015855 into sessions, which means that they were accepted by a "tcp-request
15856 connection" rule, from the currently tracked counters. A backend may count
15857 more sessions than connections because each connection could result in many
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040015858 backend sessions if some HTTP keep-alive is performed over the connection
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020015859 with the client. See also src_sess_cnt.
15860
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020015861sc_sess_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020015862sc0_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
15863sc1_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
15864sc2_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020015865 Returns the average session rate from the currently tracked counters,
15866 measured in amount of sessions over the period configured in the table. A
15867 session is a connection that got past the early "tcp-request connection"
15868 rules. A backend may count more sessions than connections because each
15869 connection could result in many backend sessions if some HTTP keep-alive is
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040015870 performed over the connection with the client. See also src_sess_rate.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020015871
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020015872sc_tracked(<ctr>[,<table>]) : boolean
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020015873sc0_tracked([<table>]) : boolean
15874sc1_tracked([<table>]) : boolean
15875sc2_tracked([<table>]) : boolean
Willy Tarreau6f1615f2013-06-03 15:15:22 +020015876 Returns true if the designated session counter is currently being tracked by
15877 the current session. This can be useful when deciding whether or not we want
15878 to set some values in a header passed to the server.
15879
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020015880sc_trackers(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020015881sc0_trackers([<table>]) : integer
15882sc1_trackers([<table>]) : integer
15883sc2_trackers([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau2406db42012-12-09 12:16:43 +010015884 Returns the current amount of concurrent connections tracking the same
15885 tracked counters. This number is automatically incremented when tracking
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020015886 begins and decremented when tracking stops. It differs from sc0_conn_cur in
Willy Tarreau2406db42012-12-09 12:16:43 +010015887 that it does not rely on any stored information but on the table's reference
15888 count (the "use" value which is returned by "show table" on the CLI). This
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015889 may sometimes be more suited for layer7 tracking. It can be used to tell a
15890 server how many concurrent connections there are from a given address for
15891 example.
Willy Tarreau2406db42012-12-09 12:16:43 +010015892
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015893so_id : integer
15894 Returns an integer containing the current listening socket's id. It is useful
15895 in frontends involving many "bind" lines, or to stick all users coming via a
15896 same socket to the same server.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010015897
Jerome Magnineb421b22020-03-27 22:08:40 +010015898so_name : string
15899 Returns a string containing the current listening socket's name, as defined
15900 with name on a "bind" line. It can serve the same purposes as so_id but with
15901 strings instead of integers.
15902
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015903src : ip
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015904 This is the source IPv4 address of the client of the session. It is of type
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015905 IP and works on both IPv4 and IPv6 tables. On IPv6 tables, IPv4 addresses are
15906 mapped to their IPv6 equivalent, according to RFC 4291. Note that it is the
15907 TCP-level source address which is used, and not the address of a client
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010015908 behind a proxy. However if the "accept-proxy" or "accept-netscaler-cip" bind
15909 directive is used, it can be the address of a client behind another
15910 PROXY-protocol compatible component for all rule sets except
Willy Tarreau64ded3d2019-01-23 10:02:15 +010015911 "tcp-request connection" which sees the real address. When the incoming
15912 connection passed through address translation or redirection involving
15913 connection tracking, the original destination address before the redirection
15914 will be reported. On Linux systems, the source and destination may seldom
15915 appear reversed if the nf_conntrack_tcp_loose sysctl is set, because a late
15916 response may reopen a timed out connection and switch what is believed to be
15917 the source and the destination.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010015918
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010015919 Example:
15920 # add an HTTP header in requests with the originating address' country
15921 http-request set-header X-Country %[src,map_ip(geoip.lst)]
15922
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015923src_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
15924 Returns the average bytes rate from the incoming connection's source address
15925 in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table, measured
15926 in amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020015927 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_bytes_in_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015928
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015929src_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
15930 Returns the average bytes rate to the incoming connection's source address in
15931 the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table, measured in
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015932 amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020015933 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_bytes_out_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015934
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015935src_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
15936 Clears the first General Purpose Counter associated to the incoming
15937 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
15938 designated stick-table, and returns its previous value. If the address is not
15939 found, an entry is created and 0 is returned. This is typically used as a
15940 second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection when a first ACL
15941 was verified :
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020015942
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030015943 Example:
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020015944 # block if 5 consecutive requests continue to come faster than 10 sess
15945 # per second, and reset the counter as soon as the traffic slows down.
15946 acl abuse src_http_req_rate gt 10
15947 acl kill src_inc_gpc0 gt 5
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010015948 acl save src_clr_gpc0 ge 0
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020015949 tcp-request connection accept if !abuse save
15950 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
15951
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010015952src_clr_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
15953 Clears the second General Purpose Counter associated to the incoming
15954 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
15955 designated stick-table, and returns its previous value. If the address is not
15956 found, an entry is created and 0 is returned. This is typically used as a
15957 second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection when a first ACL
15958 was verified.
15959
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015960src_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015961 Returns the cumulative number of connections initiated from the current
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015962 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015963 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020015964 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_conn_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015965
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015966src_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015967 Returns the current amount of concurrent connections initiated from the
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015968 current incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's
15969 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. If the address is not found,
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020015970 zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_conn_cur.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015971
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015972src_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
15973 Returns the average connection rate from the incoming connection's source
15974 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
15975 measured in amount of connections over the period configured in the table. If
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020015976 the address is not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_conn_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015977
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015978src_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015979 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Counter associated to the
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015980 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015981 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020015982 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpc0 and src_inc_gpc0.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015983
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010015984src_get_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
15985 Returns the value of the second General Purpose Counter associated to the
15986 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
15987 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
15988 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpc1 and src_inc_gpc1.
15989
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020015990src_get_gpt0([<table>]) : integer
15991 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Tag associated to the
15992 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
15993 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
15994 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpt0.
15995
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015996src_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020015997 Returns the average increment rate of the first General Purpose Counter
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015998 associated to the incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020015999 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. It reports the frequency
16000 which the gpc0 counter was incremented over the configured period. See also
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020016001 sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_gpc0_rate, src_get_gpc0, and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc0. Note
16002 that the "gpc0_rate" counter must be stored in the stick-table for a value to
16003 be returned, as "gpc0" only holds the event count.
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020016004
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010016005src_gpc1_rate([<table>]) : integer
16006 Returns the average increment rate of the second General Purpose Counter
16007 associated to the incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's
16008 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. It reports the frequency
16009 which the gpc1 counter was incremented over the configured period. See also
16010 sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_gpc1_rate, src_get_gpc1, and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc1. Note
16011 that the "gpc1_rate" counter must be stored in the stick-table for a value to
16012 be returned, as "gpc1" only holds the event count.
16013
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016014src_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016015 Returns the cumulative number of HTTP errors from the incoming connection's
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016016 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020016017 stick-table. This includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses.
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020016018 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_err_cnt. If the address is not found, zero is
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016019 returned.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020016020
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016021src_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
16022 Returns the average rate of HTTP errors from the incoming connection's source
16023 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
16024 measured in amount of errors over the period configured in the table. This
16025 includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020016026 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_err_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020016027
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016028src_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016029 Returns the cumulative number of HTTP requests from the incoming connection's
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016030 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-
16031 table. This includes every started request, valid or not. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020016032 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_req_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020016033
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016034src_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
16035 Returns the average rate of HTTP requests from the incoming connection's
16036 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-
16037 table, measured in amount of requests over the period configured in the
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020016038 table. This includes every started request, valid or not. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020016039 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_req_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020016040
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016041src_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
16042 Increments the first General Purpose Counter associated to the incoming
16043 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
16044 designated stick-table, and returns its new value. If the address is not
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020016045 found, an entry is created and 1 is returned. See also sc0/sc2/sc2_inc_gpc0.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016046 This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a
16047 connection when a first ACL was verified :
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020016048
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030016049 Example:
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020016050 acl abuse src_http_req_rate gt 10
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010016051 acl kill src_inc_gpc0 gt 0
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020016052 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020016053
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010016054src_inc_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
16055 Increments the second General Purpose Counter associated to the incoming
16056 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
16057 designated stick-table, and returns its new value. If the address is not
16058 found, an entry is created and 1 is returned. See also sc0/sc2/sc2_inc_gpc1.
16059 This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a
16060 connection when a first ACL was verified.
16061
Willy Tarreau16e01562016-08-09 16:46:18 +020016062src_is_local : boolean
16063 Returns true if the source address of the incoming connection is local to the
16064 system, or false if the address doesn't exist on the system, meaning that it
16065 comes from a remote machine. Note that UNIX addresses are considered local.
16066 It can be useful to apply certain access restrictions based on where the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016067 client comes from (e.g. require auth or https for remote machines). Please
Willy Tarreau16e01562016-08-09 16:46:18 +020016068 note that the check involves a few system calls, so it's better to do it only
16069 once per connection.
16070
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016071src_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020016072 Returns the total amount of data received from the incoming connection's
16073 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated
16074 stick-table, measured in kilobytes. If the address is not found, zero is
16075 returned. The test is currently performed on 32-bit integers, which limits
16076 values to 4 terabytes. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_kbytes_in.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020016077
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016078src_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020016079 Returns the total amount of data sent to the incoming connection's source
16080 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
16081 measured in kilobytes. If the address is not found, zero is returned. The
16082 test is currently performed on 32-bit integers, which limits values to 4
16083 terabytes. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_kbytes_out.
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +020016084
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016085src_port : integer
16086 Returns an integer value corresponding to the TCP source port of the
16087 connection on the client side, which is the port the client connected from.
16088 Usage of this function is very limited as modern protocols do not care much
16089 about source ports nowadays.
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +010016090
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016091src_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016092 Returns the cumulative number of connections initiated from the incoming
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020016093 connection's source IPv4 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
16094 designated stick-table, that were transformed into sessions, which means that
16095 they were accepted by "tcp-request" rules. If the address is not found, zero
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020016096 is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_sess_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020016097
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016098src_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
16099 Returns the average session rate from the incoming connection's source
16100 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
16101 measured in amount of sessions over the period configured in the table. A
16102 session is a connection that went past the early "tcp-request" rules. If the
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020016103 address is not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_sess_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020016104
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016105src_updt_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
16106 Creates or updates the entry associated to the incoming connection's source
16107 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table.
16108 This table must be configured to store the "conn_cnt" data type, otherwise
16109 the match will be ignored. The current count is incremented by one, and the
16110 expiration timer refreshed. The updated count is returned, so this match
16111 can't return zero. This was used to reject service abusers based on their
16112 source address. Note: it is recommended to use the more complete "track-sc*"
16113 actions in "tcp-request" rules instead.
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +020016114
16115 Example :
16116 # This frontend limits incoming SSH connections to 3 per 10 second for
16117 # each source address, and rejects excess connections until a 10 second
16118 # silence is observed. At most 20 addresses are tracked.
16119 listen ssh
16120 bind :22
16121 mode tcp
16122 maxconn 100
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020016123 stick-table type ip size 20 expire 10s store conn_cnt
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016124 tcp-request content reject if { src_updt_conn_cnt gt 3 }
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +020016125 server local 127.0.0.1:22
16126
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016127srv_id : integer
16128 Returns an integer containing the server's id when processing the response.
16129 While it's almost only used with ACLs, it may be used for logging or
16130 debugging.
Hervé COMMOWICKdaa824e2011-08-05 12:09:44 +020016131
vkill1dfd1652019-10-30 16:58:14 +080016132srv_name : string
16133 Returns a string containing the server's name when processing the response.
16134 While it's almost only used with ACLs, it may be used for logging or
16135 debugging.
16136
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200161377.3.4. Fetching samples at Layer 5
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016138----------------------------------
Willy Tarreau0b1cd942010-05-16 22:18:27 +020016139
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016140The layer 5 usually describes just the session layer which in haproxy is
16141closest to the session once all the connection handshakes are finished, but
16142when no content is yet made available. The fetch methods described here are
16143usable as low as the "tcp-request content" rule sets unless they require some
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030016144future information. Those generally include the results of SSL negotiations.
Willy Tarreauc735a072011-03-29 00:57:02 +020016145
Ben Shillitof25e8e52016-12-02 14:25:37 +00001614651d.all(<prop>[,<prop>*]) : string
16147 Returns values for the properties requested as a string, where values are
16148 separated by the delimiter specified with "51degrees-property-separator".
16149 The device is identified using all the important HTTP headers from the
16150 request. The function can be passed up to five property names, and if a
16151 property name can't be found, the value "NoData" is returned.
16152
16153 Example :
16154 # Here the header "X-51D-DeviceTypeMobileTablet" is added to the request
16155 # containing the three properties requested using all relevant headers from
16156 # the request.
16157 frontend http-in
16158 bind *:8081
16159 default_backend servers
16160 http-request set-header X-51D-DeviceTypeMobileTablet \
16161 %[51d.all(DeviceType,IsMobile,IsTablet)]
16162
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020016163ssl_bc : boolean
16164 Returns true when the back connection was made via an SSL/TLS transport
16165 layer and is locally deciphered. This means the outgoing connection was made
16166 other a server with the "ssl" option.
16167
16168ssl_bc_alg_keysize : integer
16169 Returns the symmetric cipher key size supported in bits when the outgoing
16170 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
16171
Olivier Houchard6b77f492018-11-22 18:18:29 +010016172ssl_bc_alpn : string
16173 This extracts the Application Layer Protocol Negotiation field from an
16174 outgoing connection made via a TLS transport layer.
Michael Prokop4438c602019-05-24 10:25:45 +020016175 The result is a string containing the protocol name negotiated with the
Olivier Houchard6b77f492018-11-22 18:18:29 +010016176 server. The SSL library must have been built with support for TLS
16177 extensions enabled (check haproxy -vv). Note that the TLS ALPN extension is
16178 not advertised unless the "alpn" keyword on the "server" line specifies a
16179 protocol list. Also, nothing forces the server to pick a protocol from this
16180 list, any other one may be requested. The TLS ALPN extension is meant to
16181 replace the TLS NPN extension. See also "ssl_bc_npn".
16182
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020016183ssl_bc_cipher : string
16184 Returns the name of the used cipher when the outgoing connection was made
16185 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
16186
Patrick Hemmer65674662019-06-04 08:13:03 -040016187ssl_bc_client_random : binary
16188 Returns the client random of the back connection when the incoming connection
16189 was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to to decrypt traffic
16190 sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or BoringSSL.
16191
Emeric Brun74f7ffa2018-02-19 16:14:12 +010016192ssl_bc_is_resumed : boolean
16193 Returns true when the back connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
16194 layer and the newly created SSL session was resumed using a cached
16195 session or a TLS ticket.
16196
Olivier Houchard6b77f492018-11-22 18:18:29 +010016197ssl_bc_npn : string
16198 This extracts the Next Protocol Negotiation field from an outgoing connection
16199 made via a TLS transport layer. The result is a string containing the
Michael Prokop4438c602019-05-24 10:25:45 +020016200 protocol name negotiated with the server . The SSL library must have been
Olivier Houchard6b77f492018-11-22 18:18:29 +010016201 built with support for TLS extensions enabled (check haproxy -vv). Note that
16202 the TLS NPN extension is not advertised unless the "npn" keyword on the
16203 "server" line specifies a protocol list. Also, nothing forces the server to
16204 pick a protocol from this list, any other one may be used. Please note that
16205 the TLS NPN extension was replaced with ALPN.
16206
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020016207ssl_bc_protocol : string
16208 Returns the name of the used protocol when the outgoing connection was made
16209 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
16210
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020016211ssl_bc_unique_id : binary
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020016212 When the outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020016213 returns the TLS unique ID as defined in RFC5929 section 3. The unique id
16214 can be encoded to base64 using the converter: "ssl_bc_unique_id,base64".
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020016215
Patrick Hemmer65674662019-06-04 08:13:03 -040016216ssl_bc_server_random : binary
16217 Returns the server random of the back connection when the incoming connection
16218 was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to to decrypt traffic
16219 sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or BoringSSL.
16220
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020016221ssl_bc_session_id : binary
16222 Returns the SSL ID of the back connection when the outgoing connection was
16223 made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to log if we want to know
16224 if session was reused or not.
16225
Patrick Hemmere0275472018-04-28 19:15:51 -040016226ssl_bc_session_key : binary
16227 Returns the SSL session master key of the back connection when the outgoing
16228 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to decrypt
16229 traffic sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or
16230 BoringSSL.
16231
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020016232ssl_bc_use_keysize : integer
16233 Returns the symmetric cipher key size used in bits when the outgoing
16234 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
16235
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016236ssl_c_ca_err : integer
16237 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
16238 returns the ID of the first error detected during verification of the client
16239 certificate at depth > 0, or 0 if no error was encountered during this
16240 verification process. Please refer to your SSL library's documentation to
16241 find the exhaustive list of error codes.
Willy Tarreauc735a072011-03-29 00:57:02 +020016242
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016243ssl_c_ca_err_depth : integer
16244 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
16245 returns the depth in the CA chain of the first error detected during the
16246 verification of the client certificate. If no error is encountered, 0 is
16247 returned.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010016248
Emeric Brun43e79582014-10-29 19:03:26 +010016249ssl_c_der : binary
16250 Returns the DER formatted certificate presented by the client when the
16251 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
16252 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
16253
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016254ssl_c_err : integer
16255 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
16256 returns the ID of the first error detected during verification at depth 0, or
16257 0 if no error was encountered during this verification process. Please refer
16258 to your SSL library's documentation to find the exhaustive list of error
16259 codes.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020016260
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050016261ssl_c_i_dn([<entry>[,<occ>[,<format>]]]) : string
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016262 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
16263 returns the full distinguished name of the issuer of the certificate
16264 presented by the client when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
16265 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
16266 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
16267 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
16268 For instance, "ssl_c_i_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
16269 "ssl_c_i_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050016270 The <format> parameter allows you to receive the DN suitable for
16271 consumption by different protocols. Currently supported is rfc2253 for
16272 LDAP v3.
16273 If you'd like to modify the format only you can specify an empty string
16274 and zero for the first two parameters. Example: ssl_c_i_dn(,0,rfc2253)
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020016275
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016276ssl_c_key_alg : string
16277 Returns the name of the algorithm used to generate the key of the certificate
16278 presented by the client when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
16279 transport layer.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020016280
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016281ssl_c_notafter : string
16282 Returns the end date presented by the client as a formatted string
16283 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
16284 transport layer.
Emeric Brunbede3d02009-06-30 17:54:00 +020016285
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016286ssl_c_notbefore : string
16287 Returns the start date presented by the client as a formatted string
16288 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
16289 transport layer.
Willy Tarreaub6672b52011-12-12 17:23:41 +010016290
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050016291ssl_c_s_dn([<entry>[,<occ>[,<format>]]]) : string
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016292 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
16293 returns the full distinguished name of the subject of the certificate
16294 presented by the client when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
16295 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
16296 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
16297 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
16298 For instance, "ssl_c_s_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
16299 "ssl_c_s_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050016300 The <format> parameter allows you to receive the DN suitable for
16301 consumption by different protocols. Currently supported is rfc2253 for
16302 LDAP v3.
16303 If you'd like to modify the format only you can specify an empty string
16304 and zero for the first two parameters. Example: ssl_c_s_dn(,0,rfc2253)
Willy Tarreaub6672b52011-12-12 17:23:41 +010016305
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016306ssl_c_serial : binary
16307 Returns the serial of the certificate presented by the client when the
16308 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
16309 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020016310
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016311ssl_c_sha1 : binary
16312 Returns the SHA-1 fingerprint of the certificate presented by the client when
16313 the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. This can be
16314 used to stick a client to a server, or to pass this information to a server.
Willy Tarreau2d0caa32014-07-02 19:01:22 +020016315 Note that the output is binary, so if you want to pass that signature to the
16316 server, you need to encode it in hex or base64, such as in the example below:
16317
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030016318 Example:
Willy Tarreau2d0caa32014-07-02 19:01:22 +020016319 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-SHA1 %[ssl_c_sha1,hex]
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020016320
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016321ssl_c_sig_alg : string
16322 Returns the name of the algorithm used to sign the certificate presented by
16323 the client when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
16324 layer.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020016325
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016326ssl_c_used : boolean
16327 Returns true if current SSL session uses a client certificate even if current
16328 connection uses SSL session resumption. See also "ssl_fc_has_crt".
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +020016329
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016330ssl_c_verify : integer
16331 Returns the verify result error ID when the incoming connection was made over
16332 an SSL/TLS transport layer, otherwise zero if no error is encountered. Please
16333 refer to your SSL library's documentation for an exhaustive list of error
16334 codes.
Emeric Brunce5ad802012-10-22 14:11:22 +020016335
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016336ssl_c_version : integer
16337 Returns the version of the certificate presented by the client when the
16338 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Emeric Brunce5ad802012-10-22 14:11:22 +020016339
Emeric Brun43e79582014-10-29 19:03:26 +010016340ssl_f_der : binary
16341 Returns the DER formatted certificate presented by the frontend when the
16342 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
16343 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
16344
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050016345ssl_f_i_dn([<entry>[,<occ>[,<format>]]]) : string
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016346 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
16347 returns the full distinguished name of the issuer of the certificate
16348 presented by the frontend when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
16349 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020016350 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016351 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
16352 For instance, "ssl_f_i_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
16353 "ssl_f_i_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050016354 The <format> parameter allows you to receive the DN suitable for
16355 consumption by different protocols. Currently supported is rfc2253 for
16356 LDAP v3.
16357 If you'd like to modify the format only you can specify an empty string
16358 and zero for the first two parameters. Example: ssl_f_i_dn(,0,rfc2253)
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020016359
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016360ssl_f_key_alg : string
16361 Returns the name of the algorithm used to generate the key of the certificate
16362 presented by the frontend when the incoming connection was made over an
16363 SSL/TLS transport layer.
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +020016364
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016365ssl_f_notafter : string
16366 Returns the end date presented by the frontend as a formatted string
16367 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
16368 transport layer.
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020016369
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016370ssl_f_notbefore : string
16371 Returns the start date presented by the frontend as a formatted string
16372 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
16373 transport layer.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020016374
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050016375ssl_f_s_dn([<entry>[,<occ>[,<format>]]]) : string
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016376 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
16377 returns the full distinguished name of the subject of the certificate
16378 presented by the frontend when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
16379 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
16380 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
16381 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
16382 For instance, "ssl_f_s_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
16383 "ssl_f_s_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050016384 The <format> parameter allows you to receive the DN suitable for
16385 consumption by different protocols. Currently supported is rfc2253 for
16386 LDAP v3.
16387 If you'd like to modify the format only you can specify an empty string
16388 and zero for the first two parameters. Example: ssl_f_s_dn(,0,rfc2253)
Emeric Brunce5ad802012-10-22 14:11:22 +020016389
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016390ssl_f_serial : binary
16391 Returns the serial of the certificate presented by the frontend when the
16392 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
16393 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020016394
Emeric Brun55f4fa82014-04-30 17:11:25 +020016395ssl_f_sha1 : binary
16396 Returns the SHA-1 fingerprint of the certificate presented by the frontend
16397 when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. This
16398 can be used to know which certificate was chosen using SNI.
16399
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016400ssl_f_sig_alg : string
16401 Returns the name of the algorithm used to sign the certificate presented by
16402 the frontend when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
16403 layer.
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +020016404
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016405ssl_f_version : integer
16406 Returns the version of the certificate presented by the frontend when the
16407 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
16408
16409ssl_fc : boolean
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020016410 Returns true when the front connection was made via an SSL/TLS transport
16411 layer and is locally deciphered. This means it has matched a socket declared
16412 with a "bind" line having the "ssl" option.
16413
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016414 Example :
16415 # This passes "X-Proto: https" to servers when client connects over SSL
16416 listen http-https
16417 bind :80
16418 bind :443 ssl crt /etc/haproxy.pem
16419 http-request add-header X-Proto https if { ssl_fc }
16420
16421ssl_fc_alg_keysize : integer
16422 Returns the symmetric cipher key size supported in bits when the incoming
16423 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
16424
16425ssl_fc_alpn : string
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030016426 This extracts the Application Layer Protocol Negotiation field from an
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016427 incoming connection made via a TLS transport layer and locally deciphered by
16428 haproxy. The result is a string containing the protocol name advertised by
16429 the client. The SSL library must have been built with support for TLS
16430 extensions enabled (check haproxy -vv). Note that the TLS ALPN extension is
16431 not advertised unless the "alpn" keyword on the "bind" line specifies a
16432 protocol list. Also, nothing forces the client to pick a protocol from this
16433 list, any other one may be requested. The TLS ALPN extension is meant to
16434 replace the TLS NPN extension. See also "ssl_fc_npn".
16435
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016436ssl_fc_cipher : string
16437 Returns the name of the used cipher when the incoming connection was made
16438 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020016439
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010016440ssl_fc_cipherlist_bin : binary
16441 Returns the binary form of the client hello cipher list. The maximum returned
16442 value length is according with the value of
Emmanuel Hocdetaaee7502017-03-07 18:34:58 +010016443 "tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size".
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010016444
16445ssl_fc_cipherlist_hex : string
16446 Returns the binary form of the client hello cipher list encoded as
16447 hexadecimal. The maximum returned value length is according with the value of
Emmanuel Hocdetaaee7502017-03-07 18:34:58 +010016448 "tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size".
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010016449
16450ssl_fc_cipherlist_str : string
16451 Returns the decoded text form of the client hello cipher list. The maximum
16452 number of ciphers returned is according with the value of
16453 "tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size". Note that this sample-fetch is only
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016454 available with OpenSSL >= 1.0.2. If the function is not enabled, this
Emmanuel Hocdetddcde192017-09-01 17:32:08 +020016455 sample-fetch returns the hash like "ssl_fc_cipherlist_xxh".
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010016456
16457ssl_fc_cipherlist_xxh : integer
16458 Returns a xxh64 of the cipher list. This hash can be return only is the value
16459 "tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size" is set greater than 0, however the hash
Emmanuel Hocdetaaee7502017-03-07 18:34:58 +010016460 take in account all the data of the cipher list.
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010016461
Patrick Hemmer65674662019-06-04 08:13:03 -040016462ssl_fc_client_random : binary
16463 Returns the client random of the front connection when the incoming connection
16464 was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to to decrypt traffic
16465 sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or BoringSSL.
16466
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016467ssl_fc_has_crt : boolean
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020016468 Returns true if a client certificate is present in an incoming connection over
16469 SSL/TLS transport layer. Useful if 'verify' statement is set to 'optional'.
Emeric Brun9143d372012-12-20 15:44:16 +010016470 Note: on SSL session resumption with Session ID or TLS ticket, client
16471 certificate is not present in the current connection but may be retrieved
16472 from the cache or the ticket. So prefer "ssl_c_used" if you want to check if
16473 current SSL session uses a client certificate.
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020016474
Olivier Houchardccaa7de2017-10-02 11:51:03 +020016475ssl_fc_has_early : boolean
16476 Returns true if early data were sent, and the handshake didn't happen yet. As
16477 it has security implications, it is useful to be able to refuse those, or
16478 wait until the handshake happened.
16479
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016480ssl_fc_has_sni : boolean
16481 This checks for the presence of a Server Name Indication TLS extension (SNI)
Willy Tarreauf7bc57c2012-10-03 00:19:48 +020016482 in an incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. Returns
16483 true when the incoming connection presents a TLS SNI field. This requires
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050016484 that the SSL library is built with support for TLS extensions enabled (check
Willy Tarreauf7bc57c2012-10-03 00:19:48 +020016485 haproxy -vv).
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +020016486
Nenad Merdanovic1516fe32016-05-17 03:31:21 +020016487ssl_fc_is_resumed : boolean
Nenad Merdanovic26ea8222015-05-18 02:28:57 +020016488 Returns true if the SSL/TLS session has been resumed through the use of
Jérôme Magnin4a326cb2018-01-15 14:01:17 +010016489 SSL session cache or TLS tickets on an incoming connection over an SSL/TLS
16490 transport layer.
Nenad Merdanovic26ea8222015-05-18 02:28:57 +020016491
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016492ssl_fc_npn : string
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030016493 This extracts the Next Protocol Negotiation field from an incoming connection
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016494 made via a TLS transport layer and locally deciphered by haproxy. The result
16495 is a string containing the protocol name advertised by the client. The SSL
16496 library must have been built with support for TLS extensions enabled (check
16497 haproxy -vv). Note that the TLS NPN extension is not advertised unless the
16498 "npn" keyword on the "bind" line specifies a protocol list. Also, nothing
16499 forces the client to pick a protocol from this list, any other one may be
16500 requested. Please note that the TLS NPN extension was replaced with ALPN.
Willy Tarreaua33c6542012-10-15 13:19:06 +020016501
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016502ssl_fc_protocol : string
16503 Returns the name of the used protocol when the incoming connection was made
16504 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +020016505
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020016506ssl_fc_unique_id : binary
David Sc1ad52e2014-04-08 18:48:47 -040016507 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020016508 returns the TLS unique ID as defined in RFC5929 section 3. The unique id
16509 can be encoded to base64 using the converter: "ssl_bc_unique_id,base64".
David Sc1ad52e2014-04-08 18:48:47 -040016510
Patrick Hemmer65674662019-06-04 08:13:03 -040016511ssl_fc_server_random : binary
16512 Returns the server random of the front connection when the incoming connection
16513 was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to to decrypt traffic
16514 sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or BoringSSL.
16515
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016516ssl_fc_session_id : binary
16517 Returns the SSL ID of the front connection when the incoming connection was
16518 made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to stick a given client to
16519 a server. It is important to note that some browsers refresh their session ID
16520 every few minutes.
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +020016521
Patrick Hemmere0275472018-04-28 19:15:51 -040016522ssl_fc_session_key : binary
16523 Returns the SSL session master key of the front connection when the incoming
16524 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to decrypt
16525 traffic sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or
16526 BoringSSL.
16527
16528
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016529ssl_fc_sni : string
16530 This extracts the Server Name Indication TLS extension (SNI) field from an
16531 incoming connection made via an SSL/TLS transport layer and locally
16532 deciphered by haproxy. The result (when present) typically is a string
16533 matching the HTTPS host name (253 chars or less). The SSL library must have
16534 been built with support for TLS extensions enabled (check haproxy -vv).
16535
16536 This fetch is different from "req_ssl_sni" above in that it applies to the
16537 connection being deciphered by haproxy and not to SSL contents being blindly
16538 forwarded. See also "ssl_fc_sni_end" and "ssl_fc_sni_reg" below. This
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050016539 requires that the SSL library is built with support for TLS extensions
Cyril Bonté9c1eb1e2012-10-09 22:45:34 +020016540 enabled (check haproxy -vv).
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020016541
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016542 ACL derivatives :
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016543 ssl_fc_sni_end : suffix match
16544 ssl_fc_sni_reg : regex match
Emeric Brun589fcad2012-10-16 14:13:26 +020016545
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016546ssl_fc_use_keysize : integer
16547 Returns the symmetric cipher key size used in bits when the incoming
16548 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Willy Tarreaub6fb4202008-07-20 11:18:28 +020016549
Willy Tarreaub6fb4202008-07-20 11:18:28 +020016550
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200165517.3.5. Fetching samples from buffer contents (Layer 6)
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016552------------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaub6fb4202008-07-20 11:18:28 +020016553
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016554Fetching samples from buffer contents is a bit different from the previous
16555sample fetches above because the sampled data are ephemeral. These data can
16556only be used when they're available and will be lost when they're forwarded.
16557For this reason, samples fetched from buffer contents during a request cannot
16558be used in a response for example. Even while the data are being fetched, they
16559can change. Sometimes it is necessary to set some delays or combine multiple
16560sample fetch methods to ensure that the expected data are complete and usable,
16561for example through TCP request content inspection. Please see the "tcp-request
16562content" keyword for more detailed information on the subject.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020016563
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016564payload(<offset>,<length>) : binary (deprecated)
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016565 This is an alias for "req.payload" when used in the context of a request (e.g.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016566 "stick on", "stick match"), and for "res.payload" when used in the context of
16567 a response such as in "stick store response".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010016568
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016569payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : binary (deprecated)
16570 This is an alias for "req.payload_lv" when used in the context of a request
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016571 (e.g. "stick on", "stick match"), and for "res.payload_lv" when used in the
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016572 context of a response such as in "stick store response".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010016573
Thierry FOURNIERd7d88812017-04-19 15:15:14 +020016574req.hdrs : string
16575 Returns the current request headers as string including the last empty line
16576 separating headers from the request body. The last empty line can be used to
16577 detect a truncated header block. This sample fetch is useful for some SPOE
16578 headers analyzers and for advanced logging.
16579
Thierry FOURNIER5617dce2017-04-09 05:38:19 +020016580req.hdrs_bin : binary
16581 Returns the current request headers contained in preparsed binary form. This
16582 is useful for offloading some processing with SPOE. Each string is described
16583 by a length followed by the number of bytes indicated in the length. The
16584 length is represented using the variable integer encoding detailed in the
16585 SPOE documentation. The end of the list is marked by a couple of empty header
16586 names and values (length of 0 for both).
16587
16588 *(<str:header-name><str:header-value>)<empty string><empty string>
16589
16590 int: refer to the SPOE documentation for the encoding
16591 str: <int:length><bytes>
16592
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016593req.len : integer
16594req_len : integer (deprecated)
16595 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of bytes present in the
16596 request buffer. This is mostly used in ACL. It is important to understand
16597 that this test does not return false as long as the buffer is changing. This
16598 means that a check with equality to zero will almost always immediately match
16599 at the beginning of the session, while a test for more data will wait for
16600 that data to come in and return false only when haproxy is certain that no
16601 more data will come in. This test was designed to be used with TCP request
16602 content inspection.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020016603
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016604req.payload(<offset>,<length>) : binary
16605 This extracts a binary block of <length> bytes and starting at byte <offset>
Willy Tarreau00f00842013-08-02 11:07:32 +020016606 in the request buffer. As a special case, if the <length> argument is zero,
16607 the the whole buffer from <offset> to the end is extracted. This can be used
16608 with ACLs in order to check for the presence of some content in a buffer at
16609 any location.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020016610
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016611 ACL alternatives :
16612 payload(<offset>,<length>) : hex binary match
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020016613
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016614req.payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : binary
16615 This extracts a binary block whose size is specified at <offset1> for <length>
16616 bytes, and which starts at <offset2> if specified or just after the length in
16617 the request buffer. The <offset2> parameter also supports relative offsets if
16618 prepended with a '+' or '-' sign.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020016619
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016620 ACL alternatives :
16621 payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : hex binary match
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020016622
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016623 Example : please consult the example from the "stick store-response" keyword.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020016624
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016625req.proto_http : boolean
16626req_proto_http : boolean (deprecated)
16627 Returns true when data in the request buffer look like HTTP and correctly
16628 parses as such. It is the same parser as the common HTTP request parser which
16629 is used so there should be no surprises. The test does not match until the
16630 request is complete, failed or timed out. This test may be used to report the
16631 protocol in TCP logs, but the biggest use is to block TCP request analysis
16632 until a complete HTTP request is present in the buffer, for example to track
16633 a header.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020016634
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016635 Example:
16636 # track request counts per "base" (concatenation of Host+URL)
16637 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
16638 tcp-request content reject if !HTTP
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020016639 tcp-request content track-sc0 base table req-rate
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020016640
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016641req.rdp_cookie([<name>]) : string
16642rdp_cookie([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
16643 When the request buffer looks like the RDP protocol, extracts the RDP cookie
16644 <name>, or any cookie if unspecified. The parser only checks for the first
16645 cookie, as illustrated in the RDP protocol specification. The cookie name is
16646 case insensitive. Generally the "MSTS" cookie name will be used, as it can
16647 contain the user name of the client connecting to the server if properly
16648 configured on the client. The "MSTSHASH" cookie is often used as well for
16649 session stickiness to servers.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020016650
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016651 This differs from "balance rdp-cookie" in that any balancing algorithm may be
16652 used and thus the distribution of clients to backend servers is not linked to
16653 a hash of the RDP cookie. It is envisaged that using a balancing algorithm
16654 such as "balance roundrobin" or "balance leastconn" will lead to a more even
16655 distribution of clients to backend servers than the hash used by "balance
16656 rdp-cookie".
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020016657
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016658 ACL derivatives :
16659 req_rdp_cookie([<name>]) : exact string match
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020016660
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016661 Example :
16662 listen tse-farm
16663 bind 0.0.0.0:3389
16664 # wait up to 5s for an RDP cookie in the request
16665 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
16666 tcp-request content accept if RDP_COOKIE
16667 # apply RDP cookie persistence
16668 persist rdp-cookie
16669 # Persist based on the mstshash cookie
16670 # This is only useful makes sense if
16671 # balance rdp-cookie is not used
16672 stick-table type string size 204800
16673 stick on req.rdp_cookie(mstshash)
16674 server srv1 1.1.1.1:3389
16675 server srv1 1.1.1.2:3389
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020016676
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016677 See also : "balance rdp-cookie", "persist rdp-cookie", "tcp-request" and the
16678 "req_rdp_cookie" ACL.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020016679
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016680req.rdp_cookie_cnt([name]) : integer
16681rdp_cookie_cnt([name]) : integer (deprecated)
16682 Tries to parse the request buffer as RDP protocol, then returns an integer
16683 corresponding to the number of RDP cookies found. If an optional cookie name
16684 is passed, only cookies matching this name are considered. This is mostly
16685 used in ACL.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020016686
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016687 ACL derivatives :
16688 req_rdp_cookie_cnt([<name>]) : integer match
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020016689
Alex Zorin4afdd132018-12-30 13:56:28 +110016690req.ssl_alpn : string
16691 Returns a string containing the values of the Application-Layer Protocol
16692 Negotiation (ALPN) TLS extension (RFC7301), sent by the client within the SSL
16693 ClientHello message. Note that this only applies to raw contents found in the
16694 request buffer and not to the contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so
16695 this will not work with "bind" lines having the "ssl" option. This is useful
16696 in ACL to make a routing decision based upon the ALPN preferences of a TLS
Jarno Huuskonene504f812019-01-03 07:56:49 +020016697 client, like in the example below. See also "ssl_fc_alpn".
Alex Zorin4afdd132018-12-30 13:56:28 +110016698
16699 Examples :
16700 # Wait for a client hello for at most 5 seconds
16701 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
16702 tcp-request content accept if { req_ssl_hello_type 1 }
Jarno Huuskonene504f812019-01-03 07:56:49 +020016703 use_backend bk_acme if { req.ssl_alpn acme-tls/1 }
Alex Zorin4afdd132018-12-30 13:56:28 +110016704 default_backend bk_default
16705
Nenad Merdanovic5fc7d7e2015-07-07 22:00:17 +020016706req.ssl_ec_ext : boolean
16707 Returns a boolean identifying if client sent the Supported Elliptic Curves
16708 Extension as defined in RFC4492, section 5.1. within the SSL ClientHello
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +020016709 message. This can be used to present ECC compatible clients with EC
16710 certificate and to use RSA for all others, on the same IP address. Note that
16711 this only applies to raw contents found in the request buffer and not to
16712 contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not work with "bind"
16713 lines having the "ssl" option.
Nenad Merdanovic5fc7d7e2015-07-07 22:00:17 +020016714
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016715req.ssl_hello_type : integer
16716req_ssl_hello_type : integer (deprecated)
16717 Returns an integer value containing the type of the SSL hello message found
16718 in the request buffer if the buffer contains data that parse as a complete
16719 SSL (v3 or superior) client hello message. Note that this only applies to raw
16720 contents found in the request buffer and not to contents deciphered via an
16721 SSL data layer, so this will not work with "bind" lines having the "ssl"
16722 option. This is mostly used in ACL to detect presence of an SSL hello message
16723 that is supposed to contain an SSL session ID usable for stickiness.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020016724
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016725req.ssl_sni : string
16726req_ssl_sni : string (deprecated)
16727 Returns a string containing the value of the Server Name TLS extension sent
16728 by a client in a TLS stream passing through the request buffer if the buffer
16729 contains data that parse as a complete SSL (v3 or superior) client hello
16730 message. Note that this only applies to raw contents found in the request
16731 buffer and not to contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not
16732 work with "bind" lines having the "ssl" option. SNI normally contains the
16733 name of the host the client tries to connect to (for recent browsers). SNI is
16734 useful for allowing or denying access to certain hosts when SSL/TLS is used
16735 by the client. This test was designed to be used with TCP request content
16736 inspection. If content switching is needed, it is recommended to first wait
16737 for a complete client hello (type 1), like in the example below. See also
16738 "ssl_fc_sni".
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020016739
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016740 ACL derivatives :
16741 req_ssl_sni : exact string match
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020016742
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016743 Examples :
16744 # Wait for a client hello for at most 5 seconds
16745 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
16746 tcp-request content accept if { req_ssl_hello_type 1 }
16747 use_backend bk_allow if { req_ssl_sni -f allowed_sites }
16748 default_backend bk_sorry_page
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020016749
Pradeep Jindalbb2acf52015-09-29 10:12:57 +053016750req.ssl_st_ext : integer
16751 Returns 0 if the client didn't send a SessionTicket TLS Extension (RFC5077)
16752 Returns 1 if the client sent SessionTicket TLS Extension
16753 Returns 2 if the client also sent non-zero length TLS SessionTicket
16754 Note that this only applies to raw contents found in the request buffer and
16755 not to contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not work with
16756 "bind" lines having the "ssl" option. This can for example be used to detect
16757 whether the client sent a SessionTicket or not and stick it accordingly, if
16758 no SessionTicket then stick on SessionID or don't stick as there's no server
16759 side state is there when SessionTickets are in use.
16760
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016761req.ssl_ver : integer
16762req_ssl_ver : integer (deprecated)
16763 Returns an integer value containing the version of the SSL/TLS protocol of a
16764 stream present in the request buffer. Both SSLv2 hello messages and SSLv3
16765 messages are supported. TLSv1 is announced as SSL version 3.1. The value is
16766 composed of the major version multiplied by 65536, added to the minor
16767 version. Note that this only applies to raw contents found in the request
16768 buffer and not to contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not
16769 work with "bind" lines having the "ssl" option. The ACL version of the test
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016770 matches against a decimal notation in the form MAJOR.MINOR (e.g. 3.1). This
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016771 fetch is mostly used in ACL.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016772
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016773 ACL derivatives :
16774 req_ssl_ver : decimal match
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016775
Willy Tarreau47e8eba2013-09-11 23:28:46 +020016776res.len : integer
16777 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of bytes present in the
16778 response buffer. This is mostly used in ACL. It is important to understand
16779 that this test does not return false as long as the buffer is changing. This
16780 means that a check with equality to zero will almost always immediately match
16781 at the beginning of the session, while a test for more data will wait for
16782 that data to come in and return false only when haproxy is certain that no
16783 more data will come in. This test was designed to be used with TCP response
16784 content inspection.
16785
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016786res.payload(<offset>,<length>) : binary
16787 This extracts a binary block of <length> bytes and starting at byte <offset>
Willy Tarreau00f00842013-08-02 11:07:32 +020016788 in the response buffer. As a special case, if the <length> argument is zero,
16789 the the whole buffer from <offset> to the end is extracted. This can be used
16790 with ACLs in order to check for the presence of some content in a buffer at
16791 any location.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016792
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016793res.payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : binary
16794 This extracts a binary block whose size is specified at <offset1> for <length>
16795 bytes, and which starts at <offset2> if specified or just after the length in
16796 the response buffer. The <offset2> parameter also supports relative offsets
16797 if prepended with a '+' or '-' sign.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016798
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016799 Example : please consult the example from the "stick store-response" keyword.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016800
Willy Tarreau971f7b62015-09-29 14:06:59 +020016801res.ssl_hello_type : integer
16802rep_ssl_hello_type : integer (deprecated)
16803 Returns an integer value containing the type of the SSL hello message found
16804 in the response buffer if the buffer contains data that parses as a complete
16805 SSL (v3 or superior) hello message. Note that this only applies to raw
16806 contents found in the response buffer and not to contents deciphered via an
16807 SSL data layer, so this will not work with "server" lines having the "ssl"
16808 option. This is mostly used in ACL to detect presence of an SSL hello message
16809 that is supposed to contain an SSL session ID usable for stickiness.
16810
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016811wait_end : boolean
16812 This fetch either returns true when the inspection period is over, or does
16813 not fetch. It is only used in ACLs, in conjunction with content analysis to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016814 avoid returning a wrong verdict early. It may also be used to delay some
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016815 actions, such as a delayed reject for some special addresses. Since it either
16816 stops the rules evaluation or immediately returns true, it is recommended to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016817 use this acl as the last one in a rule. Please note that the default ACL
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016818 "WAIT_END" is always usable without prior declaration. This test was designed
16819 to be used with TCP request content inspection.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016820
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016821 Examples :
16822 # delay every incoming request by 2 seconds
16823 tcp-request inspect-delay 2s
16824 tcp-request content accept if WAIT_END
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016825
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016826 # don't immediately tell bad guys they are rejected
16827 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
16828 acl goodguys src 10.0.0.0/24
16829 acl badguys src 10.0.1.0/24
16830 tcp-request content accept if goodguys
16831 tcp-request content reject if badguys WAIT_END
16832 tcp-request content reject
16833
16834
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200168357.3.6. Fetching HTTP samples (Layer 7)
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016836--------------------------------------
16837
16838It is possible to fetch samples from HTTP contents, requests and responses.
16839This application layer is also called layer 7. It is only possible to fetch the
16840data in this section when a full HTTP request or response has been parsed from
16841its respective request or response buffer. This is always the case with all
16842HTTP specific rules and for sections running with "mode http". When using TCP
16843content inspection, it may be necessary to support an inspection delay in order
16844to let the request or response come in first. These fetches may require a bit
16845more CPU resources than the layer 4 ones, but not much since the request and
16846response are indexed.
16847
16848base : string
16849 This returns the concatenation of the first Host header and the path part of
16850 the request, which starts at the first slash and ends before the question
16851 mark. It can be useful in virtual hosted environments to detect URL abuses as
16852 well as to improve shared caches efficiency. Using this with a limited size
16853 stick table also allows one to collect statistics about most commonly
16854 requested objects by host/path. With ACLs it can allow simple content
16855 switching rules involving the host and the path at the same time, such as
16856 "www.example.com/favicon.ico". See also "path" and "uri".
16857
16858 ACL derivatives :
16859 base : exact string match
16860 base_beg : prefix match
16861 base_dir : subdir match
16862 base_dom : domain match
16863 base_end : suffix match
16864 base_len : length match
16865 base_reg : regex match
16866 base_sub : substring match
16867
16868base32 : integer
16869 This returns a 32-bit hash of the value returned by the "base" fetch method
16870 above. This is useful to track per-URL activity on high traffic sites without
16871 having to store all URLs. Instead a shorter hash is stored, saving a lot of
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020016872 memory. The output type is an unsigned integer. The hash function used is
16873 SDBM with full avalanche on the output. Technically, base32 is exactly equal
16874 to "base,sdbm(1)".
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016875
16876base32+src : binary
16877 This returns the concatenation of the base32 fetch above and the src fetch
16878 below. The resulting type is of type binary, with a size of 8 or 20 bytes
16879 depending on the source address family. This can be used to track per-IP,
16880 per-URL counters.
16881
William Lallemand65ad6e12014-01-31 15:08:02 +010016882capture.req.hdr(<idx>) : string
16883 This extracts the content of the header captured by the "capture request
16884 header", idx is the position of the capture keyword in the configuration.
16885 The first entry is an index of 0. See also: "capture request header".
16886
16887capture.req.method : string
16888 This extracts the METHOD of an HTTP request. It can be used in both request
16889 and response. Unlike "method", it can be used in both request and response
16890 because it's allocated.
16891
16892capture.req.uri : string
16893 This extracts the request's URI, which starts at the first slash and ends
16894 before the first space in the request (without the host part). Unlike "path"
16895 and "url", it can be used in both request and response because it's
16896 allocated.
16897
Willy Tarreau3c1b5ec2014-04-24 23:41:57 +020016898capture.req.ver : string
16899 This extracts the request's HTTP version and returns either "HTTP/1.0" or
16900 "HTTP/1.1". Unlike "req.ver", it can be used in both request, response, and
16901 logs because it relies on a persistent flag.
16902
William Lallemand65ad6e12014-01-31 15:08:02 +010016903capture.res.hdr(<idx>) : string
16904 This extracts the content of the header captured by the "capture response
16905 header", idx is the position of the capture keyword in the configuration.
16906 The first entry is an index of 0.
16907 See also: "capture response header"
16908
Willy Tarreau3c1b5ec2014-04-24 23:41:57 +020016909capture.res.ver : string
16910 This extracts the response's HTTP version and returns either "HTTP/1.0" or
16911 "HTTP/1.1". Unlike "res.ver", it can be used in logs because it relies on a
16912 persistent flag.
16913
Willy Tarreaua5910cc2015-05-02 00:46:08 +020016914req.body : binary
16915 This returns the HTTP request's available body as a block of data. It
16916 requires that the request body has been buffered made available using
16917 "option http-buffer-request". In case of chunked-encoded body, currently only
16918 the first chunk is analyzed.
16919
Thierry FOURNIER9826c772015-05-20 15:50:54 +020016920req.body_param([<name>) : string
16921 This fetch assumes that the body of the POST request is url-encoded. The user
16922 can check if the "content-type" contains the value
16923 "application/x-www-form-urlencoded". This extracts the first occurrence of the
16924 parameter <name> in the body, which ends before '&'. The parameter name is
16925 case-sensitive. If no name is given, any parameter will match, and the first
16926 one will be returned. The result is a string corresponding to the value of the
16927 parameter <name> as presented in the request body (no URL decoding is
16928 performed). Note that the ACL version of this fetch iterates over multiple
16929 parameters and will iteratively report all parameters values if no name is
16930 given.
16931
Willy Tarreaua5910cc2015-05-02 00:46:08 +020016932req.body_len : integer
16933 This returns the length of the HTTP request's available body in bytes. It may
16934 be lower than the advertised length if the body is larger than the buffer. It
16935 requires that the request body has been buffered made available using
16936 "option http-buffer-request".
16937
16938req.body_size : integer
16939 This returns the advertised length of the HTTP request's body in bytes. It
16940 will represent the advertised Content-Length header, or the size of the first
16941 chunk in case of chunked encoding. In order to parse the chunks, it requires
16942 that the request body has been buffered made available using
16943 "option http-buffer-request".
16944
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016945req.cook([<name>]) : string
16946cook([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
16947 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Cookie"
16948 header line from the request, and returns its value as string. If no name is
16949 specified, the first cookie value is returned. When used with ACLs, all
16950 matching cookies are evaluated. Spaces around the name and the value are
16951 ignored as requested by the Cookie header specification (RFC6265). The cookie
16952 name is case-sensitive. Empty cookies are valid, so an empty cookie may very
16953 well return an empty value if it is present. Use the "found" match to detect
16954 presence. Use the res.cook() variant for response cookies sent by the server.
16955
16956 ACL derivatives :
16957 cook([<name>]) : exact string match
16958 cook_beg([<name>]) : prefix match
16959 cook_dir([<name>]) : subdir match
16960 cook_dom([<name>]) : domain match
16961 cook_end([<name>]) : suffix match
16962 cook_len([<name>]) : length match
16963 cook_reg([<name>]) : regex match
16964 cook_sub([<name>]) : substring match
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016965
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016966req.cook_cnt([<name>]) : integer
16967cook_cnt([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
16968 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of the cookie
16969 <name> in the request, or all cookies if <name> is not specified.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016970
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016971req.cook_val([<name>]) : integer
16972cook_val([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
16973 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Cookie"
16974 header line from the request, and converts its value to an integer which is
16975 returned. If no name is specified, the first cookie value is returned. When
16976 used in ACLs, all matching names are iterated over until a value matches.
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +020016977
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016978cookie([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
16979 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Cookie"
16980 header line from the request, or a "Set-Cookie" header from the response, and
16981 returns its value as a string. A typical use is to get multiple clients
16982 sharing a same profile use the same server. This can be similar to what
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +020016983 "appsession" did with the "request-learn" statement, but with support for
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016984 multi-peer synchronization and state keeping across restarts. If no name is
16985 specified, the first cookie value is returned. This fetch should not be used
16986 anymore and should be replaced by req.cook() or res.cook() instead as it
16987 ambiguously uses the direction based on the context where it is used.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016988
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016989hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
16990 This is equivalent to req.hdr() when used on requests, and to res.hdr() when
16991 used on responses. Please refer to these respective fetches for more details.
16992 In case of doubt about the fetch direction, please use the explicit ones.
16993 Note that contrary to the hdr() sample fetch method, the hdr_* ACL keywords
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030016994 unambiguously apply to the request headers.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016995
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016996req.fhdr(<name>[,<occ>]) : string
16997 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request. When
16998 used from an ACL, all occurrences are iterated over until a match is found.
16999 Optionally, a specific occurrence might be specified as a position number.
17000 Positive values indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being
17001 the first one. Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one,
17002 with -1 being the last one. It differs from req.hdr() in that any commas
17003 present in the value are returned and are not used as delimiters. This is
17004 sometimes useful with headers such as User-Agent.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010017005
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017006req.fhdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
17007 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of request
17008 header field name <name>, or the total number of header fields if <name> is
17009 not specified. Contrary to its req.hdr_cnt() cousin, this function returns
17010 the number of full line headers and does not stop on commas.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010017011
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017012req.hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
17013 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request. When
17014 used from an ACL, all occurrences are iterated over until a match is found.
17015 Optionally, a specific occurrence might be specified as a position number.
17016 Positive values indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being
17017 the first one. Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one,
17018 with -1 being the last one. A typical use is with the X-Forwarded-For header
17019 once converted to IP, associated with an IP stick-table. The function
17020 considers any comma as a delimiter for distinct values. If full-line headers
Lukas Tribus23953682017-04-28 13:24:30 +000017021 are desired instead, use req.fhdr(). Please carefully check RFC7231 to know
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017022 how certain headers are supposed to be parsed. Also, some of them are case
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017023 insensitive (e.g. Connection).
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010017024
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017025 ACL derivatives :
17026 hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : exact string match
17027 hdr_beg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : prefix match
17028 hdr_dir([<name>[,<occ>]]) : subdir match
17029 hdr_dom([<name>[,<occ>]]) : domain match
17030 hdr_end([<name>[,<occ>]]) : suffix match
17031 hdr_len([<name>[,<occ>]]) : length match
17032 hdr_reg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : regex match
17033 hdr_sub([<name>[,<occ>]]) : substring match
17034
17035req.hdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
17036hdr_cnt([<header>]) : integer (deprecated)
17037 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of request
17038 header field name <name>, or the total number of header field values if
17039 <name> is not specified. It is important to remember that one header line may
17040 count as several headers if it has several values. The function considers any
17041 comma as a delimiter for distinct values. If full-line headers are desired
17042 instead, req.fhdr_cnt() should be used instead. With ACLs, it can be used to
17043 detect presence, absence or abuse of a specific header, as well as to block
17044 request smuggling attacks by rejecting requests which contain more than one
17045 of certain headers. See "req.hdr" for more information on header matching.
17046
17047req.hdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip
17048hdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip (deprecated)
17049 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request,
17050 converts it to an IPv4 or IPv6 address and returns this address. When used
17051 with ACLs, all occurrences are checked, and if <name> is omitted, every value
17052 of every header is checked. Optionally, a specific occurrence might be
17053 specified as a position number. Positive values indicate a position from the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017054 first occurrence, with 1 being the first one. Negative values indicate
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017055 positions relative to the last one, with -1 being the last one. A typical use
17056 is with the X-Forwarded-For and X-Client-IP headers.
17057
17058req.hdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer
17059hdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer (deprecated)
17060 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request, and
17061 converts it to an integer value. When used with ACLs, all occurrences are
17062 checked, and if <name> is omitted, every value of every header is checked.
17063 Optionally, a specific occurrence might be specified as a position number.
17064 Positive values indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being
17065 the first one. Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one,
17066 with -1 being the last one. A typical use is with the X-Forwarded-For header.
17067
Frédéric Lécailleec891192019-02-26 15:02:35 +010017068
17069
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017070http_auth(<userlist>) : boolean
17071 Returns a boolean indicating whether the authentication data received from
17072 the client match a username & password stored in the specified userlist. This
17073 fetch function is not really useful outside of ACLs. Currently only http
17074 basic auth is supported.
17075
Thierry FOURNIER9eec0a62014-01-22 18:38:02 +010017076http_auth_group(<userlist>) : string
17077 Returns a string corresponding to the user name found in the authentication
17078 data received from the client if both the user name and password are valid
17079 according to the specified userlist. The main purpose is to use it in ACLs
17080 where it is then checked whether the user belongs to any group within a list.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017081 This fetch function is not really useful outside of ACLs. Currently only http
17082 basic auth is supported.
17083
17084 ACL derivatives :
Thierry FOURNIER9eec0a62014-01-22 18:38:02 +010017085 http_auth_group(<userlist>) : group ...
17086 Returns true when the user extracted from the request and whose password is
17087 valid according to the specified userlist belongs to at least one of the
17088 groups.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017089
Christopher Fauleta4063562019-08-02 11:51:37 +020017090http_auth_pass : string
Willy Tarreauc9c6cdb2020-03-05 16:03:58 +010017091 Returns the user's password found in the authentication data received from
17092 the client, as supplied in the Authorization header. Not checks are
17093 performed by this sample fetch. Only Basic authentication is supported.
Christopher Fauleta4063562019-08-02 11:51:37 +020017094
17095http_auth_type : string
Willy Tarreauc9c6cdb2020-03-05 16:03:58 +010017096 Returns the authentication method found in the authentication data received from
17097 the client, as supplied in the Authorization header. Not checks are
17098 performed by this sample fetch. Only Basic authentication is supported.
Christopher Fauleta4063562019-08-02 11:51:37 +020017099
17100http_auth_user : string
Willy Tarreauc9c6cdb2020-03-05 16:03:58 +010017101 Returns the user name found in the authentication data received from the
17102 client, as supplied in the Authorization header. Not checks are performed by
17103 this sample fetch. Only Basic authentication is supported.
Christopher Fauleta4063562019-08-02 11:51:37 +020017104
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017105http_first_req : boolean
Willy Tarreau7f18e522010-10-22 20:04:13 +020017106 Returns true when the request being processed is the first one of the
17107 connection. This can be used to add or remove headers that may be missing
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017108 from some requests when a request is not the first one, or to help grouping
17109 requests in the logs.
Willy Tarreau7f18e522010-10-22 20:04:13 +020017110
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017111method : integer + string
17112 Returns an integer value corresponding to the method in the HTTP request. For
17113 example, "GET" equals 1 (check sources to establish the matching). Value 9
17114 means "other method" and may be converted to a string extracted from the
17115 stream. This should not be used directly as a sample, this is only meant to
17116 be used from ACLs, which transparently convert methods from patterns to these
17117 integer + string values. Some predefined ACL already check for most common
17118 methods.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020017119
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017120 ACL derivatives :
17121 method : case insensitive method match
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020017122
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017123 Example :
17124 # only accept GET and HEAD requests
17125 acl valid_method method GET HEAD
17126 http-request deny if ! valid_method
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020017127
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017128path : string
17129 This extracts the request's URL path, which starts at the first slash and
17130 ends before the question mark (without the host part). A typical use is with
17131 prefetch-capable caches, and with portals which need to aggregate multiple
17132 information from databases and keep them in caches. Note that with outgoing
17133 caches, it would be wiser to use "url" instead. With ACLs, it's typically
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017134 used to match exact file names (e.g. "/login.php"), or directory parts using
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017135 the derivative forms. See also the "url" and "base" fetch methods.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020017136
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017137 ACL derivatives :
17138 path : exact string match
17139 path_beg : prefix match
17140 path_dir : subdir match
17141 path_dom : domain match
17142 path_end : suffix match
17143 path_len : length match
17144 path_reg : regex match
17145 path_sub : substring match
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020017146
Willy Tarreau49ad95c2015-01-19 15:06:26 +010017147query : string
17148 This extracts the request's query string, which starts after the first
17149 question mark. If no question mark is present, this fetch returns nothing. If
17150 a question mark is present but nothing follows, it returns an empty string.
17151 This means it's possible to easily know whether a query string is present
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010017152 using the "found" matching method. This fetch is the complement of "path"
Willy Tarreau49ad95c2015-01-19 15:06:26 +010017153 which stops before the question mark.
17154
Willy Tarreaueb27ec72015-02-20 13:55:29 +010017155req.hdr_names([<delim>]) : string
17156 This builds a string made from the concatenation of all header names as they
17157 appear in the request when the rule is evaluated. The default delimiter is
17158 the comma (',') but it may be overridden as an optional argument <delim>. In
17159 this case, only the first character of <delim> is considered.
17160
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017161req.ver : string
17162req_ver : string (deprecated)
17163 Returns the version string from the HTTP request, for example "1.1". This can
17164 be useful for logs, but is mostly there for ACL. Some predefined ACL already
17165 check for versions 1.0 and 1.1.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010017166
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017167 ACL derivatives :
17168 req_ver : exact string match
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +020017169
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017170res.comp : boolean
17171 Returns the boolean "true" value if the response has been compressed by
17172 HAProxy, otherwise returns boolean "false". This may be used to add
17173 information in the logs.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020017174
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017175res.comp_algo : string
17176 Returns a string containing the name of the algorithm used if the response
17177 was compressed by HAProxy, for example : "deflate". This may be used to add
17178 some information in the logs.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010017179
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017180res.cook([<name>]) : string
17181scook([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
17182 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Set-Cookie"
17183 header line from the response, and returns its value as string. If no name is
17184 specified, the first cookie value is returned.
Willy Tarreau0ce3aa02012-04-25 18:46:33 +020017185
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017186 ACL derivatives :
17187 scook([<name>] : exact string match
Willy Tarreau0ce3aa02012-04-25 18:46:33 +020017188
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017189res.cook_cnt([<name>]) : integer
17190scook_cnt([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
17191 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of the cookie
17192 <name> in the response, or all cookies if <name> is not specified. This is
17193 mostly useful when combined with ACLs to detect suspicious responses.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010017194
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017195res.cook_val([<name>]) : integer
17196scook_val([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
17197 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Set-Cookie"
17198 header line from the response, and converts its value to an integer which is
17199 returned. If no name is specified, the first cookie value is returned.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010017200
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017201res.fhdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
17202 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP response, or of
17203 the last header if no <name> is specified. Optionally, a specific occurrence
17204 might be specified as a position number. Positive values indicate a position
17205 from the first occurrence, with 1 being the first one. Negative values
17206 indicate positions relative to the last one, with -1 being the last one. It
17207 differs from res.hdr() in that any commas present in the value are returned
17208 and are not used as delimiters. If this is not desired, the res.hdr() fetch
17209 should be used instead. This is sometimes useful with headers such as Date or
17210 Expires.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020017211
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017212res.fhdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
17213 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of response
17214 header field name <name>, or the total number of header fields if <name> is
17215 not specified. Contrary to its res.hdr_cnt() cousin, this function returns
17216 the number of full line headers and does not stop on commas. If this is not
17217 desired, the res.hdr_cnt() fetch should be used instead.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020017218
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017219res.hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
17220shdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string (deprecated)
17221 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP response, or of
17222 the last header if no <name> is specified. Optionally, a specific occurrence
17223 might be specified as a position number. Positive values indicate a position
17224 from the first occurrence, with 1 being the first one. Negative values
17225 indicate positions relative to the last one, with -1 being the last one. This
17226 can be useful to learn some data into a stick-table. The function considers
17227 any comma as a delimiter for distinct values. If this is not desired, the
17228 res.fhdr() fetch should be used instead.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020017229
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017230 ACL derivatives :
17231 shdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : exact string match
17232 shdr_beg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : prefix match
17233 shdr_dir([<name>[,<occ>]]) : subdir match
17234 shdr_dom([<name>[,<occ>]]) : domain match
17235 shdr_end([<name>[,<occ>]]) : suffix match
17236 shdr_len([<name>[,<occ>]]) : length match
17237 shdr_reg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : regex match
17238 shdr_sub([<name>[,<occ>]]) : substring match
17239
17240res.hdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
17241shdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
17242 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of response
17243 header field name <name>, or the total number of header fields if <name> is
17244 not specified. The function considers any comma as a delimiter for distinct
17245 values. If this is not desired, the res.fhdr_cnt() fetch should be used
17246 instead.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020017247
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017248res.hdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip
17249shdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip (deprecated)
17250 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP response,
17251 convert it to an IPv4 or IPv6 address and returns this address. Optionally, a
17252 specific occurrence might be specified as a position number. Positive values
17253 indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being the first one.
17254 Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one, with -1 being
17255 the last one. This can be useful to learn some data into a stick table.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020017256
Willy Tarreaueb27ec72015-02-20 13:55:29 +010017257res.hdr_names([<delim>]) : string
17258 This builds a string made from the concatenation of all header names as they
17259 appear in the response when the rule is evaluated. The default delimiter is
17260 the comma (',') but it may be overridden as an optional argument <delim>. In
17261 this case, only the first character of <delim> is considered.
17262
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017263res.hdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer
17264shdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer (deprecated)
17265 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP response, and
17266 converts it to an integer value. Optionally, a specific occurrence might be
17267 specified as a position number. Positive values indicate a position from the
17268 first occurrence, with 1 being the first one. Negative values indicate
17269 positions relative to the last one, with -1 being the last one. This can be
17270 useful to learn some data into a stick table.
Alexandre Cassen5eb1a902007-11-29 15:43:32 +010017271
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017272res.ver : string
17273resp_ver : string (deprecated)
17274 Returns the version string from the HTTP response, for example "1.1". This
17275 can be useful for logs, but is mostly there for ACL.
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +020017276
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017277 ACL derivatives :
17278 resp_ver : exact string match
Alexandre Cassen5eb1a902007-11-29 15:43:32 +010017279
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017280set-cookie([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
17281 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Set-Cookie"
17282 header line from the response and uses the corresponding value to match. This
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +020017283 can be comparable to what "appsession" did with default options, but with
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017284 support for multi-peer synchronization and state keeping across restarts.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +010017285
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017286 This fetch function is deprecated and has been superseded by the "res.cook"
17287 fetch. This keyword will disappear soon.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +010017288
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017289status : integer
17290 Returns an integer containing the HTTP status code in the HTTP response, for
17291 example, 302. It is mostly used within ACLs and integer ranges, for example,
17292 to remove any Location header if the response is not a 3xx.
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020017293
Thierry Fournier0e00dca2016-04-07 15:47:40 +020017294unique-id : string
17295 Returns the unique-id attached to the request. The directive
17296 "unique-id-format" must be set. If it is not set, the unique-id sample fetch
17297 fails. Note that the unique-id is usually used with HTTP requests, however this
17298 sample fetch can be used with other protocols. Obviously, if it is used with
17299 other protocols than HTTP, the unique-id-format directive must not contain
17300 HTTP parts. See: unique-id-format and unique-id-header
17301
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017302url : string
17303 This extracts the request's URL as presented in the request. A typical use is
17304 with prefetch-capable caches, and with portals which need to aggregate
17305 multiple information from databases and keep them in caches. With ACLs, using
17306 "path" is preferred over using "url", because clients may send a full URL as
17307 is normally done with proxies. The only real use is to match "*" which does
17308 not match in "path", and for which there is already a predefined ACL. See
17309 also "path" and "base".
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020017310
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017311 ACL derivatives :
17312 url : exact string match
17313 url_beg : prefix match
17314 url_dir : subdir match
17315 url_dom : domain match
17316 url_end : suffix match
17317 url_len : length match
17318 url_reg : regex match
17319 url_sub : substring match
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020017320
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017321url_ip : ip
17322 This extracts the IP address from the request's URL when the host part is
17323 presented as an IP address. Its use is very limited. For instance, a
17324 monitoring system might use this field as an alternative for the source IP in
17325 order to test what path a given source address would follow, or to force an
17326 entry in a table for a given source address. With ACLs it can be used to
17327 restrict access to certain systems through a proxy, for example when combined
17328 with option "http_proxy".
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020017329
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017330url_port : integer
17331 This extracts the port part from the request's URL. Note that if the port is
17332 not specified in the request, port 80 is assumed. With ACLs it can be used to
17333 restrict access to certain systems through a proxy, for example when combined
17334 with option "http_proxy".
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020017335
Willy Tarreau1ede1da2015-05-07 16:06:18 +020017336urlp([<name>[,<delim>]]) : string
17337url_param([<name>[,<delim>]]) : string
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017338 This extracts the first occurrence of the parameter <name> in the query
17339 string, which begins after either '?' or <delim>, and which ends before '&',
Willy Tarreau1ede1da2015-05-07 16:06:18 +020017340 ';' or <delim>. The parameter name is case-sensitive. If no name is given,
17341 any parameter will match, and the first one will be returned. The result is
17342 a string corresponding to the value of the parameter <name> as presented in
17343 the request (no URL decoding is performed). This can be used for session
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017344 stickiness based on a client ID, to extract an application cookie passed as a
17345 URL parameter, or in ACLs to apply some checks. Note that the ACL version of
Willy Tarreau1ede1da2015-05-07 16:06:18 +020017346 this fetch iterates over multiple parameters and will iteratively report all
17347 parameters values if no name is given
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020017348
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017349 ACL derivatives :
17350 urlp(<name>[,<delim>]) : exact string match
17351 urlp_beg(<name>[,<delim>]) : prefix match
17352 urlp_dir(<name>[,<delim>]) : subdir match
17353 urlp_dom(<name>[,<delim>]) : domain match
17354 urlp_end(<name>[,<delim>]) : suffix match
17355 urlp_len(<name>[,<delim>]) : length match
17356 urlp_reg(<name>[,<delim>]) : regex match
17357 urlp_sub(<name>[,<delim>]) : substring match
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020017358
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020017359
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017360 Example :
17361 # match http://example.com/foo?PHPSESSIONID=some_id
17362 stick on urlp(PHPSESSIONID)
17363 # match http://example.com/foo;JSESSIONID=some_id
17364 stick on urlp(JSESSIONID,;)
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020017365
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030017366urlp_val([<name>[,<delim>]]) : integer
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017367 See "urlp" above. This one extracts the URL parameter <name> in the request
17368 and converts it to an integer value. This can be used for session stickiness
17369 based on a user ID for example, or with ACLs to match a page number or price.
Willy Tarreaua9fddca2012-07-31 07:51:48 +020017370
Dragan Dosen0070cd52016-06-16 12:19:49 +020017371url32 : integer
17372 This returns a 32-bit hash of the value obtained by concatenating the first
17373 Host header and the whole URL including parameters (not only the path part of
17374 the request, as in the "base32" fetch above). This is useful to track per-URL
17375 activity. A shorter hash is stored, saving a lot of memory. The output type
17376 is an unsigned integer.
17377
17378url32+src : binary
17379 This returns the concatenation of the "url32" fetch and the "src" fetch. The
17380 resulting type is of type binary, with a size of 8 or 20 bytes depending on
17381 the source address family. This can be used to track per-IP, per-URL counters.
17382
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +010017383
Christopher Fauletba3c68f2020-04-01 16:27:05 +0200173847.3.7. Fetching health-check samples
17385-------------------------------------
17386
17387This set of sample fetch methods may be called from an health-check execution
17388context. It was introduced in the version 2.2. The following sample fetches are
17389placed in the dedicated scope "check". Other sample fetches may also be called
17390when an health-check is performed if it makes sense and if the sample fetch was
17391adapted to be called in this context.
17392
17393check.payload(<offset>,<length>) : binary
17394 This extracts a binary block of <length> bytes and starting at byte <offset>
17395 in the check input buffer. As a special case, if the <length> argument is
17396 zero, then the whole buffer from <offset> to the end is extracted. This can
17397 be called from a tcp-check expect rule, or eventually from a set-var rule
17398 after an expect rule and before a send rule (check input buffer is filled on
17399 tcp-check expect rules and reset on tcp-check send rules).
17400
17401
174027.3.8. Fetching samples for developers
Christopher Fauletd47941d2020-01-08 14:40:19 +010017403---------------------------------------
17404
17405This set of sample fetch methods is reserved to developers and must never be
17406used on a production environment, except on developer demand, for debugging
17407purposes. Moreover, no special care will be taken on backwards compatibility.
17408There is no warranty the following sample fetches will never change, be renamed
17409or simply removed. So be really careful if you should use one of them. To avoid
17410any ambiguity, these sample fetches are placed in the dedicated scope "internal",
17411for instance "internal.strm.is_htx".
17412
17413internal.htx.data : integer
17414 Returns the size in bytes used by data in the HTX message associated to a
17415 channel. The channel is chosen depending on the sample direction.
17416
17417internal.htx.free : integer
17418 Returns the free space (size - used) in bytes in the HTX message associated
17419 to a channel. The channel is chosen depending on the sample direction.
17420
17421internal.htx.free_data : integer
17422 Returns the free space for the data in bytes in the HTX message associated to
17423 a channel. The channel is chosen depending on the sample direction.
17424
17425internal.htx.has_eom : boolean
17426 Returns true if the HTX message associated to a channel contains an
17427 end-of-message block (EOM). Otherwise, it returns false. The channel is
17428 chosen depending on the sample direction.
17429
17430internal.htx.nbblks : integer
17431 Returns the number of blocks present in the HTX message associated to a
17432 channel. The channel is chosen depending on the sample direction.
17433
17434internal.htx.size : integer
17435 Returns the total size in bytes of the HTX message associated to a
17436 channel. The channel is chosen depending on the sample direction.
17437
17438internal.htx.used : integer
17439 Returns the total size used in bytes (data + metadata) in the HTX message
17440 associated to a channel. The channel is chosen depending on the sample
17441 direction.
17442
17443internal.htx_blk.size(<idx>) : integer
17444 Returns the size of the block at the position <idx> in the HTX message
17445 associated to a channel or 0 if it does not exist. The channel is chosen
17446 depending on the sample direction. <idx> may be any positive integer or one
17447 of the special value :
17448 * head : The oldest inserted block
17449 * tail : The newest inserted block
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +050017450 * first : The first block where to (re)start the analysis
Christopher Fauletd47941d2020-01-08 14:40:19 +010017451
17452internal.htx_blk.type(<idx>) : string
17453 Returns the type of the block at the position <idx> in the HTX message
17454 associated to a channel or "HTX_BLK_UNUSED" if it does not exist. The channel
17455 is chosen depending on the sample direction. <idx> may be any positive
17456 integer or one of the special value :
17457 * head : The oldest inserted block
17458 * tail : The newest inserted block
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +050017459 * first : The first block where to (re)start the analysis
Christopher Fauletd47941d2020-01-08 14:40:19 +010017460
17461internal.htx_blk.data(<idx>) : binary
17462 Returns the value of the DATA block at the position <idx> in the HTX message
17463 associated to a channel or an empty string if it does not exist or if it is
17464 not a DATA block. The channel is chosen depending on the sample direction.
17465 <idx> may be any positive integer or one of the special value :
17466
17467 * head : The oldest inserted block
17468 * tail : The newest inserted block
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +050017469 * first : The first block where to (re)start the analysis
Christopher Fauletd47941d2020-01-08 14:40:19 +010017470
17471internal.htx_blk.hdrname(<idx>) : string
17472 Returns the header name of the HEADER block at the position <idx> in the HTX
17473 message associated to a channel or an empty string if it does not exist or if
17474 it is not an HEADER block. The channel is chosen depending on the sample
17475 direction. <idx> may be any positive integer or one of the special value :
17476
17477 * head : The oldest inserted block
17478 * tail : The newest inserted block
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +050017479 * first : The first block where to (re)start the analysis
Christopher Fauletd47941d2020-01-08 14:40:19 +010017480
17481internal.htx_blk.hdrval(<idx>) : string
17482 Returns the header value of the HEADER block at the position <idx> in the HTX
17483 message associated to a channel or an empty string if it does not exist or if
17484 it is not an HEADER block. The channel is chosen depending on the sample
17485 direction. <idx> may be any positive integer or one of the special value :
17486
17487 * head : The oldest inserted block
17488 * tail : The newest inserted block
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +050017489 * first : The first block where to (re)start the analysis
Christopher Fauletd47941d2020-01-08 14:40:19 +010017490
17491internal.htx_blk.start_line(<idx>) : string
17492 Returns the value of the REQ_SL or RES_SL block at the position <idx> in the
17493 HTX message associated to a channel or an empty string if it does not exist
17494 or if it is not a SL block. The channel is chosen depending on the sample
17495 direction. <idx> may be any positive integer or one of the special value :
17496
17497 * head : The oldest inserted block
17498 * tail : The newest inserted block
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +050017499 * first : The first block where to (re)start the analysis
Christopher Fauletd47941d2020-01-08 14:40:19 +010017500
17501internal.strm.is_htx : boolean
17502 Returns true if the current stream is an HTX stream. It means the data in the
17503 channels buffers are stored using the internal HTX representation. Otherwise,
17504 it returns false.
17505
17506
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200175077.4. Pre-defined ACLs
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020017508---------------------
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +010017509
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020017510Some predefined ACLs are hard-coded so that they do not have to be declared in
17511every frontend which needs them. They all have their names in upper case in
Patrick Mézard2382ad62010-05-09 10:43:32 +020017512order to avoid confusion. Their equivalence is provided below.
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +010017513
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020017514ACL name Equivalent to Usage
17515---------------+-----------------------------+---------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020017516FALSE always_false never match
Willy Tarreau2492d5b2009-07-11 00:06:00 +020017517HTTP req_proto_http match if protocol is valid HTTP
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020017518HTTP_1.0 req_ver 1.0 match HTTP version 1.0
17519HTTP_1.1 req_ver 1.1 match HTTP version 1.1
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010017520HTTP_CONTENT hdr_val(content-length) gt 0 match an existing content-length
17521HTTP_URL_ABS url_reg ^[^/:]*:// match absolute URL with scheme
17522HTTP_URL_SLASH url_beg / match URL beginning with "/"
17523HTTP_URL_STAR url * match URL equal to "*"
17524LOCALHOST src 127.0.0.1/8 match connection from local host
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020017525METH_CONNECT method CONNECT match HTTP CONNECT method
Daniel Schneller9ff96c72016-04-11 17:45:29 +020017526METH_DELETE method DELETE match HTTP DELETE method
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020017527METH_GET method GET HEAD match HTTP GET or HEAD method
17528METH_HEAD method HEAD match HTTP HEAD method
17529METH_OPTIONS method OPTIONS match HTTP OPTIONS method
17530METH_POST method POST match HTTP POST method
Daniel Schneller9ff96c72016-04-11 17:45:29 +020017531METH_PUT method PUT match HTTP PUT method
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020017532METH_TRACE method TRACE match HTTP TRACE method
Emeric Brunbede3d02009-06-30 17:54:00 +020017533RDP_COOKIE req_rdp_cookie_cnt gt 0 match presence of an RDP cookie
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020017534REQ_CONTENT req_len gt 0 match data in the request buffer
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010017535TRUE always_true always match
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020017536WAIT_END wait_end wait for end of content analysis
17537---------------+-----------------------------+---------------------------------
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +010017538
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010017539
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200175408. Logging
17541----------
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010017542
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017543One of HAProxy's strong points certainly lies is its precise logs. It probably
17544provides the finest level of information available for such a product, which is
17545very important for troubleshooting complex environments. Standard information
17546provided in logs include client ports, TCP/HTTP state timers, precise session
17547state at termination and precise termination cause, information about decisions
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010017548to direct traffic to a server, and of course the ability to capture arbitrary
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017549headers.
17550
17551In order to improve administrators reactivity, it offers a great transparency
17552about encountered problems, both internal and external, and it is possible to
17553send logs to different sources at the same time with different level filters :
17554
17555 - global process-level logs (system errors, start/stop, etc..)
17556 - per-instance system and internal errors (lack of resource, bugs, ...)
17557 - per-instance external troubles (servers up/down, max connections)
17558 - per-instance activity (client connections), either at the establishment or
17559 at the termination.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017560 - per-request control of log-level, e.g.
Jim Freeman9e8714b2015-05-26 09:16:34 -060017561 http-request set-log-level silent if sensitive_request
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017562
17563The ability to distribute different levels of logs to different log servers
17564allow several production teams to interact and to fix their problems as soon
17565as possible. For example, the system team might monitor system-wide errors,
17566while the application team might be monitoring the up/down for their servers in
17567real time, and the security team might analyze the activity logs with one hour
17568delay.
17569
17570
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200175718.1. Log levels
17572---------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017573
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +090017574TCP and HTTP connections can be logged with information such as the date, time,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017575source IP address, destination address, connection duration, response times,
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +090017576HTTP request, HTTP return code, number of bytes transmitted, conditions
17577in which the session ended, and even exchanged cookies values. For example
17578track a particular user's problems. All messages may be sent to up to two
17579syslog servers. Check the "log" keyword in section 4.2 for more information
17580about log facilities.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017581
17582
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200175838.2. Log formats
17584----------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017585
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010017586HAProxy supports 5 log formats. Several fields are common between these formats
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +090017587and will be detailed in the following sections. A few of them may vary
17588slightly with the configuration, due to indicators specific to certain
17589options. The supported formats are as follows :
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017590
17591 - the default format, which is very basic and very rarely used. It only
17592 provides very basic information about the incoming connection at the moment
17593 it is accepted : source IP:port, destination IP:port, and frontend-name.
17594 This mode will eventually disappear so it will not be described to great
17595 extents.
17596
17597 - the TCP format, which is more advanced. This format is enabled when "option
17598 tcplog" is set on the frontend. HAProxy will then usually wait for the
17599 connection to terminate before logging. This format provides much richer
17600 information, such as timers, connection counts, queue size, etc... This
17601 format is recommended for pure TCP proxies.
17602
17603 - the HTTP format, which is the most advanced for HTTP proxying. This format
17604 is enabled when "option httplog" is set on the frontend. It provides the
17605 same information as the TCP format with some HTTP-specific fields such as
17606 the request, the status code, and captures of headers and cookies. This
17607 format is recommended for HTTP proxies.
17608
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +020017609 - the CLF HTTP format, which is equivalent to the HTTP format, but with the
17610 fields arranged in the same order as the CLF format. In this mode, all
17611 timers, captures, flags, etc... appear one per field after the end of the
17612 common fields, in the same order they appear in the standard HTTP format.
17613
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010017614 - the custom log format, allows you to make your own log line.
17615
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017616Next sections will go deeper into details for each of these formats. Format
17617specification will be performed on a "field" basis. Unless stated otherwise, a
17618field is a portion of text delimited by any number of spaces. Since syslog
17619servers are susceptible of inserting fields at the beginning of a line, it is
17620always assumed that the first field is the one containing the process name and
17621identifier.
17622
17623Note : Since log lines may be quite long, the log examples in sections below
17624 might be broken into multiple lines. The example log lines will be
17625 prefixed with 3 closing angle brackets ('>>>') and each time a log is
17626 broken into multiple lines, each non-final line will end with a
17627 backslash ('\') and the next line will start indented by two characters.
17628
17629
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200176308.2.1. Default log format
17631-------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017632
17633This format is used when no specific option is set. The log is emitted as soon
17634as the connection is accepted. One should note that this currently is the only
17635format which logs the request's destination IP and ports.
17636
17637 Example :
17638 listen www
17639 mode http
17640 log global
17641 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
17642
17643 >>> Feb 6 12:12:09 localhost \
17644 haproxy[14385]: Connect from 10.0.1.2:33312 to 10.0.3.31:8012 \
17645 (www/HTTP)
17646
17647 Field Format Extract from the example above
17648 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14385]:
17649 2 'Connect from' Connect from
17650 3 source_ip ':' source_port 10.0.1.2:33312
17651 4 'to' to
17652 5 destination_ip ':' destination_port 10.0.3.31:8012
17653 6 '(' frontend_name '/' mode ')' (www/HTTP)
17654
17655Detailed fields description :
17656 - "source_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the connection.
17657 - "source_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
17658 - "destination_ip" is the IP address the client connected to.
17659 - "destination_port" is the TCP port the client connected to.
17660 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
17661 and processed the connection.
17662 - "mode is the mode the frontend is operating (TCP or HTTP).
17663
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010017664In case of a UNIX socket, the source and destination addresses are marked as
17665"unix:" and the ports reflect the internal ID of the socket which accepted the
17666connection (the same ID as reported in the stats).
17667
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017668It is advised not to use this deprecated format for newer installations as it
17669will eventually disappear.
17670
17671
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200176728.2.2. TCP log format
17673---------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017674
17675The TCP format is used when "option tcplog" is specified in the frontend, and
17676is the recommended format for pure TCP proxies. It provides a lot of precious
17677information for troubleshooting. Since this format includes timers and byte
17678counts, the log is normally emitted at the end of the session. It can be
17679emitted earlier if "option logasap" is specified, which makes sense in most
17680environments with long sessions such as remote terminals. Sessions which match
17681the "monitor" rules are never logged. It is also possible not to emit logs for
17682sessions for which no data were exchanged between the client and the server, by
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020017683specifying "option dontlognull" in the frontend. Successful connections will
17684not be logged if "option dontlog-normal" is specified in the frontend. A few
17685fields may slightly vary depending on some configuration options, those are
17686marked with a star ('*') after the field name below.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017687
17688 Example :
17689 frontend fnt
17690 mode tcp
17691 option tcplog
17692 log global
17693 default_backend bck
17694
17695 backend bck
17696 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
17697
17698 >>> Feb 6 12:12:56 localhost \
17699 haproxy[14387]: 10.0.1.2:33313 [06/Feb/2009:12:12:51.443] fnt \
17700 bck/srv1 0/0/5007 212 -- 0/0/0/0/3 0/0
17701
17702 Field Format Extract from the example above
17703 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14387]:
17704 2 client_ip ':' client_port 10.0.1.2:33313
17705 3 '[' accept_date ']' [06/Feb/2009:12:12:51.443]
17706 4 frontend_name fnt
17707 5 backend_name '/' server_name bck/srv1
17708 6 Tw '/' Tc '/' Tt* 0/0/5007
17709 7 bytes_read* 212
17710 8 termination_state --
17711 9 actconn '/' feconn '/' beconn '/' srv_conn '/' retries* 0/0/0/0/3
17712 10 srv_queue '/' backend_queue 0/0
17713
17714Detailed fields description :
17715 - "client_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the TCP
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010017716 connection to haproxy. If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket
17717 instead, the IP address would be replaced with the word "unix". Note that
17718 when the connection is accepted on a socket configured with "accept-proxy"
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010017719 and the PROXY protocol is correctly used, or with a "accept-netscaler-cip"
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017720 and the NetScaler Client IP insertion protocol is correctly used, then the
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010017721 logs will reflect the forwarded connection's information.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017722
17723 - "client_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010017724 If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket instead, the port would be
17725 replaced with the ID of the accepting socket, which is also reported in the
17726 stats interface.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017727
17728 - "accept_date" is the exact date when the connection was received by haproxy
17729 (which might be very slightly different from the date observed on the
17730 network if there was some queuing in the system's backlog). This is usually
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020017731 the same date which may appear in any upstream firewall's log. When used in
17732 HTTP mode, the accept_date field will be reset to the first moment the
17733 connection is ready to receive a new request (end of previous response for
17734 HTTP/1, immediately after previous request for HTTP/2).
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017735
17736 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
17737 and processed the connection.
17738
17739 - "backend_name" is the name of the backend (or listener) which was selected
17740 to manage the connection to the server. This will be the same as the
17741 frontend if no switching rule has been applied, which is common for TCP
17742 applications.
17743
17744 - "server_name" is the name of the last server to which the connection was
17745 sent, which might differ from the first one if there were connection errors
17746 and a redispatch occurred. Note that this server belongs to the backend
17747 which processed the request. If the connection was aborted before reaching
17748 a server, "<NOSRV>" is indicated instead of a server name.
17749
17750 - "Tw" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting in the various queues.
17751 It can be "-1" if the connection was aborted before reaching the queue.
17752 See "Timers" below for more details.
17753
17754 - "Tc" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the connection to
17755 establish to the final server, including retries. It can be "-1" if the
17756 connection was aborted before a connection could be established. See
17757 "Timers" below for more details.
17758
17759 - "Tt" is the total time in milliseconds elapsed between the accept and the
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030017760 last close. It covers all possible processing. There is one exception, if
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017761 "option logasap" was specified, then the time counting stops at the moment
17762 the log is emitted. In this case, a '+' sign is prepended before the value,
17763 indicating that the final one will be larger. See "Timers" below for more
17764 details.
17765
17766 - "bytes_read" is the total number of bytes transmitted from the server to
17767 the client when the log is emitted. If "option logasap" is specified, the
17768 this value will be prefixed with a '+' sign indicating that the final one
17769 may be larger. Please note that this value is a 64-bit counter, so log
17770 analysis tools must be able to handle it without overflowing.
17771
17772 - "termination_state" is the condition the session was in when the session
17773 ended. This indicates the session state, which side caused the end of
17774 session to happen, and for what reason (timeout, error, ...). The normal
17775 flags should be "--", indicating the session was closed by either end with
17776 no data remaining in buffers. See below "Session state at disconnection"
17777 for more details.
17778
17779 - "actconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the process when
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040017780 the session was logged. It is useful to detect when some per-process system
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017781 limits have been reached. For instance, if actconn is close to 512 when
17782 multiple connection errors occur, chances are high that the system limits
17783 the process to use a maximum of 1024 file descriptors and that all of them
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020017784 are used. See section 3 "Global parameters" to find how to tune the system.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017785
17786 - "feconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the frontend when
17787 the session was logged. It is useful to estimate the amount of resource
17788 required to sustain high loads, and to detect when the frontend's "maxconn"
17789 has been reached. Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is
17790 because there is congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be
17791 caused by a denial of service attack.
17792
17793 - "beconn" is the total number of concurrent connections handled by the
17794 backend when the session was logged. It includes the total number of
17795 concurrent connections active on servers as well as the number of
17796 connections pending in queues. It is useful to estimate the amount of
17797 additional servers needed to support high loads for a given application.
17798 Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is because there is
17799 congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be caused by a
17800 denial of service attack.
17801
17802 - "srv_conn" is the total number of concurrent connections still active on
17803 the server when the session was logged. It can never exceed the server's
17804 configured "maxconn" parameter. If this value is very often close or equal
17805 to the server's "maxconn", it means that traffic regulation is involved a
17806 lot, meaning that either the server's maxconn value is too low, or that
17807 there aren't enough servers to process the load with an optimal response
17808 time. When only one of the server's "srv_conn" is high, it usually means
17809 that this server has some trouble causing the connections to take longer to
17810 be processed than on other servers.
17811
17812 - "retries" is the number of connection retries experienced by this session
17813 when trying to connect to the server. It must normally be zero, unless a
17814 server is being stopped at the same moment the connection was attempted.
17815 Frequent retries generally indicate either a network problem between
17816 haproxy and the server, or a misconfigured system backlog on the server
17817 preventing new connections from being queued. This field may optionally be
17818 prefixed with a '+' sign, indicating that the session has experienced a
17819 redispatch after the maximal retry count has been reached on the initial
17820 server. In this case, the server name appearing in the log is the one the
17821 connection was redispatched to, and not the first one, though both may
17822 sometimes be the same in case of hashing for instance. So as a general rule
17823 of thumb, when a '+' is present in front of the retry count, this count
17824 should not be attributed to the logged server.
17825
17826 - "srv_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
17827 this one in the server queue. It is zero when the request has not gone
17828 through the server queue. It makes it possible to estimate the approximate
17829 server's response time by dividing the time spent in queue by the number of
17830 requests in the queue. It is worth noting that if a session experiences a
17831 redispatch and passes through two server queues, their positions will be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017832 cumulative. A request should not pass through both the server queue and the
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017833 backend queue unless a redispatch occurs.
17834
17835 - "backend_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
17836 this one in the backend's global queue. It is zero when the request has not
17837 gone through the global queue. It makes it possible to estimate the average
17838 queue length, which easily translates into a number of missing servers when
17839 divided by a server's "maxconn" parameter. It is worth noting that if a
17840 session experiences a redispatch, it may pass twice in the backend's queue,
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017841 and then both positions will be cumulative. A request should not pass
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017842 through both the server queue and the backend queue unless a redispatch
17843 occurs.
17844
17845
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200178468.2.3. HTTP log format
17847----------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017848
17849The HTTP format is the most complete and the best suited for HTTP proxies. It
17850is enabled by when "option httplog" is specified in the frontend. It provides
17851the same level of information as the TCP format with additional features which
17852are specific to the HTTP protocol. Just like the TCP format, the log is usually
17853emitted at the end of the session, unless "option logasap" is specified, which
17854generally only makes sense for download sites. A session which matches the
17855"monitor" rules will never logged. It is also possible not to log sessions for
17856which no data were sent by the client by specifying "option dontlognull" in the
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020017857frontend. Successful connections will not be logged if "option dontlog-normal"
17858is specified in the frontend.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017859
17860Most fields are shared with the TCP log, some being different. A few fields may
17861slightly vary depending on some configuration options. Those ones are marked
17862with a star ('*') after the field name below.
17863
17864 Example :
17865 frontend http-in
17866 mode http
17867 option httplog
17868 log global
17869 default_backend bck
17870
17871 backend static
17872 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
17873
17874 >>> Feb 6 12:14:14 localhost \
17875 haproxy[14389]: 10.0.1.2:33317 [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655] http-in \
17876 static/srv1 10/0/30/69/109 200 2750 - - ---- 1/1/1/1/0 0/0 {1wt.eu} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010017877 {} "GET /index.html HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017878
17879 Field Format Extract from the example above
17880 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14389]:
17881 2 client_ip ':' client_port 10.0.1.2:33317
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017882 3 '[' request_date ']' [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655]
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017883 4 frontend_name http-in
17884 5 backend_name '/' server_name static/srv1
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017885 6 TR '/' Tw '/' Tc '/' Tr '/' Ta* 10/0/30/69/109
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017886 7 status_code 200
17887 8 bytes_read* 2750
17888 9 captured_request_cookie -
17889 10 captured_response_cookie -
17890 11 termination_state ----
17891 12 actconn '/' feconn '/' beconn '/' srv_conn '/' retries* 1/1/1/1/0
17892 13 srv_queue '/' backend_queue 0/0
17893 14 '{' captured_request_headers* '}' {haproxy.1wt.eu}
17894 15 '{' captured_response_headers* '}' {}
17895 16 '"' http_request '"' "GET /index.html HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010017896
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017897Detailed fields description :
17898 - "client_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the TCP
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010017899 connection to haproxy. If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket
17900 instead, the IP address would be replaced with the word "unix". Note that
17901 when the connection is accepted on a socket configured with "accept-proxy"
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010017902 and the PROXY protocol is correctly used, or with a "accept-netscaler-cip"
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017903 and the NetScaler Client IP insertion protocol is correctly used, then the
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010017904 logs will reflect the forwarded connection's information.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017905
17906 - "client_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010017907 If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket instead, the port would be
17908 replaced with the ID of the accepting socket, which is also reported in the
17909 stats interface.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017910
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017911 - "request_date" is the exact date when the first byte of the HTTP request
17912 was received by haproxy (log field %tr).
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017913
17914 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
17915 and processed the connection.
17916
17917 - "backend_name" is the name of the backend (or listener) which was selected
17918 to manage the connection to the server. This will be the same as the
17919 frontend if no switching rule has been applied.
17920
17921 - "server_name" is the name of the last server to which the connection was
17922 sent, which might differ from the first one if there were connection errors
17923 and a redispatch occurred. Note that this server belongs to the backend
17924 which processed the request. If the request was aborted before reaching a
17925 server, "<NOSRV>" is indicated instead of a server name. If the request was
17926 intercepted by the stats subsystem, "<STATS>" is indicated instead.
17927
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017928 - "TR" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for a full HTTP
17929 request from the client (not counting body) after the first byte was
17930 received. It can be "-1" if the connection was aborted before a complete
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050017931 request could be received or a bad request was received. It should
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017932 always be very small because a request generally fits in one single packet.
17933 Large times here generally indicate network issues between the client and
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020017934 haproxy or requests being typed by hand. See section 8.4 "Timing Events"
17935 for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017936
17937 - "Tw" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting in the various queues.
17938 It can be "-1" if the connection was aborted before reaching the queue.
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020017939 See section 8.4 "Timing Events" for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017940
17941 - "Tc" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the connection to
17942 establish to the final server, including retries. It can be "-1" if the
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020017943 request was aborted before a connection could be established. See section
17944 8.4 "Timing Events" for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017945
17946 - "Tr" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the server to send
17947 a full HTTP response, not counting data. It can be "-1" if the request was
17948 aborted before a complete response could be received. It generally matches
17949 the server's processing time for the request, though it may be altered by
17950 the amount of data sent by the client to the server. Large times here on
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020017951 "GET" requests generally indicate an overloaded server. See section 8.4
17952 "Timing Events" for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017953
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017954 - "Ta" is the time the request remained active in haproxy, which is the total
17955 time in milliseconds elapsed between the first byte of the request was
17956 received and the last byte of response was sent. It covers all possible
17957 processing except the handshake (see Th) and idle time (see Ti). There is
17958 one exception, if "option logasap" was specified, then the time counting
17959 stops at the moment the log is emitted. In this case, a '+' sign is
17960 prepended before the value, indicating that the final one will be larger.
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020017961 See section 8.4 "Timing Events" for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017962
17963 - "status_code" is the HTTP status code returned to the client. This status
17964 is generally set by the server, but it might also be set by haproxy when
17965 the server cannot be reached or when its response is blocked by haproxy.
17966
17967 - "bytes_read" is the total number of bytes transmitted to the client when
17968 the log is emitted. This does include HTTP headers. If "option logasap" is
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050017969 specified, this value will be prefixed with a '+' sign indicating that
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017970 the final one may be larger. Please note that this value is a 64-bit
17971 counter, so log analysis tools must be able to handle it without
17972 overflowing.
17973
17974 - "captured_request_cookie" is an optional "name=value" entry indicating that
17975 the client had this cookie in the request. The cookie name and its maximum
17976 length are defined by the "capture cookie" statement in the frontend
17977 configuration. The field is a single dash ('-') when the option is not
17978 set. Only one cookie may be captured, it is generally used to track session
17979 ID exchanges between a client and a server to detect session crossing
17980 between clients due to application bugs. For more details, please consult
17981 the section "Capturing HTTP headers and cookies" below.
17982
17983 - "captured_response_cookie" is an optional "name=value" entry indicating
17984 that the server has returned a cookie with its response. The cookie name
17985 and its maximum length are defined by the "capture cookie" statement in the
17986 frontend configuration. The field is a single dash ('-') when the option is
17987 not set. Only one cookie may be captured, it is generally used to track
17988 session ID exchanges between a client and a server to detect session
17989 crossing between clients due to application bugs. For more details, please
17990 consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers and cookies" below.
17991
17992 - "termination_state" is the condition the session was in when the session
17993 ended. This indicates the session state, which side caused the end of
17994 session to happen, for what reason (timeout, error, ...), just like in TCP
17995 logs, and information about persistence operations on cookies in the last
17996 two characters. The normal flags should begin with "--", indicating the
17997 session was closed by either end with no data remaining in buffers. See
17998 below "Session state at disconnection" for more details.
17999
18000 - "actconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the process when
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040018001 the session was logged. It is useful to detect when some per-process system
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018002 limits have been reached. For instance, if actconn is close to 512 or 1024
18003 when multiple connection errors occur, chances are high that the system
18004 limits the process to use a maximum of 1024 file descriptors and that all
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020018005 of them are used. See section 3 "Global parameters" to find how to tune the
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018006 system.
18007
18008 - "feconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the frontend when
18009 the session was logged. It is useful to estimate the amount of resource
18010 required to sustain high loads, and to detect when the frontend's "maxconn"
18011 has been reached. Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is
18012 because there is congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be
18013 caused by a denial of service attack.
18014
18015 - "beconn" is the total number of concurrent connections handled by the
18016 backend when the session was logged. It includes the total number of
18017 concurrent connections active on servers as well as the number of
18018 connections pending in queues. It is useful to estimate the amount of
18019 additional servers needed to support high loads for a given application.
18020 Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is because there is
18021 congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be caused by a
18022 denial of service attack.
18023
18024 - "srv_conn" is the total number of concurrent connections still active on
18025 the server when the session was logged. It can never exceed the server's
18026 configured "maxconn" parameter. If this value is very often close or equal
18027 to the server's "maxconn", it means that traffic regulation is involved a
18028 lot, meaning that either the server's maxconn value is too low, or that
18029 there aren't enough servers to process the load with an optimal response
18030 time. When only one of the server's "srv_conn" is high, it usually means
18031 that this server has some trouble causing the requests to take longer to be
18032 processed than on other servers.
18033
18034 - "retries" is the number of connection retries experienced by this session
18035 when trying to connect to the server. It must normally be zero, unless a
18036 server is being stopped at the same moment the connection was attempted.
18037 Frequent retries generally indicate either a network problem between
18038 haproxy and the server, or a misconfigured system backlog on the server
18039 preventing new connections from being queued. This field may optionally be
18040 prefixed with a '+' sign, indicating that the session has experienced a
18041 redispatch after the maximal retry count has been reached on the initial
18042 server. In this case, the server name appearing in the log is the one the
18043 connection was redispatched to, and not the first one, though both may
18044 sometimes be the same in case of hashing for instance. So as a general rule
18045 of thumb, when a '+' is present in front of the retry count, this count
18046 should not be attributed to the logged server.
18047
18048 - "srv_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
18049 this one in the server queue. It is zero when the request has not gone
18050 through the server queue. It makes it possible to estimate the approximate
18051 server's response time by dividing the time spent in queue by the number of
18052 requests in the queue. It is worth noting that if a session experiences a
18053 redispatch and passes through two server queues, their positions will be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018054 cumulative. A request should not pass through both the server queue and the
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018055 backend queue unless a redispatch occurs.
18056
18057 - "backend_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
18058 this one in the backend's global queue. It is zero when the request has not
18059 gone through the global queue. It makes it possible to estimate the average
18060 queue length, which easily translates into a number of missing servers when
18061 divided by a server's "maxconn" parameter. It is worth noting that if a
18062 session experiences a redispatch, it may pass twice in the backend's queue,
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018063 and then both positions will be cumulative. A request should not pass
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018064 through both the server queue and the backend queue unless a redispatch
18065 occurs.
18066
18067 - "captured_request_headers" is a list of headers captured in the request due
18068 to the presence of the "capture request header" statement in the frontend.
18069 Multiple headers can be captured, they will be delimited by a vertical bar
18070 ('|'). When no capture is enabled, the braces do not appear, causing a
18071 shift of remaining fields. It is important to note that this field may
18072 contain spaces, and that using it requires a smarter log parser than when
18073 it's not used. Please consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers and
18074 cookies" below for more details.
18075
18076 - "captured_response_headers" is a list of headers captured in the response
18077 due to the presence of the "capture response header" statement in the
18078 frontend. Multiple headers can be captured, they will be delimited by a
18079 vertical bar ('|'). When no capture is enabled, the braces do not appear,
18080 causing a shift of remaining fields. It is important to note that this
18081 field may contain spaces, and that using it requires a smarter log parser
18082 than when it's not used. Please consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers
18083 and cookies" below for more details.
18084
18085 - "http_request" is the complete HTTP request line, including the method,
18086 request and HTTP version string. Non-printable characters are encoded (see
18087 below the section "Non-printable characters"). This is always the last
18088 field, and it is always delimited by quotes and is the only one which can
18089 contain quotes. If new fields are added to the log format, they will be
18090 added before this field. This field might be truncated if the request is
18091 huge and does not fit in the standard syslog buffer (1024 characters). This
18092 is the reason why this field must always remain the last one.
18093
18094
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +0200180958.2.4. Custom log format
18096------------------------
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010018097
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010018098The directive log-format allows you to customize the logs in http mode and tcp
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010018099mode. It takes a string as argument.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010018100
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018101HAProxy understands some log format variables. % precedes log format variables.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010018102Variables can take arguments using braces ('{}'), and multiple arguments are
18103separated by commas within the braces. Flags may be added or removed by
18104prefixing them with a '+' or '-' sign.
18105
18106Special variable "%o" may be used to propagate its flags to all other
18107variables on the same format string. This is particularly handy with quoted
Dragan Dosen835b9212016-02-12 13:23:03 +010018108("Q") and escaped ("E") string formats.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010018109
Willy Tarreauc8368452012-12-21 00:09:23 +010018110If a variable is named between square brackets ('[' .. ']') then it is used
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +020018111as a sample expression rule (see section 7.3). This it useful to add some
Willy Tarreauc8368452012-12-21 00:09:23 +010018112less common information such as the client's SSL certificate's DN, or to log
18113the key that would be used to store an entry into a stick table.
18114
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010018115Note: spaces must be escaped. A space character is considered as a separator.
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030018116In order to emit a verbatim '%', it must be preceded by another '%' resulting
Willy Tarreau06d97f92013-12-02 17:45:48 +010018117in '%%'. HAProxy will automatically merge consecutive separators.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010018118
Dragan Dosen835b9212016-02-12 13:23:03 +010018119Note: when using the RFC5424 syslog message format, the characters '"',
18120'\' and ']' inside PARAM-VALUE should be escaped with '\' as prefix (see
18121https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc5424#section-6.3.3 for more details). In
18122such cases, the use of the flag "E" should be considered.
18123
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010018124Flags are :
18125 * Q: quote a string
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040018126 * X: hexadecimal representation (IPs, Ports, %Ts, %rt, %pid)
Dragan Dosen835b9212016-02-12 13:23:03 +010018127 * E: escape characters '"', '\' and ']' in a string with '\' as prefix
18128 (intended purpose is for the RFC5424 structured-data log formats)
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010018129
18130 Example:
18131
18132 log-format %T\ %t\ Some\ Text
18133 log-format %{+Q}o\ %t\ %s\ %{-Q}r
18134
Dragan Dosen835b9212016-02-12 13:23:03 +010018135 log-format-sd %{+Q,+E}o\ [exampleSDID@1234\ header=%[capture.req.hdr(0)]]
18136
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010018137At the moment, the default HTTP format is defined this way :
18138
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020018139 log-format "%ci:%cp [%tr] %ft %b/%s %TR/%Tw/%Tc/%Tr/%Ta %ST %B %CC \
18140 %CS %tsc %ac/%fc/%bc/%sc/%rc %sq/%bq %hr %hs %{+Q}r"
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010018141
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010018142the default CLF format is defined this way :
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010018143
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020018144 log-format "%{+Q}o %{-Q}ci - - [%trg] %r %ST %B \"\" \"\" %cp \
18145 %ms %ft %b %s %TR %Tw %Tc %Tr %Ta %tsc %ac %fc \
18146 %bc %sc %rc %sq %bq %CC %CS %hrl %hsl"
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010018147
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010018148and the default TCP format is defined this way :
18149
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020018150 log-format "%ci:%cp [%t] %ft %b/%s %Tw/%Tc/%Tt %B %ts \
18151 %ac/%fc/%bc/%sc/%rc %sq/%bq"
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010018152
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010018153Please refer to the table below for currently defined variables :
18154
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010018155 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020018156 | R | var | field name (8.2.2 and 8.2.3 for description) | type |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010018157 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
18158 | | %o | special variable, apply flags on all next var | |
18159 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010018160 | | %B | bytes_read (from server to client) | numeric |
18161 | H | %CC | captured_request_cookie | string |
18162 | H | %CS | captured_response_cookie | string |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020018163 | | %H | hostname | string |
Andrew Hayworth0ebc55f2015-04-27 21:37:03 +000018164 | H | %HM | HTTP method (ex: POST) | string |
18165 | H | %HP | HTTP request URI without query string (path) | string |
Andrew Hayworthe63ac872015-07-31 16:14:16 +000018166 | H | %HQ | HTTP request URI query string (ex: ?bar=baz) | string |
Andrew Hayworth0ebc55f2015-04-27 21:37:03 +000018167 | H | %HU | HTTP request URI (ex: /foo?bar=baz) | string |
18168 | H | %HV | HTTP version (ex: HTTP/1.0) | string |
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010018169 | | %ID | unique-id | string |
Willy Tarreau4bf99632014-06-13 12:21:40 +020018170 | | %ST | status_code | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020018171 | | %T | gmt_date_time | date |
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020018172 | | %Ta | Active time of the request (from TR to end) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010018173 | | %Tc | Tc | numeric |
Willy Tarreau27b639d2016-05-17 17:55:27 +020018174 | | %Td | Td = Tt - (Tq + Tw + Tc + Tr) | numeric |
Yuxans Yao4e25b012012-10-19 10:36:09 +080018175 | | %Tl | local_date_time | date |
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020018176 | | %Th | connection handshake time (SSL, PROXY proto) | numeric |
18177 | H | %Ti | idle time before the HTTP request | numeric |
18178 | H | %Tq | Th + Ti + TR | numeric |
18179 | H | %TR | time to receive the full request from 1st byte| numeric |
18180 | H | %Tr | Tr (response time) | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020018181 | | %Ts | timestamp | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010018182 | | %Tt | Tt | numeric |
18183 | | %Tw | Tw | numeric |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010018184 | | %U | bytes_uploaded (from client to server) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010018185 | | %ac | actconn | numeric |
18186 | | %b | backend_name | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010018187 | | %bc | beconn (backend concurrent connections) | numeric |
18188 | | %bi | backend_source_ip (connecting address) | IP |
18189 | | %bp | backend_source_port (connecting address) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010018190 | | %bq | backend_queue | numeric |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010018191 | | %ci | client_ip (accepted address) | IP |
18192 | | %cp | client_port (accepted address) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010018193 | | %f | frontend_name | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010018194 | | %fc | feconn (frontend concurrent connections) | numeric |
18195 | | %fi | frontend_ip (accepting address) | IP |
18196 | | %fp | frontend_port (accepting address) | numeric |
Willy Tarreau773d65f2012-10-12 14:56:11 +020018197 | | %ft | frontend_name_transport ('~' suffix for SSL) | string |
Willy Tarreau7346acb2014-08-28 15:03:15 +020018198 | | %lc | frontend_log_counter | numeric |
Willy Tarreaud9ed3d22014-06-13 12:23:06 +020018199 | | %hr | captured_request_headers default style | string |
18200 | | %hrl | captured_request_headers CLF style | string list |
18201 | | %hs | captured_response_headers default style | string |
18202 | | %hsl | captured_response_headers CLF style | string list |
Willy Tarreau812c88e2015-08-09 10:56:35 +020018203 | | %ms | accept date milliseconds (left-padded with 0) | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020018204 | | %pid | PID | numeric |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020018205 | H | %r | http_request | string |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010018206 | | %rc | retries | numeric |
Willy Tarreau1f0da242014-01-25 11:01:50 +010018207 | | %rt | request_counter (HTTP req or TCP session) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010018208 | | %s | server_name | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010018209 | | %sc | srv_conn (server concurrent connections) | numeric |
18210 | | %si | server_IP (target address) | IP |
18211 | | %sp | server_port (target address) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010018212 | | %sq | srv_queue | numeric |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020018213 | S | %sslc| ssl_ciphers (ex: AES-SHA) | string |
18214 | S | %sslv| ssl_version (ex: TLSv1) | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010018215 | | %t | date_time (with millisecond resolution) | date |
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020018216 | H | %tr | date_time of HTTP request | date |
18217 | H | %trg | gmt_date_time of start of HTTP request | date |
Jens Bissinger15c64ff2018-08-23 14:11:27 +020018218 | H | %trl | local_date_time of start of HTTP request | date |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010018219 | | %ts | termination_state | string |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020018220 | H | %tsc | termination_state with cookie status | string |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010018221 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010018222
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020018223 R = Restrictions : H = mode http only ; S = SSL only
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010018224
Willy Tarreau5f51e1a2012-12-03 18:40:10 +010018225
182268.2.5. Error log format
18227-----------------------
18228
18229When an incoming connection fails due to an SSL handshake or an invalid PROXY
18230protocol header, haproxy will log the event using a shorter, fixed line format.
18231By default, logs are emitted at the LOG_INFO level, unless the option
18232"log-separate-errors" is set in the backend, in which case the LOG_ERR level
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018233will be used. Connections on which no data are exchanged (e.g. probes) are not
Willy Tarreau5f51e1a2012-12-03 18:40:10 +010018234logged if the "dontlognull" option is set.
18235
18236The format looks like this :
18237
18238 >>> Dec 3 18:27:14 localhost \
18239 haproxy[6103]: 127.0.0.1:56059 [03/Dec/2012:17:35:10.380] frt/f1: \
18240 Connection error during SSL handshake
18241
18242 Field Format Extract from the example above
18243 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[6103]:
18244 2 client_ip ':' client_port 127.0.0.1:56059
18245 3 '[' accept_date ']' [03/Dec/2012:17:35:10.380]
18246 4 frontend_name "/" bind_name ":" frt/f1:
18247 5 message Connection error during SSL handshake
18248
18249These fields just provide minimal information to help debugging connection
18250failures.
18251
18252
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200182538.3. Advanced logging options
18254-----------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018255
18256Some advanced logging options are often looked for but are not easy to find out
18257just by looking at the various options. Here is an entry point for the few
18258options which can enable better logging. Please refer to the keywords reference
18259for more information about their usage.
18260
18261
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200182628.3.1. Disabling logging of external tests
18263------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018264
18265It is quite common to have some monitoring tools perform health checks on
18266haproxy. Sometimes it will be a layer 3 load-balancer such as LVS or any
18267commercial load-balancer, and sometimes it will simply be a more complete
18268monitoring system such as Nagios. When the tests are very frequent, users often
18269ask how to disable logging for those checks. There are three possibilities :
18270
18271 - if connections come from everywhere and are just TCP probes, it is often
18272 desired to simply disable logging of connections without data exchange, by
18273 setting "option dontlognull" in the frontend. It also disables logging of
18274 port scans, which may or may not be desired.
18275
18276 - if the connection come from a known source network, use "monitor-net" to
18277 declare this network as monitoring only. Any host in this network will then
18278 only be able to perform health checks, and their requests will not be
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030018279 logged. This is generally appropriate to designate a list of equipment
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018280 such as other load-balancers.
18281
18282 - if the tests are performed on a known URI, use "monitor-uri" to declare
18283 this URI as dedicated to monitoring. Any host sending this request will
18284 only get the result of a health-check, and the request will not be logged.
18285
18286
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200182878.3.2. Logging before waiting for the session to terminate
18288----------------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018289
18290The problem with logging at end of connection is that you have no clue about
18291what is happening during very long sessions, such as remote terminal sessions
18292or large file downloads. This problem can be worked around by specifying
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018293"option logasap" in the frontend. HAProxy will then log as soon as possible,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018294just before data transfer begins. This means that in case of TCP, it will still
18295log the connection status to the server, and in case of HTTP, it will log just
18296after processing the server headers. In this case, the number of bytes reported
18297is the number of header bytes sent to the client. In order to avoid confusion
18298with normal logs, the total time field and the number of bytes are prefixed
18299with a '+' sign which means that real numbers are certainly larger.
18300
18301
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200183028.3.3. Raising log level upon errors
18303------------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020018304
18305Sometimes it is more convenient to separate normal traffic from errors logs,
18306for instance in order to ease error monitoring from log files. When the option
18307"log-separate-errors" is used, connections which experience errors, timeouts,
18308retries, redispatches or HTTP status codes 5xx will see their syslog level
18309raised from "info" to "err". This will help a syslog daemon store the log in
18310a separate file. It is very important to keep the errors in the normal traffic
18311file too, so that log ordering is not altered. You should also be careful if
18312you already have configured your syslog daemon to store all logs higher than
18313"notice" in an "admin" file, because the "err" level is higher than "notice".
18314
18315
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200183168.3.4. Disabling logging of successful connections
18317--------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020018318
18319Although this may sound strange at first, some large sites have to deal with
18320multiple thousands of logs per second and are experiencing difficulties keeping
18321them intact for a long time or detecting errors within them. If the option
18322"dontlog-normal" is set on the frontend, all normal connections will not be
18323logged. In this regard, a normal connection is defined as one without any
18324error, timeout, retry nor redispatch. In HTTP, the status code is checked too,
18325and a response with a status 5xx is not considered normal and will be logged
18326too. Of course, doing is is really discouraged as it will remove most of the
18327useful information from the logs. Do this only if you have no other
18328alternative.
18329
18330
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200183318.4. Timing events
18332------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018333
18334Timers provide a great help in troubleshooting network problems. All values are
18335reported in milliseconds (ms). These timers should be used in conjunction with
18336the session termination flags. In TCP mode with "option tcplog" set on the
18337frontend, 3 control points are reported under the form "Tw/Tc/Tt", and in HTTP
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020018338mode, 5 control points are reported under the form "TR/Tw/Tc/Tr/Ta". In
18339addition, three other measures are provided, "Th", "Ti", and "Tq".
18340
Guillaume de Lafondf27cddc2016-12-23 17:32:43 +010018341Timings events in HTTP mode:
18342
18343 first request 2nd request
18344 |<-------------------------------->|<-------------- ...
18345 t tr t tr ...
18346 ---|----|----|----|----|----|----|----|----|--
18347 : Th Ti TR Tw Tc Tr Td : Ti ...
18348 :<---- Tq ---->: :
18349 :<-------------- Tt -------------->:
18350 :<--------- Ta --------->:
18351
18352Timings events in TCP mode:
18353
18354 TCP session
18355 |<----------------->|
18356 t t
18357 ---|----|----|----|----|---
18358 | Th Tw Tc Td |
18359 |<------ Tt ------->|
18360
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020018361 - Th: total time to accept tcp connection and execute handshakes for low level
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018362 protocols. Currently, these protocols are proxy-protocol and SSL. This may
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020018363 only happen once during the whole connection's lifetime. A large time here
18364 may indicate that the client only pre-established the connection without
18365 speaking, that it is experiencing network issues preventing it from
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018366 completing a handshake in a reasonable time (e.g. MTU issues), or that an
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020018367 SSL handshake was very expensive to compute. Please note that this time is
18368 reported only before the first request, so it is safe to average it over
18369 all request to calculate the amortized value. The second and subsequent
18370 request will always report zero here.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018371
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020018372 - Ti: is the idle time before the HTTP request (HTTP mode only). This timer
18373 counts between the end of the handshakes and the first byte of the HTTP
18374 request. When dealing with a second request in keep-alive mode, it starts
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020018375 to count after the end of the transmission the previous response. When a
18376 multiplexed protocol such as HTTP/2 is used, it starts to count immediately
18377 after the previous request. Some browsers pre-establish connections to a
18378 server in order to reduce the latency of a future request, and keep them
18379 pending until they need it. This delay will be reported as the idle time. A
18380 value of -1 indicates that nothing was received on the connection.
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020018381
18382 - TR: total time to get the client request (HTTP mode only). It's the time
18383 elapsed between the first bytes received and the moment the proxy received
18384 the empty line marking the end of the HTTP headers. The value "-1"
18385 indicates that the end of headers has never been seen. This happens when
18386 the client closes prematurely or times out. This time is usually very short
18387 since most requests fit in a single packet. A large time may indicate a
18388 request typed by hand during a test.
18389
18390 - Tq: total time to get the client request from the accept date or since the
18391 emission of the last byte of the previous response (HTTP mode only). It's
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018392 exactly equal to Th + Ti + TR unless any of them is -1, in which case it
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020018393 returns -1 as well. This timer used to be very useful before the arrival of
18394 HTTP keep-alive and browsers' pre-connect feature. It's recommended to drop
18395 it in favor of TR nowadays, as the idle time adds a lot of noise to the
18396 reports.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018397
18398 - Tw: total time spent in the queues waiting for a connection slot. It
18399 accounts for backend queue as well as the server queues, and depends on the
18400 queue size, and the time needed for the server to complete previous
18401 requests. The value "-1" means that the request was killed before reaching
18402 the queue, which is generally what happens with invalid or denied requests.
18403
18404 - Tc: total time to establish the TCP connection to the server. It's the time
18405 elapsed between the moment the proxy sent the connection request, and the
18406 moment it was acknowledged by the server, or between the TCP SYN packet and
18407 the matching SYN/ACK packet in return. The value "-1" means that the
18408 connection never established.
18409
18410 - Tr: server response time (HTTP mode only). It's the time elapsed between
18411 the moment the TCP connection was established to the server and the moment
18412 the server sent its complete response headers. It purely shows its request
18413 processing time, without the network overhead due to the data transmission.
18414 It is worth noting that when the client has data to send to the server, for
18415 instance during a POST request, the time already runs, and this can distort
18416 apparent response time. For this reason, it's generally wise not to trust
18417 too much this field for POST requests initiated from clients behind an
18418 untrusted network. A value of "-1" here means that the last the response
18419 header (empty line) was never seen, most likely because the server timeout
18420 stroke before the server managed to process the request.
18421
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020018422 - Ta: total active time for the HTTP request, between the moment the proxy
18423 received the first byte of the request header and the emission of the last
18424 byte of the response body. The exception is when the "logasap" option is
18425 specified. In this case, it only equals (TR+Tw+Tc+Tr), and is prefixed with
18426 a '+' sign. From this field, we can deduce "Td", the data transmission time,
18427 by subtracting other timers when valid :
18428
18429 Td = Ta - (TR + Tw + Tc + Tr)
18430
18431 Timers with "-1" values have to be excluded from this equation. Note that
18432 "Ta" can never be negative.
18433
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018434 - Tt: total session duration time, between the moment the proxy accepted it
18435 and the moment both ends were closed. The exception is when the "logasap"
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020018436 option is specified. In this case, it only equals (Th+Ti+TR+Tw+Tc+Tr), and
18437 is prefixed with a '+' sign. From this field, we can deduce "Td", the data
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030018438 transmission time, by subtracting other timers when valid :
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018439
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020018440 Td = Tt - (Th + Ti + TR + Tw + Tc + Tr)
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018441
18442 Timers with "-1" values have to be excluded from this equation. In TCP
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020018443 mode, "Ti", "Tq" and "Tr" have to be excluded too. Note that "Tt" can never
18444 be negative and that for HTTP, Tt is simply equal to (Th+Ti+Ta).
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018445
18446These timers provide precious indications on trouble causes. Since the TCP
18447protocol defines retransmit delays of 3, 6, 12... seconds, we know for sure
18448that timers close to multiples of 3s are nearly always related to lost packets
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020018449due to network problems (wires, negotiation, congestion). Moreover, if "Ta" or
18450"Tt" is close to a timeout value specified in the configuration, it often means
18451that a session has been aborted on timeout.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018452
18453Most common cases :
18454
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020018455 - If "Th" or "Ti" are close to 3000, a packet has probably been lost between
18456 the client and the proxy. This is very rare on local networks but might
18457 happen when clients are on far remote networks and send large requests. It
18458 may happen that values larger than usual appear here without any network
18459 cause. Sometimes, during an attack or just after a resource starvation has
18460 ended, haproxy may accept thousands of connections in a few milliseconds.
18461 The time spent accepting these connections will inevitably slightly delay
18462 processing of other connections, and it can happen that request times in the
18463 order of a few tens of milliseconds are measured after a few thousands of
18464 new connections have been accepted at once. Using one of the keep-alive
18465 modes may display larger idle times since "Ti" measures the time spent
Patrick Mezard105faca2010-06-12 17:02:46 +020018466 waiting for additional requests.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018467
18468 - If "Tc" is close to 3000, a packet has probably been lost between the
18469 server and the proxy during the server connection phase. This value should
18470 always be very low, such as 1 ms on local networks and less than a few tens
18471 of ms on remote networks.
18472
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020018473 - If "Tr" is nearly always lower than 3000 except some rare values which seem
18474 to be the average majored by 3000, there are probably some packets lost
18475 between the proxy and the server.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018476
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020018477 - If "Ta" is large even for small byte counts, it generally is because
18478 neither the client nor the server decides to close the connection while
18479 haproxy is running in tunnel mode and both have agreed on a keep-alive
18480 connection mode. In order to solve this issue, it will be needed to specify
18481 one of the HTTP options to manipulate keep-alive or close options on either
18482 the frontend or the backend. Having the smallest possible 'Ta' or 'Tt' is
18483 important when connection regulation is used with the "maxconn" option on
18484 the servers, since no new connection will be sent to the server until
18485 another one is released.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018486
18487Other noticeable HTTP log cases ('xx' means any value to be ignored) :
18488
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020018489 TR/Tw/Tc/Tr/+Ta The "option logasap" is present on the frontend and the log
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018490 was emitted before the data phase. All the timers are valid
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020018491 except "Ta" which is shorter than reality.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018492
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020018493 -1/xx/xx/xx/Ta The client was not able to send a complete request in time
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018494 or it aborted too early. Check the session termination flags
18495 then "timeout http-request" and "timeout client" settings.
18496
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020018497 TR/-1/xx/xx/Ta It was not possible to process the request, maybe because
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018498 servers were out of order, because the request was invalid
18499 or forbidden by ACL rules. Check the session termination
18500 flags.
18501
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020018502 TR/Tw/-1/xx/Ta The connection could not establish on the server. Either it
18503 actively refused it or it timed out after Ta-(TR+Tw) ms.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018504 Check the session termination flags, then check the
18505 "timeout connect" setting. Note that the tarpit action might
18506 return similar-looking patterns, with "Tw" equal to the time
18507 the client connection was maintained open.
18508
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020018509 TR/Tw/Tc/-1/Ta The server has accepted the connection but did not return
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030018510 a complete response in time, or it closed its connection
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020018511 unexpectedly after Ta-(TR+Tw+Tc) ms. Check the session
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018512 termination flags, then check the "timeout server" setting.
18513
18514
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200185158.5. Session state at disconnection
18516-----------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018517
18518TCP and HTTP logs provide a session termination indicator in the
18519"termination_state" field, just before the number of active connections. It is
185202-characters long in TCP mode, and is extended to 4 characters in HTTP mode,
18521each of which has a special meaning :
18522
18523 - On the first character, a code reporting the first event which caused the
18524 session to terminate :
18525
18526 C : the TCP session was unexpectedly aborted by the client.
18527
18528 S : the TCP session was unexpectedly aborted by the server, or the
18529 server explicitly refused it.
18530
18531 P : the session was prematurely aborted by the proxy, because of a
18532 connection limit enforcement, because a DENY filter was matched,
18533 because of a security check which detected and blocked a dangerous
18534 error in server response which might have caused information leak
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018535 (e.g. cacheable cookie).
Willy Tarreau570f2212013-06-10 16:42:09 +020018536
18537 L : the session was locally processed by haproxy and was not passed to
18538 a server. This is what happens for stats and redirects.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018539
18540 R : a resource on the proxy has been exhausted (memory, sockets, source
18541 ports, ...). Usually, this appears during the connection phase, and
18542 system logs should contain a copy of the precise error. If this
18543 happens, it must be considered as a very serious anomaly which
18544 should be fixed as soon as possible by any means.
18545
18546 I : an internal error was identified by the proxy during a self-check.
18547 This should NEVER happen, and you are encouraged to report any log
18548 containing this, because this would almost certainly be a bug. It
18549 would be wise to preventively restart the process after such an
18550 event too, in case it would be caused by memory corruption.
18551
Simon Horman752dc4a2011-06-21 14:34:59 +090018552 D : the session was killed by haproxy because the server was detected
18553 as down and was configured to kill all connections when going down.
18554
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -070018555 U : the session was killed by haproxy on this backup server because an
18556 active server was detected as up and was configured to kill all
18557 backup connections when going up.
18558
Willy Tarreaua2a64e92011-09-07 23:01:56 +020018559 K : the session was actively killed by an admin operating on haproxy.
18560
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018561 c : the client-side timeout expired while waiting for the client to
18562 send or receive data.
18563
18564 s : the server-side timeout expired while waiting for the server to
18565 send or receive data.
18566
18567 - : normal session completion, both the client and the server closed
18568 with nothing left in the buffers.
18569
18570 - on the second character, the TCP or HTTP session state when it was closed :
18571
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +010018572 R : the proxy was waiting for a complete, valid REQUEST from the client
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018573 (HTTP mode only). Nothing was sent to any server.
18574
18575 Q : the proxy was waiting in the QUEUE for a connection slot. This can
18576 only happen when servers have a 'maxconn' parameter set. It can
18577 also happen in the global queue after a redispatch consecutive to
18578 a failed attempt to connect to a dying server. If no redispatch is
18579 reported, then no connection attempt was made to any server.
18580
18581 C : the proxy was waiting for the CONNECTION to establish on the
18582 server. The server might at most have noticed a connection attempt.
18583
18584 H : the proxy was waiting for complete, valid response HEADERS from the
18585 server (HTTP only).
18586
18587 D : the session was in the DATA phase.
18588
18589 L : the proxy was still transmitting LAST data to the client while the
18590 server had already finished. This one is very rare as it can only
18591 happen when the client dies while receiving the last packets.
18592
18593 T : the request was tarpitted. It has been held open with the client
18594 during the whole "timeout tarpit" duration or until the client
18595 closed, both of which will be reported in the "Tw" timer.
18596
18597 - : normal session completion after end of data transfer.
18598
18599 - the third character tells whether the persistence cookie was provided by
18600 the client (only in HTTP mode) :
18601
18602 N : the client provided NO cookie. This is usually the case for new
18603 visitors, so counting the number of occurrences of this flag in the
18604 logs generally indicate a valid trend for the site frequentation.
18605
18606 I : the client provided an INVALID cookie matching no known server.
18607 This might be caused by a recent configuration change, mixed
Cyril Bontéa8e7bbc2010-04-25 22:29:29 +020018608 cookies between HTTP/HTTPS sites, persistence conditionally
18609 ignored, or an attack.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018610
18611 D : the client provided a cookie designating a server which was DOWN,
18612 so either "option persist" was used and the client was sent to
18613 this server, or it was not set and the client was redispatched to
18614 another server.
18615
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020018616 V : the client provided a VALID cookie, and was sent to the associated
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018617 server.
18618
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020018619 E : the client provided a valid cookie, but with a last date which was
18620 older than what is allowed by the "maxidle" cookie parameter, so
18621 the cookie is consider EXPIRED and is ignored. The request will be
18622 redispatched just as if there was no cookie.
18623
18624 O : the client provided a valid cookie, but with a first date which was
18625 older than what is allowed by the "maxlife" cookie parameter, so
18626 the cookie is consider too OLD and is ignored. The request will be
18627 redispatched just as if there was no cookie.
18628
Willy Tarreauc89ccb62012-04-05 21:18:22 +020018629 U : a cookie was present but was not used to select the server because
18630 some other server selection mechanism was used instead (typically a
18631 "use-server" rule).
18632
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018633 - : does not apply (no cookie set in configuration).
18634
18635 - the last character reports what operations were performed on the persistence
18636 cookie returned by the server (only in HTTP mode) :
18637
18638 N : NO cookie was provided by the server, and none was inserted either.
18639
18640 I : no cookie was provided by the server, and the proxy INSERTED one.
18641 Note that in "cookie insert" mode, if the server provides a cookie,
18642 it will still be overwritten and reported as "I" here.
18643
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020018644 U : the proxy UPDATED the last date in the cookie that was presented by
18645 the client. This can only happen in insert mode with "maxidle". It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030018646 happens every time there is activity at a different date than the
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020018647 date indicated in the cookie. If any other change happens, such as
18648 a redispatch, then the cookie will be marked as inserted instead.
18649
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018650 P : a cookie was PROVIDED by the server and transmitted as-is.
18651
18652 R : the cookie provided by the server was REWRITTEN by the proxy, which
18653 happens in "cookie rewrite" or "cookie prefix" modes.
18654
18655 D : the cookie provided by the server was DELETED by the proxy.
18656
18657 - : does not apply (no cookie set in configuration).
18658
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020018659The combination of the two first flags gives a lot of information about what
18660was happening when the session terminated, and why it did terminate. It can be
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018661helpful to detect server saturation, network troubles, local system resource
18662starvation, attacks, etc...
18663
18664The most common termination flags combinations are indicated below. They are
18665alphabetically sorted, with the lowercase set just after the upper case for
18666easier finding and understanding.
18667
18668 Flags Reason
18669
18670 -- Normal termination.
18671
18672 CC The client aborted before the connection could be established to the
18673 server. This can happen when haproxy tries to connect to a recently
18674 dead (or unchecked) server, and the client aborts while haproxy is
18675 waiting for the server to respond or for "timeout connect" to expire.
18676
18677 CD The client unexpectedly aborted during data transfer. This can be
18678 caused by a browser crash, by an intermediate equipment between the
18679 client and haproxy which decided to actively break the connection,
18680 by network routing issues between the client and haproxy, or by a
18681 keep-alive session between the server and the client terminated first
18682 by the client.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010018683
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018684 cD The client did not send nor acknowledge any data for as long as the
18685 "timeout client" delay. This is often caused by network failures on
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020018686 the client side, or the client simply leaving the net uncleanly.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018687
18688 CH The client aborted while waiting for the server to start responding.
18689 It might be the server taking too long to respond or the client
18690 clicking the 'Stop' button too fast.
18691
18692 cH The "timeout client" stroke while waiting for client data during a
18693 POST request. This is sometimes caused by too large TCP MSS values
18694 for PPPoE networks which cannot transport full-sized packets. It can
18695 also happen when client timeout is smaller than server timeout and
18696 the server takes too long to respond.
18697
18698 CQ The client aborted while its session was queued, waiting for a server
18699 with enough empty slots to accept it. It might be that either all the
18700 servers were saturated or that the assigned server was taking too
18701 long a time to respond.
18702
18703 CR The client aborted before sending a full HTTP request. Most likely
18704 the request was typed by hand using a telnet client, and aborted
18705 too early. The HTTP status code is likely a 400 here. Sometimes this
18706 might also be caused by an IDS killing the connection between haproxy
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020018707 and the client. "option http-ignore-probes" can be used to ignore
18708 connections without any data transfer.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018709
18710 cR The "timeout http-request" stroke before the client sent a full HTTP
18711 request. This is sometimes caused by too large TCP MSS values on the
18712 client side for PPPoE networks which cannot transport full-sized
18713 packets, or by clients sending requests by hand and not typing fast
18714 enough, or forgetting to enter the empty line at the end of the
Willy Tarreau2705a612014-05-23 17:38:34 +020018715 request. The HTTP status code is likely a 408 here. Note: recently,
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020018716 some browsers started to implement a "pre-connect" feature consisting
18717 in speculatively connecting to some recently visited web sites just
18718 in case the user would like to visit them. This results in many
18719 connections being established to web sites, which end up in 408
18720 Request Timeout if the timeout strikes first, or 400 Bad Request when
18721 the browser decides to close them first. These ones pollute the log
18722 and feed the error counters. Some versions of some browsers have even
18723 been reported to display the error code. It is possible to work
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018724 around the undesirable effects of this behavior by adding "option
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020018725 http-ignore-probes" in the frontend, resulting in connections with
18726 zero data transfer to be totally ignored. This will definitely hide
18727 the errors of people experiencing connectivity issues though.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018728
18729 CT The client aborted while its session was tarpitted. It is important to
18730 check if this happens on valid requests, in order to be sure that no
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020018731 wrong tarpit rules have been written. If a lot of them happen, it
18732 might make sense to lower the "timeout tarpit" value to something
18733 closer to the average reported "Tw" timer, in order not to consume
18734 resources for just a few attackers.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018735
Willy Tarreau570f2212013-06-10 16:42:09 +020018736 LR The request was intercepted and locally handled by haproxy. Generally
18737 it means that this was a redirect or a stats request.
18738
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010018739 SC The server or an equipment between it and haproxy explicitly refused
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018740 the TCP connection (the proxy received a TCP RST or an ICMP message
18741 in return). Under some circumstances, it can also be the network
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018742 stack telling the proxy that the server is unreachable (e.g. no route,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018743 or no ARP response on local network). When this happens in HTTP mode,
18744 the status code is likely a 502 or 503 here.
18745
18746 sC The "timeout connect" stroke before a connection to the server could
18747 complete. When this happens in HTTP mode, the status code is likely a
18748 503 or 504 here.
18749
18750 SD The connection to the server died with an error during the data
18751 transfer. This usually means that haproxy has received an RST from
18752 the server or an ICMP message from an intermediate equipment while
18753 exchanging data with the server. This can be caused by a server crash
18754 or by a network issue on an intermediate equipment.
18755
18756 sD The server did not send nor acknowledge any data for as long as the
18757 "timeout server" setting during the data phase. This is often caused
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018758 by too short timeouts on L4 equipment before the server (firewalls,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018759 load-balancers, ...), as well as keep-alive sessions maintained
18760 between the client and the server expiring first on haproxy.
18761
18762 SH The server aborted before sending its full HTTP response headers, or
18763 it crashed while processing the request. Since a server aborting at
18764 this moment is very rare, it would be wise to inspect its logs to
18765 control whether it crashed and why. The logged request may indicate a
18766 small set of faulty requests, demonstrating bugs in the application.
18767 Sometimes this might also be caused by an IDS killing the connection
18768 between haproxy and the server.
18769
18770 sH The "timeout server" stroke before the server could return its
18771 response headers. This is the most common anomaly, indicating too
18772 long transactions, probably caused by server or database saturation.
18773 The immediate workaround consists in increasing the "timeout server"
18774 setting, but it is important to keep in mind that the user experience
18775 will suffer from these long response times. The only long term
18776 solution is to fix the application.
18777
18778 sQ The session spent too much time in queue and has been expired. See
18779 the "timeout queue" and "timeout connect" settings to find out how to
18780 fix this if it happens too often. If it often happens massively in
18781 short periods, it may indicate general problems on the affected
18782 servers due to I/O or database congestion, or saturation caused by
18783 external attacks.
18784
18785 PC The proxy refused to establish a connection to the server because the
18786 process' socket limit has been reached while attempting to connect.
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020018787 The global "maxconn" parameter may be increased in the configuration
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018788 so that it does not happen anymore. This status is very rare and
18789 might happen when the global "ulimit-n" parameter is forced by hand.
18790
Willy Tarreaued2fd2d2010-12-29 11:23:27 +010018791 PD The proxy blocked an incorrectly formatted chunked encoded message in
18792 a request or a response, after the server has emitted its headers. In
18793 most cases, this will indicate an invalid message from the server to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018794 the client. HAProxy supports chunk sizes of up to 2GB - 1 (2147483647
Willy Tarreauf3a3e132013-08-31 08:16:26 +020018795 bytes). Any larger size will be considered as an error.
Willy Tarreaued2fd2d2010-12-29 11:23:27 +010018796
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018797 PH The proxy blocked the server's response, because it was invalid,
18798 incomplete, dangerous (cache control), or matched a security filter.
18799 In any case, an HTTP 502 error is sent to the client. One possible
18800 cause for this error is an invalid syntax in an HTTP header name
Willy Tarreaued2fd2d2010-12-29 11:23:27 +010018801 containing unauthorized characters. It is also possible but quite
18802 rare, that the proxy blocked a chunked-encoding request from the
18803 client due to an invalid syntax, before the server responded. In this
18804 case, an HTTP 400 error is sent to the client and reported in the
18805 logs.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018806
18807 PR The proxy blocked the client's HTTP request, either because of an
18808 invalid HTTP syntax, in which case it returned an HTTP 400 error to
18809 the client, or because a deny filter matched, in which case it
18810 returned an HTTP 403 error.
18811
18812 PT The proxy blocked the client's request and has tarpitted its
18813 connection before returning it a 500 server error. Nothing was sent
18814 to the server. The connection was maintained open for as long as
18815 reported by the "Tw" timer field.
18816
18817 RC A local resource has been exhausted (memory, sockets, source ports)
18818 preventing the connection to the server from establishing. The error
18819 logs will tell precisely what was missing. This is very rare and can
18820 only be solved by proper system tuning.
18821
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020018822The combination of the two last flags gives a lot of information about how
18823persistence was handled by the client, the server and by haproxy. This is very
18824important to troubleshoot disconnections, when users complain they have to
18825re-authenticate. The commonly encountered flags are :
18826
18827 -- Persistence cookie is not enabled.
18828
18829 NN No cookie was provided by the client, none was inserted in the
18830 response. For instance, this can be in insert mode with "postonly"
18831 set on a GET request.
18832
18833 II A cookie designating an invalid server was provided by the client,
18834 a valid one was inserted in the response. This typically happens when
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040018835 a "server" entry is removed from the configuration, since its cookie
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020018836 value can be presented by a client when no other server knows it.
18837
18838 NI No cookie was provided by the client, one was inserted in the
18839 response. This typically happens for first requests from every user
18840 in "insert" mode, which makes it an easy way to count real users.
18841
18842 VN A cookie was provided by the client, none was inserted in the
18843 response. This happens for most responses for which the client has
18844 already got a cookie.
18845
18846 VU A cookie was provided by the client, with a last visit date which is
18847 not completely up-to-date, so an updated cookie was provided in
18848 response. This can also happen if there was no date at all, or if
18849 there was a date but the "maxidle" parameter was not set, so that the
18850 cookie can be switched to unlimited time.
18851
18852 EI A cookie was provided by the client, with a last visit date which is
18853 too old for the "maxidle" parameter, so the cookie was ignored and a
18854 new cookie was inserted in the response.
18855
18856 OI A cookie was provided by the client, with a first visit date which is
18857 too old for the "maxlife" parameter, so the cookie was ignored and a
18858 new cookie was inserted in the response.
18859
18860 DI The server designated by the cookie was down, a new server was
18861 selected and a new cookie was emitted in the response.
18862
18863 VI The server designated by the cookie was not marked dead but could not
18864 be reached. A redispatch happened and selected another one, which was
18865 then advertised in the response.
18866
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018867
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200188688.6. Non-printable characters
18869-----------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018870
18871In order not to cause trouble to log analysis tools or terminals during log
18872consulting, non-printable characters are not sent as-is into log files, but are
18873converted to the two-digits hexadecimal representation of their ASCII code,
18874prefixed by the character '#'. The only characters that can be logged without
18875being escaped are comprised between 32 and 126 (inclusive). Obviously, the
18876escape character '#' itself is also encoded to avoid any ambiguity ("#23"). It
18877is the same for the character '"' which becomes "#22", as well as '{', '|' and
18878'}' when logging headers.
18879
18880Note that the space character (' ') is not encoded in headers, which can cause
18881issues for tools relying on space count to locate fields. A typical header
18882containing spaces is "User-Agent".
18883
18884Last, it has been observed that some syslog daemons such as syslog-ng escape
18885the quote ('"') with a backslash ('\'). The reverse operation can safely be
18886performed since no quote may appear anywhere else in the logs.
18887
18888
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200188898.7. Capturing HTTP cookies
18890---------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018891
18892Cookie capture simplifies the tracking a complete user session. This can be
18893achieved using the "capture cookie" statement in the frontend. Please refer to
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020018894section 4.2 for more details. Only one cookie can be captured, and the same
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018895cookie will simultaneously be checked in the request ("Cookie:" header) and in
18896the response ("Set-Cookie:" header). The respective values will be reported in
18897the HTTP logs at the "captured_request_cookie" and "captured_response_cookie"
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020018898locations (see section 8.2.3 about HTTP log format). When either cookie is
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018899not seen, a dash ('-') replaces the value. This way, it's easy to detect when a
18900user switches to a new session for example, because the server will reassign it
18901a new cookie. It is also possible to detect if a server unexpectedly sets a
18902wrong cookie to a client, leading to session crossing.
18903
18904 Examples :
18905 # capture the first cookie whose name starts with "ASPSESSION"
18906 capture cookie ASPSESSION len 32
18907
18908 # capture the first cookie whose name is exactly "vgnvisitor"
18909 capture cookie vgnvisitor= len 32
18910
18911
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200189128.8. Capturing HTTP headers
18913---------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018914
18915Header captures are useful to track unique request identifiers set by an upper
18916proxy, virtual host names, user-agents, POST content-length, referrers, etc. In
18917the response, one can search for information about the response length, how the
18918server asked the cache to behave, or an object location during a redirection.
18919
18920Header captures are performed using the "capture request header" and "capture
18921response header" statements in the frontend. Please consult their definition in
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020018922section 4.2 for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018923
18924It is possible to include both request headers and response headers at the same
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010018925time. Non-existent headers are logged as empty strings, and if one header
18926appears more than once, only its last occurrence will be logged. Request headers
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018927are grouped within braces '{' and '}' in the same order as they were declared,
18928and delimited with a vertical bar '|' without any space. Response headers
18929follow the same representation, but are displayed after a space following the
18930request headers block. These blocks are displayed just before the HTTP request
18931in the logs.
18932
Willy Tarreaud9ed3d22014-06-13 12:23:06 +020018933As a special case, it is possible to specify an HTTP header capture in a TCP
18934frontend. The purpose is to enable logging of headers which will be parsed in
18935an HTTP backend if the request is then switched to this HTTP backend.
18936
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018937 Example :
18938 # This instance chains to the outgoing proxy
18939 listen proxy-out
18940 mode http
18941 option httplog
18942 option logasap
18943 log global
18944 server cache1 192.168.1.1:3128
18945
18946 # log the name of the virtual server
18947 capture request header Host len 20
18948
18949 # log the amount of data uploaded during a POST
18950 capture request header Content-Length len 10
18951
18952 # log the beginning of the referrer
18953 capture request header Referer len 20
18954
18955 # server name (useful for outgoing proxies only)
18956 capture response header Server len 20
18957
18958 # logging the content-length is useful with "option logasap"
18959 capture response header Content-Length len 10
18960
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018961 # log the expected cache behavior on the response
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018962 capture response header Cache-Control len 8
18963
18964 # the Via header will report the next proxy's name
18965 capture response header Via len 20
18966
18967 # log the URL location during a redirection
18968 capture response header Location len 20
18969
18970 >>> Aug 9 20:26:09 localhost \
18971 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34014 [09/Aug/2004:20:26:09] proxy-out \
18972 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/0/162/+162 200 +350 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
18973 {fr.adserver.yahoo.co||http://fr.f416.mail.} {|864|private||} \
18974 "GET http://fr.adserver.yahoo.com/"
18975
18976 >>> Aug 9 20:30:46 localhost \
18977 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34020 [09/Aug/2004:20:30:46] proxy-out \
18978 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/0/182/+182 200 +279 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
18979 {w.ods.org||} {Formilux/0.1.8|3495|||} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010018980 "GET http://trafic.1wt.eu/ HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018981
18982 >>> Aug 9 20:30:46 localhost \
18983 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34028 [09/Aug/2004:20:30:46] proxy-out \
18984 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/2/126/+128 301 +223 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
18985 {www.sytadin.equipement.gouv.fr||http://trafic.1wt.eu/} \
18986 {Apache|230|||http://www.sytadin.} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010018987 "GET http://www.sytadin.equipement.gouv.fr/ HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018988
18989
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200189908.9. Examples of logs
18991---------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018992
18993These are real-world examples of logs accompanied with an explanation. Some of
18994them have been made up by hand. The syslog part has been removed for better
18995reading. Their sole purpose is to explain how to decipher them.
18996
18997 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33318 [15/Oct/2003:08:31:57.130] px-http \
18998 px-http/srv1 6559/0/7/147/6723 200 243 - - ---- 5/3/3/1/0 0/0 \
18999 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
19000
19001 => long request (6.5s) entered by hand through 'telnet'. The server replied
19002 in 147 ms, and the session ended normally ('----')
19003
19004 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33319 [15/Oct/2003:08:31:57.149] px-http \
19005 px-http/srv1 6559/1230/7/147/6870 200 243 - - ---- 324/239/239/99/0 \
19006 0/9 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
19007
19008 => Idem, but the request was queued in the global queue behind 9 other
19009 requests, and waited there for 1230 ms.
19010
19011 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33320 [15/Oct/2003:08:32:17.654] px-http \
19012 px-http/srv1 9/0/7/14/+30 200 +243 - - ---- 3/3/3/1/0 0/0 \
19013 "GET /image.iso HTTP/1.0"
19014
19015 => request for a long data transfer. The "logasap" option was specified, so
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010019016 the log was produced just before transferring data. The server replied in
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019017 14 ms, 243 bytes of headers were sent to the client, and total time from
19018 accept to first data byte is 30 ms.
19019
19020 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33320 [15/Oct/2003:08:32:17.925] px-http \
19021 px-http/srv1 9/0/7/14/30 502 243 - - PH-- 3/2/2/0/0 0/0 \
19022 "GET /cgi-bin/bug.cgi? HTTP/1.0"
19023
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +020019024 => the proxy blocked a server response either because of an "http-response
19025 deny" rule, or because the response was improperly formatted and not
19026 HTTP-compliant, or because it blocked sensitive information which risked
19027 being cached. In this case, the response is replaced with a "502 bad
19028 gateway". The flags ("PH--") tell us that it was haproxy who decided to
19029 return the 502 and not the server.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019030
19031 >>> haproxy[18113]: 127.0.0.1:34548 [15/Oct/2003:15:18:55.798] px-http \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010019032 px-http/<NOSRV> -1/-1/-1/-1/8490 -1 0 - - CR-- 2/2/2/0/0 0/0 ""
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019033
19034 => the client never completed its request and aborted itself ("C---") after
19035 8.5s, while the proxy was waiting for the request headers ("-R--").
19036 Nothing was sent to any server.
19037
19038 >>> haproxy[18113]: 127.0.0.1:34549 [15/Oct/2003:15:19:06.103] px-http \
19039 px-http/<NOSRV> -1/-1/-1/-1/50001 408 0 - - cR-- 2/2/2/0/0 0/0 ""
19040
19041 => The client never completed its request, which was aborted by the
19042 time-out ("c---") after 50s, while the proxy was waiting for the request
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010019043 headers ("-R--"). Nothing was sent to any server, but the proxy could
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019044 send a 408 return code to the client.
19045
19046 >>> haproxy[18989]: 127.0.0.1:34550 [15/Oct/2003:15:24:28.312] px-tcp \
19047 px-tcp/srv1 0/0/5007 0 cD 0/0/0/0/0 0/0
19048
19049 => This log was produced with "option tcplog". The client timed out after
19050 5 seconds ("c----").
19051
19052 >>> haproxy[18989]: 10.0.0.1:34552 [15/Oct/2003:15:26:31.462] px-http \
19053 px-http/srv1 3183/-1/-1/-1/11215 503 0 - - SC-- 205/202/202/115/3 \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010019054 0/0 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019055
19056 => The request took 3s to complete (probably a network problem), and the
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020019057 connection to the server failed ('SC--') after 4 attempts of 2 seconds
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019058 (config says 'retries 3'), and no redispatch (otherwise we would have
19059 seen "/+3"). Status code 503 was returned to the client. There were 115
19060 connections on this server, 202 connections on this proxy, and 205 on
19061 the global process. It is possible that the server refused the
19062 connection because of too many already established.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010019063
Willy Tarreau52b2d222011-09-07 23:48:48 +020019064
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +0200190659. Supported filters
19066--------------------
19067
19068Here are listed officially supported filters with the list of parameters they
19069accept. Depending on compile options, some of these filters might be
19070unavailable. The list of available filters is reported in haproxy -vv.
19071
19072See also : "filter"
19073
190749.1. Trace
19075----------
19076
Christopher Faulet31bfe1f2016-12-09 17:42:38 +010019077filter trace [name <name>] [random-parsing] [random-forwarding] [hexdump]
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020019078
19079 Arguments:
19080 <name> is an arbitrary name that will be reported in
19081 messages. If no name is provided, "TRACE" is used.
19082
19083 <random-parsing> enables the random parsing of data exchanged between
19084 the client and the server. By default, this filter
19085 parses all available data. With this parameter, it
19086 only parses a random amount of the available data.
19087
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010019088 <random-forwarding> enables the random forwarding of parsed data. By
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020019089 default, this filter forwards all previously parsed
19090 data. With this parameter, it only forwards a random
19091 amount of the parsed data.
19092
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010019093 <hexdump> dumps all forwarded data to the server and the client.
Christopher Faulet31bfe1f2016-12-09 17:42:38 +010019094
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020019095This filter can be used as a base to develop new filters. It defines all
19096callbacks and print a message on the standard error stream (stderr) with useful
19097information for all of them. It may be useful to debug the activity of other
19098filters or, quite simply, HAProxy's activity.
19099
19100Using <random-parsing> and/or <random-forwarding> parameters is a good way to
19101tests the behavior of a filter that parses data exchanged between a client and
19102a server by adding some latencies in the processing.
19103
19104
191059.2. HTTP compression
19106---------------------
19107
19108filter compression
19109
19110The HTTP compression has been moved in a filter in HAProxy 1.7. "compression"
19111keyword must still be used to enable and configure the HTTP compression. And
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020019112when no other filter is used, it is enough. When used with the cache or the
19113fcgi-app enabled, it is also enough. In this case, the compression is always
19114done after the response is stored in the cache. But it is mandatory to
19115explicitly use a filter line to enable the HTTP compression when at least one
19116filter other than the cache or the fcgi-app is used for the same
19117listener/frontend/backend. This is important to know the filters evaluation
19118order.
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020019119
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020019120See also : "compression", section 9.4 about the cache filter and section 9.5
19121 about the fcgi-app filter.
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020019122
19123
Christopher Fauletf7e4e7e2016-10-27 22:29:49 +0200191249.3. Stream Processing Offload Engine (SPOE)
19125--------------------------------------------
19126
19127filter spoe [engine <name>] config <file>
19128
19129 Arguments :
19130
19131 <name> is the engine name that will be used to find the right scope in
19132 the configuration file. If not provided, all the file will be
19133 parsed.
19134
19135 <file> is the path of the engine configuration file. This file can
19136 contain configuration of several engines. In this case, each
19137 part must be placed in its own scope.
19138
19139The Stream Processing Offload Engine (SPOE) is a filter communicating with
19140external components. It allows the offload of some specifics processing on the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010019141streams in tiered applications. These external components and information
Christopher Fauletf7e4e7e2016-10-27 22:29:49 +020019142exchanged with them are configured in dedicated files, for the main part. It
19143also requires dedicated backends, defined in HAProxy configuration.
19144
19145SPOE communicates with external components using an in-house binary protocol,
19146the Stream Processing Offload Protocol (SPOP).
19147
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010019148For all information about the SPOE configuration and the SPOP specification, see
Christopher Fauletf7e4e7e2016-10-27 22:29:49 +020019149"doc/SPOE.txt".
19150
19151Important note:
19152 The SPOE filter is highly experimental for now and was not heavily
19153 tested. It is really not production ready. So use it carefully.
19154
Christopher Faulet99a17a22018-12-11 09:18:27 +0100191559.4. Cache
19156----------
19157
19158filter cache <name>
19159
19160 Arguments :
19161
19162 <name> is name of the cache section this filter will use.
19163
19164The cache uses a filter to store cacheable responses. The HTTP rules
19165"cache-store" and "cache-use" must be used to define how and when to use a
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050019166cache. By default the corresponding filter is implicitly defined. And when no
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020019167other filters than fcgi-app or compression are used, it is enough. In such
19168case, the compression filter is always evaluated after the cache filter. But it
19169is mandatory to explicitly use a filter line to use a cache when at least one
19170filter other than the compression or the fcgi-app is used for the same
Christopher Faulet27d93c32018-12-15 22:32:02 +010019171listener/frontend/backend. This is important to know the filters evaluation
19172order.
Christopher Faulet99a17a22018-12-11 09:18:27 +010019173
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020019174See also : section 9.2 about the compression filter, section 9.5 about the
19175 fcgi-app filter and section 6 about cache.
19176
19177
191789.5. Fcgi-app
19179-------------
19180
19181filter fcg-app <name>
19182
19183 Arguments :
19184
19185 <name> is name of the fcgi-app section this filter will use.
19186
19187The FastCGI application uses a filter to evaluate all custom parameters on the
19188request path, and to process the headers on the response path. the <name> must
19189reference an existing fcgi-app section. The directive "use-fcgi-app" should be
19190used to define the application to use. By default the corresponding filter is
19191implicitly defined. And when no other filters than cache or compression are
19192used, it is enough. But it is mandatory to explicitly use a filter line to a
19193fcgi-app when at least one filter other than the compression or the cache is
19194used for the same backend. This is important to know the filters evaluation
19195order.
19196
19197See also: "use-fcgi-app", section 9.2 about the compression filter, section 9.4
19198 about the cache filter and section 10 about FastCGI application.
19199
19200
1920110. FastCGI applications
19202-------------------------
19203
19204HAProxy is able to send HTTP requests to Responder FastCGI applications. This
19205feature was added in HAProxy 2.1. To do so, servers must be configured to use
19206the FastCGI protocol (using the keyword "proto fcgi" on the server line) and a
19207FastCGI application must be configured and used by the backend managing these
19208servers (using the keyword "use-fcgi-app" into the proxy section). Several
19209FastCGI applications may be defined, but only one can be used at a time by a
19210backend.
19211
19212HAProxy implements all features of the FastCGI specification for Responder
19213application. Especially it is able to multiplex several requests on a simple
19214connection.
19215
1921610.1. Setup
19217-----------
19218
1921910.1.1. Fcgi-app section
19220--------------------------
19221
19222fcgi-app <name>
19223 Declare a FastCGI application named <name>. To be valid, at least the
19224 document root must be defined.
19225
19226acl <aclname> <criterion> [flags] [operator] <value> ...
19227 Declare or complete an access list.
19228
19229 See "acl" keyword in section 4.2 and section 7 about ACL usage for
19230 details. ACLs defined for a FastCGI application are private. They cannot be
19231 used by any other application or by any proxy. In the same way, ACLs defined
19232 in any other section are not usable by a FastCGI application. However,
19233 Pre-defined ACLs are available.
19234
19235docroot <path>
19236 Define the document root on the remote host. <path> will be used to build
19237 the default value of FastCGI parameters SCRIPT_FILENAME and
19238 PATH_TRANSLATED. It is a mandatory setting.
19239
19240index <script-name>
19241 Define the script name that will be appended after an URI that ends with a
19242 slash ("/") to set the default value of the FastCGI parameter SCRIPT_NAME. It
19243 is an optional setting.
19244
19245 Example :
19246 index index.php
19247
19248log-stderr global
19249log-stderr <address> [len <length>] [format <format>]
19250 [sample <ranges>:<smp_size>] <facility> [<level> [<minlevel>]]
19251 Enable logging of STDERR messages reported by the FastCGI application.
19252
19253 See "log" keyword in section 4.2 for details. It is an optional setting. By
19254 default STDERR messages are ignored.
19255
19256pass-header <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
19257 Specify the name of a request header which will be passed to the FastCGI
19258 application. It may optionally be followed by an ACL-based condition, in
19259 which case it will only be evaluated if the condition is true.
19260
19261 Most request headers are already available to the FastCGI application,
19262 prefixed with "HTTP_". Thus, this directive is only required to pass headers
19263 that are purposefully omitted. Currently, the headers "Authorization",
19264 "Proxy-Authorization" and hop-by-hop headers are omitted.
19265
19266 Note that the headers "Content-type" and "Content-length" are never passed to
19267 the FastCGI application because they are already converted into parameters.
19268
19269path-info <regex>
Christopher Faulet28cb3662020-02-14 14:47:37 +010019270 Define a regular expression to extract the script-name and the path-info from
Christopher Faulet6c57f2d2020-02-14 16:55:52 +010019271 the URL-decoded path. Thus, <regex> may have two captures: the first one to
19272 capture the script name and the second one to capture the path-info. The
19273 first one is mandatory, the second one is optional. This way, it is possible
19274 to extract the script-name from the path ignoring the path-info. It is an
19275 optional setting. If it is not defined, no matching is performed on the
19276 path. and the FastCGI parameters PATH_INFO and PATH_TRANSLATED are not
19277 filled.
Christopher Faulet28cb3662020-02-14 14:47:37 +010019278
19279 For security reason, when this regular expression is defined, the newline and
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +050019280 the null characters are forbidden from the path, once URL-decoded. The reason
Christopher Faulet28cb3662020-02-14 14:47:37 +010019281 to such limitation is because otherwise the matching always fails (due to a
19282 limitation one the way regular expression are executed in HAProxy). So if one
19283 of these two characters is found in the URL-decoded path, an error is
19284 returned to the client. The principle of least astonishment is applied here.
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020019285
19286 Example :
Christopher Faulet6c57f2d2020-02-14 16:55:52 +010019287 path-info ^(/.+\.php)(/.*)?$ # both script-name and path-info may be set
19288 path-info ^(/.+\.php) # the path-info is ignored
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020019289
19290option get-values
19291no option get-values
19292 Enable or disable the retrieve of variables about connection management.
19293
19294 HAproxy is able to send the record FCGI_GET_VALUES on connection
19295 establishment to retrieve the value for following variables:
19296
19297 * FCGI_MAX_REQS The maximum number of concurrent requests this
19298 application will accept.
19299
William Lallemand93e548e2019-09-30 13:54:02 +020019300 * FCGI_MPXS_CONNS "0" if this application does not multiplex connections,
19301 "1" otherwise.
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020019302
19303 Some FastCGI applications does not support this feature. Some others close
19304 the connexion immediately after sending their response. So, by default, this
19305 option is disabled.
19306
19307 Note that the maximum number of concurrent requests accepted by a FastCGI
19308 application is a connection variable. It only limits the number of streams
19309 per connection. If the global load must be limited on the application, the
19310 server parameters "maxconn" and "pool-max-conn" must be set. In addition, if
19311 an application does not support connection multiplexing, the maximum number
19312 of concurrent requests is automatically set to 1.
19313
19314option keep-conn
19315no option keep-conn
19316 Instruct the FastCGI application to keep the connection open or not after
19317 sending a response.
19318
19319 If disabled, the FastCGI application closes the connection after responding
19320 to this request. By default, this option is enabled.
19321
19322option max-reqs <reqs>
19323 Define the maximum number of concurrent requests this application will
19324 accept.
19325
19326 This option may be overwritten if the variable FCGI_MAX_REQS is retrieved
19327 during connection establishment. Furthermore, if the application does not
19328 support connection multiplexing, this option will be ignored. By default set
19329 to 1.
19330
19331option mpxs-conns
19332no option mpxs-conns
19333 Enable or disable the support of connection multiplexing.
19334
19335 This option may be overwritten if the variable FCGI_MPXS_CONNS is retrieved
19336 during connection establishment. It is disabled by default.
19337
19338set-param <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
19339 Set a FastCGI parameter that should be passed to this application. Its
19340 value, defined by <fmt> must follows the log-format rules (see section 8.2.4
19341 "Custom Log format"). It may optionally be followed by an ACL-based
19342 condition, in which case it will only be evaluated if the condition is true.
19343
19344 With this directive, it is possible to overwrite the value of default FastCGI
19345 parameters. If the value is evaluated to an empty string, the rule is
19346 ignored. These directives are evaluated in their declaration order.
19347
19348 Example :
19349 # PHP only, required if PHP was built with --enable-force-cgi-redirect
19350 set-param REDIRECT_STATUS 200
19351
19352 set-param PHP_AUTH_DIGEST %[req.hdr(Authorization)]
19353
19354
1935510.1.2. Proxy section
19356---------------------
19357
19358use-fcgi-app <name>
19359 Define the FastCGI application to use for the backend.
19360
19361 Arguments :
19362 <name> is the name of the FastCGI application to use.
19363
19364 This keyword is only available for HTTP proxies with the backend capability
19365 and with at least one FastCGI server. However, FastCGI servers can be mixed
19366 with HTTP servers. But except there is a good reason to do so, it is not
19367 recommended (see section 10.3 about the limitations for details). Only one
19368 application may be defined at a time per backend.
19369
19370 Note that, once a FastCGI application is referenced for a backend, depending
19371 on the configuration some processing may be done even if the request is not
19372 sent to a FastCGI server. Rules to set parameters or pass headers to an
19373 application are evaluated.
19374
19375
1937610.1.3. Example
19377---------------
19378
19379 frontend front-http
19380 mode http
19381 bind *:80
19382 bind *:
19383
19384 use_backend back-dynamic if { path_reg ^/.+\.php(/.*)?$ }
19385 default_backend back-static
19386
19387 backend back-static
19388 mode http
19389 server www A.B.C.D:80
19390
19391 backend back-dynamic
19392 mode http
19393 use-fcgi-app php-fpm
19394 server php-fpm A.B.C.D:9000 proto fcgi
19395
19396 fcgi-app php-fpm
19397 log-stderr global
19398 option keep-conn
19399
19400 docroot /var/www/my-app
19401 index index.php
19402 path-info ^(/.+\.php)(/.*)?$
19403
19404
1940510.2. Default parameters
19406------------------------
19407
19408A Responder FastCGI application has the same purpose as a CGI/1.1 program. In
19409the CGI/1.1 specification (RFC3875), several variables must be passed to the
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +050019410script. So HAProxy set them and some others commonly used by FastCGI
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020019411applications. All these variables may be overwritten, with caution though.
19412
19413 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
19414 | AUTH_TYPE | Identifies the mechanism, if any, used by HAProxy |
19415 | | to authenticate the user. Concretely, only the |
19416 | | BASIC authentication mechanism is supported. |
19417 | | |
19418 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
19419 | CONTENT_LENGTH | Contains the size of the message-body attached to |
19420 | | the request. It means only requests with a known |
19421 | | size are considered as valid and sent to the |
19422 | | application. |
19423 | | |
19424 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
19425 | CONTENT_TYPE | Contains the type of the message-body attached to |
19426 | | the request. It may not be set. |
19427 | | |
19428 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
19429 | DOCUMENT_ROOT | Contains the document root on the remote host under |
19430 | | which the script should be executed, as defined in |
19431 | | the application's configuration. |
19432 | | |
19433 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
19434 | GATEWAY_INTERFACE | Contains the dialect of CGI being used by HAProxy |
19435 | | to communicate with the FastCGI application. |
19436 | | Concretely, it is set to "CGI/1.1". |
19437 | | |
19438 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
19439 | PATH_INFO | Contains the portion of the URI path hierarchy |
19440 | | following the part that identifies the script |
19441 | | itself. To be set, the directive "path-info" must |
19442 | | be defined. |
19443 | | |
19444 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
19445 | PATH_TRANSLATED | If PATH_INFO is set, it is its translated version. |
19446 | | It is the concatenation of DOCUMENT_ROOT and |
19447 | | PATH_INFO. If PATH_INFO is not set, this parameters |
19448 | | is not set too. |
19449 | | |
19450 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
19451 | QUERY_STRING | Contains the request's query string. It may not be |
19452 | | set. |
19453 | | |
19454 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
19455 | REMOTE_ADDR | Contains the network address of the client sending |
19456 | | the request. |
19457 | | |
19458 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
19459 | REMOTE_USER | Contains the user identification string supplied by |
19460 | | client as part of user authentication. |
19461 | | |
19462 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
19463 | REQUEST_METHOD | Contains the method which should be used by the |
19464 | | script to process the request. |
19465 | | |
19466 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
19467 | REQUEST_URI | Contains the request's URI. |
19468 | | |
19469 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
19470 | SCRIPT_FILENAME | Contains the absolute pathname of the script. it is |
19471 | | the concatenation of DOCUMENT_ROOT and SCRIPT_NAME. |
19472 | | |
19473 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
19474 | SCRIPT_NAME | Contains the name of the script. If the directive |
19475 | | "path-info" is defined, it is the first part of the |
19476 | | URI path hierarchy, ending with the script name. |
19477 | | Otherwise, it is the entire URI path. |
19478 | | |
19479 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
19480 | SERVER_NAME | Contains the name of the server host to which the |
19481 | | client request is directed. It is the value of the |
19482 | | header "Host", if defined. Otherwise, the |
19483 | | destination address of the connection on the client |
19484 | | side. |
19485 | | |
19486 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
19487 | SERVER_PORT | Contains the destination TCP port of the connection |
19488 | | on the client side, which is the port the client |
19489 | | connected to. |
19490 | | |
19491 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
19492 | SERVER_PROTOCOL | Contains the request's protocol. |
19493 | | |
19494 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
19495 | HTTPS | Set to a non-empty value ("on") if the script was |
19496 | | queried through the HTTPS protocol. |
19497 | | |
19498 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
19499
19500
1950110.3. Limitations
19502------------------
19503
19504The current implementation have some limitations. The first one is about the
19505way some request headers are hidden to the FastCGI applications. This happens
19506during the headers analysis, on the backend side, before the connection
19507establishment. At this stage, HAProxy know the backend is using a FastCGI
19508application but it don't know if the request will be routed to a FastCGI server
19509or not. But to hide request headers, it simply removes them from the HTX
19510message. So, if the request is finally routed to an HTTP server, it never see
19511these headers. For this reason, it is not recommended to mix FastCGI servers
19512and HTTP servers under the same backend.
19513
19514Similarly, the rules "set-param" and "pass-header" are evaluated during the
19515request headers analysis. So the evaluation is always performed, even if the
19516requests is finally forwarded to an HTTP server.
19517
19518About the rules "set-param", when a rule is applied, a pseudo header is added
19519into the HTX message. So, the same way than for HTTP header rewrites, it may
19520fail if the buffer is full. The rules "set-param" will compete with
19521"http-request" ones.
19522
19523Finally, all FastCGI params and HTTP headers are sent into a unique record
19524FCGI_PARAM. Encoding of this record must be done in one pass, otherwise a
19525processing error is returned. It means the record FCGI_PARAM, once encoded,
19526must not exceeds the size of a buffer. However, there is no reserve to respect
19527here.
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +010019528
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010019529/*
19530 * Local variables:
19531 * fill-column: 79
19532 * End:
19533 */